Skip to main content

Full text of "Works of Jules Verne"

See other formats


MM 


THIS  IS  VOLUME  13 
OF  A  COMPLETE  SET 
OF  THE  WORKS  OF 


Jules 
Verne 


consisting  of  fifteen  vol- 
umes, issued  strictly  as  a 
limited  edition.  In  Volume 
One  will  be  found  a  certif- 
icate as  to  the  limitation 
of  the  edition  and  the  reg- 
istered number  of  this  set. 


RKS 


THE  ASSAULT  ON  THE  TREE  HOUSE. 

Then  the  reports  of  the  guns  began  to  echo  from  the  embrasures. 
By  the  flashes,  Godfrey  on  the  one  side,  and  Carefinotu  on  the  other, 
beheld  the  foes  they  had  to  deal  with.  There,  in  the  enclosure,  roaring 
with  rage,  howling  at  the  reports,  rolling  beneath  the  bullets  which 
struck  many  of  them,  leaped  lions  and  tigers,  hyaenas  and  panthers,  at 
least  a  score.  To  their  roarings  and  growlings  which  reverberated  from 
afar,  there  echoed  back  those  of  other  ferocious  beasts  running  up  to 
join  them. — Page  135. 


Vol.  13. 


OMPANY 


. 


JULES  VEKNE 


EDITED  BY 

CHARLES  F.  HORNE,  Ph.D. 

Professor  of  English,  College  of  the  City  of  New  York 
Author  of  "The  Technique  of  the  Novel,"  etc. 


VINCENT  PARKE  AND  COMPANY 


NEW   YORK 


LONDON 


ILLUSTRATIONS 

VOLUME  THIRTEEN 

PAGH 

THE  ASSAUI/T  ON  THE  TREE  HOUSE.  Frontispiece 

THE  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH          .  .208 

"WHEN  THE  SEAS  ARE  SHIFTED"    ....     320 


vii 


INTRODUCTION  TO  VOLUME  THIRTEEN 

HE  ROBINSON  'CRUSOE  'SCHOOL,"  pub- 
lished  in  1882,  classes  with  "  The  Tribulations 
of  a  Chinaman  "  as  a  whimsical  fantasy,  tossed 
off  by  Jules  Verne  in  lighter  mood,  without 
either  the  geographical  or  the  scientific  pur- 
pose, one  of  which  was  usually  dominant  in  his  books.  He 
jests  good-naturedly  here,  as  indeed  he  does  in  several  of 
his  later  books,  with  the  vast  fortunes,  the  "hundred  mil- 
lions "  commonly  ascribed  to  Americans. 

What  could  be  more  grotesque  than  the  contest  of  the  two 
San  Francisco  millionaires  for  possession  of  a  worthless 
island,  for  which  neither  at  the  moment  has  any  use?  So, 
too,  we  have  the  exaggerated  picture  of  the  gilded  youth, 
utterly  unacquainted  with  the  stern  realities  of  life,  pining  to 
be  a  Robinson  Crusoe  on  a  desert  island.  The  deliberate 
preparation  for  him  of  the  uncomfortable  situation  he  has 
desired,  along  with  all  the  Crusoe  incidents,  would  have  in 
itself  been  a  merry  farce.  When  to  this  is  added  the  ven- 
geance of  the  defeated  millionaire,  turning  loose  his  mon- 
sters also  upon  the  solitude,  we  get  an  extravaganza  mingled 
with  elements  of  real  danger  and  excitement  such  as  has 
been  seldom  equaled. 

"  The  Star  of  the  South '"  ( 188  tf,  takes  us  back  to  H fried 
again;  but  not  to  the  ^Africa  of  Verne's  first  success  "  Five 
Weeks  in  a  Balloon/'  nor  of  his  tragic  slave  tale  "Dick 
Sands.1''  Those  dealt  with  the  rAfrica  of  the  negro.  This 
tale  is  of  the  ^Africa  of  the  white  man.  The  diamond  re- 
gion and  the  diamond  mines  are  fully  and  closely  depicted, 
so  are  the  rough  and  hard  types  of  men  who  make  their  way 
there. 

these  is  presented,  in  singular  contrast,  'the  edu- 


2  INTRODUCTION 

cated  young  French  engineer,  a  man,  a  gentleman,  and  a 
scientist.  Verne  has  drawn  few  better  characters  than  this 
of  Victor  Cyprien.  Though  perhaps  one  may  be  permitted 
to  suggest  that  Cyprien's  altruism  is  scarcely  convincing. 
The  love  which  twice  surrenders  its  beloved,  rather  than 
transgress  the  conventions  of  a  social  world  with  which 
neither  lover  is  any  longer  associated,  seems  to  us  a  rather 
feeble  one.  The  indifference  to  wealth  which,  while  watch- 
ing other  men  gather  diamonds  all  around,  can  only  puzzle 
over  their  desire,  and  be  contemptuous  of  their  madness, 
is  as  little  French  as  it  is  American. 

The  easy  deception  of  the  engineer  into  the  idea  that  he 
has  manufactured  a  giant  diamond,  may  be  accepted  by  the 
not  too  critical  reader  as  the  necessary  foundation  of  the 
story,  which  is  certainly  bright,  mystifying,  and  interesting 
in  the  extreme.  Africa  had  been  treated  so  seriously  in  the 
earlier  tales,  that  one  is  glad  to  find  Verne  here  playing  with 
it  in  the  scenes  where  his  people  ride  ostriches  and  giraffes. 
are  borne  aloft  by  trapped  birds,  and  leave  the  manufacture 
of  their  artificial  diamonds  to  dodge  one  another  murder- 
ously across  country. 

]As  to  "  The  Purchase  of  the  North  Pole  "  (1889),  or  as 
Verne  himself  'first  called  it  literally  "  Sense  Upside  Down," 
it  is  a  sequel  to  "  A  Trip  to  the  Moon"  written  a  quarter 
century  before.  In  its  mathematical  sincerity  and  extrava- 
gance of  analysis  it  is  worthy  of  the  earlier  tale.  With  his 
mountains  of  figures  the  author  deliberately  plays  a  joke 
upon  the  trusting  reader,  by  pointing  out  in  the  end  that  the 
figures  are  all  wrong.  In  its  astronomical  suggestiveness 
and  impressive  form  of  conveying  instruction,  this  story  is 
again  the  equal  of  its  predecessor. 


The  Robinson  Crusoe  School 


or 
A  Californian  Mystery 

CHAPTER  I 

AN    ISLAND    FOR    SALE 

N  island  to  sell,  for  cash,  to  the  highest  bid- 
der!" said  Dean  Felporg,  the  auctioneer, 
standing  behind  his  rostrum  in  the  room 
where  the  conditions  of  the  singular  sale 
were  being  noisily  discussed. 

"Island  for  sale!  island  for  sale!"  re- 
peated in  shrill  tones  again  and  again  Gingrass,  the  crier, 
who  was  threading  his  way  in  and  out  of  the  excited 
crowd  closely  packed  inside  the  largest  saloon  in  the 
auction  mart  at  No.  10  Sacramento  Street,  in  San  Fran- 
cisco. 

The  crowd  consisted  not  only  of  a  goodly  number  of 
Americans  from  the  States  of  Utah,  Oregon,  and  Cali- 
fornia, but  also  of  a  few  Frenchmen,  who  are  quite 
numerous  in  the  far  West. 

Mexicans  were  there  enveloped  in  their  sarapes;  China- 
men in  their  large-sleeved  tunics,  pointed  shoes,  and 
conical  hats;  one  or  two  Kanucks  from  the  coast;  and 
even  a  sprinkling  of  Black  Feet,  Grosventres,  or  Flat- 
heads,  from  the  banks  of  the  Trinity  River. 

The  scene  is  in  San  Francisco,  the  capital  of  Cali- 
fornia, but  not  at  the  period  when  the  placer-mining 
fever  was  raging — from  1849  to  *%52.  San  Francisco 
was  no  longer  what  it  had  been  then,  a  caravanserai,  a 
terminus,  an  inn,  where  for  a  night  there  slept  the  busy 
men  who  were  hastening  to  the  gold-fields  west  of  the 
Sierra  Nevada.  At  the  end  of  some  twenty  years  the 


4  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

old  unknown  Yerba-Buena  had  given  place  to  a  town 
unique  of  its  kind,  peopled  by  100,000  inhabitants,  built 
under  the  shelter  of  a  couple  of  hills,  away  from  the 
shore,  but  stretching  off  to  the  farthest  heights  in  ^  the 
background — a  city  in  short  which  has  dethroned  Lima, 
Santiago,  Valparaiso,  and  every  other  rival,  and  which 
the  Americans  have  made  the  queen  of  the  Pacific,  the 
"glory  of  the  western  coast!" 

It  was  the  I5th  of  May,  and  the  weather  was  still 
cold.  But  the  cold  was  hardly  noticeable  in  the  thick 
of  the  auction  crowd.  The  bell  with  its  incessant  clangor 
had  brought  together  an  enormous  throng,  and  quite  a 
summer  temperature  caused  the  drops  of  perspiration  to 
glisten  on  the  foreheads  of  the  spectators. 

Do  not  imagine  that  all  these  folks  had  come  to  the 
auction-room  with  the  intention  of  buying.  I  might  say 
that  all  of  them  had  but  come  to  see.  Who  was  going  to 
be  mad  enough,  even  if  he  were  rich  enough,  to  purchase 
an  isle  of  the  Pacific,  which  the  government  had  in  some 
eccentric  moment  decided  to  sell?  Would  the  reserve 
price  ever  be  reached?  Could  anybody  be  found  to  work 
up  the  bidding?  If  not,  it  would  scarcely  be  the  fault  of 
the  public  crier,  who  tried  his  best  to  tempt  buyers  by  his 
shoutings  and  gestures,  and  the  flowery  metaphors  of  his 
harangue.  People  laughed  at  him,  but  they  did  not  seem 
much  influenced  by  him. 

"An  island!  an  isle  to  sell!"  repeated  Gingrass. 

"But  not  to  buy!"  answered  an  Irishman,  whose  pocket 
did  not  hold  enough  to  pay  for  a  single  pebble. 

"An  island  which  at  the  valuation  will  not  fetch  six 
dollars  an  acre!"  said  the  auctioneer. 

"And  which  won't  pay  an  eight  per  cent.!"  replied  a 
big  farmer,  who  was  well  acquainted  with  agricultural 
speculations. 

"An  isle  which  measures  quite  sixty-four  miles  around, 
and  has  an  area  of  two  hundred  and  twenty-five  thousand 
acres!" 

"Is  it  solid  on  its  foundation?"  asked  a  Mexican,  an 
old  customer  at  the  liquor-bars,  whose  personal  solidity 
seemed  rather  doubtful  at  the  moment. 

"An  isle  with  forests  still  virgin!"  repeated  the  crier, 
"with  prairies,  hills,  watercourses — " 


AN  ISLAND  FOR  SALE  5 

"Warranted?"  asked  a  Frenchman,  who  seemed  rather 
inclined  to  nibble. 

"Yes!  warranted!"  added  Felporg,  much  too  old  at 
his  trade  to  be  moved  by  the  chaff  of  the  public. 

"For  two  years?" 

"To  the  end  of  the  world!" 

"Beyond  that?" 

"A  freehold  island!"  repeated  the  crier,  "an  island 
without  a  single  noxious  animal,  no  wild  beasts,  no 
reptiles!—" 

"No  birds?"  added  a  wag. 

"No  insects?"  inquired  another. 

"An  island  for  the  highest  bidder!"  said  Dean  Felporg, 
beginning  again.  "Come,  gentlemen,  come!  Have  a  little 
courage  in  your  pockets !  Who  wants  an  island  in  perfect 
state  of  repair,  never  been  used,  an  island  in  the  Pacific, 
that  ocean  of  oceans?  The  valuation  is  a  mere  nothing! 
It  is  put  at  eleven  hundred  thousand  dollars,  is  there  any 
one  will  bid?  Who  speaks  first?  You,  sir? — you,  over 
there,  nodding  your  head  like  a  porcelain  mandarin? 
Here  is  an  island!  a  really  good  island!  Who  says  an 
island?" 

"Pass  it  around!"  said  a  voice,  as  if  they  were  dealing 
with  a  picture  or  a  vase. 

And  the  room  shouted  with  laughter,  but  not  a  half- 
dollar  was  bid. 

However,  if  the  lot  could  not  be  passed  around,  the  map 
of  the  island  was  at  the  public  disposal.  The  where- 
abouts of  the  portion  of  the  globe  under  consideration 
could  be  accurately  ascertained.  There  was  neither  sur- 
prise nor  disappointment  to  be  feared  in  that  respect. 
Situation,  orientation,  outline,  altitudes,  levels,  hydrog- 
raphy, climatology,  lines  of  communication,  all  these 
were  easily  to  be  verified  in  advance.  People  were  not 
buying  a  pig  in  a  poke,  and  most  undoubtedly  there  could 
be  no  mistake  as  to  the  nature  of  the  goods  on  sale. 
Moreover,  the  innumerable  journals  of  the  United  States, 
especially  those  of  California,  had  been  for  several  months 
directing  constant  attention  to  the  island  whose  sale  by 
auction  had  been  authorized  by  Act  of  Congress. 

The  island  was  Spencer  Island,  which  lies  about  460 
miles  from  the  Calif ornian  coast,  in  32°  15'  north  latitude, 


6  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

and  145°  1 8'  west  longitude,  reckoning  from  Greenwich. 
It  would  be  impossible  to  imagine  a  more  isolated  posi- 
tion, quite  out  of  the  way  of  all  maritime  or  commercial 
traffic,  although  Spencer  Island  was,  relatively,  not  very 
far  off,  and  situated  practically  in  American  waters.  But 
thereabout  the  regular  currents  diverging  to  the  north 
and  south  have  formed  a  kind  of  lake  of  calms,  which  is 
sometimes  known  as  the  "Whirlpool  of  Fleurieu." 

It  is  in  the  center  of  this  enormous  eddy,  which  has 
hardly  an  appreciable  movement,  that  Spencer  Island  is 
situated.  And  so  it  is  sighted  by  very  few  ships.  The 
main  routes  of  the  Pacific,  which  join  the  new  to  the  old 
continent,  and  lead  away  to  China  or  Japan,  run  in  a  more 
southerly  direction.  Sailing-vessels  would  meet  with  end- 
less calms  in  the  Whirlpool  of  Fleurieu;  and  steamers, 
which  always  take  the  shortest  road,  would  gain  no  ad- 
vantage by  crossing  it.  Hence  ships  of  neither  class  know 
anything  of  Spencer  Island,  which  rises  above  the  waters 
like  the  isolated  summit  of  one  of  the  submarine  moun- 
tains of  the  Pacific.  Truly,  for  a  man  wishing  to  flee 
from  the  noise  of  the  world,  seeking  quiet  in  solitude, 
what  could  be  better  than  this  island,  lost  within  a  few 
hundred  miles  of  the  coast?  For  a  voluntary  Robinson 
Crusoe,  it  would  be  the  very  ideal  of  its  kind!  Only  of 
course  he  must  pay  for  it. 

And  now,  why  did  the  United  States  desire  to  part  with 
the  island?  Was  it  for  some  whim?  No!  A  great 
nation  cannot  act  on  caprice  in  any  matter,  however 
simple.  The  truth  was  this:  situated  as  it  was,  Spencer 
Island  had  for  a  long  time  been  known  as  a  station  per- 
fectly useless.  There  could  be  no  practical  result  from 
settling  there.  In  a  military  point  of  view  it  was  of  no 
importance,  for  it  only  commanded  an  absolutely  deserted 
portion  of  the  Pacific.  In  a  commercial  point  of  view 
there  was  a  similar  want  of  importance,  for  the  products 
would  not  pay  the  freight  either  inward  or  outward. 
For  a  criminal  colony  it  was  too  far  from  the  coast. 
And  to  occupy  it  in  any  way,  would  be  a  very  expensive 
undertaking.  So  it  had  remained  deserted  from  time  im- 
memorial, and  Congress,  composed  of  "eminently  practi- 
cal'* men,  had  resolved  to  put  it  up  for  sale — on  one 


AN  ISLAND  FOR  SALE  7 

condition  only,  and  that  was,  that  its  purchaser  should 
be  a  free  American  citizen.  There  was  no  intention  of 
giving  away  the  island  for  nothing,  and  so  the  reserve 
price  had  been  fixed  at  $1,100,000.  This  amount  for  a 
financial  society  dealing  with  such  matters  was  a  mere 
bagatelle,  if  the  transaction  could  offer  any  advantages; 
but  as  we  need  hardly  repeat,  it  offered  none,  and  com- 
petent men  attached  no  more  value  to  this  detached  por- 
tion of  the  United  States,  than  to  one  of  the  islands  lost 
beneath  the  glaciers  of  the  Pole. 

In  one  sense,  however,  the  amount  was  considerable.  A 
man  must  be  rich  to  pay  for  this  hobby,  for  in  any  case  it 
would  not  return  him  a  halfpenny  per  cent.  He  would 
even  have  to  be  immensely  rich  for  the  transaction  was  to 
be  a  "cash"  one,  and  even  in  the  United  States  it  is  as 
yet  rare  to  find  citizens  with  $1,100,000  in  their  pockets, 
who  would  care  to  throw  the  amount  into  the  water  with- 
out hope  of  return.  And  Congress  had  decided  not  to 
sell  the  island  under  the  price.  Eleven  hundred  thousand 
dollars,  not  a  cent  less,  or  Spencer  Island  would  remain 
the  property  of  the  Union.  It  was  hardly  likely  that  any 
one  would  be  mad  enough  to  buy  it  on  the  terms. 

Besides,  it  was  expressly  reserved  that  the  proprietor, 
if  one  offered,  should  not  become  king  of  Spencer  Island, 
but  president  of  a  republic.  He  would  gain  no  right  to 
have  subjects,  but  only  fellow-citizens,  who  could  elect 
him  for  a  fixed  time,  and  would  be  free  from  re-electing 
him  indefinitely.  Under  any  circumstances  he  was  for- 
bidden to  play  at  monarchy.  The  Union  could  never 
tolerate  the  foundation  of  a  kingdom,  no  matter  how 
small,  in  American  waters. 

This  reservation  was  enough  to  keep  off  many  an 
ambitious  millionaire,  many  an  aged  nabob,  who  might 
like  to  compete  with  the  kings  of  the  Sandwich,  the 
Marquesas,  and  the  other  archipelagoes  of  the  Pacific. 

In  short,  for  one  reason  or  other,  nobody  presented 
himself.  Time  was  getting  on,  the  crier  was  out  of  breath 
in  his  efforts  to  secure  a  buyer,  the  auctioneer  orated 
without  obtaining  a  single  specimen  of  those  nods  which 
his  estimable  fraternity  are  so  quick  to  discover:  and  the 
reserve  price  was  not  even  mentioned. 

However,  if  the  hammer  was  not  wearied  with  oscillat- 


8  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

ing  above  the  rostrum,  the  crowd  was  not  wearied  with 
waiting  around  it  The  joking  continued  to  increase,  and 
the  chaff  never  ceased  for  a  moment.  One  individual 
offered  two  dollars  for  the  island,  costs  included.  Another 
said  that  a  man  ought  to  be  paid  for  taking  it. 

And  all  the  time  the  crier  was  heard.  "An  island  to 
sell !  an  island  for  sale !"  And  there  was  no  one  to  buy  it. 

"Will  you  guarantee  that  there  are  flats  there?"  said 
Stumpy,  the  grocer  of  Merchant  Street,  alluding  to  the 
deposits  so  famous  in  alluvial  gold-mining. 

"No,"  answered  the  auctioneer,  "but  it  is  not  impossible 
•that  there  are,  and  the  State  abandons  all  its  rights  over 
the  gold  lands." 

"Haven't  you  got  a  volcano?"  asked  Oakhurst,  the  bar- 
keeper of  Montgomery  Street. 

"No  volcanoes,"  replied  Dean  Felporg,  "if  there  were, 
we  could  not  sell  at  this  price!" 

An  immense  shout  of  laughter  followed. 

"An  island  to  sell!  an  island  for  sale!"  yelled  Gingrass, 
whose  lungs  tired  themselves  to  no  purpose. 

"Only  a  dollar!  only  a  half-dollar!  only  a  cent  above 
the  reserve!"  said  the  auctioneer  for  the  last  time,  "and  I 
will  knock  it  down!  Once!  Twice!" 

Perfect  silence. 

"If  nobody  bids  we  must  put  the  lot  back!  Once! 
Twice!—" 

"Twelve  hundred  thousand  dollars!" 

The  four  words  rang  through  the  room  like  four  shots 
from  a  revolver.  The  crowd,  suddenly  speechless,  turned 
toward  the  bold  man  who  had  dared  to  bid.  It  was 
William  W.  Kolderup,  of  San  Francisco. 


CHAPTER   II 

THE    ISLAND    BOUGHT 

A  MAN  extraordinarily  rich,  who  counte'd  dollars  by 
the  million  as  other  men  do  by  the  thousand;  such  was 
William  W.  Kolderup. 

people  said  he  was  richer  than  the  Duke  of  West- 
minster, whose  income  is  some  $4,000,000  a  year,  and 
who  can  spend  his  $10,000  a  day,  or  seven  dollars  every 


THE  ISLAND  BOUGHT  9 

minute;  richer  than  Senator  Jones,  of  Nevada,  who  has 
$35,000,000  in  the  funds;  richer  than  Mr.  Mackay  him- 
self, whose  annual  $13,750,000  give  him  $1,560  per  hour, 
or  half-a-dollar  to  spend  every  second  of  his  life.  I  do 
not  mention  such  minor  millionaires  as  the  Rothchilds, 
the  Vanderbilts,  the  Duke  of  Northumberland,  or  the 
Stewarts,  or  the  directors  of  the  powerful  bank  of  Cali- 
fornia, and  other  opulent  personages  of  the  old  and  new 
worlds  whom  William  W.  Kolderup  would  have  been 
able  to  comfortably  pension.  He  could,  without  incon- 
venience, have  given  away  a  million  just  as  you  and  I 
might  give  away  a  shilling. 

It  was  in  developing  the  early  placer-mining  enterprises 
in  California  that  our  worthy  speculator  had  laid  the  solid 
foundations  of  his  incalculable  fortune.  He  was  the 
principal  associate  of  Captain  Sutter,  the  Swiss,  in  the 
localities,  where,  in  1848,  the  first  traces  were  discovered. 
Since  then,  luck  and  shrewdness  combined  had  helped 
him  on,  and  he  had  interested  himself  in  all  the  great 
enterprises  of  both  worlds.  He  threw  himself  boldly  into 
commercial  and  industrial*  speculations.  His  inexhaustible 
funds  were  the  life  of  hundreds  of  factories,  his  ships 
were  on  every  sea.  His  wealth  increased  not  in  arith- 
metical but  in  geometrical  progression.  People  spoke  of 
him  as  one  of  those  few  "milliardaires"  who  never  know 
how  much  they  are  worth.  In  reality  he  knew  almost 
to  a  dollar,  but  he  never  boasted  of  it. 

At  this  very  moment  when  we  introduce  him  to  our 
readers  with  all  the  consideration  such  a  many-sided  man 
merits,  William  W.  Kolderup  had  2000  branch  offices 
scattered  over  the  globe,  80,000  employes  in  America, 
Europe,  and  Australia,  300,000  correspondents,  a  fleet  of 
500  ships  which  continually  plowed  the  ocean  for  his 
profit,  and  he  was  spending  not  less  than  a  million  a 
year  in  bill-stamps  and  postages.  In  short,  he  was  the 
honor  and  glory  of  opulent  Frisco — the  nickname  famil- 
iarly given  by  the  Americans  to  the  Californian  capital. 

A  bid  from  William  W.  Kolderup  could  not  but  be  a 
serious  one.  And  when  the  crowd  in  the  auction  room 
had  recognized  who  it  was  that  by  $100,000  had  capped 
the  reserve  price  of  Spencer  Island,  there  was  an  irre- 
sistible sensation,  the  chaffing  ceased  instantly,  jokes  gave 


io  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

place  to  interjections  of  admiration,  and  cheers  resounded 
through  the  saloon.  Then  a  deep  silence  succeeded  the 
hubbub,  eyes  grew  bigger,  and  ears  opened  wider.  For 
our  part  had  we  been  there  we  would  have  had  to  hold 
our  breath  that  we  might  lose  nothing  of  the  exciting 
scene  which  would  follow  should  any  one  dare  to  bid 
against  William  W.  Kolderup. 

But  was  it  probable?    Was  it  even  possible? 

No!  And  at  the  outset  it  was  only  necessary  to  look 
at  William  W.  Kolderup  to  feel  convinced  that  he  could 
never  yield  on  a  question  where  his  financial  gallantry 
was  at  stake.  He  was  a  big,  powerful  man,  with  huge 
head,  large  shoulders,  well-built  limbs,  firmly  knit,  and 
tough  as  iron.  His  quiet  but  resolute  look  was  not 
willingly  cast  downward,  his  gray  hair,  brushed  up  in 
front,  was  as  abundant  as  if  he  were  still  young.  The 
straight  lines  of  his  nose  formed  a  geometrically-drawn 
right-angled  triangle.  No  mustache;  his  beard  cut  in 
Yankee  fashion  bedecked  his  chin,  and  the  two  upper 
points  met  at  the  opening  of  the  lips  and  ran  up  to  the 
temples  in  pepper-and-salt  whiskers;  teeth  of  snowy  white- 
ness were  symmetrically  placed  on  the  borders  of  a 
clean-cut  mouth.  The  head  of  one  of  those  true  kings  of 
men  who  rise  in  the  tempest  and  face  the  storm.  No 
hurricane  could  bend  that  head,  so  solid  was  the  neck 
which  supported  it.  In  these  battles  of  the  bidders  each 
of  its  nods  meant  an  additional  hundred  thousand  dollars. 

There  was  no  one  to  dispute  with  him. 

"Twelve  hundred  thousand  dollars — twelve  hundred 
thousand!"  said  the  auctioneer,  with  that  peculiar  accent 
which  men  of  his  vocation  find  most  effective. 

"Going  at  twelve  hundred  thousand  dollars!"  repeated 
Gingrass  the  crier. 

"You  could  safely  bid  more  than  that,"  said  Oakhurst, 
the  bar-keeper;  "William  Kolderup  will  never  give  in." 

"He  knows  no  one  will  chance  it,"  answered  the  grocer 
from  Merchant  Street. 

Repeated  cries  of  "Hush !"  told  the  two  worthy  trades- 
men to  be  quiet.  All  wished  to  hear.  All  hearts  palpi- 
tated. Dare  any  one  raise  his  voice  in  answer  to  the 
voice  of  William  W.  Kolderup?  He,  magnificent  to  look 
upon,  never  moved.  There  he  remained  as  calm  as  if  the 


THE  ISLAND  BOUGHT  II 

matter  had  no  interest  for  him.  But — and  this  those 
near  to  him  noticed — his  eyes  were  like  revolvers  loaded 
with  dollars,  ready  to  fire. 

"Nobody  speaks?"  asked  Dean  Felporg. 

Nobody  spoke. 

"Once!     Twice!" 

"Once!  Twice!"  repeated  Gingrass,  quite  accustomed 
to  this  little  dialogue  with  his  chief. 

"Going!" 

"Going!" 

"For  twelve — hundred — thousand — dollars — Spencer — 
Island — com — plete !" 

The  waistcoats  rose  and  fell  convulsively.  Could  it  be 
possible  that  at  the  last  second  a  higher  bid  would  come? 
Felporg  with  his  right  hand  stretched  on  the  table  was 
shaking  his  ivory  hammer — one  rap,  two  raps,  and  the 
deed  would  be  done.  The  public  could  not  have  been 
more  absorbed  in  the  face  of  a  summary  application  of 
the  law  of  Justice  Lynch! 

The  hammer  slowly  fell,  almost  touched  the  table,  rose 
again,  hovered  an  instant  like  a  sword  which  pauses  ere 
the  drawer  cleaves  the  victim  in  twain;  then  it  flashed 
swiftly  downward. 

But  before  the  sharp  rap  could  be  given,  a  voice  was 
heard :  "Thirteen — hundred — thousand — dollars !" 

There  was  a  preliminary  "Ah!"  of  general  stupefaction, 
then  a  second  "Ah!"  of  not  less  general  satisfaction. 
Another  bidder  had  presented  himself!  There  was  going 
to  be  a  fight  after  all! 

But  who  was  the  reckless  individual  who  had  dared  to 
come  to  dollar  strokes  with  William  W.  Kolderup  of 
San  Francisco?  It  was  J.  R.  Taskinar,  of  Stockton. 

J.  R.  Taskinar  was  rich,  but  he  was  more  than  propor- 
tionately fat.  He  weighed  490  Ibs.  If  he  had  only  run 
second  in  the  last  fat-man  show  at  Chicago,  it  was  because 
he  had  not  been  allowed  time  to  finish  his  dinner,  and 
had  lost  about  a  dozen  pounds. 

This  colossus,  who  had  had  to  have  special  chairs  made 
for  his  portly  person  to  rest  upon,  lived  at  Stockton,  on 
the  San  Joachim.  Stockton  is  one  of  the  most  important 
cities  in  California,  one  of  the  depot  centers  for  the 
mines  of  the  south,  the  rival  of  Sacramento,  the  center 


12  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

for  the  mines  of  the  north.  There  the  ships  embark  the 
largest  quantity  of  Californian  corn. 

Not  only  had  the  development  of  the  mines  and  specu- 
lations in  wheat  furnished  J.  R.  Taskinar  with  the  occasion 
of  gaining  an  enormous  fortune,  but  petroleum,  like  an- 
other Pactolus,  had  run  through  his  treasury.  Besides,  he 
was  a  great  gambler,  a  lucky  gambler,  and  he  had  found 
"poker"  most  prodigal  of  its  favors  to  him. 

But  if  he  was  a  Croesus,  he  was  also  a  rascal;  and  no 
one  would  have  addressed  him  as  "honorable,"  although 
the  title  in  those  parts  is  so  much  in  vogue.  After  all, 
he  was  a  good  war-horse,  and  perhaps  more  was  put  on 
his  back  than  was  justly  his  due.  One  thing  was  certain, 
and  that  was  that  on  many  an  occasion  he  had  not  hesi- 
tated to  use  his  "Derringer" — the  Californian  revolver. 

Now  J.  R.  Taskinar  particularly  detested  William  W. 
Kolderup.  He  envied  him  for  his  wealth,  his  position, 
and  his  reputation.  He  despised  him  as  a  fat  man 
despises  a  lean  one.  It  was  not  the  first  time  that  the 
merchant  of  Stockton  had  endeavored  to  do  the  merchant 
of  San  Francisco  out  of  some  business  or  other,  good  or 
bad,  simply  owing  to  a  feeling  of  rivalry.  William  W. 
Kolderup  thoroughly  knew  his  man,  and  on  all  occasions 
treated  him  with  scorn  enough  to  drive  him  to  distraction. 

The  last  success  which  J.  R.  Taskinar  could  not  forgive 
his  opponent  was  that  gained  in  the  struggle  over  the 
state  elections.  Notwithstanding  his  efforts,  his  threats, 
and  his  libels,  not  to  mention  the  millions  of  dollars 
squandered  by  his  electoral  courtiers,  it  was  William  W. 
Kolderup  who  sat  in  his  seat  in  the  Legislative  Council 
of  Sacramento. 

J.  R.  Taskinar  had  learned— how,  I  cannot  tell — that  it 
was  the  intention  of  William  W.  Kolderup  to  acquire 
possession  of  Spencer  Island.  This  island  seemed  doubt- 
less as  useless  to  him  as  it  did  to  his  rival.  No  matter. 
Here  was  another  chance  for  fighting,  and  perhaps  for 
conquering.  J.  R.  Taskinar  would  not  allow  it  to  escape 
him. 

'And  that  is  why  J.  R.  Taskinar  had  come  to  the  auction 
room  among  the  curious  crowd  who  could  not  be  aware 
of  his  designs,  why  at  all  points  he  had  prepared  his  bat- 
teries, why  before  opening  fire,  he  had  waited  till  his 


THE  ISLAND  BOUGHT  13 

opponent  had  covered  the  reserve  and  why  when  William 
W.  Kolderup  had  made  his  bid  of  "Twelve  hundred 
thousand  dollars!"  J.  R.  Taskinar  at  the  moment  when 
William  W.  Kolderup  thought  he  had  definitely  secured 
the  island,  woke  up  with  the  words  shouted  in  stentorian 
tones, — 

"Thirteen  hundred  thousand  dollars!" 

Everybody  as  we  have  seen  turned  to  look  at  him. 

"Fat  Taskinar!"  The  name  passed  from  mouth  to 
mouth.  Yes.  Fat  Taskinar!  He  was  known  well 
enough!  His  corpulence  had  been  the  theme  of  many  an 
article  in  the  journals  of  the  Union.  I  am  not  quite 
sure  which  mathematician  it  was  who  had  demonstrated 
by  transcendental  calculations,  that  so  great  was  his  mass 
that  it  actually  influenced  that  of  our  satellite  and  in  an 
appreciable  manner  disturbed  the  elements  of  the  lunar 
orbit. 

But  it  was  not  J.  R.  Taskinar's  physical  composition 
which  interested  the  spectators  in  the  room.  It  was 
something  far  different  which  excited  them;  it  was  that 
he  had  entered  into  direct  public  rivalry  with  William  W. 
Kolderup.  It  was  a  fight  of  heroes,  dollar  versus  dollar, 
which  had  opened,  and  I  do  not  know  which  of  the  two 
coffers  would  turn  out  to  be  best  lined.  Enormously  rich 
were  both  these  mortal  enemies!  After  the  first  sensa- 
tion, which  was  rapidly  suppressed,  renewed  silence  fell 
on  the  assembly.  You  could  have  heard  a  spider  weaving 
his  web. 

It  was  the  voice  of  Dean  Felporg  which  broke  the  spell. 

"For  thirteen  hundred  thousand  dollars,  Spencer 
Island!"  declaimed  he,  drawing  himself  up  so  as  to  better 
command  the  circle  of  bidders. 

William  W.  Kolderup  had  turned  towards  J.  R.  Tas- 
kinar. The  bystanders  moved  back,  so  as  to  allow  the 
adversaries  to  behold  each  other.  The  man  of  Stockton 
and  the  man  of  San  Francisco  were  face  to  face,  mutually 
staring,  at  their  ease.  Truth  compels  me  to  state  that 
they  made  the  most  of  the  opportunity.  Never  would  one 
of  them  consent  to  lower  his  eyes  before  those  of  his 
rival. 

"Fourteen  hundred  thousand  dollars,"  said  William  W. 
Kolderup. 


I4  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

"Fifteen  hundred  thousand!"  retorted  J.   R.  Taskinar. 

"Sixteen  hundred  thousand!" 

"Seventeen  hundred  thousand!" 

Have  you  ever  heard  the  story  of  the  two  mechanics  of 
Glasgow,  who  tried  which  should  raise  the  other  highest 
up  the  factory  chimney  at  the  risk  of  a  catastrophe?  The 
only  difference  was  that  here  the  chimney  was  of  ingots 
of  gold. 

Each  time  after  the  capping  bid  of  J.  R.  Taskinar, 
William  W.  Kolderup  took  a  few  moments  to  reflect  be- 
fore he  bid  again.  On  the  contrary  Taskinar  burst  out 
like  a  bomb,  and  did  not  seem  to  require  a  second  to  think. 

"Seventeen  hundred  thousand  dollars!"  repeated  the 
auctioneer.  "Now,  gentlemen,  that  is  a  mere  nothing! 
It  is  giving  it  away!" 

And  one  can  well  believe  that,  carried  away  by  the 
jargon  of  his  profession,  he  was  about  to  add,  "The 
frame  alone  is  worth  more  than  that!"  When— 

"Eighteen  hundred  thousand!"  replied  William  W. 
Kolderup. 

"Nineteen  hundred  thousand!"  retorted  J.  R.  Taskinar. 

"Two  millions!"  quoth  William  W.  Kolderup,  and  so 
quickly  that  this  time  he  evidently  had  not  taken  the 
trouble  to  think.  His  face  was  a  little  pale  when  these 
last  words  escaped  his  lips,  but  his  whole  attitude  was 
that  of  a  man  who  did  not  intend  to  give  in. 

J.  R.  Taskinar  was  simply  on  fire.  His  enormous  face 
was  like  one  of  those  gigantic  railway  bull's-eyes  which, 
screened  by  the  red,  signal  the  stoppage  of  the  train.  But 
it  was  highly  probable  that  his  rival  would  disregard  the 
block,  and  decline  to  shut  off  steam. 

This  J.  R.  Taskinar  felt.  The  blood  mounted  to  his 
brows,  and  seemed  apoplectically  congested  there.  He 
wriggled  his  fat  fingers,  covered  with  diamonds  of  great 
price,  along  the  huge  gold  chain  attached  to  his  chro- 
nometer. He  glared  at  his  adversary,  and  then  shutting 
his  eyes  so  as  to  open  them  with  a  more  spiteful  expres- 
sion a  moment  afterward,  "Two  millions,  four  hundred 
thousand  dollars!"  he  remarked,  hoping  by  this  tremen- 
dous leap  to  completely  rout  his  rival. 

"Two  millions,  seven  hundred  thousand!"  replied  Wil- 
liam W.  Kolderup  in  a  peculiarly  calm  voice. 


THE  ISLAND  BOUGHT  15 

"Two  millions,  eight  hundred  thousand!" 

"Three  millions!" 

Yes!  William  W.  Kolderup,  of  San  Francisco,  said 
three  millions  of  dollars! 

Applause  rang  through  the  room,  hushed,  however,  at 
the  voice  of  the  auctioneer,  who  repeated  the  bid,  and 
whose  oscillating  hammer  threatened  to  fall  in  spite  of 
himself  by  the  involuntary  movement  of  his  muscles.  It 
seemed  as  though  Dean  Felporg,  surfeited  with  the  sur- 
prises of  public  auction  sales,  would  be  unable  to  contain 
himself  any  longer.  All  glances  were  turned  on  J.  R. 
Taskinar.  That  voluminous  personage  was  sensible  of 
this,  but  still  more  was  he  sensible  of  the  weight  of  these 
three  millions  of  dollars,  which  seemed  to  crush  him. 
He  would  have  spoken,  doubtless  to  bid  higher — but  he 
could  not.  He  would  have  liked  to  nod  his  head — he 
could  do  so  no  more. 

After  a  long  pause,  however,  his  voice  was  heard; 
feeble  it  is  true,  but  sufficiently  audible.  "Three  millions, 
five  hundred  thousand!" 

"Four  millions,"  was  the  answer  of  William  W.  Kol- 
derup. It  was  the  last  blow  of  the  bludgeon.  J.  R.  Tas- 
kinar succumbed.  The  hammer  gave  a  hard  rap  on  the 
marble  table  and — 

Spencer  Island  fell  for  four  millions  of  dollars  to  Wil- 
liam W.  Kolderup,  of  San  Francisco. 

"I  will  be  avenged!"  muttered  J.  R.  Taskinar,  and 
throwing  a  glance  of  hatred  at  his  conqueror,  he  returned 
to  the  Occidental  Hotel. 

But  "hip,  hip,  hurrah,"  three  times  thrice,  smote  the 
ears  of  William  W.  Kolderup,  then  cheers  followed  him 
to  Montgomery  Street,  and  such  was  the  delirious  en- 
thusiasm of  the  Americans  that  they  even  forgot  to 
favor  him  with  the  customary  bars  of  "Yankee  Doodle." 


16  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 


CHAPTER  III 

WITH   PIANO  ACCOMPANIMENT 

WILLIAM  W.  KOLDERUP  had  returned  to  his  mansion  in 
Montgomery  Street.  This  thoroughfare  is  the  Regent 
Street,  the  Broadway,  the  Boulevard  des  Italiens  of  San 
Francisco.  Throughout  its  length,  the  great  artery  which 
crosses  the  city  parallel  with  its  quays  is  astir  with  life 
and  movement;  trams  there  are  innumerable;  carriages 
with  horses,  carriages  with  mules;  men  bent  on  business, 
hurrying  to  and  fro  over  its  stone  pavements,  past  shops 
thronged  with  customers;  men  bent  on  pleasure,  crowding 
the  doors  of  the  "bars,"  where  at  all  hours  are  dispensed 
the  Calif ornian's  drinks. 

There  is  no  need  for  us  to  describe  the  mansion  of  a 
Frisco  nabob.  With  so  many  millions,  there  was  propor- 
tionate luxury.  More  comfort  than  taste.  Less  of  the 
artistic  than  the  practical.  One  cannot  have  everything. 
So  the  reader  must  be  contented  to  know  that  there  was 
a  magnificent  reception-room,  and  in  this  reception-room 
a  piano,  whose  chords  were  permeating  the  mansion's 
warm  atmosphere  when  the  opulent  Kolderup  walked  in. 

"Good!"  he  said.  "She  and  he  are  there!  A  word  to 
my  cashier,  and  then  we  can  have  a  little  chat." 

And  he  stepped  toward  his  office  to  arrange  the  little 
matter  of  Spencer  Island,  and  then  dismiss  it  from  his 
mind.  He  had  only  to  realize  a  few  certificates  in  his 
portfolio  and  the  acquisition  was  settled  for.  Half-a- 
dozen  lines  to  his  broker — no  more.  Then  William 
W.  Kolderup  devoted  himself  to  another  "combination" 
which  was  much  more  to  his  taste. 

Yes!  she  and  he  were  in  the  drawing-room — she,  in 
front  of  the  piano;  he,  half  reclining  on  the  sofa,  listen- 
ing vaguely  to  the  pearly  arpeggios  which  escaped  from 
the  fingers  of  the  charmer.  "Are  you  listening?"  she 
said. 

"Of  course." 

"Yes!  but  do  you  understand  it?" 

"Do  I  understand  it,  Phina!  Never  have  you  played 
those  'Auld  Robin  Gray'  variations  more  superbly." 


WITH  PIANO  ACCOMPANIMENT  17 

"But  it  is  not  'Auld  Robin  Gray/  Godfrey;  it  is 
'Happy  Moments/ ' 

"Oh!  ah!  yes!  I  remember!"  answered  Godfrey,  in  a 
tone  of  indifference  which  it  was  difficult  to  mistake. 
The  lady  raised  her  two  hands,  held  them  suspended  for 
an  instant  above  the  keys  as  if  they  were  about  to  grasp 
another  chord,  and  then  with  a  half-turn  on  her  music 
stool  she  remained  for  a  moment  looking  at  the  too 
tranquil  Godfrey,  whose  eyes  did  their  best  to  avoid  hers. 

Phina  Hollaney  was  the  goddaughter  of  William  W. 
Kolderup.  An  orphan,  he  had  educated  her,  and  given 
her  the  right  to  consider  herself  his  daughter,  and  to 
love  him  as  her  father.  She  wanted  for  nothing.  She  was 
young,  "handsome  in  her  way"  as  people  say,  but  un- 
doubtedly fascinating;  a  blonde  of  sixteen  with  the  ideas 
of  a  woman  much  older,  as  one  could  read  in  the  crys- 
tal of  her  blue-black  eyes.  Of  course,  we  must  compare 
her  to  a  lily,  for  all  beauties  are  compared  to  lilies  in 
the  best  of  American  society.  She  was  then  a  lily,  but  a 
lily  grafted  into  an  eglantine.  She  certainly  had  plenty 
of  spirit,  but  she  had  also  plenty  of  practical  common- 
sense,  a  somewhat  selfish  demeanor,  and  but  little  sym- 
pathy with  the  illusions  and  dreams  so  characteristic  of 
her  sex  and  age. 

Her  dreams  were  when  she  was  asleep,  not  when  she 
was  awake.  She  was  not  asleep  now,  and  had  no  inten- 
tion of  being  so.  "Godfrey?"  she  continued. 

"Phina?"  answered  the  young  man. 

"Where  are  you  now?" 

"Near  you — in  this  room — " 

"Not  near  me,  Godfrey!  Not  in  this  room!  But  far, 
far  away,  over  the  seas,  is  it  not  so?" 

And  mechanically  Phina's  hand  sought  the  key-board 
and  rippled  along  a  series  of  sinking  sevenths,  which 
spoke  of  a  plaintive  sadness,  unintelligible  perhaps  to  the 
nephew  of  William  W.  Kolderup. 

For  such  was  this  young  man,  such  was  the  relationship 
he  bore  toward  the  master  of  the  house.  The  son  of  a 
sister  of  this  buyer  of  islands,  fatherless  and  motherless 
for  a  good  many  years,  Godfrey  Morgan,  like  Phina, 
had  been  brought  up  in  the  house  of  his  uncle,  in  whom 

Vol.  13  Verne 


1 8  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

the  fever  of  business  had  still  left  a  place  for  the  idea  of 
marrying  these  two  to  each  other. 

Godfrey  was  in  his  twenty-second  year.  His  education 
now  finished,  had  left  him  with  absolutely  nothing  to  do. 
He  had  graduated  at  the  University,  but  had  found  it 
of  little  use.  For  him  life  opened  out  but  paths  of  ease; 
go  where  he  would,  to  the  right  or  the  left,  whichever 
way  he  went,  fortune  would  not  fail  him. 

Godfrey  was  of  good  presence,  gentlemanly,  elegant— 
never  tying  his  cravat  in  a  ring,  nor  starring  his  fingers, 
his  wrists  or  his  shirt-front  with  those  jeweled  gim- 
cracks  so  dear  to  his  fellow-citizens. 

I  shall  surprise  no  one  in  saying  that  Godfrey  Mor- 
gan was  going  to  marry  Phina  Hollaney.  Was  he  likely 
to  do  otherwise?  All  the  proprieties  were  in  favor  of 
it.  Besides,  William  W.  Kolderup  desired  the  marriage. 
The  two  people  whom  he  loved  most  in  this  world  were 
sure  of  a  fortune  from  him,  without  taking  into  consid- 
eration whether  Phina  cared  for  Godfrey,  or  Godfrey 
cared  for  Phina.  It  would  also  simplify  the  bookkeeping 
of  the  commercial  house.  Ever  since  their  births  an  ac- 
count had  been  opened  for  the  boy,  another  for  the  girl. 
It  would  then  be  only  necessary  to  rule  these  off  and 
transfer  the  balances  to  a  joint  account  for  the  young 
couple.  The  worthy  merchant  hoped  that  this  would 
soon  be  done,  and  the  balances  struck  without  error  or 
omission. 

But  it  is  precisely  that  there  had  been  an  omission 
and  perhaps  an  error  that  we  are  about  to  show.  An 
error,  because  at  the  outset  Godfrey  felt  that  he  was  not 
yet  old  enough  for  the  serious  undertaking  of  marriage; 
an  omission,  because  he  had  not  been  consulted  on  the 
subject. 

In  fact,  when  he  had  finished  his  studies  Godfrey  had 
displayed  a  quite  premature  indifference  to  the  world,  in 
which  he  wanted  for  nothing,  in  which  he  had  no  wish 
remaining  ungratified,  and  nothing  whatever  to  do.  The 
thought  of  traveling  around  the  world  was  always 
present  to  him.  Of  the  old  and  new  continents  he  knew 
but  one  spot — San  Francisco,  where  he  was  born,  and 
which  he  had  never  left  except  in  a  dream.  What  harm 
was  there  in  a  young  man  making  a  tour  of  the  globe 


WITH  PIANO  ACCOMPANIMENT  19 

twice  or  thrice — especially  if  he  were  an  American? 
Would  it  do  him  any  good?  Would  he  learn  anything 
in  the  different"  adventures  he  would  meet  with  in  a  voy- 
age of  any  length?  If  he  were  not  already  satiated  with 
a  life  of  adventure,  how  could  he  be  answered?  Finally, 
how  many  millions  of  leagues  of  observation  and  instruc- 
tion were  indispensable  for  the  completion  of  the  young 
man's  education? 

Things  had  reached  this  pass;  for  a  year  or  more 
Godfrey  had  been  immersed  in  books  of  voyages  of  recent 
date,  and  had  passionately  devoured  them.  He  had  dis- 
covered the  Celestial  Empire  with  Marco  Polo,  America 
with  Columbus,  the  Pacific  with  Cook,  the  South  Pole 
with  Dumont  d'Urville.  He  had  conceived  the  idea  of 
going  where  these  illustrious  travelers  had  been  without 
him.  In  truth,  he  would  not  have  considered  an  exploring 
expedition  of  several  years  to  cost  him  too  dear  at  the 
price  of  a  few  attacks  of  Malay  pirates,  several  ocean 
collisions,  and  a  shipwreck  or  two  on  a  desert  island  where 
he  could  live  the  life  of  a  Selkirk  or  a  Robinson  Crusoe! 
A  Crusoe!  To  become  a  Crusoe!  What  young  imagina- 
tion has  not  dreamed  of  this  in  reading,  as  Godfrey  had 
often,  too  often  done,  the  adventures  of  the  imaginary 
heroes  of  Daniel  de  Foe  and  De  Wyss? 

Yes !  The  nephew  of  William  W.  Kolderup  was  in  this 
state  when  his  uncle  was  thinking  of  binding  him  in  the 
chains  of  marriage.  To  travel  in  this  way  with  Phina, 
then  become  Mrs.  Morgan,  would  be  clearly  impossible! 
He  must  go  alone  or  leave  it  alone.  Besides,  once  his 
fancy  had  passed  away,  would  not  she  be  better  disposed 
to  sign  the  settlements?  Was  it  for  the  good  of  his  wife 
that  he  had  not  been  to  China  or  Japan,  not  even  to 
Europe?  Decidedly  not. 

And  hence  it  was  that  Godfrey  was  now  absent  in  the 
presence  of  Phina,  indifferent  when  she  spoke  to  him,  deaf 
when  she  played  the  airs  which  used  to  please  him;  and 
Phina,  like  a  thoughtful,  serious  girl,  soon  noticed  this. 
To  say  that  she  did  not  feel  a  little  annoyance,  mingled 
with  some  chagrin,  is  to  do  her  a  gratuitous  injustice. 
But  accustomed  to  look  things  in  the  face,  she  had  rea- 
soned thus :  "If  we  must  part,  it  had  better  be  before 
marriage  than  afterward!" 


20  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

And  thus  it  was  that  she  had  spoken  to  Godfrey  in 
these  significant  words:  "No!  you  are  not  near  me  at 
this  moment — you  are  beyond  the  seas!" 

Godfrey  had  risen.  He  had  walked  a  few  steps  with- 
out noticing  Phina,  and  unconsciously  his  index  finger 
touched  one  of  the  keys  of  the  piano.  A  loud  C*  of  the 
octave  below  the  staff,  a  note  dismal  enough,  answered 
for  him. 

Phina  had  understood  him  and  without  more  discussion 
was  about  to  bring  matters  to  a  crisis,  when  the  door 
of  the  room  opened. 

William  W.  Kolderup  appeared,  seemingly  a  little  pre- 
occupied as  usual.  Here  was  the  merchant  who  had  just 
finished  one  negotiation  and  was  about  to  begin  another. 
"Well,"  said  he,  "there  is  nothing  more  now  than  for  us 
to  fix  the  date." 

"The  date?"  answered  Godfrey,  with  a  start.  "What 
date,  if  you  please,  uncle?" 

"The  date  of  your  wedding!"  said  William  W.  Kolder- 
up. "Not  the  date  of  mine,  I  suppose!" 

"Perhaps  that  is  more  urgent?"  said  Phina. 

"Hey?— what?"  exclaimed  the  uncle — "what  does  that 
matter?  We  are  only  talking  of  current  affairs,  are  we 
not?" 

"Godfather  Will,"  answered  the  lady.  "It  is  not  of 
a  wedding  that  we  are  going  to  fix  the  date  today, 
but  of  a  departure." 

"A  departure!" 

"Yes,  the  departure  of  Godfrey,"  continued  Phina,  "of 
Godfrey  who,  before  he  gets  married,  wants  to  see  a 
Irttle  of  the  world!" 

"You  want  to  go  away— you?"  said  William  W. 
Kolderup,  stepping  toward  the  young  man  and  raising 
his  arms  as  if  he  were  afraid  that  this  "rascal  of  a 
nephew"  would  escape  him. 

"Yes;  I  do,  uncle,"  said  Godfrey  gallantly. 

"And  for  how  long?" 

"For  eighteen  months,  or  two  years,  or  more  if — 

"If  you  will  let  me,  and  Phina  will  wait  for  me." 
"Wait  for  you!    An  intended  who  intends  until  he  gets 
away!"  exclaimed  William  W.  Kolderup. 


WITH  PIANO  ACCOMPANIMENT  21 

"You  must  let  Godfrey  go,"  pleaded  Phina;  "I  have 
thought  it  carefully  over.  I  am  young,  but  really  Godfrey 
is  younger.  Travel  will  age  him,  and  I  do  not  think  it 
will  change  his  taste!  He  wishes  to  travel,  let  him  travel! 
The  need  of  repose  will  come  to  him  afterward,  and  he 
will  find  me  when  he  returns.'* 

"What!"  exclaimed  William  W.  Kolderup,  "you  con- 
sent to  give  your  bird  his  liberty?" 

"Yes,  for  the  two  years  he  asks." 

"And  you  will  wait  for  him?" 

"Uncle  Will,  if  I  could  not  wait  for  him  I  could  not 
love  him!"  and  so  saying,  Phina  returned  to  the  piano, 
and  whether  she  willed  it  or  no,  her  fingers  softly  played 
a  portion  of  the  then  fashionable  "Depart  du  Fiance," 
which  was  very  appropriate  under  the  circumstances.  But 
Phina,  without  perceiving  it  perhaps,  was  playing  in  "A 
minor,"  whereas  it  was  written  in  "A  major,"  and  all 
the  sentiment  of  the  melody  was  transformed,  and  its 
plaintiveness  chimed  in  well  with  her  hidden  feelings. 

But  Godfrey  stood  embarrassed,  and  said  not  a  word. 
His  uncle  took  him  by  the  head  and  turning  it  to  the 
light  looked  fixedly  at  him  for  a  moment  or  two.  In  this 
way  he  questioned  him  without  having  to  speak,  and 
Godfrey  was  able  to  reply  without  having  occasion  to 
utter  a  syllable. 

And  the  lamentations  of  the  "Depart  du  Fiance"  con- 
tinued their  sorrowful  theme,  and  then  William  W.  Kol- 
derup, having  made  the  turn  of  the  room,  returned  to  God- 
frey, who  stood  like  a  criminal  before  the  judge.  Then 
raising  his  voice,  "You  are  serious?"  he  asked. 

"Quite  serious!"  interrupted  Phina,  while  Godfrey  con- 
tented himself  with  making  a  sign  of  affirmation. 

"You  want  to  try  traveling  before  you  marry  Phina? 
Well!  You  shall  try  it,  my  nephew!" 

He  made  two  or  three  steps  and  stopping  with  crossed 
arms  before  Godfrey,  asked,  "Where  do  you  want  to  go?" 

"Everywhere." 

And  when  do  you  want  to  start?" 

"When  you  please,  Uncle  Will." 

"All  right,"  replied  William  W.  Kolderup,  fixing  a 
curious  look  on  his  nephew.  Then  he  muttered  between 
his  teeth,  "The  sooner  the  better." 


22  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

At  these  last  words  came  a  sudden  interruption  from 
Phina.  The  little  finger  of  her  left  hand  touched  a  G*, 
and  the  fourth  had,  instead  of  falling  on  the  key-note, 
rested  on  the  "sensible,"  like  Ralph  in  the  "Huguenots," 
when  he  leaves  at  the  end  of  his  duet  with  Valentine. 

Perhaps  Phina's  heart  was  nearly  full,  she  had  made 
up  her  mind  to  say  nothing. 

It  was  then  that  William  W.  Kolderup,  without  notic- 
ing Godfrey,  approached  the  piano.  "Phina,"  said  he 
gravely,  "you  should  never  remain  on  the  'sensible'!'' 

With  the  tip  of  his  large  finger  he  dropped  vertically 
on  to  one  of  the  keys,  and  an  "A  natural"  resounded 
through  the  room. 


CHAPTER    IV 

T.     ARTELETT,    OTHERWISE     TARTLET 

IF  T.  Artelett  had  been  a  Parisian,  his  compatriots 
would  not  have  failed  to  nickname  him  Tartlet,  but  as 
he  had  already  received  this  title  we  do  not  hesitate  to 
describe  him  by  it.  If  Tartlet  was  not  a  Frenchman  he 
ought  to  have  been  one. 

In  his  "Itineraire  de  Paris  a  Jerusalem,"  Chateau- 
briand tells  of  a  little  man  "powdered  and  frizzed  in  the 
old-fashioned  style,  with  a  coat  of  apple  green,  a  waist- 
coat of  drouget,  shirt-frill  and  cuffs  of  muslin,  who 
scraped  a  violin  and  made  the  Iroquois  dance  'Madeleine 
Friquet.' ' 

The  Californians  are  not  Iroquois,  far  from  it;  but 
Tartlet  was  none  the  less  professor  of  dancing  and  de- 
portment in  the  capital  of  their  state.  If  they  did  not 
pay  him  for  his  lessons,  as  they  had  his  predecessor  in 
beaver-skins  and  bear-hams,  they  did  so  in  dollars.  If 
in  speaking  of  his  pupils  he  did  not  talk  of  the  "bucks 
and  their  squaws,"  it  was  because  his  pupils  were  highly 
civilized,  and  because  in  his  opinion  he  had  contributed 
considerably  to  their  civilization. 

Tartlet  was  a  bachelor,  and  aged  about  forty-five  at 
the  time  we  introduce  him  to  our  readers.  Though  for 
a  dozen  years  or  so  his  marriage  with  some  lady  of 
mature  age  had  been  expected  to  take  place. 


T.   ARTELETT,  OR  TARTLET  23 

Under  present  circumstances  it  is  perhaps  advisable  to 
give  "two  or  three  lines"  concerning  his  age,  appearance 
and  position  in  life.  He  was  born  on  the  I7th  of  July,  1835, 
at  a  quarter-past  three  in  the  morning.  His  height  is 
five  feet,  two  inches,  three  lines.  His  weight,  increased 
by  some  six  pounds  during  the  last  year,  is  one  hundred 
and  fifty-one  pounds,  two  ounces.  He  has  an  oblong 
head.  His  hair,  very  thin  above  the  forehead,  is  gray 
chestnut,  his  forehead  is  high,  his  face  oval,  his  complex- 
ion fresh  colored.  His  eyes — sight  excellent — a  grayish 
brown,  eyelashes  and  eyebrows  clear  chestnut,  eyes  them- 
selves somewhat  sunk  in  their  orbits  beneath  the  arches  of 
the  brows.  His  nose  is  of  medium  size,  and  has  a  slight 
indentation  toward  the  end  of  the  left  nostril.  His 
cheeks  and  temples  are  flat  and  hairless.  His  ears  are 
large  and  flat.  His  mouth,  of  middling  size,  is  absolutely 
free  from  bad  teeth.  His  lips,  thin  and  slightly  pinched, 
are  covered  with  a  heavy  mustache  and  imperial,  his  chin 
is  round  and  also  shaded  with  a  many-tinted  beard.  A 
small  mole  ornaments  his  plump  neck — in  the  nape. 
Finally,  when  he  is  in  the  bath  it  can  be  seen  that  his 
skin  is  white  and  smooth. 

His  life  is  calm  and  regular.  Without  being  robust, 
thanks  to  his  great  temperance,  he  has  kept  his  health 
uninjured  since  his  birth.  His  lungs  are  rather  irritable, 
and  hence  he  has  not  contracted  the  bad  habit  of  smoking. 
He  drinks  neither  spirits,  coffee,  liquors,  nor  neat  wine. 
In  a  word,  all  that  could  prejudicially  affect  his  nervous 
system  is  vigorously  excluded  from  his  table.  Light  beer, 
and  weak  wine  and  water  are  the  only  beverages  he  can 
take  without  danger.  It  is  on  account  of  his  carefulness* 
that  he  has  never  had  to  consult  a  doctor  since  his  life 
began. 

His  gesture  is  prompt,  his  walk  quick,  his  character 
frank  and  open.  His  thoughtfulness  for  others  is  extreme, 
and  it  is  on  account  of  this  that  in  the  fear  of  making 
his  wife  unhappy,  he  has  never  entered  into  matrimony. 

Such  would  have  been  the  report  furnished  by  Tartlet, 
but  desirable  as  he  might  be  to  a  lady  of  a  certain  age, 
the  projected  union  had  hitherto  failed.  -The  professor 
remained  a  bachelor,  and  continued  ^to  give  lessons  in 
dancing  and  deportment 


24  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL  - 

It  was  in  this  capacity  that  he  entered  the  mansion  of 
William  W.  Kolderup.  As  time  rolled  on  his  pupils  grad- 
ually abandoned  him,  and  he  ended  by  becoming  one 
wheel  more  in  the  machinery  of  the  wealthy  establish- 
ment. 

After  all,  he  was  a  brave  man,  in  spite  of  his  eccen- 
tricities. Everybody  liked  him.  He  liked  Godfrey,  he  liked 
Phina,  and  they  liked  him.  He  had  only  one  ambition  in 
the  world,  and  that  was  to  teach  them  all  the  secrets  of 
his  art,  to  make  them  in  fact,  as  far  as  deportment  was 
concerned,  two  highly  accomplished  individuals. 

Now,  what  would  you  think?  It  was  he,  this  Professor 
Tartlet,  whom  William  W.  Kolderup  had  chosen  as  his 
nephew's  companion  during  the  projected  voyage.  Yes! 
He  had  reason  to  believe  that  Tartlet  had  not  a  little 
contributed  to  imbue  Godfrey  with  this  roaming  mania, 
so  as  to  perfect  himself  by  a  tour  around  the  world. 
William  W.  Kolderup  had  resolved  that  they  should  go 
together.  On  the  morrow,  the  i6th  of  April,  he  sent  for 
the  professor  to  his  office. 

The  request  of  the  nabob  was  an  order  for  Tartlet. 
The  professor  left  his  room,  with  his  pocket  violin — gen- 
erally known  as  a  kit — so  as  to  be  ready  for  all  emer- 
gencies. He  mounted  the  great  staircase  of  the  mansion 
with  his  feet  academically  placed  as  was  fitting  for  a 
dancing-master;  knocked  at  the  door  of  the  room,  en- 
tered— his  body  half  inclined,  his  elbows  rounded,  his 
mouth  on  the  grin — and  waited  in  the  third  position, 
after  having  crossed  his  feet  one  before  the  other,  at  half 
their  length,  his  ankles  touching  and  his  toes  turned  out. 
Any  one  but  Professor  Tartlet  placed  in  this  sort  of 
unstable  equilibrium  would  have  tottered  on  his  base,  but 
the  professor  preserved  an  absolute  perpendicularity. 

"Mr.  Tartlet,"  said  William  W.  Kolderup,  "I  have 
sent  for  you  to  tell  you  some  news  which  I  imagine  will 
rather  surprise  you." 

"As  you  think  best!"  answered  the  professor. 

"My  nephew's  marriage  is  put  off  for  a  year  or  eight- 
een months,  and  Godfrey,  at  his  own  request,  is  going 
to  visit  the  different  countries  of  the  old  and  new  world." 

"Sir,"  answered  Tartlet,  "my  pupil,  Godfrey,  will 
do  honor  to  the  country  of  his  birth,  and — " 


T.  ARTELETT,  OR  TARTLET  25 

"And,  to  the  professor  of  deportment  who  has  initiated 
him  into  etiquette,"  interrupted  the  merchant,  in  a  tone  of 
which  the  guileless  Tartlet  failed  to  perceive  the  irony. 

In  fact,  thinking  it  the  correct  thing  to  execute  an 
"assemblee,"  he  first  moved  one  foot  and  then  the  other, 
by  a  sort  of  semi-circular  side  slide,  and  then  with  a  light 
and  graceful  bend  of  the  knee,  he  bowed  to  William  W. 
Kolderup. 

"I  thought,"  continued  the  latter,  "that  you  might  feel 
a  little  regret  at  separating  from  your  pupil?" 

"The  regret  will  be  extreme,"  answered  Tartlet,  "but 
should  it  be  necessary — " 

"It  is  not  necessary,"  answered  William  W.  Kolderup, 
knitting  his  bushy  eyebrows. 

"Ah!"  replied  Tartlet.  Slightly  troubled,  he  made  a 
graceful  movement  to  the  rear,  so  as  to  pass  from  the 
third  to  the  fourth  position;  but  he  left  the  breadth  of  a 
foot  between  his  feet,  without  perhaps  being  conscious  of 
what  he  was  doing. 

"Yes!"  added  the  merchant  in  a  peremptory  tone, 
which  admitted  not  of  the  ghost  of  a  reply;  "I  have 
thought  it  would  really  be  cruel  to  separate  a  professor 
and  a  pupil  so  well  made  to  understand  each  other!" 

"Assuredly! — the  journey?"  answered  Tartlet,  who  did 
not  seem  to  want  to  understand. 

"Yes!  Assuredly!"  replied  William  W.  Kolderup; 
"not  only  will  his  travels  bring  out  the  talents  of  my 
nephew,  but  the  talents  of  the  professor  to  whom  he  owes 
so  correct  a  bearing." 

Never  had  the  thought  occurred  to  this  great  baby 
that  one  day  he  would  leave  San  Francisco,  California, 
America,  to  roam  the  seas.  Such  an  idea  had  never 
entered  the  brain  of  a  man  more  absorbed  in  choregraphy 
than  geography,  and  who  was  still  ignorant  of  the  sub- 
urbs of  the  capital  beyond  ten  miles  radius.  And  now 
this  was  offered  to  him.  He  was  to  understand  that 
nolens  volens  he  was  to  expatriate  himself,  he  himself 
was  to  experience  with  all  their  costs  and  incon- 
veniences the  very  adventures  he  had  recommended  to 
his  pupil!  Here,  decidedly,  was  something  to  trouble  a 
brain  much  more  solid  than  his,  and  the  unfortunate 
Tartlet  for  the  first  time  in  his  life  felt  an  involuntary 


*6  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

yielding  in  the  muscles  of  his  limbs,  suppled  as  they 
were  by  thirty-five  years'  exercise. 

"Perhaps,"  said  he,  trying  to  recall  to  his  lips  the  stereo- 
typed smile  of  the  dancer  which  had  left  him  for  an 
instant — "perhaps — and  am  I  not — " 

"You  will  go!"  answered  William  W.  Kolderup  like  a 
man  with  whom  discussion  was  useless. 

To  refuse  was  impossible.  Tartlet  did  not  even  think 
of  such  a  thing.  What  was  he  in  the  house?  A  thing, 
a  parcel,  a  package  to  be  sent  to  every  corner  of  the 
world.  "And  when  am  I  to  start?"  demanded  he,  try- 
ing to  get  back  into  an  academical  position. 

"In  a  month." 

"And  on  what  raging  ocean  has  Mr.  Kolderup  decided 
that  his  vessel  should  bear  his  nephew  and  me?" 

"The  Pacific,  at  first." 

"And  on  what  point  of  the  terrestrial  globe  shall  I 
first  set  foot?" 

"On  the  soil  of  New  Zealand,"  answered  William  W. 
Kolderup;  "I  have  remarked  that  the  New  Zealanders 
always  stick  their  elbows  out!  Now  you  can  teach  them 
to  turn  them  in!" 

And  thus  was  Professor  Tartlet  selected  as  the  travel- 
ing-companion of  Godfrey  Morgan. 

A  nod  from  the  merchant  gave  him  to  understand  that 
the  audience  had  terminated.  He  retired,  considerably  agi- 
tated, and  the  performance  of  the  special  graces  which 
he  usually  displayed  in  this  difficult  act  left  a  good  deal 
to  be  desired.  In  fact,  for  the  first  time  in  his  life,  Pro- 
fessor Tartlet,  forgetting  in  his  preoccupation  the  most 
elementary  principles  of  his  art,  went  out  with  his  toes 
turned  in. 


CHAPTER  V 

A   STOWAWAY 

THE  voyage  had  begun.  There  had  not  been  much 
difficulty  so  far,  it  must  be  admitted. 

Professor  Tartlet,  with  incontestable  logic,  often  re- 
peated, "Any  voyage  can  begin!  But  where  and  how  it 
finishes  is  the  important  point." 


A  STOWAWAY  27 

The  cabin  occupied  by  Godfrey  was  below  the  poop  of 
the  Dream  and  opened  on  to  the  dining-saloon.  Our 
young  traveler  was  lodged  there  as  comfortably  as  pos- 
sible. He  had  given  Phina's  photograph  the  best  place 
on  the  best  lighted  panel  of  his  room.  A  cot  to  sleep 
on,  a  lavatory  for  toilet  purposes,  some  chests  of  drawers 
for  his  clothes  and  his  linen,  a  table  to  work  at,  an  arm- 
chair to  sit  upon,  what  could  a  young  man  in  his  twenty- 
second  year  want  more?  Under  such  circumstances  he 
might  have  gone  twenty-two  times  around  the  world !  Was 
he  not  at  the  age  of  that  practical  philosophy  which  con- 
sists in  good  health  and  good  humor  ?  Ah !  young  people, 
travel  if  you  can,  and  if  you  cannot — travel  all  the  same! 

Tartlet  was  not  in  a  good  humor.  His  cabin,  near  that 
of  his  pupil,  seemed  to  him  too  narrow,  his  bed  too  hard, 
the  six  square  yards  which  he  occupied  quite  insufficient  for 
his  steps  and  strides.  Would  not  the  traveler  in  him  ab- 
sorb the  professor  of  dancing  and  deportment?  No!  It 
was  in  the  blood,  and  when  Tartlet  reached  the  hour  of 
his  last  sleep  his  feet  would  be  found  placed  in  a  hori- 
zontal line  with  the  heels  one  against  the  other,  in  the 
first  position. 

Meals  were  taken  in  common.  Godfrey  and  Tartlet  sat 
opposite  to  each  other,  the  captain  and  mate  occupying 
each  end  of  the  rolling  table.  This  alarming  appellation, 
the  "rolling  table,"  is  enough  to  warn  us  that  the  profes- 
sor's place  would  too  often  be  vacant. 

At  the  start  in  the  lovely  month  of  June,  there  was  a 
beautiful  breeze  from  the  north-east,  and  Captain  Turcott 
was  able  to  set  his  canvas  so  as  to  increase  his  speed. 
The  Dream  thus  balanced  hardly  rolled  at  all,  and  as 
the  waves  followed  her,  her  pitching  was  but  slight.  This 
mode  of  progressing  was  not  such  as  to  affect  the  looks 
of  the  passengers  and  give  them  pinched  noses,  hollow 
eyes,  livid  foreheads,  or  colorless  cheeks.  It  was  support- 
able. They  steered  south-west  over  a  splendid  sea,  hardly 
lifting  in  the  least,  and  the  American  coast  soon  disap- 
peared below  the  horizon. 

For  two  days  nothing  occurred  worthy  of  mention. 
The  Dream  made  good  progress.  The  commencement  of 
the  voyage  promised  well — so  that  Captain  Turcott  seemed 
occasionally  to  feel  an  anxiety  which  he  tried  in  vain  to 


28  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

hide.  Each  day  as  the  sun  crossed  the  meridian  he  care- 
fully took  his  observations.  But  it  could  be  noticed  that 
immediately  afterward  he  retired  with  the  mate  into  his 
cabin,  and  then  they  remained  in  secret  conclave  as  if  they 
were  discussing  some  grave  eventuality.  This  performance 
passed  probably  unnoticed  by  Godfrey,  who  understood 
nothing  about  the  details  of  navigation,  but  the  boat- 
swain and  the  crew  seemed  somewhat  astonished  at  it, 
particularly  as  frr  two  or  three  times  during  the  first 
week,  when  there  was  not  the  least  necessity  for  the 
maneuver,  the  course  of  the  Dream  at  night  was  com- 
pletely altered,  and  resumed  again  in  the  morning.  In  a 
sailing-ship  this  might  be  intelligible;  but  in  a  steamer, 
which  could  keep  on  the  great  circle  line  and  only  use 
canvas  when  the  wind  was  favorable,  it  was  somewhat 
.extraordinary. 

During  the  morning  of  the  I2th  of  June  a  very  unex- 
pected incident  occurred  on  board. 

Captain  Turcott,  the  mate,  and  Godfrey,  were  sitting 
down  to  breakfast  when  an  unusual  noise  was  heard  on 
deck.    Almost  immediately  afterward  the  boatswain  opened 
the  door  and  appeared  on  the  threshold. 
"Captain!"  he  said. 

"What's  up?"  asked  Turcott,  sailor  as  he  was,  always 
on  the  alert. 

"Here's  a — Chinee!"  said  the  boatswain. 
"A  Chinese!" 

"Yes!  a  genuine  Chinese  we  have  just  found  by  chance 
at  the  bottom  of  the  hold!" 

"At  the  bottom  of  the  Hold!"  exclaimed  Turcott. 
"Well,  by  all  the — somethings — of  Sacramento,  just  send 
him  to  the  bottom  of  the  sea !" 

"All  right!"  answered  the  boatswain. 
And  that   excellent   man   with   all   the  contempt   of   a 
Californian  for  a  son  of  the  Celestial  Empire,  taking  'the 
order  as  quite  a  natural   one,   would  have  had  not  the 
slightest  compunction  in  executing  it. 

However,  Captain  Turcott  rose  from  his  chair,  and 
followed  by  Godfrey  and  the  mate,  left  the  saloon  and 
walked  toward  the  forecastle  of  the  Dream. 

There  stood  a  Chinaman,  tightly  handcuffed,  and  held 
by  two  or  three  sailors,  who  were  by  no  means  sparing  of 


A  STOWAWAY  29 

their  nudges  and  knocks.  He  was  a  man  of  from  five-and- 
thirty  to  forty,  with  intelligent  features,  well  built,  of 
lithe  figure,  but  a  little  emaciated,  owing  to  his  sojourn  for 
sixty  hours  at  the  bottom  of  a  badly  ventilated  hold. 

Captain  Turcott  made  a  sign  to  his  men  to  leave  the 
unhappy  intruder  alone, 

"Who  are  you?"  he  asked. 

"A  son  of  the  sun." 

"And.  what  is  your  name?" 

"Seng  Vou,"  answered  the  Chinese,  whose  name  in 
the  Celestial  language  signifies  "he  who  does  not  live." 

"And  what  are  you  doing  en  board  here?" 

'"'1  am  out  for  a  sail!"  coolly  answered  Seng  Vou, 
"but  am  doing  you  as  little  harm  as  I  can." 

"Really!  as  little  harm! — and  you  stowed  yourself  away 
in  the  hold  when  we  started?" 

"Just  so,  captain." 

"So  that  we  might  take  you  for  nothing  from  America 
to  China,  on  the  other  side  of  the  Pacific?" 

"If  you  will  have  it  so." 

"And  if  I  don't  wish  to  have  it  so,  you  yellow-skinned 
nigger.  If  I  will  have  it  that  you  have  to  swim  to 
China?" 

"I  will  try,"  said  the  Chinaman  with  a  smile,  "but  I 
shall  probably  sink  on  the  road!" 

"Well,  John,"  exclaimed  Captain  Turcott,  "I  am  going 
to  show  you  how  to  save  your  passage-money." 

And  Captain  Turcott,  much  more  angry  than  circum- 
stances necessitated,  was  perhaps  about  to  put  his  threat 
into  execution,  when  Godfrey  intervened. 

"Captain,"  he  said,  "one  more  Chinee  on  board  the 
Dream  is  one  Chinee  less  in  California,  where  there  are 
too  many." 

"A  great  deal  too  many!"  answered  Captain  Turcott. 

"Yes,  too  many.  Well,  if  this  poor  beggar  wishes  to 
relieve  San  Francisco  of  his  presence,  he  ought  to  be 
pitied!  Bah!  we  can  throw  him  on  shore  at  Shanghai! 
and  there  needn't  be  any  fuss  about  it!" 

There  is  no  reason  why  we  should  conceal  the  fact — 
Seng  Vou  belonged  to  a  Chinese  actors'  troupe,  in  which 
he  filled  the  role  of  "comic  lead,"  if  such  a  description 
can  apply  to  any  Chinese  artiste.  As  a  matter  of  fact 


30  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

they  are  so  serious,  even  in  their  fun,  that  the  Californiaa 
romancer,  Bret  Harte,  has  told  us  that  he  never  saw  a 
genuine  Chinaman  laugh,  and  has  even  confessed  that  he 
is  unable  to  say  whether  one  of  the  national  pieces  he  wit- 
nessed was  a  tragedy  or  a  farce. 

In  short,  Seng  Vou  was  a  comedian.  The  season  had 
ended,  crowned  with  success — perhaps  out  of  proportion 
to  the  gold  pieces  he  had  amassed — he  wished  to  return  to 
his  country  otherwise  than  as  a  corpse,  for  Chinamen 
always  like  to  get  buried  at  home,  and  there  are  special 
steamers  who  carry  dead  Celestials  and  nothing  else.  At 
all  risks,  therefore,  he  had  secretly  slipped  on  board  the 
Dream. 

Loaded  with  provisions,  did  he  hope  to  get  through, 
incognito,  a  passage  of  several  weeks,  and  then  to  land 
on  the  coast  of  China  without  being  seen?  It  is  just 
possible.  At  any  rate,  the  case  was  hardly  one  for  a  death 
penalty. 

So  Godfrey  had  good  reason  to  interfere  in  favor  of 
the  intruder,  and  Captain  Turcott,  who  pretended  to  be 
angrier  than  he  really  was,  gave  up  the  idea  of  sending 
Seng  Vou  overboard  to  battle  with  the  waves  of  the 
Pacific. 

Seng  Vou,  however,  did  not  return  to  his  hiding-place 
in  the  hold,  though  he  was  rather  an  incubus  on  board. 
Phlegmatic,  methodic,  and  by  no  means  communicative, 
he  carefully  avoided  the  seamen,  who  had  always  some 
prank  to  play  off  on  him,  and  he  kept  to  his  own  pro- 
visions. He  was  thin  enough  in  all  conscience,  and  his 
additional  weight  but  imperceptibly  added  to  the  cost 
of  navigating  the  Dream.  If  Seng  Vou  got  a  free 
passage  it  was  obvious  that  his  carriage  did  not  cost 
William  W.  Kolderup  very  much.  His  presence  on  board 
put  into  Captain  Turcott's  head  an  idea  which  his  mate 
probably  was  the  only  one  to  understand  thoroughly. 

"He  will  bother  us  a  bit — this  confounded  Chinee! — 
after  all,  so  much  the  worse  for  him." 

"Whatever  made  him  stow  himself  away  on  board  the 
Dream?"  answered  the  mate. 

"To  get  to  Shanghai!"  replied  Captain  Turcott.  "Bless 
John  and  all  John's  sons  tool" 


A  PECULIAR  DISASTER  31 


CHAPTER  VI 

A    PECULIAR    DISASTER 

DURING  the  following-  days,  the  I3th,  I4th,  and  i$th  of 
June,  the  barometer  slowly  fell,  without  an  attempt  to 
rise  in  the  slightest  degree,  and  the  weather  became  vari- 
able, hovering  between  rain  and  wind  or  storm.  The 
breeze  strengthened  considerably,  and  changed  to  south- 
westerly. It  was  a  head-wind  for  the  Dream,  and  the 
waves  had  now  increased  enormously,  and  lifted  her  for- 
ward. The  sails  were  all  furled,  and  she  had  to  depend 
on  her  screw  alone;  under  half  steam,  however,  so  as  to 
avoid  excessive  laboring. 

Godfrey  bore  the  trial  of  the  ship's  motion  without 
even  losing  his  good-humor  for  a  moment.  Evidently 
he  w^s  fond  of  the  sea.  But  Tartlet  was  not  fond  of 
the  sea,  and  it  served  him  out.  It  was  pitiful  to  see  the 
unfortunate  professor  of  deportment  deporting  himself  no 
longer,  the  professor  of  dancing  dancing  contrary  to 
every  rule  of  his  art.  Remain  in  his  cabin,  with  the  seas 
shaking  the  ship  from  stem  to  stern,  he  could  not. 

"Air!  air!"  he  gasped.  And  so  he  never  left  the  deck. 
A  roll  sent  him  rolling  from  one  side  to  the  other,  a  pitch 
sent  him  pitching  from  one  end  to  the  other.  He  clung 
to  the  rails,  he  clutched  the  ropes,  he  assumed  every  atti- 
tude that  is  absolutely  condemned  by  the  principles  of  the 
modern  choregraphic  art. 

Ah!  why  could  he  not  raise  himself  into  the  air  by 
some  balloon-like  movement,  and  escape  the  eccentricities 
of  that  moving  plane  ?  A  dancer  of  his  ancestors  had  said 
that  he  only  consented  to  set  foot  to  the  ground  so  as 
not  to  humiliate  his  companions,  but  Tartlet  would  will- 
ingly never  have  come  down  at  all  on  the  deck,  whose 
perpetual  agitation  threatened  to  hurl  him  into  the  abyss. 
What  an  idea  it  was  for  the  rich  William  \V.  Kolderup  to 
send  him  here. 

"Is  this  bad  weather  likely  to  last?"  asked  he  of 
Captain  Turcott  twenty  times  a  day. 

"Dunno!  barometer  is  not  very  promising!"  was  the 
invariable  answer  of  the  captain,  knitting'  his  brows. 

"Shall  we  soon  get  there?" 


32  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

"Soon,  Mr.   Tartlet?     Hum!   soon!" 

"And  they  call  this  the  Pacific  Ocean!"  repeated  the 
unfortunate  man,  between  a  couple  of  shocks  and  oscilla- 
tions. 

It  should  be  stated  that,  not  only  did  Professor  Tartlet 
suffer  from  sea-sickness,  but  also  that  fear  had  seized  him 
as  he  watched  the  great  seething  waves  breaking  into 
foam  level  with  the  bulwarks  of  the  Dream,  and  heard  the 
valves,  lifted  by  the  violent  beats,  letting  the  steam  off 
through  the  waste-pipes,  as  he  felt  the  steamer  tossing 
like  a  cork  on  the  mountains  of  water. 

"No,"  said  he  with  a  lifeless  look  at  his  pupil,  "it  is  not 
impossible  for  us  to  capsize." 

"Take  it  quietly,  Tartlet,"  replied  Godfrey.  "A  ship 
was  made  to  float!  There  are  reasons  for  all  this." 

"I  tell  you  there  are  none."  And,  thinking  thus,  the 
professor  had  put  on  his  life-belt.  He  wore  it  night  and 
day,  tightly  buckled  around  his  waist.  He  would  not  have 
taken  it  off  for  untold  gold.  Every  time  the  sea  gave  him 
a  moment's  respite  he  would  replenish  it  with  another  puff. 
In  fact,  he  never  blew  it  out  enough  to  please  him. 

The  weather  became  worse  and  worse,  and  threatened 
the  Dream  with  a  gale,  which,  had  she  been  near  the 
shore,  would  have  been  announced  to  her  by  the  sema- 
phores. During  the  day  the  ship  was  dreadfully  knocked 
about,  though  running  at  half  steam  so  as  not  to  dam- 
age her  engines.  Her  screw  was  continually  immerging 
and  emerging  in  the  violent  oscillations  of  her  liquid  bed. 
Hence,  powerful  strokes  from  its  wings  in  the  deeper 
water,  or  fearful  tremors  as  it  rose  and  ran  wild,  causing 
heavy  thunderings  beneath  the  stern,  and  furious  gallop- 
ings  of  the  pistons  which  the  engineer  could  master  but 
with  difficulty. 

One  observation  Godfrey  made,  of  which  at  first  he 
could  not  discover  the  cause.  This  was,  that  during  the 
night  the  shocks  experienced  by  the  steamer  were  infinitely 
less  violent  than  during  the  day.  Was  he  then  to  conclude 
that  the  wind  then  fell,  and  that  a  calm  set  in  after  sun- 
down ? 

This  was  so  remarkable  that,  on  the  night  between  the 
2 1st  and  22nd  of  June,  he  endeavored  to  find  out  some 
explanation  of  it.  The  day  had  been  particularly  stormy, 


A  PECULIAR  DISASTER  33 

the  wind  had  freshened,  and  it  did  not  appear  at  all  likely 
that  the  sea  would  fall  at  night,  lashed  so  capriciously  as  it 
had  been  for  so  many  hours. 

Toward  midnight  then  Godfrey  dressed,  and,  wrap- 
ping himself  up  warmly,  went  on  deck.  The  men  on 
watch  were  forward,  Captain  Turcott  was  on  the  bridge. 
The  force  of  the  wind  had  certainly  not  diminished.  The 
shock  of  the  waves,  which  should  have  dashed  on  the 
bows  of  the  Dreain,  was,  however  very  much  less  vio- 
lent. But  in  raising  his  eyes  toward  the  top  of  the  fun- 
nel, with  its  black  canopy  of  smoke,  Godfrey  saw  that 
the  smoke,  instead  of  floating  from  the  bow  aft,  was  on 
the  contrary,  floating  from  aft  forward,  and  following  the 
same  direction  as  the  ship. 

"Has  the  wind  changed?"  he  said  to  himself. 

And  extremely  glad  at  the  circumstance  he  mounted  the 
bridge.  Stepping  up  to  Turcott,  "Captain!"  he  said. 

The  latter,  enveloped  in  his  oilskins,  had  not  heard  him 
approach,  and  at  first  could  not  conceal  a  movement  of  an- 
noyance in  seeing  him  close  to  him.  "You,  Mr.  God- 
frey, you — on  the  bridge?" 

"Yes,  I,  Captain.     I  came  to  ask — " 

"What?"  answered   Captain  Turcott  sharply. 

"If  the  wind  has  not  changed?" 

"No,  Mr.  Godfrey,  no.  And,  unfortunately,  I  think  it 
will  turn  to  a  storm!" 

"But  we  now  have  the  wind  behind  us!" 

"Wind  behind  us — yes — wind  behind  us!"  replied  the 
captain,  visibly  disconcerted  at  the  observation.  "But  it 
is  not  my  fault." 

"What  do  you  mean?" 

"I  mean  that  in  order  not  to  endanger  the  vessel's  safe- 
ty I  have  had  to  put  her  about  and  run  before  the  storm." 

"That  will  cause  a  most  lamentable  delay!"  said  God- 
frey. 

"Very  much  so,"  answered  Captain  Turcott,  "but  when 
'day  breaks,  if  the  sea  falls  a  little,  I  shall  resume  our 
westerly  route.  I  should  recommend  you,  Mr.  Godfrey, 
to  get  back  to  your  cabin.  Take  my  advice,  try  and  sleep 
while  we  are  running  before  the  wind.  You  will  be  less 
knocked  about." 

Godfrey  made  a  sign  of  affirmation;  turning  a  last  anx- 

Vol.  13  Verne 


34  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

ious  glance  at  the  low  clouds  which  were  chasing  each 
other  with  extreme  swiftness,  he  left  the  bridge,  returned 
to  his  cabin,  and  soon  resumed  his  interrupted  slumbers. 
The  next  morning,  the  22nd  of  June,  as  Captain  Turcott 
had  said,  the  wind  having  sensibly  abated,  the  Dream 
was  headed  in  the  proper  direction. 

This  navigation  toward  the  west  during  the  day, 
toward  the  east  during  the  night,  lasted  for  forty-eight 
hours  more;  but  the  barometer  showed  some  tendency  to 
rise,  its  oscillations  became  less  frequent ;  it  was  to  be  pre- 
sumed that  the  bad  weather  would  end  in  northerly  winds. 
And  so  in  fact  it  happened. 

On  the  -2 5th  of  June,  about  eight  o'clock  in  the  morn- 
ing, when  Godfrey  stepped  on  deck,  a  charming  breeze 
from  the  north-east  had  swept  away  the  clouds,  the 
sun's  rays  were  shining  through  the  rigging  and  tipping 
its  projecting  points  with  touches  of  fire.  The  sea,  deep 
green  in  color,  glittered  along  a  large  section  of  its  sur- 
face beneath  the  direct  influence  of  its  beams.  The  wind 
blew  only  in  feeble  gusts  which  laced  the  wave-crests  with 
delicate  foam.  The  lower  sails  were  set. 

Properly  speaking,  they  were  not  regular  waves  on 
which  the  sea  rose  and  fell,  but  only  lengthened  undula- 
tions which  gently  rocked  the  steamer. 

Undulations  or  waves,  it  is  true,  it  was  all  one  to  Pro- 
fessor Tartlet,  as  unwell  when  it  was  "too  mild/'  as  when 
it  was  "too  rough."  There  he  was,  half  crouching  on  the 
deck,  with  his  mouth  open  like  a  carp  fainted  out  of  water. 

The  mate  on  the  poop,  his  telescope  at  his  eye,  was  look- 
ing toward  the  north-east. 

Godfrey  approached  him. 

"Well,  sir,"  said  he  gaily,  "today  is  a  little  better  than 
yesterday." 

"Yes,  Mr.  Godfrey,"  replied  the  mate,  "we  are  now  in 
smooth  water." 

"And  the  Dream  is  on  the  right  road!" 

"Not  yet." 

"Not  yet?  and  why?" 

"Because  \ve  have  evidently  drifted  north-eastward 
during  this  last  spell,  and  we  must  find  out  our  position 
exactly." 


A  PECULIAR  DISASTER  35 

"But  there  is  a  good  sun  and  a  horizon  perfectly 
clear." 

"At  noon  in  taking  its  height  we  shall  get  a  good  ob- 
servation, and  then  the  captain  will  give  us  our  course." 

"Where. is  the  captain?"  asked  Godfrey. 

"He  has  gone  off." 

"Gone  off?" 

"Yes!  our  look-outs  saw  from  the  whiteness  of  the  sea 
that  there  were  some  breakers  away  to  the  east;  breakers 
which  were  not  shown  on  the  chart.  So  the  steam  launch 
was  got  out,  and  with  the  boatswain  and  three  men, 
Captain  Turcott  has  gone  off  to  explore." 

"How  long  ago?" 

"About  an  hour  and  a  half!" 

"Ah!"  said  Godfrey,  "I  am  sorry  he  did  not  tell  me. 
I  should  like  to  have  gone  too." 

"You  were  asleep,  Mr.  Godfrey,"  replied  the  mate,  "and 
the  captain  did  not  like  to  wake  you." 

"I  am  sorry;  but  tell  me,  which  way  did  the  launch 
go?" 

"Over  there,"  answered  the  mate,  "over  the  starboard 
bow,  north-eastward." 

"And  can  you  see  it  with  the  telescope?" 

"No,  she  is  too  far  off." 

"But  will  she  be  long  before  she  comes  back?" 

"She  won't  be  long,  for  the  captain  is  going  to  take 
the  sights  himself,  and  to  do  that  he  must  be  back  before 
noon." 

At  this  Godfrey  went  and  sat  on  the  forecastle,  having 
sent  some  one  for  his  glasses.  He  was  anxious  to  watch 
the  return  of  the  launch.  Captain  Turcott's  reconnais- 
sance did  not  cause  him  any  surprise.  It  was  natural 
that  the  Dream  should  not  be  run  into  danger  on  a  part 
of  the  sea  where  breakers  had  been  reported. 

Two  hours  passed.  It  was  not  until  half-past  ten  that 
a  light  line  of  smoke  began  to  rise  on  the  horizon. 

It  was  evidently  the  steam  launch  which,  having  finished 
the  reconnaissance,  was  making  for  the  ship. 

It  amused  Godfrey  to  follow  her  in  the  field  of  his 
glasses.  He  saw  her  little  by  little  reveal  herself  in  clearer 
outline,  he  saw  her  grow  011  the  surface  of  the  sea,  and 
then  give  definite  shape  to  her  smoke  wreath,  as  it  min- 


36  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

gled  with  a  few  curls  of  steam  on  the  clear  depth  of  the 
horizon. 

She  was  an  excellent  little  vessel,  of  immense  speed, 
and  as  she  came  along  at  full  steam,  she  was  soon  visible 
to  the  naked  eye.  Toward  eleven  o'clock,  the  wash  from 
her  bow  as  she  tore  through  the  waves  was  perfectly 
distinct,  and  behind  her  the  long  furrow  of  foam  gradually 
growing  wider  and  fainter  like  the  tail  of  a  comet. 

At  a  quarter-past  eleven,  Captain  Turcott  hailed  and 
boarded  the  Dream. 

"Well,  captain,  what  news?"  asked  Godfrey,  shaking 
his  hand. 

"Ah!  Good  morning,  Mr.  Godfrey!" 

"And  the  breakers?" 

"Only  show!"  answered  Captain  Turcott.  "We  saw 
nothing  suspicious,  our  men  must  have  been  deceived, 
but  I  am  rather  surprised  at  that,  all  the  same." 

"We  are  going  ahead  then?"  said  Godfrey. 

"Yes,  we  are  going  on  now,  but  I  must  first  take  an 
observation." 

"Shall  we  get  the  launch  on  board?"  asked  the  mate. 

"No,"  answered  the  captain,  "we  may  want  it  again. 
Leave  it  in  tow!" 

The  captain's  orders  were  executed,  and  the  launch, 
still  under  steam,  dropped  around  to  the  stern  of  the 
Dream. 

Three-quarters  of  an  hour  afterward,  Captain  Turcott, 
with  his  sextant  in  his  hand,  took  the  sun's  altitude,  and 
having  made  his  observation,  he  gave  the  course.  That 
done,  having  given  a  last  look  at  the  horizon,  he  called 
the  mate,  and  taking  him  into  his  cabin,  the  two  remained 
there  in  a  long  consultation. 

The  day  was  a  very  fine  one.  The  sails  had  been  furled, 
and  the  Dream  steamed  rapidly  without  their  help.  The 
wind  was  very  slight,  and  with  the  speed  given  by  the 
screw  there  would  not  have  been  enough  to  fill  them. 

Godfrey  was  thoroughly  happy.  This  sailing  over  a 
beautiful  sea,  under  a  beautiful  sky,  could  anything  be 
more  cheering,  could  anything  give  more  impulse  to 
thought,  more  satisfaction  to  the  mind?  And  it  is  scarcely 
to  be  wondered  at  that  Professor  Tartlet  also  began  to 
recover  himself  a  little.  The  state  of  the  sea  did  not 


A  PECULIAR  DISASTER  37 

inspire  him  with  immediate  inquietude,  and  his  physical 
being  showed  a  little  reaction.  He  tried  to  eat,  but  with- 
out taste  or  appetfte.  Godfrey  would  have  had  him  take 
off  the  life-belt  which  encircled  his  waist,  but  this  he  abso- 
lutely refused  to  do.  Was  there  not  a  chance  of  this 
conglomeration  of  wood  and  iron,  which  men  call  a  ves- 
sel, gaping  asunder  at  any  moment? 

The  evening  came,  a  thick  mist  spread  over  the  sky, 
without  descending  to  the  level  of  the  sea.  The  night  was 
to  be  much  darker  than  would  have  been  thought  from 
the  magnificent  daytime. 

There  was  no  rock  to  fear  in  these  parts,  for  Captain 
Turcott  had  just  fixed  his  exact  position  on  the  charts; 
but  collisions  are  always  possible,  and  they  were  much 
more  frequent  on  foggy  nights. 

The  lamps  were  carefully  put  into  place  as  soon  as  the 
sun  set.  The  white  one  was  run  up  the  mast,  and  the 
green  light  to  the  right  and  the  red  one  to  the  left 
gleamed  in  the  shrouds.  If  the  Dream  was  run  down, 
at  least  it  would  not  be  her  fault — that  was  one  consola- 
tion. To  founder  when  one  is  in  order,  is  to  founder 
nevertheless.  But  if  any  one  on  board  made  this  observa- 
tion it  was  of  course  Professor  Tartlet.  However,  the 
worthy  man,  always  on  the  roll  and  the  pitch,  had  re- 
gained his  cabin,  Godfrey  his;  the  one  with  the  assurance, 
the  other  in  the  hope  that  he  would  pass  a  good  night, 
for  the  Dream  scarcely  moved  on  the  crest  of  the  length- 
ened waves. 

Captain  Turcott,  having  handed  over  the  watch  to  the 
mate,  also  came  under  the  poop  to  take  a  few  hours'  rest. 
All  was  in  order.  The  steamer  could  go  ahead  in  perfect 
safety,  although  it  did  not  seem  as  though  the  thick  fog 
would  lift. 

In  about  twenty  minutes  Godfrey  was  asleep,  and  the 
sleepless  Tartlet,  who  had  gone  to  bed  with  his  clothes  on 
as  usual,  'only  betrayed  himself  by  distant  sighs.  All  at 
once — at  about  one  in  the  morning — Godfrey  was  awak- 
ened by  a  dreadful  clamor. 

He  jumped  out  of  bed,  slipped  on  his  clothes,  his 
trousers,  his  waistcoat  and  his  sea-boots.  Almost  imme- 
diately a  fearful  cry  was  heard  on  deck,  "We  are  sinking! 
we  are  sinking!" 


38  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

In  an  instant  Godfrey  was  out  of  his  cabin  and  in  the 
saloon.  There  he  cannoned  against  an  inert  mass  which 
he  did  not  recognize.  It  was  Professor  Tartlet. 

The  whole  crew  were  on  deck,  hurrying  about  at  the 
orders  of  the  mate  and  captain. 

"A  collision?"  asked  Godfrey. 

"I  don't  know,  I  don't  know — this  beastly  fog—"  an- 
swered the  mate;  "but  we  are  sinking!" 

"Sinking?"  exclaimed  Godfrey. 

And  in  fact  the  Dream,  which  had  doubtless  struck  on  a 
rock,  was  sensibly  foundering.  The  water  was  creeping 
up  to  the  level  of  the  deck.  The  engine  fires  were  prob- 
ably already  out  below. 

"To  the  sea!  to  the  sea,  Mr.  Morgan!"  exclaimed  the 
captain.  "There  is  not  a  moment  to  lose!  You  can  see 
the  ship  settling  down!  It  will  draw  you  down  in  the 
eddy!" 

"And  Tartlet?" 

"I'll  look  after  him ! — We  are  only  half  a  cable  from  the 
shore!" 

"But  you?" 

"My  duty  compels  me  to  remain  here  to  the  last,  and 
I  remain!"  said  the  captain.  "But  get  off!  get  off!" 

Godfrey  still  hesitated  to  cast  himself  into  the  waves, 
but  the  water  was  already  up  to  the  level  of  the  deck. 

Captain  Turcott  knowing  that  Godfrey  swam  like  a 
fish,  seized  him  by  the  shoulders,  and  did  him  the  service 
of  throwing  him  overboard. 

It  was  time!  Had  it  not  been  for  the  darkness,  there 
would  doubtless  have  been  seen  a  deep  raging  vortex  in 
the  place  once  occupied  by  the  Dream. 

But  Godfrey,  in  a  few  strokes  in  the  calm  water, 
was  able  to  get  swiftly  clear  of  the  whirlpool,  which  would 
have  dragged  him  down  like  the  maelstrom. 

All  this  was  the  work  of  a  minute. 

A  few  minutes  afterward,  amid  shouts  of  despair,  the 
lights  on  board  went  out  one  after  the  other. 

Doubt  existed  no  more;  the  Dream  had  sunk  head 
downward ! 

As  for  Godfrey  he  had  been  able  to  reach  a  large,  lofty 
rock  away  from  the  surf.  There,  shouting  vainly  in  the 
darkness,  hearing  no  voice  in  reply  to  his  own,  not  know- 


ON  LAND  AGAIN  39 

ing  if  he  should  find  himself  on  an  isolated  rock  or  at 
the  extremity  of  a  line  of  reefs,  and  perhaps  the  sole  sur- 
vivor of  the  catastrophe,  he  waited  for  the  dawn. 


CHAPTER  VII 

ON  LAND  AGAIN 

THREE  long  hours  had  still  to  pass  before  tHe  sun  re- 
appeared above  the  horizon.  These  were  such  hours  that 
they  might  rather  be  called  centuries. 

The  trial  was  a  rough  one  to  begin  with,  but,  we  repeat, 
Godfrey  had  not  come  out  for  a  simple  promenade.  He 
himself  put  it  very  well  when  he  said  he  had  left  behind 
him  quite  a  lifetime  of  happiness  and  repose,  which  he 
would  never  find  again  in  his  search  for  adventures.  He 
tried  his  utmost  therefore  to  rise  to  the  situation. 

He  was,  temporarily,  under  shelter.  The  sea  after  all 
could  not  drive  him  off  the  rock  which  lay  anchored  alone 
amid  the  spray  of  the  surf.  Was  there  any  fear  of  the 
incoming  tide  soon  reaching  him?  No,  for  on  reflection 
he  concluded  that  the  wreck  had  taken  place  at  the  high- 
est tide  of  the  new  moon. 

But  was  the  rock  isolated?  Did  it  command  a  line  of 
breakers  scattered  on  this  portion  of  the  sea?  What  was 
this  coast  which  Captain  Turcott  had  thought  he  saw 
in  the  darkness?  To  which  continent  did  it  belong?  It 
was  only  too  certain  that  the  Dream  had  been  driven  out 
of  her  route  during  the  storm  of  the  preceding  days.  The 
position  of  the  ship  could  not  have  been  exactly  fixed. 
How  could  there  be  a  doubt  of  this  when  the  captain  had 
two  hours  before  affirmed  that  his  charts  bore  no  indi- 
cations of  breakers  in  these  parts !  He  had  even  done  bet- 
ter and  had  gone  himself  to  reconnoiter  these  imaginary 
reefs  which  his  look-outs  reported  they  had  seen  in  the 
east.  It  nevertheless  had  been  only  too  true,  and  Cap- 
tain  Turcott's  reconnaissance  would  have  certainly  pre- 
vented the  catastrophe  if  it  had  only  been  pushed  far 
enough.  But  what  was  the  good  of  returning  to  the  past  ? 

The  important  question  in  face  of  what  had  happened — 
a  question  of  life  or  death — was  for  Godfrey  to  know  if 
he  was  near  to  some  land.  In  what  part  of  the  Pacific 


40  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

there  would  be  time  later  on  to  determine.  Before 
everything  he  must  think  as  soon  as  the  day  came  of 
how  to  leave  the  rock,  which  in  its  biggest  part  could  not 
measure  more  than  twenty  yards  square.  But  people  do 
not  leave  one  place  except  to  go  to  another.  And  if  this 
other  did  not  exist,  if  the  captain  had  been  deceived  in 
the  fog,  if  around  the  breakers  there  stretched  a  boundless 
sea,  if  at  the  extreme  point  of  view  the  sky  and  the  water 
seemed  to  meet  all  around  the  horizon? 

The  thoughts  of  the  man  were  thus  concentrated  on 
this  point.  All  his  powers  of  vision  did  he  employ  to 
discover  through  the  black  night  if  any  confused  mass,  any 
heap  of  rocks  or  cliffs,  would  reveal  the  neighborhood  of 
land  to  the  eastward  of  the  reef. 

Godfrey  saw  nothing.  Not  a  smell  of  earth  reached  his 
nose,  not  a  sensation  of  light  reached  his  eyes,  not  a 
sound  reached  his  ears.  Not  a  bird  traversed  the  darkness. 
It  seemed  that  around  him  there  was  nothing  but  a  vast 
desert  of  water. 

Godfrey  did  not  hide  from  himself  that  the  chances 
were  a  thousand  to  one  that  he  was  lost.  He  no  longer 
thought  of  making  the  tour  of  the  world,  but  of  facing 
death,  and  calmly  and  bravely  his  thoughts  rose  to  that 
Providence  which  can  do  all  things  for  the  feeblest  of  its 
creatures,  though  the  creatures  can  do  nothing  of  them- 
selves. And  so  Godfrey  had  to  wait  for  the  day  to  resign 
himself  to  his  fate,  if  safety  was  impossible;  and,  on  the 
contrary,  to  try  everything,  if  there  was  any  chance  of 
life. 

Calmed  by  the  very  gravity  of  his  reflections,  Godfrey 
had  seated  himself  on  the  rock.  He  had  stripped  off  some 
of  his  clothes  which  had  been  saturated  by  the  sea-water, 
his  woolen  waistcoat  and  his  heavy  boots,  so  as  to  be 
ready  to  jump  into  the  sea  if  necessary. 

However,  was  it  possible  that  no  one  had  survived  the 
wreck?  What!  not  one  of  the  men  of  the  Dream  car- 
ried to  shore?  Had  they  all  been  sucked  in  by  the  terri- 
ble whirlpool  which  the  ship  had  drawn  around  herself  as 
she  sank?  The  last  to  whom  Godfrey  had  spoken  was 
Captain  Turcott,  resolved  not  to  quit  his  ship  while  one 
of  his  sailors  was  still  there!  It  was  the  captain  himself 


ON  LAND  AGAIN  41 

who  had  hurled  him  into  the  sea  at  the  moment  the  Dream 
was  disappearing. 

But  the  others,  the  unfortunate  Tartlet,  and  the  unhap- 
py Chinese,  surprised  without  doubt,  and  swallowed  up, 
the  one  in  the  poop,  the  other  in  the  depths  of  the  hold, 
what  had  become  of  them?  Of  all  those  on  board  the 
Dream,  was  he  the  only  one  saved?  And  had  the  steam 
launch  remained  at  the  stern  of  the  steamer?  Could  not 
a  few  passengers  or  sailors  have  saved  themselves  therein, 
and  found  time  to  flee  from  the  wreck?  But  was  it  not 
rather  to  be  feared  that  the  launch  had  been  dragged 
down  by  the  ship  under  several  fathoms  of  water? 

Godfrey  then  said  to  himself,  that  if  in  this  dark  night 
he  could  not  see,  he  could  at  least  make  himself  heard. 
There  was  nothing  to  prevent  his  shouting  and  hailing1 
in  the  deep  silence.  Perhaps  the  voice  of  one  of  his  com- 
panions would  respond  to  his. 

Over  and  over  again  then  did  he  call,  giving  forth  a 
prolonged  shout  which  should  have  been  heard  for  a  con- 
siderable distance  around.  Not  a  cry  answered  to  his. 

He  began  again,  many  times,  turning  successively  to 
every  point  of  the  horizon. 

Absolute  silence. 

"Alone!  alone!"  he  murmured. 

Not  only  had  no  cry  answered  to  him,  but  no  echo  had 
sent  him  back  the  sound  of  his  own  voice.  Had  he  been 
near  a  cliff,  not  far  from  the  group  of  rocks,  such  as 
generally  border  the  shore,  it  is  certain  that  his  shouts, 
repelled  by  the  obstacles,  would  have  returned  to  him. 
Either  eastward  of  the  reef,  therefore,  stretched  a  low- 
lying  shore  ill-adapted  for  the  production  of  an  echo,  or 
there  was  no  land  in  his  vicinity,  the  bed  of  breakers  on 
which  he  had  found  refuge  was  isolated. 

Three  hours  were  passed  in  these  anxieties.  Godfrey, 
quite  chilled,  walked  about  the  top  of  the  rock,  trying  to 
battle  with  the  cold.  At  last  a  few  pale  beams  of  light 
tinged  the  clouds  in  the  zenith.  It  was  the  reflection  of 
the  first  coloring  of  the  horizon. 

Godfrey  turned  to  the  west — the  only  side  toward 
which  there  could  be  land — to  see  if  any  cliff  outlined 
itself  in  the  shadow.  With  its  early  rays  the  rising  sun 
might  disclose  its  features  more  distinctly. 


42  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

But  nothing  appeared  through  the  misty  dawn.  A  light 
fog  was  rising  over  the  sea,  which  did  not  even  admit  of 
his  discovering  the  extent  of  the  breakers. 

He  had,  therefore,  to  satisfy  himself  with  illusions.  If 
Godfrey  were  really  cast  on  an  isolated  rock  in  the  Pacific, 
it  was  death  to  him  after  a  brief  delay,  death  by  hunger, 
by  thirst,  or  if  necessary,  death  at  the  bottom  of  the  sea 
as  a  last  resource! 

However,  he  kept  constantly  looking,  and  it  seemed 
as  though  the  intensity  of  his  gaze  increased  enormously, 
for  all  his  will  was  concentrated  therein. 

At  length  the  morning  mist  began  to  fade  away.  God- 
frey saw  the  rocks  which  formed  the  reef  successively  de- 
fined in  relief  on  the  sea,  like  a  troop  of  marine  monsters. 
It  was  a  long  and  irregular  assemblage  of  dark  boulders, 
strangely  worn,  of  all  sizes  and  forms,  whose  direction 
was  almost  west  and  east.  The  enormous  block  on  the 
top  of  which  Godfrey  found  himself  emerged  from  the 
sea  on  the  western  edge  of  the  bank  scarcely  thirty  fathoms 
from  the  spot  where  the  Dream  had  gone  down.  The  sea 
hereabout  appeared  to  be  very  deep,  for  of  the  steamer 
nothing  was  to  be  seen,  not  even  the  ends  of  her  masts. 
Perhaps  by  some  under-current  she  had  been  drawn  away 
from  the  reefs. 

A  glance  was  enough  for  Godfrey  to  take  in  this  state 
of  affairs.  There  was  no  safety  on  that  side.  All  his 
attention  was  directed  toward  the  other  side  of  the 
breakers,  which  the  lifting  fog  was  gradually  disclosing. 
The  sea,  now  that  the  tide  had  retired,  allowed  the  rocks 
to  stand  out  very  distinctly.  They  could  be  seen  to 
lengthen  as  their  humid  bases  widened.  Here  were  vast 
intervals  of  water,  there  a  few  shallow  pools.  If  they 
joined  on  to  any  coast,  it  would  not  be  difficult  to  reach  it. 

Up  to  the  present,  however,  there  was  no  sign  of  any 
shore.  Nothing  yet  indicated  the  proximity  of  dry  land, 
even  in  this  direction.  The  fog  continued  to  lift,  and  the 
field  of  view  persistently  watched  by  Godfrey  continued 
to  grow.  Its  wreaths  had  now  rolled  off  for  about  half  a 
mile  or  so.  Already  a  few  sandy  flats  appeared  among 
the  rocks,  carpeted  with  their  slimy  sea-weed. 

Did  not  this  sand  indicate  more  or  less  the  presence  of 
a  beach,  and  if  the  beach  existed,  could  there  be  a  doubt 


ON  LAND  AGAIN  43 

but  what  it  belonged  to  the  coast  of  a  more  important 
land?  At  length  a  long  profile  of  low  hills,  buttressed 
with  huge  granitic  rocks,  became  clearly  outlined  and 
seemed  to  shut  in  the  horizon  on  the  west.  The  sun  had 
drunk  up  all  the  morning  vapors,  and  his  disk  broke  forth 
in  all  its  glory. 

"Land!  land!"  exclaimed  Godfrey. 

And  he  stretched  his  hands  toward  the  shore-line,  as 
he  kneeled  on  the  reef  and  offered  his  thanks  to  Heaven. 

It  was  really  land.  The  breakers  only  formed  a  pro- 
jecting ridge,  something  like  the  southern  cape  of  a  bay, 
which  curved  around  for  about  two  miles  or  more.  The 
bottom  of  the  curve  seemed  to  be  a  level  beach,  bordered 
by  trifling  hills,  contoured  here  and  there  with  lines  of 
vegetation,  but  of  no  great  size. 

From  the  place  which  Godfrey  occupied,  his  view  was 
able  to  grasp  the  whole  of  this  side. 

Bordered  north  and  south  by  two  unequal  promontories, 
it  stretched  away  for,  at  the  most,  five  or  six  miles.  It 
was  possible,  however,  that  it  formed  part  of  a  large  dis- 
trict. Whatever  it  was,  it  offered  at  the  least  temporary 
safety.  Godfrey,  at  the  sight,  could  not  conceive  a  doubt 
but  that  he  had  not  been  thrown  on  to  a  solitary  reef,  and 
that  this  morsel  of  ground  would  satisfy  his  earliest  wants. 

"To  land!  to  land!"  he  said  to  himself. 

But  before  he  left  the  reef,  he  gave  a  look  around  for 
the  last  time.  His  eyes  again  interrogated  the  sea  away 
up  to  the  horizon.  Would  some  raft  appear  on  the  surface 
of  the  waves,  some  fragment  of  the  Dream,  some  survivor, 
perhaps  ? 

Nothing.  The  launch  even  was  not  there,  and  had 
probably  been  dragged  into  the  common  abyss. 

Then  the  idea  occurred  to  Godfrey  that  among  the 
breakers  some  of  his  companions  might  have  found  a 
refuge,  and  were,  like  him,  waiting  for  the  day  to  try  and 
reach  the  shore. 

There  was  nobody,  neither  on  the  rocks,  nor  on  the 
beach!  The  reef  was  as  deserted  as  the  ocean! 

But  in  default  of  survivors,  had  not  the  sea  thrown  up 
some  of  the  corpses?  Could  not  Godfrey  find  among  the 
rocks,  along  to  the  utmost  boundary  of  the  surf,  the 
inanimate  bodies  of  some  of  his  companions? 


44  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

No!  Nothing  along  the  whole  length  of  the  breakers, 
which  the  last  ripples  of  the  ebb  had  now  left  bare. 

Godfrey  was  alone!  He  could  only  count  on  himself 
to  battle  with  the  dangers  of  every  sort  which  environed 
him! 

Before  this  reality,  however,  Godfrey,  let  it  be  said  to 
his  credit,  did  not  quail.  But  as  before  everything  it  was 
best  for  him  to  ascertain  the  nature  of  the  ground  from 
which  he  was  separated  by  so  short  a  distance,  he  left  the 
summit  of  the  rock  and  began  to  approach  the  shore. 

When  the  interval  which  separated  the  rocks  was  too 
great  to  be  cleared  at  a  bound,  he  got  down  into  the  water, 
and  sometimes  walking  and  sometimes  swimming,  he 
easily  gained  the  one  next  in  order.  When  there  was  but 
a  yard  or  two  between,  he  jumped  from  one  rock  to  the 
other.  His  progress  over  these  slimy  stones,  carpeted 
with  glistening  sea-weeds,  was  not  easy,  and  it  was  long. 
Nearly  a  quarter  of  a  mile  had  thus  to  be  traversed. 

But  Godfrey  was  active  and  handy,  and  at  length  he  set 
foot  on  the  land  where  there  probably  awaited  him,  if  not 
early  death,  at  least  a  miserable  life  worse  than  death. 
Hunger,  thirst,  cold,  and  nakedness,  and  perils  of  all 
kinds;  without  a  weapon  of  defense,  without  a  gun  to 
shoot  with,  without  a  change  of  clothes— such  the  ex- 
tremities to  which  he  was  reduced. 

How  imprudent  he  had  been!  He  had  been  desirous  of 
knowing  if  he  was  capable  of  making  his  way  in  the  world 
under  difficult  circumstances!  He  had  put  himself  to  the 
proof!  He  had  envied  the  lot  of  a  Crusoe!  Well,  he 
would  see  if  the  lot  were  an  enviable  one! 

And  then  there  returned  to  his  mind  the  thought  of  his 
happy  existence,  that  easy  life  in  San  Francisco,  in  the 
midst  of  a  rich  and  loving  family,  which  he  had  abandoned 
to  throw  himself  into  adventures.  He  thought  of  his 
Uncle  Will,  of  his  betrothed  Phina,  of  his  friends  who 
would  doubtless  never  see  him  again. 

As  he  called  up  these  remembrances  his  heart  swelled, 
and  in  spite  of  his  resolution  tears  rose  to  his  eyes. 

And  again,  if  he  was  not  alone,  if  some  other  survivor 
of  the  shipwreck  had  managed,  like  him,  to  reach  the 
shore,  and  even  in  default  of  the  captain  or  the  mate,  this 
proved  to  be  Professor  Tartlet,  how  little  he  could  depend 


ON  LAND  AGAIN  45 

on  that  frivolous  being,  and  how  slightly  improved  the 
chances  of  the  future  appeared!  At  this  point,  however, 
he  still  had  hope.  If  he  had  found  no  trace  among  the 
breakers,  would  he  meet  with  any  on  the  beach? 

Godfrey  took  another  long  look  from  north  to  south. 
He  did  not  notice  a  single  human  being.  Evidently  this 
portion  of  the  earth  was  uninhabited.  In  any  case  there 
was  no  sign,  not  a  trace  of  smoke  in  the  air. 

"Let  us  get  on!"  said  Godfrey  to  himself. 

And  he  walked  along  the  beach  toward  the  north,  be- 
fore venturing  to  climb  the  sand  dunes,  which  would  allow 
him  to  reconnoiter  the  country  over  a  larger  extent. 

The  silence  was  absolute.  The  sand  had  received  no 
other  footmark.  A  few  sea-birds,  gulls  or  guillemots, 
were  skimming  along  the  edge  of  the  rocks,  the  only  liv- 
ing things  in  the  solitude. 

Godfrey  continued  his  walk  for  a  quarter  of  an  hour. 
At  last  he  was  about  to  turn  on  to  the  talus  of  the  most 
elevated  of  the  dunes,  dotted  with  rushes  and  brushwood, 
when  he  suddenly  stopped. 

A  shapeless  object,  extraordinarily  distended,  something 
like  the  corpse  of  a  sea  monster,  thrown  there,  doubtless, 
by  the  late  storm,  was  lying  about  thirty  paces  off  on  the 
edge  of  the  reef.  Godfrey  hastened  toward  it. 

The  nearer  he  approached  the  more  rapidly  did  his 
heart  beat.  In  truth,  in  this  stranded  animal  he  seemed 
to  recognize  a  human  form. 

Godfrey  was  not  ten  paces  away  from  it,  when  he 
stopped  as  if  rooted  to  the  soil,  and  exclaimed,  "Tartlet!" 

It  was  the  professor  of  dancing  and  deportment.  God- 
frey rushed  toward  his  companion,  who  perhaps  still 
breathed. 

A  moment  afterward  he  saw  that  it  was  the  life-belt 
which  produced  this  extraordinary  distension,  and  gave  the 
aspect  of  a  monster  of  the  sea  to  the  unfortunate  pro- 
fessor. But  although  Tartlet  was  motionless,  was  he 
dead?  Perhaps  this  natatory  clothing  had  kept  him  above 
water  while  the  surf  had  borne  him  to  shore? 

Godfrey  set  to  work.  He  kneeled  down  by  Tartlet;  he 
unloosed  the  life-belt  and  rubbed  him  vigorously.  He 
noticed  at  last  a  light  breath  on  the  half-opened  lips!  He 
put  his  hand  on  his  heart!  The  heart  still  beat. 


46 


ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 


Godfrey  spoke  to  him.  Tartlet  shook  his  head,  then  he 
gave  utterance  to  a  hoarse  exclamation,  followed  by  in- 
coherent words.  Godfrey  shook  him  violently.  Tartlet 
then  opened  his  eyes,  passed  his  left  hand  over  his  brow, 
lifted  his  right  hand  and  assured  himself  that  his  precious 
kit  and  bow,  which  he  tightly  held,  had  not  abandoned 
him. 

"Tartlet!  My  dear  Tartlet!"  shouted  Godfrey,  lightly 
raising  his  head. 

The  head  with  its  mass  of  tumbled  hair  gave  an  affirm- 
ative nod. 

"It  is  I!  I!  Godfrey!" 

"Godfrey?"  asked  the  professor.  And  then  he  turned 
over,  and  rose  to  his  knees,  and  looked  about,  and  smiled, 
and  rose  to  his  feet!  He  had  discovered  that  at  last  he 
was  on  a  solid  base!  He  had  gathered  that  he  was  no 
longer  on  the  ship's  deck,  exposed  to  all  the  uncertainties 
of  its  pitches  and  its  rolls!  The  sea  had  ceased  to  carry 
him!  He  stood  on  firm  ground! 

And  then  Professor  Tartlet  recovered  the  aplomb  which 
he  had  lost  since  his  departure;  his  feet  placed  themselves 
naturally,  with  their  toes  turned  out,  in  the  regulation 
position;  his  left  hand  seized  his  kit,  his  right  hand 
grasped  his  bow. 

Then,  while  the  strings,  vigorously  attacked,  gave  forth 
a  humid  sound  of  melancholy  sonorousness,  these  words 
escaped  his  smiling  lips,  "In  place,  miss!" 

The  good  man  was  thinking  of  Phina. 


CHAPTER  VIII 

THE    OTHER    REFUGEES 

THAT  done,  the  professor  and  his  pupil  rushed  into  one 
another's  arms.  "My  dear  Godfrey!"  exclaimed  Tartlet. 

"My  good  Tartlet!"  replied  Godfrey. 

"At  last  we  are  arrived  in  port!"  observed  the  professor 
in  the  tone  of  a  man  who  has  had  enough  of  navigation 
and  its  accidents. 

He  called  it  arriving  in  port! 

Godfrey  had  no  desire  to  contradict  him.     "Take  off 


THE  OTHER  REFUGEES  47 

your  life-belt,"  he  said.  "It  suffocates  you  and  hampers 
your  movements." 

"Do  you  think  I  can  do  so  without  inconvenience?" 
asked  Tartlet. 

"Without  any  inconvenience,"  answered  Godfrey.  "Now 
put  up  your  fiddle,  and  let  us  take  a  look  around." 

"Come  on,"  replied  the  professor;  "but  if  you  don't 
mind,  Godfrey,  let  us  go  to  the  first  restaurant  we  see.  I 
am  dying  of  hunger,  and  a  dozen  sandwiches  washed 
down  with  a  glass  or  two  of  wine  will  soon  set  me  on  my 
legs  again." 

"Yes!  to  the  first  restaurant!"  answered  Godfrey,  nod- 
'ding  his  head;  "and  even  to  the  last,  if  the  first  does  not 
suit  us." 

"And,"  continued  Tartlet,  "we  can  ask  some  fellow  as 
we  go  along  the  road  to  the  telegraph  office  so  as  to 
send  a  message  off  to  your  Uncle  Kolderup.  That  ex- 
cellent man  will  hardly  refuse  to  send  on  some  necessary 
cash  for  us  to  get  back  to  Montgomery  Street,  for  I  have 
not  got  a  cent  with  me !" 

"Agreed,  to  the  first  telegraph  office,"  answered  God- 
frey, "or  if  there  isn't  one  in  this  country,  to  the  first  post 
office.  Come  on,  Tartlet." 

The  professor  took  off  his  swimming  apparatus,  and 
passed  it  over  his  shoulder  like  a  hunting-horn,  and  then 
both  stepped  out  for  the  edge  of  the  dunes  which  bordered 
the  shore. 

What  more  particularly  interested  Godfrey,  whom  the 
encounter  with  Tartlet  had  imbued  with  some  hope,  was 
to  see  if  they  two  were  the  only  survivors  of  the  Dream. 

A  quarter  of  an  hour  after  the  explorers  had  left  the 
edge  of  the  reef  they  had  climbed  a  dune  about  sixty  or 
eighty  feet  high,  and  stood  on  its  crest.  Thence  they 
looked  on  a  large  extent  of  coast,  and  examined  the 
horizon  in  the  east,  which  till  then  had  been  hidden  by 
the  hills  on  the  shore. 

Two  or  three  miles  away  in  that  direction  a  second  line 
of  hills  formed  the  background,  and  beyond  them  nothing 
was  seen  of  the  horizon. 

Toward  the  north  the  coast  trended  off  to  a  point,  but 
it  could  not  be  seen  if  there  was  a  corresponding  cape  be- 
hind. On  the  south  a  creek  ran  some  distance  into  the 


48  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

shore,  and  on  this  side  it  looked  as  though  the  ocean  closed 
the  view.  Whence  this  land  in  the  Pacific  was  probably 
a  peninsula,  and  the  isthmus  which  joined  it  to  the  con- 
tinent would  have  to  be  sought  for  toward  the  north  or 
northeast. 

The  country,  however,  far  from  being  barren,  was  hid- 
den beneath  an  agreeable  mantle  of  verdure;  long  prairies, 
amid  which  meandered  many  limpid  streams,  and  high  and 
thick  forests,  whose  trees  rose  above  one  another  to  the 
very  background  of  hills.  It  was  a  charming  landscape. 

But  of  houses  forming  town,  village,  or  hamlet,  not  one 
was  in  sight!  Of  buildings  grouped  and  arranged  as  a 
farm  of  any  sort,  not  a  sign!  Of  smoke  in  the  sky,  be- 
traying some  dwelling  hidden  among  the  trees,  not  a 
trace.  Not  a  steeple  above  the  branches,  not  a  windmill 
on  an  isolated  hill.  Not  even  in  default  of  houses  a  cabin, 
a  hut,  an  ajoupa,  or  a  wigwam  ?  No !  nothing.  If  human 
beings  inhabited  this  unknown  land,  they  must  live  like 
troglodytes,  below,  and  not  above  the  ground.  Not  a  road 
was  visible,  not  a  footpath,  not  even  a  track.  It  seemed 
that  the  foot  of  man  had  never  trod  either  a  rock  of  the 
beach  or  a  blade  of  the  grass  on  the  prairies. 

"I  don't  see  the  town,"  remarked  Tartlet,  who,  however, 
remained  on  tiptoe. 

"That  is  perhaps  because  it  is  not  in  this  part  of  the 
province!"  answered  Godfrey. 

"But  a  village?" 

"There's  nothing  here." 

"Where  are  we  then?" 

"I  know  nothing  about  it." 

"What!  You  don't  know!  But,  Godfrey,  we  had 
better  make  haste  and  find  out." 

"Who  is  to  tell  us?" 

"What  will  become  of  us  then?"  exclaimed  Tartlet, 
rounding  his  arms  and  lifting  them  to  the  sky. 

"Become  a  couple  of  Crusoes!" 

At  this  answer  the  professor  gave  a  bound  such  as  no 
clown  had  ever  equaled. 

Crusoes!  They!  A  Crusoe!  He!  Descendants  of  that 
Selkirk  who  had  lived  for  long  years  on  the  island  of 
Juan  Fernandez!  Imitators  of  the  imaginary  heroes  of 
Daniel  Defoe  and  De  Wyss  whose  adventures  they  had  so 


THE  OTHER  REFUGEES  49 

often  read!  Abandoned,  far  from  their  relatives,  their 
friends;  separated  from  their  fellow-men  by  thousands  of 
miles,  destined  to  defend  their  lives  perhaps  against  wild 
beasts,  perhaps  against  savages  who  would  land  there, 
wretches  without  resources,  suffering  from  hunger,  suffer- 
ing from  thirst,  without  weapons,  without  tools,  almost 
without  clothes,  left  to  themselves.  No,  it  was  impossible! 

"Don't  say  such  things,  Godfrey,"  exclaimed  Tartlet. 
"No!  Don't  joke  about  such  things!  The  mere  supposi- 
tion will  kill  me!  You  are  laughing  at  me,  are  you  not?" 

"Yes,  my  gallant  Tartlet,"  answered  Godfrey.  "Reas- 
sure yourself.  But  in  the  first  place,  let  us  think  about 
matters  that  are  pressing." 

In  fact,  they  had  to  try  and  find  some  cavern,  a  grotto 
or  hole,  in  which  to  pass  the  night,  and  then  to  collect 
some  edible  mollusks  so  as  to  satisfy  the  cravings  of  their 
stomachs.  Godfrey  and  Tartlet  then  commenced  to  de- 
scend the  talus  of  the  dunes  in  the  direction  of  the  reef. 
Godfrey  showed  himself  very  ardent  in  his  researches,  and 
Tartlet  considerably  stupefied  by  his  shipwreck  experiences. 
The  first  looked  before  him,  behind  him,  and  all  around 
him;  the  second  hardly  saw  ten  paces  in  front  of  him. 

"If  there  are  no  inhabitants  on  this  land,  are  there  any 
animals?"  asked  Godfrey. 

He  meant  to  say  domestic  animals,  such  as  furred  and 
feathered  game,  not  wild  animals  which  abound  in  tropical 
regions,  and  with  which  they  were  not  likely  to  have  to  do. 

Several  flocks  of  birds  were  visible  on  the  shore,  bit- 
terns, curlews,  bernicle  geese,  and  teal,  which  hovered  and 
chirped  and  filled  the  air  with  their  flutterings  and  cries, 
doubtless  protesting  against  the  invasion  of  their  domain. 

Godfrey  was  justified  in  concluding  that  where  there 
were  birds  there  were  nests,  and  where  there  were  nests 
there  were  eggs.  The  birds  congregated  here  in  such 
numbers,  because  rocks  provided  them  with  thousands  of 
cavities  for  their  dwelling-places.  In  the  distance  a  few 
herons  and  some  flocks  of  snipe  indicated  the  neighbor- 
hood of  a  marsh. 

Birds  then  were  not  wanting,  the  only  difficulty  was  to 
get  at  them  with'out  fire-arms.  The  best  thing  to  do  now 
was  to  make  use  of  them  in  the  egg  state,  and  consume 
them  under  that  elementary  but  nourishing  form. 

Vol.  13  Verne 


50  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

But  if  the  dinner  was  there,  how  were  they  to  cook  it? 
How  were  they  to  set  about  lighting  a  fire?  An  im- 
portant question,  the  solution  of  which  was  postponed. 

Godfrey  and  Tartlet  returned  straight  toward  the  reef, 
over  which  some  sea-birds  were  circling.  An  agreeable 
surprise  there  awaited  them. 

Among  the  indigenous  fowl  which  ran  along  the  sand 
of  the  beach  and  pecked  about  among  the  sea-weed  and 
under  the  tufts  of  aquatic  plants,  was  it  a  dozen  hens  and 
two  or  three  cocks  of  the  American  breed  that  they  be- 
held? No!  There  was  no  mistake,  for  at  their  approach 
did  not  a  resounding  cock-a-doodle-do-oo-oo  rend  the  air 
like  the  sound  of  a  trumpet? 

And  farther  off,  what  were  those  quadrupeds  which 
were  gliding  in  and  out  of  the  rocks,  and  making  their 
way  toward  the  first  slopes  of  the  hills,  or  grubbing  be- 
neath some  of  the  green  shrubs?  Godfrey  could  not  be 
mistaken.  There  were  a  dozen  agouties,  five  or  six  sheep, 
and  as  many  goats,  who  were  quietly  browsing  on  the 
first  vegetation  on  the  very  edge  of  the  prairie. 

"Look  there,  Tartlet!"  he  exclaimed. 

And  the  professor  looked,  but  saw  nothing,  so  much  was 
he  absorbed  with  the  thought  of  this  unexpected  situation. 

A  thought  flashed  across  the  mind  of  Godfrey,  and  it 
was  correct:  it  was  that  these  hens,  agouties,  goats,  and 
sheep  had  belonged  to  the  Dream.  At  the  moment  she 
went  down,  the  fowls  had  easily  been  able  to  reach  the 
reef  and  then  the  beach.  As  for  the  quadrupeds,  they 
could  easily  have  swum  ashore. 

"And  so,"  remarked  Godfrey,  "what  none  of  our  un- 
fortunate companions  have  been  able  to  do,  these  simple 
animals,  guided  by  their  instinct,  have  done!  And  of  all 
those  on  board  the  Dream,  none  have  been  saved  but  a 
few  beasts!" 

"Including  ourselves !"  answered  Tartlet  naively. 

As  far  as  he  was  concerned,  he  had  come  ashore  uncon- 
sciously, very  much  like  one  of  the  animals.  It  mattered 
little.  It  was  a  very  fortunate  thing  for  the  two  ship- 
wrecked men  that  a  certain  number  of  these  animals  had 
reached  the  shore.  They  would  collect  them,  fold  them, 
and  with  the  special  fecundity  of  their  species,  if  their  stay 


THE  OTHER  REFUGEES  51 

on  this  land  was  a  lengthy  one,  it  would  be  easy  to  have 
quite  a  flock  of  quadrupeds,  and  a  yard  full  of  poultry. 

But  on  this  occasion,  Godfrey  wished  to  keep  to  such 
alimentary  resources  as  the  coast  could  furnish,  either  in 
eggs  or  shell-fish.  Professor  Tartlet  and  he  set  to  work 
to  forage  among  the  interstices  of  the  stones,  and  beneath 
the  carpet  of  sea-weeds,  and  not  without  success.  They 
soon  collected  quite  a  notable  quantity  of  mussels  and  peri- 
winkles, which  they  could  eat  raw.  A  few  dozen  eggs  of 
the  bernicle  geese  were  also  found  among  the  higher  rocks 
which  shut  in  the  bay  on  the  north.  They  had  enough  to 
satisfy  a  good  many;  and,  hunger  pressing,  Godfrey  and 
Tartlet  hardly  thought  of  making  difficulties  about  their 
first  repast 

"And  the  fire?"  said  the  professor. 

"Yes!    The  fire!"  said  Godfrey. 

It  was  the  most  serious  of  questions,  and  it  led  to  an 
inventory  being  made  of  the  contents  of  their  pockets. 
Those  of  the  professor  were  empty  or  nearly  so.  They 
contained  a  few  spare  strings  for  his  kit,  and  a  piece  of 
rosin  for  his  bow.  How  would  you  get  a  light  from  that, 
I  should  like  to  know?  Godfrey  was  hardly  better  pro- 
vided. However,  it  was  with  extreme  satisfaction  that  he 
discovered  in  his  pocket  an  excellent  knife,  whose  leather 
case  had  kept  it  from  the  sea-water.  This  knife,  with 
blade,  gimlet,  hook,  and  saw,  was  a  valuable  instrument 
under  the  circumstances.  But  besides  this  tool,  Godfrey 
and  his  companion  had  only  their  two  hands;  and  as  the 
hands  of  the  professor  had  never  been  used  except  in 
playing  his  fiddle,  and  making  his  gestures,  Godfrey  con- 
cluded that  he  would  have  to  trust  to  his  own. 

He  thought,  however,  of  utilizing  those  of  Tartlet  for 
procuring  a  fire  by  means  of  rubbing  two  sticks  of  wood 
rapidly  together.  A  few  eggs  cooked  in  the  embers  would 
be  greatly  appreciated  at  their  second  meal  at  noon. 

While  Godfrey  then  was  occupied  in  robbing  the  nests 
in  spite  of  the  proprietors,  who  tried  to  defend  their  prog- 
eny in  the  shell,  the  professor  went  off  to  collect  some 
pieces  of  wood  which  had  been  dried  by  the  sun  at  the 
foot  of  the  dunes.  These  were  taken  behind  a  rock  shel- 
tered from  the  wind  from  the  sea.  Tartlet  then  chose  two 
very  dry  pieces,  with  the  intention  of  gradually  obtaining 


52  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

sufficient  heat  by  rubbing  them  vigorously  and  continu- 
ously together.  What  simple  Polynesian  savages  com- 
monly did,  why  should  not  the  professor,  so  much  their 
superior  in  his  own  opinion,  be  able  to  do? 

Behold  him  then,  rubbing  and  rubbing,  in  a  way  to 
dislocate  the  muscles  of  his  arm  and  shoulder.  He 
worked  himself  into  quite  a  rage,  poor  man !  But  whether 
it  was  that  the  wood  was  not  right,  or  its  dryness  was  not 
sufficient,  or  the  professor  held  it  wrongly,  or  had  not  got 
the  peculiar  turn  of  hand  necessary  for  operations  of  this 
kind,  if  he  did  not  get  much  heat  out  of  the  wood,  he 
succeeded  in  getting  a  good  deal  out  of  himself.  In  short, 
it  was  his  own  forehead  alone  which  smoked  under  the 
vapors  of  his  own  perspiration. 

When  Godfrey  returned  with  his  collection  of  eggs,  he 
found  Tartlet  in  a  rage,  in  a  state  to  which  his  chore- 
graphic  exercises  had  never  provoked  him. 

"Doesn't  it  do?"  he  asked. 

"No,  Godfrey,  it  does  not  do,"  replied  the  professor. 
"And  I  begin  to  think  that  these  inventions  of  the  savages 
are  only  imaginations  to  deceive  the  world." 

"No,"  answered  Godfrey.  "But  in  that,  as  in  all  things, 
you  must  know  how  to  do  it." 

"These  eggs,  then?" 

"There  is  another  way.  If  you  attach  one  of  these  eggs 
to  the  end  of  a  string  and  whirl  it  round  rapidly,  and  sud- 
denly arrest  the  movement  of  rotation,  the  movement  may 
perhaps  transform  itself  into  heat,  and  then — " 

"And  then  the  egg  will  be  cooked?" 

"Yes,  if  the  rotation  has  been  swift  enough  and  the 
stoppage  sudden  enough.  But  how  do  you  produce  the 
stoppage  without  breaking  the  egg?  Now,  there  is  a 
simpler  way,  dear  Tartlet.  Behold!" 

And  carefully  taking  one  of  the  eggs  of  the  bernicle 
goose,  he  broke  the  shell  at  its  end,  and  adroitly  swallowed 
the  inside  without  any  further  formalities. 

Tartlet  could  not  make  up  his  mind  to  imitate  him, 
and  contented  himself  with  the  shell-fish. 

It  now  remained  to  look  for  a  grotto  or  some  shelter  in 
which  to  pass  the  night. 

"It   is  an   unheard-of  thing,"    observed   the  professor, 


THE  OTHER  REFUGEES  53 

"that  Crusoes  cannot  at  the  least  find  a  cavern,  which, 
later  on,  they  can  make  their  home!" 

"Let  us  look,"  said  Godfrey. 

It  was  unheard  of.  We  must  avow,  however,  that  on 
this  occasion  the  tradition  was  broken.  In  vain  did  they 
search  along  the  rocky  shore  on  the  southern  part  of  the 
bay.  Not  a  cavern,  not  a  grotto,  not  a  hole  was  there 
that  would  serve  as  a  shelter.  They  had  to  give  up  the 
idea.  Godfrey  resolved  to  reconnoiter  up  to  the  first  trees 
in  the  background  beyond  the  sandy  coast. 

Tartlet  and  he  then  remounted  the  first  line  of  sand-hills 
and  crossed  the  verdant  prairies  which  they  had  seen  a  few 
hours  before.  A  very  odd  circumstance,  and  a  very  fortu- 
nate one  at  the  time,  that  the  other  survivors  of  the  wreck 
voluntarily  followed  them.  Evidently,  cocks  and  hens,  and 
sheep,  goats  and  agouties,  driven  by  instinct,  had  resolved 
to  go  with  them.  Doubtless  they  felt  too  lonely  on  the 
beach,  which  did  not  yield  sufficient  food. 

Three-quarters  of  an  hour  later  Godfrey  and  Tartlet 
— they  had  scarcely  spoken  during  the  exploration — ar- 
rived at  the  outskirts  of  the  trees.  Not  a  trace  was  there 
of  habitation  or  inhabitant.  Complete  solitude.  It  might 
even  be  doubted  if  this  part  of  the  country  had  ever  been 
trodden  by  human  feet. 

In  this  place  were  a  few  handsome  trees,  in  isolated 
groups,  and  others  more  crowded  about  a  quarter  of  a  mile 
in  the  rear  formed  a  veritable  forest  of  different  species. 

Godfrey  looked  out  for  some  old  trunk,  hollowed  by 
age,  which  could  offer  a  shelter  among  its  branches,  but 
his  researches  were  in  vain,  although  he  continued  them 
till  night  was  falling. 

Hunger  made  itself  sharply  felt,  and  the  two  contented 
themselves  with  mussels,  of  which  they  had  thoughtfully 
brought  an  ample  supply  from  the  beach.  Then,  quite 
tired  out,  they  lay  down  at  the  foot  of  a  tree,  and  trusting 
to  Providence,  slept  through  the  night. 


54  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 


CHAPTER  IX 

GODFREY  EXPLORES 

THE  night  passed  without  incident.  The  two  men,  quite 
knocked  up  with  excitement  and  fatigue,  had  slept  as 
peacefully  as  if  they  had  been  in  the  most  comfortable 
room  in  the  mansion  in  Montgomery  Street. 

On  the  morrow,  the  27th  of  June,  at  the  first  rays  of 
the  rising  sun,  the  crow  of  the  cock  awakened  them. 

Godfrey  immediately  recognized  where  he  was,  but 
Tartlet  had  to  rub  his  eyes  and  stretch  his  arms  for  some 
time  before  he  did  so. 

"Is  breakfast  this  morning  to  resemble  dinner  yester- 
day?" was  his  first  observation. 

"I  am  afraid  so,"  answered  Godfrey.  "But  I  hope  we 
shall  dine  better  this  evening." 

The  professor  could  not  restrain  a  significant  grimace. 
Where  were  the  tea  and  sandwiches  which  had  hitherto 
been  brought  to  him  when  he  awoke?  How  could  he  wait 
till  breakfast-time,  the  bell  for  which  would  perhaps  never 
sound,  without  this  preparatory  repast? 

But  it  was  necessary  to  make  a  start.  Godfrey  felt  the 
responsibility  which  rested  on  him,  on  him  alone,  for  he 
could  in  no  way  depend  on  his  companion.  In  that  empty 
box  which  served  the  professor  for  a  cranium  there  could 
be  born  no  practical  idea;  Godfrey  would  have  to  think, 
contrive,  and  decide  for  both. 

His  first  thought  was  for  Phina,  his  betrothed,  whom  he 
had  so  stupidly  refused  to  make  his  wife;  his  second  for 
his  Uncle  Will,  whom  he  had  so  imprudently  left,  and 
then  turning  to  Tartlet,  "To  vary  our  ordinary,"  he  said, 
"here  are  some  shell-fish  and  half  a  dozen  eggs." 

"And  nothing  to  cook  them  with!" 

"Nothing!"  said  Godfrey.  "But  if  the  food  itself  was 
missing,  what  would  you  say  then,  Tartlet?" 

"I  should  say  that  nothing  was  not  enough,"  said  Tart- 
let dryly. 

Nevertheless,  they  had  to  be  content  with  this  repast. 

The  very  natural  idea  occurred  to  Godfrey  to  push  for- 
ward the  reconnaissance  commenced  the  previous  evening. 
Above  all  it  was  necessary  to  know  as  soon  as  possible  in 


GODFREY  EXPLORES  55 

what  part  of  the  Pacific  Ocean  the  Dream  had  been  lost,  so 
as  to  discover  some  inhabited  place  on  the  shore,  where 
they  could  either  arrange  the  way  of  returning  home  or 
await  the  passing  of  some  ship. 

Godfrey  observed  that  if  he  could  cross  the  second  line 
of  hills,  whose  picturesque  outline  was  visible  beyond  the 
first,  he  might  perhaps  be  able  to  do  this.  He  reckoned 
that  they  could  get  there  in  an  hour  or  two,  and  it  was  to 
this  urgent  exploration  that  he  resolved  to  devote  the  first 
hours  of  the  day.  He  looked  around  him.  The  cocks  and 
hens  were  beginning  to  peck  about  among  the  high  vege- 
tation. Agouties,  goats,  sheep,  went  and  came  on  the 
skirt  of  the  forest. 

Godfrey  did  not  care  to  drag  all  this  flock  of  poultry 
and  quadrupeds  about  with  him.  But  to  keep  them  more 
safely  in  this  place,  it  would  be  necessary  to  leave  Tartlet 
in  charge  of  them. 

Tartlet  agreed  to  remain  alone,  and  for  several  hours 
to  act  as  shepherd  of  the  flock.  He  made  but  one  observa- 
tion. "If  you  lose  yourself,  Godfrey?" 

"Have  no  fear  of  that,"  answered  the  young  man,  "I 
have  only  this  forest  to  cross,  and  as  you  will  not  leave 
its  edge  I  am  certain  to  find  you  again." 

"Don't  forget  the  telegram  to  your  Uncle  Will,  and  ask 
him  for  a  good  many  hundred  dollars." 

"The  telegram — or  the  letter!  It  is  all  one!"  answered 
Godfrey,  who  so  long  as  he  had  not  fixed  on  the  position 
of  this  land  was  content  to  leave  Tartlet  to  his  illusions. 

Then  having  shaken  hands  with  the  professor,  he 
plunged  beneath  the  trees,  whose  thick  branches  scarcely 
allowed  the  sun's  rays  to  penetrate.  It  was  their  direc- 
tion, however,  which  was  to  guide  our  young  explorer 
toward  the  high  hill  whose  curtain  hid  from  his  view  the 
whole  of  the  eastern  horizon. 

Footpath  there  was  none.  The  ground,  however,  was 
not  free  from  all  imprint.  Godfrey  in  certain  places  re- 
marked the  tracks  of  animals.  On  two  or  three  occasions 
he  even  believed  he  saw  some  rapid  ruminants  moving  off, 
either  elans,  deer,  or  wapiti,  but  he  recognized  no  trace  of 
ferocious  animals  such  as  tigers  or  jaguars,  whose  absence 
however,  was  no  cause  for  regret. 

The  first  floor  of  the  forest,  that  is  to  say  all  that  portion 


56  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

of  the  trees,  comprised  between  the  first  fork  and  the 
branches,  afforded  an  asylum  to  a  great  number  of  birds — 
wild  pigeons  by  the  hundred  beneath  the  trees,  ospreys, 
grouse,  aracaris  with  beaks  like  a  lobster's  claw,  and 
higher,  hovering  above  the  glades,  two  or  three  of  those 
lammergeiers  whose  eye  resembles  a  cockade.  But  none  of 
the  birds  were  of  such  special  kinds  that  he  could  there- 
from make  out  the  latitude  of  this  continent.  So  it  was 
with  the  trees  of  this  forest.  Almost  the  same  species  as 
those  in  that  part  of  the  United  States  which  comprises 
Lower  California,  and  New  Mexico. 

Generally,  there  was  enough  space  between  the  trees  to 
allow  him  to  pass  without  being  obliged  to  call  on  fire  or 
the  axe.  The  sea  breeze  circulated  freely  amid  the  higher 
branches,  and  here  and  there  great  patches  of  light  shone 
on  the  ground. 

And  so  Godfrey  went  along  striking  an  oblique  line 
beneath  these  large  trees.  To  take  any  precautions  never 
occurred  to  him.  The  desire  to  reach  the  heights  which 
bordered  the  forest  on  the  east  entirely  absorbed  him.  He 
sought  among  the  foliage  for  the  direction  of  the  solar  rays 
so  as  to  march  straight  on  his  goal.  He  did  not  even  see 
the  guide-birds,  so  named  because  they  fly  before  the  steps 
of  the  traveler,  stopping,  returning,  and  darting  on  ahead 
as  if  they  were  showing  the  way.  Nothing  could  distract 
him. 

His  state  of  mind  was  intelligible.  Before  an  hour  had 
elapsed  his  fate  would  be  settled!  Before  an  hour  he 
would  know  if  it  were  possible  to  reach  some  inhabited 
portion  of  the  continent. 

Already  Godfrey,  reasoning  on  what  had  been  the  route 
followed  and  the  way  made  by  the  Dream  during  a  navi- 
gation of  seventeen  days,  had  concluded  that  it  could  only 
be  on  the  Japanese  or  Chinese  coast  that  the  ship  had 
gone  down. 

Besides  the  position  of  the  sun,  always  in  the  south, 
rendered  it  quite  certain  that  the  Dream  had  not  crossed 
the  line. 

Two  hours  after  he  had  started  Godfrey  reckoned  the 
distance  he  had  traveled  at  about  five  miles,  considering 
several  circuits  which  he  had  had  to  make  owing  to  the 


GODFREY  EXPLORES  57 

density  of  the  forest.  The  second  group  of  hills  could  not 
be  far  away. 

Already  the  trees  were  getting  farther  from  each  other, 
forming  isolated  groups,  and  the  rays  of  light  pene- 
trated more  easily  through  the  lofty  branches.  The  ground 
began  slightly  to  slope,  and  then  abruptly  to  rise. 

Although  he  was  somewhat  fatigued,  Godfrey  had 
enough  will  not  to  slacken  his  pace.  He  would  doubtless 
have  run  had  it  not  been  for  the  steepness  of  the  earlier 
ascents. 

He  soon  got  high  enough  to  overlook  the  general 
mass  of  the  verdant  dome  which  stretched  away  behind 
him,  and  whence  several  heads  of  trees  here  and  there 
emerged. 

But  Godfrey  did  not  dream  of  looking  back.  His  eyes 
never  quitted  the  line  of  the  denuded  ridge,  which  showed 
itself  about  400  or  500  feet  before  and  above  him.  That 
was  the  barrier  which  all  the  time  hid  him  from  the  eastern 
horizon. 

A  tiny  cone,  obliquely  truncated,  overlooked  this  rugged 
line  and  joined  on  with  its  gentle  slope  to  the  sinuous  crest 
of  the  hills. 

"There!  there!"  said  Godfrey,  "that  is  the  point  I  must 
reach !  The  top  of  that  cone !  And  from  there  what  shall 
I  see? — A  town?— A  village? — A  desert?" 

Highly  excited,  Godfrey  mounted  the  hill,  keeping  his 
elbows  at  his  chest  to  restrain  the  beating  of  his  heart. 
His  panting  tired  him,  but  he  had  not  the  patience  to 
stop  so  as  to  recover  himself.  Were  he  to  have  fallen 
half  fainting  on  the  summit  of  the  cone  which  shot  up 
about  100  feet  above  his  head,  he  would  not  have  lost  a 
minute  in  hastening  toward  it. 

A  few  minutes  more  and  he  would  be  there.  The  ascent 
seemed  to  him  steep  enough  on  his  side,  an  angle  perhaps 
of  thirty  or  thirty-five  degrees.  He  helped  himself  up  with 
hands  and  feet;  he  seized  on  the  tufts  of  slender  herbs  on 
the  hill-side,  and  on  a  few  meager  shrubs,  mastics  and 
myrtles,  which  stretched  away  up  to  the  top. 

A  last  effort  was  made!  His  head  rose  above  the  plat- 
form of  the  cone,  and  then,  lying  on  his  stomach,  his  eyes 
gazed  at  the  eastern  horizon. 


58  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

It  was  the  sea  which  formed  it.  Twenty  miles  off  it 
united  with  the  line  of  the  sky! 

He  turned  around. 

Still  sea — west  of  him,  south  of  him,  north  of  him!  The 
immense  ocean  surrounding  him  on  all  sides! 

"An  island!" 

As  he  uttered  the  word  Godfrey  felt  his  heart  shrink. 
The  thought  had  not  occurred  to  him  that  he  was  on  an 
island.  And  yet  such  was  the  case!  The  terrestrial  chain 
which  should  have  attached  him  to  the  continent  was 
abruptly  broken.  He  felt  as  though  he  had  been  a  sleeping 
man  in  a  drifted  boat,  who  awoke  with  neither  oar  nor 
sail  to  help  him  back  to  shore. 

But  Godfrey  was  soon  himself  again.  His  part  was 
taken,  to  accept  the  situation.  If  the  chances  of  safety  did 
not  come  from  without,  it  was  for  him  to  contrive  them. 

He  set  to  work  at  first  then  as  exactly  as  possible  to 
ascertain  the  disposition  of  this  island  which  his  view 
embraced  over  its  whole  length.  He  estimated  that  it 
ought  to  measure  about  sixty  miles  around,  being,  as  far 
as  he  could  see,  about  twenty  miles  long  from  south  to 
north,  and  twelve  miles  wide  from  east  to  west. 

Its  central  part  was  screened  by  the  green  depths  of 
forest  which  extended  up  to  the  ridge  dominated  by  the 
cone,  whose  slope  died  away  on  the  shore. 

All  the  rest  was  prairie,  with  clumps  of  trees,  or  beach 
with  rocks,  whose  outer  ring  was  capriciously  tapered  off 
in  the  form  of  capes  and  promontories.  A  few  creeks  cut 
out  the  coast,  but  could  only  afford  refuge  for  two  or 
three  fishing  boats. 

The  bay  at  the  bottom  of  which  the  Dream  lay  ship- 
wrecked was  the  only  one  of  any  size,  and  that  extended 
over  some  seven  or  eight  miles.  An  open  roadstead,  no 
vessel  would  have  found  it  a  safe  shelter,  at  least  unless 
the  wind  was  blowing  from  the  east. 

But  what  was  this  island?  To  what  geographical  group 
did  it  belong?  Did  it  form  part  of  an  archipelago,  or  was 
it  alone  in  this  portion  of  the  Pacific? 

In  any  case,  no  other  island,  large  or  small,  high  or  low, 
appeared  within  the  range  of  vision. 

Godfrey  rose  and  gazed  around  the  horizon.  Nothing 
was  to  be  seen  along  the  circular  line  where  sea  and  sky 


GODFREY  EXPLORES  59 

ran  into  each  other.  If,  then,  there  existed  to  windward  or 
to  leeward  any  island  or  coast  of  a  continent,  it  could  only 
be  at  a  considerable  distance. 

Godfrey  called  up  all  his  geographical  reminiscences,  in 
order  to  discover  what  island  of  the  Pacific  this  could  be. 
In  reasoning  it  out  he  came  to  this  conclusion. 

The  Dream  for  seventeen  days  had  steered  very  nearly 
south-west.  Now  with  a  speed  of  from  150  to  180  miles 
every  four-and-twenty  hours,  she  ought  to  have  covered 
nearly  fifty  degrees.  Now  it  was  obvious  that  she  had 
not  crossed  the  equator.  The  situation  of  the  island,  or 
of  the  group  to  which  it  belonged,  would  therefore  have 
to  be  looked  for  in  that  part  of  the  ocean  comprised  be- 
tween the  i6oth  and  i7Oth  degrees  of  west  longitude. 

In  this  portion  of  the  Pacific  it  seemed  to  Godfrey  that 
the  map  showed  no  other  archipelago  than  that  of  the 
Sandwich  Islands,  but  outside  this  archipelago  were  there 
not  any  isolated  islands  whose  names  escaped  him  and 
which  were  dotted  here  and  there  over  the  sea  up  to  the 
coast  of  the  Celestial  Empire? 

It  was  not  of  much  consequence.  There  existed  no 
means  of  his  going  in  search  of  another  spot  on  the  ocean 
which  might  prove  more  hospitable. 

"Well,"  said  Godfrey  to  himself,  "if  I  don't  know  the 
name  of  this  island,  I'll  call  it  Phina  Island,  in  memory  of 
her  I  ought  never  to  have  left  to  run  about  the  world,  and 
perhaps  the  name  will  bring  us  some  luck." 

Godfrey  then  occupied  himself  in  trying  to  ascertain  if 
the  island  was  inhabited  in  the  part  which  he  had  not  yet 
been  able  to  visit. 

From  the  top  of  the  cone  he  saw  nothing  which  betrayed 
the  presence  of  aborigines,  neither  habitations  on  the 
prairie  nor  houses  on  the  skirt  of  the  trees,  not  even  a 
fisherman's  hut  on  the  shore. 

But  if  the  island  was  deserted,  the  sea  which  surrounded 
it  was  none  the  less  so,  for  not  a  ship  showed  itself  within 
the  limits  of  what,  from  the  height  of  the  cone,  was  a  con- 
siderable circuit. 

Godfrey  having  finished  his  exploration  had  now  only 
to  get  down  to  the  foot  of  the  hill  and  retake  the  road 
through  the  forest  so  as  to  rejoin  Tartlet.  But  before  he 
did  so  his  eyes  were  attracted  by  a  sort  of  cluster  of  trees 


60  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

of  huge  stature,  which  rose  on  the  boundary  of  the  prairie 
toward  the  north.  It  was  a  gigantic  group,  it  exceeded  by 
a  head  all  those  which  Godfrey  had  previously  seen. 

"Perhaps,"  he  said,  "it  would  be  better  to  take  up  our 
quarters  over  there,  more  especially  as,  if  I  am  not  mis- 
taken, I  can  see  a  stream  which  should  rise  in  the  central 
chain  and  flow  across  the  prairie." 

This  was  to  be  looked  into  on  the  morrow. 

Toward  the  south  the  aspect  of  the  island  was  slightly 
different.  Forests  and  prairies  rapidly  gave  place  to  the 
yellow  carpet  of  the  beach,  and  in  places  the  shore  was 
bounded  with  picturesque  rocks. 

But  what  was  Godfrey's  surprise,  when  he  thought  he 
saw  a  light  smoke,  which  rose  in  the  air  beyond  this  rocky 
barrier. 

"Are  these  any  of  our  companions?"  he  exclaimed. 
"But  no,  it  is  not  possible!  Why  should  they  have  got  so 
far  from  the  bay  since  yesterday,  and  around  so  many 
miles  of  reef?  Is  it  a  village  of  fishermen,  or  the  encamp- 
ment of  some  indigenous  tribe?" 

Godfrey  watched  it  with  the  closest  attention.  Was 
this  gentle  vapor  which  the  breeze  softly  blew  toward 
the  west  a  smoke?  Could  he  be  mistaken?  Anyhow  it 
quickly  vanished,  a  few  minutes  afterward  nothing  could 
be  seen  of  it.  It  was  a  false  hope. 

Godfrey  took  a  last  look  in  its  direction,  and  then  seeing 
nothing,  glided  down  the  slope,  and  again  plunged  beneath 
the  trees.  An  hour  later  he  had  traversed  the  forest  and 
found  himself  on  its  skirt. 

There  Tartlet  awaited  him  with  his  two-footed  and 
four-footed  flock.  And  how  was  the  obstinate  professor 
occupying  himself?  In  the  same  way.  A  bit  of  wood 
was  in  his  right  hand,  another  piece  in  his  left,  and  he  still 
continued  his  efforts  to  set  them  alight.  He  rubbed  and 
rubbed  with  a  constancy  worthy  of  a  better  fate. 

"Well,"  he  shouted  as  he  perceived  Godfrey  some  dis- 
tance off — "and  the  telegraphic  office  ?" 

"It  is  not  open!"  answered  Godfrey,  who  dared  not 
yet  tell  him  anything  of  the  situation. 

"And  the  post?" 

"It  is  shut !  But  let  us  have  something  to  eat !— t  am 
dying  with  hunger!  We  can  talk  presently." 


A  READY  MADE  HOUSE  61 

'And  this  morning  Godfrey  and  his  companion  had  again 
to  content  themselves  with  a  too  meager  repast  of  raw 
eggs  and  shell-fish. 

"Wholesome  diet!"  repeated  Godfrey  to  Tartlet,  who 
was  hardly  of  that  opinion,  and  picked  his  food  with  con- 
siderable care. 


CHAPTER  X 

A   READY    MADE   HOUSE 

THE  day  was  already  far  advanced.  Godfrey  resolved  to 
defer  till  the  morrow  the  task  of  proceeding  to  a  new 
abode.  But  to  the  pressing  questions  which  the  professor 
propounded  on  the  results  of  his  exploration  he  ended  by 
replying  that  it  was  an  island,  Phina  Island,  on  which  they 
both  had  been  cast,  and  that  they  must  think  of  the  means 
of  living  before  dreaming  of  the  means  of  departing. 

"An  island!"  exclaimed  Tartlet. 

"Yes!    It  is  an  island!" 

"Which  the  sea  surrounds?" 

"Naturally." 

"But  what  is  it?" 

"I  have  told  you,  Phina  Island,  and  you  understand  why 
I  gave  it  that  name." 

"No,  I  do  not  understand!"  answered  Tartlet  making  a 
grimace;  "and  I  don't  see  the  resemblance!  Miss  Phina 
is  surrounded  by  land,  not  water!" 

After  this  melancholy  reflection,  he  prepared  to  pass  the 
night  with  as  little  discomfort  as  possible.  Godfrey  went 
off  to  the  reef  to  get  a  new  stock  of  eggs  and  mollusks, 
with  which  he  had  to  be  contented,  and  then,  tired  out,  he 
came  back  to  the  tree  and  soon  fell  asleep,  while  Tartlet, 
whose  philosophy  would  not  allow  him  to  accept  such  a 
state  of  affairs,  gave  himself  over  to  the  bitterest  medi- 
tations. On  the  morrow,  the  28th  of  June,  they  were  both 
afoot  before  the  cock  had  interrupted  their  slumbers. 

To  begin  with,  a  hasty  breakfast,  the  same  as  the  day 
before.  Only  water  from  a  little  brook  was  advantageously 
replaced  by  a  little  milk  given  by  one  of  the  goats. 

Ah!  worthy  Tartlet!  Where  were  the  "mint  julep,"  the 
"port  wine  sangaree,"  the  "sherry  cobbler,"  the  "sherry 


62  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

cocktail,"  which  were  served  him  at  all  hours  in  the  bars 
and  taverns  of  San  Francisco?  How  he  envied  the  poultry, 
the  agotities,  and  the  sheep,  who  cheerfully  quenched  their 
thirst  without  the  addition  of  such  saccharine  or  alcoholic 
mixtures  to  their  water  from  the  stream !  To  these  animals 
no  fire  was  necessary  to  cook  their  food;  roots  and  herbs 
and  seeds  sufficed,  and  their  breakfast  was  always  served 
to  the  minute  on  their  tablecloth  of  green. 

"Let  us  make  a  start,"  said  Godfrey. 

And  behold  the  two  on  their  way,  followed  by  a  pro- 
cession of  domestic  animals,  who  refused  to  be  left  behind. 
Godfrey's  idea  was  to  explore,  in  the  north  of  the  island, 
that  portion  of  the  coast  on  which  he  had  noticed  the 
group  of  gigantic  trees  in  his  view  from  the  cone.  But  to 
get  there  he  resolved  to  keep  along  the  shore.  The  surf 
might  perhaps  have  cast  up  some  fragment  of  the  wreck. 
Perhaps  they  might  find  on  the  beach  some  of  their  com- 
panions in  the  Dream  to  which  they  could  give  Christian 
burial.  As  for  finding  any  one  of  them  living,  it  was 
hardly  to  be  hoped  for,  after  a  lapse  of  six-and-thirty 
hours. 

The  first  line  of  hills  was  surmounted,  and  Godfrey  and 
his  companion  reached  the  beginning  of  the  reef,  which 
looked  as  deserted  as  it  had  when  they  had  left  it.  There 
they  renewed  their  stock  of  eggs  and  mollusks,  in  case  they 
should  fail  to  find  even  such  meager  resources  away  to  the 
north.  Then,  following  the  fringe  of  sea-weed  left  by  the 
last  tide,  they  again  ascended  the  dunes,  and  took  a  good 
look  around. 

Nothing!  always  nothing! 

We  must  certainly  say  that  if  misfortune  had  made 
Crusoes  of  these  survivors  of  the  Dream,  it  had  shown 
itself  much  more  rigorous  toward  them  than  toward 
their  predecessors,  who  always  had  some  portion  of  the 
vessel  left  to  them,  and  who,  after  bringing  away  numerous 
objects  of  necessity,  had  been  able  to  utilize  the  timbers  of 
the  wreck.  Victuals  for  a  considerable  period,  clothes, 
tools,  weapons,  had  always  been  left  them  with  which  to 
satisfy  the  elementary  exigencies  of  existence.  But  here 
there  was  nothing  of  all  this!  In  the  middle  of  that  dark 
night  the  ship  had  disappeared  in  the  depths  of  the  sea, 
without  leaving  on  the  reefs  the  slightest  traces  of  its 


A  READY  MADE  HOUSE  63 

wreck!  It  had  not  been  possible  to  save  a  thing  from 
her — not  even  a  lucifer  match — and  to  tell  the  truth,  the 
want  of  that  match  was  the  most  serious  of  all  wants. 

I  know  well,  good  people  comfortably  installed  in  your 
easy-chairs  before  a  comfortable  hearth  at  which  is  blazing 
brightly  a  fire  of  wood  or  coals,  that  you  will  be  apt  to 
say,  "But  nothing  was  more  easy  than  for  them  to  get  a 
fire!  There  are  a  thousand  ways  of  doing  that!  Two 
pebbles !  A  little  dry  moss !  A  little  burned  rag,"  but  how 
do  you  burn  the  rag?  "The  blade  of  a  knife  would  do  for 
a  steel,  or  two  bits  of  wood  rubbed  briskly  together  in 
Polynesian  fashion!"  Well,  try  it! 

lit  was  about  this  that  Godfrey  was  thinking  as  he 
walked,  and  this  it  was  that  occupied  his  thoughts  more 
than  anything  else.  Perhaps  he,  too,  poking  his  coke  fire 
and  reading  his  travelers'  tales,  had  thought  the  same  as 
you  good  people!  But  now  he  had  to  put  matters  to  the 
test,  and  he  saw  with  considerable  disquietude  the  want  of 
a  fire,  that  indispensable  element  which  nothing  could  re- 
place. 

He  kept  on  ahead,  then,  lost  in  thought,  followed  by 
Tartlet,  who  by  his  shouts  and  gestures,  kept  together 
the  flock  of  sheep,  agouties,  goats,  and  poultry. 

Suddenly  his  look  was  attracted  by  the  bright  colors  of 
a  cluster  of  small  apples  which  hung  from  the  branches  of 
certain .  shrubs,  growing  in  hundreds  at  the  foot  of  the 
dunes.  He  immediately  recognized  them  as  "manzanillas," 
which  serve  as  food  to  the  Indians  in  certain  parts  of 
California.  "At  last,"  he  exclaimed,  "there  is  something 
which  will  be  a  change  from  our  eggs  and  mussels." 

"What?  Do  you  eat  those  things?"  said  Tartlet  with 
his  customary  grimace. 

"You  shall  soon  see!"  answered  Godfrey.  And  he  set 
to  work  to  gather  the  manzanillas,  and  eat  them  greedily. 

They  were  only  wild  apples,  but  even  their  acidity  did 
not  prevent  them  from  being  agreeable.  The  professor 
made  little  delay  in  imitating  his  companion,  and  did  not 
show  himself  particularly  discontented  at  the  work.  God- 
frey thought,  and  with  reason,  that  from  these  fruits  there 
could  be  made  a  fermented  liquor  which  would  be  prefer- 
able to  the  water. 

The  march  was  resumed.     Soon  the  end  of  the  sand 


64  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

dunes  died  away  in  a  prairie  traversed  by  a  small  stream. 
This  was  the  one  Godfrey  had  seen  from  the  top  of  the 
cone.  The  large  trees  appeared  further  on,  and  after  a 
journey  of  about  nine  miles  the  two  explorers,  tired  enough 
by  their  four  hours'  walk,  reached  them  a  few  minutes 
after  noon.  The  site  was  well  worth  the  trouble  of  look- 
ing at,  of  visiting,  and,  doubtless,  occupying. 

On  the  edge  of  a  vast  prairie,  dotted  with  manzanilla 
bushes  and  other  shrubs,  there  rose  a  score  of  gigantic 
trees  which  could  have  even  borne  comparison  with  the 
same  species  of  the  forests  of  California.  They  were  ar- 
ranged in  a  semi-circle.  The  carpet  of  verdure,  which 
stretched  at  their  feet,  after  bordering  the  stream  for  some 
hundreds  of  feet,  gave  place  to  a  long  beach,  covered  with 
rocks,  and  shingle,  and  sea-weed,  which  ran  out  into  the 
water  in  a  narrowing  point  to  the  north. 

These  "big  trees,"  as  they  are  commonly  called  in  West- 
ern America,  belong  to  the  genus  Sequoia,  and  are  conifers 
of  the  fir  family.  If  you1  ask  the  English  for  their  dis- 
tinguishing name,  you  will  be  told  "Wellingtonias,"  if  you 
ask  the  Americans,  they  will  reply,  "Washingtonias."  But 
whether  they  recall  the  memory  of  the  phlegmatic  victor 
of  Waterloo,  or  of  the  illustrious  founder  of  the  American 
Republic,  they  are  the  hugest  products  known  of  the 
Californian  and  Nevadan  floras.  In  certain  districts  in 
these  states  there  are  entire  forests  of  these  trees,  such 
as  the  groups  at  Mariposa  and  Calaveras,  some  of  the 
trees  of  which  measure  from  60  to  80  feet  in  circum- 
ference, and  some  300  feet  in  height.  One  of  them, 
at  the  entrance  of  the  Yosemite  Valley,  is  quite  100  feet 
around.  When  living — for  it  is  now  prostrate — its  first 
branches  could  have  overtopped  Strasburg  Cathedral,  or,  in 
other  words,  were  80  feet  from  the  ground. 

Besides  this  tree  there  are  "The  Mother  of  the  Forest," 
"The  Beauty  of  the  Forest,"  "The  Hut  of  the  Pioneer," 
"The  Two  Sentinels,"  "General  Grant,"  "Miss  Emma," 
"Miss  Mary,"  "Brigham  Young  and  His  Wife,"  "The 
Three  Graces,"  "The  Bear,"  etc.,  etc. ;  all  of  them  veritable 
vegetable  phenomena.  One  of  the  trees  has  been  sawed 
across  at  its  base,  and  on  it  there  has  been  built  a  ball- 
room, in  which  a  quadrille  of  eight  or  ten  couples  can  be 
danced  with  ease. 


A  READY  MADE  HOUSE  65 

But  the  giant  of  giants,  in  a  forest  which  is  the  property 
of  the  state,  about  fifteen  miles  from  Murphy,  is  "The 
Father  of  the  Forest,"  an  old  sequoia,  4000  years  old, 
which  rises  452  feet  from  the  ground,  higher  than  the 
cross  of  St.  Peter's,  at  Rome,  higher  than  the  great  pyramid 
of  Ghizeh,  higher  than  the  iron  bell-turret  which  now 
caps  one  of  the  towers  of  Rouen  Cathedral. 

It  was  a  group  of  some  twenty  of  these  colossi  that 
nature  had  planted  on  this  point  of  the  island,  at  the  epoch, 
probably,  when  Solomon  was  building  that  temple  at  Jeru- 
salem which  has  never  risen  from  its  ruins.  The  largest 
was,  perhaps,  300  feet  high,  the  smallest  nearly  200. 

Some  of  them,  hollowed  out  by  age,  had  enormous 
arches  through  their  bases,  beneath  which  a  troop  of  horse- 
men could  have  ridden  with  ease. 

Godfrey  was  struck  with  admiration  in  the  presence  of 
these  natural  phenomena,  as  they  are  not  generally  found 
at  altitudes  of  less  than  from  5000  to  6000  feet  above  the 
level  of  the  sea.  He  even  thought  that  the  view  alone 
was  worth  the  journey.  Nothing  he  had  seen  was  compara- 
ble to  these  columns  of  clear  brown,  which  outlined  them- 
selves almost  without  sensible  diminution  of  their  diameters 
to  their  lowest  fork.  The  cylindrical  trunks  rising  from 
80  to  100  feet  above  the  earth,  ramified  into  such  thick 
branches  that  they  themselves  looked  like  tree-stems  of 
huge  dimensions  bearing  quite  a  forest  in  the  air. 

One  of  these  specimens  of  Sequoia  gigantea — one  of  the 
biggest  in  the  group — more  particularly  attracted  Godfrey's 
attention. 

Gazing  at  its  base  it  displayed  an  opening  of  from  four 
to  five  feet  in  width,  and  ten  feet  high,  which  gave  en- 
trance to  its  interior.  The  giant's  heart  had  disappeared, 
the  alburnum  had  been  dissipated  into  soft  whitish  dust ;  but 
if  the  tree  did  not  depend  so  much  on  its  powerful  roots  as 
on  its  solid  bark,  it  could  still  keep  its  position  for  cen- 
turies. 

"In  default  of  a  cavern  or  a  grotto,"  said  Godfrey,  "here 
is  a  ready-made  dwelling.  A  wooden  house,  a  tower,  such 
as  there  is  in  no  inhabited  land.  Here  we  can  be  sheltered 
and  shut  in.  Come  along,  Tartlet!  come!" 

And  the  young  man,  catching  hold  of  his  companion, 
dragged  him  inside  the  sequoia. 

Vol.  18  Verno 


66  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

The  base  was  covered  with  a  bed  of  vegetable  dust,  and 
in  diameter  could  not  be  less  than  twenty  feet. 

As  for  the  height  to  which  its  vault  extended,  the  gloom 
prevented  even  an  estimate.  For  not  a  ray  of  light  found 
its  way  through  the  bark  wall.  Neither  cleft  nor  fault 
was  there  through  which  the  wind  or  rain  could  come.  Our 
two  Crusoes  would  therein  find  themselves  in  a  position  to 
brave  with  impunity  the  inclemency  of  the  weather.  No 
cave  could  be  firmer,  or  drier,  or  more  compact.  In  truth  it 
would  have  been  difficult  to  have  anywhere  found  a  better. 

"Eh,  T,artlet,  what  do  you  think  of  our  natural  house?" 
asked  Godfrey. 

"Yes,  but  the  chimney?"  answered  Tartlet. 

"Before  we  talk  about  the  chimney,"  replied  Godfrey, 
"let  us  wait  till  we  have  the  fire!" 
.     This  was  only  logical. 

Godfrey  went  to  reconnoiter  the  neighborhood.  As  we 
have  said,  the  prairie  extended  to  this  enormous  mass  of 
sequoias  which  formed  its  edge.  The  small  stream  me- 
andering through  the  grassy  carpet  gave  a  healthy  fresh- 
ness to  its  borders,  and  thereon  grew  shrubs  of  different 
kinds.  Farther  off,  on  ground  that  grew  gradually  higher, 
were  scattered  several  clumps  of  trees,  but  of  great  stature 
as  they  were,  they  seemed  but  simple  underwood  by  the 
side  of  the  "mammoths,"  whose  huge  shadows  the  sun 
was  throwing  even  into  the  sea.  Across  the  prairie  lay 
minor  lines  of  bushes,  and  vegetable  clumps  and  verdant 
thickets,  which  Godfrey  resolved  to  investigate  on  the 
following  day. 

If  the  site  pleased  him,  it  did  not  displease  the  domestic 
animals.  Agouties,  goats,  and  sheep  had  soon  taken  pos- 
session of  this  domain,  which  offered  them  roots  to  nibble 
at,  and  grass  to  browse  on  far  beyond  their  needs.  As  for 
the  fowls  they  were  greedily  pecking  away  at  the  seeds  and 
worms  in  the  banks  of  the  rivulet.  Animal  life  was  already 
manifesting  itself  in  such  goings  and  comings,  such  flights 
and  gambols,  such  bleatings  and  gruntings  and  duckings 
as  had  doubtless  never  been  heard  of  in  these  parts  before. 

Then  Godfrey  returned  to  the  clump  of  sequoias,  and 
made  a  more  attentive  examination  of  the  tree  in  which 
he  had  chosen  to  take  up  his  abode.  It  appeared  to  him 
that  it  would  be  difficult,  if  not  impossible,  to  climb  into 


A  THUNDER-BOLT  67 

the  first  branches,  at  least  by  the  exterior;  for  the  trunk 
presented  no  protuberances.  Inside  it  the  ascent  might 
be  easier,  if  the  tree  were  hollow  up  to  the  fork. 

In  case  of  danger  it  would  be  advisable  to  seek  refuge 
among  the  thick  boughs  borne  by  the  enormous  trunk. 
But  this  matter  could  be  looked  into  later  on. 

When  he  had  finished  his  inquiries  the  sun  was  low  on 
the  horizon,  and  it  seemed  best  to  put  off  till  tomorrow  the 
preparations  for  definitely  taking  up  their  abode. 

But,  after  a  meal  with  dessert  composed  of  wild  apples, 
what  could  they  do  better  than  pass  the  night  on  a  bed  of 
the  vegetable  dust  which  covered  the  ground  inside  the 
sequoia  ? 

And  this,  under  the  keeping  of  Providence,  was  what 
was  done  but  not  until  after  Godfrey  in  remembrance  of 
his  uncle  William  W.  Kolderup,  had  given  to  the  giant 
the  name  of  "Will  Tree,"  just  as  its  prototypes  in  the 
forests  of  California  and  the  neighboring  states  bear  the 
names  of  the  great  citizens  of  the  American  Republic. 


CHAPTER  XI 

A  THUNDER-BOLT 

IT  must  be  acknowledged  that  Godfrey  was  in  a  fair  way 
to  become  a  new  man  in  this  completely  novel  position 
to  one  so  frivolous,  so  light-minded,  and  so  thoughtless. 
He  had  hitherto  only  had  to  allow  himself  to  live.  Never 
had  care  for  the  morrow  disquieted  his  rest.  In  the  opu- 
lent mansion  in  Montgomery  Street,  where  he  slept  his 
ten  hours  without  a  break,  not  the  fall  of  a  rose  leaf  had 
ever  troubled  his  slumbers. 

It  was  so  no  longer.  On  this  unknown  land  he  found 
himself  thoroughly  shut  off  from  the  rest  of  the  world,  left 
entirely  to  his  own  resources,  obliged  to  face  the  neces- 
sities of  life  under  conditions  in  which  a  man  even  much 
more  practical  might  have  been  in  great  difficulty.  Doubt- 
less when  it  was  found  that  the  Dream  did  not  return,  a 
search  for  him  would  be  made.  But  what  were  these  two? 
Less  than  a  needle  in  a  hayrick,  or  a  sand-grain  on  the  sea- 
bottom!  The  incalculable  fortune  of  Uncle  Kolderup  could 
not  do  everything. 


68  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

When  Godfrey  had  found  his  fairly  acceptable  shelter, 
his  sleep  in  it  was  by  no  means  undisturbed.  His  brain 
traveled  as  it  had  never  done  before.  Ideas  of  all  kinds 
were  associated  together:  those  of  the  past  which  he  bit- 
terly regretted,  those  of  the  present  of  which  he  sought 
the  realization,  those  of  the  future  which  disquieted  him 
more  than  all ! 

But  in  these  rough  trials,  the  reason  and,  in  consequence, 
the  reasoning  which  naturally  flows  from  it,  were  little  by 
little  freed  from  the  limbo  in  which  they  had  hitherto  slept. 
Godfrey  was  resolved  to  strive  against  his  ill-luck,  and  to 
do  all  he  could  to  get  out  of  his  difficulties.  If  he  escaped, 
the  lesson  would  certainly  not  be  lost  on  him  for  the  future. 

At  daybreak  he  was  astir,  with  the  intention  of  proceed- 
ing to  a  more  complete  installation.  The  question  of  food, 
above  all  that  of  fire,  which  was  connected  with  it,  occupied 
the  first  place;  then  there  were  tools  or  arms  to  make, 
clothes  to  procure,  unless  they  were  anxious  of  soon  ap- 
pearing attired  in  Polynesian  costume. 

Tartlet  still  slumbered.  You  could  not  see  him  in  the 
shadow,  but  you  could  hear  him.  That  poor  man,  spared 
from  the  wreck,  remained  as  frivolous  at  forty-five  as  his 
pupil  had  formerly  been.  He  was  a  gain  in  no  sense.  He 
even  might  be  considered  an  incubus,  for  he  had  to  be 
cared  for  in  all  ways.  But  he  was  a  companion! 

He  was  worth  more  in  that  than  the  most  intelligent 
dog,  although  he  was  probably  of  less  use!  He  was  a 
creature  able  to  talk — although  only  at  random;  to  con- 
verse— if  the  matter  were  never  serious;  to  complain — and 
this  he  did  most  frequently!  As  it  was,  Godfrey  was 
able  to  hear  a  human  voice.  That  was  worth  more  than 
the  parrot's  in  Robinson  Crusoe!  Even  with  a  Tartlet 
he  would  not  be  alone,  and  nothing  was  so  disheartening 
as  the  thought  of  absolute  solitude. 

"Crusoe  before  Friday,  Crusoe  after  Friday;  what  a 
difference!"  thought  he. 

However,  on  this  morning,  that  of  June  29th,  Godfrey 
was  not  sorry  to  be  alone,  so  as  to  put  into  execution  his 
project  of  exploring  the  group  of  sequoias.  Perhaps  he 
would  be  fortunate  enough  to  discover  some  fruit,  some 
edible  root,  which  he  could  bring  back — to  the  extreme 


A  THUNDER-BOLT  69 

satisfaction  of  the  professor.  And  so  he  left  Tartlet  to 
his  dreams,  and  set  out. 

A  light  fog  still  shrouded  the  shore  and  the  sea,  but 
already  it  had  commenced  to  lift  in  the  north  and  east 
under  the  influence  of  the  solar  rays,  which  little  by  little 
were  condensing  it.  The  day  promised  to  be  fine.  Godfrey, 
after  having  cut  himself  a  substantial  walking  stick,  went 
for  two  miles  along  that  part  of  the  beach  which  he  did 
not  know,  and  which  formed  the  outstretched  point  of 
Phina  Island. 

There  he  made  a  first  meal  of  shell-fish,  mussels,  clams, 
and  especially  some  capital  little  oysters  which  he  found  in 
great  abundance. 

"If  it  comes  to  the  worst,"  he  said  to  himself,  "we  need 
never  die  of  hunger!  Here  are  thousands  of  dozens  of 
oysters  to  satisfy  the  calls  cf  the  most  imperious  stomach! 
If  Tartlet  complains,  it  is  because  he  does  not  like  mol- 
lusks!  Well,  he  will  have  to  like  them!" 

Decidedly,  if  the  oyster  did  not  absolutely  replace  bread 
and  meat,  it  furnished  an  aliment  in  no  whit  less  nutritive 
and  in  a  condition  capable  of  being  absorbed  in  large 
quantities.  But  though  this  mollusk  is  of  very  easy  diges- 
tion, it  is  somewhat  dangerous  in  its  use,  to  say  nothing  of 
its  abuse. 

This  breakfast  ended,  Godfrey  again  seized  his  stick,  and 
struck  off  obliquely  toward  the  south-east,  so  as  to  walk 
up  the  right  bank  of  the  stream.  In  this  direction,  he 
would  cross  the  prairie  up  to  the  groups  of  trees  observed 
the  night  before  beyond  the  long  lines  of  shrubs  and 
underwood,  which  he  wished  to  examine  carefully. 

Fortunately  when  Godfrey  reached  the  first  line  of  shrubs 
he  recognized  two  sorts  of  fruits  or  roots.  One  sort  had 
to  pass  through  the  fiery  trial  before  being  eaten,  the  other 
was  edible  in  its  natural  state.  The  first  was  a  shrub  of 
the  kind  called  "camas,"  which  thrives  even  in  lands  unfit 
for  culture.  The  other  bush  produces  a  species  of  bulb  of 
oblong  form,  bearing  the  indigenous  name  of  "yam,"  and 
if  it  possesses  less  nutritive  principles  than  the  camas,  it 
is  much  better  for  one  thing — it  can  be  eaten  raw. 

Godfrey,  highly  pleased  at  his  discovery,  at  once  satis- 
fied his  hunger  on  a  few  of  these  excellent  roots,  and  not 
forgetting  Tartlet's  breakfast,  collected  a  large  bundle,  and 


70  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

throwing  it  over  his  shoulder,  retook  the  road  to  Will  Tree. 
That  he  was  well  received  on  his  arrival  with  the  crop  of 
yams  need  not  be  insisted  on.  The  professor  greedily  re- 
galed himself,  and  his  pupil  had  to  caution  him  to  be  mod- 
erate. 

"Ah !"  he  said.  "We  have  got  some  roots  today.  Who 
knows  whether  we  shall  have  any  tomorrow?" 

"Without  any  doubt,"  replied  Godfrey,  "tomorrow  and 
the  day  after,  and  always.  There  is  only  the  trouble  of 
going  and  fetching  them." 

"Well,  Godfrey,  and  the  camas?" 

"Of  the  camas  we  will  make  flour  and  bread  when  we 
have  got  a  fire." 

"Fire !"  exclaimed  the  professor,  shaking  his  head.  "Fire ! 
And  how  shall  we  make  it?" 

"I  don't  know  yet,  but  somehow  or  other  we  will  get 
at  it." 

"May  Heaven  hear  you,  my  dear  Godfrey!  And  when 
I  think  that  there  are  so  many  fellows  in  this  world  who 
have  only  got  to  rub  a  bit  of  wood  on  the  sole  of  their  boot 
to  get  it,  it  annoys  me!  No!  Never  would  I  have  be- 
lieved that  ill-luck  would  have  reduced  me  to  this  state! 
You  need  not  take  three  steps  down  Montgomery  Street, 
before  you  will  meet  with  a  gentleman,  cigar  in  mouth, 
who  thinks  it  a  pleasure  to  give  you  a  light,  and  here — " 

"Here  we  are  not  in  San  Francisco,  Tartlet,  nor  in 
Montgomery  Street,  and  I  think  it  would  be  wiser  for  us 
not  to  reckon  on  the  kindness  of  those  we  meet!" 

"But,  why  is  cooking  necessary  for  bread  and  meat? 
Why  did  not  nature  make  us  so  that  we  might  live  upon 
nothing?" 

"That  will  come,  perhaps!"  answered  Godfrey  with  a 
good-humored  smile. 

"Do  you  think  so?" 

"I  think  that  our  scientists  are  probably  working  out  the 
subject." 

"Is  it  possible !  And  how  do  they  start  on  their  research 
as  to  this  new  mode  of  alimentation?" 

"On  this  line  of  reasoning,"  answered  Godfrey,  "as  the 
functions  of  digestion  and  respiration  are  connected,  the 
endeavor  is  to  substitute  one  for  the  other.  Hence  the 
day  when  chemistry  has  made  the  aliments  necessary  for 


A  THUNDER-BOLT  711 

the  food  of  man  capable  of  assimilation  by  respiration,  the 
problem  will  be  solved.  There  is  nothing  wanted  beyond 
rendering  the  air  nutritious.  You  will  breathe  your  dinner 
instead  of  eating  it,  that  is  all!" 

"Ah !  Is  it  not  a  pity  that  this  precious  discovery  is  not 
yet  made!"  exclaimed  the  professor.  "How  cheerfully 
would  I  breathe  half  a  dozen  sandwiches  and  a  silverside 
of  beef,  just  to  give  me  an  appetite!" 

And  Tartlet  plunged  into  a  semi-sensuous  reverie,  in 
which  he  beheld  succulent  atmospheric  dinners,  and  at  them 
unconsciously  opened  his  mouth  and  breathed  his  lungs  full, 
oblivious  that  he  had  scarcely  the  wherewithal  to  feed 
upon  in  the  ordinary  way. 

Godfrey  aroused  him  from  his  meditation,  and  brought 
him  back  to  the  present.  He  was  anxious  to  proceed  to  a 
more  complete  installation  in  the  interior  of  Will  Tree. 

The  first  thing  to  do  was  to  clean  up  their  future  dwell- 
ing-place. It  was  at  the  outset  necessary  to  bring  out  sev- 
eral bushels  of  that  vegetable  dust  which  covered  the 
ground  and  in  which  they  sank  almost  up  to  their  knees. 
Two  hours'  work  hardly  sufficed  to  complete  this  trouble- 
some task,  but  at  length  the  chamber  was  clear  of  the 
pulverulent  bed,  which  rose  in  clouds  at  the  slightest  move- 
ment. 

The  ground  was  hard  and  firm,  as  if  floored  with  joists, 
the  large  roots  of  the  sequoia  ramifying  over  its  surface. 
It  was  uneven  but  solid.  Two  corners  were  selected  for 
the  beds,  and  of  these  several  bundles  of  herbage,  thor- 
oughly dried  in  the  sun,  were  to  form  the  materials.  As 
for  other  furniture,  benches,  stools,  or  tables,  it  was  not 
impossible  to  make  the  most  indispensable  things,  for 
Godfrey  had  a  capital  knife,  with  its  saw  and  gimlet.  The 
companions  would  have  to  keep  inside  during  rough 
weather,  and  they  could  eat  and  work  there.  Daylight 
did  not  fail  them,  for  it  streamed  through  the  opening. 
Later  on,  if  it  became  necessary  to  close  this  aperture  for 
greater  safety,  Godfrey  could  try  and  pierce  one  or  two 
embrasures  in  the  bark  of  the  sequoia  to  serve  as  windows. 

As  for  discovering  to  what  height  the  opening  ran  up 
into  the  trunk,  Godfrey  could  not  do  so  without  a  light. 
All  that  he  could  do  was  to  find  out  with  the  aid  of  a  pole 


72  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

ten  or  twelve  feet  long,  held  above  his  head,  that  he  could 
not  touch  the  top. 

The  question,  however,  was  not  an  urgent  one.  It  would 
be  solved  eventually. 

The  day  passed  in  these  labors,  which  were  not  ended 
at  sunset.  Godfrey  and  Tartlet,  tired  as  they  were,  found 
their  novel  bed-clothes  formed  of  the  dried  herbage,  of 
which  they  had  an  ample  supply,  most  excellent;  but  they 
had  to  drive  away  the  poultry  who  would  willingly  have 
roosted  in  the  interior  of  Will  Tree.  Then  occurred  to 
Godfrey  the  idea  of  constructing  a  poultry-house  in  some 
other  sequoia,  as,  to  keep  them  out  of  the  common  room, 
he  was  building  up  a  hurdle  of  brushwood.  Fortunately 
neither  the  sheep  nor  the  agouties,  nor  the  goats  ex- 
perienced the  like  temptation.  These  animals  remained 
quietly  outside,  and  had  no  fancy  to  get  through  the  in- 
sufficient barrier. 

The  following  days  were  employed  in  different  jobs,  in 
fitting  up  the  house  or  bringing  in  food;  eggs  and  shell- 
fish were  collected,  yam  roots  and  manzanilla  apples  were 
brought  in,  and  oysters,  for  which  each  morning  they 
went  to  the  bank  or  the  shore.  All  this  took  time,  and 
the  hours  passed  away  quickly. 

The  "dinner  things'*  consisted  now  of  large  bivalve 
shells,  which  served  for  dishes  or  plates.  It  is  true  that 
for  the  kind  of  food  to  which  the  hosts  of  Will  Tree  were 
reduced,  others  were  not  needed. 

There  was  also  the  washing  of  the  linen  in  the  clear 
water  of  the  stream,  which  occupied  the  leisure  of  Tartlet. 
It  was  to  him  that  this  task  fell;  but  he  only  had  to  see 
to  the  two  shirts,  two  handkerchiefs,  and  two  pairs  of 
socks,  which  composed  the  entire  wardrobe  of  both. 

While  this  operation  was  in  progress,  Godfrey  and  Tart- 
let had  to  wear  only  waistcoat  and  trousers,  but  in  the 
blazing  sun  of  that  latitude  the  clothes  quickly  dried.  And 
so  matters  went  on  without  either  rain  or  wind  till  July 
3rd.  Already  they  had  begun  to  be  fairly  comfortable 
in  their  new  home,  considering  the  condition  in  which  they 
had  been  cast  on  the  island. 

However,  it  was  advisable  not  to  neglect  the  chances  of 
safety  which  might  come  from  without.  Each  day  God- 
frey examined  the  whole  sector  of  sea  which  extended 


A  THUNDER-BOLT  73 

from  the  east  to  the  north-west  beyond  the  promontory. 

This  part  of  the  Pacific  was  always  deserted.  Not  a 
vessel,  not  a  fishing-boat,  not  a  ribbon  of  smoke  detaching 
itself  from  the  horizon,  proclaimed  the  passage  of  a 
steamer.  It  seemed  that  Phina  Island  was  situated  out  of 
the  way  of  all  the  itineraries  of  commerce.  All  they 
could  do  was  to  wait,  trusting  in  the  Almighty,  who  never 
abandons  the  weak. 

Meanwhile,  when  their  immediate  necessities  allowed 
them  leisure,  Godfrey,  incited  by  Tartlet,  returned  to  that 
important  and  vexed  question  of  the  fire.  It  was  possible 
that  some  of  the  varieties  of  mushrooms  which  grew  in 
the  crevices  of  the  old  trees,  after  having  been  subjected 
to  prolonged  drying,  might  be  transformed  into  a  com- 
bustible substance.  Many  of  these  mushrooms  were  col- 
lected and  exposed  to  the  direct  action  of  the  sun,  until 
they  were  reduced  to  powder.  Then  with  the  back  of 
his  knife,  Godfrey  endeavored  to  strike  some  sparks  off 
with  a  flint,  so  that  they  might  fall  on  this  substance.  It 
was  useless.  The  spongy  stuff  would  not  catch  fire.  God- 
frey then  tried  to  use  that  fine  vegetable  dust,  dried  dur- 
ing so  many  centuries,  which  he  had  found  in  the  interior 
of  Will  Tree.  The  result  was  equally  discouraging. 

In  desperation  he  then,  by  means  of  his  knife  and  flint, 
strove  to  secure  the  ignition  of  a  sort  of  sponge  which 
grew  under  the  rocks.  He  fared  no  better.  The  particle 
of  steel,  lighted  by  the  impact  of  the  silex,  fell  onto  the 
substance,  but  went  out  immediately.  Godfrey  and  Tartlet 
were  in  despair.  To  do  without  fire  was  impossible.  Of 
their  fruits  and  mollusks  they  were  getting  tired,  and 
their  stomaches  began  to  revolt  at  such  food.  They  eyed — 
the  professor  especially — the  sheep,  agouties,  and  fowls 
which  went  and  came  around  Will  Tree.  The  pangs  of 
hunger  seized  them  as  they  gazed.  With  their  eyes  they 
ate  the  living  meat! 

No!    It  could  not  go  on  like  this! 

But  an  unexpected  circumstance,  a  providential  one  if 
you  will,  came  to  their  aid.  In  the  night  of  the  3rd  of 
July  the  weather,  which  had  been  on  the  change  for  a  day 
or  so,  grew  stormy,  after  an  oppressive  heat  which  the  sea- 
breeze  had  been  powerless  to  temper. 

Godfrey  and  Tartlet  at  about  one  o'clock  in  the  morn- 


^4  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

ing  were  awakened  by  heavy  claps  of  thunder,  and  most 
vivid  flashes  of  lightning.  It  did  not  rain  as  yet,  but  it 
promised  to  do  so,  and  then  regular  cataracts  would  be 
precipitated  from  the  cloudy  zone,  owing  to  the  rapid 
condensation  of  the  vapor. 

Godfrey  got  up  and  went  out  so  as  to  observe  the  state 
of  the  sky.  There  seemed  quite  a  conflagration  above  the 
domes  of  the  giant  trees  and  the  foliage  appeared  on  fire 
against  the  sky,  like  the  fine  network  of  a  Chinese  shadow. 

Suddenly,  in  the  midst  of  the  general  uproar,  a  vivid 
flash  illuminated  the  atmosphere.  The  thunder-clap  fol- 
lowed immediately,  and  Will  Tree  was  permeated  from 
top  to  bottom  with  the  electric  force. 

Godfrey,  staggered  by  the  return  shock,  stood  in  the 
midst  of  a  rain  of  fire  which  showered  around  him.  The 
lightning  had  ignited  the  dry  branches  above  him.  They 
were  incandescent  particles  of  carbon  which  crackled  at 
his  feet. 

Godfrey  with  a  shout  awoke  his  companion.  "Fire! 
Fire!" 

"Fire!"  answered  Tartlet.  "Blessed  be  Heaven  which 
sends  it  to  us!" 

Instantly  they  possessed  themselves  of  the  flaming 
twigs,  of  which  some  still  burned,  while  others  had  been 
consumed  in  the  flames.  Hurriedly,  at  the  same  time,  did 
they  heap  together  a  quantity  of  dead  wood  such  as  was 
never  wanting  at  the  foot  of  the  sequoia,  whose  trunk 
had  not  been  touched  by  the  lightning. 

Then  they  returned  into  their  gloomy  habitation  as  the 
rain,  pouring  down  in  sheets,  extinguished  the  fire  which 
threatened  to  devour  the  upper  branches  of  Will  Tree. 


CHAPTER  XII 

MYSTERIES    BEGIN 

^  THAT  was  a  storm  which  came  just  when  it  was  wanted ! 
Godfrey  and  Tartlet  had  not,  like  Prometheus,  to  venture 
into  space  to  bring  down  the  celestial  fire!  "It  was,"  said 
Tartlet,  "as  if  the  sky  had  been  obliging  enough  to  send 
it  down  to  us  on  a  lightning  flash." 

With  them  now  remained  the  task  of  keeping  it! 


MYSTERIES  BEGIN  75 

"No!  we  must  not  let  it  go  out!"  Godfrey  had  said. 

"Not  until  the  wood  fails  us  to  feed  it!"  had  responded 
Tartlet,  whose  satisfaction  showed  itself  in  little  cries  of 
joy. 

"Yes!  but  who  will  keep  it  in?" 

"I!  I  will!  I  will  watch  it  day  and  night,  if  neces- 
sary," replied  Tartlet,  brandishing  a  flaming  bough. 

And  he  did  so  till  the  sun  rose. 

Dry  wood,  as  we  have  said,  abounded  beneath  the 
sequoias.  Until  the  dawn  Godfrey  and  the  professor, 
after  heaping  up  a  considerable  stock,  did  not  spare  to 
feed  the  fire.  By  the  foot  of  one  of  the  large  trees  in  a 
narrow  space  between  the  roots  the  flames  leaped  up,  crack- 
ling clearly  and  joyously.  Tartlet  exhausted  his  lungs 
blowing  away  at  it,  although  his  doing  so  was  perfectly 
useless.  In  this  performance  he  assumed  the  most  charac- 
teristic attitudes  in  following  the  grayish  smoke  whose 
wreaths  were  lost  in  the  foliage  above. 

But  it  was  not  that  they  might  admire  it  that  they  had 
so  longingly  asked  for  this  indispensable  fire,  nor  to  warm 
themselves  at  it.  It  was  destined  for  a  much  more  in- 
teresting use.  There  was  to  be  an  end  of  their  miserable 
meals  of  raw  mollusks  and  yam  roots,  whose  nutritive 
elements  boiling  water  and  simple  cooking  in  the  ashes 
had  never  developed.  It  was  in  this  way  that  Godfrey 
and  Tartlet  employed  it  during  the  morning. 

"We  could  eat  a  fowl  or  two!"  exclaimed  Tartlet, 
whose  jaws  moved  in  anticipation.  "Not  to  mention  an 
agouti  ham,  a  leg  of  mutton,  a  quarter  of  goat,  some  of 
the  game  on  the  prairie,  without  counting  two  or  three 
freshwater  fish  and  a  sea  fish  or  so." 

"Not  so  fast,"  answered  Godfrey,  whom  the  declaration 
of  this  modest  bill  of  fare  had  put  in  good  humor.  "We 
need  not  risk  indigestion  to  satisfy  a  fast!  We  must 
look  after  our  reserves,  Tartlet!  Take  a  couple  of  fowls 
— one  apiece — and  if  we  want  bread,  I  hope  that  our  camas 
roots  can  be  so  prepared  as  to  replace  it  with  advantage!" 

This  cost  the  lives  of  two  innocent  hens,  who,  plucked, 
trussed,  and  dressed  by  the  professor,  were  stuck  on  a 
stick,  and  soon  roasted  before  the  crackling  flames. 

Meanwhile,  Godfrey  was  getting  the  camas  roots  in  a 
state  to  figure  creditably  at  the  first  genuine  breakfast  on 


ro  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

PMna  Island.  To  render  them  edible  it  was  only  neces- 
sary to  follow  the  Indian  method,  which  the  Californians 
were  wefl  acquainted  with. 

This  was  what  Godfrey  did.  A  few  flat  stones  selected 
from  Ac  beach  were  thrown  hi  the  fire  ID  as  to  get  in- 
tensely hot  Tartlet  seemed  to  tliink  it  a  great  shame  to 
use  such  a  good  fire  "to  cook  stones  with,"  but  as  it  did 
not  hinder  the  preparation  of  his  fowls  in  any  way  he 
had  no  other  complaint  to  make. 

While  the  stones  were  getting  warm  Godfrey  selected  a 
piece  of  ground  about  a  yard  square  from  which  he  tore 
up  the  grass;  then  with  his  hands  armed  with  large  scallop 
shells  he  dug  the  soil  to  the  depth  of  about  ten  inches. 
That  done  he  laid  at  the  bottom  of  the  cavity  a  fire  of 
dry  wood,  which  he  so  arranged  as  to  communicate  to  the 
earth  heaped  up  at  its  bottom  some  considerable  heat 

When  all  the  wood  had  been  consumed  and  the  cinders 
taken  away,  the  camas  roots,  previously  cleaned  and 
scraped,  were  strewn  in  the  hole,  a  thin  layer  of  sods 
thrown  over  them  and  the  glowing  stones  placed  on  the 
top,  so  as  to  serve  as  the  basis  of  a  new  fire  which  was 
lighted  on  their  surface. 

In  fact,  it  was  a  kind  of  oven  which  had  been  prepared ; 
and  in  a  very  short  time — about  half  an  hour  or  so— the 
operation  was  at  an  end. 

Beneath  the  double  layer  of  stones  and  sods  lay  the 
roots  cooked  by  this  violent  heating.  On  crushing  them 
there  was  obtainable  a  flour  well  fitted  for  making  into 
bread,  but,  even  eaten  as  they  were,  they  proved  much 
fike  potatoes  of  highly  nutritive  quality. 

It  was  thus  that  this  time  the  roots  were  served,  and  we 
leave  oar  readers  to  imagine  what  a  breakiast  our  two 
friends  made  on  the  chickens  which  they  devoured  to  the 
very  bones,  and  on  die  excellent  camas  roots,  of  which 
they  had  no  need  to  be  sparing.  The  field  was  not  far 
off  where  they  grew  in  abundance.  They  could  be  picked' 
up  in  hundreds  by  simply  stooping  down  for  diem. 

The  repast  over,  Godfrey  set  to  work  to  prepare  some 
of  the  floor,  which  keeps  for  any  length  of  time,  and  which 
could  be  transformed  into  bread  for  their  daily  wants. 

The  day  was  passed  in  different  occupations.     The  fire 
kept  up  widi  great  care.     Particularly  was  the  fuel 


MYSTERIES  BEGIN  77 

heaped  on  for  the  night;  and  Tartlet,  nevertheless,  arose 
on  many  occasions  to  sweep  the  ashes  together  and  pro- 
voke a  more  active  combustion.  Having  done  this,  he 
would  go  to  bed  again,  to  get  up  as  soon  as  the  fire  burned 
low,  and  thus  he  occupied  himself  till  the  day  broke.  The 
night  passed  without  incident,  the  cracklings  of  the  fire 
and  the  crow  of  the  cock  awoke  Godfrey  and  his  com- 
panion, who  had  ended  his  performances  by  falling  off  to 
sleep. 

At  first  Godfrey  was  surprised  at  feeling  a  current  of  air 
coming  down  from  above  in  the  interior  of  Will  Tree. 
He  was  thus  led  to  think  that  the  sequoia  was  hollow  up 
to  the  junction  of  the  lower  branches  where  there  was  an 
opening  which  they  would  have  to  stop  up  if  they  wished 
to  be  snug  and  sheltered. 

"But  it  is  very  singular!"  said  Godfrey  to  himself. 
"How  was  it  that  during  the  preceding  nights  I  did  not 
feel  this  current  of  air?   Could  it  have  been  the  lightning?" 
And  to  get  an  answer  to  this  question,  the  idea  occurred 
to  him  to  examine  the  trunk  of  the  sequoia  from  the  out- 
side. 

When  he  had  done  so,  he  understood  what  had  hap- 
pened during  the  storm. 

The  track  of  the  lightning  was  visible  on  the  tree,  which 
had  had  a  long  strip  of  its  bark  torn  off  from  the  fork 
down  to  the  roots. 

Had  the  electric  spark  found  its  way  into  the  interior 
of  the  sequoia  in  place  of  keeping  to  the  outside,  Godfrey 
and  his  companion  would  have  been  struck.  Most  de- 
cidedly they  had  had  a  narrow  escape. 

"It  is  not  a  good  thing  to  take  refuge  under  trees  dur- 
ing a  storm,"  said  Godfrey.  "That  is  all  very  well  for 
people  who  can  do  otherwise.  But  what  way  have  we  to 
avoid  the  danger  who  live  inside  the  tree?  We  must 
see!" 

Then  examining  the  sequoia  from  the  point  where  the 
long  lightning  trace  began — "It  is  evident,"  said  he,  "that 
where  the  flash  struck  the  tree  has  been  cracked.  But  since 
the  air  penetrates  by  this  orifice  the  tree  must  be  hollow 
along  its  whole  length,  and  only  lives  in  its  bark.  Now 
that  is  what  I  ought  to  see  about!" 


78  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

And  Godfrey  went  to  look  for  a  resinous  piece  of  wood 
that  might  do  for  a  torch. 

A  bundle  of  pine  twigs  furnished  him  with  the  torch  he 
needed,  as  from  them  exuded  a  resin  which,  once  inflamed, 
gave  forth  a  brilliant  light. 

Godfrey  then  entered  the  cavity  which  served  him  for 
his  house.  To  darkness  immediately  succeeded  light,  and 
it  was  easy  to  see  the  state  of  the  interior  of  Will  Tree. 

A  sort  of  vault  of  irregular  formation  stretched  across 
in  a  ceiling  some  fifteen  feet  above  the  ground.  Lifting  his 
torch  Godfrey  distinctly  saw  that  into  this  there  opened  a 
narrow  passage  whose  further  development  was  lost  in 
the  shadow.  The  tree  was  evidently  hollow  throughout 
its  length;  but  perhaps  some  portion  of  the  alburnum  still 
remained  intact.  In  that  case,  by  the  help  of  the  pro- 
tuberances it  would  be  possible  if  not  easy  to  get  up  to 
the  fork. 

Godfrey,  who  was  thinking  of  the  future,  resolved  to. 
know  without  delay  if  this  were  so. 

He  had  two  ends  in  view;  one,  to  securely  close  the 
opening  by  which  the  rain  and  wind  found  admission,  and 
so  render  Will  Tree  almost  habitable;  the  other,  to  see  if 
in  case  of  danger,  or  an  attack  from  animals  or  savages, 
the  upper  branches  of  the  tree  would  not  afford  a  con- 
venient refuge.  He  could  but  try.  If  he  encountered  any 
insurmountable  obstacle  in  the  narrow  passage,  Godfrey 
could  be  got  down  again. 

After  firmly  sticking  his  torch  between  two  of  the  roots 
below,  behold  him  then  commencing  to  raise  himself  on  to 
the  first  interior  knots  of  the  bark.  He  was  lithe,  strong, 
and  accustomed  to  gymnastics  like  all  young  Americans. 
It  was  only  sport  to  him.  Soon  he  had  reached  in  this 
uneven  tube  a  part  much  narrower,  in  which,  with  the  aid 
of  his  back  and  knees,  he  could  work  his  way  upward 
like  a  chimney-sweep.  All  he  feared  was  that  the  hole 
would  not  continue  large  enough  for  him  to  get  up. 

However,  he  kept  on,  and  each  time  he  reached  a  pro- 
jection he  would  stop  and  take  breath. 

Three  minutes  after  leaving  the  ground,  Godfrey  had 
mounted  about  sixty  feet,  and  consequently  could  only 
have  about  twenty  feet  further  to  go. 

In  fact,  he  already  felt  the  air  blowing  more  strongly 


MYSTERIES  BEGIN  79 

on  his  face.  He  inhaled  it  greedily,  for  the  atmosphere 
inside  the  sequoia  was  not  particularly  fresh. 

After  resting  for  a  minute,  and  shaking  off  the  fine  dust 
which  he  had  rubbed  on  to  him  off  the  wall,  Godfrey 
started  again  up  the  long  tunnel,  which  gradually  nar- 
rowed. 

But  at  this  moment  his  attention  was  attracted  by  a 
peculiar  noise,  which  appeared  to  him  somewhat  suspicious. 
There  was  a  sound  of  scratching,  up  the  tree.  Almost 
immediately  a  sort  of  hissing  was  heard. 

Godfrey  stopped. 

"What  is  that?"  he  asked.  "Some  animal  taken  refuge 
in  the  sequoia?  Is  it  a  snake?  No!  We  have  not  yet 
seen  one  on  the  island!  Perhaps  it  is  a  bird  that  wants 
to  get  out!" 

Godfrey  was  not  mistaken;  and  as  he  continued  to 
mount,  a  cawing,  followed  by  a  rapid  flapping  of  wings 
showed  him  that  it  was  some  bird  ensconced  in  the  tree 
whose  sleep  he  was  doubtless  disturbing. 

It  proved  to  be  a  kind  of  jackdaw,  of  huge  stature, 
which  scuttled  out  of  the  opening,  and  disappeared  into  the 
summit  of  Will  Tree. 

A  few  seconds  afterward,  Godfrey's  head  appeared 
through  the  same  opening,  and  he  soon  found  himself  quite 
at  his  ease,  installed  on  a  fork  of  the  tree  where  the  lower 
branches  gave  off,  at  about  eighty  feet  from  the  ground. 

There,  as  has  been  seen,  the  enormous  stem  of  the 
sequoia  supported  quite  a  forest.  The  capricious  network 
of  its  upper  boughs  presented  the  aspect  of  a  wood 
crowded  with  trees,  which  no  gap  rendered  passable. 

However,  Godfrey  managed,  not  without  difficulty,  to 
get  along  from  one  branch  to  another,  so  as  to  gain  little 
by  little  the  upper  story  of  this  vegetable  phenomenon. 

A  number  of  birds  with  many  a  cry  flew  off  at  his  ap- 
proach, and  hastened  to  take  refuge  in  the  neighboring 
members  of  the  group,  above  which  Will  Tree  towered  by 
more  than  a  head. 

Godfrey  continued  to  climb  as  well  as  he  could,  and  did 
not  stop  until  the  ends  of  the  higher  branches  began  to 
bend  beneath  his  weight. 

A  huge  horizon  of  water  surrounded  Phina  Island,  which 
lay  unrolled  like  a  relief-map  at  his  feet.  Greedily  his 


80  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

eyes  examined  that  portion  of  the  sea.  It  was  still  de- 
serted. He  had  to  conclude  once  more,  that  the  island 
lay  away  from  the  trade  routes  of  the  Pacific. 

Godfrey  uttered  a  heavy  sigh;  then  his  look  fell  on  the 
narrow  domain  on  which  fate  had  condemned  him  to  live, 
doubtless  for  long,  perhaps  forever. 

But  what  was  his  surprise  when  he  saw,  this  time  away 
to  the  north,  a  smoke  similar  to  that  which  he  had  al- 
ready thought  he  had  seen  in  the  south.  He  watched 
it  with  the  keenest  attention.  A  very  light  vapor,  calm 
and  pure,  grayish  blue  at  its  tip,  rose  straight  in  the  air. 

"No!  I  am  not  mistaken!"  exclaimed  Godfrey.  "There 
is  smoke,  and  therefore  a  fire  which  produces  it!  And 
that  fire  could  not  have  been  lighted  except  by — by 
whom  ?" 

Godfrey  then,  with  extreme  precision,  took  the  bearings 
of  the  spot  in  question.  The  smoke  was  rising  in  the 
north-east  of  the  island,  amid  the  high  rocks  which  bor- 
dered the  beach.  There  was  no  mistake  about  that.  It  was 
less  than  five  miles  from  Will  Tree.  Striking  straight  to 
the  north-east  across  the  prairie,  and  then  following  the 
shore,  he  could  not  fail  to  find  the  rocks  above  which  the 
vapor  rose. 

With  beating  heart  Godfrey  made  his  way  down  the 
scaffolding  of  branches  until  he  reached  the  fork.  There 
he  stopped  an  instant  to  clear  off  the  moss  and  leaves 
which  clung  to  him,  and  that  done  he  slid  down  the  open- 
ing, which  he  enlarged  as  much  as  possible,  and  rapidly 
gained  the  ground.  A  word  to  Tartlet  not  to  be  uneasy 
at  his  absence,  and  Godfrey  hastened  off  in  the  north- 
easterly direction  so  as  to  reach  the  shore. 

It  was  a  two  hours'  walk  across  the  verdant  prairie, 
through  clumps  of  scattered  trees,  or  hedges  of  spiny 
shrubs,  and  then  along  the  beach.  At  length  the  last 
chain  of  rocks  was  reached. 

But  the  smoke  which  Godfrey  had  seen  from  the  top  of 
the  tree  he  searched  for  in  vain  when  he  had  reached  the 
ground.  As  he  had  taken  the  bearings  of  the  spot  with 
great  care,  he  came  toward  it  without  any  mistake. 

There  Godfrey  began  his  search.  He  carefully  explored 
every  nook  and  corner  of  this  part  of  the  shore.  He 
called.  No  one  answered  to  his  shout.  No  human  being 


SOME  WRECKAGE  AT  LAST  81 

appeared  on  the  beach.  Not  a  rock  gave  him  a  trace  of  a 
newly  lighted  fire — nor  of  a  fire  now  extinct,  which  could 
have  been  fed  by  sea  herbs  and  dry  algae  thrown  up  by 
the  tide. 

"But  it  is  impossible  that  I  should  have  been  mistaken !" 
repeated  Godfrey  to  himself.  "I  am  sure  it  was  smoke 
that  I  saw!  And  besides! — "  As  Godfrey  could  not  ad- 
mit that  he  had  been  the  dupe  of  a  delusion,  he  began  to 
think  that  there  must  exist  some  well  of  heated  water,  or 
kind  of  intermittent  geyser,  which  he  could  not  exactly 
find,  but  which  had  given  forth  the  vapor.  There  was 
nothing  to  show  that  in  the  island  there  were  not  many 
such  natural  wells,  and  the  apparition  of  the  column  of 
smoke  could  be  easily  explained  by  so  simple  a  geological 
phenomenon. 

Godfrey  left  the  shore  and  returned  toward  Will  Tree, 
observing  the  country  as  he  went  along  a  little  more  care- 
fully than  he  had  done  as  he  came.  A  few  ruminants 
showed  themselves,  among  others  some  wapiti,  but  they 
dashed  past  with  such  speed  that  it  was  impossible  to  get 
near  them. 

In  about  four  hours  Godfrey  got  back.  Just  before  he 
reached  the  tree  he  heard  the  shrill  "twang!  squeak!"  of 
the  kit,  and  soon  found  himself  face  to  face  with  Professor 
Tartlet,  who,  in  the  attitude  of  a  vestal,  was  watching  the 
sacred  fire  confided  to  his  keeping. 


CHAPTER  XIII 

SOME    WRECKAGE    AT    LAST 

To  PUT  up  with  what  you  cannot  avoid  is  a  philosoph- 
ical principle,  that  may  not  perhaps  lead  you  to  the  accom- 
plishment of  great  deeds,  but  is  assuredly  eminently  prac- 
tical. On  this  principle  Godfrey  had  resolved  to  act  for 
the  future.  If  he  had  to  live  on  this  island,  the  wisest 
thing  for  him  to  do  was  to  live  there  as  comfortably  as 
possible  until  an  opportunity  offered  for  him  to  leave  it. 

And  so,  without  delay,  he  set  to  work  to  get  the  interior 
of  Will  Tree  into  some  order.  Cleanliness  was  of  the  first 
importance.  The  beds  of  dried  grass  were  frequently  re- 
newed. The  plates  and  dishes  were  only  scallop  shells, 

Vol.  13  Verne 


82  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

it  is  true,  but  no  American  kitchen  could  show  cleaner 
ones.  It  should  be  said  to  his  praise  that  Professor 
Tartlet  was  a  capital  washer.  With  the  help  of  his 
knife,  Godfrey,  by  flattening  out  a  large  piece  of  bark, 
and  sticking  four  uprights  into  the  ground,  had  contrived 
a  table  in  the  middle  of  the  room.  Some  large  stumps 
served  for  stools.  The  comrades  were  no  longer  reduced 
to  eating  on  their  knees,  when  the  weather  prevented  their 
dining  in  the  open  air. 

There  was  still  the  question  of  clothing,  which  was  of 
great  interest  to  them,  and  they  did  the  best  they  could. 
In  that  climate,  and  under  that  latitude,  there  was  no 
reason  why  they  should  not  go  about  half  naked;  but,  at 
length,  trousers,  waistcoat,  and  linen  shirt  would  be  all 
worn  out.  How  could  they  replace  them?  Were  the 
sheep  and  the  goats  to  provide  them  with  skins  for  cloth- 
ing, after  furnishing  them  with  flesh  for  food?  It  looked 
like  it.  Meanwhile,  Godfrey  had  the  few  garments  he 
possessed  frequently  washed.  It  was  on  Tartlet,  trans- 
formed into  a  laundress,  that  this  task  fell,  and  he  ac- 
quitted himself  of  it  to  the  general  satisfaction. 

Godfrey  busied  himself  specially  in  providing  food,  and 
in  arranging  matters  generally.  He  was,  in  fact,  the 
caterer.  Collecting  the  edible  roots  and  the  manzanilla 
fruit  occupied  him  some  hours  every  day;  and  so  did  fish- 
ing with  plaited  rushes,  sometimes  in  the  waters  of  the 
stream,  and  sometimes  in  the  hollows  of  the  rocks  on  the 
beach  when  the  tide  had  gone  out.  The  means  were  primi- 
tive, no  doubt,  but  from  time  to  time  a  fine  crustacean 
or  a  succulent  fish  figured  on  the  table  of  Will  Tree,  to 
say  nothing  of  the  mollusks,  which  were  easily  caught  by 
hand. 

But  we  must  confess  that  the  pot — of  all  the  pieces  in 
the  battery  of  the  cook  undoubtedly  the  most  essential — 
the  simple  iron  pot  was  wanting.  Its  absence  could  not 
but  be  deeply  felt.  Godfrey  knew  not  how  to  replace  the 
vulgar  pipkin,  whose  use  is  universal.  No  hash,  no  stew, 
no  boiled  meat,  no  fish,  nothing  but  roasts  and  grills.  No 
soup  appeared  at  the  beginning  of  the  meal.  Constantly 
and  bitterly  did  Tartlet  complain — but  how  to  satisfy  the 
poor  man? 

Godfrey  was  busied  with  other  cares.      In  visiting  the 


SOME  WRECKAGE  AT  LAST  83 

different  trees  of  the  group  he  had  found  a  second  sequoia 
of  great  height,  of  which  the  lower  part,  hollowed  out 
by  the  weather,  was  very  rugged  and  uneven. 

Here  he  devised  his  poultry  house,  and  in  it  the  fowls 
took  up  their  abode.  The  hens  soon  became  accustomed  to 
their  home,  and  settled  themselves  to  set  on  eggs  placed 
in  the  dried  grass,  and  chickens  began  to  multiply.  Every 
evening  the  broods  were  driven  in  and  shut  up,  so  as  to 
keep  them  from  birds  of  prey,  who,  aloft  in  the  branches, 
watched  their  easy  victims,  and  would,  if  they  could,  have 
ended  by  destroying  them. 

As  for  the  agouties,  the  sheep,  and  the  goats,  it  would 
have  been  useless  then  to  have  looked  out  a  stable  or 
a  shelter  for  them.  When  the  bad  weather  came,  there 
would  be  time  enough  to  see  to  that.  Meanwhile,  they 
prospered  on  the  luxuriant  pasturage  of  the  prairie,  with 
its  abundance  of  sainfoin  and  edible  roots,  of  which  the 
porcine  representatives  showed  genuine  appreciation.  A 
few  kids  had  been  dropped  since  the  arrival  in  the  island, 
and  as  much  milk  as  possible  was  left  to  the  goats  with 
which  to  nourish  their  little  ones. 

From  all  this  it  resulted  that  the  surroundings  of  Will 
Tree  were  quite  lively.  The  well-fed  domestic  animals 
came  during  the  warm  hours  of  the  day  to  find  there  a 
refuge  from  the  heat  of  the  sun.  No  fear  was  there  of 
their  wandering  abroad,  or  of  their  falling  prey  to  wild 
beasts,  of  which  Phina  Island  seemed  to  contain  not  a 
single  specimen. 

And  so  things  went  on,  with  a  present  fairly  comfort- 
able perhaps,  but  a  future  very  disquieting,  when  an  un- 
expected incident  occurred  which  bettered  the  position  con- 
siderably. 

It  was  on  the  29th  of  July.  Godfrey  was  strolling  in 
the  morning  along  that  part  of  the  shore  which  formed 
the  beach  of  the  large  bight  to  which  he  had  given  the 
name  of  Dream  Bay.  He  was  exploring  it  to  see  if  it  was 
as  rich  in  shell-fish  as  the  coast  on  the  north.  Perhaps  he 
still  hoped  that  he  might  yet  come  across  some  of  the 
wreck,  of  which  it  seemed  to  him  so  strange  that  the  tide 
had  as  yet  brought  in  not  a  single  fragment. 

On  this  occasion  he  had  advanced  to  th«  northern  point 
which  terminated  in  a  sandy  spit,  when  his  attention  was 


84  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

attracted  by  a  rock  of  curious  shape,  rising  near  the  last 
group  of  algae  and  sea-weeds. 

A  strange  presentiment  made  him  hasten  his  steps. 
What  was  his  surprise,  and  his  joy,  when  he  saw  that 
what  he  had  taken  for  a  rock  was  a  box,  half  buried  in 
the  sand. 

Was  it  one  of  the  packages  of  the  Dream?  Had  it 
been  here  ever  since  the  wreck?  Was  it  not  rather  all 
that  remained  of  another  and  more  recent  catastrophe?  It 
was  difficult  to  say.  In  any  case  no  matter  whence  it  came 
or  what  it  held,  the  box  was  a  valuable  prize. 

Godfrey  examined  it  outwardly.  There  was  no  trace  of 
an  address — not  even  a  name,  not  even  one  of  those  huge 
initials  cut  out  of  thin  sheet  metal  which  ornament  the 
boxes  of  the  Americans.  Perhaps  he  would  find  inside  it 
some  paper  which  would  indicate  the  origin,  or  nationality, 
or  name  of  the  proprietor?  Anyhow  it  was  apparently 
hermetically  sealed,  and  there  was  hope  that  its  contents 
had  not  been  spoiled  by  their  sojourn  in  the  sea-water. 
It  was  a  very  strong  wooden  box,  covered  with  thick 
leather,  with  copper  corner  plates  at  the  angles,  and  large 
straps  all  over  it. 

Impatient  as  he  was  to  view  the  contents  of  the  box, 
Godfrey  did  not  think  of  damaging  it,  but  of  opening  it 
after  destroying  the  lock;  as  to  transporting  it  from  the 
bottom  of  Dream  Bay  to  Will  Tree,  its  weight  forbade  it, 
and  he  never  gave  that  a  thought. 

"Well,"  said  Godfrey  to  himself,  "we  must  empty  it 
where  it  is,  and  make  as  many  journeys  as  may  be  neces- 
sary to  take  away  all  that  is  inside." 

It  was  about  four  miles  from  the  end  of  the  promontory 
to  the  group  of  sequoias.  It  would  therefore  take  some 
time  to  do  this,  and  occasion  considerable  fatigue.  Time 
did  not  press,  however.  As  for  the  fatigue,  it  was  hardly 
worth  thinking  about. 

What  did  the  box  contain?  Before  returning  to  Will 
Tree,  Godfrey  had  a  try  at  opening  it.  He  began  by  un- 
buckling the  straps,  and  once  they  were  off  he  very  care- 
fully lifted  the  leather  shield  which  protected  the  lock. 
But  how  was  he  to  force  it? 

It  was  a  difficult  job.  Godfrey  had  no  lever  with  which 
to  bring  his  strength  to  bear.  He  had  to  guard  against 


SOME  WRECKAGE  AT  LAST  85 

the  risk  of  breaking  his  knife,  and  so  he  looked  about  for 
a  heavy  stone  with  which  he  could  start  the  staple.  God- 
frey picked  out  one  as  thick  as  his  wrist,  and  with  it  he 
gave  a  tremendous  whack  on  the  plate  of  copper. 

To  his  extreme  surprise  the  bolt  shot  through  the  staple 
immediately  gave  way.  Either  the  staple  was  broken  by 
the  blow,  or  the  lock  was  not  turned.  Godfrey's  heart 
beat  high  as  he  stooped  to  lift  up  the  box  lid. 

It  rose  unchecked,  and  in  truth  had  Godfrey  had  to  get 
it  to  pieces  he  would  not  have  done  so  without  trouble. 
The  trunk  was  a  regular  strong-box.  The  interior  was 
lined  with  sheet  zinc,  so  that  the  sea-water  had  failed  to 
penetrate.  The  objects  it  contained,  however  delicate 
they  might  be,  would  be  found  in  a  perfect  state  of  pres- 
ervation. 

And  what  objects!  As  he  took  them  out  Godfrey  could 
not  restrain  exclamations  of  joy.  Most  assuredly  the  box 
must  have  belonged  to  some  highly  practical  traveler,  who 
had  reckoned  on  getting  into  a  country  where  he  would 
have  to  trust  to  his  own  resources. 

In  the  first  place  there  was  linen — shirts,  table-cloths, 
sheets,  counterpanes;  then  clothes — woolen  jerseys,  woolen 
socks,  cotton  socks,  cloth  trousers,  velveteen  trousers, 
knitted  waistcoats,  waistcoats  of  good  heavy  stuffs;  then 
two  pairs  of  strong  boots,  and  hunting-shoes  and  felt  hats. 

Then  came  a  few  kitchen  and  toilet  utensils ;  and  an  iron 
pot— the  famous  pot  which  was  wanted  so  badly — a  kettle, 
a  coffee-pot,  a  tea-pot,  some  spoons,  some  forks,  some 
knives,  a  looking-glass,  and  brushes  of  all  kinds,  and,  what 
was  by  no  means  to  be  despised,  three  cans,  containing 
about  fifteen  pints  of  brandy  and  tafia,  and  several  pounds 
of  tea  and  coffee. 

Then,  in  the  third  place,  came  some  tools — an  auger,  a 
gimlet,  a  handsaw,  an  assortment  of  nails  and  brads,  a 
spade,  a  shovel,  a  pickaxe,  a  hatchet,  an  adze,  etc.,  etc. 

In  the  fourth  place  there  were  some  weapons,  two  hunt- 
ing-knives in  their  leather  sheaths,  a  carbine  and  two 
muskets,  three  six-shooter  revolvers,  a  dozen  pounds  of 
powder,  many  thousand  caps,  and  an  important  stock  of 
lead  and  bullets,  all  the  arms  seeming  to  be  of  English 
make.  There  was  also  a  small  medicine-chest,  a  telescope, 
a  compass,  and  a  chronometer.  There  were,  also  a  few 


86  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

English  books,  several  quires  of  blank  paper,  pencils,  pens, 
and  ink,  an  almanac,  a  Bible  with  a  New  York  imprint, 
and  a  "Complete  Cook's  Manual." 

Verily  this  is  an  inventory  of  what  under  the  circum- 
stances was  an  inestimable  prize.  Godfrey  could  not  con- 
tain himself  for  joy.  Had  he  expressly  ordered  the  trous- 
seau for  the  use  of  shipwrecked  folks  in  difficulties,  he 
could  not  have  made  it  more  complete.  Abundant  thanks 
were  due  for  it  to  Providence.  And  Providence  had  the 
thanks,  and  from  an  overflowing  heart. 

Godfrey  indulged  himself  in  the  pleasure  of  spreading 
out  all  his  treasure  on  the  beach.  Every  object  was 
looked  over,  but  not  a  scrap  of  paper  was  there  in  the  box 
to  indicate  to  whom  it  belonged,  or  the  ship  on  which  it 
had  been  embarked.  Around,  the  sea  showed  no  signs 
of  a  recent  wreck. 

Nothing  was  there  on  the  rocks,  nothing  on  the  sands. 
The  box  must  have  been  brought  in  by  the  flood,  after 
being  afloat  for  perhaps  many  days.  In  fact,  its  size  in 
proportion  to  its  weight  gave  it  sufficient  buoyancy. 

The  two  inhabitants  of  Phina  Island  would  for  some 
time  be  kept  provided  in  a  large  measure  with  the  material 
wants  of  life, — tools,  arms,  instruments,  utensils,  clothes — 
due  to  the  luckiest  of  chances. 

Godfrey  did  not  dream  of  taking  all  the  things  to  Will 
Tree  at  once.  Their  transport  would  necessitate  several 
journeys,  but  he  would  have  to  make  haste  for  fear  of  bad 
weather.  Godfrey  then  put  back  most  of  the  things  in 
the  box.  A  gun,  a  revolver,  a  certain  quantity  of  powder 
and  lead,  a  hunting-knife,  the  telescope,  and  the  iron  pot, 
he  took  as  his  first  load. 

The  box  was  carefully  closed  and  strapped  up,  and 
with  a  rapid  step  Godfrey  strode  back  along  the  shore. 

"Ah!  What  a  reception  he  had  from  Tartlet,  an  hour 
later!  And  the  delight  of  the  Professor  when  his  pupil 
ran  over  the  list  of  their  new  riches!  The  pot — that  pot 
above  everything — threw  him  into  transports  of  joy, 
culminating  in  a  series  of  "hornpipes"  and  "cellar-flaps," 
wound  up  by  a  triumphant  "six-eight  breakdown." 

It  was  only  noon  as  yet.  Godfrey  wished  after  the  meal 
to  get  back  at  once  to  Dream  Bay.  He  would  never  rest 
until  the  whole  was  in  safety  at  Will  Tree. 


SOME  WRECKAGE  AT  LAST  87 

Tartlet  made  no  objection,  and  declared  himself  ready 
to  start.  It  was  no  longer  necessary  to  watch  the  fire. 
With  the  powder  they  could  always  get  a  light.  But  the 
Professor  was  desirous  that  during  their  absence  the  soup 
which  he  was  thinking  about  might  be  kept  gently  on  the 
simmer.  The  wonderful  pot  was  soon  filled  with  water 
from  the  stream,  a  whole  quarter  of  a  goat  was  thrown 
in,  accompanied  by  a  dozen  yam  roots,  to  take  the  place 
of  vegetables,  and  then  a  pinch  or  two  of  salt  found  in  the 
crevices  of  the  rocks  gave  seasoning  to  the  mixture. 

"It  must  skim  itself,"  exclaimed  Tartlet,  who  seemed 
highly  satisfied  at  his  performance. 

And  off  they  started  for  Dream  Bay  by  the  shortest 
road.  The  box  had  not  been  disturbed.  Godfrey  opened 
it  with  care.  Amid  a  storm  of  admiring  exclamations 
from  Tartlet,  he  began  to  pick  out  the  things. 

In  this  first  journey  Godfrey  and  his  companion,  trans- 
formed into  beasts  of  burden,  carried  away  to  Will  Tree 
the  arms,  the  ammunition,  and  a  part  of  the  wearing  ap- 
parel. 

Then  they  rested  from  their  fatigue  beside  the  table,  on 
which  there  smoked  the  stewed  goat,  which  they  pro- 
nounced most  excellent.  As  for  the  meat,  to  listen  to 
the  Professor  it  would  have  been  difficult  even  to  imagine 
anything  more  exquisite!  Oh!  the  marvelous  effect  of 
privation ! 

On  the  3Oth,  the  next  day,  Godfrey  and  Tartlet  set  forth 
at  dawn,  and  in  three  other  journeys  succeeded  in  empty- 
ing and  carrying  away  all  that  the  box  contained.  Before 
the  evening,  tools,  weapons,  instruments,  utensils,  were 
all  brought,  arranged,  and  stowed  away  in  Will  Tree. 

On  the  ist  of  August,  the  box  itself,  dragged  along  the 
beach  not  without  difficulty,  found  a  place  in  the  tree,  and 
was  transformed  into  a  linen-closet. 

Tartlet,  with  the  fickleness  of  his  mind,  now  looked 
upon  the  future  through  none  but  rosy  glasses.  We  can 
hardly  feel  astonished  then  that  on  this  day,  with  his  kit 
in  his  hand,  he  went  out  to  find  his  pupil,  and  said  to  him 
in  all  seriousness,  as  if  he  were  in  the  drawing-room  of 
Kolderup's  mansion,  "Well,  Godfrey,  my  boy,  don't  you 
think  it  is  time  to  resume  our  dancing  lessons?" 


88  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 


CHAPTER  XIV 

A    CHANCE   OF    RESCUE 

AND  now  the  future  looked  less  gloomy.  But  if  Tart- 
let saw  in  the  possession  of  the  instruments,  the  tools,  and 
the  weapons  only  the  means  of  making  their  life  of  isola- 
tion a  little  more  agreeable,  Godfrey  was  already  thinking 
of  how  to  escape  from  Phina  Island.  Could  he  not  now 
construct  a  vessel  strong  enough  to  enable  them  to  reach  if 
not  some  neighboring  land,  at  least  some  ship  passing 
within  sight  of  the  island? 

Meanwhile  the  weeks  which  followed  were  principally 
spent  in  carrying  out  not  these  ideas,  but  those  of  Tartlet. 
The  wardrobe  at  Will  Tree  was  now  replenished,  but  it 
was  decided  to  use  it  with  all  the  discretion  which  the 
uncertainty  of  the  future  required.  Never  to  wear  any  of 
the  clothes  unless  necessity  compelled  him  to  do  so,  was  the 
rule  to  which  the  professor  was  forced  to  submit. 

"What  is  the  good  of  that?"  grumbled  he.  "It  is  a 
great  deal  too  stingy,  my  dear  Godfrey!  Are  we  savages, 
that  we  should  go  about  half  naked?" 

"I  beg  your  pardon,  Tartlet,"  replied  Godfrey ;  "we  are 
savages,  and  nothing  else." 

"As  you  please ;  but  you  will  see  that  we  shall  leave  the 
island  before  we  have  worn  the  clothes!" 

"I  know  nothing  about  it,  Tartlet,  and  it  is  better  to 
have  than  to  want." 

"But  on  Sunday  now,  surely  on  Sunday,  we  might  dress 
up  a  little?" 

"Very  well,  on  Sundays,  then,  and  perhaps  on  public 
holidays,"  answered  Godfrey,  who  did  not  wish  to  anger 
his  frivolous  companion ;  "but  as  today  is  Monday  we  shall 
have  to  wait  a  whole  week  before  we  come  out  in  our 
best."  We  need  hardly  mention  that  from  the  moment  he 
arrived  on  the  island  Godfrey  had  not  omitted  to  mark 
each  day  as  it  passed.  By  the  aid  of  the  calendar  he  found- 
in  the  box  he  was  able  to  verify  that  the  day  was  really 
Monday. 

Each  performed  his  daily  task  according  to  his  ability. 
It  was  no  longer  necessary  for  them  to  keep  watch  by  day 
and  night  over  a  fire  which  they  had  now  the  means  of 


A  CHANCE  OF  RESCUE  89 

relighting.  Tartlet  therefore  abandoned,  not  without  re- 
gret, a  task  which  suited  him  so  well.  Henceforward  he 
took  charge  of  the  provisioning  with  yam  and  camas 
roots — of  that  in  short  which  formed  the  daily  bread  of 
the  establishment,  so  that  the  professor  went  every  day 
and  collected  them,  up  to  the  lines  of  shrubs  with  which 
the  prairie  was  bordered  behind  Will  Tree.  It  was  one 
or  two  miles  to  walk,  but  he  accustomed  himself  to  it. 
Between  whiles  he  occupied  his  time  in  collecting  oysters  or 
other  mollusks,  of  which  they  consumed  a  great  quantity. 

Godfrey  reserved  for  himself  the  care  of  the  domestic 
animals  and  the  poultry.  The  butchering  trade  was  hardly 
to  his  taste,  but  he  soon  overcame  his  repugnance.  Thanks 
to  him,  boiled  meats  appeared  frequently  on  the  table, 
followed  by  an  occasional  joint  of  roast  meat  to  afford 
a  sufficiently  varied  bill  of  fare.  Game  abounded  in  the 
woods  of  Phina  Island,  and  Godfrey  proposed  to  begin  his 
shooting  when  other  more  pressing  cares  allowed  him 
time.  He  thought  of  making  good  use  of  the  guns, 
powder,  and  bullets  in  his  arsenal,  but  he  in  the  first  place 
wished  to  complete  his  preparations.  His  tools  enabled 
him  to  make  several  benches  inside  and  outside  Will  Tree. 
The  stools  were  cut  out  roughly  with  the  axe,  the  table, 
made  a  little  less  roughly,  became  more  worthy  of  the 
dishes  and  dinner  things  with  which  Professor  Tartlet 
adorned  it.  The  beds  were  arranged  in  wooden  boxes  and 
their  litter  of  dry  grass  assumed  a  more  inviting  aspect. 
If  mattresses  and  palliasses  were  still  wanting,  counter- 
panes at  least  were  not.  The  various  cooking  utensils 
stood  no  longer  on  the  ground,  but  had  their  places  on 
planks  fixed  along  the  walls.  Stores,  linen,  and  clothes 
were  carefully  put  away  in  cavities  hollowed  out  in  the 
bark  of  the  sequoia.  From  strong  pegs  were  suspended 
the  arms  and  instruments,  forming  quite  a  trophy  on  the 
walls. 

Godfrey  was  also  desirous  of  putting  a  door  to  the 
house,  so  that  the  other  living  creatures — the  domestic 
animals — should  not  come  during  the  night  and  trouble 
their  sleep.  As  he  could  not  cut  out  boards  with  his  only 
saw,  the  handsaw,  he  used  large  and  thick  pieces  of  bark, 
which  he  got  off  very  easily.  With  these  he  made  a  door 
sufficiently  massive  to  close  the  opening  into  .Will  Tree,  at 


90  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

the  same  time  he  made  two  little  windows,  one  opposite 
to  the  other,  so  as  to  let  light  and  air  into  the  room. 
Shutters  allowed  him  to  close  them  at  night,  but  from 
the  morning  to  the  evening  it  was  no  longer  necessary 
to  take  refuge  in  flaring  resinous  torches  which  filled 
the  dwelling  with  smoke.  What  Godfrey  would  think  of 
to  yield  them  light  during  the  long  nights  of  winter  he 
had  as  yet  no  idea.  He  might  take  to  making  candles  with 
the  mutton  fat,  or  he  might  be  contented  with  resinous 
torches  more  carefully  prepared. 

Another  of  his  anxieties  was  how  to  construct  a  chimney 
in  Will  Tree.  While  the  fine  weather  lasted,  the  fire  out- 
side among  the  roots  of  the  sequoia  sufficed  for  all  the 
wants  of  the  kitchen,  but  when  the  bad  weather  came  and 
the  rain  fell  in  torrents,  and  they  would  have  to  battle  with 
the  cold,  whose  extreme  rigor  during  a  certain  time  they 
reasonably  feared,  they  would  have  to  have  a  fire  inside 
their  house,  and  the  smoke  from  it  must  have  some  vent. 
This  important  question  therefore  had  to  be  settled. 

One  very  useful  work  which  Godfrey  undertook  was  to 
put  both  banks  of  the  river  in  communication  with  each 
other  on  the  skirt  of  the  sequoia  trees. 

He  managed,  after  some  difficulty,  to  drive  a  few  stakes 
into  the  river-bed,  and  on  them  he  fixed  a  staging  of 
planks,  which  served  for  a  bridge.  They  could  thus  get 
away  to  the  northern  shore  without  crossing  the  ford, 
which  led  them  a  couple  of  miles  out  of  their  road. 

But  if  Godfrey  took  all  these  precautions  so  as  to  make 
existence  a  little  more  possible  on  this  lone  isle  of  the 
Pacific,  in  case  he  and  his  companion  were  destined  to  live 
on  it  for  some  time,  or  perhaps  live  on  it  forever,  he  had 
no  intention  of  neglecting  in  any  way  the  chances  of 
rescue. 

Phina  Island  was  not  on  the  routes  taken  by  the  ships — 
that  was  only  too  evident.  It  offered  no  port  of  call,  nor 
means  of  revictualing.  There  was  nothing  to  encourage 
ships  to  take  notice  of  it.  At  the  same  time  it  was  not 
impossible  ^  that  a  war-ship  or  a  merchant-vessel  might 
come  in  sight.  It  was  advisable  therefore  to  find  some 
way  of  attracting  attention,  and  showing  that  the  island 
was  inhabited. 

With  this  object  Godfrey  erected  a  flagstaff  at  the  end 


A  CHANCE  OF  RESCUE  91 

of  the  cape  which  ran  out  to  the  north,  and  for  a  flag  he 
sacrificed  a  piece  of  one  of  the  cloths  found  in  the  trunk. 
As  he  thought  that  the  white  color  would  only  be  visible 
in  a  strong  light,  he  tried  to  stain  his  flag  with  the 
berries  of  a  sort  of  shrub  which  grew  at  the  foot  of  the 
dunes.  He  obtained  a  very  vivid  red,  which  he  could  not 
make  indelible  owing  to  his  having  no  mordant,  but  he 
could  easily  redye  the  cloth  when  the  wind  or  rain  had 
faded  it. 

These  varied  employments  occupied  him  up  to  the  I5th 
of  August.  For  many  weeks  the  sky  had  been  constantly 
clear,  with  the  exception  of  two  or  three  storms  of  ex- 
treme violence  which  had  brought  down  a  large  quantity 
of  water,  to  be  greedily  drank  by  the  soil. 

About  this  time  Godfrey  began  his  shooting  expeditions. 
But  if  he  was  skilful  enough  in  the  use  of  the  gun,  he 
could  not  reckon  on  Tartlet,  who  had  yet  to  fire  his  first 
shot.  Many  days  of  the  week  did  Godfrey  devote  to  the 
pursuit  of  fur  and  feather,  which,  without  being  abun- 
dant, were  yet  plentiful  enough  for  the  requirements  of 
Will  Tree.  A  few  partridges,  some  of  the  red-legged 
variety,  and  a  few  snipes,  came  as  a  welcome  variation  of 
the  bill  of  fare.  Two  or  three  antelopes  fell  to  the  prow- 
ess of  the  young  stalker ;  and  although  he  had  had  nothing 
to  do  with  their  capture,  the  professor  gave  them  a  no  less 
welcome  than  he  did  when  they  appeared  as  haunches  and 
cutlets. 

While  he  was  out  shooting,  Godfrey  did  not  forget 
to  take  a  more  complete  survey  of  the  island.  He  pene- 
trated the  depths  of  the  dense  forests  which  occupied  the 
central  districts.  He  ascended  the  river  to  its  source. 
He  again  mounted  the  summit  of  the  cone,  and  re  de- 
scended by  the  talus  on  the  eastern  shore,  which  he  had 
not,  up  to  then,  visited. 

"After  all  these  explorations,"  repeated  Godfrey  to 
himself,  "there  can  be  no  doubt  that  Phina  Island  has  no 
dangerous  animals,  neither  wild  beasts,  snakes,  nor  sau- 
rians!  I  have  not  caught  sight  of  one!  Assuredly  if 
there  had  been  any,  the  report  of  the  gun  would  have 
waked  them !  It  is  fortunate,  indeed.  If  it  were  to  become 
necessary  to  fortify  Will  Tree  against  their  attacks,  I  do 
not  know  how  we  should  get  on  I" 


92  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

"It  must  also  be  concluded,"  continued  he,  "that  the 
island  is  not  inhabited  at  all.  Either  natives  or  people 
shipwrecked  here  would  have  appeared  before  now  at  the 
sound  of  the  gun!  There  is,  however,  that  inexplicable 
smoke  which  I  twice  thought  I  saw." 

The  fact  is,  that  Godfrey  had  never  been  able  to  trace 
any  fire.  As  for  the  hot  water  springs  to  which  he 
attributed  the  origin  of  the  vapor  he  had  noticed,  Phina 
Island  being  in  no  way  volcanic  did  not  appear  to  contain 
any,  and  he  had  to  content  himself  with  thinking  that  he 
had  twice  been  the  victim  of  an  illusion. 

Besides,  this  apparition  of  the  smoke  or  the  vapor  was 
not  repeated.  When  Godfrey  the  second  time  ascended 
the  central  cone,  as  also  when  he  again  climbed  up  into 
Will  Tree,  he  saw  nothing  to  attract  his  attention.  He 
ended  by  forgetting  the  circumstance  altogether. 

Many  weeks  passed  in  different  occupations  about  the 
tree,  and  many  shooting  excursions  were  undertaken. 
With  every  day  their  mode  of  life  improved. 

Every  Sunday,  as  had  been  agreed,  Tartlet  donned  his 
best  clothes.  On  that  day  he  did  nothing  but  walk  about 
under  the  big  trees,  and  indulge  in  an  occasional  tune  on 
the  kit.  Many  were  the  glissades  he  performed,  giving 
lessons  to  himself,  as  his  pupil  had  positively  refused 
to  continue  his  course. 

"What  is  the  good  of  it?"  was  Godfrey's  answer  to  the 
entreaties  of  the  professor.  "Can  you  imagine  Robinson 
Crusoe  taking  lessons  in  dancing  and  deportment?" 

"And  why  not?"  asked  Tartlet  seriously.  "Why  should 
Robinson  Crusoe  dispense  with  deportment?  Not  for  the 
good  of  others,  but  of  himself,  he  should  acquire  refined 
manners." 

To  this  Godfrey  made  no  reply.  And  as  he  never 
came  for  his  lesson,  the  professor  became  professor 
"emeritus." 

The  1 3th  of  September  was  noted  for  one  of  the  great- 
est and  crudest  deceptions  to  which,  on  a  desert  island, 
the  unfortunate  survivors  of  a  shipwreck  could  be  sub- 
jected. Godfrey  had  never  again  seen  that  inexplicable 
and  undiscoverable  smoke  on  the  island;  but  on  this  day, 
about  three  o'clock  in  the  afternoon,  his  attention  was  at- 


A  CHANCE  OF  RESCUE  93 

tracted  by  a  long  line  of  vapor,  about  the  origin  of  which 
he  could  not  be  deceived. 

He  had  gone  for  a  walk  to  the  end  of  Flag  Point — the 
name  of  which  he  had  given  to  the  cape  on  which  he  had 
erected  his  flagstaff.  While  he  was  looking  through  his 
glass  he  saw  above  the  horizon  a  smoke  driven  by  the 
west  wind  toward  the  island. 

Godfrey's  heart  beat  high.     "A  ship!"  he  exclaimed. 

But  would  this  ship,  this  steamer,  pass  in  sight  of  Phina 
Island?  And  if  it  passed,  would  it  come  near  enough 
for  the  signal  thereon  to  be  seen  on  board?  Or  would  not 
rather  the  semi-visible  smoke  disappear  with  the  vessel 
toward  the  north-west  or  south-west  of  the  horizon? 

For  two  hours  Godfrey  was  a  prey  to  alternating  emo- 
tions more  easy  to  indicate  than  to  describe.  The  smoke 
got  bigger  and  bigger.  It  increased  when  the  steamer 
restoked  her  fires,  and  diminished  almost  to  vanishing 
point  as  the  fuel  was  consumed.  Continually  did  the 
vessel  visibly  approach.  About  four  o'clock  her  hull  had 
come  up  on  the  line  between  the  sky  and  the  sea. 

She  was  a  large  steamer,  bearing  north-east.  Godfrey 
easily  made  that  out.  If  that  direction  was  maintained, 
she  would  inevitably  approach  Phina  Island. 

Godfrey  had  at  first  thought  of  running  back  to  Will 
Tree  to  inform  Tartlet.  What  was  the  use  of  doing  so? 
The  sight  of  one  man  making  signals  could  do  as  much 
good  as  that  of  two.  He  remained  there,  his  glass  at  his 
eye,  losing  not  a  single  movement  of  the  ship. 

The  steamer  kept  on  her  course  toward  the  coast,  her 
bow  steered  straight  for  the  cape.  By  five  o'clock  the 
horizon-line  was  already  above  her  hull,  and  her  rig  was 
visible.  Godfrey  could  even  recognize  the  colors  at  her 
gaff.  She  carried  the  United  States'  ensign. 

"But  if  I  can  see  their  flag,  cannot  they  see  mine?  The 
wind  keeps  it  out,  so  that  they  could  easily  see  my  flag 
with  their  glasses.  Shall  I  make  signals,  by  raising  it  and 
lowering  it  a  few  times,  so  as  to  show  that  I  want  to  enter 
into  communication  with  them?  Yes!  I  have  not  an  in- 
stant to  lose." 

It  was  a  good  idea.  Godfrey  ran  to  the  end  of  Flag 
Point,  and  began  to  haul  his  flag  up  and  down,  as  if  he 
were  saluting.  Then  he  left  it  half-mast  high,  so  as  to 


94  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

show,  in  the  way  usual  with  seafaring  people,  that  he  re- 
quired help  and  succor. 

The  steamer  still  approached  to  within  three  miles  of 
the  shore,  but  her  flag  remained  immovable  at  the  peak, 
and  replied  not  to  that  on  Flag  Point.  Godfrey  felt  his 
heart  sink.  He  would  not  be  noticed!  It  was  half-past 
six,  and  the  sun  was  about  to  set ! 

The  steamer  was  now  about  two  miles  from  the  cape, 
which  she  was  rapidly  nearing.  At  this  moment  the  sun 
disappeared  below  the  horizon.  With  the  first  shadows 
of  night,  all  hope  of  being  seen  had  to  be  given  up.  God- 
frey again,  with  no  more  success,  began  to  raise  and  lower 
his  flag.  There  was  no  reply. 

He  then  fired  his  gun  two  or  three  times,  but  the  dis- 
tance was  still  great,  and  the  wind  did  not  set  in  that 
direction !  No  report  would  be  heard  on  board !  The  night 
gradually  came  on;  soon  the  steamer's  hull  grew  invisible. 
Doubtless  in  another  hour  she  would  have  passed  Phina 
Island. 

Godfrey,  not  knowing  what  to  do,  thought  of  setting 
fire  to  a  group  of  resinous  trees  which  grew  at  the  back  of 
Flag  Point.  He  lighted  a  heap  of  dry  leaves  with  some 
gunpowder,  and  then  set  light  to  the  group  of  pines,  which 
flared  up  like  an  enormous  torch. 

But  no  fire  on  the  ship  answered  to  the  one  on  the 
land,  and  Godfrey  returned  sadly  to  Will  Tree,  feeling 
perhaps  more  desolate  than  he  had  ever  felt  till  then. 


CHAPTER  XV 

VISITORS  ON  THE  ISLAND 

To  Godfrey  the  blow  was  serious.  Would  this  unex- 
pected chance  which  had  just  escaped  him  ever  offer  again  ? 
Could  he  hope  so?  No!  The  indifference  of  the  steamer 
as  she  passed  in  sight  of  the  island,  without  even  taking  a 
look  at  it,  was  obviously  shared  in  by  all  the  vessels  ven- 
turing in  this  deserted  portion  of  the  Pacific.  Why  should 
they  put  into  port  more  than  she  had  done?  The  island 
did  not  possess  a  single  harbor. 

Godfrey  passed  a  sorrowful  night.  Every  now  and  then 
jumping  up  as  if  he  heard  a  cannon  out  at  sea,  he  would 


VISITORS  ON  THE  ISLAND  95 

ask  himself  if  the  steamer  had  not  caught  sight  of  the 
huge  fire  which  still  burned  on  the  coast,  and  if  she  were 
not  endeavoring  to  answer  the  signal  by  a  gunshot? 

Godfrey  listened.  It  was  only  an  illusion  of  his  over- 
excited brain.  When  the  day  came,  he  had  almost  come  to 
look  upon  the  apparition  of  the  ship  as  but  a  dream,  which 
had  commenced  about  three  o'clock  on  the  previous  after- 
noon. But  no!  He  was  only  too  certain  that  a  ship  had 
been  in  sight  of  Phina  Island,  maybe  within  two  miles 
of  it,  and  certainly  she  had  not  put  in. 

Of  this  deception  Godfrey  said  not  a  word  to  Tartlet. 
What  was  the  good  of  talking  about  it?  Besides,  his 
frivolous  mind  could  not  see  more  than  twenty-four  hours 
ahead.  He  was  no  longer  thinking  of  the  chances  of 
escaping  from  the  island  which  might  offer.  He  no  longer 
imagined  that  the  future  had  great  things  in  store  for 
them.  San  Francisco  was  fading  out  of  his  recollection. 
He  had  no  sweetheart  waiting  for  him,  no  Uncle  Will  to 
return  to.  If  at  this  end  of  the  world  he  could  only 
commence  a  course  of  lessons  on  dancing,  his  happiness 
would  be  complete — were  it  only  with  one  pupil. 

If  the  professor  dreamed  not  of  immediate  danger,  such 
as  to  compromise  his  safety  in  this  island — bare,  as  it 
was,  of  wild  beasts  and  savages — he  was  wrong.  This 
very  day  his  optimism  was  to  be  put  to  a  rude  test. 

About  four  o'clock  in  the  afternoon  Tartlet  had  gone, 
according  to  his  custom,  to  collect  some  oysters  and  mus- 
sels, on  that  part  of  the  shore  behind  Flag  Point,  when 
Godfrey  saw  him  coming  back  as  fast  as  his  legs  could 
carry  him  to  Will  Tree.  His  hair  stood  on  end  around  his 
temples.  He  looked  like  a  man  in  flight,  who  dared  not 
turn  his  head  to  the  right  or  to  the  left. 

"What  is  the  matter?"  shouted  Godfrey,  not  without 
alarm,  running  to  meet  his  companion. 

"There!  there !"  answered  Tartlet,  pointing  with  his 
finger  toward  the  narrow  strip  of  sea  visible  to  the  north 
between  the  trees. 

"But  what  is  it?"  asked  Godfrey,  whose  first  movement 
was  to  run  to  the  edge  of  the  sequoias. 

"A  canoe!" 

"A  canoe?" 


96  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

"Yes!  Savages!  Quite  a  fleet  of  savages!  Cannibals, 
perhaps !" 

Godfrey  looked  in  the  direction  pointed  out.  It  was 
not  a  fleet,  as  the  distracted  Tartlet  had  said;  but  he  was 
only  mistaken  about  the  quantity.  In  fact,  there  was  a 
small  vessel  gliding  through  the  water,  now  very  calm, 
about  half  a  mile  from  the  coast,  so  as  to  double  Flag 
Point. 

"And  why  should  they  be  cannibals?"  asked  Godfrey, 
turning  toward  the  professor. 

"Because  in  Crusoe  Islands,"  answered  Tartlet,  "there 
are  always  cannibals,  who  arrive  sooner  or  later." 

"Is  it  not  a  boat  from  some  merchant-ship?" 

"From  a  ship?" 

"Yes.  From  a  steamer  which  passed  here  yesterday 
afternoon,  in  sight  of  our  island." 

"And  you  said  nothing  to  me  about  it!"  exclaimed 
Tartlet,  lifting  his  hands  to  the  sky. 

"What  good  should  I  have  done?"  asked  Godfrey.  "Be- 
sides, I  thought  that  the  vessel  had  disappeared!  But 
that  boat  might  belong  to  her !  Let  us  go  and  see !" 

Godfrey  ran  rapidly  back  to  Will  Tree,  and,  seizing 
his  glass,  returned  to  the  edge  of  the  trees.  He  then 
examined  with  extreme  attention  the  little  vessel,  which 
would  ere  then  have  perceived  the  flag  on  Flag  Point  as 
it  fluttered  in  the  breeze. 

The  glass  fell  from  his  hands.  "Savages!  Yes!  They 
are  really  savages!"  he  exclaimed. 

Tartlet  felt  his  knees  knock  together,  and  a  tremor  of 
fright  ran  through  his  body. 

It  was  a  vessel  manned  by  savages  which  Godfrey  saw 
approaching  the  island.  Built  like  a  Polynesian  canoe, 
she  carried  a  large  sail  of  woven  bamboo ;  an  outrigger  on 
the  weather  side  kept  her  from  capsizing  as  she  heeled 
down  to  the  wind. 

Godfrey  easily  distinguished  the  build  of  the  vessel.  She 
was  a  proa,  and  this  would  indicate  that  Phina  Island  was 
not  far  from  Malaysia.  But  they  were  not  Malays  on 
board;  they  were  half-naked  blacks,  and  there  were  about 
a  dozen  of  them. 

The  danger  of  being  found  was  thus  great.  Godfrey 
regretted  that  he  had  hoisted  the  flag,  which  had  not  been 


VISITORS  ON  THE  ISLAND  97 

seen  by  the  ship,  but  would  be  by  these  black  fellows.  To 
take  it  down  now  would  be  too  late.  It  was,  in.  truth,  very 
unfortunate.  The  savages  had  probably  come  to  the 
island  thinking  it  was  uninhabited,  as  indeed  it  had  been 
before  the  wreck  of  the  Dream.  But  there  was  the  flag, 
indicating  the  presence  of  human  beings  on  the  coast! 
How  were  they  to  escape  them  if  they  landed? 

Godfrey  knew  not  what  to  do.  Anyhow  his  immediate 
care  must  be  to  watch  if  they  set  foot  on  the  island.  He 
could  think  of  other  things  afterward.  With  his  glass 
at  his  eye  he  followed  the  proa;  he  saw  it  turn  the 
point  of  the  promontory,  then  run  along  the  shore  and 
then  approach  the  mouth  of  the  small  stream,  which,  two 
miles  up,  flowed  past  Will  Tree. 

If  the  savages  intended  to  paddle  up  the  river,  they 
would  soon  reach  the  group  of  sequoias — and  nothing 
could  hinder  them.  Godfrey  and  Tartlet  ran  rapidly  back 
to  their  dwelling.  They  first  of  all  set  about  guarding 
themselves  against  surprise,  and  giving  themselves  time  to 
prepare  their  defense. 

At  least  that  is  what  Godfrey  thought  of.  The  idea  of 
the  professor  took  quite  a  different  turn.  "Ah!"  he  ex- 
claimed. "It  is  destiny!  This  is  as  it  was  written!  We 
could  not  escape  it!  You  cannot  be  a  Crusoe  without  a 
canoe  coming  to  your  island,  without  cannibals  appearing 
one  day  or  another!  Here  we  have  been  for  only  three 
months,  and  there  they  are  already!  Assuredly,  neither 
Defoe  nor  De  Wyss  exaggerated  matters!  You  can  make 
yourself  a  Crusoe,  if  you  like!" 

The  precautions  taken  by  Godfrey  as  soon  as  he  re- 
turned to  Will  Tree  were  as  follows.  The  fire  burning 
among  the  roots  of  the  sequoia  was  extinguished,  and  the 
embers  scattered  broadcast,  so  as  to  leave  no  trace;  cocks, 
hens,  and  chickens  were  already  in  their  house  for  the 
night,  and  the  entrance  was  hidden  with  shrubs  and  twigs 
as  much  as  possible;  the  other  animals,  the  goats,  agouties, 
and  sheep,  were  driven  on  to  the  prairie,  but  it  was  un- 
lucky that  there  was  no  stable  to  shut  them  up  in;  all 
the  instruments  and  tools  were  taken  into  the  tree.  Noth- 
ing was  left  outside  that  could  indicate  the  presence  or 
the  passage  of  human  beings.  Then  the  door  was  closely 
shut,  after  Godfrey  and  Tartlet  had  gone  in.  The  door 

Vol.  13  Vern« 


98  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

made  of  the  sequoia  bark  was  indistinguishable  from 
the  bark  of  the  trunk,  and  might  perhaps  escape  the 
eyes  of  the  savages,  who  would  not  look  at  it  very  closely. 
It  was  the  same  with  the  two  windows,  in  which  the 
lower  boards  were  shut.  Then  all  light  was  extinguished 
in  the  dwelling,  and  our  friends  remained  in  total 
darkness.  How  long  that  night  was!  Godfrey  and  Tart- 
let heard  the  slightest  sounds  outside.  The  creaking  of  a 
dry  branch,  even  a  puff  of  wind,  made  them  start.  They 
thought  they  heard  some  one  walking  under  the  trees.  It 
seemed  that  they  were  prowling  around  Will  Tree.  Then 
Godfrey  climbed  up  to  one  of  the  windows,  opened  one  of 
the  boards,  and  anxiously  peered  into  the  gloom. 

Nothing! 

However,  Godfrey  at  last  heard  footsteps  on  the  ground. 
His  ear  could  not  deceive  him  this  time.  He  still  looked, 
but  could  only  see  one  of  the  goats  come  for  shelter 
beneath  the  trees. 

Had  any  of  the  savages  happened  to  discover  the  house 
hidden  in  the  enormous  sequoia,  Godfrey  had  made  up  his 
mind  what  to  do.  He  would  drag  up  Tartlet  with  him  by 
the  chimney  inside,  and  take  refuge  in  the  higher  branches, 
where  he  would  be  better  able  to  resist.  With  guns  and 
revolvers  in  his  possession,  and  ammunition  in  abundance, 
he  would  there  have  some  chance  against  a  dozen  savages 
devoid  of  fire-arms. 

If  in  the  event  of  their  being  armed  with  bows  and 
arrows  they  attacked  from  below,  it  was  not  likely  that 
they  would  have  the  best  of  it  against  fire-arms  aimed 
from  above.  If  on  the  other  hand  they  forced  the  door 
of  the  dwelling  and  tried  to  reach  the  branches  from  the 
inside,  they  would  find  it  very  difficult  to  get  there,  owing 
to  the  narrow  opening,  which  the  besieged  could  easily 
defend. 

Godfrey  said  nothing  about  this  to  Tartlet.  The  poor 
man  had  been  almost  out  of  his  mind  with  fright  since  he 
had  seen  the  proa.  The  thought  that  he  might  be  obliged 
to  take  refuge  in  the  upper  part  of  a  tree,  as  if  in  an 
eagle's  nest,  would  not  have  soothed  him  in  the  least.  If 
it  became  necessary,  Godfrey  decided  to  drag  him  up  be- 
fore he  had  time  to  think  about  it. 

The  night  passed  amid  these  alternations  of  fear  and 


VISITORS  ON  THE  ISLAND  99 

hope.  No  attack  occurred.  The  savages  had  not  yet 
come  to  the  sequoia  group.  Perhaps  they  would  wait 
for  the  day  before  venturing  to  cross  the  island. 

"That  is  probably  what  they  will  do,"  said  Godfrey, 
"since  our  flag  shows  that  it  is  inhabited!  But  there  are 
only  a  dozen  of  them,  and  they  will  have  to  be  cautious! 
How  are  they  to  know  that  they  have  only  to  deal  with  a 
couple  of  shipwrecked  men?  No!  they  will  risk  nothing 
except  by  daylight — at  least,  if  they  are  going  to  stop." 

"Supposing  they  go  away  when  the  daylight  comes?" 
answered  Tartlet. 

"Go  away?  Why  should  they  have  come  to  Phina 
Island  for  one  night?" 

"I  do  not  know,"  replied  the  professor,  who  in  his  ter- 
ror could  only  explain  the  arrival  of  the  blacks  by  suppos- 
ing that  they  had  come  to  feed  on  human  flesh. 

"Anyhow,"  continued  Godfrey,  "tomorrow  morning,  if 
they  have  not  come  to  Will  Tree,  we  will  go  out  and 
reconnoiter." 

"We?" 

"Yes!  we!  Nothing  would  be  more  imprudent  than 
for  us  to  separate!  Who  knows  whether  we  may  not 
have  to  run  to  the  forest  in  the  center  of  the  island  and 
hide  there  for  some  days — until  the  departure  of  the  proa! 
No!  We  will  keep  together,  Tartlet!" 

"Hush!"  said  the  professor  in  a  low  voice;  "I  think  I 
hear  something  outside." 

Godfrey  climbed  up  again  4o  the  window,  and  got  down 
again  almost  immediately.  "No!"  he  said.  "Nothing  sus- 
picious! It  is  only  our  cattle  coming  back  to  the  wood." 

"Hunted  perhaps!"  exclaimed  Tartlet. 

"They  seem  very  quiet,  then,"  replied  Godfrey;  "I 
fancy  they  have  only  come  in  search  of  shelter  against  the 
morning  dew." 

"Ah!"  murmured  Tartlet  in  so  piteous  a  tone  that 
Godfrey  could  hardly  help  laughing,  "these  things  could 
not  happen  at  your  uncle's  place  in  Montgomery  Street!" 

"Day  will  soon  break,"  said  Godfrey,  after  a  pause.  "In 
an  hour's  time,  if  the  savages  have  not  appeared,  we  will 
leave  Will  Tree  and  reconnoiter  toward  the  north  of  the 
island.  You  are  able  to  carry  a  gun,  Tartlet?" 

"Carry?    iYes!" 


loo      ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

"And  to  fire  it  in  a  stated  direction?" 

"I  do  not  know!  I  have  never  tried  such  a  thing,  and 
you  may  be  sure,  Godfrey,  that  my  bullet  will  not  go — " 

"Who  knows  if  the  report  alone  might  not  frighten  the 
savages  ?" 

An  hour  later,  it  was  light  enough  to  see  beyond  the 
sequoias.  Godfrey  then  cautiously  reopened  the  shutters. 

From  that  looking  to  the  south  he  saw  nothing  extraor- 
dinary. The  domestic  animals  wandered  peacefully  under 
the  trees,  and  did  not  appear  in  the  least  alarmed.  The 
survey  completed,  Godfrey  carefully  shut  this  window. 
Through  the  opening  to  the  north  there  was  a  view  up  to 
the  shore.  Two  miles  off  even  the  end  of  Flag  Point  could 
be  seen ;  but  the  mouth  of  the  river  at  the  place  where  the 
savages  had  landed  the  evening  before  was  not  visible. 
Godfrey  at  first  looked  around  without  using  his  glass,  so 
as  to  examine  the  environs  of  Will  Tree  on  this  side  of 
Phina  Island.  All  was  quite  peaceful. 

Godfrey,  then  taking  his  glass,  swept  around  the  coast 
to  the  promontory  at  Flag  Point.  Perhaps,  as  Tartlet  had 
said,  though  it  was  difficult  to  find  the  reason,  the  savages 
had  embarked,  after  a  night  spent  on  shore,  without 
attempting  to  see  if  the  island  were  inhabited. 


CHAPTER  XVI 
CRUSOE'S  MAN  FRIDAY 

BUT  Godfrey  suddenly  uttered  an  exclamation  which 
made  the  professor  jump.  There  could  be  no  doubt  that 
the  savages  knew  the  island  was  inhabited,  for  the  flag 
hitherto  hoisted  at  the  extremity  of  the  cape  had  been 
carried  away  by  them,  and  no  longer  floated  on  the  mast 
at  Flag  Point.  The  moment  had  then  come  to  put  the 
project  into  execution,  to  reconnoiter  if  the  savages  were 
still  on  the  island,  and  see  what  they  were  doing. 

"Let  us  go,"  said  he  to  his  companion. 

"Go!     But—"  answered  Tartlet. 

"Would  you  rather  stay  here?" 

"With   you,   Godfrey — yes!" 

"No— alone!" 

"Alone!    Never!" 


CRUSOE'S  MAN  FRIDAY  101 

"Come  along,  then!" 

Tartlet,  thoroughly  understanding  that  Godfrey  would 
not  alter  his  decision,  resolved  to  accompany  him.  He  had 
not  courage  enough  to  stay  behind  at  Will  Tree. 

Before  starting,  Godfrey  assured  himself  that  the  fire- 
arms were  ready  for  action.  The  two  guns  were  loaded, 
and  one  passed  into  the  hands  of  the  professor,  who 
seemed  as  much  embarrassed  with  it  as  might  have  been  a 
savage  of  Pomotou.  He  also  hung  one  of  the  hunting- 
knives  to  his  belt,  to  which  he  had  already  attached  his 
cartridge-pouch.  The  thought  had  occurred  to  him  to 
.also  take  his  fiddle,  imagining  perhaps  that  they  would  be 
sensible  to  the  charm  of  its  squeaking,  of  which  all  the 
talent  of  a  virtuoso  could  not  conceal  the  harshness.  God- 
frey had  some  trouble  in  getting  him  to  abandon  this  idea. 

It  was  now  six  o'clock  in  the  morning.  The  summits 
of  the  sequoias  were  glowing  in  the  first  rays  of  the  sun. 
Godfrey  opened  the  door;  he  stepped  outside;  he  scanned 
the  group  of  trees.  Complete  solitude.  The  animals  had 
returned  to  the  prairie.  There  they  were,  tranquilly 
browsing,  about  a  quarter  of  a  mile  away.  Nothing  about 
them  denoted  the  least  uneasiness. 

Godfrey  made  a  sign  to  Tartlet  to  join  him.  The 
professor,  as  clumsy  as  could  be  in  his  fighting  harness, 
followed — not  without  some  hesitation.  Then  Godfrey 
shut  the  door,  and  saw  that  it  was  well  hidden,  in  the  bark 
of  the  sequoia.  Then,  having  thrown  at  the  foot  of  the 
tree  a  bundle  of  twigs,  which  he  weighted  with  a  few 
large  stones,  he  set  out  toward  the  river,  whose  banks 
he  intended  to  descend,  if  necessary,  to  its  mouth.  Tartlet 
followed  him,  not  without  giving  before  each  of  his  steps 
an  uneasy  stare  completely  around  him  up  to  the  very 
limits  of  the  horizon;  but  the  fear  of  being  left  alone 
impelled  him  to  advance. 

Arrived  at  the  edge  of  the  group  of  trees,  Godfrey 
stopped.  Taking  his  glasses  from  their  case,  he  scanned 
with  extreme  attention  all  that  part  of  the  coast  between 
the  Flag  Point  promontory  and  the  north-east  angle  of 
the  island.  Not  a  living  being  showed  itself,  not  a  single 
smoke  wreath  was  rising  in  the  air. 

The  end  of  the  cape  was  equally  deserted,  but  they 
would  there  doubtless  find  numberless  footprints,  freshly 


102  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

made.  As  for  the  mast,  Godfrey  had  not  been  deceived. 
If  the  staff  still  rose  above  the  last  rock  on  the  cape,  it 
was  bereft  of  its  flag.  Evidently  the  savages  after  com- 
ing to  the  place  had  gone  off  with  the  red  cloth  which  had 
excited  their  covetousness,  and  had  regained  their  boat  at 
the  mouth  of  the  river. 

Godfrey  then  turned  off  so  as  to  examine  the  western 
shore.  It  was  nothing  but  a  vast  desert  from  Flag  Point 
right  away  beyond  the  curve  of  Dream  Bay.  No  boat  of 
any  kind  appeared  on  the  surface  of  the  sea.  If  the 
savages  had  taken  to  their  proa,  it  only  could  be  con- 
cluded that  they  were  hugging  the  coast  sheltered  by  the 
rocks,  and  so  closely  that  they  could  not  be  seen. 

However,  Godfrey  could  not  and  would  not  remain  in 
doubt.  He  was  determined  to  ascertain,  yes  or  no,  if  the 
proa  had  definitely  left  the  island.  To  do  this  it  was 
necessary  to  visit  the  spot  where  the  savages  had  landed 
the  night  before,  that  is  to  say,  the  narrow  creek  at  the 
mouth  of  the  river.  This  he  immediately  attempted. 

The  borders  of  the  small  watercourse  were  shaded  by 
occasional  clumps  of  trees  encircled  by  shrubs,  for  a  dis- 
tance of  about  two  miles.  Beyond  that  for  some  five  or 
six  hundred  yards  down  to  the  sea  the  river  ran  between 
naked  banks.  This  state  of  affairs  enabled  him  to  ap- 
proach close  to  the  landing-place  without  being  perceived. 
It  might  be,  however,  that  the  savages  had  ascended  the 
stream,  and  to  be  prepared  for  this  eventuality  the  advance 
had  to  be  made  with  extreme  caution. 

Godfrey,  however,  thought,  not  without  reason.,  that,  at 
this  early  hour  the  savages,  fatigued  by  their  long  voy- 
age, would  not  have  quitted  their  anchorage.  Perhaps  they 
were  still  sleeping  either  in  their  canoe  or  on  land,  in 
which  case  it  would  be  seen  if  they  could  not  be  surprised. 

This  idea  was  acted  upon  at  once.  It  was  important 
that  they  should  get  on  quickly.  In  such  circumstances 
the  advantage  is  generally  gained  at  the  outset.  The 
fire-arms  were  again  examined,  the  revolvers  were  care- 
fully looked  at,  and  then  Godfrey  and  Tartlet  commenced 
the  descent  of  the  left  bank  of  the  river  in  Indian  file. 
All  around  was  quiet.  Flocks  of  birds  flew  from  one 
bank  to  the  other,  pursuing  each  other  among  the  higher 
branches  without  showing  any  uneasiness. 


CRUSOE'S  MAN  FRIDAY  103 

Godfrey  went  first,  but  it  can  easily  be  believed  that 
his  companion  found  the  attempt  to  cover  step  rather  tir- 
ing. Moving  from  one  tree  to  another  they  advanced 
toward  the  shore  without  risk  of  discovery.  Here  the 
clumps  of  bushes  hid  them  from  the  opposite  bank,  there 
even  their  heads  disappeared  amid  the  luxurious  vegeta- 
tion. But  no  matter  where  they  were,  an  arrow  from  a 
bow  or  a  stone  from  a  sling  might  at  any  moment  reach 
them.  And  so  they  had  to  be  constantly  on  their  guard. 

However,  in  spite  of  the  recommendations  which  were 
addressed  to  him,  Tartlet,  tripping  against  an  occasional 
stump,  had  two  or  three  falls  which  might  have  com- 
plicated matters.  Godfrey  was  beginning  to  regret  having 
brought  such  a  clumsy  assistant.  Indeed,  the  poor  man 
could  not  be  much  help  to  him.  Doubtless  he  would  have 
been  worth  more  left  behind  at  Will  Tree;  or,  if  he  would 
not  consent  to  that,  hidden  away  in  some  nook  in  the 
forest.  But  it  was  too  late.  An  hour  after  he  had  left 
the  sequoia  group,  Godfrey  and  his  companion  had  come 
a  mile — only  a  mile — for  the  path  was  not  easy  beneath 
the  high  vegetation  and  between  the  luxuriant  shrubs. 
Neither  one  nor  the  other  of  our  friends  had  seen  any- 
thing suspicious. 

Hereabout  the  trees  thinned  out  for  about  a  hundred 
yards  or  less,  the  river  ran  between  naked  banks,  the 
country  around  was  barer.  Godfrey  stopped.  He  carefully 
observed  the  prairie  to  the  right  and  left  of  the  stream. 

Still  there  was  nothing  to  disquiet  him,  nothing  to  indi- 
cate the  approach  of  savages.  It  is  true  that  as  they  could 
not  but  believe  the  island  inhabited,  they  would  not  ad- 
vance without  precaution,  in  fact  they  would  be  as  care- 
ful in  ascending  the  little  river  as  Godfrey  was  in  descend- 
ing it.  It  was  to  be  supposed  therefore  that  if  they  were 
prowling  about  the  neighborhood,  they  would  also  profit 
by  the  shelter  of  the  trees  or  the  high  bushes  of  mastics 
and  myrtles  which  formed  such  an  excellent  screen. 

It  was  a  curious  though  very  natural  circumstance  that, 
the  farther  they  advanced,  Tartlet,  perceiving  no  enemy, 
little  by  little  lost  his  terror,  and  began  to  speak  with 
scorn  of  "those  cannibal  laughing-stocks."  Godfrey,  on 
the  contrary,  became  more  anxious,  and  it  was  with 
greater  precaution  than  ever  that  he  crossed  the  open 


104  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

space  and  regained  the  shadow  of  the  trees.  Another  hour 
led  them  to  the  place  where  the  banks,  beginning  to  feel 
the  effects  of  the  sea's  vicinity,  were  only  bordered  with 
stunted  shrubs,  or  sparse  grasses. 

Under  these  circumstances  it  was  difficult  to  keep  hidden 
or  rather  impossible  to  proceed  without  crawling  along 
the  ground.  This  is  what  Godfrey  did,  and  also  what  he 
advised  Tartlet  to  do.  "There  are  not  any  savages! 
There  are  not  any  cannibals!  They  have  all  gone!"  said 
the  professor. 

"There  are!"  answered  Godfrey  quickly,  in  a  low  voice. 
"They  ought  to  be  here!  Down,  Tartlet,  get  down!  Be 
ready  to  fire,  but  don't  do  so  till  I  tell  you." 

Godfrey  said  these  words  in  such  a  tone  of  authority 
that  the  professor,  feeling  his  limbs  give  way  under  him, 
had  no  difficulty  in  at  once  assuming  the  required  posi- 
tion. And  he  did  well! 

It  was  not  without  reason  that  Godfrey  had  spoken  as 
he  had.  From  the  spot  which  they  then  occupied,  they 
could  see  neither  the  shore,  nor  the  place  where  the  river 
entered  the  sea.  A  small  spur  of  hills  shut  out  the  view 
about  a  hundred  yards  ahead,  but  above  this  near  horizon 
a  dense  smoke  was  rising  straight  in  the  air. 

Godfrey,  stretched  at  full  length  in  the  grass,  with  his 
finger  on  the  trigger  of  his  musket,  kept  looking  toward 
the  coast.  "This  smoke,"  he  said,  "is  it  not  of  the  same 
kind  that  I  have  already  seen  twice  before?  Should  I 
conclude  that  savages  have  previously  landed  on  the  north 
and  south  of  the  island,  and  that  the  smoke  came  from 
fires  lighted  by  them?  But  no!  That  is  not  possible,  for 
I  found  no  cinders,  nor  traces  of  a  fireplace,  nor  embers! 
Ah!  this  time  I'll  know  the  reason  of  it."  And  by  a 
clever  reptilian  movement,  which  Tartlet  imitated  as  well 
as  he  could,  he  managed,  without  showing  his  head  above 
the  grass,  to  reach  the  bend  of  the  river.  Thence  he 
could  command,  at  his  ease,  every  part  of  the  bank 
through  which  the  river  ran. 

An  exclamation  could  not  but  escape  him!  His  hand 
touched  the  professor's  shoulder  to  prevent  any  movement 
of  his!  Useless  to  go  further!  Godfrey  saw  what  he 
had  come  to  see! 

A  large  fire  of  wood  was  lighted  on  the  beach,  among 


CRUSOE'S  MAN  FRIDAY  105 

the  lower  rocks,  and  from  it  a  canopy  of  smoke  rose 
slowly  to  the  sky.  Around  the  fire,  feeding  it  with  fresh 
armfuls  of  wood,  of  which  they  had  made  a  heap,  went 
and  came  the  savages  who  had  landed  the  evening  before. 
Their  canoe  was  moored  to  a  large  stone,  and,  lifted  by 
the  rising  tide,  oscillated  on  the  ripples  of  the  shore. 

Godfrey  could  distinguish  all  that  was  passing  on  the 
sands  without  using  his  glasses.  He  was  not  more  than 
two  hundred  yards  from  the  fire,  and  he  could  even  hear 
it  crackling.  He  immediately  perceived  that  he  need  fear 
no  surprise  from  the  rear,  for  all  the  blacks  he  had 
counted  in  the  proa  were  in  the  group. 

Ten  out  of  the  twelve  were  occupied  in  looking  after 
the  fire  and  sticking  stakes  in  the  ground  with  the  evident 
intention  of  rigging  up  a  spit  in  the  Polynesian  manner. 
An  eleventh,  who  appeared  to  be  the  chief,  was  walking 
along  the  beach,  and  constantly  turning  his  glances  toward 
the  interior  of  the  island,  as  if  he  were  afraid  of  an 
attack.  Godfrey  recognized  as  a  piece  of  finery  on  his 
shoulders  the  red  stuff  of  his  flag. 

The  twelfth  savage  was  stretched  on  the  ground,  tied 
tightly  to  a  post.  Godfrey  recognized  at  once  the  fate  in 
store  for  the  wretched  man.  The  spit  was  for  him!  The 
fire  was  to  roast  him  at !  Tartlet  had  not  been  mistaken 
when,  the  previous  evening,  he  had  spoken  of  these  folks 
as  cannibals! 

It  must  be  admitted  that  neither  was  he  mistaken  in 
saying  that  the  adventures  of  Crusoes,  real  or  imaginary, 
were  all  copied  one  from  the  other!  Most  certainly  God- 
frey and  he  did  then  find  themselves  in  the  same  position 
as  the  hero  of  Daniel  Defoe  when  the  savages  landed  on 
his  island.  They  were  to  assist,  without  doubt,  at  the 
same  scene  of  cannibalism. 

Godfrey  decided  to  act  as  this  hero  did!  He  would 
not  permit  the  massacre  of  the  prisoner  for  which  the 
stomachs  of  the  cannibals  were  waiting!  He  was  well 
armed.  His  two  muskets — four  shots — his  two  revolvers 
— a  dozen  shots — could  easily  settle  these  eleven  rascals, 
whom  the  mere  report  of  one  of  the  fire-arms  might  per- 
haps be  sufficient  to  scatter.  Having  taken  his  decision 
he  coolly  waited  for  the  moment  to  interfere  like  a 
thunderclap. 


io6  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

He  had  not  long  to  wait!  Twenty  minutes  had  barely 
elapsed,  when  the  chief  approached  the  fire.  Then  by  a 
gesture  he  pointed  out  the  prisoner  to  the  savages  who 
were  expecting  his  orders. 

Godfrey  arose.  Tartlet,  without  knowing  why,  followed 
the  example.  He  did  not  even  comprehend  where  his 
companion  was  going,  for  he  had  said  nothing  to  him  of 
his  plans. 

Godfrey  imagined,  evidently,  that  at  sight  of  him  the 
savages  would  make  some  movement,  perhaps  to  rush  to 
their  boat,  perhaps  to  rush  at  him.  They  did  nothing. 
It  did  not  even  seem  as  though  they  saw  him;  but  at  this 
moment  the  chief  made  a  significant  gesture.  Three  of 
his  companions  went  toward  the  prisoner,  unloosed  him, 
and  forced  him  near  the  fire. 

He  was  still  a  young  man,  who,  feeling  that  his  last 
hour  had  come,  resisted  with  all  his  might.  Assuredly, 
if  he  could,  he  would  sell  his  life  dearly.  He  began  by 
throwing  off  the  savages  who  held  him,  but  he  was  soon 
knocked  down,  and  the  chief,  seizing  a  sort  of  stone  axe, 
jumped  forward  to  beat  in  his  head. 

Godfrey  uttered  a  cry,  followed  by  a  report.  A  bullet 
whistled  through  the  air,  and  it  seemed  as  though  the 
chief  were  mortally  wounded,  for  he  fell  on  the  ground. 

At  the  report,  the  savages,  surprised  as  though  they  had 
never  heard  the  sound  of  fire-arms,  stopped.  At  the  sight 
of  Godfrey  those  who  held  the  prisoner  instantly  released 
him.  Immediately  the  poor  fellow  arose,  and  ran  toward 
the  place  where  he  perceived  his  unexpected  liberator. 

At  this  moment  a  second  report  was  heard.  It  was 
Tartlet,  who,  without  looking— for  the  excellent  man  kept 
his  eyes  shut — had  just  fired,  and  the  stock  of  the  musket 
on  his  right  shoulder  delivered  the  hardest  knock  which 
had  ever  been  received  by  the  professor  of  dancing  and 
deportment.  But — what  a  chance  it  was! — a  second  sav- 
age fell  close  to  his  chief. 

The  rout  at  once  began.  Perhaps  the  savages  thought 
they  had  to  do  with  a  numerous  troop  of  natives  whom 
they  could  not  resist.  Perhaps  they  were  simply  terrified 
at  the  sight  of  the  two  white  men  who  seemed  to  keep 
the  lightning  in  their  pockets.  There  they  were,  seizing 
the  two  who  were  wounded,  carrying  them  off,  rushing 


NEW  ANIMALS  APPEAR  107 

to  the  proa,  driving  it  by  their  paddles  out  of  the  little 
creek,  hoisting  their  sail,  steering  before  the  wind,  making 
for  the  Flag  Point  promontory,  and  doubling  it  in  hot 
haste. 

Godfrey  had  no  thought  of  pursuing  them.  What  was 
the  good  of  killing  them?  They  had  saved  the  victim. 
They  had  put  them  to  flight,  that  was  the  important 
point.  This  had  been  done  in  such  a  way  that  the  canni- 
bals would  never  dare  to  return  to  Phina  Island. 

All  was  then  for  the  best.  They  had  only  to  rejoice  in 
their  victory,  in  which  Tartlet  did  not  hesitate  to  claim 
the  greatest  share. 

Meanwhile  the  prisoner  had  come  to  his  rescuer.  For 
an  instant  he  stopped,  with  the  fear  inspired  in  him  by 
superior  beings,  but  almost  immediately  he  resumed  his 
course.  When  he  arrived  before  the  two  whites,  he  bowed 
to  the  ground;  then  catching  hold  of  Godfrey's  foot,  he 
placed  it  on  his  head  in  sign  of  servitude. 

One  would  almost  have  thought  that  this  Polynesian 
savage  had  also  read  Robinson  Crusoe! 


CHAPTER  XVII 

NEW    ANIMALS   APPEAR 

GODFREY  at  once  raised  the  poor  fellow,  who  lay  pros- 
trate before  him.  He  looked  in  his  face. 

He  was  a  man  of  thirty-five  or  more,  wearing  only  a 
rag  around  his  loins.  In  his  features,  *  as  in  the  shape  of 
his  head,  there  could  be  recognized  the  type  of  the  African 
negro.  It  was  not  possible  to  confound  him  with  the 
debased  wretches  of  the  Polynesian  islands,  who,  with 
their  depressed  crania  and  elongated  arms,  approach  so 
strangely  to  the  monkey. 

Now,  as  he  was  a  negro  from  Soudan  or  Abyssinia  who 
had  fallen  into  the  hands  of  the  natives  of  an  archipelago 
of  the  Pacific,  it  might  be  that  he  could  speak  English  or 
one  or  two  words  of  the  European  languages  which  God- 
frey understood.  But  it  was  soon  apparent  that  the  un- 
happy man  only  used  an  idiom  that  was  absolutely  incom- 
prehensible— probably  the  language  of  the  aborigines 
among  whom  he  had  doubtless  arrived  when  very  young. 


io8  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

In  fact,  Godfrey  had  immediately  interrogated  him  in 
English,  and  had  obtained  no  reply.  He  then  made  him 
understand  by  signs,  not  without  difficulty,  that  he  would 
like  to  know  his  name. 

After  many  fruitless  essays,  the  negro,  who  had  a  very 
intelligent  and  even  honest  face,  replied  to  the  demand 
which  was  made  of  him  in  a  single  word — 

"Carefinotu." 

"Carefinotu!"  exclaimed  Tartlet.  "Do  you  hear  the 
name?  I  propose  that  we  call  him  'Wednesday/  for  to- 
day is  Wednesday,  and  that  is  what  they  always  do  in 
these  Crusoe  islands!  Is  he  to  be  allowed  to  call  himself 
Carefinotu?" 

"If  that  is  his  name/'  said  Godfrey,  "why  should  he  not 
keep  it?" 

And  at  the  moment  he  felt  a  hand  placed  on  his  chest, 
while  all  the  black's  physiognomy  seemed  to  ask  him 
what  his  name  was. 

"Godfrey!"  answered  he. 

The  black  endeavored  to  say  the  word,  but  although 
Godfrey  repeated  it  several  times,  he  could  not  succeed 
in  pronouncing  it  in  an  intelligible  fashion.  Then  he 
turned  toward  the  professor,  as  if  to  know  his  name. 

"Tartlet,"  was  the  reply  of  that  individual  in  a  most 
amiable  tone. 

"Tartlet!"  repeated  Carefinotu. 

And  it  seemed  as  though  this  assemblage  of  syllables 
was  more  agreeable  to  his  vocal  chords,  for  he  pronounced 
it  distinctly.  The  professor  appeared  to  be  extremely 
flattered.  In  truth  he  had  reason  to  be. 

Then  Godfrey,  wishing  to  put  the  intelligence  of  the 
black  to  some  profit,  tried  to  make  him  understand  that 
he  wished  to  know  the  name  of  the  island.  He  pointed 
with  his  hand  to  the  woods  and  prairies  and  hills,  and 
then  the  shore  which  bound  them,  and  then  the  horizon 
of  the  sea,  and  he  interrogated  him  with  a  look. 

Carefinotu  did  not  at  first  understand  what  was  meant, 
and  imitating  the  gesture  of  Godfrey  he  also  turned  and 
ran  his  eyes  over  the  space.  "Arneka,"  said  he  at  length. 

"Arneka?"  replied  Godfrey,  striking  the  soil  with  his 
foot  so  as  to  accentuate  his  demand. 

"Arneka!"  repeated  the  negro. 


NEW  ANIMALS  APPEAR  109 

This  told  Godfrey  nothing1,  neither  the  geographical 
name  borne  by  the  island,  nor  its  position  in  the  Pacific. 
He  could  not  remember  such  a  name;  it  was  probably  a 
native  one,  little  known  to  geographers. 

However,  Carefinotu  did  not  cease  from  looking  at  the 
two  white  men,  not  without  some  stupor,  going  from  one 
to  the  other  as  if  he  wished  to  fix  in  his  mind  the  differ- 
ences which  characterized  them.  The  smile  on  his  mouth 
disclosed  abundant  teeth  of  magnificent  whiteness  which 
Tartlet  did  not  examine  without  a  certain  reserve. 

"If  those  teeth,"  he  said,  "have  never  eaten  human 
flesh  may  my  fiddle  burst  up  in  my  hand." 

"Anyhow,  Tartlet,"  answered  Godfrey;  "our  new  com- 
panion no  longer  looks  like  the  poor  beggar  they  were 
going  to  cook  and  feed  on!  That  is  the  main  point!" 

What  particularly  attracted  the  attention  of  Carefinotu 
were  the  weapons  carried  by  Godfrey  and  Tartlet — as 
much  the  musket  in  the  hand  as  the  revolver  in  the  belt. 

Godfrey  easily  understood  this  sentiment  of  curiosity. 
It  was  evident  that  the  savage  had  never  seen  a  fire-arm. 
He  said  to  himself  that  this  was  one  of  those  iron  tubes 
which  had  launched  the  thunderbolt  that  had  delivered  him. 
There  could  be  no  doubt  of  it. 

Godfrey,  wishing  to  give  him,  not  without  reason,  a 
high  idea  of  the  power  of  the  whites,  loaded  his  gun,  and 
then,  showing  to  Carefinotu  a  red-legged  partridge  that 
was  flying  across  the  prairie  about  a  hundred  yards  away, 
he  shouldered  it  quickly,  and  fired.  The  bird  fell. 

At  the  report  the  black  gave  a  prodigious  leap,  which 
Tartlet  could  not  but  admire  from  a  choregraphic  point 
of  view.  Then  repressing  his  fear,  and  seeing  the  bird 
with  broken  wing  running  through  the  grass,  he  started 
off  and  swift  as  a  greyhound  ran  toward  it,  and  with 
many  a  caper,  half  of  joy,  half  of  stupefaction,  brought 
it  back  to  his  master. 

Tartlet  then  thought  of  displaying  to  Carefinotu  that 
the  Great  Spirit  had  also  favored  him  with  the  power  of 
the  lightning;  and  perceiving  a  kingfisher  tranquilly  seated 
on  an  old  stump  near  the  river  was  bringing  the  stock 
up  to  his  cheek,  when  Godfrey  stopped  him  with,  "No! 
Don't  fire,  Tartlet!" 

"Why  not?" 


a  io  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

"Suppose  that  by  some  mishap  you  were  not  to  hit  the 
bird,  think  how  we  would  fall  in  the  estimation  of  the 
negro !" 

"And  why  should  I  not  hit  him?"  replied  Tartlet  with 
some  acerbity.  "Did  I  not,  during  the  battle,  at  more 
than  a  hundred  paces,  the  very  first  time  I  handled  a  gun, 
hit  one  of  the  cannibals  full  in  the  chest?" 

"You  touched  him  evidently,"  said  Godfrey;  "for  he 
fell.  But  take  my  advice,  Tartlet,  and  in  the  common  in- 
terest do  not  tempt  fortune  twice!" 

The  professor,  slightly  annoyed,  allowed  himself  to  be 
convinced;  he  threw  the  gun  on  his  shoulder  with  a 
swagger,  and  both  our  heroes,  followed  by  Carefinotu, 
returned  to  Will  Tree. 

There  the  new  guest  of  Phina  Island  met  with  quite  a 
surprise  in  the  habitation  so  happily  contrived  in  the  lower 
part  of  the  sequoia.  First  he  had  to  be  shown,  by  using 
them  while  he  looked  on,  the  use  of  the  tools,  instru- 
ments, and  utensils.  It  was  obvious  that  Carefinotu  be- 
longed to,  or  had  lived  among  savages  in  the  lowest  rank 
of  the  human  scale,  for  fire  itself  seemed  to  be  unknown 
to  him.  He  could  not  understand  why  the  pot  did  not 
take  fire  when  they  put  it  on  the  blazing  wood;  he  would 
have  hurried  away  from  it,  to  the  great  displeasure  of 
Tartlet,  who  was  watching  the  different  phases  of  the 
cooking  of  the  soup.  At  a  mirror,  which  was  held  out 
to  him,  he  betrayed  consummate  astonishment;  he  turned 
around,  and  turned  it  around  to  see  if  he  himself  were  not 
behind  it. 

"The  fellow  is  hardly  a  monkey!"  exclaimed  the  pro- 
fessor with  a  disdainful  grimace. 

"No,  Tartlet,"  answered  Godfrey;  "he  is  more  than  a 
monkey,  for  his  looks  behind  the  mirror  show  good  rea- 
soning power." 

"Well,  I  will  admit  that  he  is  not  a  monkey,"  said 
Tartlet,  shaking  his  head  as  if  only  half  convinced;  "but 
we  shall  see  if  such  a  thing  can  be  of  any  good  to  us." 

"I  am  sure  he  will  be!"  replied  Godfrey. 

In  any  case  Carefinotu  showed  himself  quite  at  home 
with  the  food  placed  before  him.  He  first  tore  it  apart, 
and  then  tasted  it;  and  then  I  believe  that  the  whole 
breakfast  of  which  they  partook — the  agouti  soup,  the 


NEW  ANIMALS  APPEAR  ill 

partridge  killed  by  Godfrey,  and  the  shoulder  of  mutton 
with  camas  and  yam  roots— would  hardly  have  sufficed  to 
calm  the  hunger  which  devoured  him. 

"The  poor  fellow  has  a  good  appetite!"  said  Godfrey. 

"Yes,"  responded  Tartlet;  "and  we  shall  have  to  keep 
a  watch  on  his  cannibal  instinct." 

"Well,  Tartlet!  We  shall  make  him  get  over  the  taste 
of  human  flesh  if  he  ever  had  it!" 

"I  would  not  swear  that,"  replied  the  professor.  "It 
appears  that  once  they  have  acquired  this  taste — " 

While  they  were  talking,  Carefinotu  was  listening  with 
extreme  attention.  His  eyes  sparkled  with  intelligence. 
One  could  see  that  he  understood  what  was  being  said  in 
his  presence.  He  then  spoke  with  extreme  volubility,  but 
it  was  only  a  succession  of  onomatopoeias  devoid  of  sense, 
of  harsh  interjections  with  a  and  ou  predominant,  as  in 
the  majority  of  Polynesian  idioms. 

Whatever  the  negro  was,  he  was  a  new  companion;  he 
might  become  a  devoted  servant,  which  the  most  unex- 
pected chance  had  sent  to  the  hosts  of  Will  Tree.  He 
was  powerful,  adroit,  active;  no  work  came  amiss  to  him. 
He  showed  a  real  aptitude  to  imitate  what  he  saw  being 
done.  It  was  in  this  way  that  Godfrey  proceeded  with 
his  education.  The  care  of  the  domestic  animals,  the  col- 
lection of  the  roots  and  fruits,  the  cutting  up  of  the  sheep 
or  agouties,  which  were  to  serve  for  food  for  the  day, 
the  fabrication  of  a  sort  of  cider  they  extracted  from  the 
wild  manzanilla  apples — he  acquitted  himself  well  in  all 
these  tasks,  after  having  seen  them  done. 

Whatever  Tartlet  thought,  Godfrey  felt  no  distrust  in 
the  savage,  and  never  seemed  to  regret  having  come  across 
him.  What  disquieted  him  was  the  possible  return  of  the 
cannibals  who  now  knew  the  siKiation  of  Phina  Island. 

From  the  first,  a  bed  had  been  reserved  for  Carefinotu 
in  the  room  at  Will  Tree,  but  generally,  unless  it  was 
raining,  he  preferred  to  sleep  outside  in  some  hole  in  the 
tree,  as  though  he  were  on  guard  over  the  house. 

During  the  fortnight  which  followed  his  arrival  on  the 
island,  Carefinotu  many  times  accompanied  Godfrey  on 
his  shooting  excursions.  His  surprise  was  always  extreme 
when  he  saw  the  game  fall,  hit  at  such  a  distance;  but  in 
his  character  of  retriever,  he  showed  a  dash  and  daring 


112  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

which  no  obstacles,  hedge  or  bush,  or  stream,  could  stop. 

Gradually,  Godfrey  became  greatly  attached  to  this 
negro.  There  was  only  one  part  of  his  progress  in  which 
Carefinotu  showed  refractoriness;  that  was  in  learning 
the  English  language.  Do  what  he  might,  he  could  not 
be  prevailed  upon  to  pronounce  the  most  ordinary  words 
which  Godfrey,  and  particularly  Professor  Tartlet,  tried 
to  teach  him. 

So  the  time  passed.  But  if  the  present  was  fairly  sup- 
portable, thanks  to  a  happy  accident,  if  no  immediate 
danger  menaced  them,  Godfrey  could  not  help  asking 
himself,  if  they  were  ever  to  leave  this  island,  by  what 
means  they  were  to  rejoin  their  country!  Not  a  day 
passed  but  he  thought  of  Uncle  Will  and  his  betrothed. 
It  was  not  without  secret  apprehension  that  he  saw  the 
bad  season  approaching,  which  would  put  between  his 
friends  and  him  a  barrier  still  more  impassable. 

On  the  2/th  of  September  a  circumstance  occurred  de- 
serving of  note.  If  it  gave  more  \vork  to  Godfrey  and 
his  two  companions,  it  at  least  assured  them  of  an  abun- 
dant reserve  of  food.  Godfrey  and  Carefinotu  were  busied 
in  collecting  the  mollusks,  at  the  extreme  end  of  Dream 
Bay,  when  they  perceived  out  at  sea  an  innumerable 
quantity  of  small  moving  islets  which  the  rising  tide  was 
bringing  gently  to  shore.  It  was  a  sort  of  floating  archi- 
pelago, on  the  surface  of  which  there  walked,  or  flew,  a 
few  of  those  sea-birds,  with  great  expanse  of  wing, 
known  as  sea-hawks. 

What  then  were  these  masses  which  floated  landward, 
rising  and  falling  with  the  undulations  of  the  waves? 
Godfrey  did  not  know  what  to  think,  when  Carefinotu 
threw  himself  down  on  his  stomach,  and  then  drawing 
his  head  back  into  his  shoulders,  folded  beneath  him  his 
arms  and  legs,  and  began  to  imitate  the  movements  of  an 
animal  crawling  slowly  along  the  ground. 

Godfrey  looked  at  him  without  understanding  these  ex- 
traordinary gymnastics.  Then  suddenly,  "Turtles!"  he 
exclaimed. 

Carefinotu  was  right.  There  was  quite  a  square  mile  of 
myriads  of  turtles,  swimming  on  the  surface  of  the  water. 

About  a  hundred  fathoms  from  the  shore  the  greater 
part  of  them  dived  and  disappeared,  and  the  sea-hawks, 


NEW  ANIMALS  APPEAR  113 

finding  their  footing  gone,  flew  up  into  the  air  in  large 
spirals.  But  luckily  about  a  hundred  of  the  amphibians 
came  on  to  the  beach. 

Godfrey  and  the  negro  had  quickly  run  down  in  front 
of  these  creatures,  each  of  which  measured  at  the  least 
from  three  to  four  feet  in  diameter.  Now  the  only  way 
of  preventing  turtles  from  regaining  the  sea  is  to  turn 
them  on  their  backs;  and  it  was  in  this  rough  work  that 
Godfrey  and  Carefinotu  employed  themselves,  not  without 
great  fatigue. 

The  following  days  were  spent  in  collecting  the  booty. 
The  flesh  of  the  turtle,  which  is  excellent  fresh  or  pre- 
served, could  perhaps  be  kept  for  a  time  in  both  forms. 
In  preparation  for  the  winter,  Godfrey  had  the  greater 
part  salted  in  such  a  way  as  to  serve  for  the  needs  of 
each  day.  For  some  time  the  table  was  supplied  with 
turtle  soup,  on  which  Tartlet  was  not  the  only  one  to 
regale  himself. 

Barring  this  incident,  the  monotony  of  existence  was  in 
no  way  ruffled.  Every  day  the  same  hours  were  devoted 
to  the  same  work.  Would  not  the  life  become  still  more 
depressing  when  the  winter  season  would  oblige  Godfrey 
and  his  companions  to  shut  themselves  up  in  Will  Tree? 
Godfrey  could  not  think  of  it  without  anxiety.  But  what 
could  he  do? 

Meanwhile,  he  continued  the  exploration  of  the  island, 
and  all  the  time  not  occupied  with  more  pressing  tasks  he 
spent  in  roaming  about  with  his  gun.  Generally  Carefinotu 
accompanied  him,  Tartlet  remaining  behind  at  the  dwell- 
ing. Decidedly  he  was  no  hunter,  although  his  first  shot 
had  been  a  master-stroke! 

On  one  of  these  occasions  an  unexpected  incident  hap- 
pened, of  a  nature  to  gravely  compromise  the  future  safety 
of  the  inmates  of  Will  Tree.  Godfrey  and  the  black  had 
gone  out  hunting  in  the  central  forest,  at  the  foot  of  the 
hill  which  formed  the  principal  ridge  of  Phina  Island. 
Since  the  morning  they  had  seen  nothing  pass  but  two  or 
three  antelopes  through  the  high  underwood,  but  at  too 
great  a  distance  for  them  to  fire  with  any  chance  of  hit- 
ting them.  As  Godfrey  was  not  in  search  of  game  for 
dinner,  and  did  not  seek  to  destroy  for  destruction's  sake, 
he  resigned  himself  to  return  empty-handed.  If  he  re- 

Vol.  13  Verne 


114  ROBIlNSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

gretted  doing  so  it  was  not  so  much  for  the  meat  of  the 
antelope,  as  for  the  skin,  of  which  he  intended  to  make 
good  use. 

It  was  about  three  o'clock  in  the  afternoon.  He  and 
his  companion  after  lunch  were  no  more  fortunate  than 
before.  They  were  preparing  to  return  to  Will  Tree  for 
dinner,  when,  just  as  they  cleared  the  edge  of  the  wood, 
Carefinotu  made  a  bound;  then  precipitating  himself  on 
Godfrey,  he  seized  him  by  the  shoulders,  and  dragged  him 
along  with  such  vigor  that  resistance  was  impossible. 

After  going  about  twenty  yards  they  stopped.  Godfrey 
took  breath,  and,  turning  toward  Carefinotu,  interrogated 
him  with  a  look. 

The  black,  exceedingly  frightened,  stretched  out  his 
hand  toward  an  animal  which  was  standing  motionless 
about  fifty  yards  off. 

It  was  a  grizzly  bear,  whose  paws  held  the  trunk  of  a 
tree,  and  who  was  swaying  his  big  head  up  and  down,  as 
if  he  were  going  to  rush  at  the  two  hunters. 

Immediately,  without  pausing  to  think,  Godfrey  loaded 
his  gun,  and  fired  before  Carefinotu  could  hinder  him. 

Was  the  enormous  plantigrade  hit  by  the  bullet?  Prob- 
ably. Was  he  killed?  They  could  not  be  sure,  but  his 
paws  unclasped,  and  he  rolled  at  the  foot  of  the  tree. 
Delay  was  dangerous.  A  struggle  with  so  formidable  an 
animal  might  have  the  worst  results.  In  the  forests  of 
California  the  pursuit  of  the  grizzly  is  fraught  with  the 
greatest  danger,  even  to  professional  hunters  of  the  beast. 

And  so  the  black  seized  Godfrey  by  the  arms  to  drag 
him  away  in  the  direction  of  Will  Tree,  and  Godfrey, 
understanding  that  he  could  not  be  too  cautious,  made  no 
resistance. 


CHAPTER  XVIII 

A   DANGEROUS    FOE 

THE  presence  of  a  formidable  wild  beast  in  Phina  Island 
was,  it  must  be  confessed,  calculated  to  make  our  friends 
think  the  worst  of  the  ill-fortune  which  had  fallen  on 
them. 

Godfrey — perhaps  he  was  wrong — did  not  consider  that 


A  DANGEROUS  FOE 

he  ought  to  hide  from  Tartlet  what  had  passed.  "A 
bear !"  screamed  the  professor,  looking  around  him  with  a 
bewildered  glare  as  if  the  environs  of  Will  Tree  were 
being  assailed  by  a  herd  of  wild  beasts.  "Why,  a  bear? 
Up  to  now  we  had  not  a  bear  in  our  island!  If  there  is 
one  there  may  be  many,  and  even  numbers  of  other 
ferocious  beasts — jaguars,  panthers,  tigers,  hyaenas,  lions!" 

Tartlet  already  beheld  Phina  Island  given  over  to  quite 
a  menagerie  escaped  from  their  cages. 

Godfrey  answered  that  there  was  no  need  for  him  to 
exaggerate.  He  had  seen  one  bear,  that  was  certain. 
Why  one  of  these  animals  had  never  been  seen  before  in 
his  wanderings  on  the  island  he  could  not  explain,  and  it 
was  indeed  inexplicable.  But  to  conclude  from  this  that 
wild  animals  of  all  kinds  were  prowling  in  the  woods  and 
prairies  was  to  go  too  far.  Nevertheless,  they  would  have 
to  be  cautious  and  never  go  out  unarmed. 

Unhappy  Tartlet!  From  this  day  there  commenced  for 
him  an  existence  of  anxieties,  emotions,  alarms,  and  irra- 
tional terrors  which  gave  him  nostalgia  for  his  native 
land  in  a  most  acute  form.  "No!"  repeated  he.  "No! 
If  there  are  animals — I  have  had  enough  of  it,  and  I 
want  to  get  off!" 

Godfrey  and  his  companions  then  had  henceforth  to  be 
on  their  guard.  An  attack  might  take  place  not  only  on 
the  shore  side  or  the  prairie  side,  but  even  in  the  group  of 
sequoias.  This  is  why  serious  measures  were  taken  to  put 
the  habitation  in  a  state  to  repel  a  sudden  attack.  The 
door  was  strengthened,  so  as  to  resist  the  clutches  of  a 
wild  beast.  As  for  the  domestic  animals  Godfrey  would 
have  built  a  stable  to  shut  them  up  in  at  least  at  night, 
but  it  was  not  easy  to  do  so.  He  contented  himself  at 
present  with  making  a  sort  of  enclosure  of  branches  not 
far  from  Will  Tree,  which  would  keep  them  as  in  a  fold. 
But  the  enclosure  was  not  solid  enough  nor  high  enough 
to  hinder  a  bear  or  hyaena  from  upsetting  it  or  getting 
over  it. 

Notwithstanding  the  remonstrances  made  to  him,  Care- 
finotu persisted  in  watching  outside  during  the  night,  and 
Godfrey  hoped  thus  to  receive  warning  of  a  direct  attack. 

Decidedly  Carefinotu  endangered  his  life  in  thus  consti- 
tuting himself  the  guardian  of  Will  Tree;  but  he  had 


ii6  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

understood  that  he  could  thus  be  of  service  to  his  liber- 
ators, and  he  persisted,  in  spite  of  all  Godfrey  said  to  him/ 
in  watching  as  usual  over  the  general  safety. 

A  week  passed  without  any  of  these  formidable  visitors 
appearing  in  the  neighborhood.  Godfrey  did  not  go  very 
far  from  the  dwelling,  unless  there  was  a  necessity  for  his 
doing  so.  While  the  sheep  and  goats  grazed  on  the 
neighboring  prairie,  they  were  never  allowed  out  of  sight. 
Generally  Carefinotu  acted  as  shepherd.  He  did  not  take 
a  gun,  for  he  did  not  seem  to  understand  the  management 
of  fire-arms,  but  one  of  the  hunting-knives  hung  from  his 
belt,  and  he  carried  an  axe  in  his  right  hand.  Thus  armed 
the  active  negro  would  not  have  hesitated  to  throw  him- 
self before  a  tiger  or  any  animal  of  the  worst  description. 

However,  as  neither  a  bear  nor  any  of  his  congeners 
had  appeared  since  the  last  encounter  Godfrey  began  to 
gather  confidence.  He  gradually  resumed  his  hunting  ex- 
peditions, but  without  pushing  far  into  the  interior  of  the 
island.  Frequently  the  black  accompanied  him;  Tartlet, 
safe  in  Will  Tree,  would  not  risk  himself  in  the  open,  not 
even  if  he  had  the  chance  of  giving  a  dancing  lesson. 
Sometimes  Godfrey  would  go  alone,  and  then  the  profes- 
sor had  a  companion  to  whose  instruction  he  obstinately 
devoted  himself. 

Yes!  Tartlet  had  at  first  thought  of  teaching  Care- 
finotu the  most  ordinary  words  in  the  English  language, 
but  he  had  to  give  this  up,  as  the  negro  seemed  to  lack 
the  necessary  phonetic  apparatus  for  that  kind  of  pro- 
nunciation. "Then,"  had  Tartlet  said,  "if  I  cannot  be  his 
professor,  I  will  be  his  pupil!" 

And  he  it  was  who  attempted  to  learn  the  idiom  spoken 
by  Carefinotu.  Godfrey  had  warned  him  that  the  accom- 
plishment would  be  of  little  use.  Tartlet  was  not  dis- 
suaded. He  tried  to  get  Carefinotu  to  name  the  objects 
he  pointed  at  with  his  hand.  In  truth  Tartlet  must  have 
got  on  excellently,  for  at  the  end  of  fifteen  days  he 
actually  knew  fifteen  words!  He  knew  that  Carefinotu 
said  "birsi"  for  fire,  "aradore"  for  the  sky,  "mervira"  for 
the  sea,  "doura"  for  a  tree,  etc.  He  was  as  proud  of  this 
as  if  he  had  taken  the  first  prize  for  Polynesian  at  some 
examination ! 

It  was  then  with  a  feeling  of  gratitude  that  he  wished 


A  DANGEROUS  FOE  117 

to  make  some  recognition  of  what  had  been  done  for  him, 
and  instead  of  torturing  the  negro  with  English  words,  he 
resolved  on  teaching  him  deportment  and  the  true  prin- 
ciples of  European  choregraphy. 

At  this  Godfrey  could  not  restrain  his  peals  of  laughter. 
After  all  it  would  pass  the  time  away,  and  on  Sunday, 
when  there  was  nothing  else  to  do,  he  willingly  assisted 
at  the  course  of  lectures  delivered  by  the  celebrated  Profes- 
sor Tartlet  of  San  Francisco.  Indeed,  we  ought  to  have 
seen  them!  The  unhappy  Carefinotu  perspired  profusely 
as  he  went  through  the  elementary  exercises.  He  was 
docile  and  willing,  nevertheless;  but  like  all  his  fellows, 
his  shoulders  did  not  set  back,  nor  did  his  chest  throw 
out,  nor  did  his  knees  or  his  feet  point  apart!  To  make  a 
Vestris  or  a  Saint  Leon  of  a  savage  of  this  sort! 

The  professor  pursued  his  task  in  quite  a  fury.  Care- 
finotu, tortured  as  he  was,  showed  no  lack  of  zeal.  What 
he  suffered,  even  to  get  his  feet  into  the  first  position,  can 
be  imagined!  And  when  he  passed  to  the  second  and 
then  to  the  third,  it  was  still  more  agonizing. 

"But  look  at  me,  you  blockhead!"  exclaimed  Tartlet, 
who  added  example  to  precept.  "Put  your  feet  out! 
Further  out!  The  heel  of  one  to  the  heel  of  the  other! 
Open  your  knees,  you  duffer!  Put  back  your  shoulders, 
you  idiot!  Stick  up  your  head!  Round  your  elbows!" 

"But  you  ask  what  is  impossible!"  said  Godfrey. 

"Nothing  is  impossible  to  an  intelligent  man!"  was 
Tartlet's  invariable  response. 

"But  his  build  won't  allow  of  it." 

"Well,  his  build  must  allow  of  it!  He  will  have  to  do 
it  sooner  or  later,  for  the  savage  must  at  least  know  how 
to  present  himself  properly  in  a  drawing-room!" 

"But,  Tartlet,  he  will  never  have  the  opportunity  of 
appearing  in  a  drawing-room!" 

"Eh!  How  do  you  know  that,  Godfrey?"  replied  the 
professor,  drawing  himself  up.  "Do  you  know  what  the 
future  may  bring  forth?" 

This  was  the  last  word  in  all  discussions  with  Tartlet. 
And  then  the  professor  taking  his  kit  would  with  the  bow 
extract  from  it  some  squeaky  little  air  to  the  delight  of 
Carefinotu.  It  required  but  this  to  excite  him.  Oblivious 
of  choregraphic  rules,  what  leaps,  what  contortions,  what 


Ii8  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

capers!  And  Tartlet,  in  a  reverie,  as  he  saw  this  child  of 
Polynesia  so  demean  himself,  inquired  if  these  steps,  per- 
haps a  little  too  characteristic,  were  not  natural  to  the 
human  being,  although  outside  all  the  principles  of  his  art. 

But  we  must  leave  the  professor  of  dancing  and  deport- 
ment to  his  philosophical  meditations,  and  return  to  ques- 
tions at  once  more  practical  and  pressing.  During  his 
last  excursions  into  the  plain,  either  by  himself  or  with 
Carefinotu,  Godfrey  had  seen  no  wild  animal.  He  had 
even  come  upon  no  traces  of  such.  The  river  to  which 
they  would  come  to  drink  bore  no  footprint  on  its  banks. 
During  the  night  there  were  no  howlings  nor  suspicious 
noises.  Besides  the  domestic  animals  continued  to  give 
no  signs  of  uneasiness. 

"This  is  singular,"  said  Godfrey  several  times;  "but  I 
was  not  mistaken!  Carefinotu  certainly  was  not!  It  was 
really  a  bear  that  he  showed  me!  It  was  really  a  bear 
that  I  shot!  Supposing  I  killed  him,  was  he  the  last 
representative  of  the  plantigrades  on  the  island?" 

It  was  quite  inexplicable!  Besides,  if  Godfrey  had 
killed  this  bear,  he  would  have  found  the  body  where  he 
had  shot  it.  Now  they  searched  for  it  in  vain!  Were 
they  to  believe  then  that  the  animal  mortally  wounded  had 
died  far  off  in  some  den?  It  was  possible  after  all,  but 
then  at  this  place,  at  the  foot  of  this  tree,  there  would 
have  been  traces  of  blood,  and  there  were  none. 

"Whatever  it  is,"  thought  Godfrey,  "it  does  not  much 
matter;  and  we  must  keep  on  our  guard." 

With  the  first  days  of  November  it  could  be  said  that 
the  wet  season  had  commenced  in  this  unknown  latitude. 
Cold  rains  fell  for  many  hours.  Later  on  probably  they 
would  experience  those  interminable  showers  which  do 
not  cease  for  weeks  at  a  time,  and  are  characteristic  of  the 
rainy  period  of  winter  in  these  latitudes. 

Godfrey  had  then  to  contrive  a  fireplace  in  the  interior 
of  Will  Tree — an  indispensable  fireplace  that  would  serve 
as  well  to  warm  the  dwelling  during  the  winter  months  as 
to  cook  their  food  in  shelter  from  the  rain  and  tempest. 

The  hearth  could  at  any  time  be  placed  in  a  corner  of 
the  chamber  between  big  stones,  some  placed  on  the 
ground,  and  others  built  up  around  them ;  but  the  question 
was  how  to  get  the  smoke  out,  for  to  leave  it  to  escape 


A  DANGEROUS  FOE  119 

by  the  long  chimney,  which  ran  down  the  center  of  the 
sequoia,  proved  impracticable. 

Godfrey  thought  of  using  as  a  pipe  some  of  those  long 
stout  bamboos  which  grew  on  certain  parts  of  the  river 
banks.  It  should  be  said  that  on  this  occasion  he  was 
greatly  assisted  by  Carefinotu.  The  negro,  not  without 
effort,  understood  what  Godfrey  required.  He  it  was  who 
accompanied  him  for  a  couple  of  miles  from  Will  Tree  to 
select  the  larger  bamboos;  he  it  was  who  helped  him  build 
his  hearth.  The  stones  were  placed  on  the  ground  opposite 
to  the  door;  the  bamboos,  emptied  of  their  pith  and  bored 
through  at  the  knots,  afforded,  when  joined  one  to  another, 
a  tube  of  sufficient  length,  which  ran  out  through  an 
aperture  made  for  it  in  the  sequoia  bark,  and  would  serve 
every  purpose,  provided  it  did  not  catch  fire.  Godfrey 
soon  had  the  satisfaction  of  seeing  a  good  fire  burning 
without  filling  the  interior  of  Will  Tree  with  smoke. 

He  was  quite  right  in  hastening  on  these  preparations, 
for  from  the  3rd  to  the  loth  of  November  the  rain  never 
ceased  pouring  down.  It  would  have  been  impossible  to 
keep  a  fire  going  in  the  open  air.  During  these  miserable 
days  they  had  to  keep  indoors  and  did  not  venture  out 
except  when  the  flocks  and  poultry  urgently  required  them 
to  do  so.  Under  these  circumstances  the  reserve  of  camas 
roots  began  to  fail;  and  these  were  what  took  the  place 
of  bread,  and  of  which  the  want  would  be  immediately 
felt. 

Godfrey  then  one  day,  the  loth  of  November,  informed 
Tartlet  that  as  soon  as  the  weather  began  to  mend  a  little 
he  and  Carefinotu  would  go  out  and  collect  some.  Tart- 
let, who  was  never  in  a  hurry  to  run  a  couple  of  miles 
across  a  soaking  prairie,  decided  to  remain  at  home  dur- 
ing Godfrey's  absence. 

In  the  evening  the  sky  began  to  clear  of  the  heavy 
clouds  which  the  west  wind  had  been  accumulating  since 
the  commencement  of  the  month,  the  rain  gradually  ceased, 
the  sun  gave  forth  a  few  crepuscular  rays.  It  was  to  be 
hoped  that  the  morning  would  yield  a  lull  in  the  storm, 
of  which  it  was  advisable  to  make  the  most. 

"Tomorrow,"  said  Godfrey,  "I  will  go  out,  and  Care- 
finotu will  go  with  me." 

"Agreed!"  answered  Tartlet. 


120  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

The  evening  came,  and  when  supper  was  finished  and 
the  sky,  cleared  of  clouds,  permitted  a  few  brilliant  stars 
to  appear,  the  black  wished  to  take  up  his  accustomed 
place  outside,  which  he  had  had  to  abandon  during  the 
preceding  rainy  nights.  Godfrey  tried  to  make  him  under- 
stand that  he  had  better  remain  indoors,  that  there  was 
no  necessity  to  keep  a  watch  as  no  wild  animal  had  been 
noticed;  but  Carefinotu  was  obstinate.  He  therefore  had 
to  have  his  way. 

The  morning  was  as  Godfrey  had  foreseen,  no  rain  had 
fallen  since  the  previous  evening,  and  when  he  stepped 
forth  from  Will  Tree,  the  first  rays  of  the  sun  were  lightly 
gilding  the  thick  dome  of  the  sequoias. 

Carefinotu  was  at  his  post,  where  he  had  passed  the 
night.  He  was  waiting.  Immediately,  well  armed  and 
provided  with  large  sacks,  the  two  bade  farewell  to  Tartlet, 
and  started  for  the  river,  which  they  intended  ascending 
along  the  left  bank  up  to  the  camas  bushes. 

An  hour  afterward  they  arrived  there  without  meeting 
with  any  unpleasant  adventure.  The  roots  were  rapidly 
torn  up  and  a  large  quantity  obtained,  so  as  to  fill  the 
sacks.  This  took  three  hours,  so  that  it  was  about  eleven 
o'clock  in  the  morning  when  Godfrey  and  his  companion 
set  out  on  their  return  to  Will  Tree. 

Walking  close  together,  keeping  a  sharp  look-out,  for 
they  could  not  talk  to  each  other,  they  had  reached  a  bend 
in  the  small  river  where  there  were  a  few  large  trees, 
grown  like  a  natural  cradle  across  the  stream,  when  God- 
frey suddenly  stopped. 

This  time  it  was  he  who  showed  to  Carefinotu  a  mo- 
tionless animal  at  the  foot  of  a  tree  whose  eyes  were 
gleaming  with  a  singular  light 

"A  tiger!"  he  exclaimed. 

He  was  not  mistaken.  It  was  really  a  tiger  of  large 
stature  resting  on  its  hind  legs  with  its  forepaws  on  the 
trunk  of  a  tree,  and  ready  to  spring. 

In  a  moment  Godfrey  had  dropped  his  sack  of  roots. 
The  loaded  gun  passed  into  his  right  hand;  he  cocked  it, 
presented  it,  aimed  it,  and  fired. 

"Hurrah!  hurrah!"  he  exclaimed. 

This  time  there  was  no  room  for  doubt;  the  tiger, 
struck  by  the  bullet,  had  bounded  backward.  But  perhaps 


THE  MYSTERY  BECOMES  DEEPER        121' 

he  was  not  mortally  wounded,  perhaps  rendered  still  more 
furious  by  his  wound  he  would  spring  on  to  them!  God- 
frey held  his  gun  pointed,  and  threatened  the  animal  with 
his  second  barrel. 

But  before  Godfrey  could  stop  him,  Carefinotu  had 
rushed  at  the  place  where  the  tiger  disappeared,  his  hunt- 
ing-knife in  his  hand. 

Godfrey  shouted  for  him  to  stop,  to  come  back!  It 
was  in  vain.  The  black,  resolved  even  at  the  risk  of  his 
life  to  finish  the  animal  which  perhaps  was  only  wounded, 
did  not  or  would  not  hear.  Godfrey  rushed  after  him. 

When  he  reached  the  bank,  he  saw  Carefinotu  strug- 
gling with  the  tiger,  holding  him  by  the  throat,  and  at 
last  stabbing  him  to  the  heart  with  a  powerful  blow. 

The  tiger  then  rolled  into  the  river,  of  which  the 
waters,  swollen  by  the  rains,  carried  it  away  with  the 
quickness  of  a  torrent.  The  corpse,  which  floated  only 
for  an  instant,  was  swiftly  borne  off  toward  the  sea. 

A  bear!  A  tiger!  There  could  be  no  doubt  that  the 
island  did  contain  formidable  beasts  of  prey! 

Godfrey,  after  rejoining  Carefinotu,  found  that  in  the 
struggle  the  black  had  only  received  a  few  scratches.  Then, 
deeply  anxious  about  the  future,  he  retook  the  road  to 
Will  Tree. 


CHAPTER  XIX 

THE    MYSTERY    BECOMES    DEEPER 

WHEN  Tartlet  learned  that  there  were  not  only  bears  in 
the  island,  but  tigers,  too,  his  lamentations  again  arose. 
Now  he  would  never  dare  to  go  out!  The  wild  beasts 
would  end  by  discovering  the  road  to  Will  Tree!  There 
was  no  longer  any  safety  anywhere!  In  his  alarm  the 
professor  wanted  for  his  protection  quite  a  fortification! 
Yes!  Stone  walls  with  scarps  and  counterscarps,  curtains 
and  bastions,  and  ramparts,  for  what  was  the  use  of  a 
shelter  under  a  group  of  sequoias?  Above  all  things,  he 
would  at  all  risks,  like  to  be  off. 

"So  would  I,"  answered  Godfrey  quietly. 

In  fact,  the  conditions  miti^r  wftich  the  castaways  on 
Phina  Island  had  Jived  up  to  now  were  no  longer  the 


122  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

same.  To  struggle  to  the  end,  to  struggle  for  ttie  neces- 
saries of  life,  they  had  been  able,  thanks  to  fortunate 
circumstances.  Against  the  bad  season,  against  winter 
and  its  menaces,  they  knew  how  to  act,  but  to  have  to 
defend  themselves  against  wild  animals,  whose  attack  was 
possible  every  minute,  was  another  thing  altogether;  and 
in  fact  they  could  not  do  it. 

The  situation,  already  complicated,  had  become  very 
serious,  for  it  had  become  intolerable. 

"But,"  repeated  Godfrey  to  himself,  without  cessation, 
"how  is  it  that  for  four  months  we  did  not  see  a  single 
beast  of  prey  on  the  island,  and  why  during  the  last  fort- 
night have  we  had  to  encounter  a  bear  and  a  tiger?  What 
shall  we  say  to  that?" 

The  fact  might  be  inexplicable,  but  it  was  none  the 
less  real.  Godfrey,  whose  coolness  and  courage  increased 
as  difficulties  grew,  was  not  cast  down.  If  dangerous 
animals  menaced  their  little  colony,  it  was  better  to  put 
themselves  on  guard  against  their  attacks,  and  that  with- 
out delay. 

But  what  was  to  be  done?  It  was  at  the  outset  decided 
that  excursions  into  the  woods  or  to  the  sea-shore  should 
be  rarer,  and  that  they  should  never  go  out  unless  well 
armed,  and  only  when  it  was  absolutely  necessary  for 
their  wants. 

"We  have  been  lucky  enough  in  our  two  encounters!" 
said  Godfrey  frequently;  "but  there  may  come  a  time 
when  we  may  not  shoot  so  straight!  So  there  is  no 
necessity  for  us  to  run  into  danger!" 

At  the  same  time  they  had  not  only  to  settle  about  the 
excursions,  but  to  protect  WTill  Tree — not  only  the  dwell- 
ing, but  the  annexes,  the  poultry  roost,  and  the  fold  for 
the  animals,  where  the  wild  beasts  could  easily  cause 
irreparable  disaster. 

Godfrey  thought  then,  if  not  of  fortifying  Will  Tree 
according  to  the  famous  plans  of  Tartlet,  at  least  of  con- 
necting the  four  or  five  large  sequoias  which  surrounded  it. 

If  he  could  devise  a  high  and  strong  palisade  from  one 
tree  to  another,  they  would  be  in  comparative  security  at 
any  rate  from  a  surprise. 

It  was  practicable — Godfrey  concluded  so  after  an  ex- 
amination of  the  ground — but  it  would  cost  a  good  deal 


THE  MYSTERY  BECOMES  DEEPER        123 

of  labor.  To  reduce  this  as  much  as  possible,  he  thought 
of  erecting  the  palisade  around  a  perimeter  of  only  some 
three  hundred  feet.  We  can  judge  from  this  the  number 
of  trees  he  had  to  select,  cut  down,  carry,  and  trim  until 
the  enclosure  was  complete. 

Godfrey  did  not  quail  before  his  task.  He  imparted 
his  projects  to  Tartlet,  who  approved  them,  and  promised 
his  active  co-operation;  but  what  was  more  important,  he 
made  his  plans  understood  to  Carefinotu,  who  was  always 
ready  to  come  to  his  assistance. 

They  set  to  work  without  delay.  There  was  at  a  bend 
in  the  stream,  about  a  mile  from  Will  Tree,  a  small  wood 
of  stone  pines  of  medium  height,  whose  trunks,  in  default 
of  beams  and  planks,  without  wanting  to  be  squared, 
would,  by  being  placed  close  together,  form  a  solid  pali- 
sade. 

It  was  to  this  wood  that,  at  dawn  on  the  I2th  of 
November,  Godfrey  and  his  two  companions  repaired. 
Though  well  armed  they  advanced  with  great  care. 

"You  can  have  too  much  of  this  sort  of  thing,"  mur- 
mured Tartlet,  whom  these  new  difficulties  had  rendered 
still  more  discontented.  "I  would  rather  be  off!" 

But  Godfrey  did  not  take  the  trouble  to  reply  to  him. 
On  this  occasion  his  tastes  were  not  being  consulted,  his 
intelligence  even  was  not  being  appealed  to.  It  was  the 
assistance  of  his  arms  that  the  common  interest  demanded. 
In  short,  he  had  to  resign  himself  to  his  vocation  of  beast 
of  burden. 

No  unpleasant  accident  happened  in  the  mile  which 
separated  the  wood  from  Will  Tree.  In  vain  they  had 
carefully  beaten  the  underwood,  and  swept  the  horizon  all 
around  them.  The  domestic  animals  they  had  left  out  at 
pasture  gave  no  sign  of  alarm.  The  birds  continued  their 
frolics  with  no  more  anxiety  than  usual. 

Work  immediately  began.  Godfrey,  very  properly  did 
not  want  to  begin  carrying  until  all  the  trees  he  wanted 
had  been  felled.  They  could  work  at  them  in  greater 
safety  on  the  spot. 

Carefinotu  was  of  great  service  during  this  toilsome 
task.  He  had  become  very  clever  in  the  use  of  the  axe 
and  saw.  His  strength  even  allowed  him  to  continue  at 
work  when  Godfrey  was  obliged  to  rest  for  a  minute  or 


124  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

so,  and  when  Tartlet,  with  bruised  hands  and  aching 
limbs,  had  not  even  strength  left  to  lift  his  fiddle. 

However,  although  the  unfortunate  professor  of  dancing 
and  deportment  had  been  transformed  into  a  wood-cutter, 
Godfrey  had  reserved  for  him  the  least  fatiguing  part,  that 
is,  the  clearing  off  of  the  smaller  branches.  In  spite  of 
this,  if  Tartlet  had  only  been  paid  half  a  dollar  a  day,  he 
would  have  stolen  four-fifths  of  his  salary! 

For  six  days,  from  the  I2th  to  the  i7th  of  November, 
these  labors  continued.  Our  friends  went  off  in  the  morn- 
ing at  dawn,  they  took  their  food  with  them,  and  they 
did  not  return  to  Will  Tree  until  evening.  The  sky  was 
not  very  clear.  Heavy  clouds  frequently  accumulated 
over  it.  It  was  harvest  weather,  with  alternating  showers 
and  sunshine;  and  during  the  showers  the  wood-cutters 
would  take  shelter  under  the  trees,  and  resume  their  task 
when  the  rain  had  ceased. 

On  the  1 8th  all  the  trees,  topped  and  cleared  of  branches, 
were  lying  on  the  ground,  ready  for  transport  to  Will 
Tree. 

During  this  time  no  wild  beast  had  appeared  in  the 
neighborhood  of  the  river.  The  question  was,  were  there 
any  more  in  the  island,  or  had  the  bear  and  the  tiger 
been — a  most  improbable  event — the  last  of  their  species? 

Whatever  it  was,  Godfrey  had  no  intention  of  abandon- 
ing his  project  of  the  solid  palisade  so  as  to  be  prepared 
against  a  surprise  from  savages,  or  bears,  or  tigers.  Be- 
sides, the  worst  was  over,  and  there  only  remained  to 
take  the  wood  where  it  was  wanted. 

We  say  "the  worst  was  over,"  though  the  carriage  prom- 
ised to  be  somewhat  laborious.  If  it  were  not  so,  it  was 
because  Godfrey  had  had  a  very  practical  idea,  which 
materially  lightened  the  task;  this  was  to  make  use  of  the 
current  of  the  river,  which  the  flood  occasioned  by  the 
recent  rains  had  rendered  very  rapid,  to  transport  the 
wood.  Small  rafts  could  be  formed,  and  they  would 
quietly  float  down  to  the  sequoias,  where  a  bar,  formed 
by  the  small  bridge,  would  stop  them.  From  thence  to 
Will  Tree  was  only  about  fifty-five  paces.  If  any  of  them 
showed  particular  satisfaction  at  this  mode  of  procedure, 
it  was  Tartlet. 

On  the  iSththe  first  rafts  were  formed,  and  they  arrived 


THE  MYSTERY  BECOMES  DEEPER        125 

at  the  barrier  without  accident.  In  less  than  three  days, 
on  the  evening  of  the  25th,  the  palisade  had  been  all  sent 
down  to  its  destination. 

On  the  morrow,  the  first  trunks,  sunk  two  feet  in  the 
soil,  began  to  rise  in  such  a  manner  as  to  connect  the 
principal  sequoias  which  surrounded  Will  Tree.  A  cap- 
ping of  strong  flexible  branches,  pointed  by  the  axe,  as- 
sured the  solidity  of  the  wall. 

Godfrey  saw  the  work  progress  with  extreme  satisfac- 
tion, and  delayed  not  until  it  was  finished.  "Once  the 
palisade  is  done/'  he  said  to  Tartlet,  "we  shall  be  really 
at  home/' 

"We  shall  not  be  really  at  home,"  replied  the  professor 
dryly,  "until  we  are  in  Montgomery  Street,  with  your 
Uncle  Kolderup."  There  was  no  disputing  this  opinion. 

On  the  26th  of  November  the  palisade  was  three  parts 
done.  It  comprised  among  the  sequoias  attached  one 
to  another  that  in  which  the  poultry  had  established 
themselves,  and  Godfrey's  intention  was  to  build  a  stable 
inside  it.  In  three  or  four  days  the  fence  was  finished. 
There  only  remaned  to  fit  in  a  solid  door,  which  would 
assure  the  closure  of  Will  Tree. 

But  on  the  morning  of  the  27th  of  November  the  work 
was  interrupted  by  an  event  which  we  had  better  explain 
with  some  detail,  for  it  was  one  of  those  unaccountable 
things  peculiar  to  Phina  Island. 

About  eight  o'clock,  Carefinotu  had  climbed  up  to  the 
fork  of  the  sequoia,  so  as  to  more  carefully  close  the  hole 
by  which  the  cold  and  rain  penetrated,  when  he  uttered  a 
singular  cry.  Godfrey,  who  was  at  work  at  the  palisade, 
raised  his  head  and  saw  the  black,  with  expressive  ges- 
tures, motioning  to  him  to  join  him  without  delay. 

Godfrey,  thinking  Carefinotu  would  not  have  disturbed 
him  unless  he  had  serious  reason,  took  his  glasses  with  him 
and  climbed  up  the  interior  passage,  and  passing  through 
the  hole,  seated  himself  astride  of  one  of  the  main 
branches.  Carefinotu,  pointing  with  his  arm  toward  the 
rounded  angle  which  Phina  Island  made  to  the  north-east, 
showed  a  column  of  smoke  rising  in  the  air  like  a  long 
plume. 

"Again!"  exclaimed  Godfrey.  And  putting  his  glasses 
in  the  direction,  he  assured  himself  that  this  time  there 


126  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

was  no  possible  error,  that  it  must  escape  from  some  im- 
portant fire,  which  he  could  distinctly  see  must  be  about 
five  miles  off. 

Godfrey  turned  toward  the  black.  Carefinotu  expressed 
his  surprise,  by  his  looks,  his  exclamations,  in  fact  by 
his  whole  attitude.  Assuredly  he  was  no  less  astounded 
than  Godfrey  at  this  apparition. 

Besides,  in  the  offing,  there  was  no  ship,  not  a  vessel, 
native  or  other,  nothing  which  showed  that  a  landing  had 
recently  been  made  on  the  shore. 

"Ah!  This  time  I  will  find  out  the  fire  which  produces 
that  smoke!"  exclaimed  Godfrey. 

And  pointing  to  the  north-east  angle  of  the  island,  and 
then  to  the  foot  of  the  tree,  he  gesticulated  to  Carefinotu 
that  he  wished  to  reach  the  place  without  losing  an  instant. 

Carefinotu  understood  him.  He  even  gave  him  to  under- 
stand that  he  approved  of  the  idea. 

"Yes,"  said  Godfrey  to  himself,  "if  there  is  a  human 
being  there,  we  must  know  who  he  is  and  whence  he 
comes!  We  must  know  why  he  hides  himself!  It  will  be 
for  the  safety  of  all !" 

A  moment  afterward  Carefinotu  and  he  descended  to 
the  foot  of  Will  Tree.  Then  Godfrey,  informing  Tartlet 
of  what  had  passed  and  what  he  was  going  to  do,  proposed 
for  him  to  accompany  them  to  the  north  coast.  A  dozen 
miles  to  traverse  in  one  day  was  not  a  very  tempting  sug- 
gestion to  a  man  who  regarded  his  legs  as  the  most  prec- 
ious part  of  his  body,  and  only  designed  for  noble  exer- 
cises. And  so  he  replied  that  he  would  prefer  to  remain 
at  Will  Tree. 

"Very  well,  we  will  go  alone,"  answered  Godfrey,  "but 
do  not  expect  us  until  the  evening."  So  saying,  Carefi- 
notu and  he  carrying  some  provisions  for  lunch  on  the 
road,  set  out  after  taking  leave  of  the  professor,  whose 
private  opinion  it  was  that  they  would  find  nothing,  and 
that  all  their  fatigue  would  be  useless. 

Godfrey  took  his  musket  and  revolver;  the  black  the 
axe  and  the  hunting-knife  which  had  become  his  favorite 
weapon.  They  crossed  the  plank  bridge  to  the  right  bank 
of  the  river,  and  then  struck  off  across  the  prairie  to  the 
point  on  the  shore  where  the  smoke  had  been  seen  rising 
among  the  rocks.  It  was  rather  more  easterly  than  the 


THE  MYSTERY  BECOMES  DEEPER         127 

place  which  Godfrey  had  uselessly  visited  on  his  second 
exploration. 

They  progressed  rapidly,  not  without  a  sharp  look-out 
that  the  wood  was  clear  and  that  the  bushes  and  under- 
wood did  not  hide  some  animal  whose  attack  might  be 
formidable.  Nothing  disquieting  occurred. 

At  noon,  after  having  had  some  food,  without,  however, 
stopping  for  an  instant,  they  reached  the  first  line  of  rocks 
which  bordered  the  beach.  The  smoke,  still  visible,  was 
rising  about  a  quarter  of  a  mile  ahead.  They  had  only  to 
keep  straight  on  to  reach  their  goal. 

They  hastened  their  steps,  but  took  precautions  so  as  to 
surprise,  and  not  be  surprised. 

Two  minutes  afterward  the  smoke  disappeared,  as  if 
the  fire  had  been  suddenly  extinguished.  But  Godfrey 
had  noted  with  exactness  the  spot  whence  it  arose.  It  was 
at  the  point  of  a  strangely  formed  rock,  a  sort  of  truncated 
pyramid,  easily  recognizable.  Showing  this  to  his  com- 
panion, he  kept  straight  on.  The  quarter  of  a  mile  was 
soon  traversed,  then  the  last  line  was  climbed,  and  Godfrey 
and  Carefinotu  gained  the  beach  about  fifty  paces  from 
the  rock. 

They  ran  up  to  it.  Nobody!  But  this  time  half- 
smoldering  embers  and  half -burned  wood  proved  clearly 
that  the  fire  had  been  alight  on  the  spot. 

"There  has  been  some  one  here!"  exclaimed  Godfrey. 
"Some  one  not  a  moment  ago!  We  must  find  out  who!" 

He  shouted.  No  response!  Carefinotu  gave  a  terrible 
yell.  No  one  appeared! 

Behold  them  then  hunting  among  the  neighboring  rocks, 
searching  a  cavern,  a  grotto,  which  might  serve  as  a  refuge 
for  a  shipwrecked  man,  an  aboriginal,  a  savage — 

It  was  in  vain  that  they  ransacked  the  slightest  recesses 
of  the  shore.  There  was  neither  ancient  nor  recent  camp 
in  existence,  not  even  the  traces  of  the  passage  of  a  man. 

"But,"  repeated  Godfrey,  "it  was  not  smoke  from  a 
warm  spring  this  time!  It  was  from  a  fire  of  wood  and 
grass,  and  that  fire  could  not  light  itself." 

Vain  was  their  search.  Then  about  two  o'clock  Godfrey 
and  Carefinotu,  as  weary  as  they  were  disconcerted  at 
their  fruitless  endeavors,  retook  their  road  to  Will  Tree. 

There  was  nothing  astonishing  in  Godfrey  being  deep  in 


128  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

thought.  It  seemed  to  him  that  the  island  was  now  under 
the  empire  of  some  occult  power.  The  reappearance  of 
this  fire,  the  presence  of  wild  animals,  did  not  all  this 
denote  some  extraordinary  complication? 

And  was  there  not  cause  for  his  being  confirmed  in  this 
idea  when  an  hour  after  he  had  regained  the  prairie,  he 
heard  a  singular  noise,  a  sort  of  hard  jingling? 

Carefinotu  pushed  him  aside  at  the  same  instant  as  a 
serpent  glided  beneath  the  herbage,  and  was  about  to  strike 
at  him.  "Snakes,  now.  Snakes  in  the  island,  after  the 
bears  and  the  tigers!"  he  exclaimed. 

Yes!  It  was  one  of  those  reptiles  well-known  by  the 
noise  they  make,  a  rattlesnake  of  the  most  venomous 
species;  a  giant  of  the  Crotalus  family! 

Carefinotu  threw  himself  between  Godfrey  and  the 
reptile,  which  hurried  off  under  a  thick  bush.  But  the 
negro  pursued  it  and  smashed  in  its  head  with  a  blow 
of  the  axe.  When  Godfrey  rejoined  him,  the  two  halves 
of  the  reptile  were  writhing  on  the  blood-stained  soil. 

Then  other  serpents,  not  less  dangerous,  appeared  in 
great  abundance  on  this  part  of  the  prairie  which  was 
separated  by  the  stream  from  Will  Tree.  Was  it  then  a 
sudden  invasion  of  reptiles?  Was  Phina  Island  going  to 
become  the  rival  of  ancient  Tenos,  whose  formidable 
ophidians  rendered  it  famous  in  antiquity,  and  which  gave 
its  name  to  the  viper? 

"Come  on!  come  on!"  exclaimed  Godfrey,  motioning  to 
Carefinotu  to  quicken  his  pace.  He  was  uneasy.  Strange 
presentiments  agitated  him  without  his  being  able  to  control 
them.  Under  their  influence,  fearing  some  approaching 
misfortune,  he  hastened  his  return  to  Will  Tree. 

Matters  became  serious  when  he  reached  the  planks 
across  the  river.  Screams  of  terror  resounded  from  be- 
neath the  sequoias — cries  for  help  in  a  tone  of  agony 
which  it  was  impossible  to  mistake! 

"It  is  Tartlet!"  exclaimed  Godfrey.  "The  unfortunate 
man  has  been  attacked!  Quick!  quick!" 

Once  over  the  bridge,  about  twenty  paces  further  on, 
Tartlet  was  perceived  running  as  fast  as  his  legs  could 
carry  him.  An  enormous  crocodile  had  come  out  of  the 
river  and  was  pursuing  him  with  its  jaws  wide  open.  The 
poor  man,  distracted,  mad  with  fright,  instead  of  turning 


DANGERS  REACH  A  CLIMAX  129 

to  the  right  or  the  left,  was  keeping  in  a  straight  line,  and 
so  running  the  risk  of  being  caught.  Suddenly  he  stum- 
bled. He  fell.  He  was  lost. 

Godfrey  halted.  In  the  presence  of  this  imminent  dan- 
ger his  coolness  never  forsook  him  for  an  instant.  He 
brought  his  gun  to  his  shoulder,  and  aimed  at  the  crocodile. 
The  well-aimed  bullet  struck  the  monster,  and  it  made  a 
bound  to  one  side  and  fell  motionless  on  the  ground. 

Carefmotu  rushed  toward  Tartlet  and  lifted  him  up. 
Tartlet  had  escaped  with  a  fright!  But  what  a  fright! 

A  moment  afterward  Godfrey  and  his  two  companions 
had  reached  Will  Tree.  How  bitter  were  their  reflections 
during  their  evening  repast!  What  long,  sleepless  hours 
were  in  store  for  the  inhabitants  of  Phina  Island,  on  whom 
misfortunes  were  now  crowding! 

As  for  the  professor,  in  his  anguish  he  could  only 
repeat  the  words  which  expressed  the  whole  of  his 
thoughts,  "I  had  much  rather  be  off !" 


CHAPTER  XX 

DANGERS    REACH    A    CLIMAX 

THE  winter  season,  so  severe  in  these  latitudes,  had  come 
at  last.  The  first  frosts  had  already  been  felt,  and  there 
was  every  promise  of  rigorous  weather.  Godfrey  was  to 
be  congratulated  on  having  established  his  fireplace  in  the 
tree.  It  need  scarcely  be  said  that  the  work  at  the  palisade 
had  been  completed,  and  that  a  sufficiently  solid  door  now 
assured  the  closure  of  the  fence. 

During  the  six  weeks  which  followed,  that  is  to  say, 
until  the  middle  of  December,  there  had  been  a  good  many 
wretched  days  on  which  it  was  impossible  to  venture  forth. 
At  the  outset  there  came  terrible  squalls.  They  shook  the 
group  of  sequoias  to  their  very  roots.  They  strewed  the 
ground  with  broken  branches,  and  so  furnished  an  ample 
reserve  for  the  fire. 

Then  it  was  that  the  inhabitants  of  Will  Tree  clothed 
themselves  as  warmly  as  they  could.  The  woolen  stuffs 
found  in  the  box  were  used  during  the  few  excursions 
necessary  for  revictualing,  until  the  weather  became  so  bad 
that  even  these  were  forbidden.  All  hunting  was  at  an 

Vol.  18  Verne 


130  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

end,  and  the  snow  fell  in  such  quantity  that  Godfrey  could 
have  believed  himself  in  the  inhospitable  latitudes  of  the 
Arctic  Ocean. 

It  is  well  known  that  Northern  America,  swept  by  the 
Polar  winds,  with  no  obstacle  to  check  them,  is  one  of 
the  coldest  countries  on  the  globe.  The  winter  there  lasts 
until  the  month  of  April.  Exceptional  precautions  have 
to  be  taken  against  it.  It  was  the  coming  of  the  winter 
as  it  did  which  gave  rise  to  the  thought  that  Phina  Island 
was  situated  in  a  higher  latitude  than  Godfrey  had  sup- 
posed. 

Hence  the  necessity  of  making  the  interior  of  Will  Tree 
as  comfortable  as  possible.  But  the  suffering  from  rain 
and  cold  was  cruel.  The  reserves  of  provisions  were  unfortu- 
nately insufficient,  the  preserved  turtle  flesh  gradually  dis- 
appeared. Frequently  there  had  to  be  sacrificed  some  of 
the  sheep  or  goats  or  agouties,  whose  numbers  had  but 
slightly  increased  since  their  arrival  in  the  island. 

With  these  new  trials,  what  sad  thoughts  haunted 
Godfrey !  It  happened  also  that  for  a  fortnight  he  fell  into 
a  violent  fever.  Without  the  tiny  medicine-chest  which 
afforded  the  necessary  drugs  for  his  treatment,  he  might 
never  have  recovered.  Tartlet  was  ill-suited  to  attend 
to  the  petty  cares  that  were  necessary  during  the  contin- 
uance of  the  malady.  It  was  to  Carefinotu  that  he  mainly 
owed  his  return  to  health. 

But  what  remembrances  and  what  regrets!  Who  but 
himself  could  he  blame  for  getting  into  a  situation  of 
which  he  could  not  even  see  the  end?  How  many  times 
in  his  delirium  did  he  call  Phina,  whom  he  never  should 
see  again,  and  his  Uncle  Will,  from  whom  he  beheld  him- 
self separated  forever!  Ah!  he  had  to  alter  his  opinion 
of  this  Crusoe  life  which  his  boyish  imagination  had  made 
his  ideal!  Now  he  was  contending  with  reality!  He  could 
no  longer  even  hope  to  return  to  the  domestic  hearth. 

So  passed  this  miserable  December,  at  the  end  of  which 
Godfrey  began  to  recover  his  strength. 

As  for  Tartlet,  by  special  grace,  doubtless,  he  was  al- 
ways well.  But  what  incessant  lamentations!  What  end- 
less jeremiads!  As  the  grotto  of  Calypso  after  the  depar- 
ture of  Ulysses,  Will  Tree  "resounded  no  more  to  his 


DANGERS  REACH  A  CLIMAX  131 

song"— that  of  his  fiddle — for  the  cold  had   frozen  the 
strings ! 

It  should  be  said  too  that  one  of  the  gravest  anxieties  of 
Godfrey  was  not  only  the  reappearance  of  dangerous  ani- 
mals, but  the  fear  of  the  savages  returning  in  great  num- 
bers to  Phina  Island,  the  situation  of  which  was  known  to 
them.  Against  such  an  invasion  the  palisade  was  but  an 
insufficient  barrier.  All  things  considered,  the  refuge  of- 
fered by  the  high  branches  of  the  sequoia  appeared  much 
safer,  and  the  rendering  the  access  less  difficult  was  taken 
in  hand.  It  would  always  be  easy  to  defend  the  narrow 
orifice  by  which  the  top  of  the  trunk  was  reached. 

With  the  aid  of  Carefinotu,  Godfrey  began  to  cut  regular 
ledges  on  each  side,  like  the  steps  of  a  staircase,  and  these, 
connected  by  a  long  cord  of  vegetable  fiber,  permitted  of 
rapid  ascent  up  the  interior. 

"Well,"  said  Godfrey,  when  the  work  was  done,  "that 
gives  us  a  town  house  below,  and  a  country  house  above !" 
"I  had  rather  have  a  cellar,  if  it  was  in  Montgomery 
Street!"  answered  Tartlet. 

Christmas  arrived.  Christmas  kept  in  such  style  through- 
out the  United  States  of  America!  The  New  Year's  Day, 
full  of  memories  of  childhood,  rainy,  snowy,  cold,  and 
gloomy,  began  the  new  year  under  the  most  melancholy 
auspices.  It  was  six  months  since  the  survivors  of  the 
Dream  had  remained  without  communication  with  the  rest 
of  the  world.  \ 

The  commencement  of  the  year  was  not  very  cheering. 
It  made  Godfrey  and  his  companions  anticipate  that  they 
would  still  have  many  trials  to  encounter.  The  snow  never 
ceased  falling  until  January  i8th.  The  flocks  had  to  be  let 
out  to  pasture  to  get  what  feed  they  could.  At  the  close 
of  the  day,  a  very  cold  damp  night  enveloped  the  island, 
and  the  space  shaded  by  the  sequoias  was  plunged  in  pro- 
found obscurity.  Tartlet  and  Carefinotu,  stretched  on  their 
beds  inside  Will  Tree,  were  trying  in  vain  to  sleep.  God- 
frey, by  the  struggling  light  of  a  torch,  was  turning  over 
the  pages  of  his  Bible. 

About  ten  o'clock  a  distant  noise,  which  came  nearer 
and  nearer,  was  heard  outside  away  toward  the  north. 
There  could  be  no  mistake.  It  was  the  wild  beasts  prowl- 
ing in  the  neighborhood,  and,  alarming  to  relate,  the 


I32  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

howling  of  the  tiger  and  of  the  hyaena,  and  the  roaring 
of  the  panther  and  the  lion  were  this  time  blended  in  one 
formidable  concert. 

Godfrey,  Tartlet,  and  the  negro  sat  up,  each  a  prey  to 
indescribable  anguish.  If  at  this  unaccountable  invasion 
of  ferocious  animals  Carefinotu  shared  the  alarm  of  his 
companions,  his  astonishment  was  quite  equal  to  his  fright. 

During  two  mortal  hours  all  three  kept  on  the  alert.  The 
howlings  sounded  at  times  close  by;  then  they  suddenly 
ceased,  as  if  the  beasts,  not  knowing  the  country,  were 
roaming  about  all  over  it.  Perhaps  then  Will  Tree  would 
escape  an  attack! 

"It  doesn't  matter  if  it  does/'  thought  Godfrey.  "If  we 
do  not  destroy  these  animals  to  the  very  last  one,  there 
will  be  no  safety  for  us  in  the  island !" 

A  little  after  midnight  the  roaring  began  again  in  full 
strength  at  a  moderate  distance  away.  Impossible  now  to 
doubt  but  that  the  howling  army  was  approaching  Will 
Tree! 

Yes!  It  was  only  too  certain!  But  whence  came  these 
wild  animals?  They  could  not  have  recently  landed  on 
Phina  Island!  They  must  have  been  there  then  before 
Godfrey's  arrival!  But  how  was  it  that  all  of  them  had 
remained  hidden  during  his  walks  and  hunting  excursions, 
as  well  across  the  center  as  in  the  most  out-of-the-way 
parts  to  the  south?  For  Godfrey  had  never  found  a  trace 
of  them.  Where  was  the  mysterious  den  which  vomited 
forth  lions,  hyaenas,  panthers,  tigers?  Among  all  the 
unaccountable  things  up  to  now  this  was  indeed  the  most 
unaccountable. 

Carefinotu  could  not  believe  what  he  heard.  We  have 
said  that  his  astonishment  was  extreme.  By  the  light  of 
the  fire  which  illuminated  the  interior  of  Will  Tree  there 
could  be  seen  on  his  black  face  the  strangest  of  grimaces. 

Tartlet,  in  the  corner,  groaned  and  lamented,  and  moaned 
again.  He  would  have  asked  Godfrey  all  about  it,  but 
Godfrey  was  not  in  the  humor  to  reply.  He  had  a  pre- 
sentiment of  very  great  danger,  and  he  was  seeking  for  a 
way  to  retreat  from  it. 

Once  or  twice  Carefinotu  and  he  went  out  to  the  center 
of  the  palisade.  They  wished  to  see  that  the  door  was 
firmly  and  strongly  shut. 


DANGERS  REACH  A  CLIMAX  133 

Suddenly  an  avalanche  of  animals  appeared  with  a 
huge  tumult  along  the  front  of  Will  Tree.  It  was  the  goats 
and  sheep  and  agouties.  Terrified  at  the  howling  of  the 
wild  beasts,  and  scenting  their  approach,  they  had  fled  from 
their  pasturage  to  take  shelter  behind  the  palisade. 

"We  must  open  the  door!"  exclaimed  Godfrey. 

Carefinotu  nodded  his  head.  He  did  not  need  to  know 
the  language  to  understand  what  Godfrey  meant.  The 
door  was  opened,  and  the  frightened  flock  rushed  into  the 
enclosure. 

But  at  that  instant  there  appeared  through  the  opening 
a  gleaming  of  eyes  in  the  depths  of  the  darkness  which 
the  shadow  of  the  sequoias  rendered  still  more  profound. 
There  was  no  time  to  close  the  enclosure ! 

To  jump  at  Godfrey,  seize  him  in  spite  of  himself,  push 
him  into  the  dwelling  and  slam  the  door,  was  done  by 
Carefinotu  like  a  flash  of  lightning. 

New  roarings  indicated  that  three  or  four  wild  beasts 
had  just  cleared  the  palisade.  Then  these  horrible  roarings 
were  mingled  with  quite  a  concert  of  bleatings  and  groan- 
ings  of  terror.  The  domestic  flock  were  taken  as  in  a 
trap  and  delivered  over  to  the  clutches  of  the  assailants. 

Godfrey  and  Carefinotu,  who  had  climbed  up  to  the  two 
small  windows  in  the  bark  of  the  sequoia,  endeavored  to 
see  what  was  passing  in  the  gloom.  Evidently  the  wild 
animals — tigers  or  lions,  panthers  or  hyaenas,  they  did  not 
know  which  yet — had  thrown  themselves  on  the  flock  and 
begun  their  slaughter. 

At  this  moment,  Tartlet,  in  a  paroxysm  of  blind  terror, 
seized  one  of  the  muskets,  and  would  have  taken  a  chance 
shot  out  of  one  of  the  windows.  Godfrey  stopped  him. 

"No!"  said  he.  "In  this  darkness  our  shots  will  be  lost, 
and  we  must  not  waste  our  ammunition!  Wait  for  day- 
light!" 

He  wa?  right.  The  bullets  would  just  as  likely  have 
struck  the  domestic  as  the  wild  animals — more  likely  in 
fact,  for  the  former  were  the  most  numerous.  To  save  them 
was  now  impossible.  Once  they  were  sacrificed,  the  wild 
beasts,  thoroughly  gorged,  might  quit  the  enclosure  before 
sunrise.  They  would  then  see  how  to  act  to  guard  against 
a  fresh  invasion. 

It  was  most  important,  too,  during  the  dark  night,  to 


134  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

avoid  as  much  as  possible  revealing  to  these  animals  the 
presence  of  human  beings,  whom  they  might  prefer  to 
the  flock.  Perhaps  they  would  thus  avoid  a  direct  attack 
against  Will  Tree. 

As  Tartlet  was  incapable  of  understanding  either  this 
reasoning  or  any  other,  Godfrey  contented  himself  with 
depriving  him  of  his  weapon.  The  professor  then  went 
and  threw  himself  on  his  bed  and  freely  anathematized  all 
travels  and  travelers  and  maniacs  who  could  not  remain 
quietly  at  their  own  firesides.  Both  his  companions  re- 
sumed their  observations  at  the  windows. 

Thence  they  beheld,  without  the  power  of  interference, 
the  horrible  massacre  which  was  taking  place  in  the  gloom. 
The  cries  of  the  sheep  and  the  goats  gradually  diminished 
as  the  slaughter  of  the  animals  was  consummated,  al- 
though the  greater  part  had  escaped  outside,  where  death, 
none  the  less  certain,  awaited  them.  This  loss  was  ir- 
reparable for  the  little  colony;  but  Godfrey  was  not  then 
anxious  about  the  future.  The  present  was  disquieting 
enough  to  occupy  all  his  thoughts. 

There  was  nothing  they  could  do,  nothing  they  could 
try,  to  hinder  this  work  of  destruction. 

Godfrey  and  Carefinotu  kept  constant  watch,  and  now 
they  seemed  to  see  new  shadows  coming  up  and  passing 
into  the  palisade,  while  a  fresh  sound  of  footsteps  struck 
on  their  ears.  Evidently  certain  belated  beasts,  attracted 
by  the  odor  of  the  blood  which  impregnated  the  air,  had 
traced  the  scent  up  to  Will  Tree. 

They  ran  to  and  fro,  they  rushed  around  and  around  the 
tree  and  gave  forth  their  hoarse  and  angry  growls.  Some 
of  the  shadows  jumped  on  the  ground  like  enormous  cats. 
The  slaughtered  flock  had  not  been  sufficient  to  satisfy 
their  rage.  Neither  Godfrey  nor  his  companions  moved. 
In  keeping  completely  motionless  they  might  avoid  a 
direct  attack.  An  unlucky  shot  suddenly  revealed  their 
presence  and  exposed  them  to  the  greatest  danger. 

Tartlet,  a  prey  to  a  veritable  hallucination,  had  arisen. 
He  had  seized  a  revolver;  and  this  time,  before  Godfrey 
and  Carefinotu  could  hinder  him,  and  not  knowing  him- 
self what  he  did,  but  believing  that  he  saw  a  tiger  standing 
before  him,  he  had  fired!  The  bullet  passed  through  the 


DANGERS  REACH  A  CLIMAX  135 

door  of  Will  Tree.  "Fool !"  exclaimed  Godfrey,  throwing 
himself  on  Tartlet,  while  the  negro  seized  the  weapon. 

It  was  too  late.  The  alarm  was  given,  and  growlings 
still  more  violent  resounded  without.  Formidable  talons 
were  heard  tearing  the  bark  of  the  sequoia.  Terrible  blows 
shook  the  door,  which  was  too  feeble  to  resist  such  an  as- 
sault. "We  must  defend  ourselves!"  shouted  Godfrey. 

And,  with  his  gun  in  his  hand  and  his  cartridge-pouch 
round  his  waist,  he  took  his  post  at  one  of  the  windows. 

To  his  great  surprise,  Carefinotu  had  done  the  same! 
Yes !  the  black,  seizing  the  second  musket — a  weapon  which 
he  had  never  before  handled — had  filled  his  pockets  with 
cartridges  and  taken  his  place  at  the  second  window. 

Then  the  reports  of  the  guns  began  to  echo  from  the 
embrasures.  By  the  flashes,  Godfrey  on  the  one  side,  and 
Carefinotu  on  the  other,  beheld  the  foes  they  had  to  deal 
with.  There,  in  the  enclosure,  roaring  with  rage,  howling 
at  the  reports,  rolling  beneath  the  bullets  which  struck 
many  of  them,  leaped  of  lions  and  tigers,  hyaenas  and 
panthers,  at  least  a  score.  To  their  roarings  and  growl- 
ings  which  reverberated  from  afar,  there  echoed  back 
those  of  other  ferocious  beasts  running  up  to  join  them. 
Already  the  now  distant  roaring  could  be  heard  as  they 
approached  the  environs  of  Will  Tree.  It  was  as  though 
quite  a  menagerie  of  wild  animals  had  been  suddenly  set 
free  on  the  island! 

However,  Godfrey  and  Carefinotu,  without  troubling 
themselves  about  Tartlet,  who  could  be  of  no  use,  were 
keeping  as  cool  as  they  could,  and  refraining  from  firing 
unless  they  were  certain  of  their  aim.  Wishing  to  waste 
not  a  shot,  they  waited  till  a  shadow  passed  in  front  of 
them.  Then  came  the  flash  and  the  report,  and  then  a 
growl  of  grief  told  them  that  the  animal  had  been  hit. 

A  quarter  of  an  hour  elapsed,  and  then  came  a  respite. 
Had  the  wild  beasts  given  up  the  attack  which  had  cost 
the  lives  of  so  many  among  them?  Were  they  waiting 
for  the  day  to  recommence  the  attempt  under  more  favor- 
able conditions?  Whatever  might  be  the  reason,  neither 
Godfrey  nor  Carefinotu  desired  to  leave  his  post.  The 
black  had  shown  himself  no  less  ready  with  the  gun  than 
Godfrey.  If  that  was  due  only  to  the  instinct  of  imitation, 
it  must  be  admitted  that  it  ,was  indeed  surprising. 


136  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

About  two  o'clock  in  the  morning  there  came  a  new 
alarm — more  furious  than  before.  The  danger  was  immi- 
nent, the  position  in  the  interior  of  Will  Tree  was  becoming 
untenable.  New  growlings  resounded  around  the  foot  of 
the  sequoia.  Neither  Godfrey  nor  Carefinotu,  on  account 
of  the  situation  of  the  windows,  which  were  cut  straight 
through,  could  see  the  assailants,  nor,  in  consequence, 
could  they  fire  with  any  chance  of  success. 

It  was  now  the  door  which  the  beasts  attacked,  and  it 
was  only  too  evident  that  it  would  be  beaten  in  by  their 
weight  or  torn  down  by  their  claws. 

Godfrey  and  the  black  had  descended  to  the  ground. 
The  door  was  already  shaking  beneath  the  blows  from 
without.  They  could  feel  the  heated  breath  making  its 
way  in  through  the  cracks  in  the  bark.  Godfrey  and  Care- 
finotu attempted  to  prop  back  the  door  with  the  stakes 
which  kept  up  the  beds,  but  these  proved  quite  useless. 

It  was  obvious  that  in  a  little  while  it  would  be  driven 
in — for  the  beasts  were  mad  with  rage — particularly  as  no 
shots  could  reach  them. 

Godfrey  was  powerless.  If  he  and  his  companions  were 
inside  Will  Tree  when  the  assailants  broke  in,  their  weapons 
would  be  useless  to  protect  them. 

Godfrey  had  crossed  his  arms.  He  saw  the  boards  of 
the  door  open  little  by  little.  He  could  do  nothing.  In  a 
moment  of  hesitation,  he  passed  his  hand  across  his  fore- 
head, as  if  in  despair.  But  soon  recovering  his  self-posses- 
sion, he  shouted,  "Up  we  go!  Up!  All  of  us!"  And  he 
pointed  to  the  narrow  passage  which  led  up  to  the  fork 
inside  Will  Tree. 

Carefinotu  and  he,  taking  their  muskets  and  revolvers, 
supplied  themselves  with  cartridges. 

And  now  he  turned  to  make  Tartlet  follow  them  into 
these  heights  where  he  had  never  ventured  before.  Tartlet 
was  no  longer  there.  He  had  started  up  while  his  compan- 
ions were  firing.  "Up!"  repeated  Godfrey. 

It  was  a  last  retreat,  where  they  would  assuredly  be 
sheltered  from  the  wild  beasts.  If  any  tiger  or  panther 
attempted  to  come  up  into  the  branches  of  the  sequoia,  it 
would  be  easy  to  defend  the  hole  through  which  he  would 
have  to  pass. 

Godfrey   and   Carefinotu   had   scarcely   ascended   thirty 


DANGERS  REACH  A  CLIMAX  137 

feet,  when  the  roaring  was  heard  in  the  interior  of  Will 
Tree.  A  few  moments  more  and  they  would  have  been 
surprised.  The  door  had  just  fallen  in.  They  both  hurried 
along,  and  at  last  reached  the  upper  end  of  the  hole. 

A  scream  of  terror  welcomed  them.  It  was  Tartlet,  who 
imagined  he  saw  a  panther  or  tiger!  The  unfortunate 
professor  was  clasping  a  branch,  frightened  almost  out  of 
his  life  lest  he  should  fall.  Carefinotu  went  to  him,  and 
compelled  him  to  lean  against  an  upright  bough,  to  which 
he  firmly  secured  him  with  his  belt. 

Then,  while  Godfrey  selected  a  place  whence  he  could 
command  the  opening,  Carefinotu  went  to  another  spot 
whence  he  could  deliver  a  cross  fire.  And  they  waited. 

Under  these  circumstances  it  certainly  looked  as  though 
the  besieged  were  safe  from  attack. 

Godfrey  endeavored  to  discover  what  was  passing  be- 
neath them;  but  the  night  was  still  too  dark.  Then  he 
tried  to  hear;  the  growlings,  which  never  ceased,  showed 
that  the  assailants  had  no  thought  of  abandoning  the  place. 

Suddenly,  toward  four  o'clock  in  the  morning,  a  great 
light  appeared  at  the  foot  of  the  tree.  At  once  it  shot  out 
through  the  door  and  windows.  At  the  same  time  a 
thick  smoke  spread  forth  from  the  upper  opening  and  lost 
itself  in  the  higher  branches. 

"What  is  that  now?"  exclaimed   Godfrey. 

It  was  easily  explained.  The  wild  beasts,  in  ravaging 
the  interior  of  Will  Tree,  had  scattered  the  remains  of 
the  fire.  The  fire  had  spread  to  the  things  in  the  room. 
The  flame  had  caught  the  bark,  which  had  dried  and 
become  combustible.  The  gigantic  sequoia  was  ablaze 
below.  The  position  was  now  more  terrible  than  it  had 
ever  been.  By  the  light  of  the  flames,  which  illuminated 
the  space  beneath  the  grove,  they  could  see  the  wild  beasts 
leaping  around  the  foot  of  Will  Tree.  At  the  same  instant, 
a  fearful  explosion  occurred.  The  sequoia,  violently 
wrenched,  trembled  from  its  roots  to  its  summit.  It  was 
the  reserve  of  gunpowder  which  had  exploded  inside  Will 
Tree,  and  the  air,  violently  expelled  from  the  opening, 
rushed  forth  like  the  gas  from  a  discharging  cannon. 

Godfrey  and  Carefinotu  were  almost  torn  from  their 
resting-places.  Had  Tartlet  not  been  lashed  to  the  branch, 
he  would  assuredly  have  been  hurled  to  the  ground. 


138  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

The  wild  beasts,  terrified  at  the  explosion,  and  more  or 
less  wounded,  had  taken  to  flight.  But  at  the  same  time 
the  conflagration,  fed  by  the  sudden  combustion  of  the 
powder,  had  considerably  extended.  It  swiftly  grew  in 
dimensions  as  it  crept  up  the  enormous  stem. 

Large  tongues  of  flame  lapped  the  interior,  and  the 
highest  soon  reached  the  fork,  and  the  dead  wood  snapped 
and  crackled  like  shots  from  a  revolver.  A  huge  glare 
lighted  up,  not  only  the  group  of  giant  trees,  but  even  the 
whole  of  the  coast  from  Flag  Point  to  the  southern 
cape  of  Dream  Bay. 

Soon  the  fire  had  reached  the  lower  branches  of  the 
sequoia,  and  threatened  to  invade  the  spot  where  Godfrey 
and  his  companions  had  taken  refuge.  Were  they  then 
to  be  devoured  by  the  flames,  with  which  they  could  not 
battle,  or  had  they  but  the  last  resource  of  throwing  them- 
selves to  the  ground  to  escape  being  burned  alive?  In 
either  case  they  must  die! 

Godfrey  sought  about  for  some  means  of  escape.  He 
saw  none!  Already  the  lower  branches  were  ablaze  and  a 
dense  smoke  was  struggling  with  the  first  gleams  of  dawn 
which  were  rising  in  the  east. 

At  this  moment  there  was  a  horrible  crash  of  rending 
and  breaking.  The  sequoia,  burned  to  the  very  roots, 
cracked  violently — it  toppled  over — it  fell! 

But  as  it  fell  the  stem  met  the  stems  of  the  trees 
which  environed  it;  their  powerful  branches  were  mingled 
with  its  own,  and  so  it  remained  obliquely  cradled  at  an 
angle  of  about  forty-five  degrees  from  the  ground.  At 
the  moment  that  the  sequoia  fell,  Godfrey  and  his  com- 
panions believed  themselves  lost! 

"Nineteenth  of  January !"  exclaimed  a  voice,  which  God- 
frey, in  spite  of  his  astonishment,  immediately  recognized. 
It  was  Carefinotu!  Yes,  Carefinotu  had  just  pronounced 
these  words,  and  in  that  English  language  which  up  to 
then  he  had  seemed  unable  to  speak  or  to  understand ! 

"What  did  you  say?'*  asked  Godfrey,  as  he  followed 
him  along  the  branches. 

"I  said,  Mr.  Morgan,"  answered  Carefinotu,  "that  today 
your  Uncle  Will  ought  to  reach  us,  and  that  if  he  doesn't 
turn  up  we  are  done  for!" 


ALL  THE  MYSTERIES  SOLVED  139 


CHAPTER  XXI 

ALL  THE  MYSTERIES  SOLVED 

AT  that  instant,  and  before  Godfrey  could  reply,  the 
report  of  fire-arms  was  heard  not  far  from  Will  Tree. 

At  the  same  time  one  of  those  rain  storms,  regular  cata- 
racts in  their  fury,  fell  in  a  torrential  shower  just  as  the 
flames  devouring1  the  lower  branches  were  threatening  to 
seize  upon  the  trees  against  which  Will  Tree  was  resting. 

What  was  Godfrey  to  think  after  this  series  of  inexpli- 
cable events?  Carefinotu  speaking  English  like  a  cock- 
ney, calling  him  by  his  name,  announcing  the  early  arrival 
of  Uncle  Will,  and  then  the  sudden  report  of  the  fire-arms  ? 

He  asked  himself  if  he  had  gone  mad;  but  he  had  no 
time  for  insoluble  questions,  for  below  him — hardly  five 
minutes  after  the  first  sound  of  the  guns — a  body  of  sailors 
appeared  hurrying  through  the  trees. 

Godfrey  and  Carefinotu  slipped  down  along  the  stem, 
the  interior  of  which  was  still  burning. 

The  moment  that  Godfrey  touched  the  ground,  he 
heard  himself  spoken  to,  and  by  two  voices  which  even  in 
his  trouble  it  was  impossible  for  him  not  to  recognize. 

"Nephew  Godfrey,  I  have  the  honor  to  salute  you!" 

"Godfrey!    Dear  Godfrey!" 

"Uncle  Will!  Phina!  You!"  exclaimed  Godfrey,  as- 
tounded. Three  seconds  afterward  he  was  in  somebody's 
arms,  and  was  clasping  that  somebody  in  his  own. 

At  the  same  time  two  sailors,  at  the  order  of  Captain 
Turcott  who  was  in  command,  climbed  up  along  the  se- 
quoia to  set  Tartlet  free,  and,  with  all  due  respect,  pluck 
him  from  the  branch  as  if  he  were  a  fruit.  And  then  the 
questions,  the  answers,  the  explanations  which  passed! 

"Uncle  Will!    You?" 

"Yes!  me!" 

"And  how  did  you  discover  Phina  Island?" 

"Phina  Island!"  answered  William  W.  Kolderup.  "You 
should  say  Spencer  Island!  Well,  it  wasn't  very  difficult. 
I  bought  it  six  months  ago!" 

"Spencer  Island!" 

"And  you  gave  my  name  to  it,  you  dear  Godfrey!"  said 
the  young  lady. 


ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

"The  new  name  is  a  good  one,  and  we  will  keep  to 
it,"  answered  the  uncle;  "but  for  geographers  this  is 
Spencer  Island,  only  three  days'  journey  from  San  Fran- 
cisco, on  which  I  thought  it  would  be  a  good  plan  for  you 
to  serve  your  apprenticeship  to  the  Crusoe  business !" 

"Oh!  Uncle!  Uncle  Will!  What  is  it  you  say?"  ex- 
claimed Godfrey.  "Well,  if  you  are  in  earnest,  I  can 
only  answer  that  I  deserved  it!  But  then,  Uncle  Will,  the 
wreck  of  the  Dream?" 

"Sham!"  replied  William  W.  Kolderup,  who  had  never 
seemed  in  such  a  good  humor  before.  "The  Dream  was 
quietly  sunk  by  means  of  her  water  ballast,  according  to 
the  instructions  I  had  given  Turcott.  You  thought  she 
sank  for  good,  but  when  the  captain  saw  that  you  and 
Tartlet  had  gotten  safely  to  land  he  brought  her  up  and 
steamed  away.  Three  days  later  he  got  back  to  San  Fran- 
cisco, and  he  it  is  who  has  brought  us  to  Spencer  Island 
on  the  date  we  fixed!" 

"Then  none  of  the  crew  perished  in  the  wreck?" 

"None — unless  it  was  the  unhappy  Chinaman  who  hid 
himself  away  on  board  and  could  not  be  found!" 

"But  the  canoe?" 

"Sham!    The  canoe  was  of  my  own  make." 

"But  the  savages?" 

"Sham !    The  savages  whom  luckily  you  did  not  shoot !" 

"But  Carefinotu?" 

"Sham!  Carefinotu  was  my  faithful  Jup  Brass,  who 
played  his  part  of  Friday  marvelously  well,  as  I  see." 

"Yes,"  answered  Godfrey.  "He  twice  saved  my  life — 
once  from  a  bear,  once  from  a  tiger — " 

"The  bear  was  sham!  the  tiger  was  sham!"  laughed 
William  W.  Kolderup.  "Both  of  them  were  stuffed  with 
straw,  and  landed  before  you  saw  them  with  Jup  Brass  and 
his  companions!" 

"But  he  moved  his  head  and  his  paws !" 

"By  means  of  a  spring  which  Jup  Brass  had  fixed  during 
the  night  a  few  hours  before  the  meetings  which  were 
prepared  for  you." 

"What!  all  of  them?"  repeated  Godfrey,  a  little  ashamed 
at  having  been  taken  in  by  these  artifices. 

"Yes!  Things  were  going  too  smoothly  in  your  island, 
and  we  had  to  get  up  a  little  excitement!" 


ALL  THE  MYSTERIES  SOLVED  141 

"Then,"  answered  Godfrey,  who  had  begun  to  laugh,  "if 
you  wished  to  make  matters  unpleasant  for  us,  why  did 
you  send  us  the  box  which  contained  everything  we 
wanted?" 

"A  box?"  answered  William  W.  Kolderup.  "What  box? 
I  never  sent  you  a  box!  Perhaps  by  chance — "  And  he 
looked  toward  Phina,  who  cast  down  her  eyes  and  turned 
away  her  head. 

"Oh !  indeed ! — a  box !  but  then  Phina  must  have  had  an 
accomplice — " 

And  Uncle  Will  turned  toward  Captain  Turcott,  who 
laughingly  answered,  "What  could  I  do,  Mr.  Kolderup? 
I  can  sometimes  resist  you — but  Miss  Phina — it  was  too 
difficult !  And  four  months  ago,  when  you  sent  me  to  look 
around  the  island,  I  landed  the  box  from  my  boat — " 

"Dearest  Phina!"  said  Godfrey,  seizing  the  young  lady's 
hand. 

"Turcott,  you  promised  to  keep  the  secret!"  said  Phina 
with  a  blush.  And  Uncle  William  Kolderup,  shaking  his 
big  head,  tried  in  vain  to  hide  that  he  was  touched. 

But  if  Godfrey  could  not  restrain  his  smiles  as  he  list- 
ened to  the  explanations  of  Uncle  Will,  Prof.  Tartlet  did 
not  laugh  in  the  least!  He  was  excessively  mortified  at 
what  he  heard !  To  have  been  the  object  of  such  a  mystifi- 
cation, he,  a  professor  of  dancing  and  deportment!  And  so 
advancing  with  much  dignity  he  observed,  "Mr.  William 
Kolderup  will  hardly  assert,  I  imagine,  that  the  enormous 
crocodile,  of  which  I  was  nearly  the  unhappy  victim,  was 
made  of  pasteboard  and  wound  up  with  a  spring?" 

"A  crocodile?"  replied  the  uncle. 

"Yes,  Mr.  Kolderup,"  said  Carefinotu,  to  whom  we  had 
better  return  his  proper  name  of  Jup  Brass.  "Yes,  a  real 
live  crocodile,  which  went  for  Mr.  Tartlet,  and  which  I 
did  not  have  in  my  collection !" 

Godfrey  then  related  what  had  happened,  the  sudden 
appearance  of  the  wild  beasts  in  such  numbers,  real  lions, 
real  tigers,  real  panthers,  and  then  the  invasion  of  the 
snakes,  of  which  during  four  months  they  had  not  seen  a 
single  specimen  in  the  island! 

William  W.  Kolderup  at  this  was  quite  disconcerted. 
He  knew  nothing  about  it.  Spencer  Island — it  had  been 
known  for  a  long  time — never  had  any  wild  beasts,  did 


I42  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

not  possess  even  a  single  noxious  animal;  it  was  so  stated 
in  the  deeds  of  sale. 

Neither  did  he  understand  what  Godfrey  told  him  of  the 
attempts  he  had  made  to  discover  the  origin  of  the  smoke 
which  had  appeared  at  different  points  on  the  island.  And 
he  seemed  very  much  troubled  to  find  that  all  had  not 
passed  on  the  island  according  to  his  instructions,  and  that 
the  program  had  been  so  seriously  interfered  with. 

As  for  Tartlet,  he  was  not  the  sort  of  man  to  be  hum- 
bugged. For  his  part  he  would  admit  nothing,  neither  the 
sham  shipwreck,  nor  the  sham  savages,  nor  the  sham  ani- 
mals, and  above  all  he  would  never  give  up  the  glory  which 
he  had  gained  in  shooting  with  the  first  shot  from  his  gun 
the  chief  of  the  Polynesian  tribe — one  of  the  servants  of 
the  Kolderup  establishment,  who  turned  out  to  be  as  well 
as  he  was. 

All  was  described,  all  was  explained,  except  the  serious 
matter  of  the  real  wild  beasts  and  the  unknown  smokev 
Uncle  Will  became  very  thoughtful  about  this.  But,  like  a 
practical  man,  he  put  off,  by  an  effort  of  the  will,  the  solu- 
tion of  the  problems,  and  addressing  his  nephew,  "God- 
frey," said  he,  "you  have  always  been  so  fond  of  islands, 
that  I  am  sure  it  will  please  you  to  hear  that  this  is  yours 
— wholly  yours!  I  make  you  a  present  of  it!  You  can 
do  what  you  like  with  it ! — I  never  dreamed  of  bringing  you 
away  by  force;  and  I  would  not  take  you  away  from  it! 
Be  then  a  Crusoe  for  the  rest  of  your  life,  if  your  heart 
tells  you  to—" 

"I!"  answered  Godfrey.     "I!     All  my  life!" 

Phina  stepped  forward.  "Godfrey,"  she  asked,  "would 
you  like  to  remain  on  your  island?" 

"I  would  rather  die!"  he  exclaimed.  But  immediately 
he  added,  as  he  took  the  young  lady's  hand,  "Well,  yes,  I 
will  remain;  but  on  three  conditions.  The  first  is,  you 
stay  with  me,  dearest  Phina ;  the  second  is,  that  Uncle  Will 
lives  with  us;  and  the  third  is,  that  the  chaplain  of  the 
Dream  marries  us  this  very  day!" 

"There  is  no  chaplain  on  board  the  Dream,  Godfrey!" 
replied  Uncle  Will.  "You  know  that  very  well.  But  I 
think  there  is  still  one  left  in  San  Francisco,  and  that  we 
can  find  some  worthy  minister  to  perform  the  service! 


ALL  THE  MYSTERIES  SOLVED  143 

I  believe  I  read  your  thoughts  when  I  say  that  before 
tomorrow  we  shall  put  to  sea  again!" 

Then  Phina  and  Uncle  Will  asked  Godfrey  to  do  the 
honors  of  his  island.  Behold  them  then  walking  under  the 
group  of  sequoias,  along  the  stream  up  to  the  little  bridge. 

Alas!  of  the  habitation  at  Will  Tree  nothing  remained. 
The  fire  had  completely  devoured  the  dwelling  in  the  base 
of  the  tree !  Without  the  arrival  of  William  W.  Kolderup, 
what  with  the  approaching  winter,  the  destruction  of  their 
stores,  and  the  genuine  wild  beasts  in  the  island,  our 
Crusoes  would  have  deserved  to  be  pitied. 

"Uncle  Will!"  said  Godfrey,  "if  I  gave  the  island  the 
name  of  Phina,  let  me  add  that  I  gave  our  dwelling  the 
name  of  Will  Tree!" 

"Well,"  answered  the  uncle,  "we  will  take  away  some 
of  the  seed,  and  plant  it  in  my  garden  at  'Frisco!" 

During  the  walk  they  noticed  some  wild  animals  in  the 
distance;  but  they  dared  not  attack  so  formidable  a  party 
as  the  sailors  of  the  Dream.  But  none  the  less  was  their 
presence  absolutely  incomprehensible. 

Then  they  returned  on  board,  not  without  Tartlet  asking 
permission  to  bring  off  "his  crocodile" — a  permission  which 
was  granted.  That  evening  the  party  were  united  in  the 
saloon  of  the  Dream,  and  there  was  quite  a  cheerful  dinner 
to  celebrate  the  end  of  the  adventures  of  Godfrey  Morgan 
and  his  marriage  with  Phina  Hollaney. 

On  the  morrow,  the  2Oth  of  January,  the  Dream  set  sail 
under  the  command  of  Captain  Turcott.  At  eight  o'clock 
in  the  morning  Godfrey,  not  without  emotion,  saw  the 
horizon  in  the  west  wipe  out,  as  if  it  were  a  shadow,  the 
island  on  which  he  had  been  to  school  for  six  months — a 
school  of  which  he  never  forgot  the  lessons. 

The  passage  was  rapid;  the  sea  magnificent;  the  wind 
favorable.  This  time  the  Dream  went  straight  to  her 
destination!  There  was  no  one  to  be  mystified!  She 
made  no  tackings  without  number  as  on  the  first  voyage! 
She  did  not  lose  during  the  night  what  she  had  gained 
during  the  day! 

And  so  on  the  23-rd  of  January,  after  passing  at  noon 
through  the  Golden  Gate,  she  entered  the  vast  bay  of  San 
Francisco,  and  came  alongside  the  wharf  in  Merchant 
Street. 


144  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

And  what  did  they  then  see?  They  saw  issue  from  the 
hold  a  man  who,  having  swum  to  the  Dream  during  the 
night  while  she  was  anchored  at  Phina  Island,  had  suc- 
ceeded in  stowing  himself  away  for  the  second  time!  And 
who  was  this  man  ?  It  was  the  Chinaman,  Seng  Vou,  who 
had  made  the  passage  back  as  he  had  made  the  passage 
out! 

Seng  Vou  advanced  toward  William  W.  Kolderup.  "I 
hope  Mr.  Kolderup  will  pardon  me,"  said  he  very  politely. 
"When  I  took  my  passage  in  the  Dream,  I  thought  she 
was  going  direct  to  Shanghai,  and  then  I  should  have 
reached  my  country,  but  I  leave  her  now,  and  return  to 
San  Francisco." 

Every  one,  astounded  at  the  apparition,  knew  not  what 
to  answer,  and  laughingly  gazed  at  the  intruder.  "But," 
said  William  W.  Kolderup  at  last,  "you  have  not  remained 
six  months  in  the  hold,  I  suppose?" 

"No!"  answered  Seng  Vou. 

"Where  have  you  been,  then?" 

"On  the  island!" 

"You!"  exclaimed  Godfrey. 

"Yes." 

"Then  the  smoke?" 

"A  man  must  have  a  fire!" 

"And  you  did  not  attempt  to  come  to  us,  to  share  our 
living?" 

"A  Chinaman  likes  to  live  alone,"  quietly  replied  Seng 
Vou.  "He  is  sufficient  for  himself,  and  he  wants  no  one !" 
And  thereupon  this  eccentric  individual  bowed  to  William 
W.  Kolderup,  landed,  and  disappeared. 

"That  is  the  stuff  they  make  real  Crusoes  of!"  observed 
Uncle  Will.  "Look  at  him  and  see  if  you  are  like  him! 
It  does  not  matter,  the  English  race  would  do  no  good  bv 
absorbing  fellows  of  that  stamp!" 

"Good!"  said  Godfrey,  "the  smoke  is  explained  by  the 
presence  of  Seng  Vou;  but  the  beasts?" 

"And  my  crocodile!"  added  Tartlet;  "I  should  like 
some  one  to  explain  my  crocodile!" 

William  W.  Kolderup  seemed  much  embarrassed,  and 
feeling  in  turn  quite  mystified,  passed  his  hand  over  his 
forehead  as  if  to  clear  the  clouds  away. 


ALL  THE  MYSTERIES  SOLVED  145 

"We  shall  know  later  on,"  he  said.  "Everything  is 
found  by  him  who  knows  how  to  seek !" 

A  few  days  afterward  there  was  celebrated  with  great 
pomp  the  wedding  of  the  nephew  and  goddaughter  of 
William  W.  Kolderup.  That  the  young  couple  were  made 
much  of  by  all  the  friends  of  the  wealthy  merchant  can 
easily  be  imagined. 

At  the  ceremony  Tartlet  was  perfect  in  bearing,  in 
everything,  and  the  pupil  did  honor  to  the  celebrated  pro- 
fessor of  dancing  and  deportment. 

Now  Tartlet  had  an  idea.  Not  being  able  to  mount  his 
crocodile  on  a  scarf-pin— and  much  he  regretted  it — he 
resolved  to  have  it  stuffed.  The  animal  prepared  in  this 
fashion — hung  from  the  ceiling,  with  the  jaws  half  open, 
and  the  paws  outspread — would  make  a  fine  ornament  for 
his  room.  The  crocodile  was  consequently  sent  to  a  fa- 
mous taxidermist,  and  he  brought  it  back  to  Tartlet  a  few 
days  afterward.  Every  one  came  to  admire  the  monster 
who  had  almost  made  a  meal  of  Tartlet. 

"You  know,  Mr.  Kolderup,  where  the  animal  came 
from?"  said  the  celebrated  taxidermist,  presenting  his  bill. 

"No,  I  do  not,"  answered  Uncle  Will. 

"But  it  had  a  label  underneath  its  carapace." 

"A  label!"  exclaimed  Godfrey. 

"Here  it  is,"  said  the  celebrated  taxidermist. 

And  he  held  out  a  piece  of  leather  on  which,  in  indelible 
ink,  were  written  these  words: 

"From  Hagenbeck,  Hamburg, 

"To  J.  R.  Taskinar,  Stockton,  U.  S.  A." 

When  William  W.  Kolderup  had  read  these  words  he 
burst  into  a  shout  of  laughter.  He  understood  all. 

It  was  his  enemy,  J.  R.  Taskinar,  his  conquered  com- 
petitor, who,  to  be  revenged,  had  bought  a  cargo  of  wild 
beasts,  reptiles,  and  other  objectionable  creatures  from  a 
well-known  purveyor  to  the  menageries  of  both  hemi- 
spheres, and  had  landed  them  at  night  in  several  voyages  to 
Spencer  Island.  It  had  cost  him  a  good  deal,  no  doubt,  to 
do  so ;  but  he  had  succeeded  in  infesting  the  property  of  his 
rival,  as  the  English  did  Martinique,  if  we  are  to  believe 
the  legend,  before  it  was  handed  over  to  France. 

Vol.  13  Verno 


146  ROBINSON  CRUSOE  SCHOOL 

There  was  thus  no  more  to  explain  of  the  remarkable 
occurrences  on  Phina  Island. 

"Well  done!"  exclaimed  William  W.  Kolderup.  "I  could 
not  have  done  better  myself!" 

"But  with  those  terrible  creatures,"  said  Phina,  "Spencer 
Island—" 

"Phina  Island — "  interrupted  Godfrey. 

"Phina  Island,"  continued  the  bride,  with  a  smile,  "is 
quite  uninhabitable." 

"Bah !"  answered  Uncle  Will ;  "we  can  wait  till  the  last 
lion  has  eaten  up  the  last  tiger!" 

"And  then,  dearest  Phina,"  said  Godfrey,  "you  will  not 
be  afraid  to  pass  a  season  there  with  me?" 

"With  you,  my  dear  husband,  I  fear  nothing  from  any- 
where," answered  Phina,  "and  as  you  have  not  had  your 
voyage  around  the  world — " 

"We  will  have  it  together,"  said  Godfrey,  "and  if  an 
unlucky  chance  should  ever  make  me  a  real  Crusoe — " 

"You  will  ever  have  near  you  the  most  devoted  of 
Crusoe-esses !" 

THE  END. 


The  Star  of  the  South 

or 
The  Vanished  Diamond 

A  South  African  Romance 


The  Star  of  the  South 


CHAPTER  I 

ONE   FOR   THE   FRENCHMAN 

O  on,  I  am  listening." 

"I  have  the  honor  to  ask  you  for  your 
daughter's  hand." 

"Alice?" 

"Yes.  My  request  seems  to  surprise 
you.  Perhaps  you  will  forgive  me  if  I 
have  some  difficulty  in  understanding  why  it  appears 
so  strange.  I  am  twenty-six  years  old;  my  name  is 
Victor  Cyprien;  I  am  a  mining  engineer,  and  left  the 
Polytechnic  as  second  on  the  list.  My  family  is  honest 
and  respected,  if  it  is  not  rich.  The  French  consul  at 
Capetown  can  answer  any  questions  about  me  you  are 
likely  to  ask,  and  my  friend  Pharamond  Barthes,  the  ex- 
plorer, whom  you — like  everybody  else  in  Griqualand— 
know  right  well,  can  add  his  testimony.  I  am  here  on  a 
scientific  mission  in  the  name  of  the  Academy  of  Sciences 
and  the  French  Government.  Last  year  I  gained  the 
Houdart  prize  at  the  Institute  for  my  researches  on  the 
chemistry 'of  the  volcanic  rocks  of  Auvergne.  My  paper 
on  the  diamantiferous  basin  of  the  Vaal,  which  is  nearly 
finished,  is  sure  of  a  good  reception  from  the  scientific 
world.  When  I  started  on  my  mission  I  was  appointed 
Assistant-Professor  at  the  Paris  School  of  Mines,  and  I 
have  already  engaged  my  rooms  on  the  third  floor  at  No. 
104  of  the  Rue  Universite.  My  appointments  will,  during 
the  first  year,  bring  me  in  two  hundred  pounds.  That  is 
hardly  an  El  Dorado,  I  know,  but  with  my  private  work 
I  can  nearly  double  it.  My  wants  being  few,  I  have 
enough  to  be  happy  on.  And  so,  Mr.  Watkins,  I  have  the 
honor  to  ask  you  for  your  daughter's  hand." 

From  the  firm,  decided  tone  of  this  little  speech  it  was 

149 


150  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

easy  to  see  that  Cyprien  was  accustomed  to  go  straight  to 
the  point  in  what  he  did,  and  to  speak  his  mind  freely. 

His  looks  did  not  belie  his  words.  They  were  those  of  a 
young  man  habitually  occupied  in  the  abstrusest  problems 
of  science,  and  only  giving  to  worldly  vanities  the  time 
that  was  absolutely  necessary.  All  about  him  showed  an 
earnest  and  serious  disposition,  while  his  clear,  keen  glance 
proclaimed  an  untroubled  conscience.  He  was  by  birth  a 
Frenchman,  but  he  spoke  English  as  well  as  if  he  had 
lived  all  his  life  beneath  the  British  flag. 

Seated  in  his  arm-chair,  with  his  left  leg  thrust  out  on 
to  a  stool,  and  his  elbow  resting  on  the  table,  Mr.  Watkins 
listened  to  Cyprien's  speech  and  puffed  away  at  his  pipe. 
The  old  man  wore  white  trousers,  a  blue  linen  jacket,  and 
a  yellow  flannel  shirt,  and  had  neither  waistcoat  nor  cra- 
vat. His  huge  felt  hat  seemed  to  be  screwed  on  to  his 
gray  head.  The  red,  bloated  face  was  cut  into  by  a  bristly 
beard,  and  lighted  up  by  two  little  gray  eyes  that  spoke  of 
anything  but  patience  and  good-nature. 

As  some  excuse  for  Mr.  Watkins,  it  may  be  mentioned 
that  he  was  a  terrible  sufferer  from  the  gout — hence  his 
bandaged  leg;  and  the  gout  in  Africa,  as  elsewhere,  is  not 
calculated  to  soften  the  asperities  of  a  man's  character. 

The  scene  is  at  Watkins'  Farm,  in  lat.  29°  S.,  long.  25° 
E.,  on  the  western  border  of  the  Orange  Free  State,  and 
nearly  five  hundred  miles  from  Capetown.  On  the  older 
maps  the  surrounding  district  bears  the  title  of  Griqualand, 
but  for  the  last  dozen  years  it  has  been  better  known  as 
the  Diamond  Fields. 

The  parlor  in  which  the  interview  is  in  progress  is  as 
remarkable  for  the  luxury  of  some  of  its  furniture  as  for 
the  poverty  of  the  rest.  The  floor  is  simply  the  natural 
earth  leveled  and  beaten  flat,  and  this  is  covered  here  and 
there  with  thick  carpets  and  precious  furs.  The  walls  are 
destitute  of  paper  or  paint,  and  yet  they  are  decked 
with  a  magnificent  candelabrum,  and  valuable  weapons 
of  various  kinds  hang  side  by  side  with  gorgeously  colored 
lithographs  in  resplendent  frames.  A  velvet  sofa  stands 
next  to  a  plain  deal  table,  such  as  is  generally  found  in 
kitchens.  Arm-chairs  direct  from  Europe  offer  their  arms 
in  vain  to  Mr.  Watkins,  who  is  taking  his  ease  in  a  solid 
construction  of  his  own  design.  On  the  whole,  however, 


ONE  FOR  THE  FRENCHMAN  151 

the  heap  of  objects  of  value,  and  the  numerous  furs — 
panther-skins,  leopard-skins,  giraffe-skins,  and  tiger-cat- 
skins,  that  cover  nearly  every  article  of  furniture,  give  the 
room  a  certain  air  of  barbarous  wealth. 

The  ceiling  shows  that  the  house  is  not  built  in  stories; 
it  can  only  boast  of  a  ground  floor.  Like  all  the  rest  in 
the  neighborhood,  its  walls  are  of  planks  and  clay,  and  its 
roof  of  corrugated  iron. 

It  is  obviously  a  new  house.  From  its  windows,  to  the 
right  and  left  of  it,  can  be  seen  five  or  six  abandoned 
buildings  of  the  same  order  of  architecture,  but  of  different 
ages,  in  various  stages  of  decay.  These  are  the  mansions 
that  Mr.  Watkins  has  successively  built,  inhabited,  and 
deserted  as  he  built  up  his  fortune,  and  now  serve  to  mark 
the  several  steps  of  his  progress  to  affluence. 

That  farthest  off  is  a  hut  of  sods.  Next  to  it  comes  one 
with  walls  of  clay.  The  third  has  walls  of  clay  and  wood. 
The  fourth  rejoices  in  a  little  zinc. 

The  group  of  buildings  is  situated  on  a  gentle  rise  that 
commands  the  junction  of  the  Vaal  and  the  Modder,  the 
two  principal  tributaries  of  the  Orange.  Around,  as  far  as 
the  eye  can  see,  there  stretches  the  bare  and  dreary-looking 
plain.  The  Veld,  as  this  plain  is  called,  has  a  reddish 
soil,  dry,  barren,  and  dusty,  with  here  and  there  at  con- 
siderable intervals  a  straggling  bush  or  a  clump  of  thorn- 
shrubs. 

The  total  absence  of  trees  is  characteristic;  and  as  there 
is  no  coal,  owing  to  the  communication  with  the  sea  being 
so  difficult  and  lengthy,  the  only  fuel  for  domestic  purposes 
is  that  yielded  by  the  sheep's  droppings. 

Through  this  dismal  and  monotonous  plain  there  flow 
the  two  rivers,  with  their  banks  so  low  and  sloping  that  it 
is  difficult  to  understand  why  the  water  does  not  break  its 
bounds  and  flood  the  country. 

Eastward  the  horizon  is  cut  by  the  distant  outlines  of 
two  mountains,  the  Platberg  and  the  Paardeberg,  at  whose 
base  the  dust  and  smoke  and  the  little  white  spots  of  huts 
and  tents  denote  a  busy  human  colony. 

It  is  in  this  Veld  that  the  diamond  mines  are  situated — • 
Dutoit's  Pan,  New  Rush,  and  perhaps  the  richest  of  all, 
Vandergaart  Kopje.  These  dry  diggings,  as  mines  open 
to  the  sky  are  called,  have  since  1870  yielded  about 


152  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

i6,ooo,ooo/.  in  diamonds  and  precious  stones.  They  are 
all  close  together,  and  can  be  distinctly  seen  with  a  good 
glass  from  the  windows  of  Watkins'  Farm,  about  four 
miles  away. 

Farm,  by-the-bye,  is  rather  a  misnomer.  There  are  no 
signs  of  cultivation  in  the  neighborhood.  Like  all  the 
so-called  farmers  of  this  part  of  South  Africa,  Mr.  Wat- 
kins  is  rather  a  master  shepherd,  an  owner  of  flocks  and 
herds,  than  an  agriculturist. 

But  Mr.  Watkins  has  not  yet  replied  to  the  question  put 
to  him  so  clearly  and  politely  by  our  hero.  After  giving 
himself  three  minutes  for  reflection,  he  decided  to  remove 
his  pipe  from  his  lips.  Then  he  made  the  following 
observation,  which  would  seem  to  be  but  very  distantly 
connected  with  the  subject  at  issue. 

"I  think  we  shall  have  a  change  in  the  weather!  My 
gout  never  worried  me  more  than  it  has  done  since  this 
morning." 

The  young  engineer  frowned,  and  turned  away  his  head 
for  a  moment.  It  was  only  by  an  effort  that  he  concealed 
his  disappointment. 

"It  might  do  you  good  if  you  were  to  give  up  your  gin, 
Mr.  Watkins,"  replied  he,  very  dryly,  pointing  to  the  jug 
on  the  table. 

"Give  up  my  gin!  Well,  that's  a  good  'un!"  exclaimed 
the  farmer.  "Is  it  the  gin  that  does  it?  Oh!  I  know 
what  you  are  driving  at.  You  mean  the  medicine  the 
Lord  Mayor  was  recommended  when  he  had  the  gout. 
Whose  was  it?  Abernethy's?  'If  you  want  to  be  well, 
live  on  a  shilling  a  day  and  earn  it/  That's  all  very  fine. 
But  if  you  have  to  live  on  a  shilling  a  day  to  be  well, 
what's  the  use  of  making  a  fortune?  Such  rubbish  is 
unworthy  of  a  sensible  man  like  you.  So  don't  say  any 
more  about  it.  I'll  do  as  I  please.  I'll  eat  well,  drink 
well,  and  smoke  a  good  pipe  when  I  am  worried.  I  have 
no  other  pleasure  in  this  world,  and  you  want  me  to  give 
it  up,  do  you?" 

"It  is  a  matter  of  no  consequence,"  answered  Cyprien; 
"I  only  dropped  a  hint  that  I  thought  might  be  of  use 
to  you.  But  let  it  pass,  Mr.  Watkins,  if  you  please,  and 
get  back  to  the  special  object  of  my  visit." 


ONE  FOR  THE  FRENCHMAN  153 

The  farmer's  flow  of  eloquence  came  to  a  sudden  pause. 
He  relapsed  into  silence  and  puffed  away  at  his  pipe. 

And  now  the  door  opened,  and  a  young  lady  entered, 
carrying  a  glass  on  a  salver. 

And  very  charming  she  looked  in  her  neat  print  dress 
and  large  white  cap,  such  as  is  always  worn  by  the  ladies 
of  the  Veld.  Aged  about  nineteen  or  twenty,  with  singu- 
larly clear  complexion,  fair,  silky  hair,  pure  blue  eyes,  and 
gentle,  thoughtful  face,  she  was  quite  a  picture  of  health, 
grace,  and  good-nature. 

"Good  morning,  Mr.  Cyprien." 

"Good  morning,  Miss  Watkins!"  answered  Cyprien, 
rising  and  bowing. 

"I  saw  you  come  in,"  said  Alice,  "and  as  I  know  you 
don't  care  for  papa's  horrible  gin,  I  have  brought  you 
some  orangeade,  which  I  hope  you  will  find  to  your  taste." 

"It  is  very  kind  of  you,  I  am  sure." 

"Of  course  it  is!  Now,  what  do  you  think  my  ostrich 
Dada  gobbled  up  this  morning?  The  ivory  ball  I  darn 
the  stockings  on!  Yes,  my  ivory  ball;  and  it  is  of  good 
size,  as  you  know.  Well,  that  greedy  Dada  swallowed  it 
as  if  it  had  been  a  pill.  I  know  he  will  give  me  serious 
trouble  some  day." 

As  she  said  this  the  laughing  look  in  her  eyes  did  not 
betray  much  alarm  at  the  anticipated  sorrow.  In  an 
instant,  however,  there  was  a  change.  With  quick  intui- 
tion she  noticed  the  constraint  that  her  father  and  Cyprien 
felt  at  her  presence. 

"I  am  an  intruder,  I  see,"  she  said.  "I  am  sorry  I 
should  have  interrupted  you,  particularly  as  I  have  no 
time  to  lose.  I  must  study  my  sonata  before  I  begin  to 
look  after  the  dinner.  I  am  sure  no  one  could  complain 
of  your  talkativeness  today,  gentlemen.  I  leave  you  to 
your  conspiracies." 

She  had  reached  the  door,  when  she  turned  around  and 
gravely  said,  as  if  the  subject  were  of  the  deepest  impor- 
tance, "When  you  wish  to  talk  about  oxygen,  Mr.  Cyprien, 
I  am  quite  prepared  for  you.  Three  times  have  I  read 
over  the  chemical  lesson  you  gave  me  to  learn,  and  'the 
gaseous,  colorless,  scentless,  and  tasteless  body'  has  no 
longer  any  secrets  from  me." 

And  with  that  Miss  Watkins  dropped  a  slight  curtsy 


154  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

and  disappeared  like  a  meteor.  A  moment  later  the  notes 
of  an  excellent  piano,  heard  from  one  of  the  rooms  at 
some  distance  from  the  parlor,  announced  that  the  daughter 
of  the  house  was  engaged  in  her  musical  exercises. 

"Well,  Mr.  Watkins,"  said  Cyprien,  reminded  of  his 
request  by  this  apparition — if  it  had  been  possible  for  him 
to  forget  it — "will  you  give  me  an  answer  to  the  question 
I  had  the  honor  to  ask  you  ?" 

Mr.  Watkins  removed  his  pipe  from  the  corner  of  his 
mouth,  expectorated  with  great  majesty,  abruptly  raised 
his  head,  and  looked  at  the  young  man  with  the  air  of  a 
grand  inquisitor. 

"Was  it  by  chance  that  you  spoke  about  this  to  her?" 

"Spoke  about  what?    To  whom?" 

"What  you  have  been  talking  about  now ;  my  daughter." 

"For  whom  do  you  take  me,  Mr.  Watkins?"  replied  the 
young  engineer,  warmly.  "I  am  a  Frenchman,  sir,  and 
that  is  to  say,  that  without  your  consent  I  should  never 
think  of  speaking  to  your  daughter  about  marriage." 

Mr.  Watkins  looked  somewhat  mollified,  and  his  tongue 
seemed  to  move  more  freely.  "So  much  the  better,  my 
boy.  I  expected  no  less  of  you,"  answered  he,  in  almost 
a  cordial  tone.  "And  now  as  I  can  trust  you,  you  will 
give  me  your  word  of  honor  never  to  speak  of  it  in  the 
future." 

"And  why,  sir?" 

"Because  the  marriage  is  impossible,  and  the  best  thing 
you  can  do  is  to  drop  all  thoughts  of  it,"  continued  the 
farmer.  "Mr.  Cyprien,  you  are  an  honest  young  fellow, 
a  perfect  gentleman,  an  excellent  chemist,  a  distinguished 
professor,  and  have  a  brilliant  future;  I  do  not  doubt  it 
at  all.  But  you  will  never  have  my  daughter,  and  that 
because  I  have  quite  different  plans  for  her." 

"But,  Mr.  Watkins—" 

"Say  no  more;  it  is  useless,"  interrupted  the  farmer. 
"If  you  were  an  English  duke,  you  might  convince  me; 
but  you  are  not  even  an  English  subject,  and  you  have 
just  told  me  with  perfect  frankness  that  you  have  no 
money!  Look  you  here;  do  you  seriously  think  that, 
educating  Alice  as  I  have  done,  giving  her  the  best  masters 
of  Victoria  and  Bloemfontein,  I  had  intended  to  send  her, 
as  soon  as  she  was  twenty,  to  Paris,  on  the  third  floor  at 


ONE  FOR  THE  FRENCHMAN  155 

No.  104  of  the  Roo  University,  to  live  with  a  man  whose 
language  I  don't  even  understand?  Just  give  that  a 
thought,  and  put  yourself  in  my  place.  Suppose  you  were 
John  Watkins,  farmer  and  proprietor  of  Vandergaart 
Kopje  Mine,  and  I  was  Victor  Cyprien,  on  a  scientific 
mission  to  the  Cape;  suppose  that  you  here  were  seated 
in  this  chair,  smoking  your  pipe;  suppose  that  you  were 
I,  and  I  were  you;  would  you  for  a  moment  think  of 
giving  me  your  daughter  in  marriage?" 

"Certainly  I  would,  Mr.  Watkins,"  replied  Cyprien,  "and 
without  the  slightest  hesitation,  if  I  thought  you  were 
likely  to  make  her  happy." 

"Oh!  ah!  Well,  then,  you  would  be  wrong.  You 
would  act  like  a  man  unworthy  of  being  the  owner  of 
Vandergaart  Kopje,  or  rather,  you  never  would  have  been 
the  owner  of  it!  For  do  you  think  I  only  had  to  hold  my 
hand  out  as  it  came  by?  Do  you  think  I  wanted  neither 
sense  nor  energy  when  I  found  it  out  and  made  it  my 
property?  Well,  Mr.  Cyprien,  the  sense  I  showed  in  that 
affair,  I  show  and  will  show  in  every  act  of  my  life,  and 
particularly  in  all  that  concerns  my  daughter.  And  so  I 
say,  drop  it.  Alice  will  never  be  yours."  And  at  this 
triumphant  conclusion  Mr.  Watkins  tossed  off  his  glass. 

The  young  engineer  was  silent,  and  the  old  man  con- 
tinued, "You  Frenchmen  are  an  astonishing  lot!  There  is 
nothing  very  backward  about  you.  You  come  here  as  if 
you  had  dropped  from  the  moon  into  this  out-of-the-way 
spot  in  Griqualand,  call  on  a  man  who  had  never  heard  of 
you  three  months  ago,  and  who  has  not  set  eyes  on  you  a 
dozen  times,  and  say  to  him,  'John  Stapleton  Watkins, 
you  have  a  nice  daughter,  well  educated,  everywhere  known 
as  the  pride  of  the  place,  and,  what  is  anything  but  a 
draw-back,  the  sole  heiress  of  the  richest  diamond  kopje 
in  the  world.  I  am  Mr.  Victor  Cyprien,  of  Paris,  an 
engineer  with  two  hundred  a  year,  and  I  should  like  you 
tc  give  me  your  daughter,  so  that  I  can  take  her  home, 
and  you  can  never  hear  of  her  for  the  future,  except  by 
post  or  telegraph'/  And  you  think  that  is  quite  natural? 
I  think  it  is  consummate  impudence!" 

Cyprien  rose,  looking  very  pale.  He  picked  up  his  hat 
and  prepared  to  leave. 

"Yes,  consummate  impudence!"  continued  the   farmer. 


156  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

"No  gilded  pills  for  me.  I  am  an  Englishman  of  the  old 
sort,  sir.  I  have  been  poorer  than  you — yes,  much  poorer. 
I  have  tried  my  hand  at  everything.  I  have  been  a  cabin- 
boy  on  a  merchant  ship,  a  buffalo-hunter  in  Dakota,  a  dig- 
ger in  Arizona,  and  a  shepherd  in  the  Transvaal.  I  have 
known  heat  and  cold  and  hunger  and  trouble.  For  twenty 
years  I  earned  my  crust  by  the  sweat  of  my  brow.  When 
I  married  Alice's  mother,  we  hadn't  enough  to  feed  a  goat 
on.  But  I  worked.  I  never  lost  courage.  And  now  I  am 
rich,  and  intend  to  profit  by  the  fruit  of  my  labors.  I  am 
going  to  keep  my  daughter  to  nurse  me,  to  look  after  my 
gout,  and  to  give  me  some  music  in  the  evening  when  I 
am  tired.  If  she  ever  marries,  she  will  marry  here;  and 
she  will  marry  some  fellow  who  lives  here,  a  farmer  or 
a  digger  like  I  am,  and  who  will  not  talk  to  me  of  semi- 
starvation  in  a  third  floor  in  a  country  that  I  never  had  the 
slightest  desire  to  go  near.  She  will  marry  James  Hilton 
or  some  fellow  of  that  stamp.  There  will  be  no  lack  of 
offers." 

Cyprien  had  already  reached  the  door. 

"No  animosity,  my  boy;  I  wish  you  no  harm.  I  shall 
always  be  glad  to  see  you  as  a  tenant  and  a  friend.  We 
have  got  some  people  coming  to  dinner  this  evening.  Will 
you  make  one?" 

"No,  thank  you,  sir,"  answered  Cyprien,  coldly.  "I 
have  my  letters  to  write  for  the  mail." 

"One  for  the  Frenchman !"  chuckled  Mr.  Watkins. 


CHAPTER  II 

TO  THE  DIAMOND  FIELDS 

WHAT  most  humiliated  the  young  engineer  in  the  answer 
he  received  from  Mr.  Watkins  was  the  fact  that,  in  spite 
of  the  rudeness  in  which  it  was  couched,  the  decision  was 
not  unreasonable.  When  he  came  to  think  matters  over, 
he  was  surprised  at  himself  for  not  having  seen  the  farm- 
er's very  obvious  objections. 

But  the  fact  is,  that  up  till  then  he  had  never  dreamed  of 
the  difference  of  fortune,  race,  and  education  between  the 
young  lady  and  himself.  Accustomed  for  the  last  five  or 
six  years  to  regard  minerals  merely  from  their  scientific 


TO  THE  DIAMOND  FIELDS  157 

point  of  view,  diamonds  were  in  his  eyes  but  specimens  of 
carbon  adapted  for  exhibition  in  the  museum  of  the  School 
of  Mines.  In  France  he  had  moved  in  quite  a  different 
social  circle  from  what  he  did  here,  and  he  had  quite  lost 
sight  of  the  commercial  value  of  the  rich  mine  possessed 
by  the  farmer.  The  thought  that  there  was  a  difference  in 
station  between  the  daughter  of  the  owner  of  Vandergaart 
Kopje  and  himself  had  never  entered  his  head. 

The  sharp  reprimand  he  had  received  from  Watkins 
awoke  him  from  his  illusion.  Cyprien  had  too  much  sense 
not  to  appreciate  the  farmer's  reasons,  and  too  much 
honesty  to  be  angry  at  a  decision  which  he  admitted  was, 
in  the  main,  a  just  one. 

But  the  blow  was  none  the  less  severe,  and  now  that  he 
had  to  give  up  Alice  he  found  how  dear  she  had  become 
to  him  in  those  three  months.  For  only  three  months 
had  elapsed  since  his  arrival  in  Griqualand. 

How  far  off  it  all  seemed ! 

Landing  with  his  friend  Pharamond  Barthes — an  old 
schoolfellow  who  had  come  out  to  South  Africa  on  his 
third  hunting  and  exploring  expedition — he  had  separated 
from  him  at  the  Cape.  Barthes  started  for  Basutoland  to 
engage  an  escort;  Cyprien  secured  a  seat  in  the  heavy, 
lumbering,  fourteen-horse  wagon — the  stage-coach  of  the 
Veld — and  set  out  for  the  Diamond  Fields. 

Five  or  six  huge  cases — a  complete  chemical  and  min- 
eralogical  laboratory,  from  which  he  was  very  loath  to  part 
— formed  the  luggage  of  the  youthful  scientist;  but  the 
coach  only  allowed  a  hundredweight  of  luggage  to  each 
passenger,  and  he  had  consequently  been  obliged  to  entrust 
his  precious  cases  to  the  tender  mercies  of  a  bullock  cart. 

The  "coach"  held  twelve  passengers.  It  was  covered 
with  a  canvas  tilt,  and  had  four  enormous  wheels  con- 
stantly wet  from  crossing  the  fords.  The  horses,  which 
were  occasionally  replaced  by  mules,  were  harnessed  in 
pairs,  and  driven  by  two  coachmen  seated  side  by  side  on 
the  front  bench.  One  held  the  reins,  while  the  other 
manipulated  a  tremendously  long  bamboo  whip,  not  unlike 
a  huge  fishing-rod,  and  used  it  to  guide  the  horses  as  well 
as  to  urge  them  on. 

The  road  goes  by  Beaufort,  a  pleasant  little  place  at 
the  foot  of  the  Nieuwveld  Mountains,  across  the  bills  to 


'158  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

Victoria,  then  to  Hopetown  on  the  Orange,  and  thence  to 
Kimberley  and  the  principal  diamond  centers,  which  are 
but  a  few  miles  away  from  it. 

It  is  a  wearying,  monotonous  journey  across  the  Veld, 
and  takes  from  eight  to  nine  days.  The  landscape  is  most 
miserable — red  plains,  scattered  stones  like  moraine  rubbish 
on  the  surface,  and  gray  rock  cropping  out  from  below, 
half-starved-looking  bushes,  and  here  and  there  a  stunted 
sickly  plant.  At  long  intervals  a  few  dilapidated  farms 
doing  duty  for  inns.  The  hospitality  of  these  inns  is 
somewhat  rudimentary.  The  "good  accommodation  for 
man  and  beast"  comprises  neither  a  bed  for  the  man  nor 
litter  for  the  beast,  and  the  provisions  are  tinned  ones  that 
have  gone  the  round  of  the  world,  and  sell  at  the  buyer's 
risk  for  their  weight  in  gold. 

There  being  nothing  for  the  horses  at  the  farms,  the 
teams  are  unharnessed  and  allowed  to  wander  about  in 
search  of  their  own  food.  They  have  to  be  caught  again 
before  a  start  can  be  made,  and  the  loss  of  time  thus 
occasioned  may  be  imagined. 

Great  is  the  jolting  of  the  primitive  coach  along  the  still 
more  primitive  roads.  The  seats  are  the  lids  of  the 
wooden  lockers  which  hold  the  light  luggage  of  the  pas- 
sengers, and  on  them  for  a  week  or  more  their  possessors 
go  thump- jump,  like  so  many  forge  hammers,  as  the  wagon 
rolls  along.  Impossible  to  read,  impossible  to  sleep,  nay, 
even  impossible  to  talk! 

Cyprien's  fellow-travelers  were  fairly  representative  of 
the  floating  population  peculiar  to  gold  and  diamond  fields. 
There  was  an  ungainly  Neapolitan,  with  long  black  hair, 
a  face  like  parchment,  and  a  pair  of  glittering  treacherous- 
looking  eyes,  who  said  his  name  was  Annibale  Pantalacci; 
a  Portuguese  Jew  named  Nathan,  an  expert  in  diamonds, 
who  kept  himself  quiet  in  a  corner  and  looked  upon  hu- 
manity like  a  philosopher;  a  tall  collier,  Thomas  Steel, 
with  a  red  beard  and  broad  shoulders,  who  had  left  his 
native  Lancashire  to  try  his  fortune  in  Griqualand;  a 
German,  Herr  Fredel,  who  spoke  like  an  oracle,  and  knew 
everything  about  diamonds  and  diamond  digging — in 
theory;  a  thin-lipped  Yankee,  who  reckoned  to  open  a 
canteen  and  persuade  the  miners  to  waste  their  hard-earned 
wealth ;  a  farmer  from  the  Hartz ;  a  Boer  from  the  Orange 


TO  THE  DIAMOND  FIELDS  159 

Free  State;  an  ivory  trader  on  his  way  to  Namaqualand ; 
two  Transvaal  colonists;  and  a  Chinaman  named  Li — like 
every  other  Chinaman — made  up  the  most  heterogeneous, 
noisy,  and  disorderly  company  in  which  it  was  ever  given 
to  a  man  to  find  himself. 

At  first  Cyprien  was  amused,  but  not  for  long.  There 
was  only  Steel,  with  his  massive  strength  and  loud  laugh- 
ter, and  Li,  with  his  gentle  catlike  ways,  in  whom  he  con- 
tinued to  take  the  slightest  interest.  To  the  Neapolitan, 
with  his  spiteful  buffooneries,  he  felt  the  strongest  aversion. 

One  of  the  most  popular  jokes  of  this  personage  con- 
sisted in  his  tying  on  to  the  Chinaman's  pigtail,  whenever 
he  got  an  opportunity,  a  collection  of  miscellaneous  objects, 
such  as  bundles  of  greens,  cabbage-stalks,  a  cow's  tail,  and 
a  horse's  bladebone,  picked  up  on  the  road. 

The  Chinaman  unconcernedly  removed  the  articles  from 
his  appendage,  and  neither  by  word,  look,  nor  gesture 
showed  that  he  considered  the  pleasantry  beyond  the 
bounds  of  propriety.  His  yellow  face  and  little  almond 
eyes  were  as  unalterably  placid  as  if  he  were  quite  a 
stranger  to  what  was  passing  around  him.  In  fact  it 
seemed  as  though  he  understood  not  a  word  of  all  that 
was  spoken  in  this  Noah's  Ark  bound  north  for  Griqua- 
land. 

And  Annibale  Pantalacci,  in  his  broken  English,  was 
profuse  in  his  very  vulgar  witticisms  on  the  same  subject, 
and  kept  the  travelers  in  a  roar  of  laughter.  What  made 
the  laugh  all  the  longer  was  that  the  Boers  invariably  took 
some  time  to  see  the  joke,  and  burst  out  noisily  about 
three  minutes  after  everybody  else. 

Cyprien  at  last  became  indignant  at  the  dead  set  thus 
made  against  the  unfortunate  Li,  and  told  Pantalacci  that 
he  ought  to  be  ashamed  of  himself.  The  Neapolitan 
would  probably  have  made  some  insolent  rejoinder,  but  a 
word  from  Steel  put  a  sudden  check  on  him. 

"No,"  said  the  Lancashire  man,  regretting  that  he  had 
laughed  with  the  others,  "it  isn't  fair  play  to  keep  on 
like  that  at  a  chap  who  doesn't  even  understand  your 
lingo." 

Here  the  matter  dropped  for  a  time.  But  a  few  minutes 
after,  Cyprien  was  surprised  to  see  the  quietly  ironical  look 
of  thanks  with  which  the  Chinaman  regarded  him,  and 


160  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

which  made  him  think  that  Li  knew  rather  more  English 
than  he  gave  him  credit  for. 

But  it  was  in  vain  that  at  the  next  halt  he  tried  to 
engage  the  Chinaman  in  conversation.  Li  remained  mute 
and  impassible.  Henceforward  the  young  engineer  looked 
upon  him  as  an  enigma  whose  key  might  be  found  with 
perseverance,  and  made  a  constant  study  of  the  smooth 
yellow  face,  the  mouth  like  a  sword-cut  opening  on  to  the 
row  of  very  white  teeth,  the  short,  broad  nose,  the  large 
forehead,  and  the  slanting  eyes,  always  cast  down,  as  if  to 
hide  the  latent  malice  in  their  look. 

What  age  was  Li?  Fifteen  or  sixty?  Impossible  to 
say.  If  his  teeth,  his  eyes,  and  his  hair,  black  as  soot, 
made  him  look  quite  young,  the  wrinkles  in  his  forehead, 
his  cheeks,  and  even  around  his  mouth,  gave  him  the  ap- 
pearance of  an  old  man.  He  was  short  and  of  slight 
active  build,  and  seemed  to  be  rather  a  good  sort  of  fellow 
than  otherwise. 

Was  he  rich  or  poor?  Another  dubious  question!  His 
gray  trousers,  yellow  blouse,  plaited  string  hat,  felt-soled 
shoes,  and  stockings  of  immaculate  whiteness,  might  have 
belonged  to  a  mandarin  of  the  first  class  or  to  a  man  of 
the  people.  His  luggage  consisted  of  a  solitary  red  box 
with  an  address  in  black  ink, — 

"H.  Li, 
"From  Canton  to  the  Cape." 

The  Chinaman  was  the  very  pattern  of  neatness,  never 
smoked,  nor  drank  anything  but  water,  and  took  advantage 
of  every  halt  to  carefully  shave  his  head.  Cyprien  found 
he  could  make  nothing  of  him,  and  soon  gave  him  up  as 
a  mystery. 

The  days  went  by,  and  the  miles  were  slowly  rolled  off. 
Sometimes  the  horses  would  cover  the  ground  in  fine  style, 
at  others  it  seemed  impossible  to  move  them.  Little  by 
little  the  journey  was  completed,  and  one  fine  day  the 
coach  reached  Hopetown.  Another  long  spell  and  then 
Kimberley  was  passed.  Then  a  few  wooden  huts  appeared 
on  the  horizon.  It  was  New  Rush. 

There  the  diggers*  camp  differed  but  little  from  the  tem- 
porary towns  which  spring  from  the  ground,  as  if  by 
enchantment,  in  all  new  countries — wooden  huts  of  no 


TO  THE  DIAMOND  FIELDS  161 

great  size  and  roughly  built,  a  few  tents,  a  dozen  coffee 
bars  or  canteens,  an  alhambra  or  dancing-saloon,  several 
"stores,"  and  the  usual  johnny-all-sorts  shops. 

In  the  shops  were  clothes  and  furniture,  boots  and 
glasses,  books  and  saddles,  weapons  and  drapery,  brushes 
and  brooms,  blankets  and  cigars,  green  vegetables  and 
patent  medicines,  wheel  plows  and  toilet  soaps,  hair- 
combs  and  condensed  milk,  frying-pans  and  cheap  litho- 
graphs— everything,  in  short,  but  buyers. 

For  the  whole  population  of  the  camp  was  now  at  work 
at  the  mine,  which  is  about  a  quarter  of  a  mile  from  New 
Rush. 

Cyprien,  like  the  other  fresh  arrivals,  hastened  off 
thither,  while  dinner  was  being  got  ready  at  the  Conti- 
nental Hotel. 

It  was  about  six  o'clock  in  the  afternoon.  Already  the 
sun  had  begun  to  veil  the  horizon  in  a  thin  cloud  of  gold. 
Once  again  the  engineer  noticed  the  enormous  apparent 
diameter  assumed  by  the  sun  as  well  as  the  moon  in  these 
latitudes,  a  phenomenon  of  which  no  sufficient  explanation 
has  yet  been  advanced — the  said  diameter  being  about 
double  as  large  as  in  Europe. 

But  a  spectacle  of  much  greater  novelty  for  Cyprien 
awaited  him  at  the  Kopje,  that  is  to  say,  at  the  diamond 
diggings.  Before  the  opening  of  the  works  the  site  of 
the  mine  was  an  elliptical  knoll,  the  only  elevation  in  a 
plain  as  level  as  the  sea.  But  now  an  immense  gap  with 
sloping  sides,  a  sort  of  circus,  oval  in  form  and  about 
forty  yards  across,  had  taken  the  place  of  the  hill.  The 
surface  was  cut  up  into  three  or  four  hundred  "claims," 
or  concessions,  each  thirty-one  feet  long. 

The  ground,  consisting  chiefly  of  reddish  sand  and 
gravel,  was  being  excavated  by  pickaxe  and  spade,  and 
sent  to  the  surface.  Thence  it  was  taken  to  the  sorting- 
tables,  to  be  washed,  crushed,  sifted,  and,  finally,  examined 
with  extreme  care  to  see  if  it  contained  any  of  the  precious 
stones. 

The  claims,  having  been  excavated  independently  of 
each  other,  formed  ditches  of  varying  depths.  Some  went 
down  for  a  hundred  yards  or  more,  others  for  thirty, 
twenty,  or  even  fifteen.  To  give  room  for  working  and 
intercommunication,  each  holder  is  officially  required  to 

Vol.  IS  Verne 


162  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

leave  untouched  on  one  of  the  sides  of  his  claim  a  space 
of  seven  feet.  This  space,  with  that  left  by  his  neighbor, 
serves  as  a  sort  of  gangway  or  embankment  flush  with  the 
original  level  of  the  ground.  OH  it  joists  are  placed  so  as 
to  overhang  the  claims  for  about  a  yard  on  each  side,  and 
by  this  means  sufficient  width  is  obtained  to  allow  a  couple 
of  carts  to  pass  abreast. 

Unfortunately  for  the  solidity  of  this  hanging  way  and 
the  safety  of  the  miners,  the  holders  of  the  claims  grad- 
ually work  in  as  the  wall  goes  down,  and  as  in  some  cases 
the  depth  is  two  or  three  hundred  feet,  the  result  is  that 
the  partition  becomes  a  reversed  pyramid,  standing  on  its 
apex.  The  consequences  can  be  guessed.  The  walls  fall 
in,  particularly  during  the  rainy  season,  when,  owing  to 
the  abrupt  changes  of  temperature,  the  surface  is  seamed 
with  cracks,  and  the  sides  split  off  along  them.  Neverthe- 
less, the  periodic  recurrence  of  these  disasters  has  no 
effect  on  the  miners,  and  they  persist  in  excavating  their 
claims  up  to  the  very  farthest  limit  of  the  dividing  line. 

As  Cyprien  approached  the  mine,  he  could  see  nothing 
but  the  carts  moving  about  on  the  hanging  roads;  but 
when  he  had  got  near  enough  to  peer  into  the  depths  of 
the  curious  quarry,  he  beheld  a  busy  crowd  of  diggers  of 
every  nation,  every  color,  and  every  costume  at  work  in 
the  claims.  Negroes  and  whites,  Europeans  and  Africans, 
Mongols  and  Celts — most  of  them  in  a  state  of  semi- 
nudity,  or  wearing  cotton  drawers,  flannel  shirts,  and  straw 
hats,  decked  in  many  instances  with  ostrich  plumes. 

All  were  engaged  in  throwing  the  soil  into  leather 
buckets  and  sending  them  to  the  bank  along  wire  ropes  by 
means  of  cowskin  halliards  working  over  drums  of  open 
woodwork.  There  the  buckets  were  emptied  into  the  carts, 
and  then  sent  down  to  the  bottom  of  the  claim  to  be  re- 
turned with  a  fresh  load. 

These  long  iron  ropes,  stretched  diagonally  across  the 
rectangular  chasms,  give  a  peculiar  look  to  all  dry  diggings 
or  diamond  mines,  and  resemble  the  threads  of  a  gigantic 
spider's  web,  whose  weaving  has  been  suddenly  inter- 
rupted. 

For  some  time  Cyprien  amused  himself  with  contem- 
plating this  human  ant-hill.  Then  he  returned  to  New 
Rush,  where  the  dinner-bell  rang  almost  immediately  after 


A  LITTLE  SCIENCE  163 

his  arrival.  There  during  the  evening  he  had  the  pleasure 
of  hearing  of  the  wonderful  finds  that  had  been  made,  of 
miners  poor  as  Job  suddenly  becoming  rich  men  by  find- 
ing a  solitary  diamond,  of  others  ever  down  on  their  luck, 
of  the  greed  of  the  brokers,  of  the  dishonesty  of  the 
Kaffirs  employed  in  the  mines,  who  stole  the  best  stones, 
and  of  many  other  technical  matters.  The  talk  was  of 
nothing  but  diamonds,  carats,  and  hundreds  of  pounds. 

Every  one  seemed  the  picture  of  misery,  and  instead  of 
the  happy  digger  noisily  calling  for  his  champagne  to  wet 
his  luck,  there  were  a  dozen  lanky,  long-faced  fellows 
drinking  nothing  but  small  beer. 

Occasionally  a  stone  would  be  passed  around  the  table  to 
be  weighed,  examined,  valued,  and  returned  to  its  owner's 
belt.  That  dull  grayish  pebble,  with  no  more  sparkle  than 
a  fragment  of  quartz  rolled  in  a  torrent,  was  a  diamond  in 
its  gangue! 

At  night  the  coffee  bars  filled,  and  the  same  conver- 
sation, the  same  discussion  which  had  occupied  the  dinner- 
hour,  began  again. 

Cvprien  went  to  bed  early  in  the  tent  next  to  the  hotel 
which  had  been  assigned  to  him.  There  he  soon  fell 
asleep,  despite  the  noise  of  a  ball  in  the  open  air  among 
the  Kaffir  diggers  close  by,  and  the  piercing  brays  of  a 
B-flat  cornet  from  a  neighboring  dancing-saloon,  in  which 
the  whites  were  amusing  themselves  with  a  few  energetic 
lessons  in  choregraphy. 


CHAPTER  III 

A   LITTLE   SCIENCE 

To  his  honor,  be  it  said,  the  young  engineer  had  not 
come  to  Griqualand  to  spend  his  time  in  an  atmosphere 
of  greed,  drunkenness,  and  tobacco  smoke.  His  object 
was  to  make  sundry  topographical  and  geological  surveys 
of  certain  parts  of  the  country,  to  collect  specimens  of  the 
rocks  and  diamantiferous  gravels,  and  to  conduct  a  few 
delicate  analyses  on  the  spot.  His  first  care,  therefore, 
was  to  procure  a  quiet  dwelling-place,  where  he  could  set 
up  his  laboratory,  and  which  would  serve  as  the  center 
of  his  explorations  in  the  mining  districts. 


164  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

The  knoll  on  which  Watkins'  Farm  was  situated  soon 
attracted  his  attention  as  a  site  particularly  favorable  for 
his  work,  far  enough  away  to  suffer  but  little  from  the 
noisy  proximity  of  the  camp,  and  at  the  same  time  within 
an  hour's  walk  of  the  farthest  kopjes,  for  the  diamond 
field  is  not  more  than  ten  miles  in  circumference.  And  so 
it  happened  that  in  the  course  of  a  single  afternoon  he  had 
selected  one  of  the  houses  abandoned  by  Mr.  Watkins, 
agreed  to  take  it,  and  installed  himself  therein.  The 
farmer  was  most  agreeable.  At  heart  he  was  thoroughly 
tired  of  being  alone,  and  highly  pleased  to  find  a  young 
man  anxious  to  take  up  his  quarters  close  by,  and  break 
into  the  wearisome  monotony. 

But  if  Mr.  Watkins  expected  to  find  in  his  tenant  a 
mere  table-companion  or  a  partner  in  his  assaults  on  the 
gin-bottle,  he  was  very  much  mistaken.  Almost  before 
he  had  taken  up  his  quarters  with  his  retorts,  furnaces, 
and  reagents,  almost  before  the  chief  articles  of  his  labora- 
tory had  arrived,  he  was  out  on  his  geological  excursions. 
Coming  home  in  the  evening  nearly  knocked  up  with 
fatigue,  with  rock  specimens  in  his  satchel,  in  his  pockets, 
and  even  in  his  hat,  he  had  much  more  inclination  to  go 
to  sleep  than  to  listen  to  the  sub-fossil  yarns  of  Mr.  Wat- 
kins.  Besides,  he  smoked  very  little,  and  drank  much  less; 
and  take  him  altogether,  he  was  hardly  the  jolly  com- 
panion that  the  farmer  had  anticipated. 

Nevertheless,  Cyprien  was  so  straightforward  and  con- 
siderate, so  simple  in  his  manner  and  speech,  so  well  in- 
formed and  so  modest,  that  it  was  impossible  to  meet  him 
frequently  without  liking  him.  And  Mr.  Watkins  soon 
held  him  in  more  respect  than  any  other  man  he  knew. 

"If  he  only  knew  how  to  drink!  But  what  are  you 
to  do  with  a  man  who  will  not  touch  the  least  drop  of 
gin  ?"  Thus  did  the  farmer  conclude  his  frequent  disquisi- 
tion on  his  tenant's  merits. 

Miss  Watkins,  for  her  part,  found  herself  suddenly 
placed  on  a  footing  of  unrestrained  friendship  with  the 
young  scientist.  Finding  in  him  a  distinction  of  manner, 
an  intellectual  superiority  which  she  had  hardly  met  with 
before  in  her  usual  circle,  she  had  taken  advantage  of  the 
unexpected  opportunity  to  complete  experimentally  the 


A  LITTLE  SCIENCE  165 

varied  chemical  knowledge  she  had  obtained  by  reading 
scientific  works. 

The  young  engineer's  laboratory,  with  its  strange-look- 
ing apparatus,  interested  her  greatly.  She  was  above  all 
things  anxious  to  learn  what  she  could  about  the  nature 
of  the  diamond,  that  precious  stone  which  played  so  im- 
portant a  part  in  the  conversation  and  commerce  of  the 
country.  In  fact,  Alice  had  almost  come  to  look  upon  the 
gem  as  a  worthless  pebble.  Cyprien,  she  could  not  but 
see,  held  much  the  same  opinion  on  the  subject  as  she 
did,  and  this  community  of  sentiment  had  had  no  little 
influence  on  the  friendship  which  speedily  grew  up  be- 
tween them.  We  may  say  without  fear  of  contradiction 
that  these  two  were  alone  in  Griqualand  in  thinking  that 
the  sole  object  of  life  did  not  consist  in  finding,  cutting, 
and  selling  the  little  stones  so  keenly  coveted  among  the 
nations  of  the  earth. 

"The  diamond,"  said  Cyprien  to  her  on  one  occasion, 
"is  only  pure  carbon.  It  is  a  fragment  of  crystallized 
coal ;  nothing  more.  You  can  burn  it  like  a  lump  of  coke, 
and  it  was  its  property  of  combustion  that  first  led  to  the 
knowledge  of  its  real  nature.  Newton,  who  observed  so 
many  things,  noticed  that  the  diamond  refracted  light 
more  than  any  other  transparent  body;  and  as  he  knew 
that  this  property  belonged  to  most  combustibles,  he,  with 
his  usual  boldness,  deducted  from  the  fact  the  conclusion 
that  the  diamond  ought  to  be  combustible.  And  experi- 
ence proved  that  he  was  right." 

"But,  Mr.  Cyprien,  if  the  diamond  is  only  carbon,  why 
does  it  fetch  such  a  price?"  asked  Alice. 

"Because  of  its  rarity,"  answered  Cyprien,  "and  because 
it  has  only  as  yet  been  found  in  small  quantities.  For  a 
long  time  it  came  only  from  India,  Brazil,  and  Borneo. 
And  surely  you  can  remember,  when  you  were  about  seven 
or  eight  years  old,  how  it  was  first  discovered  in  South 
Africa."  ' 

"Oh,  yes!  I  remember!"  said  Miss  Watkins.  "Every- 
body seemed  to  go  mad  in  Griqualand !  There  was  nothing 
to  be  seen  but  people  with  pickaxes  and  shovels  prospecting 
all  over  the  place,  changing  the  courses  of  the  streams  to 
examine  their  beds,  and  dreaming  and  speaking  of  nothing 
but  diamonds.  Young  as  I  was,  I  can  assure  you  that  I 


166  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

was  quite  weary  of  it  at  times.     But  you  say  that  the 
diamond  is  dear  because  it  is  rare.    Is  that  its  only  merit?" 

"Not  entirely.  Its  transparency,  its  brilliancy  when  it 
has  been  cut  so  as  to  refract  the  light,  even  the  difficulty  of 
this  cutting,  and  its  extreme  hardness,  make  it  a  very 
interesting  body  for  the  scientist,  and,  I  should  add,  very 
useful  in  the  arts.  You  know  it  can  only  be  polished  with 
its  own  dust,  and  that  it  is  its  peculiar  hardness  which  has 
caused  it  to  be  used  for  many  years  for  rock-boring  pur- 
poses. Without  its  help,  not  only  would  it  be  very  difficult 
to  work  in  glass  and  other  hard  substances,  but  the  boring 
of  tunnels,  mine-galleries,  and  deep  wells  would  be  much 
more  difficult." 

"I  understand  now,"  said  Alice,  who  began  to  have  a 
slight  respect  for  the  poor  diamonds  she  had  hitherto  so 
despised.  "But,  Mr.  Cyprien,  this  carbon,  of  which  you 
say  the  diamond  is  composed,  in  a  crystalline  state — that 
is  right,  isn't  it? — this  carbon,  what  is  it?" 

"A  simple  body,  not  a  metal,  and  one  of  the  most 
widely  distributed  bodies  in  nature,"  answered  Cyrien.  "All 
organic  matter  without  exception  possesses  it.  Wood, 
meat,  bread,  vegetables,  etc.,  all  have  it  among  their  con- 
stituents !" 

"How  strange!"  said  Miss  Watkins.  "To  think  that 
those  bushes,  the  grass,  the  tree,  the  flesh  of  my  ostrich 
Dada,  and  my  own,  and  yours,  Mr.  Cyprien,  are  all  partly 
made  of  carbon — like  diamonds!  Is  everything  carbon  in 
this  world?" 

"Well,  some  people  have  been  suspecting  something  of 
the  sort  for  a  considerable  time.  And  contemporary 
science  is  making  rapid  advances  toward  some  such 
solution.  That  is  to  say,  the  tendency  is  to  reduce  the 
number  of  simple  bodies,  and  prove  many  of  the  old 
elements  to  be  mere  compounds.  The  spectroscope  has 
lately  thrown  quite  a  new  light  on  chemistry,  and  the 
sixty-two  substances  classed  hitherto  as  elements  would 
seem  to  be  but  forms  of  one — hydrogen  perhaps — under 
different  electric,  dynamic,  and  calorific  forms." 

"Oh!  you  frighten  me,  Mr.  Cyprien,  with  your  long 
words,"  said  Miss  Watkins.  "Let  us  only  talk  about 
carbon.  Why  do  not  you  chemists  crystallize  it  as  you  did 
the  sulphur  in  those  pretty  needles  the  other  day?  It 


A  LITTLE  SCIENCE  167 

would  be  so  much  more  convenient,  surely,  than  having  to 
dig  among  the  rocks  to  find  it." 

"People  have  often  tried  to  do  so,"  replied  Cyprien,  "and 
attempted  the  manufacture  of  diamonds  by  the  crystal- 
lization of  pure  carbon,  and  to  a  certain  extent  have  suc- 
ceeded. Despretz  in  1883,  and  quite  recently  in  England 
another  experimenter,  have  produced  diamond  dust  by 
employing  a  strong  electric  current  in  vacuo  to  act  on 
carbon  cylinders  free  from  mineral  substances,  and  pre- 
pared with  sugar-candy.  But  up  to  the  present,  the  problem 
has  not  met  with  solution  that  would  bring  it  into  trade. 
Notwithstanding,  it  may  be  only  a  question  of  time.  Any 
day,  perhaps  at  this  very  moment,  the  method  of  making 
diamonds  may  be  discovered." 

It  was  thus  they  talked  as  they  strolled  along  the  sandy 
terrace  which  extended  by  the  farm,  or,  seated  under  the 
veranda,  watched  the  stars  twinkling  in  the  southern  sky. 

Sometimes  Alice  would  leave  the  engineer  and  return  to 
the  house,  at  others  she  would  take  him  to  visit  her  flock 
of  ostriches,  kept  in  an  enclosure  at  the  foot  of  the  knoll 
on  which  Watkins'  Farm  was  situated.  Their  small,  white 
heads  craning  over  their  black  bodies,  and  the  bunches  of 
yellowish  feathers  ornamenting  their  wings  and  tails, 
(interested  the  young  lady,  who  for  a  year  or  more  had 
kept  quite  a  poultry-yard  full  of  the  giants. 

Ostriches  are  very  seldom  tamed,  and  the  Cape  farmers 
leave  them  in  a  half  wild  state,  parked  in  an  enclosure  of 
vast  extent,  surrounded  by  wire  fencing  like  that  in  many 
countries  running  alongside  the  railroad.  There  they  live 
all  the  year  around  in  a  captivity  they  know  not  of,  feeding 
on  what  they  can  find,  and  seeking  quiet  corners  wherein 
to  deposit  their  eggs,  which  very  strict  laws  protect  against 
marauders.  It  is  only  at  moulting  time,  when  they  throw 
off  the  feathers  so  much  in  request  by  the  ladies  of  Europe, 
that  the  beaters  drive  them  into  a  series  of  enclosures, 
diminishing  in  size,  until  the  birds  can  be  easily  seized  and 
made  to  give  up  their  plumage. 

This  industry  has  been  thriving  at  the  Cape  for  many 
years.  Every  ostrich  reduced  to  slavery  brings  to  his 
proprietor  without  further  expense  a  revenue  of  from  eight 
to  twelve  pounds,  nothing  very  extraordinary  when  it  is 
remembered  that  a  large  feather  of  good  quality  will  fetch 


i68  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

from  two  to  three  pounds,  and  that  even  the  medium  and 
smallest  feathers  are  of  considerable  value. 

But  it  was  only  for  her  private  amusement  that  Miss 
Watkins  had  made  pets  of  a  dozen  of  these  huge  birds.  It 
pleased  her  to  see  them  with  their  eggs,  and  come  up  with 
their  chickens  to  be  fed  as  if  they  were  fowls  or  turkeys. 
Cyprien  often  accompanied  her  to  the  ostrich-yard,  and 
amused  himself  by  stroking  the  best-looking  of  the  lot,  a 
certain  black-headed  ostrich  with  golden  eyes — that  very 
Dada  who  had  swallowed  the  ivory  ball  which  Alice  used 
for  darning  on. 

Little  by  little  there  had  grown  up  in  Cyprien  a  feeling 
of  much  depth  and  tenderness  toward  the  young  lady. 
He  had  persuaded  himself  that  never  would  he  find  a 
companion  more  simple-hearted,  more  intelligent,  more 
amiable,  or  more  accomplished  in  every  way  to  share  his 
life  of  labor  and  meditation.  In  fact,  Miss  Watkins, 
having  lost  her  mother  very  early,  had  been  obliged  to  take 
charge  of  her  father's  house,  and  was  an  accomplished 
housewife,  at  the  same  time  a  true  woman  of  the  world. 
It  was  this  curious  mixture  of  perfect  refinement  and 
attractive  simplicity  that  made  her  so  charming.  Having 
none  of  the  silly  scruples  of  so  many  of  the  young  ladies 
of  Europe,  she  was  never  afraid  of  soiling  her  white  hands 
in  the  paste  for  the  pudding,  or  of  superintending  the 
dinner,  or  keeping  the  linen  in  proper  repair.  And  all 
this  did  not  hinder  her  from  playing  Beethoven's  sonatas 
as  well  as,  and  perhaps  better  than,  most  people,  from 
speaking  two  or  three  languages,  from  taking  pleasure  in 
reading,  from  appreciating  the  masterpieces  in  litera- 
ture, and,  finally,  from  being  eminently  successful  at  the 
little  weekly  assemblies  among  the  rich  farmers  of  the 
district. 

Cyprien  had  seen  all  this,  and  now,  alas,  great  was  the 
fall  in  his  hopes.  For  the  first  time  he  saw  the  almost 
impassable  gulf  which  separated  him  from  Alice,  and 
heavy  was  his  heart  as  he  returned  from  the  decisive  inter- 
view. But  he  was  not  the  man  to  give  up  to  despair.  He 
was  resolved  to  fight  his  way  in  the  world,  and  in  his 
work  he  had  a  sure  solace  for  his  grief. 

Taking  his  seat  at  the  small  table,  he  finished,  in  a  quick, 
firm  hand,  the  long,  confidential  letter  which  he  had  begun 


A  LITTLE  SCIENCE  169 

in  the  morning  to  his  revered  master,  Mr.  J ,  a  mem- 

her  of  the  Academy  of  Sciences,  and  titular  professor  at 
the  School  of  Mines. 

"One  thing,"  he  wrote,  "I  thought  better  not  to  put  in 
my  official  memoir,  because  it  is  as  yet  only  a  hypothesis, 
and  that  is,  the  opinion  I  have  been  led  by  my  geological 
researches  to  entertain  on  the  subject  of  the  diamond's 
formation.  Neither  the  hypothesis  that  assumes  it  to  be 
of  volcanic  origin,  nor  that  which  attributes  its  appearance 
in  the  beds  to  violent  disturbances  satisfies  me  any  more 
than  it  does  you,  my  dear  master,  and  I  need  not  repeat 
the  reasons  which  led  us  to  abandon  it.  The  formation  of 
the  diamond  in  situ  by  the  action  of  fire  is  likewise  too 
vague  an  explanation  to  satisfy  me.  What  was  the  nature 
of  this  fire?  and  why  did  it  not  affect  the  limestones  of 
all  kinds  which  are  invariably  met  with  in  diamantiferous 
deposits?  The  idea  seems  to  me  quite  childish,  and 
on  a  par  with  the  theories  of  the  vortices  and  hooked 
atoms. 

"The  only  explanation  which  satisfies  me,  if  not  entirely, 
at  least  in  a  certain  degree,  is  that  of  the  transportation  by 
water  of  the  gem's  elements,  and  the  subsequent  formation 
of  the  crystal  in  position.  I  have  been  much  struck  with 
the  peculiar  outline,  almost  identical  in  all  cases,  of  the 
different  beds  which  I  have  noted  and  measured  with  great 
care.  All  more  or  less  are  in  the  general  form  of  a  basin, 
or  rather,  considering  the  shape  of  the  overlying  strata, 
that  of  a  hunting-flask  on  its  side.  This  appears  to  have 
been  a  reservoir  of  from  thirty  to  forty  thousand  cubic 
yards  in  extent,  in  which  there  has  been  a  deposit  of 
sandy  conglomerate,  of  mud,  and  of  alluvial  earth  laid 
down,  on  the  older  rocks.  This  character  is  very  marked 
at  Vandergaart  Kopje,  one  of  the  most  recently  discovered 
of  the  diggings,  and,  which  belongs,  by  the  way,  to  the 
owner  of  the  house  in  which  I  am  writing. 

"When  a  liquid  containing  bodies  in  suspension  is 
poured  into  a  cup,  what  happens?  The  bodies  arrange 
themselves  at  the  bottom  of  the  cup  or  around  its  sides. 
That  is  exactly  what  has  happened  in  this  kopje.  It  is  at 
the  bottom  and  in  the  center  of  the  basin  as  well  as  around 
the  outer  edges  that  the  diamonds  are  met  with.  And  this 
is  so  well  understood  that  the  claims  between  rapidly  fall 


1 70  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

to  a  lower  value,  while  the  central  concessions  or  those 
bordering  on  the  boundary  enormously  increase  as  soon 
as  the  shape  of  the  deposit  is  made  out. 

"Besides,  several  circumstances  that  you  find  mentioned 
in  my  memoir  tend  to  show  the  formation  of  the  crystal  in 
position  rather  than  its  transport  thither  in  a  perfect 
state.  To  mention  only  two  or  three,  diamonds  are  nearly 
always  found  in  groups  of  the  same  kind  and  color,  which 
would  hardly  be  the  case  had  they  been  formed  afar  and 
brought  thither  by  a  torrent.  Frequently  two  are  found 
together,  united  but  detachable  at  the  least  blow.  How 
could  they  have  resisted  the  grinding  and  jarring  if  brought 
down  by  water?  Again,  the  larger  diamonds  are  always 
found  under  the  shelter  of  a  rock,  which  seems  to  show 
that  the  influence  of  the  rock — its  radiation  of  heat,  if 
nothing  else — has  helped  on  the  crystallization.  It  is  rare 
— very  rare — that  large  and  small  diamonds  are  found 
together.  Whenever  a  large  specimen  is  discovered,  it  is 
almost  always  isolated.  It  is  as  if  all  the  adamantine 
elements  in  the  depression  had  been  concentrated  into  a 
single  crystal  under  the  influence  of  special  causes. 

"These  and  many  other  reasons  urge  me  to  think  that 
the  diamond  is  formed  in  position,  and  that  the  elements 
of  crystallization  were  brought  down  to  the  spot  by 
water. 

"But  whence  came  the  waters  which  bore  down  the 
organic  detritus  destined  to  be  formed  into  diamonds  ?  This 
I  have  not  yet  been  able  to  determine  in  spite  of  my 
careful  study  of  the  district. 

"The  determination,  however,  may  prove  of  some  value. 
If  we  can  find  the  route  taken  by  the  streams,  why  should 
we  not,  in  tracing  it  up,  arrive  at  the  starting-point  whence 
came  the  diamonds?  and  there  we  should  doubtless  find 
them  in  large  numbers  compared  to  that  in  the  beds  at 
present  worked.  It  would  be  a  complete  demonstration  of 
my  theory,  and  one  that  I  should  be  very  glad  to  make. 
But  it  will  not  be  my  lot  to  do  so,  as  I  have  nearly  com- 
pleted the  period  for  which  I  was  sent  out.  I  have  been 
more  successful  in  my  analysis  of  the  rocks — "  and  the 
young  engineer,  continuing  his  story,  plunged  into  tech- 
nical details,  which,  though  doubtless  of  much  interest 
to  himself  and  his  correspondent,  are  hardly  likely  to 


VANDERGAART   KOPJE  171 

please  the  uninitiated  reader.  As  soon  as  he  had  finished 
his  long  letter,  Cyprien  extinguished  his  lamp,  stretched 
himself  in  his  hammock,  and  slept  the  sleep  of  the  just. 

Work  had  driven  out  grief — at  least,  for  an  hour  or  so 
— but  a  pleasing  vision  haunted  the  young  student's  dream, 
and  seemed  to  whisper  that  there  yet  was  hope. 


CHAPTER  IV 

VANDERGAART    KOPJE 

"I  MUST  be  off,"  said  Cyprien,  as  he  dressed  himself 
next  morning.  "I  must  leave  Griqualand.  After  what 
that  man  said  to  me,  to  remain  here  a  day  would  be  weak- 
ness. He  won't  give  me  his  daughter?  Perhaps  he  is 
right.  Anyhow,  it  will  never  do  to  look  as  if  I  wanted 
to  plead  extenuating  circumstances.  I  must  accept  the 
verdict  like  a  man,  however  painful  it  may  be,  and  trust  to 
the  future  to  set  things  right." 

And  without  further  hesitation  he  began  to  stow  away 
the  apparatus  in  the  packing-cases,  which  had  served  him 
for  tables  and  cupboards.  He  worked  with  a  will  for  an 
hour  or  so,  and  then  through  the  open  window  came  a 
sweet,  girlish  voice,  clear  and  full  as  the  voice  of  the 
skylark : — 

'Tis  the  last  rose  of  summer 

Left  blooming  alone; 
All   her  lovely  companions 

Are  faded  and  gone. 

He  ran  to  the  window  and  saw  Alice  on  her  way  to  the 
ostriches,  with  her  apron  full  of  scraps  for  their  food.  She 
it  was,  who  was  singing  to  the  rising  sun. 

The  young  engineer  was  not  particularly  susceptible  to 
poetical  influences,  but  something  in  the  song  affected 
him  deeply.  He  stood  still  at  the  window  and  listened 
intently. 

The  song  ceased.  Miss  Watkins  began  to  feed  the 
ostriches,  and  as  she  did  so  it  was  pleasant  to  see  the 
birds  craning  their  long  necks  and  dodging  their  huge 


172  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

awkward  heads  in  front  of  her  hand  as  she  tantalizingly 
held  out  and  withdrew  the  morsels  of  food.  Then  she 
finished  her  task,  and  as  she  returned  resumed  her  song. 

Cyprien  was  standing  in  the  same  place,  with  tears  well- 
ing up  into  his  eyes,  as  if  under  a  charm. 

The  voice  grew  more  distant.  Alice  was  within  twenty 
yards  of  the  farm,  when  the  sound  of  hurried  footsteps 
caused  her  to  pause  and  turn  around. 

Cyprien,  by  an  irresistible  impulse,  had  left  his  hut,  and 
was  running  after  her  bare-headed. 

"Miss  Watkins." 

"Mr.  Cyprien." 

They  were  face  to  face  in  the  full  glow  of  the  rising  sun 
on  the  path  that  bordered  the  farm.  Their  shadows  were 
thrown  sharp  and  clear  on  the  white  wood  of  the  palings. 
And  now  that  Cyprien  had  reached  Miss  Watkins,  he 
seemed  astonished  at  what  he  had  done  and  undecided 
what  to  say. 

"You  have  something  to  say  to  me,  Mr.  Cyprien?" 
asked  the  lady  anxiously. 

"I  have  come  to  bid  you  good-bye.  I  am  going  away 
today,"  was  the  answer. 

The  delicate  rose  tint  which  gave  the  life  to  Alice's  face 
suddenly  disappeared. 

"Going  away!  You  are  going  away?  Where?"  she 
asked  tremblingly. 

"Home — to  France,"  replied  Cyprien.  "My  work  is 
done  here.  My  mission  has  ended.  I  have  nothing  else 
to  do  in  Griqualand.  And  I  am  obliged  to  get  back  to 
Paris."  This  with  a  pause  between  each  sentence,  and  as 
if  he  were  craving  pardon  for  some  crime. 

The  girl  was  astounded.  The  news  fell  on  her  like  a 
blow  from  a  crowbar.  Suddenly  the  teardrops  showed 
themselves,  and  hung  suspended  on  the  long  lashes  which 
shaded  her  eyes.  And  then,  as  if  recalled  to  the  reality  of 
the  scene,  she  recovered  herself,  and  said,  with  a  slight 
smile,  "Going  away!  And  you  are  going  to  run  away 
from  your  scholar  before  she  has  finished  her  chemistry? 
You  are  going  to  leave  me  in  oxygen  and  those  mysteries 
of  azote  which  were  always  a  dead-letter  for  me?  It  is 
hardly  the  correct  thing,  sir." 

She  tried  to  put  a  good  face  on  it,  and  to  laugh  it  off, 


VANDERGAART  KOPJE  173 

but  the  tone  of  her  voice  belied  her  words.  Beneath  her 
jesting  there  was  a  deep  reproach  which  went  straight  to 
the  young  man's  heart.  She  continued,  but  the  jesting 
tone  was  gone.  "And  I?  Do  you  think  I  am  nothing? 
You  quietly  drop  me  back  into  chaos!  You  come  here 
that  I  may  see  among  all  these  Boers  and  greedy  diggers 
a  superior  privileged  being,  learned,  proud,  disinterested, 
apart  from  the  rest!  you  make  me  help  you  in  your  study 
and  work !  you  open  your  heart  to  me,  and  make  me  share 
your  hopes,  your  literary  preferences,  and  your  artistic 
tastes!  you  reveal  to  me  the  distance  between  a  thinker 
such  as  you  and  the  mere  bimana  that  surround  me!  you 
encourage  me  to  admire  you  and  to  like  you!  you  nearly 
succeeded  in  doing  so!  Then  you  come  and  coolly  tell 
me  that  it  is  all  over,  that  you  are  off  to  Paris,  and  are  in 
a  hurry  to  forget  me!  And  you  think  I  am  going  to  take 
it  all  as  coolly  as  if  I  were  a  philosopher!" 

Yes,  he  had  done  all  that  Alice  with  her  tearful  eyes 
had  reproached  him  with. 

He  was  just  about  to  say  in  defense,  "It  is  necessary 
that  I  do  so!  I  yesterday  asked  your  father  to  allow  me 
to  ask  you  to  be  my  wife!  He  has  refused,  and  gives  me 
no  hope!  Now  do  you  understand  why  I  am  going?" 
Then  the  thought  of  his  promise  crossed  his  mind.  He 
had  promised  John  Watkins  never  to  speak  to  his  daughter 
on  the  subject  of  his  dream,  and  he  judged  it  dishonorable 
to  break  his  word. 

But  at  the  same  time  he  felt  that  his  idea  of  immediate 
departure  was  brutally  unkind.  It  seemed  to  him  impossi- 
ble to  thus  suddenly  abandon  the  girl  he  loved,  and  who 
evidently — there  could  be  no  doubt  of  it — loved  him.  At 
first  the  thought  of  delay  frightened  him,  then  it  seemed 
to  him  as  imperatively  necessary. 

"When  I  spoke  of  going  away,  Miss  Watkins,"  at  last 
he  said,  "I  did  not  mean  this  morning — nor  today — nor — 
I  have  a  few  more  notes  to  make — preparations  to  finish — 
Anyhow,  I  shall  have  the  pleasure  of  seeing  you  again  and 
— talking  with  you  about — about— your  studies !" 

And  then  Cyprien  abruptly  turned  away  and  ran  off  like 
a  lunatic.  He  rushed  into  his  hut,  and  throwing  himself 
into  an  arm-chair,  was  immediately  deep  in  thought. 


174  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

And  his  thoughts  were  somewhat  different  from  what 
they  were  before  he  spoke  to  Miss  Watkins. 

"Give  her  up  because  I  have  got  no  money!"  he  said  to 
himself.  "Knock  under  at  the  first  blow!  Is  that  the 
sort  of  man  I  am?  Would  it  not  be  better  to  sacrifice  a 
few  prejudices  and  try  and  make  myself  worthy  of  her? 
How  many  fellows  make  their  fortunes  in  a  few  months 
on  the  Diamond  Fields?  Why  shouldn't  I  turn  up  a 
hundred  carat  diamond  as  the  others  have  done;  or  better 
still,  find  a  new  field?  Surely  I  have  more  theoretical 
and  practical  knowledge  than  most  of  these  men.  Why 
should  not  knowledge  give  me  what  work  and  luck  give 
them?  After  all,  I  risk  little  in  having  a  try.  Even  from 
this  standpoint  of  my  mission  it  would  not  do  me  any 
harm  to  take  a  turn  with  shovel  and  pick  and  gain  some 
practical  experience  as  a  digger.  And,  if  I  succeed;  if  I 
become  rich  in  this  primitive  way,  who  knows  but  what 
Watkins  may  yield,  and  reverse  his  decision?  The  prize 
is  well  worth  the  trial !" 

And  Cyprien  began  to  walk  up  and  down  the  laboratory, 
but  his  hands  were  still,  his  brain  only  was  at  work.  Sud- 
denly he  stopped,  put  on  his  hat,  and  walked  out.  He  took 
the  path  down  to  the  flat,  and  at  a  great  pace  set  out  for 
Vandergaart  Kopje.  In  less  than  an  hour  he  was  there. 

The  miners  were  recrowding  into  the  camp  after  their 
breakfast.  Cyprien,  as  the  bronzed  visages  passed  by, 
was  wondering  to  whom  to  apply  for  the  information  he 
wanted,  when  he  recognized  in  one  of  the  groups  the 
honest  face  of  Thomas  Steel,  the  Lancashire  miner.  Two 
or  three  times  had  he  met  him  since  his  arrival  in  Griqua- 
land,  and  found  that  he  was  prospering,  a  fact  sufficiently 
shown  by  his  contented  features,  his  brand-new  clothes, 
and  the  large  leather  belt  around  his  waist.  Cyprien  made 
up  his  mind  to  accost  him  and  tell  him  of  his  intention. 

"Buy  a  claim?  Nothing  easier  if  you  have  got  the 
money!"  answered  the  miner.  "There  is  one  now  close  to 
mine.  Four  hundred  pounds !  It  is  giving  it  away !  \Vith 
half  a  dozen  niggers  to  work  for  you,  you'll  make  thirty 
pounds  a  week." 

"But  I  haven't  got  four  hundred  pounds,  and  I  don't 
possess  a  nigger!" 

"Well,  buy    a    share    in    a    claim — an    eighth    or    a    six- 


VANDERGAART   KOPJE  175 

teenth — and  work  it  yourself!  You  can  get  one  for  forty 
pounds/' 

"That  is  more  my  figure,"  answered  the  engineer;  "but 
you,  Mr.  Steel,  how  have  you  done,  if  I  may  be  allowed 
to  ask?  Did  you  have  any  capital?" 

"I  got  here  with  my  arms  and  three  sovereigns  in  my 
pocket,"  replied  the  Lancashire  lad;  "but  I  was  lucky.  I 
first  worked  half-shares  with  a  man  who  had  an  eighth. 
The  fellow  liked  hanging  about  the  liquor-shop  better  than 
working,  and  so  we  halved.  I  made  some  excellent  finds, 
one  a  five-carat  stone  that  we  sold  for  two  hundred  pounds ! 
Then  I  left  off  working  for  the  first  cove  and  bought  a  six- 
teenth for  myself.  As  I  only  found  small  stones  I  got 
clear  of  that  in  ten  days  and  went  halves  with  an  Austra- 
lian on  his  claim.  But  we  have  hardly  made  a  fiver  this 
first  week." 

"If  I  found  a  share  in  a  good  claim  that  would  not 
cost  too  much,  will  you  go  partners  with  me  and  work  it  ?" 
asked  the  engineer. 

"If  you  like,"  answered  Steel;  "but  on  one  condition. 
That  is,  we  each  keep  what  we  find.  Not  that  I  mistrust 
you,  Mr.  Cyprien.  But  you  see,  since  I  have  been  here  I 
always  lose  when  the  sharing  comes,  for  I  am  a  good  hand 
at  the  pickaxe  and  shovel,  and  I  do  about  three  times  the 
work  of  the  other  fellows!" 

"That  seems  fair  enough,"  said  Cyprien. 

"Well,  then  here's  an  idea,  perhaps  a  good  'un.  Let 
us  two  take  one  of  John  Watkins'  claims." 

"One  of  his  claims?  I  thought  all  the  kopje  belonged 
to  him." 

"So  it  does,  but  the  Colonial  Government,  you  know, 
lays  hold  of  it  as  soon  as  it  is  declared  a  diamond  field. 
The  Government  looks  after  it,  measures  it  out,  cuts  up 
the  claims,  and  keeps  the  best  part  of  the  price,  and  pays 
only  a  fixed  royalty.  And  the  royalty,  when  the  kopje  is  as 
large  as  this  one,  amounts  to  something.  But  the  free- 
holder always  has  the  preference  in  buying  back  as  many 
claims  as  he  can  work.  That  is  the  case  with  Watkins. 
He  has  got  several  going  besides  his  property  in  the  kopje. 
But  he  cannot  work  them  as  he  ought  to,  for  the  gout 
stops  him  from  coming  down  here,  and  I  think  he  would 
let  you  have  one  cheap  if  you  made  an  offer."  < 


176  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

"I  would  rather  you  do  the  bargaining,"  said  Cyprien. 

"It  makes  no  difference  to  me,"  replied  Steel.  "Just  as 
you  like." 

Three  hours  later  half -claim  No.  942,  duly  marked  out 
with  stakes  and  identified  on  the  plan,  was  handed  over 
to  Messrs.  Cyprien  and  Steel  for  the  sum  of  ninety  pounds. 
It  was  expressly  stipulated  in  the  deed  that  the  conces- 
sionaries should  share  the  profits  with  John  Watkins,  and 
as  a  royalty  hand  him  over  the  three  first  diamonds  weigh- 
ing more  than  ten  carats  that  they  should  find.  There  was 
nothing  to  show  that  such  a  find  was  likely  to  be  made,  but 
still  it  was  possible — everything  was  possible. 

On  the  whole  the  bargain  was  a  good  one  for  Cyprien, 
and  Watkins,  with  his  customary  frankness,  told  him  so 
as  he  signed  the  contract. 

"You  have  acted  like  'a  sensible  chap,"  said  he,  as  he 
tapped  Cyprien  on  the  shoulder.  "There  is  some  stuff  in 
you.  I  shouldn't  be  surprised  if  you  turn  out  one  of  the 
luckiest  diggers  in  Griqualand." 

Cyprien  could  not  but  see  in  these  words  a  happy  augury 
for  the  future. 

And  Miss  Watkins,  who  was  present  at  the  interview, 
had  she  a  look  bright  as  sunshine  in  her  blue  eyes?  No! 
Seemingly  she  had  been  crying  all  the  morning. 

By  tacit  consent  nothing  was  said  about  the  meeting 
early  in  the  day.  Cyprien  was  going  to  stay,  that  was 
evident. 

The  young  engineer  left  with  a  light  heart,  and  having 
made  up  his  mind  to  visit  the  farm  for  the  future  only  in 
his  leisure  moments,  set  to  work  to  pack  up  a  few  of  his 
things  and  take  them  down  to  his  tent  at  Vandergaart 
Kopje. 


CHAPTER  V 

THE    DIGGERS    AT    WORK 

THE  next  morning  the  two  partners  set  to  work.  Their 
claim  was  near  the  boundary  of  the  kopje,  and,  if  Cyprien's 
theory  was  correct,  ought  to  prove  a  very  rich  one.  Un- 
fortunately the  claim  had  already  been  overhauled,  and 


THE  DIGGERS  AT  WORK  177 

had  been  driven  down  into  for  a  hundred  and  fifty  feet  or 
more. 

In  one  respect  this  was  an  advantage,  as  its  owners,  by 
finding  themselves  below  the  level  of  the  neighboring 
claims,  were  entitled,  by  the  custom  of  the  country,  to  all 
the  earth  and  all  the  diamonds  that  fell  into  it. 

The  proceedings  were  very  simple.  By  means  of  the 
shovel  and  pickaxe  the  two  men  cut  away  a  certain  quan- 
tity of  earth  from  the  mass.  That  done  one  of  them 
went  to  the  surface,  and  hauled  up  along  the  wire  rope  the 
bucketfuls  sent  him  from  below. 

This  earth  was  then  taken  in  a  cart  to  Steel's  hut,  and 
there,  after  being  crushed  with  wooden  billets,  so  as  to 
clear  away  the  worthless  pebbles,  was  passed  through  a  fine 
sieve  and  separated  from  the  tiniest  stones,  which  were  all 
carefully  picked  over  before  being  rejected.  Then  the 
earth  was  sifted  through  a  still  finer  sieve  to  get  rid  of  the 
dust,  and  then  it  was  in  a  fit  condition  to  be  looked  over 
for  the  diamonds. 

When  it  had  been  turned  out  on  to  the  table,  the  two 
diggers  sat  down,  and,  armed  with  a  sort  of  scraper  made 
out  of  a  piece  of  tin,  went  over  it  carefully,  handful  by 
handful,  and  then  threw  it  under  the  table,  whence,  when 
the  examination  was  over,  it  was  taken  and  thrown  away 
as  rubbish. 

All  this  was  to  find  out  if  it  contained  any  diamonds,  no 
matter  how  small.  The  partners  thought  themselves  very 
lucky  when  the  day  had  gone  if  they  had  found  but  one 
solitary  specimen.  They  worked  with  great  eagerness, 
and  minutely  tried  through  the  earth,  but  during  the  earlier 
days  the  results  were  almost  negative. 

Cyprien  seemed  to  stand  no  chance  whatever.  If  a  tiny 
diamond  was  found  in  the  earth  it  was  always  Steel  who 
noticed  it.  The  first  one  he  found  did  not  weigh,  gangue 
and  all,  more  than  the  sixth  of  a  carat. 

The  carat  is  a  weight  of  four  grains.  A  diamond  of  the 
first  water — that  is  to  say,  pure,  limpid,  and  colorless — is 
worth,  once  it  is  cut,  about  ten  pounds  if  it  weighs  a  carat. 
But  if  smaller,  diamonds  are  very  much  less  valuable  in 
proportion.  Larger  ones  increase  in  value  at  a  very  rapid 
rate.  Generally  speaking,  a  stone  of  pure  water  is  equal 
to  the  square  of  its  weight  in  carats  multiplied  by  the 

VoL  13  Verne 


178  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

current  price  per  carat.  Thus  if  the  price  per  carat  is  ten 
pounds,  a  stone  of  the  same  quality  weighing  ten  carats 
would  be  worth  a  thousand  pounds. 

But  stones  of  ten  carats,  and  even  of  one  carat,  are  very 
rare,  and  that  is  why  they  are  so  dear.  And,  besides,  the 
Griqualand  diamonds  are  nearly  always  yellowish  in 
color,  and  that  greatly  detracts  from  their  value  in  jewelry. 

The  finding  of  a  stone  weighing  the  sixth  of  a  carat 
after  seven  or  eight  days'  work,  was  a  very  poor  return 
for  the  trouble  it  had  cost.  At  that  rate  it  would  pay 
better  to  go  out  and  dig,  to  look  after  sheep,  or  to  break 
stones  on  the  road.  So  thought  Cyprien  to  himself.  But 
the  hope  of  coming  across  a  splendid  diamond,  which 
would  pay  them  at  one  stroke  for  the  work  of  many  weeks, 
or  perhaps  of  many  months,  sustained  him  as  it  sustained 
all  the  other  miners,  even  those  least  sanguine.  Steel 
worked  like  a  machine,  and  did  not  think  at  all — at  least, 
he  did  not  seem  to  do  so. 

The  partners  generally  breakfasted  together,  contenting 
themselves  with  sandwiches  brought  from  a  bar  close  by; 
but  they  dined  at  one  of  the  numerous  ordinaries,  like  the 
rest  of  those  in  camp.  The  evenings  they  spent  apart, 
Cyprien  generally  visiting  the  farm  for  an  hour  or  two. 

There  he  frequently  had  the  disagreeable  necessity  of 
meeting  his  rival,  James  Hilton,  a  large  man  with  red 
hair  and  freckled  face.  This  rival  was  evidently  making 
great  progress  in  the  esteem  of  John  Watkins  by  dint  of 
drinking  more  gin  and  smoking  more  tobacco  than  he  did 
himself. 

Alice,  it  is  true,  seemed  to  have  the  most  perfect  con- 
tempt for  the  clownish  manners  and  commonplace  con- 
versation of  young  Hilton.  But  his  presence  was  simply 
insupportable  to  Cyprien,  who  could  not  stand  him  at  any 
price,  and  consequently  took  his  departure,  and  left  the 
field  clear  for  him. 

"The  Frenchman  is  not  satisfied!"  Watkins  would  say 
to  his  companion,  giving  him  a  wink.  "It  seems  that 
diamonds  don't  come  by  themselves  into  the  shovel;"  and 
Hilton  would  laugh  loudly  at  the  joke. 

Often  on  these  occasions  Cyprien  would  finish  his  even- 
ings with  an  old  Boer  living  near  the  camp,  whose  name 
was  Jacobus  Vandergaart. 


THE  DIGGERS  AT  WORK  179 

It  was  from  him  that  the  kopje  took  its  name,  for  he 
had  been  the  freeholder  in  the  early  days  of  the  con- 
cession. But  if  he  was  to  be  believed,  he  was,  by  some 
gross  piece  of  injustice,  dispossessed  in  favor  of  Watkins. 
Now  he  was  completely  ruined,  and  lived  in  an  old  mud 
hut,  earning  a  living  by  diamond-cutting — a  trade  he  had 
formerly  followed  in  his  native  town  of  Amsterdam. 

It  often  happened  that  the  diggers,  curious  to  know  the 
exact  weights  that  their  diamonds  would  be  once  they 
were  cut,  would  bring  them  to  him  sometimes  to  cleave 
them,  sometimes  to  submit  them  to  more  delicate  oper- 
ations. But  this  work  required  a  sure  hand  and  keen  eye- 
sight, and  old  Jacobus  Vandergaart,  excellent  workman 
though  he  had  been  in  his  time,  had  now  great  trouble  in 
executing  his  orders.  Cyprien  had  given  him  his  first  dia- 
mond to  mount  in  a  ring,  and  had  immediately  taken  a 
fancy  to  him.  He  liked  to  come  and  sit  in  his  humble 
workshop  and  have  a  chat,  sometimes  even  merely  to  keep 
him  company  while  he  worked  at  his  lapidary's  wheel. 
Jacobus  Vandergaart,  with  his  white  beard,  bald  head,  and 
black  velvet  cap,  and  long  nose,  surmounted  by  a  pair  of 
round  spectacles,  looked  like  an  alchymist  of  the  fifteenth 
century  seated  among  his  quaint  old  tools  and  acid 
flagons. 

In  a  bowl  on.  a  bench  near  the  window  were  the  rough 
diamonds  entrusted  to  Jacobus  Vandergaart.  Their  value 
was  something  considerable.  If  he  wished  to  cleave  a 
specimen  whose  crystallization  did  not  seem  quite  perfect 
he  would  begin  by  ascertaining  by  means  of  his  magnify- 
ing-glass  the  direction  of  the  cleavage  planes.  Then  with 
a  splinter  of  another  diamond  he  would  make  an  incision 
in  the  selected  face,  and  then  he  would  introduce  a  thin 
steel  blade  into  this  incision,  and  give  it  a  sharp  blow. 
In  this  way  he  would  cleave  the  diamond's  faces  one  after 
the  other. 

If  Jacobus  Vandergaart  wished  to  "cut"  a  diamond,  or, 
to  speak  more  accurately,  to  shape  it  into  some  desired 
form,  he  would  begin  by  drawing  in  chalk  on  the  gangue 
the  facets  he  had  selected.  Then  he  would  place  each  of 
the  faces  in  succession  in  contact  with  a  second  diamond, 
and  then  he  would  submit  them  both  to  prolonged  friction. 


i8o  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

The  two  stones  would  mutually  grind  away  each  other  and 
gradually  the  facets  would  be  formed. 

In  this  way  Vandergaart  would  give  the  g^em  one  of  the 
customary  forms,  all  of  which  can  be  classified  under 
three  headings,  "double-cut  brilliants,"  "single-cut  bril- 
liants," and  "rose  diamonds." 

A  double  brilliant  has  sixty-four  facets,  a  "table,"  and  a 
"pavilion." 

A  simple  brilliant  is  just  half  a  double  brilliant. 

A  rose  is  flat  below  and  has  a  faceted  dome  above. 

Now  and  then  Vandergaart  had  to  cut  a  "briolette," 
that  is,  a  diamond  with  neither  top  nor  bottom,  and  shaped 
like  a  pear.  In  India  briolettes  have  a  hole  bored  through 
the  narrow  ends,  and  by  it  are  threaded  in  strings. 

"Pendants,"  which  he  very  rarely  had  to  cut,  are  half 
briolettes  with  table  and  pavilion  and  faceted  on  the  inner 
side. 

Once  the  diamond  is  cut,  it  has  to  be  polished.  This  is 
done  by  means  of  a  disk  of  steel  or  lead,  about  nine  inches 
in  diameter,  spinning  horizontally  on  a  table  at  the  rate  of 
from  two  to  three  thousand  revolutions  per  minute,  and 
worked  by  a  crank  and  fly-wheel.  This  disk  is  smeared 
with  oil,  and  dusted  over  with  diamond  dust  derived  from 
previous  cuttings,  and  against  it  Vandergaart  would  press 
the  faces  of  his  stone  until  they  had  acquired  a  perfect 
polish.  The  crank  was  worked  sometimes  by  a  little 
Hottentot  boy,  who  was  engaged  by  the  day,  sometimes 
by  a  friend  like  Cyprien,  who  was  always  very  happy  to 
oblige. 

As  the  diamond-cutter  worked  he  talked,  and  some- 
times he  would  push  his  spectacles  on  to  his  forehead  and 
stop  short  in  his  work  to  tell  some  story  of  the  past.  He 
had  been  forty  years  in  South  Africa,  and  knew  nearly 
all  its  history,  and  what  gave  the  charm  to  his  conver- 
sation was  that  he  spoke  from  personal  experience,  and 
honestly  believed  in  the  traditions  and  prejudices  of  his 
countrymen. 

Often  would  he  tell  how  in  early  days  the  colony  had 
been  captured  by  the  British,  and  how  the  Boers,  to  avoid 
the  restraints  of  laws  to  which  they  were  unaccustomed, 
had  moved  farther  and  farther  up  the  country.  And  he 
would  enlarge  on  the  perils  and  incidents  of  each  exodus 


THE  DIGGERS  AT  WORK  181 

as  with  wagons  and  cattle  and  all  their  belongings  the 
Dutch  settlers  penetrated  into  Kaffirland  in  search  of  a 
new  home.  And  many  were  the  stories  he  would  tell  of 
the  wars  with  the  natives  occasioned  by  these  irruptions 
into  the  countries  of  the  savage  kings. 

"At  last,"  concluded  he  on  one  occasion,  "I  built  this 
house  where  we  are  sitting,  and  started  a  farm.  With 
me  were  my  wife  and  two  children.  My  kraal  was  on 
the  site  of  the  present  mine.  Ten  years  later  John  Wat- 
kins  arrived  in  these  parts  and  built  his  first  house.  We 
did  not  then  know  that  there  were  diamonds  in  this  coun- 
try, and  so  little  occasion  had  I  for  thirty  years  to  think 
of  my  old  trade  that  I  had  almost  forgotten  the  existence 
of  such  gems. 

"Suddenly,  in  1867,  diamonds  were  discovered,  the  first 
recognized,  as  you  know,  while  it  was  being  thrown  about 
by  a  child  to  whom  it  had  been  given  as  a  pretty  pebble 
for  a  plaything.  In  1870  I  lost  my  wife  and  children, 
and  almost  alone  in  the  country  I  remained  quite  indiffer- 
ent to  the  fever  raging  around  me.  I  worked  away  on 
my  farm  just  as  if  the  deposit  Dutoit's  Pan  had  been  a 
thousand  miles  off  instead  of  within  musket-shot. 

"One  night  I  found  the  wall  of  my  kraal  had  been 
knocked  down  and  the  boundary  removed  three  hundred 
yards  farther  back,  John  Watkins,  helped  by  a  hundred 
Kaffirs,  had  built  a  wall  joining  on  to  his  own  so  as  to 
enclose  a  large  patch  of  sandy,  gravelly  land,  up  to  that 
moment  always  recognized  as  belonging  to  me. 

"I  complained  to  him.  He  only  laughed.  I  threatened 
to  go  to  law.  He  told  me  I  might  as  soon  as  I  liked. 

"Three  days  later  the  mystery  was  solved.  The  patch 
of  ground  was  a  diamond  mine.  John  Watkins  had  dis- 
covered it,  and,  hurrying  off  to  Kimberley,  had  certified  it 
as  his  own. 

"I  went  :o  law,  and  you  know  what  that  means.  One 
by  one  I  lost  my  cattle,  my  horses,  my  sheep.  I  sold  my 
furniture,  I  parted  with  everything.  I  lost  my  law-suit 
and  I  was  ruined. 

"The  decision  of  the  court  was  that  I  had  made  out  no 
claim  to  the  land  in  dispute,  but  that  to  avoid  further 
trouble  they  would  confirm  me  in  possession  of  what  I 
then  he!4  and  certify  the  boundary.  That  boundary  they 


182  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

took  as  the  twenty-fifth  degree  of  east  longitude.  The 
land  to  the  west  of  it  was  adjudged  to  John  Watkins,  that 
to  the  east  to  Jacobus  Vandergaart. 

"The  mine  was  to  the  west  of  the  line,  and  so,  although 
it  bears  my  name,  it  became  the  property  of  John  Wat- 
kins." 


CHAPTER  VI 

IN   CAMP 

THE  subject  of  the  conversation  was  not  very  agree- 
able to  the  young  engineer.  He  scarcely  liked  to  hear 
such  imputations  on  the  honor  of  the  man  whom  he  per- 
sisted in  regarding  as  his  future  father-in-law.  And  so 
he  came  to  consider  Vandergaart's  statements  as  merely 
the  pleadings  in  his  law-suit  and  therefore  liable  to  con- 
siderable alteration  when  compared  with  those  of  the 
other  side. 

Watkins,  to  whom  he  one  day  spoke  on  the  subject, 
burst  into  a  shout  of  laughter,  and  as  his  only  reply  tapped 
his  head  with  his  finger,  thereby  intimating  that  Vander- 
gaart was  simply  mad. 

Was  it  not  possible  that  the  old  man,  under  the  ex- 
citement of  the  discovery  of  the  mine,  had  imagined  that 
it  was  his  property  on  insufficient  evidence?  The  court 
had  evidently  decided  against  him  all  through,  and  it 
would  be  very  strange  had  they  no  cause  for  doing  so. 
And  so  Cyprien  continued  his  visits  to  Watkins  Farm, 
although  he  knew  what  Vandergaart  thought  of  its  owner. 

There  was  another  man  in  the  camp  with  whom 
Cyprien  was  on  visiting  terms.  This  was  Mathys  Pre- 
torius,  a  name  well  known  to  all  Griqualand  miners. 

Although  only  forty  years  old,  Pretorius  had  for  many 
years  roamed  about  the  great  valley  of  the  Orange  before 
settling  here.  But  this  nomadic  existence  had  not,  as  in 
Vandergaart's  case,  had  the  effect  of  souring  him.  On 
the  contrary,  he  had  grown  good-humored,  and  so  fat  that 
he  could  scarcely  walk.  He  was  just  like  an  elephant. 

At  home  he  was  nearly  always  seated  in  a  huge  wooden 
chair,  built  specially  to  support  his  majestic  form.  Abroad 
he  never  went  except  in  a  carriage  made  of  wickerwork, 


IN  CAMP  183 

and  drawn  by  a  gigantic  ostrich.  The  ease  with  which 
the  bird  drew  the  huge  mass  after  him  was  a  striking 
demonstration  of  his  muscular  power. 

Mathys  Pretorius  always  came  to  the  camp  to  arrange 
about  the  sale  of  his  vegetables.  He  was  very  popular, 
although  his  popularity,  being  due  to  his  extreme  cowar- 
dice, was  scarcely  an  enviable  one.  The  miners  amused 
themselves  by  endeavoring  to  frighten  him  with  all  sorts 
of  fantastic  rumors. 

One  day  they  would  tell  him  of  an  inroad  of  the  Basu- 
tos  or  the  Zulus;  another  they  would  pretend  to  read  in  a 
newspaper  that  an  act  had  been  passed  making  it  punish- 
able for  a  man  to  weigh  more  than  three  hundred  pounds; 
another  they  would  declare  that  a  mad  dog  had  been 
reported  on  the  Driesfontein  road;  and  poor  Pretorius, 
who  was  obliged  to  take  that  road  home,  would  find  a 
thousand  excuses  for  remaining  in  camp. 

But  these  imaginary  alarms  were  nothing  to  his  actual 
terror  lest  a  diamond  mine  should  be  discovered  on  his 
estate.  A  horrible  picture  of  the  future  presented  itself  to 
him — avaricious  men  invading  his  kitchen  garden,  up- 
setting his  vegetable  borders,  and  ending  by  turning  him 
out  and  taking  possession!  For  how  could  he  help  think- 
ing that  the  fate  of  Jacobus  Vandergaart  would  be  his? 
One  of  his  most  relentless  persecutors  was  Annibale 
Pantalacci.  This  mischievous  Italian — who  seemed  to 
prosper  exceedingly,  judging  from  his  employing  three 
Kaffirs  on  his  claim,  and  sporting  an  enormous  diamond 
on  his  shirt-front — had  discovered  the  Boer's  weakness, 
and  at  least  once  a  week  made  it  his  business  to  go  digging 
and  pecking  near  Pretorius  Farm.  The  farm  lay  along 
the  left  bank  of  the  Vaal,  about  two  miles  above  the 
camp,  and  consisted  of  alluvial  land  that  might  be  diaman- 
tiferous,  though  nothing  as  yet  had  shown  that  it  was  so. 
Pantalacci,  entering  thoroughly  into  the  spirit  of  his 
cumbrous  joke,  would  place  himself  full  in  view  of  the 
windows  of  the  farm,  often  bringing  with  him  a  few  com- 
panions to  assist  in  the  comedy.  The  portly  farmer 
would  be  seen  dodging  behind  his  cotton  curtains  anx- 
iously following  all  their  gestures,  ready  to  rush  to  the 
stable,  hitch  up  his  ostrich,  and  be  off  at  the  first  sign  of 
their  success. 


184  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

Why  had  he  been  foolish  enough  to  tell  one  of  his 
friends  that  he  kept  his  ostrich  harnessed  night  and  day, 
and  his  carriage  packed  with  provisions,  ready  to  start  at 
the  first  unmistakable  symptom  of  invasion? 

"I  shall  go  up  among  the  Bushmen,  to  the  north  of 
the  Limpopo,"  he  said.  "Ten  years  ago  I  traded  ivory 
with  them,  and  I  would  a  hundred  times  rather  do  that 
than  remain  among  such  a  lot  of  lions  and  jackals  as  we 
have  here!" 

And  the  confidant — as  is  the  custom  of  confidants— 
immediately  hastened  to  make  the  confidence  public,  and 
Pantalacci  seized  the  opportunity,  to  the  great  amuse- 
ment of  the  miners. 

Another  constant  victim  of  the  same  facetious  individual 
was  the  Chinaman  Li.  Li  had  settled  at  Vandergaart 
Kopje,  and  opened  a  laundry.  The  mysterious  red  box 
contained  nothing  but  brushes,  soda,  soap,  and  washing- 
blue.  Such  was  all  that  an  intelligent  Chinaman  required 
to  make  his  fortune  with  in  this  country. 

Cyprien  could  hardly  help  laughing  when  he  met  the 
ever-silent  and  uncommunicative  Li  carrying  a  large  bas- 
ketful of  dirty  clothes  on  their  way  to  the  wash.  But 
what  angered  him  was  that  Pantalacci's  persecution  of  the 
unfortunate  Celestial  was  absolutely  cruel.  He  threw 
bottles  of  ink  among  the  linen,  stretched  cords  across  the 
doorway  so  that  Li  tumbled  over  them,  stuck  him  to  his 
seat  by  a  knife  in  the  tail  of  his  blouse,  etc.  Whenever 
he  got  a  chance  he  would  give  him  a  sly  kick,  and  call 
him  a  "pagan  hound,"  and  this  he  did  invariably  when  he 
paid  his  weekly  bill.  Never  was  his  washing  done  as  he 
wished,  although  Li  got  it  up  most  marvelously.  For 
the  least  false  fold  he  would  fly  into  a  most  frightful  rage 
and  thrash  the  unhappy  Chinee  as  if  he  were  his  slave. 

Such  were  the  ordinary  "amusements"  of  the  camp. 
Occasionally,  however,  they  partook  of  a  more  tragic 
character.  If,  for  instance,  it  happened  that  a  negro  em- 
ployed in  one  of  the  mines  was  accused  of  stealing  a 
diamond,  the  whole  population  turned  out  to  escort  him  to 
the  magistrate,  and  urged  him  along  with  their  clenched 
fists.  But  the  crime  of  receiving  was  held  in  greater 
detestation  than  that  of  stealing. 

Ward,  the  Yankee,  who  arrived  in  Griqualand  at  the 


IN  CAMP  185 

same  time  as  the  young  engineer,  had  some  cruel  experi- 
ence of  the  consequence  of  buying  diamonds  from  Kaffirs. 
By  law,  a  Kaffir  on  the  works  is  not  allowed  to  possess 
diamonds,  or  to  buy  a  claim,  or  work  on  his  own  account. 

No  sooner  was  it  known  what  the  Yankee  had  done 
than  an  excited  crowd  rushed  to  Ward's  canteen,  sacked 
it  from  top  to  bottom,  set  it  on  fire,  and  would  have 
hanged  the  proprietor  on  the  gallows  that  willing  hands 
were  preparing,  had  not  a  dozen  of  the  mounted  police 
opportunely  arrived  and  marched  him  off  to  prison. 

And  such  scenes  of  violence  were  frequent  among  this 
very  mixed  and  half-savage  population.  Men  of  every 
race  jostled  each  other  in  the  incongruous  crowd.  The 
thirst  for  gold,  the  drunkenness,  the  torrid  climate,  the 
disappointments,  and  the  dissipation  combined  to  set  their 
brains  ablaze.  Had  all  been  lucky  in  their  digging  they 
would  perhaps  have  been  quieter  and  more  patient.  But 
for  the  one  or  two  to  whom  the  chance  would  come  of 
finding  a  stone  of  great  value  there  were  hundreds  who 
barely  vegetated — who  scarcely  earned  enough  to  keep 
themselves  alive,  even  if  they  did  not  fall  into  absolute 
penury. 

This  Cyprien  soon  began  to  see,  and  he  was  asking  him- 
self if  it  were  worth  while  or  not  to  continue  so  unre- 
munerative  a  trade  when  an  opportunity  offered  for  him 
to  change  his  plan  of  operations. 

One  morning  he  found  himself  face  to  face  with  a 
dozen  Kaffirs,  who  had  arrived  in  camp  in  search  of  work. 
These  men  had  come  from  the  distant  mountains  that 
divide  Kaffirland,  properly  so  called,  from  the  Basutos. 
For  more  than  four  hundred  and  fifty  miles  they  had 
traveled  in  Indian  file  along  the  bank  of  the  Orange,  liv- 
ing on  what  they  found  on  their  way — roots,  berries,  and 
locusts.  They  were  in  a  state  of  semi-starvation,  and 
looked  more  like  skeletons  than  living  beings.  With  their 
emaciated  limbs,  long,  naked  bodies,  parchment-like  skins, 
bony  sides,  and  hollow  cheeks,  they  seemed  more  likely  to 
devour  a  beefsteak  of  human  flesh  than  to  do  a  day's  work. 
No  one  offered  to  engage  them,  and  they  remained 
squatted  by  the  side  of  the  road,  helpless,  gloomy,  and 
brutalized  by  misery  and  want. 

Cyprien  was   much   affected   at   their   appearance,   and 


i86  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

took  pity  on  them.  He  motioned  them  to  wait  a  little, 
and  then  went  off  to  the  hotel,  where  he  ordered  a  large 
potful  of  boiled  maize-flour  and  some  tins  of  preserved 
meat  to  be  sent  out,  and  then  returned  to  amuse  himself 
at  seeing  them  enjoy  these  unaccustomed  luxuries. 

One  would  have  thought  they  were  shipwrecked  sailors 
rescued  from  a  raft  after  a  fortnight's  fasting.  They  ate 
so  much  that  for  their  health's  sake  they  had  to  be  stopped 
to  prevent  their  suffocation.  Only  one — the  youngest  and 
best-looking  of  the  group — showed  any  signs  of  self- 
restraint,  and — what  was  a  still  rarer  thing  for  a  Kaffir — 
he  even  went  so  far  as  to  thank  his  benefactor.  He 
stepped  up  to  Cyprien,  seized  his  hand,  and  solemnly 
passed  it  over  his  woolly  head. 

"What  is  your  name?"  asked  Cyprien. 

The  Kaffir,  understanding  a  few  words  of  English,  re- 
plied, "Mataki." 

Cyprien  liked  his  straightforward  look,  and  conceived 
the  idea  of  engaging  him  to  work  on  his  claim. 

"After  all,"  he  said  to  himself,  "it  is  what  everybody 
does  in  these  parts.  Better  for  the  Kaffir  that  he  should 
have  me  for  his  master  instead  of  some  Pantalacci."  And 
so — "Well,  Mataki,  you  are  looking  for  work,  are  you?" 

The  Kaffir  nodded. 

"Will  you  work  for  me?  I  will  board  you,  find  you  in 
tools,  and  give  you  a  pound  a  month." 

Such  was  the  customary  rate,  and  Cyprien  knew  that 
he  could  not  offer  more  without  raising  the  whole  camp 
against  him.  But  he  intended  to  make  up  the  very  poor 
pay  with  gifts  of  clothes,  cooking  utensils,  and  other 
things. 

As  his  only  reply,  Mataki  smiled,  showed  his  white 
teeth,  and  again  laid  his  protector's  hand  on  his  head. 

The  contract  was  signed. 

Cyprien  took  him  to  his  tent  and  gave  him  a  flannel 
shirt,  a  pair  of  cotton  trousers,  and  an  old  hat.  Mataki 
could  hardly  believe  his  eyes.  To  see  himself  thus  splen- 
didly arrayed  as  soon  as  he  arrived  in  camp  surpassed  his 
dreams.  He  knew  not  how  to  express  his  gratitude  or  his 
joy.  He  jumped  and  capered  and  laughed  and  cried  again 
and  again. 

At  the  end  of  a  week  Mataki  had  picked  up  so  many 


IN  CAMP  187 

words  that  he  was  able  to  make  himself  understood,  and 
Cyprien  learned  his  history.  He  did  not  know  the  name 
of  the  country  where  he  was  born,  but  it  was  in  the  moun- 
tains, toward  the  sun-rising.  All  he  could  say  about  it 
was  that  he  was  very  miserable,  and,  like  many  other 
warriors  of  his  tribe,  to  make  his  fortune  he  had  come  to 
the  Diamond  Fields. 

What  did  he  hope  to  gain?  A  red  cloak  and  ten  times 
ten  pieces  of  silver!  For  the  Kaffirs  hate  gold  pieces, 
their  prejudice  against  them  being  due  to  their  having 
been  used  by  the  first  European  traders. 

And  what  did  Mataki,  the  ambitious,  think  of  doing 
with  these  pieces  of  silver? 

His  intention  was  to  get  a  red  cloak,  a  gun,  and  ammu- 
nition, and  then  to  return  to  his  kraal.  There  he  would 
buy  a  wife,  who  would  work  for  him,  take  care  of  his 
cow,  and  cultivate  his  mealie-field.  Then  would  he  become 
a  great  chief.  Every  one  would  envy  his  gun  and  his  good 
fortune,  and  he  would  die  full  of  years  and  respected. 
Nothing  could  be  simpler. 

Cyprien  remained  deep  in  thought  after  hearing  the 
simple  program.  Could  he  change  it;  enlarge  the  poor 
savage's  horizon,  and  show  him  a  better  object  in  life  than 
a  red  cloak  and  a  shot-gun?  Or  should  he  leave  him  in 
his  ignorance  and  let  him  return  to  his  kraal  in  peace,  and 
live  the  life  he  hoped  for?  A  serious  question,  which  the 
engineer  dared  not  solve,  but  which  Mataki  did  for  him- 
self. 

For  as  soon  as  the  Kaffir  had  picked  up  sufficient  of  the 
language  to  make  himself  understood,  he  betrayed  an 
extraordinary  thirst  for  information.  His  questions  were 
incessant;  he  wished  to  know  everything — the  name  of 
each  object,  its  use,  and  its  origin.  Then  he  devoted  him- 
self to  reading,  writing,  and  to  ciphering.  In  short,  his 
thirst  for  knowledge  was  insatiable.  And  Cyprien  en- 
couraged him,  and  every  evening  gave  him  an  hour's  lesson 
to  help  him  on  the  road  he  had  chosen. 

Miss  Watkins  was  also  interested  in  his  unusual  eager- 
ness, and  undertook  to  give  him  lessons.  And  these  the 
young  Kaffir  would  repeat  to  himself  as  he  worked  at  the 
bottom  of  the  claim,  dealing  mighty  strokes  with  the 
pickaxe  below,  drawing  the  buckets  up  above,  or  sorting 


iS8  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

out  the  pebbles  at  the  sieves.  So  well  did  he  work  that 
his  example  was  contagious,  and  the  men  on  the  neighbor- 
ing claims  made  far  more  progress  than  they  had  ever 
done  before. 

On  Mataki's  recommendation,  Cyprien  engaged  another 
Kaffir  of  the  same  tribe,  whose  name  was  Bardik,  and  his 
zeal  and  intelligence  were  equally  appreciated. 

Soon  after  Bardik's  engagement,  Cyprien  had  his  first 
good  find,  a  seven-carat  stone,  which  he  at  once  sold  to 
Nathan,  the  broker,  for  twenty  pounds.  This  was  prom- 
ising, and  a  miner  who  was  only  on  the  look-out  for 
reasonable  wages  would  have  been  content — but  Cyprien 
was  not. 

"If  I  stay  here  for  two  or  three  months  at  this  rate," 
he  said  to  himself,  "shall  I  be  any  better  off?  It  is  not 
one  seven-carat  stone  that  I  want,  but  a  thousand  or  two, 
or  else  Miss  Watkins  will  be  handed  over  to  James  Hilton, 
or  some  other  worthless  fellow." 

Thus  thought  Cyprien  as  he  returned  to  the  kopje  one 
sultry,  dusty  day — the  dust,  that  reddish,  blinding  cloud, 
that  hangs  like  a  pall  over  the  site  of  a  diamond  mine. 
Suddenly  he  stopped,  and  stepped  back,  horror-struck  at 
what  he  saw  in  the  yard  of  one  of  the  isolated  huts. 

A  man  was  hanging  from  the  pole  of  an  ox-cart,  which 
had  been  drawn  up  by  the  wall.  The  body  hung  like  a 
plummet  against  a  background  of  snowy  white  linen — 
motionless,  lifeless,  with  the  feet  stretched  to  the  ground, 
and  the  arms  dropped  limply  at  its  side. 

Cyprien  was  for  a  moment  aghast.  But  as  he  recognized 
the  Chinaman  Li,  hanging  by  the  pigtail,  which  had  been 
hitched  around  his  neck,  his  astonishment  gave  way  to 
pity.  He  did  not  hesitate  irery  long.  He  sprang  to  the 
pole,  caught  the  body  in  his  arms,  and  cut  the  tail  with 
his  pocket-knife.  That  done,  he  carefully  laid  his  burden 
in  the  shadow  of  the  hut. 

It  was  time.  Li  was  not  quite  cold.  His  heart  beat 
feebly,  but  still  it  did  beat.  Soon  he  opened  his  eyes,  and, 
strange  to  relate,  seemed  to  come  to  his  senses  as  soon  as 
he  saw  the  light.  His  impassible  face  betrayed  neither 
fear  nor  astonishment  at  emerging  from  so  horrible  a  trial. 
He  seemed  as  though  he  had  been  awakened  from  some 
gentle  sleep. 


IN  CAMP  189 

Cyprien  made  him  drink  a  few  drops  of  vinegar  and 
water  that  he  happened  to  have  in  his  flask. 

"Can  you  speak  now?"  asked  he,  mechanically,  forget- 
ting that  Li  could  not  understand  him. 

Li,  however,  gave  an  affirmative  nod. 

"Who  hanged  you,  then?" 

"I  did,"  replied  the  Chinaman,  as  if  he  had  said  the 
most  natural  thing  in  the  world. 

"You?  You  were  committing  suicide,  then,  you  scoun- 
drel! And  why?" 

"Li  was  too  warm!  Li  was  tired  of  it!"  replied  the 
Celestial.  And  then  he  shut  his  eyes,  as  if  to  escape 
further  questioning. 

It  now  struck  Cyprien  for  the  first  time  that  the  China- 
man was  not  supposed  to  know  the  language. 

"You  speak  English?"  asked  he. 

"Yes,"  answered  Li,  lifting  his  eyelids,  or  rather  the 
two  oblique  button-holes  alongside  his  nose. 

The  look  he  gave  reminded  Cyprien  of  that  ironical 
glance  which  had  surprised  him  on  the  coach  to  Kimber- 
ley. 

"Your  reasons  are  absurd!"  he  said  severely.  "People 
do  not  commit  suicide  because  the  weather  is  too  hot! 
Speak  seriously.  There  is  something  in  all  this,  I  know. 
Has  that  Pantalacci  been  doing  anything  to  you?" 

The  Chinaman  bowed  his  head.  "He  threatened  to  cut 
off  my  pigtail,"  said  he,  in  a  low  voice,  "and  I  am  sure 
that  he  would  have  done  so  in  an  hour  or  two." 

At  that  moment  Li  perceived  the  very  pigtail  in 
Cyprien's  hand,  and  saw  that  the  misfortune  he  dreaded 
above  all  things  had  come  to  pass. 

"Oh!  sir!  what!  you!  You  cut  it!"  he  screamed  in 
terror. 

"It  was  necessary  to  do  so  to  prevent  your  being 
strangled,"  said  Cyprien;  "but  it  is  of  no  consequence 
to  you  in  this  place.  Be  calm!" 

The  Chinaman  seemed  so  broken-hearted  at  the  ampu- 
tation that  Cyprien,  fearing  he  might  make  another  at- 
tempt on  his  life,  took  him  along  with  him. 

Li  followed  without  a  word,  sat  down  near  his  rescuer, 
listened  to  his  reprimands,  promised  never  to  renew  the 


190  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

attempt,  and,  under  the  influence  of  a  cup  of  hot  tea,  even 
favored  him  with  some  scraps  of  his  biography. 

He  was  a  native  of  Canton,  and  had  been  brought  up 
in  an  English  commercial  house.  From  Canton  he  had 
gone  to  Ceylon,  thence  to  Australia,  and  thence  to  South 
Africa.  Fortune  had  never  smiled  on  him.  The  laundry 
trade  had  been  as  unprofitable  as  the  twenty  other  trades 
he  had  tried  his  hands  at.  But  Pantalacci  had  simply 
rendered  his  life  insupportable,  and  to  escape  his  persecu- 
tion he  had  made  up  his  mind  to  hang  himself. 

Cyprien  comforted  the  poor  fellow,  promised  to  protect 
him  against  the  Neapolitan,  gave  him  all  the  dirty  clothes 
to  wash  that  he  could  find,  and  sent  him  away  contented 
at  the  loss  of  his  capillary  appendage,  and  free  from  super- 
stition regarding  the  consequences. 


CHAPTER  VII 

THE    LANDSLIP 

A  FORTNIGHT  passed,  and  Cyprien  found  not  a  single 
diamond.  More  and  more  did  he  become  disgusted  with 
his  trade.  It  seemed  to  him,  without  capital  enough  to 
buy  a  first-class  claim  and  pay  a  dozen  Kaffirs  to  work  it 
properly,  but  little  better  than  a  swindle. 

One  morning,  while  Mataki  and  Bardik  went  out  with 
Steel  to  work,  he  stayed  in  his  tent  to  answer  a  letter  from 
Pharamond  Barthes,  which  had  been  brought  in  by  an 
ivory  trader. 

Barthes  was  enchanted  with  his  life  of  hunting  and 
adventure.  He  had  already  killed  three  lions,  sixteen 
elephants,  and  an  incalculable  number  of  giraffes,  ante- 
lopes, and  such  small  game. 

"Like  the  conquerors  of  history,"  he  said,  "we  make 
war  feed  on  war.  It  frequently  happens  that  we  not  only 
feed  the  whole  expedition  on  what  we  bag,  but  also  make 
considerable  profit  by  selling  or  bartering  the  skins  and 
ivory."  And  in  conclusion  he  said,  "Why  don't  you  come 
with  me  and  have  a  turn  on  the  Limpopo?  I  shall  be 
there  about  the  end  of  next  month,  and  intend  to  go  down 
to  Delagoa  Bay,  to  return  by  sea  to  Durban,  whither  I 


THE  LANDSLIP  191 

have  promised  to  take  my  Basutos.     Leave  your  horrible 
Griqualand  for  a  few  weeks  and  join  me." 

Cyprien  was  reading  the  letter  over  again  when  a 
tremendous  noise,  followed  by  a  loud  shouting  in  the  camp, 
made  him  rush  out  of  his  tent. 

An  excited  crowd  were  running  toward  the  diggings. 

"A  landslip!"  was  the  cry  from  all  sides. 

The  night  had  been  very  cold,  while  the  preceding  day 
had  been  one  of  the  hottest  for  some  time.  This  sudden 
change  of  temperature  had,  as  usual,  caused  the  earth  to 
crack  and  break  away.  Cyprien  hurried  to  the  kopje.  A 
glance  showed  him  what  had  happened. 

An  enormous  block  of  earth,  about  sixty  yards  high 
and  two  hundred  long,  had  been  cleft  vertically,  and  a 
fissure  formed  in  it  like  a  breach  in  a  rampart.  Thou- 
sands of  tons  of  gravel  had  been  detached  from  the  main 
mass  and  rolled  down  into  the  claims,  filling  them  with 
sand,  pebbles,  and  rubbish.  Everything  on  the  spot  at 
the  time — men,  oxen,  and  carts — had  been  hurled  below. 
Fortunately  the  majority  of  the  diggers  had  not  yet  gone 
down  to  work,  so  that  but  a  very  few  were  buried  by  the 
fall. 

Cyprien's  first  thought  was  for  Steel,  and  soon  he  had 
the  pleasure  of  recognizing  him  among  the  men  near 
the  cleft.  He  ran  up  to  ask  him  how  it  had  happened. 

"We  are  all  right,"  said  the  Lancashire  man,  as  he  shook 
hands. 

"Where's  Mataki  ?"  asked  Cyprien. 

"He  is  down  under  there,"  answered  Steel,  pointing  to 
the  rubbish  which  had  heaped  up  on  their  claim.  "I  was 
waiting  here  till  he  had  filled  his  first  bucket  when  the 
slip  took  place." 

"But  we  cannot  leave  him  there  without  trying  to  rescue 
him.  Perhaps  he  is  still  alive." 

Steel  shook  his  head.  "It  is  not  likely  that  he  can  be 
living  under  fifteen  or  twenty  tons  of  earth.  Besides,  it 
would  take  ten  men  two  or  three  days  to  clear  all  that 
off." 

"Never  mind,"  answered  the  engineer;  "it  shall  not  be 
said  that  we  left  a  fellow-creature  down  in  that  grave 
without  trying  to  get  him  out." 

And  then,  through  Bardik,  who  was  standing  near,  he 


192  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

offered  to  the  Kaffirs  the  high  pay  of  five  shillings  a  day 
to  all  who  would  help  to  clear  out  the  claim. 

Thirty  negroes  undertook  the  job,  and  without  losing 
an  instant  set  to  work.  Picks  and  shovels  were  there, 
buckets  and  ropes  were  ready,  and  the  carts  were  standing 
by.  A  great  number  of  the  whites,  hearing  that  they 
were  trying  to  dig  out  a  poor  fellow  buried  alive  by  the 
landslip,  volunteered  their  help,  and  Steel,  thoroughly 
roused  by  Cyprien's  energy,  was  by  no  means  the  least 
active  among  them. 

By  noon  several  tons  of  gravel  had  been  cleared  away. 
At  three  o'clock  Bardik  uttered  a  hoarse  cry.  Beneath 
his  pickaxe  he  had  just  caught  sight  of  a  black  head.  The 
men  worked  with  a  will,  and  a  few  minutes  later  Mataki's 
body  was  exhumed.  The  unhappy  man  was  lying  on  his 
back,  motionless,  and  to  all  appearances  dead.  By  a 
singular  chance  one  of  the  leather  buckets  had  been  turned 
over  on  his  face  and  covered  it  like  a  mask. 

This  Cyprien  noticed  at  once,  and  it  led  him  to  think 
that  he  might  recall  the  poor  fellow  to  life.  The  hope, 
however,  was  very  feeble,  for  the  heart  beat  no  longer, 
the  skin  was  cold,  the  limbs  had  stiffened,  the  hands  were 
clenched  in  agony,  and  the  face — of  that  livid  paleness 
peculiar  to  the  negroes — was  frightfully  contracted  by 
asphyxia. 

Cyprien  did  not  lose  courage.  He  had  Mataki  carried 
to  Steel's  hut,  which  was  nearer  than  his  own,  and  here 
he  was  laid  on  the  table  where  the  gravel  was  usually 
tried  over.  Systematic  rubbing  was  then  begun,  particu- 
larly that  chafing  the  thoracic  cage,  with  a  view  to  es- 
tablish artificial  respiration,  which  is  employed  in  the  case 
of  the  apparently  drowned.  Cyprien  knew  that  this  treat- 
ment was  equally  applicable  to  all  kinds  of  asphyxia,  and 
in  the  present  instance  he  had  nothing  else  to  attend  to, 
as  no  wound  or  fracture,  or  even  serious  bruise,  was 
apparent. 

"Look !"  said  Steel,  who  was  rubbing  away  assiduously ; 
"he  is  holding  something  in  his  hand!" 

The  result  of  these  measures  soon  became  apparent. 
The  corpse-like  stiffness  of  the  young  Kaffir  gradually 
relaxed;  the  temperature  of  the  skin  sensibly  changed. 
Cyprien,  who  was  watching  the  heart  for  the  least  sign  of 


THE  LANDSLIP,  193 

life,  thought  he  could  feel  a  gentle  trembling  that  augured 
well. 

Soon  the  symptoms  became  more  marked.  The  pulse 
began  to  beat,  a  slight  inspiration  seemed  to  insensibly 
inflate  Mataki's  chest,  and  then  a  stronger  expiration  be- 
trayed a  manifest  return  of  the  vital  functions. 

Suddenly  two  vigorous  sneezes  shook  the  black  carcass 
from  head  to  foot.  Mataki  opened  his  eyes,  breathed, 
recovered  his  consciousness. 

"Hurrah!  hurrah!  he's  all  right!"  exclaimed  Thomas 
Steel,  as,  dripping  with  perspiration,  he  suspended  his 
rubbing.  "But  look!  he  has  never  let  go  of  that  piece  of 
earth  in  his  hand!" 

Cyprien  had  other  things  to  think  of  than  such  a  trifle 
as  that!  He  made  his  patient  swallow  a  spoonful  of 
spirits,  and  then  raised  him  so  as  to  facilitate  his  breath- 
ing. Finally,  when  he  found  he  had  really  returned  to 
life,  he  wrapped  him  up  in  blankets,  and,  with  the  help 
of  three  or  four  willing  companions,  carried  him  to  his 
own  hut  at  Watkins  Farm. 

There  the  poor  Kaffir  was  put  to  bed,  and  Bardik  made 
him  take  a  mug  of  hot  tea.  In  a  quarter  of  an  hour  he 
peacefully  fell  asleep.  He  was  saved! 

Cyprien  felt  that  incomparable  gladness  in  his  heart 
which  a  man  experiences  when  he  has  snatched  a  human 
life  from  the  jaws  of  death;  and,  sitting  down  by  Mataki, 
took  up  a  book,  interrupting  his  reading  from  time  to 
time  to  look  at  him  as  he  slept — like  a  father  watching  the 
sleep  of  a  convalescent  son. 

During  the  six  weeks  Mataki  had  been  in  his  service 
Cyprien  had  had  every  reason  to  be  satisfied  with  him. 
His  intelligence,  obedience,  and  ardor  in  his  work  were 
astonishing.  He  was  fearless  and  obliging,  and  of  a 
singularly  quiet  and  cheerful  disposition.  He  had,  how- 
ever, one  fault — a  very  serious  one — due  evidently  to  his 
earlier  education,  and  to  the  Spartan  customs  that  pre- 
vailed in  his  father's  kraal.  Mataki  was  just  a  little  of  a 
thief,  but  almost  unconsciously  so.  When  he  saw  any- 
thing he  liked  he  thought  it  the  most  natural  thing  in  the 
world  to  annex  it. 

In  vain  his  master,  alarmed  at  the  tendency,  talked  to 
him  and  argued  with  him.  In  vain  he  had  threatened  to 

Vol.  13  Verne 


194  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

send  him  away  if  he  found  him  out  in  another  attempt. 
Mataki  promised  never  to  do  so  again,  cried,  begged  par- 
don, and  the  very  next  day  stole  something  else,  as  if 
nothing  at  all  had  happened. 

His  larcenies  were  not  heavy,  however.  His  covet- 
ousness  was  not  excited  by  things  of  great  value;  a  knife, 
a  cravat,  a  pencil,  or  some  such  trifle  would  be  enough  for 
him.  But  Cyprien  was  none  the  less  broken-hearted  at 
finding  such  a  failing  in  so  sympathetic  a  nature. 

"Wait!  hope!"  he  said.  "Perhaps  I  shall  some  day 
make  him  understand  how  wicked  it  is." 

Toward  nightfall  Mataki  awoke,  as  well  as  if  nothing 
had  happened,  and  then  he  told  his  story. 

The  bucket  that  had  accidentally  covered  his  face,  and  a 
long  ladder  serving  as  a  buttress  above  him,  had  kept  off 
the  pressure,  and  saved  him  for  some  time  from  complete 
asphyxia  by  leaving  him  a  little  air  to  breathe.  He  had 
made  the  best  he  could  of  this  fortunate  circumstance  by 
breathing  only  at  long  intervals.  But  little  by  little  the 
air  became  foul.  Mataki  found  his  senses  gradually  going, 
and  fell  off  into  a  deep,  painless  sleep,  whence  he  roused 
for  a  moment  now  and  then  to  make  a  determined  attempt 
at  inspiration.  Then  all  was  a  blank. 

Cyprien  let  him  talk  for  a  minute  or  two,  and  then  got 
him  to  drink  and  eat,  and  compelled  him,  in  spite  of  his 
protests,  to  remain  in  bed  for  the  night.  Then,  feeling 
sure  that  all  danger  was  over,  he  left  him  alone,  and  went 
to  pay  his  customary  visit  to  Watkins  Farm. 

He  wished  to  tell  Alice  what  he  thought  of  the  events 
of  the  day,  and  of  the  dislike  he  had  taken  to  the  mine — a 
dislike  which  the  deplorable  accident  of  the  morning  could 
not  but  increase.  He  told  her  of  his  disappointments  and 
vexations,  and  of  the  letter  he  had  received  from  Phara- 
mond  Barthes.  Would  it  not  be  better  for  him  to  take 
his  friend's  advice?  What  would  he  lose  by  going  to  the 
Limpopo  and  trying  his  luck  as  a  hunter  ?  Surely  it  would 
be  a  nobler  occupation  than  that  of  sifting  the  earth  like 
a  miser,  or  getting  other  people  to  sift  it  for  him. 

"What  do  you  think,  Miss  Watkins?"  he  asked.  "You 
have  so  much  practical  good  sense,  advise  me.  I  have 
lost  my  moral  equilibrium;  I  want  a  friendly  hand  to  set 
me  right  again." 


THE  LANDSLIP  195 

Thus  spoke  he  in  all  sincerity,  pleased,  he  knew  not 
why,  at  thus  betraying  his  indecision  to  his  gentle  confi- 
dante, who  listened  with  deep  sympathy. 

"I  have  long  thought  the  same  of  you,"  she  answered. 
"I  cannot  understand  how  a  scientific  man  like  you  can 
abandon  yourself  to  such  a  life.  Is  it  not  a  crime  against 
yourself  and  against  science  itself?  To  give  your  precious 
time  to  mere  hand  labor,  such  as  a  Kaffir  or  a  Hottentot 
could  do  much  better,  seems  to  me  to  waste  it." 

Cyprien  had  only  one  explanation  to  give  of  the  problem 
which  so  greatly  astonished  and  shocked  the  young  lady. 
Perhaps  she  was  exaggerating  her  indignation  a  little  to 
force  him  to  an  avowal  ?  But  that  avowal  he  had  promised 
not  to  make,  and  so  he  restrained  himself,  although  it 
trembled  on  his  lips. 

Miss  Watkins  continued,  "If  you  want  to  find  diamonds 
so  badly,  why  don't  you  look  where  you  are  most  likely  to 
find  them — in  your  crucible?  What!  you  a  chemist, 
knowing  more  than  anybody  what  these  wretched  stones 
are  which  people  value  so  highly,  and  set  yourself  to  mere 
mechanical  labor?  If  I  were  in  your  place  I  should  try 
to  make  diamonds,  not  to  find  them!" 

Unfortunately  at  this  moment  Watkins  awoke  from  his 
sleep  to  ask  the  latest  news  from  Vandergaart  Kopje,  but 
the  seed  had  been  thrown  on  good  ground,  and  was  sure 
to  germinate. 

As  the  young  engineer  returned  home  he  pondered  over 
Miss  Watkins'  thrilling  words.  All  that  was  fanciful 
about  them  disappeared  when  he  thought  of  the  generous 
and  almost  tender  confidence  that  they  had  showed  in  him. 

"And  why  not?"  he  asked  himself.  "The  fabrication 
of  the  diamond  may  have  appeared  Utopian  a  century 
ago,  but  now  it  is  as  good  as  done.  Fremy  and  Peil  have 
made  rubies,  emeralds,  and  sapphires  which  are  only  dif- 
ferently colored  crystals  of  alumina.  MacTear  and  Han- 
nay,  of  Glasgow,  really  made  diamonds,  and  their  only 
fault  was  that  they  were  so  horribly  dear — dearer  than  the 
natural  diamonds  of  Brazil  and  Griqualand — and  conse- 
quently the  discovery  was  of  no  commercial  value.  But 
when  the  scientific  solution  of  a  problem  has  been  arrived 
at,  the  industrial  solution  is  not  far  off.  Why  should  I 
not  seek  for  it?  The  men  who  have  failed  hitherto  have 


196  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

been  mere  theorists — men  of  the  study  and  the  laboratory. 
They  have  not  studied  the  diamond  in  position — in  its 
native  earth — in  its  cradle,  so  to  speak.  I  have  the  benefit 
of  their  work — of  their  experience — in  addition  to  my 
own.  I  have  extracted  the  diamond  with  my  own  hands. 
I  have  analyzed  it,  studied  it  under  every  aspect  in  which 
it  has  been  found.  If  anybody  had  a  good  chance  of  suc- 
ceeding, I  am  the  man — at  least,  I  ought  to  be  the  man." 

Thus  thought  Cyprien,  as,  turning  the  matter  over  in  his 
mind,  he  lay  awake  during  the  greater  part  of  the  night. 

His  resolution  was  soon  taken.  On  the  following  morn- 
ing he  told  Steel  that  he  did  not  intend  to  work  his  claim 
any  more,  and  arranged  with  him  to  retire  from  the 
partnership  as  soon  as  some  one  could  be  found  to  take 
his  place.  Then  he  went  back  and  shut  himself  up  in  his 
laboratory  to  think  over  his  new  scheme. 


CHAPTER  VIII 

THE  GREAT  EXPERIMENT 

"PERHAPS/*  said  Cyprien,  "these  diamond  deposits  are 
really  carbonataras.  If  a  lot  of  hydrogen  and  carbon 
hung  about  the  streams  and  alluvial  deposits  in  the  form 
of  marsh  gas,  why  should  there  not  have  been  an  oxyda- 
tion  of  the  hydrogen  with  an  accompanying  partial  oxy- 
dation  of  the  carbon,  such  as  would  bring  about  a  crys- 
tallization of  the  carbon  in  excess?" 

With  this  idea  to  begin  with,  a  chemist  had  little 
difficulty  in  selecting  a  compound  to  play  the  part  of  the 
oxygen  in  an  analogous  but  artificial  reaction,  and  Cyprien 
immediately  entered  on  the  investigation. 

In  the  first  place  a  state  of  things  had  to  be  devised 
experimentally  to  resemble  as  much  as  possible  the  sup- 
posed conditions  under  which  the  natural  diamond  was 
produced.  This  was  simple  enough.  Everything  great  in 
science  and  art  is  simple.  What  can  be  less  complicated 
than  the  greatest  discoveries  of  humanity — gravitation,  the 
compass,  the  printing-press,  the  steam-engine,  the  electric 
telegraph  ? 

Cyprien  himself  went  down  to  the  lowest  depths  of  the 
diggings  and  there  selected  samples  of  the  earth  which  he 


THE  GREAT  EXPERIMENT  197 

thought  best  suited  for  his  experiment.  With  it  he  made 
a  thick  pasty  mortar,  and  with  this  he  carefully  lined  a 
steel  tube  about  half  a  yard  long,  two  inches  thick,  and 
three  inches  in  bore. 

This  tube  was  simply  a  piece  of  cannon  condemned 
as  unfit  for  service.  He  had  managed  to  buy  it  at  Kim- 
berley  from  a  company  of  volunteers  who  had  been  dis- 
banded after  a  campaign  against  the  neighboring  Kaffirs. 
This  cannon,  sawed  in  segments  in  old  Vandergaart's 
work-shop,  gave  the  very  instrument  that  was  required — 
namely  a  chamber  of  sufficient  resistance  to  support  enor- 
mous internal  pressure. 

After  firmly  closing  one  end  of  the  tube,  he  placed  in  it 
a  few  fragments  of  copper  and  about  three  pints  of  water. 
Then  he  filled  it  with  marsh  gas,  and  then  carefully  luting 
it  with  his  mortar  he  drove  stoppers  into  each  end  and 
fastened  them  in  strongly  enough  to  withstand  any  force. 
Thus  was  the  apparatus  constructed.  The  next  thing  to 
do  was  to  submit  it  to  intense  heat. 

To  obtain  this  it  was  put  into  a  large  reverberating 
furnace  kept  going  night  and  day  for  a  fortnight,  so  as  to 
give  a  constant  white  heat. 

Both  the  furnace  and  the  tube  were  then  enveloped  in  a 
thick  coating  of  refractory  earth,  so  as  to  retain  the 
greatest  possible  quantity  of  heat,  and  to  cool  down  as 
slowly  as  possible  when  the  time  came.  The  furnace 
looked  like  a  huge  beehive  or  an  Eskimo  hut. 

And  now  Mataki  was  able  to  be  of  use.  All  the  prep- 
arations had  been  watched  by  him  with  great  attention, 
and  when  he  found  that  they  were  going  to  try  and  make 
a  diamond  his  interest  in  the  experiment  became  intense. 
He  soon  learned  how  to  stoke  the  furnace,  and  the  charge 
of  that  department  was  entrusted  to  him. 

As  can  be  imagined,  these  arrangements  took  some  time. 
In  a  European  laboratory  the  experiment  would  have  been 
begun  within  a  couple  of  hours  of  its  having  been  planned 
out,  but  in  this  half -civilized  place  it  took  three  weeks 
before  all  was  ready.  And  Cyprien  was  very  lucky  in 
several  things;  for  instance,  in  rinding  the  old  gun,  which 
just  suited  him,  and  in  procuring  coal  for  fuel.  In  fact, 
so  rare  was  coal  at  Kimberley  that  he  had  to  apply  to 
three  merchants  to  scrape  together  a  single  ton. 


198  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

At  length  all  difficulties  were  surmounted,  and  once  the 
fire  was  lighted,  Mataki  took  it  in  charge. 

The  young  Kaffir  was  very  proud  of  his  functions. 
They  were  not  quite  novel  to  him,  as  once  or  twice  in  his 
native  land  he  had  assisted  at  a  more  or  less  diabolical 
act  of  cookery.  For  among  his  fellows  it  seemed  that 
Mataki  had  the  reputation  of  being  a  magician.  A  few 
secrets  of  elementary  surgery,  and  two  or  three  mesmeric 
passes  learned  from  his  father,  were  his  whole  stock  in 
trade.  But  the  Kaffirs  came  to  consult  him  for  all  their 
ailments,  real  or  imaginary,  for  the  interpretation  of  their 
dreams  and  the  settlement  of  their  disputes.  Mataki  was 
never  at  fault,  and  had  always  some  formula  ready,  some 
portent  to  explain,  or  some  sentence  to  pronounce.  The 
formulae  were  generally  strange  and  the  sentences  pre- 
posterous, but  his  countrymen  were  satisfied.  And  what 
more  would  you  have? 

Besides,  the  flasks  and  retorts  by  which  he  was  sur- 
rounded in  Cyprien's  laboratory — to  say  nothing  of  the 
mysterious  operations  in  which  he  was  allowed  to  take 
part — could  not  but  contribute  to  his  prestige. 

Cyprien  often  smiled  at  the  solemn  airs  the  black  gave 
himself  in  performing  this  humble  task  of  stoker  and 
preparer,  in  putting  on  the  coal  and  poking  the  fire,  or 
dusting  the  rows  of  crucibles  and  test  tubes.  And  in  this 
gravity  there  was  something  even  pathetic — that  artless 
expression  of  the  awe  inspired  by  science  in  a  nature 
degraded,  but  intelligent  and  greedy  to  learn. 

But  Mataki  had  his  play  hours  like  other  men,  especially 
when  he  was  in  the  company  of  Li.  A  firm  friendship 
had  sprung  up  between  these  two,  different  as  they  were 
in  their  origin,  during  the  now  very  frequent  visits  that 
the  Chinaman  paid  to  Watkins  Farm.  They  had  both 
been  rescued  by  Cyprien  from  imminent  death,  and  re- 
garded him  with  the  warmest  gratitude.  It  was  thus  very 
natural  that  they  should  be  first  drawn  toward  each  other 
by  a  sincere  sympathy,  and  then  that  this  sympathy  should 
be  changed  into  affection. 

Between  themselves  Li  and  Mataki  had  given  the  young 
engineer  a  familiar  name  that  well  expressed  the  nature  of 
the  sentiment  with  which  they  regarded  him.  They  called 


THE  GREAT  EXPERIMENT  199 

him  "pa,"   and  never  spoke  of  him  except  in  terms  of 
admiration  and  devotion. 

On  Li's  part  this  devotion  showed  itself  in  the  scrupu- 
lous attention  with  which  he  washed  and  got  up  Cyprien's 
linen;  on  Mataki's  part  by  the  rigid  punctuality  with 
which  he  carried  out  all  his  master's  instructions. 

But  sometimes  the  two  friends  went  a  little  further  in 
their  endeavor  to  gratify  their  "pa."  Occasionally,  for 
instance,  Cyprien  would  find  on  his  table  certain  fruits  or 
dainties  that  he  had  never  ordered,  and  which  never  ap- 
peared in  the  tradesmen's  bills.  Now  and  then  when  his 
shirts  returned  from  the  wash  they  would  be  provided 
with  gold  studs  of  mysterious  origin.  An  excellent  easy- 
chair  appeared  among  the  furniture;  an  embroidered 
cushion,  a  panther-skin,  and  several  costly  nicknacks  came 
into  the  hut  none  knew  whence. 

And  if  Cyprien  asked  Li  or  Mataki  about  them,  all  he 
could  get  were  evasive  responses,  such  as,  "It  wasn't  me, 
sir!"  "I  wonder  who  did  it!"  etc.,  etc. 

Cyprien  would  have  taken  little  notice  of  these  things 
had  he  not  suspected  that  the  gifts  had  been  very  easily 
acquired.  Had  they  cost  more  than  the  trouble  of  taking 
them?  Nothing,  however,  happened  to  confirm  his  sus- 
picions, and  all  his  inquiries  produced  no  result,  while 
behind  his  back  Li  and  Mataki  exchanged  sly  looks, 
significant  smiles,  and  cabalistic  signs  that  seemed  to 
afford  them  intense  gratification. 

Cyprien  had,  however,  other  cares  to  attend  to.  John 
Watkins  seemed  to  have  made  up  his  mind  to  get  Alice 
married  as  soon  as  possible,  and  with  this  in  view  seemed 
to  keep  open  quite  a  museum  of  probable  admirers.  Not 
only  was  James  Hilton  there  every  evening,  but  all  the 
bachelor  diggers  whose  success  in  the  kopje  had  in  Wat- 
kins'  eyes  given  them  the  necessary  qualifications  for  his 
son-in-law.  The  German  Friedel  and  the  Italian  Panta- 
lacci  were  among  them,  both  having  been  among  the 
lucky  ones  of  the  mine.  Friedel  was  more  pedantic  and 
peremptory  than  ever;  Pantalacci  had  blossomed  out  into 
a  colonial  swell,  resplendent  with  gold  chains  and  diamond 
pins.  He  wore  a  white  linen  suit,  which  made  his  yellow 
complexion  look  still  yellower  and  more  cadaverous. 

With  his  buffooneries,   his  Neapolitan  songs,   and  his 


200  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

attempts  at  being  a  fine  gentleman,  Pantalacci  tried  in 
vain  to  please  Alice,  who  despised  him  heartily  for  the 
very  obvious  motive  that  brought  him  to  the  farm.  She 
never  listened  to  him  if  she  could  help  it,  and  never  gave 
the  faintest  smile  either  at  his  jokes  or  his  attitudes. 

And  Cyprien  was  at  work  both  night  and  day  on  other 
experiments  which  he  intended  to  try  should  he  fail  in  his 
first  attempt  at  diamond-making.  He  was  not  content 
with  theory  and  formula,  though  with  them  for  hours  he 
would  fill  notebook  after  notebook.  Frequently  did  he 
visit  the  kopje,  to  bring  home  fresh  specimens  of  the 
gravels  and  sands  and  submit  them  to  a  searching  analysis, 
which,  repeated  in  many  ways,  allowed  of  no  margin  for 
error.  The  greater  the  danger  became  of  losing  Alice 
Watkins,  the  more  was  he  resolved  to  omit  nothing  that 
might  give  him  the  victory.  And  yet,  so  little  confidence 
had  he  in  himself  that  he  whispered  not  a  word  to  her  of 
the  experiment  in  progress.  All  Alice  knew  was  that  he 
had  gone  back  to  his  chemistry — and  she  was  very  glad 
to  hear  it. 


CHAPTER  IX 

A  SURPRISE 

IT  was  a  great  day  when  the  experiment  was  completed. 
For  two  weeks  the  fire  had  been  allowed  to  die  out,  so 
that  the  apparatus  might  gradually  cool.  Cyprien,  con- 
sidering that  the  crystallization  of  the  carbon  ought  by 
now  to  have  been  effected,  resolved  to  open  the  mound 
which  covered  the  furnace. 

This  was  no  easy  matter.  The  pickaxes  had  all  their 
work  to  do  to  cut  their  way  through  the  baked  earth.  It 
had  been  hardened  like  a  brick.  At  length  it  yielded  to 
the  attacks  of  Mataki,  and  the  upper  part  of  the  furnace, 
the  capital,  so  to  speak,  was  visible.  Then  the  whole 
furnace  was  revealed  to  view. 

Cyprien's  heart  beat  a  hundred  and  twenty  to  the 
minute  as  the  Kaffir,  assisted  by  Bardik  and  Li,  lifted  off 
the  top. 

That  the  experiment  had  succeeded  he  could  hardly  be- 
lieve. He  was  one  of  those  who  always  doubt  themselves, 


A  SURPRISE  201 

But  after  all  it  was  possible!  And  if  it  had!  All  his 
hopes  of  happiness,  of  glory,  and  of  fortune  were  con- 
tained in  that  huge  black  cylinder  which  now  met  his  sight 
after  so  many  weeks  of  trial! 

Horror!    The  cannon  had  burst! 

Yes!  Against  the  formidable  pressure  of  the  vapor  of 
the  water  and  the  marsh  gas  raised  to  such  a  tremendous 
temperature  the  very  steel  had  been  unable  to  contend. 
The  barrel,  although  two  inches  thick,  had  split  like  a  test 
tube.  On  one  of  its  sides  about  half-way  down  there 
gaped  a  huge  fissure  blackened  and  twisted  by  the  flames, 
which  seemed  to  grin  in  the  face  of  the  discomfited 
engineer. 

This  was  indeed  unfortunate !  So  much  trouble  to  reach 
a  negative!  Indeed  Cyprien  would  have  felt  less  humili- 
ated if,  thanks  to  his  precautions,  the  cylinder  had  re- 
sisted the  fire — and  been  found  empty.  That  there  might 
be  no  diamond  inside  the  tube  he  was  prepared  for.  But 
to  have  heated  up  and  cooled  down  and  cherished  for  a 
month  or  more  that  old  lump  of  steel,  and  then  to  end 
like  this,  was  the  acme  of  misfortune!  He  felt  inclined  to 
kick  the  whole  concern  over  his  hut — but  its  weight  for- 
bade him. 

He  was  about  to  leave  the  spot  in  despair,  when  curi- 
osity led  him  to  hold  a  match  at  the  gap  in  the  tube  so  as 
to  examine  the  interior. 

"Perhaps,"  he  thought,  "the  earth  I  plastered  around  it 
has  been  baked  into  a  brick  like  that  outside." 

He  was  right.  But  a  very  curious  phenomenon  pre- 
sented itself  which  at  first  he  could  not  understand.  A 
sort  of  clay  nodule  seemed  to  have  detached  itself  from 
the  lining  of  the  tube  and  hardened  separately. 

The  nodule  was  of  a  reddish  color.  It  was  about  the 
size  of  an  orange,  and  could  easily  pass  through  the  gap. 
Cyprien  drew  it  out,  and  held  it  up  carelessly  to  examine 
it.  Then  remembering  that  it  was  only  a  piece  of  clay 
like  the  rest,  but  separately  baked,  he  was  going  to  throw 
it  aside.  But  it  sounded  hollow  like  a  piece  of  pottery. 

It  was  a  sort  of  closed  cup  in  which  something  seemed 
to  shake.  "A  regular  money-box!"  said  Cyprien. 

But  had  he  under  pain  of  death  been  obliged  to  explain 
the  mystery  he  could  not  have  done  so. 


202  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

However,  he  resolved  to  see  what  it  meant.  He  took 
up  a  hammer  and  smashed  the  "money-box." 

And  it  was  a  money-box,  and  contained  a  magnificent 
treasure.  There  could  be  no  mistake  as  to  the  nature  of 
the  pebble  which  disclosed  itself  to  the  astonished  eyes  of 
the  engineer.  The  stone  was  a  diamond  in  its  gangue,  in 
every  respect  like  an  ordinary  diamond,  but  a  diamond  of 
colossal  dimensions. 

It  was  as  large  as  a  fowl's  egg.  It  looked  not  unlike  a 
potato.  It  weighed  over  half  a  pound. 

"A  diamond !  An  artificial  diamond !"  repeated  Cyprien 
in  an  undertone.  "I  have  solved  the  problem  notwith- 
standing the  accident  to  the  tube.  I  am  a  rich  man! 
Alice,  my  dear  Alice,  is  mine!" 

Then  he  doubted  his  eyesight. 

"But  it  is  impossible!  It  is  an  illusion,  a  mirage! 
But  I'll  soon  find  out  the  truth." 

And  without  stopping  to  put  on  his  hat,  mad  with  joy, 
like  Archimedes  jumping  from  the  bath  when  he  dis- 
covered his  famous  principle,  Cyprien  tore  down  the  road 
from  the  farm  and  bounded  like  a  shot  into  the  workshop 
of  Jacobus  Vandergaart. 

He  found  the  old  lapidary  examining  some  stones  which 
Nathan  the  broker  had  brought  to  be  cut. 

"Ha!  Mr.  Nathan,  you  are  just  in  time,"  exclaimed 
Cyprien.  "Look  here!  and  you,  Mr.  Vandergaart,  see 
what  I  have  brought  you,  and  tell  me  what  it  is." 

He  put  the  stone  on  the  table  and  crossed  his  arms. 
Nathan  first  took  it  up.  He  turned  pale  with  surprise,  his 
eyes  opened  wide,  as  he  handed  the  stone  to  Vandergaart. 

Jacobus  held  it  up  to  the  level  of  his  eyes,  looked  at  it 
in  the  light  from  the  window,  and  then  looked  at  it  over 
his  spectacles.  Then  he  laid  it  on  the  table,  looked  at 
Cyprien,  and  said  very  quietly: 

"That  is  the  biggest  diamond  in  the  world." 

"Yes!  The  biggest!"  repeated  Nathan.  "Two  or  three 
times  as  large  as  the  Kohinoor,  the  Mountain  of  Light, 
the  pride  of  the  royal  jewels  of  England,  and  which 
weighs  a  hundred  and  seventy-nine  carats." 

"Two  or  three  times  as  large  as  the  Grand  Mogul,  the 
largest  known  stone,  which  weighs  two  hundred  and  eighty 
carats,"  said  the  lapidary. 


A  SURPRISE  203 

"Four  or  five  times  as  large  as  the  Czar's  diamond, 
which  weighs  a  hundred  and  ninety-three  carats!"  con- 
tinued Nathan. 

"Seven  or  eight  times  as  large  as  the  Regent,  which 
weighs  one  hundred  and  thirty-six  carats,"  quoth  Vander- 
gaart. 

"Twenty  or  thirty  times  as  large  as  the  Dresden 
diamond,  which  weighs  only  thirty-one!"  said  Nathan, 
adding  immediately,  "I  should  say  that  after  it  is  cut  it 
will  weigh  at  least  four  hundred  carats!  But  how  can  we 
dare  to  value  it?  It  is  beyond  all  calculation." 

"Why  not?"  answered  Jacobus  Vandergaart,  who  re- 
mained the  coolest  of  the  two.  "The  Kohinoor  is  esti- 
mated at  a  million  and  a  quarter,  the  Grand  Mogul  at 
half  a  million,  the  Czar's  diamond  at  three  hundred  and 
fifty  thousand,  the  Regent  at  two  hundred  and  fifty  thou- 
sand— and  that  certainly  ought  to  be  worth  four  millions 
of  money!" 

"It  all  depends  on  its  color  and  quality,"  said  Nathan, 
who  began  to  recover  his  senses,  and  to  prepare  for  the 
future  with  a  view  to  a  future  bargain.  "If  it  is  pure  and 
of  the  first  water  its  value  will  be  inestimable;  but  if  it 
is  yellow,  like  most  of  our  Griqualand  stones,  it  will  not 
be  worth  nearly  so  much.  For  a  stone  of  that  size,  I 
think  I  should  prefer  just  a  slight  tinge  of  sapphire-blue, 
like  the  Hope  diamond,  or  perhaps  a  rose  tint,  like  that  of 
the  Grand  Mogul,  or  even  emerald  shade,  like  that  of  the 
Dresden  diamond." 

"No,  no!"  said  the  old  lapidary,  excitedly;  "I  believe 
in  colorless  diamonds!  Give  me  the  Kohinoor  or  the 
Regent!  There  are  gems  for  you!  By  the  side  of  them 
those  others  are  but  fancy  stones." 

Cyprien  had  heard  enough. 

"Gentlemen,  you  must  excuse  me,"  said  he,  hurriedly; 
"I  must  leave  you  for  a  minute,"  and,  picking  up  his 
precious  pebble,  he  ran  back  along  the  road  to  the  farm. 

Without  stopping  to  knock,  he  burst  open  the  sitting- 
room  door,  found  himself  in  Alice's  presence,  and,  without 
giving  a  thought,  caught  her  in  his  arms  and  kissed  her 
on  both  cheeks. 

"Hallo!  what's  up?"  exclaimed  Mr.  Watkins,  quite 
scandalized  at  the  performance. 


204  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

He  was  seated  at  a  table  in  front  of  Annibale  Panta- 
lacci. 

"Miss  Watkins,  I  beg  your  pardon!"  stammered  Cy- 
prien,  surprised  at  his  boldness,  but  radiant  with  joy. 
"I  am  so  happy!  I  have  gone  mad  with  joy.  Look! 
see  what  I  have  brought  you!"  and  he  threw  rather  than 
placed  the  diamond  on  the  table  between  the  two  men. 

Like  Nathan  and  Jacobus  Vandergaart,  they  at  once 
recognized  it.  Mr.  Watkins,  it  being  early  in  the  day, 
was  sufficiently  sober  to  take  in  the  matter  at  a  glance. 

"You  found  that— you  yourself — in  your  claim?"  ex- 
claimed he. 

"Found  it!"  answered  Cyprien,  triumphantly.  "I  did 
better  than  that!  I  made  it!  Ah,  Mr.  Watkins,  there 
is  some  good  in  chemistry  after  all!"  and  he  laughed, 
and  he  clasped  Alice's  delicate  hand  in  his  own,  and  she, 
surprised  at  his  passionate  demonstrations,  but  delighted 
at  his  happiness,  stood  smiling,  as  he  said,  "It  is  you  to 
whom  I  owe  the  discovery!  You  advised  me  to  return 
to  chemistry.  It  was  your  daughter,  Mr.  Watkins,  that 
made  me  make  artificial  diamonds!  I  render  homage  to 
her  like  the  knights  to  the  ladies  of  old,  and  proclaim 
that  to  her  alone  belongs  the  credit  of  the  invention!  I 
should  never  have  dreamed  of  it  without  her." 

Watkins  and  Pantalacci  looked  at  the  diamond,  then 
they  looked  at  each  other  and  shook  their  heads.  They 
were  completely  bewildered. 

"You  say  you  made  that — you  yourself?"  said  Wat- 
kins.  "Then  it  is  a  sham!" 

"A  sham!"  exclaimed  Cyprien.  "Well,  yes!  a  sham! 
But  Jacobus  Vandergaart  and  Nathan  value  it  as  worth 
two  millions  at  the  least,  and  perhaps  four!  Although  it 
is  an  artificial  diamond,  obtained  by  a  process  of  which  I 
am  the  inventor,  it  is  none  the  less  perfectly  authentic! 
You  see,  there  is  nothing  missing — not  even  the  gangue!" 

"And  you  are  going  to  make  other  diamonds  like  it?" 
continued  Watkins. 

"If  I  like.  I  can  make  them  by  the  bushel,  and  I  can 
make  them  ten  times — a  hundred  times — as  large  as  that! 
I  will  make  enough  of  them  to  pave  your  terrace  with — to 
macadamize  the  roads  of  Griqualand  with  if  you  wish! 
It  is  but  the  first  step  that  costs.  Once  the  first  stone  is 


A  SURPRISE  205 

made,  the  rest  is  merely  a  detail — a  simple  affair  of  work- 
ing certain  technical  formulae." 

"But  if  that  is  so,"  gasped  the  miner,  turning  ashy  pale, 
"you  will  ruin  all  the  mine-owners!  You  will  ruin  me! 
You  will  ruin  all  Griqualand  r 

"Certainly!"  replied  Cyprien.  "Who  would  go  grub- 
bing for  little  diamonds  in  the  ground  when  you  can 
manufacture  big  ones  that  will  give  you  a  fortune  in  no 
time?" 

"But  it  is  monstrous!"  exclaimed  Watkins.  "It  is  a 
shame!  it  is  abominable!  If  wKat  you  say  is  true,  if  you 
really  possess  this  secret — " 

He  gasped  for  breath. 

"Well,  you  see,"  said  Cyprien  coldly,  "I  am  not  merely 
talking  about  it;  I  brought  you  my  first  specimen,  and  I 
think  it  is  big  enough  to  convince  you." 

"Well,  then,"  said  Watkins,  who  had  at  last  recovered 
his  breath,  "if  it  is  true — you — you  ought  to  be  shot,  sir! 
That  is  my  opinion!" 

"And  that  is  mine!"  Pantalacci  thought  proper  to  add, 
with  a  threatening  gesture. 

Miss  Watkins  rose,  looking  very  pale. 

"Shot,  because  I  have  solved  a  chemical  problem  that 
men  have  been  trying  for  the  last  fifty  years?"  answered 
the  engineer,  shrugging  his  shoulders.  "That  is  rather 
too  good!" 

"There  is  nothing  to  laugh  at  in  it,  sir!"  replied  the 
furious  farmer.  "Think  of  the  consequences  of  what  you 
call  your  discovery — of  all  the  work  in  the  diggings 
stopped — of  all  Griqualand  deprived  of  its  glorious  in- 
dustry— of  me  reduced  to  beggary!" 

"Well,  I  didn't  think  of  all  that,  I  admit,"  answered 
Cyprien,  very  frankly.  "That  is  the  inevitable  conse- 
quence of  industrial  progress,  and  pure  science  cannot 
stop  to  worry  itself  about  it!  As  to  you  personally,  Mr. 
Watkins,  you  need  not  be  alarmed.  What  is  mine  is 
yours,  and  you  know  very  well  the  motive  I  had  in  work- 
ing out  the  subject." 

Watkins  took  the  hint,  and,  as  he  did  not  want  the 
Italian  to  know  too  much,  suddenly  shifted  his  ground. 
"After  all,"  he  said,  "you  may  be  right,  and  you  speak 
like  the  plucky  fellow  you  are.  Perhaps  we  may  under- 


206  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

stand  each  other  yet.  But  why  do  you  want  to  make  a 
lot  of  diamonds  that  will  soon  make  your  discovery  cheap? 
Why  not  carefully  keep  your  secret,  use  it  with  moderation, 
and  only  make  one  or  two  stones  like  that,  so  as  to  raise 
sufficient  capital,  and  become  the  richest  man  in  these 
parts?  No  one  would  have  anything  to  say  against  you, 
things  would  go  on  as  they  are,  and  you  would  not  have 
to  run  counter  to  all  the  respectable  people  in  the  neigh- 
borhood." 

This  was  a  new  view  of  the  question  that  Cyprien  had 
never  dreamed  of.  There  was  no  mistake  about  the 
dilemma;  either  he  must  keep  his  secret,  leave  the  world 
ignorant  of  it  and  abuse  it  for  his  own  aggrandizement, 
or,  as  Watkins  very  truly  said,  depreciate  at  one  blow  all 
diamonds,  natural  and  artificial,  and  consequently  renounce 
the  fortune.  For  what?  To  ruin  every  miner  in  Griqua- 
land,  India,  and  Brazil! 

With  the  alternative  thus  placed  before  him,  Cyprien 
hesitated,  but  it  was  only  for  an  instant.  He  saw  that  to 
take  the  side  of  sincerity,  honor,  and  fidelity  to  science 
was  to  renounce  the  very  hope  that  had  urged  him  to  the 
discovery. 

The  sorrow  was  as  bitter,  as  poignant  as  it  was  unex- 
pected. To  fall  so  suddenly  from  so  sweet  a  dream! 

"Mr.  Watkins,"  said  he,  gravely,  "if  I  kept  the  secret 
of  my  discovery  to  myself  I  should  be  an  impostor!  I 
should  trade  with  false  weights,  and  deceive  the  public  as 
to  the  quality  of  the  goods.  The  results  obtained  by  the 
man  of  science  do  not  belong  to  him  alone;  they  are  part 
of  the  patrimony  of  us  all.  To  keep  for  himself  in  his 
own  personal  interest  the  smallest  part  of  it  would  be  to 
commit  as  vile  an  act  as  a  man  can  do!  I  will  not  do  it! 
No;  I  will  not  wait  a  week,  nor  a  day,  to  give  to  the 
public  the  formula  which  chance  and  a  little  thought  put 
into  my  power.  My  Only  reservation  will  be  to  give  it 
first  of  all  to  those  who  sent  me  here.  Tomorrow  I  will 
send  the  secret  of  my  process  to  the  Academy  of  Sciences. 
Good-bye,  sir ;  I  thank  you  for  having  taught  me  my  duty. 
Miss  Watkins,  I  was  merely  dreaming;"  and  before  Alice 
could  move  to  stop  him  Cyprien  had  taken  up  his  diamond 
and  gone. 


J.  WATKINS  THINKS  MATTERS  OVER    207 
CHAPTER  X 

JOHN   WATKINS  THINKS   MATTERS  OVER 

CYPRIEN  left  the  farm,  sad  at  heart  but  resolved  to  do 
his  duty.  He  made  his  way  to  Jacobus  Vandergaart.  He 
found  him  alone.  Nathan,  the  broker,  had  gone  off  to  be 
the  first  to  spread  the  news  so  likely  to  interest  the  diggers. 
The  news  did  not  cause  so  much  excitement  as  might  be 
supposed,  for  Nathan  did  not  then  know  that  the  huge 
diamond  was  an  artificial  one. 

Cyprien  had  come  to  old  Vandergaart  to  verify  the 
quality  and  color  of  the  stone  before  drawing  up  his  re- 
port. 

"My  dear  Jacobus,"  said  he,  as  he  sat  down  beside  him, 
"first  cut  a  facet  on  that  boss,  so  that  we  can  see  what  is 
underneath." 

"Nothing  easier,"  said  the  old  lapidary,  taking  the 
pebble  from  him.  "You  have  chosen  a  capital  place," 
added  he,  as  he  noticed  a  slight  swelling  on  one  of  the 
sides  of  the  gem,  which  but  for  it  was  an  almost  perfect 
oval.  "We  shall  risk  nothing  in  cutting  it  here." 

Without  further  delay  Vandergaart  set  to  work.  He 
took  from  his  wooden  bowl  a  common  boort-stone  of 
about  four  or  five  carats,  and  fixed  it  firmly  at  the  end  of 
a  sort  of  handle.  He  then  began  to  rub  together  the  ex- 
terior surfaces  of  the  two  stones. 

"We  could  do  it  more  quickly  by  cleavage,"  said  he; 
"but  who  would  dare  to  amuse  himself  by  hammering  at 
a  gem  of  this  value?" 

The  task  was  a  long  and  monotonous  one.  It  took 
nearly  two  hours.  When  the  facet  was  large  enough  to 
allow  of  the  nature  of  the  stone  being  seen  it  had  to  be 
polished  on  the  wheel,  and  that  also  took  some  time. 

At  last  the  work  was  finished,  and  Cyprien  and  Van-- 
dergaart,  yielding  to  their  curiosity,  took  up  the  diamond 
to  see  the  result. 

A  beautiful  facet  of  the  color  of  jet,  but  of  matchless 
limpidity  and  splendor,  revealed  itself  to  their  view. 

The  diamond  was  black! 

But  this  almost  unique  peculiarity  added  to  rather  than 
diminished  its  value. 


208  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

Vandergaart's  hands  trembled  with  emotion  as  he  flashed 
the  facet  in  the  sunshine. 

"It  is  the  finest  and  most  curious  gem  that  ever  reflected 
the  sunlight,"  said  he,  in  a  tone  of  the  deepest  reverence. 
"What  will  it  be  like  when  we  have  cut  all  its  facets  so 
that  it  can  refract  the  light  as  well  as  reflect  it?" 
"Will  you  undertake  to  do  it?"  asked  Cyprien. 
"Yes,    certainly,  my   boy,  and   the  honor   will    be    the 
crowning  point  of  my  long  career!     But  perhaps  you  had 
better  choose  a  younger  and  firmer  hand  than  mine." 

"No!"  answered  Cyprien.  "Nobody,  I  am  sure,  would 
do  the  work  more  carefully  or  cleverly  than  you !  Take 
the  diamond  and  cut  it  at  your  leisure;  you  will  make  it 
a  masterpiece." 

The  old  man  turned  the  stone  over  and  over  in  his 
fingers,  and  sat  as  if  hesitating  to  tell  what  was  passing 
in  his  mind. 

"One  thing  troubles  me,"  he  said  at  length.  "The 
thought  of  having  under  my  roof  a  jewel  of  such  value. 
Here  is  a  couple  of  millions'  worth  at  the  least  in  the  palm 
of  my  hand.  It  is  not  wise  of  me  to  take  such  a  respon- 
sibility on  myself." 

"None  will  know  of  it  if  you  say  nothing  about  it; 
and,  as  far  as  I  am  concerned,  I  will  not  betray  your 
secret." 

"Perhaps.  But  you  can  be  followed  when  you  come 
here!  Suppose  you  are?  There  are  queer  people  about! 
I  shall  not  sleep  quietly!" 

"Perhaps  you  are  right,"  replied  Cyprien,  as  he  un- 
derstood the  old  man's  hesitation;  "but  what  is  to  be 
done?" 

"That  is  what  I  am  thinking  of,"  said  Vandergaart,  and 
he  remained  silent  for  a  moment  or  so. 
Then  he  continued: 

"Listen,  my  dear  fellow.  What  I  am  going  to  say  is  of 
some  delicacy,  and  presupposes  that  in  me  you  have 
absolute  confidence.  But  you  know  me  well  enough  to 
see  nothing  strange  in  my  suggestion.  I  must  leave  here 
at  once  with  my  tools  and  this  stone,  and  get  out  of  the 
way  into  some  corner  where  I  am  not  known — in  Hope- 
town  or  Bloemfontein,  for  example.  I  will  hire  a  room 


:;'f  T-IT 

:  .  n-i'3d  bj; 

'on  -^d  ^HI 

|  ibifiw 

i 

hrv;  .U-\,  ;A      .ioh(f 

oi-iu-)  nsr.i- 

ili  »niin.  :«i  aril  rii  u 


THE  SOUTH 
•tawKi-  'ii  emotion 


)£  the  cK 
have  cut  all  il 
s  well  as  reflect 
1  asked  Cyprien. 

honor   will    be    the 
perhaps  you  had 
than  mine/' 

re,  would 

THE  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH. 

It  was  a  great  day  when  the  experiment  was  completed.  For  two 
weeks  the  fire  had  been  allowed  to  die  out,  so  that  the  apparatus  might 
gradually  cool.  Cyprien,  considering  that  the  crystallization  of  the 
carbon  ought  by  now  to  have  been  effected,  resolved  to  open  the  mound 
which  covered  the  furnace. 

This  was  no  easy  matter.  The  pickaxes  had  all  their  work  to  do  to 
cut  their  way  through  the  baked  earth.  It  had  been  hardened  like  a 
brick.  At  length  it  yielded  to  the  attacks  of  Mataki,  and  the  upper 
part  of  the  furnace,  the  capital,  so  to  s^eak,  was  visible.  Then  the 
whole  furnace  was  revealed  to  view.  *  *  *  * 

He  was  about  to  leave  the  spot  in  despair,  when  curiosity  led  him 
to  hold  a  match  at  the  gap  in  the  tube,  so  as  to  examine  the  interior. — 
Pages  200,  201. 

ig  about  it; 
ncerned,   I  will  not  betray  your 

LI  can  be  f  when  you  come 

There  are  queer  people  about! 

u   are   right,"    replied   Cyprien,    a 
old   man's  hesitation;   "but   what 

vhat  I  am  thinking  of,"  said  Van* 


What  I 
presupposes  tl 
"But  yor 

Vol.  13. 


J.  WATKINS  THINKS  MATTERS  OVER    209 

and  there  work  in  secret,  and  only  return  when  my  work 
is  done.  In  that  way  I  may  perhaps  out-manoeuvre  these 
rascals.  But,  I  repeat,  I  am  very  shy  of  proposing  such  a 
plan  to  you — " 

"But  it  is  a  very  good  one,"  interrupted  Cyprien,  "and 
I  shall  be  very  glad  if  you  will  start  on  it." 

"I  shall  want  at  least  a  month,  and  all  sorts  of  accidents 
may  happen  to  me  on  the  road." 

"Never  mind,  if  you  think  it  is  all  right.  And  after 
all,  if  the  diamond  does  go  it  does  not  much  matter." 

Vandergaart  looked  at  his  young  friend  as  if  he  were 
horror-stricken.  "Has  such  a  stroke  of  luck  bereft  him 
of  reason?"  asked  he  of  himself. 

Cyprien  divined  his  thoughts,  and  smiled  to  himself. 
Then  he  explained  to  him  whence  the  diamond  had  come, 
and  how,  if  he  liked,  he  could  make  many  more.  But  the 
old  lapidary — whether  it  was  that  he  hardly  believed  the 
story,  or  that  he  did  not  care  to  be  left  alone  with  a  jewel 
of  such  price — all  the  time  busied  himself  in  his  prepara- 
tions for  starting. 

Putting  his  tools  and  his  clothes  in  an  old  leather  bag, 
Vandergaart  stuck  on  his  door  a  notice  to  the  effect  that 
he  was  "away  on  business,"  put  the  key  in  his  pocket  and 
the  diamond  in  his  waistcoat,  and  set  out. 

Cyprien  accompanied  him  for  a  mile  or  two  on  the  road 
to  Bloemfontein.  It  was  night  when  the  engineer  re- 
turned, thinking  perhaps  more  of  Miss  Watkins  than  of 
his  wonderful  discovery. 

However,  having  done  but  scant  justice  to  the  dinner 
Mataki  had  prepared,  he  sat  himself  down  at  his  writing- 
table  and  began  the  report  he  intended  to  send  off  by 
next  mail  to  the  Academy  of  Sciences.  It  consisted  of  a 
detailed  account  of  his  experiment,  and  a  highly  ingenious 
theory  of  the  reaction  which  had  given  birth  to  this  mag- 
nificent carbon  crystal. 

"Its  most  remarkable  characteristic,"  wrote  he,  "is  its 
complete  identity  with  the  natural  diamond,  and  more 
especially  its  possession  of  a  gangue." 

And  Cyprien  did  not  hesitate  to  attribute  this  curious 
result  to  the  care  with  which  he  had  coated  his  apparatus 
with  the  earth  from  Vandergaart  Kopje.  The  mode  in 
which  a  portion  of  this  earth  had  detached  itself  from  the 

Vol.  13  Verne 


210  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

rest  and  formed  a  coating  around  the  crystal  was  not  very 
easy  to  explain,  but  this  was  a  point  on  which  further 
experiments  would  doubtless  throw  some  light.  It  was 
possible  that  he  had  discovered  a  new  phenomenon  of  chem- 
ical affinity,  and  he  proposed  to  carefully  work  out  the 
subject.  He  did  not  attempt  to  commit  himself  straight 
off  to  a  complete  theory  of  his  discovery.  His  object 
was  rather  to  communicate  the  news  without  delay  to  the 
scientific  world,  and  to  invite  discussion  on  these  hitherto 
obscure  and  unexplained  facts. 

Having  made  good  progress  in  his  memoir,  and  ad- 
vanced it  so  far  that  only  a  few  additional  observations 
were  required  for  its  completion,  he  sat  down  to  supper, 
and  then  went  to  bed. 

In  the  morning  he  went  for  a  walk  among  the  dig- 
gings. The  greeting  he  received  was  hardly  as  friendly 
as  it  might  have  been  but  this  he  did  not  notice.  He  had 
forgotten  all  the  consequences  of  his  grand  discovery  as 
unfolded  the  evening  before  by  John  Watkins — that  is 
to  say,  the  ruin  sooner  or  later  of  the  Griqualand  claims 
and  their  owners.  This  was  enough,  however,  to  make 
a  man  uneasy  in  a  semi-civilized  country,  whose  peo- 
ple never  hesitated  to  take  the  law  into  their  own  hands 
when  the  whim  seized  them.  If  the  manufacture  of  the 
diamond  was  to  become  a  trade,  the  millions  invested  in 
the  Brazilian  as  well  as  the  South  African  mines  would 
irrevocably  be  lost.  Most  assuredly  the  young  engineer 
would  have  done  wisely  to  have  kept  his  secret.  But  his 
resolution  had  been  distinctly  declared,  and  he  had  decided 
to  act  otherwise. 

On  the  other  hand,  during  the  night — a  night  of  torpor, 
during  which  Watkins  dreamed  of  diamonds  by  the  score, 
worth  millions  apiece — Alice's  father  had  had  time  to 
consider.  And  his  thoughts  ran  in  this  wise. 

Nothing  could  be  more  natural  than  that  Annibale  Pan- 
taJacci  and  the  other  diggers  should  view  with  anger 
and  anxiety  the  revolution  which  Cyprien's  discovery  would 
effect.  But  for  him,  merely  as  the  owner  of  Watkins' 
Farm,  the  situation  was  somewhat  different.  If  the 
claims  were  abandoned  owing  to  the  depreciation  of  the 
gems,  if  the  whole  mining  population  were  to  clear  out 


J.  WATKINS  THINKS  MATTERS  OVER     211 

from  the  Griqualand  fields,  the  value  of  his  farm  would 
seriously  diminish,  his  crops  would  not  find  buyers,  his 
houses  and  huts  would  not  let  for  want  of  tenants,  and 
some  day  he  might  have  to  bid  farewell  to  so  poor  a 
district. 

"Good,"  said  Watkins  to  himself,  "but  some  years  will 
have  to  elapse  before  then.  Diamond-making-  has  not 
yet  reached  a  practical  stage,  notwithstanding  Mr.  Cyprien. 
There  may  be  a  good  deal  of  chance  about  it.  But,  chance 
or  not,  he  has  at  least  made  a  stone  of  enormous  value, 
and  if  a  natural  diamond  is  worth  so  much,  an  artificial 
one  under  such  circumstances  is  worth  considerably  more! 
Yes,  we -must  keep  our  eyes  on  this  young  man.  At  any 
rate,  we  must  stop  him  from  proclaiming  his  proceedings 
on  the  housetops.  The  stone  must  come  into  our  family, 
and  must  not  leave  it  unless  handsomely  paid  for.  To 
keep  the  maker  of  it  is  easy  enough,  even  without  com- 
mitting ourselves  too  deeply.  Alice  is  there,  and  by  means 
of  Alice  I  can  put  the  stopper  on  his  going  to  Europe. 
Yes;  I  can  promise  he  shall  marry  her.  I  can  even  let 
him  marry  her." 

Thus  thought  Watkins.  Hither  did  his  avarice  lead 
him.  Throughout  he  thought  only  of  himself,  he  saw  only 
himself.  And  if  the  old  egotist  gave  a  thought  to  his 
child,  it  was  only  to  say,  "And  after  all,  Alice  has  nothing 
to  complain  of.  The  young  fool  is  not  so  bad  in  his 
way.  He  loves  her,  and  I  fancy  she  is  not  indifferent  to 
him.  What  can  be  better  than  to  unite  two  hearts  that 
have  been  made  for  each  other — or  rather  to  let  them  hope 
for  the  union,  which  need  not  take  place  until  matters 
have  shaped  somewhat?" 

So  reasoned  Watkins,  pitting  his  daughter's  happiness 
against  that  little  piece  of  crystallized  carbon,  and  expect- 
ing he  could  keep  the  scales  level.  And  in  the  morning 
he  had  made  up  his  mind.  He  would  see  how  things 
turned  out,  and  act  accordingly. 

In  the  first  place  he  wished  to  see  his  tenant  again. 
Nothing  could  be  easier,  for  the  engineer  came  to  the 
farm  every  day.  In  the  second  place  he  longed  to  gaze 
once  more  on  the  diamond  that  had  assumed  such  fabulous 
proportions  in  his  dreams.  The  second  was  if  anything 


212  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

the  greater  attraction,  and  so  Watkins  strolled  down  to 
the  laboratory.     Cyprien  was  at  home. 

"Well,  my  young  friend,"  said  he,  most  genially,  "and 
how  have  you  passed  the  night,  the  first  night  after  your 
grand  discovery  ?" 

"Very  well,  Mr.  Watkins,  very  well,  thank  you,"  was 
the  frigid  reply. 

"What!  you  went  to  sleep?" 

"I  did      As  usual." 

"All  the  millions,"  continued  Watkins,  "all  the  millions 
you  have  been  making — did  not  the  thought  of  them  keep 
you  awake?" 

"Not  at  all,"  replied  Cyprien.  "Don't  you  see,  Mr. 
Watkins,  that  the  diamond  is  only  worth  millions  when  it 
is  nature's  work.  A  chemist's  diamond — " 

"Yes,  yes,  Mr.  Cyprien !  But  are  you  sure  you  can  make 
another  ? — many  others  ?" 

Cyprien  hesitated.  He  knew  well  that  in  such  an  ex- 
periment something  might  happen  to  prevent  his  at- 
taining a  similar  result. 

"Ah!  you  twig!"  continued  Watkins.  "You  won't  an- 
swer. Until  you  have  scored  again  your  diamond  will 
retain  its  value.  Until  then,  why  should  you  say  it  is  an 
artificial  stone?" 

"I  repeat,  Mr.  Watkins,  that  it  is  out  of  my  power  to 
retain  so  important  a  scientific  secret " 

"Yes,  yes,  I  know,"  continued  Watkins,  with  a  gesture 
to  the  engineer  not  to  speak  so  loudly,  as  people  outside 
might  hear  him.  "We  will  talk  about  that.  Never  you 
fear  Pantalacci  and  his  lot ;  they  won't  tell  of  you ;  it  is  not 
their  interest  to  do  so.  Take  my  word  for  it.  And  look 
here.  Alice  and  I  are  overjoyed  at  your  success.  We 
are  really.  Yes!  Can  I  have  a  look  at  the  diamond?  I 
hardly  had  time  to  examine  it  yesterday.  Will  you  allow 
me?" 

"I  haven't  got  it  now,"  answered  Cyprien. 

"You  have  sent  it  to  France !"  exclaimed  Watkins  aghast 
at  the  thought. 

"No,  not  yet.  In  its  rough  state  no  one  could  judge  of 
its  beauty." 

"Who  have  you  given  it  to,  then?" 

"I  gave  it  to  Jacobus  Vandergaart  to  cut,  and  I  have 


J.  WATKINS  THINKS  MATTERS  OVER     213 

not  the    slightest  idea    where  he    has    gone    to  with    it." 

"You  trusted  a  diamond  like  that  to  that  old  lunatic!" 
exclaimed  Watkins,  perfectly  furious.  "You  must  be  mad, 
sir!  stark,  staring  mad,  sir!" 

"Bosh!"  answered  Cyprien.  "What  does  it  matter  what 
Vandergaart  does  with  it?  How  could  he  get  rid  of 
a  stone  worth  so  many  millions?  Do  you  think  he  could 
sell  it  on  the  quiet?" 

Watkins  seemed  struck  with  the  argument.  It  would 
evidently  be  rather  a  difficult  matter  to  dispose  of  so  valu- 
able a  stone.  Nevertheless,  the  farmer  was  uneasy,  and 
he  would  have  given  a  good  deal  to  prevent  Cyprien  hand- 
ing over  the  jewel  to  the  old  lapidary,  or  rather  to  make 
the  old  lapidary  bring  it  back  again  immediately. 

But  Vandergaart  had  demanded  a  month,  and  the  im- 
patient Watkins  had  to  wait. 

Of  course  his  cronies,  Pantalacci,  Friedel,  and  their 
companions,  said  all  they  could  against  the  character  of 
the  honest  old  lapidary.  In  Cyprien's  absence  they  had  a 
good  deal  to  say  about  him,  and  invariably  remarked  to 
Watkins  that  the  month  was  nearly  up  and  no  Vandergaart 
had  put  in  an  appearance. 

"And  why,"  said  Friedel,  "should  he  return  to  Griqua- 
land?  Why  shouldn't  he  keep  the  diamond  of  large  value 
whose  artificial  origin  is  nowhere  shown?" 

"Because  he  would  never  find  a  buyer,"  answered  Wat- 
kins,  reproducing  Cyprien's  argument. 

"That  is  a  fine  reason!" 

"A  very  fine  reason,"  said  Pantalacci.  "And  believe  me, 
at  this  very  moment  the  old  crocodile  is  hundreds  of 
miles  away.  Nothing  could  be  easier  than  to  doctor  the 
stone  so  as  to  make  it  unrecognizable.  You  don't  even 
know  what  its  color  is!  What  is  to  hinder  him  from 
cutting  it  into  five  or  six  pieces  and  making  a  batch  of 
good-sized  stones  ?"  / 

Greatly  was  the  soul  of  Watkins  troubled  by  these 
discussions.  He  began  to  think  that  Vandergaart  would 
never  come  back.  Cyprien  alone  believed  in  the  old  man's 
honesty,  and  declared  that  he  would  return  on  the  day  he 
had  said.  He  was  right. 

Vandergaart  returned  twenty-four  hours  before  his  time. 
Such  had  been  his  diligence,  and  so  well  had  he  worked, 


214  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

that  in  twenty-seven  days  he  had  cut  the  stone.  He  came 
back  during  the  night  to  polish  it  on  the  wheel,  worked  at 
it  till  he  had  done,  and  in  the  morning  of  the  twenty-ninth 
day  Cyprien  beheld  him  enter  the  door  of  the  laboratory. 

"There  is  your  pebble/'  was  all  that  the  old  lapidary 
said  as  he  placed  a  small  wooden  box  on  the  table. 

Cyprien  opened  the  box  and  stood  dazzled  and  motion- 
less. On  a  pad  of  white  cotton  wool  lay  an  enormous 
black  crystal  of  the  shape  of  a  rhomboidal  dodecahedron. 
From  it  streamed  forth  prismatic  fires  of  such  brilliancy  as 
to  light  up  the  whole  laboratory.  The  combination  of 
ink-like  color  with  absolutely  perfect  adamantine  transpar- 
ency and  wondrous  refractive  power  gave  the  most  start- 
ling results  conceivable. 

It  seemed  as  though  he  was  in  the  presence  of  some 
unique  phenomenon,  of  some  unprecedented  freak  of 
nature.  All  idea  of  value  apart,  the  splendor  of  the  jewel 
was  something  to  marvel  at. 

"It  is  not  only  the  largest,  it  is  the  most  beautiful 
diamond  in  the  world,"  said  Vandergaart,  with  great 
gravity  and  in  a  tone  of  paternal  pride.  "It  weighs  four 
hundred  and  thirty-two  carats!  You  have  made  some- 
thing to  be  proud  of,  my  friend.  Your  prentice  hand  has 
made  a  masterpiece." 

Cyprien  gave  no  reply  to  the  old  lapidary's  compliments. 
In  his  own  eyes  he  was  but  the  author  of  a  curious  dis- 
covery, nothing  more.  Many  others  in  the  chemical  field 
had  failed  where  he  had  succeeded,  it  is  true.  But  what 
use  to  humanity  would  be  this  manufacture  of  artificial 
diamonds?  In  the  future  it  would  inevitably  ruin  all  who 
earn  their  living  by  trading  in  precious  stones,  and  would 
enrich  nobody. 

Then  he  thought  of  his  elation  during  the  first  few 
hours  after  his  discovery.  Now  the  diamond,  beautiful 
as  it  had  come  from  Vandergaart's  hands,  appeared  to  him 
but  as  a  worthless  stone,  to  which  even  the  prestige  of 
rarity  would  not  long  remain. 

Cyprien  closed  the  box,  and  shaking  hands  with  his  old 
friend,  hastened  off  to  Watkins  Farm. 

The  farmer  was  in  the  lower  room,  anxious  and  uneasy, 
and  thinking  of  the  doubtful  chance  of  Vandergaart's 


J.  WATKINS  THINKS  MATTERS  OVER     215 

returning.  His  daughter  was  with  him  doing  her  best  to 
allay  his  suspicions. 

Cyprien  opened  the  door  and  stood  for  an  instant  on 
the  threshold. 

"Well?"  asked  Watkins  sharply,  as  he  suddenly  rose 
from  his  chair. 

"Well,  honest  Jacobus  Vandergaart  came  back  this 
morning,"  answered  Cyprien. 

"With  the  diamond?" 

"With  the  diamond  beautifully  cut,  and  it  even  now 
weighs  four  hundred  and  thirty-two  carats." 

"Four  hundred  and  thirty-two  carats!"  exclaimed  Wat- 
kins.  "And  you  have  brought  it  with  you?" 

"Here-  it  is." 

The  farmer  took  the  box.  He  opened  it,  and  his  eyes 
sparkled  almost  as  much  as  the  diamond  he  looked  at. 
Then  when  his  fingers  were  allowed  to  close  on  the 
splendid  crystal,  he  was  so  carried  away  with  the  thoughts 
of  its  colossal  value  that  his  excitement  became  quite 
laughable. 

Tears  came  into  his  eyes,  and  he  spoke  to  the  gem  as  if 
it  were  some  cherished  friend. 

"Oh!  You  love!  You  superb,  you  splendid  stone!  Here 
you  are  back  again,  my  beauty!  You  are  magnificent! 
You  are  a  weight!  How  much  are  you  worth  in  golden 
sovereigns?  What  shall  we  do  with  you,  my  darling? 
Send  you  to  the  Cape  and  on  to  London  to  be  seen  and 
admired?  But  who  will  be  rich  enough  to  buy  you?  The 
Queen  herself  could  not  afford  so  great  a  luxury!  You 
would  take  two  or  three  years  of  her  income!  She  would 
want  a  Parliamentary  vote!  A  national  subscription!  And 
they'll  do  it,  never  fear!  And  you'll  go  to  the  Tower  of 
London  and  sleep  by  the  Kohinoor,  who  is  but  a  very  little 
chap  by  the  side  of  you.  What  are  we  to  value  you  at, 
my  pet?" 

And  then,  betaking  himself  to  his  mental  arithmetic,  he 
continued : 

"For  the  Czar's  diamond  Catherine  II.  paid  a  million 
roubles  and  an  annuity  of  four  thousand  pounds.  Surely 
you  are  worth  a  million  sterling,  cash  down,  and  twenty 
thousand  a  year  for  ever  afterward." 

Then,  struck  with  the  sudden  idea: 


216  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

"Should  not  the  owner  of  such  a  jewel  be  raised  to  the 
peerage?  Look  here,  Alice!  Two  eyes  are  not  enough  to 
admire  this  with!" 

For  the  first  time  in  her  life  Miss  Watkins  looked  at  a 
diamond  with  some  interest. 

"It  is  really  very  beautiful.  It  glows  like  the  piece  of 
carbon  that  it  is,  but  like  the  carbon  when  it  is  alight," 
said  she,  as  she  carefully  picked  it  up. 

Then,  by  an  instinctive  movement,  that  every  girl  in  her 
place  would  have  had,  she  turned  to  the  looking-glass  and 
held  the  jewel  to  her  forehead. 

"A  star  set  in  gold!"  said  Cyprien  gallantly. 

"True.  We'll  call  it  a  star!"  exclaimed  Alice.  "Let  us 
christen  it  the  Star  of  the  South.  What  do  you  say, 
Mr.  Cyprien?  Is  it  not  as  black  as  our  native  beauties 
and  as  brilliant  as  the  constellations  of  our  southern  sky?" 

"Never  mind  the  Star  of  the  South,"  said  Watkins, 
who  attached  but  little  importance  to  a  name,  "but 
take  care  you  don't  drop  it,  it  will  break  like  glass." 

"Indeed!  Is  it  as  fragile  as  that?"  answered  Alice, 
scornfully  replacing  the  gem  in  its  box.  "Poor  star!  you 
are  only  a  mockery — a  vulgar  bottle-stopper!" 

"A  bottle-stopper!"  exclaimed  Watkins,  almost  choked 
with  horror.  "You  young  people  respect  nothing!" 

"Miss  Alice,"  said  the  engineer,  "it  was  you  who  en- 
couraged me  to  take  up  artificial  diamond-making.  It 
is  owing  to  you  that  this  stone  now  exists;  and  your 
father  will  allow  me,  I  hope,  to  offer  it  to  you  in  remem- 
brance of  your  happy  influence  on  my  work!" 

"What !"  exclaimed  the  farmer  unable  to  hide  his  delight 
at  so  unexpected  an  offer. 

"Alice,"  continued  Cyprien,  "the  diamond  is  yours.  If 
you  will  accept  it,  I  give  it!"  and  Miss  Watkins,  as  her 
only  reply,  held  out  her  hand  to  him,  and  he  gently  clasped 
it  in  his  own. 


THE  STAR  DISAPPEARS  217 


CHAPTER  XI 

THE  STAR  DISAPPEARS 

THE  news  of  Vandergaart's  return  promptly  spread. 
Visitors  to  the  farm  soon  began  to  arrive  in  crowds  to 
gaze  upon  the  wonder  of  the  kopje.  They  were  not  long 
in  learning  that  the  diamond  belonged  to  Miss  Watkins, 
and  that  her  father  was  its  real  owner.  Hence  a  con- 
siderable increase  in  the  public  excitement. 

It  may  be  mentioned  that  the  artificial  origin  of  the 
stone  had  been  kept  very  quiet.  The  Griqualand  miners 
were  not  so  ill-advised  as  to  noise  abroad  a  secret  that 
might .  ruin  them.  And  Cyprien,  unwilling  to  trust  to 
chance,  had  made  up  his  mind  to  say  nothing  and  to  keep 
back  his  memoir  until  by  a  second  experiment  he  had 
verified  his  facts.  What  he  had  done  once  he  wished  to 
be  sure  he  could  do  again. 

Public  curiosity,  then,  was  highly  excited,  and  John 
Watkins  could  not  with  decency  decline  to  gratify  it. 
Greatly  was  his  vanity  flattered.  He  laid  the  Star  on  a 
pad  of  cotton  wool,  and  placed  it  on  the  top  of  a  small 
white  marble  column  in  the  center  of  the  mantelpiece  in 
his  parlor.  There  the  whole  day  long  did  he  remain 
seated  in  his  arm-chair,  admiring  the  incomparable  jewel 
and  exhibiting  it  to  the  public  view. 

James  Hilton  was  the  first  to  throw  out  a  hint  as  to  the 
imprudence  of  these  proceedings.  Had  Watkins  thought 
of  the  danger  he  was  running  in  exhibiting  to  all  comers  a 
gem  of  such  value?  Ought  he  not  immediately  to  send  off 
to  Kimberley  for  a  special  police  guard  ?  That  very  night, 
perhaps,  might  not  pass  without  something  occurring. 

Watkins  was  rather  scared  at  these  warnings.  He  has- 
tened to  follow  the  judicious  advice,  and  breathed  very 
much  more  freely  when  toward  evening  a  squadron  of 
mounted  police  put  in  an  appearance.  These  twenty-five 
men  were  put  up  in  the  outhouses  of  the  farm. 

The  crowds  could  not  but  increase  during  the  following 
days,  and  the  fame  of  the  Star  of  the  South  extended 
beyond  the  boundaries  of  the  district  to  the  most  distant 
towns.  The  colonial  journals  devoted  article  upon  article 
to  its  dimensions,  its  figure,  its  color,  and  its  brilliancy. 


218  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

The  telegraph  cable  from  Durban  carried  its  details  by 
way  of  Zanzibar  and  Aden  to  Europe  and  Asia,  and  on  to 
America  and  Australasia.  Photographers  begged  to  be 
allowed  to  take  the  portrait  of  the  marvelous  gem;  special 
artists  came  from  the  illustrated  journals  to  reproduce  its 
image ;  in  fact,  the  event  became  of  world-wide  celebrity. 

And  of  course  legend  began  to  weave  its  web  round  the 
stone.  Stories  began  to  circulate  among  the  miners  of  its 
mysterious  properties.  With  bated  breath  they  told  how 
a  black  stone  must  necessarily  bring  bad  luck.  Practical 
men  shook  their  heads,  and  vowed  they  would  rather 
Watkins  had  the  stone  than  they.  In  short,  calumny,  with- 
out which  celebrity  cannot  exist,  did  its  unenviable  duty 
with  the  Star  of  the  South,  and  the  Star  very  naturally  was 
in  no  way  troubled  thereby,  but  continued  to  pour  forth 
its  brilliant  rays  on  its  obscure  detractors. 

Watkins,  however,  was  much  more  sensitive  to  them. 
The  gossip  exasperated  him.  It  seemed  as  though  it 
depreciated  the  value  of  the  stone,  and  he  resented  it  as  a 
personal  insult.  When  the  governor  of  the  colony,  the 
officers  of  the  neighboring  garrisons,  the  magistrates  and 
all  the  high  functionaries  had  done  homage  to  his  jewel,  it 
seemed  to  him  that  such  depreciatory  comment  was  little 
less  than  sacrilege. 

To  create  a  reaction  against  this  silly  trash  and  to 
gratify  his  weakness  for  the  pleasures  of  the  table  he 
resolved  to  give  a  grand  banquet  in  honor  of  his  cherished 
diamond,  which,  notwithstanding  what  Cyprien  had  said 
and  Alice  wished,  he  still  dreamed  of  converting  into 
coin. 

Such,  alas!  is  the  influence  of  the  stomach  on  the 
feelings  of  many  men,  that  the  mere  announcement  of  the 
dinner  effected  quite  a  revolution  in  the  opinion  of  Van- 
dergaart  Kopje.  Those  who  had  been  most  conspicuous  in 
maligning  the  Star  now  changed  their  game,  and  confessed 
that  after  all  the  stone  was  innocent  of  the  noxious  in- 
fluences they  had  ascribed  to  it,  and  that  an  invitation 
from  Mr.  Watkins  would  be  thankfully  received. 

Long  will  the  fame  of  that  dinner  continue.  Eighty 
guests  sat  down  in  a  tent  pitched  along  one  side  of  the 
parlor,  the  wall  of  which  had  been  removed  for  the 
occasion.  A  baron  of  beef  occupied  the  center  of  the  table, 


THE  STAR  DISAPPEARS  219 

and  around  it  were  samples  of  all  the  game  in  the  district. 
Mountains  of  vegetables  and  fruit,  and  gallons  of  beer  and 
wine,  were  the  chief  features  of  this  truly  pantagruelian 
repast. 

The  Star  of  the  South,  placed  on  its  pedestal  and  begirt 
with  lighted  candles,  presided  behind  John  Watkins,  at 
the  festival  given  in  its  honor. 

Twenty  Kaffirs  officiated  as  waiters  under  the  directions 
of  Mataki,  who  was  loaned  by  his  master  for  the  occasion. 

Besides  the  police,  of  whose  services  Mr.  Watkins  thus 
showed  his  appreciation,  there  were  present  all  the  chief 
personages  of  the  camp  and  its  neighborhood.  Mathys 
Pretorius  was  there,  and  so  were  Nathan,  James  Hilton, 
Pantalacci,  Friedel,  Steel,  and  fifty  others. 

And  even  the  dogs — and,  above  all,  the  ostriches — took 
part  in  the  festivities  and  came  in  to  beg  during  the  meal. 

Alice  took  the  end  of  the  table  opposite  to  her  father, 
and  did  the  honors  with  her  accustomed  grace,  but  not 
without  secret  chagrin,  for  neither  Cyprien  nor  Vander- 
gaart  was  present,  and  she  well  knew  the  motives  of  their 
abstention. 

The  engineer  had  from  the  first  avoided  as  much  as 
possible  the  society  of  Friedel,  Pantalacci,  and  their 
particular  friends;  and  now,  since  his  discovery,  he  was 
well  aware  of  their  anything  but  good  wishes  toward  him, 
and  even  of  their  threats  against  the  inventor  of  the 
process  that  would  eventually  ruin  them.  He  therefore 
excused  himself  from  appearing  at  the  dinner.  To  Vander- 
gaart,  Watkins  had  made  the  most  urgent  offers  of  recon- 
ciliation, but  the  old  lapidary  had  rejected  them  with 
scorn. 

The  banquet  approached  its  end.  Thanks  to  Alice's 
presence,  the  boisterous  spirits  of  the  diners  had  been 
happily  somewhat  restrained.  Watkins  arose,  rested  both 
hands  on  the  tablecloth,  and  began  the  speech  of  the 
occasion. 

"This  day,"  he  said,  "is  the  greatest  day  of  my  colonial 
life.  After  the  trials  and  struggles  of  my  youth,  to  see 
myself  here  in  wealthy  Griqualand,  surrounded  by  eighty 
friends  assembled  to  do  honor  to  the  greatest  diamond 
in  the  world,  is  a  pleasure  I  shall  never  forget.  It  is  true 
that  tomorrow  one  of  our  honorable  friends  may  find  a 


220  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

bigger  stone.  That  is  the  beauty  and  poetry  of  a  digger's 
life!  (Cheers.)  I  wish  you  may  have  such  luck!  (Laugh- 
ter and  cheers.)  I  do  not  hesitate  to  affirm  that  it  would 
be  difficult  to  satisfy  the  man  who  in  my  place  would  not 
declare  himself  satisfied.  But  to  conclude,  I  invite  you 
all  to  drink  to  the  prosperity  of  Griqualand  and  a  rising 
diamond  market — notwithstanding  all  that  may  have  hap- 
pened— and  a  happy  voyage  to  the  Star  of  the  South  down 
the  country,  around  the  Cape,  and  home,  I  hope,  to  Eng- 
land." 

"But,"  said  Steel,  "won't  there  be  some  danger  in  send- 
ing a  stone  of  such  value  down  to  the  Cape?" 

"Oh,  it  will  be  strongly  escorted!"  replied  Watkins. 
"Lots  of  diamonds  have  gone  the  same  road  in  safety." 

"Even  that  of  Durieux  de  Sancy,"  said  Alice ;  "although, 
had  it  not  been  for  the  servant's  devotion — " 

"Eh!"  said  Hilton;  "what  was  that?" 

"The  anecdote  runs,"  said  Alice,  "that  De  Sancy  was  a 
French  gentleman  of  the  Court  of  Henry  III.  He  owned 
a  famous  diamond,  still  called  after  him.  The  diamond 
had  already  been  through  some  remarkable  adventures. 
It  had  belonged  to  Charles  the  Bold,  and  he  was  wearing 
it  when  he  was  killed  under  the  walls  of  Nancy.  A  Swiss 
soldier  found  it  on  the  Duke  of  Burgundy's  corpse,  and 
sold  it  for  a  florin  to  a  poor  priest,  who  parted  with  it  for 
five  or  six  florins  to  a  Jew.  At  the  time  it  belonged  to 
De  Sancy  the  royal  treasury  was  in  difficulties,  and  he 
consented  to  put  the  stone  in  pawn  to  raise  funds  for  the 
king.  The  money-lender  at  the  time  was  at  Metz,  and 
De  Sancy  entrusted  the  jewel  to  one  of  his  servants  to 
take  it  there.  'Are  you  not  afraid  that  the  man  will  run 
away  with  it  to  England?'  people  asked.  'I  am  sure  of 
him!'  was  the  answer.  In  spite  of  this  assurance  neither 
the  man  nor  the  diamond  arrived  at  Metz,  and  the  court 
made  great  fun  of  De  Sancy.  'I  am  sure  of  my  servant/ 
he  persisted.  'He  must  have  been  assassinated!'  And 
in  fact,  when  a  search  was  made,  the  man's  body  was 
found  in  a  ditch  by  the  roadside.  'Cut  him  open!'  said 
De  Sancy ;  'the  diamond  ought  to  be  in  his  stomach !'  They 
did  as  he  ordered,  and  it  was  found  to  be  so.  The  humble 
hero,  whose  name  is  unknown  to  history,  had  been  faithful 
to  death  to  his  duty  and  honor,  'outshining,'  as  the  old 


THE  STAR  DISAPPEARS  221 

chronicler  says,  'by  the  splendor  of  his  deeds  the  splendor 
of  the  jewel  he  carried!'  I  shall  be  very  much  surprised," 
said  Alice,  as  she  concluded  her  story,  "if  the  Star  of  the 
South  does  not  inspire  some  similar  instance  of  devotion 
during  its  travels." 

The  sentiment  was  received  with  loud  acclamation, 
eighty  arms  lifted  high  an  equal  number  of  glasses,  and 
all  eyes  turned  instinctively  to  the  mantelpiece  to  render 
homage  to  the  incomparable  gem. 

The  Star  had  disappeared! 

The  astonishment  on  the  eighty  faces  was  so  manifest 
that  the  host  turned  sharply  around  to  see  what  was  the 
matter. 

He  fell  back  in  his  chair  as  if  thunderstruck. 

They  crowded  around  him,  loosened  his  cravat,  dashed 
cold  water  over  his  face — and  he  soon  came  to. 

"The  diamond!"  he  roared.  "The  diamond!  Who  has 
taken  the  diamond?" 

"See  that  no  one  leaves  the  room,"  said  the  chief  of  the 
police,  ordering  his  men  to  the  doors. 

The  guests  looked  at  each  other  in  dismay,  or  spoke  in 
whispers.  Not  five  minutes  before  all  of  them  saw,  or 
thought  they  saw,  the  diamond  in  its  place. 

"I  propose  we  shall  all  be  searched  before  we  leave 
the  room,"  said  Steel  with  his  usual  frankness. 

"Yes!  yes!"  replied  the  company,  seemingly  unanimous. 

The  suggestion  gave  Watkins  a  ray  of  hope. 

The  police  officer  drew  up  the  guests  along  one  side  of 
the  room  and  began  to  search  himself  to  begin  with.  He 
turned  out  his  pockets,  took  off  his  boots,  and  patted  his 
clothes  in  the  customary  professional  manner.  Then  he 
proceeded  to  search  the  guests  in  similar  fashion,  and  then 
one  by  one  they  passed  before  him  and  were  subjected  to 
a  more  minute  examination. 

The  investigation  produced  no  result. 

Every  nook  and  cranny  in  the  place  was  then  carefully 
pried  into.  Not  a  trace  of  the  diamond  was  discovered. 

"There  are  the  Kaffirs  who  were  waiting  on  us!"  said 
the  police  officer,  who  did  not  yet  like  to  own  himself  de- 
feated. 

"That  is  so!"  was  the  reply.  "The  Kaffirs  are  quite 
thieves  enough  to  have  done  it!" 


222  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

The  waiters  had,  however,  gone  out  just  as  Watkins 
began  his  speech,  and  were  now  grouped  around  a  fire  out- 
side, making  merry  with  the  scraps  of  the  meal  that  had 
been  reserved  for  them.  Their  guitars  made  out  of  cala- 
bashes, flutes  blown  by  the  nose,  and  tom-toms  of  different 
kinds,  had  already  commenced  that  deafening  cacophony 
which  precedes  the  musical  manifestations  of  the  natives 
of  South  Africa.  The  Kaffirs  hardly  knew  what  to  make 
of  it  when  they  were  brought  back  and  searched  in  their 
scanty  garments.  And  the  search  was  as  useless  as  all  that 
had  gone  before. 

"If  the  thief  is  one  of  the  Kaffirs— and  he  ought  to  be — 
he  has  had  quite  time  enough  to  clear  off,"  remarked  one  of 
the  guests,  very  sensibly. 

"That  is  so,"  said  the  police  officer;  "and  there  is 
perhaps  only  one  way  of  finding  him  out,  and  that  is  to 
apply  to  one  of  the  native  medicine-men.  That  might  suc- 
ceed—" 

"If  you  will  let  me,"  said  Mataki,   "I  will  try." 

The  offer  was  immediately  accepted.  The  guests  formed 
a  circle  around  the  natives,  and  Mataki,  thoroughly  accus- 
tomed to  the  work,  began  the  ceremony. 

He  first  breathed  upon  two  or  three  pinches  of  tobacco, 
which  he  took  from  his  pouch,  and  said: 

"I  will  now  try  the  wands." 

He  then  stepped  to  a  neighboring  bush  and  cut  off  a 
score  of  twigs.  These  he  measured  very  carefully  and  cut 
them  all  down  to  the  same  length  of  about  twelve  inches. 
Then  he  distributed  them  one  to  each  Kaffir,  keeping  one 
for  himself. 

"Now  you  can  go  away  where  you  like  for  a  quarter  of 
an  hour,"  said  he,  in  a  solemn  tone,  "and  you  will  come 
back  when  you  hear  the  tom-tom!  If  one  of  you  is  the 
thief  his  wand  will  be  three  inches  longer  than  the  rest." 

The  Kaffirs  dispersed  visibly  affected  by  this  little  speech, 
knowing  well  that  according  to  the  summary  proceedings 
of  Griqualand  justice  they  could  be  tried  and  hanged  in  a 
few  minutes  without  a  word  being  heard  in  their  defense. 

The  guests,  who  had  been  much  interested  in  the  scene, 
were  naturally  impressed  by  it  according  to  their  different 
dispositions. 

"The  thief  need  not  come  back  at  all,"  objected  one. 


THE  STAR  DISAPPEARS  223 

"Well,  then,  that  would  show  who  was  the  thief,"  replied 
another. 

"What  bosh!  He  can  easily  do  Mataki  by  cutting  off 
three  inches,  so  as  to  counterbalance  the  lengthening  he  is 
afraid  of." 

"That  is  what  the  medicine-man  is  hoping  for,  perhaps, 
so  as  to  catch  him  on  the  hop." 

However,  the  quarter  of  an  hour  elapsed,  and  Mataki 
beat  the  tom-tom  and  called  in  his  compatriots.  They  all 
returned  and  handed  back  their  sticks,  Mataki  formed  a 
bundle  of  them,  and  found  them  all  of  the  same  length. 
He  was  going  to  put  them  on  one  side  and  declare  that 
the  honor  of  his  friends  was  cleared,  when  he  bethought 
him  of  measuring  the  bundle  with  the  stick  he  had  retained 
for  himself. 

He  did  so,  and  all  the  sticks  in  it  were  three  inches 
short ! 

The  Kaffirs  had  judged  it  best  to  provide  against  the 
lengthening,  which,  to  their  superstitious  minds,  was  far 
from  improbable. 

A  general  shout  of  laughter  saluted  this  unexpected 
result.  Mataki  seemed  quite  humiliated  that  this  method 
whose  efficacy  he  had  frequently  proved  in  his  kraal, 
should  turn  out  a  failure  in  civilized  life. 

"We  must  give  it  up  for  the  present,"  said  the  police 
officer  to  Watkins,  who  was  seated  in  his  arm-chair, 
plunged  in  despair.  "We  may  do  better  tomorrow  if  we 
offer  a  good  reward  for  information  that  may  put  us  on 
the  track  of  the  thief." 

"The  thief!"  exclaimed  Pantalacci.  "And  why  should 
he  not  be  the  man  who  was  trying  his  comrades  just 
now?" 

"What  do  you  say?"  asked  the  officer. 

"Why,  Mataki,  who  played  the  medicine-man  to  divert 
your  suspicions." 

Had  Mataki  been  noticed  at  this  moment  he  would 
have  been  seen  to  make  a  curious  grimace  and  hurriedly 
leave  the  room  and  run  inside  his  hut. 

"Yes,"  continued  the  Italian,  "he  was  with  his  com- 
panions waiting  on  us  during  the  dinner.  He  is  a  thor- 
ough cheating  scoundrel,  and  why  Mr.  Cyprien  has  taken 
a  fancy  to  him  no  one  can  make  out." 


224  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

"Mataki  is  honest;  I  will  answer  for  that,"  said  Miss 
Watkins,  eager  to  defend  Cyprien's  servant. 

"Eh !  How  do  you  know  ?"  exclaimed  the  farmer.  "Yes, 
he  is  quite  capable  of  laying  hands  on  the  Star!" 

"He  cannot  be  far  off,"  said  the  police  officer.  "We  can 
soon  search  him." 

An  instant  later  Mr.  Watkins  and  his  guests  were  at 
Mataki's  hut.  The  door  was  fastened.  It  was  broken  in. 
Mataki  was  not  there,  and  they  waited  for  him  in  vain 
throughout  the  night. 

Nor  did  he  come  back  next  morning,  and  it  seemed 
certain  that  he  had  fled  from  Vandergaart  Kopje. 


CHAPTER  XII 

MAKING  READY 

IN  the  morning,  when  Cyprien  learned  what  had  hap- 
pened at  the  banquet,  the  first  thing  he  did  was  to  strenu- 
ously object  to  the  serious  charge  brought  against  his  serv- 
ant. He  agreed  with  Alice  that  Mataki  could  not  be  such 
a  thief  as  was  supposed.  In  fact  he  would  rather  have  sus- 
pected Pantalacci  and  his  companions  who  seemed  to  him 
very  much  more  suspicious  characters. 

It  was  not  likely,  however,  that  a  white  man  was  the 
guilty  party.  To  those  who  knew  nothing  of  its  origin, 
the  Star  of  the  South  was  a  natural  diamond,  and  con- 
sequently of  such  value  that  the  getting  rid  of  it  would  be 
difficult. 

"All  the  same,"  said  Cyprien,  "it  cannot  possibly  be 
Mataki." 

But  then  he  suddenly  remembered  certain  petty  larcenies 
of  which  the  man  had  been  guilty.  In  spite  of  all  his 
master's  warning,  the  Kaffir  had  never  been  able  to  cure 
himself  of  his  objectionable  habits.  What  he  had  taken 
was,  it  is  true,  almost  valueless,  but  still  the  tendency 
shown  could  not  but  tell  against  him  in  any  judicial  in- 
vestigation. 

And  there  were  other  things  in  favor  of  the  presump- 
tion. There  was  his  presence  in  the  dining-room  when 
the  diamond  was  eclipsed  as  if  by  magic.  There  was  his 
not  having  been  found  in  his  hut. 


MAKING  READY 


225 


And  then  there  was  his  flight. 

For  he  had  certainly  left  the  district,  and  Cyprien  waited 
in  vain  during  the  morning  for  Mataki  to  reappear.  He 
could  not  believe  in  his  servant's  guilt;  but  his  servant 
did  not  return.  And  further  examination  showed  that 
sundry  objects  and  utensils  such  as  a  man  would  take  with 
him  for  a  journey  across  the  African  desert  had  also  gone. 
There  was  no  further  room  for  doubt.  Guilty  or  not 
guilty,  the  Kaffir  had  fled. 

About  ten  o'clock  the  engineer,  very  much  more  grieved 
at  the  conduct  of  Mataki  than  at  the  loss  of  the  diamond, 
called  at  Watkins  Farm. 

There  he  found  the  farmer  in  conference  with  Pantalacci, 
Hilton,  and  Friedel.  As  he  presented  himself,  Alice,  who 
had  seen  him  coming,  also  entered  the  room  where  her 
father  and  his  three  cronies  were  noisily  discussing  what 
to  do  to  recover  the  stolen  diamond. 

"We  must  follow  Mataki!"  exclaimed  Watkins  angrily. 
"We  must  get  hold  of  him,  and  if  the  diamond  is  not 
handed  over,  we  must  rip  him  open  to  see  if  he  has  swal- 
lowed it!  Ah,  my  lass,  it  was  a  capital  notion  of  yours 
to  tell  us  that  story  yesterday!" 

"But,"  said  Cyprien,  in  a  quiet  tone,  anything  but 
pleasing  to  the  farmer,  "to  swallow  a  stone  of  that  size 
Mataki  would  have  to  have  a  stomach  like  an  ostrich!" 
"A  Kaffir's  stomach  is  capable  of  anything,  Mr.  Cy- 
prien," replied  Watkins.  "And  if  you  think  there  is  any- 
thing to  laugh  at — " 

"I  did  not  laugh,  Mr.  Watkins,"  said  Cyprien  seriously. 
"But  if  I  am  sorry  about  the  diamond,  it  is  only  because 
you  allowed  me  to  give  it  to  Miss  Watkins." 

"I  am  just  as  grateful  for  it,"  said  Alice,  "as  if  I  still 
had  it." 

"There's  a  woman's  head  for  you!"  exclaimed  the 
farmer.  "Just  as  grateful  as  if  she  still  had  it — a  diamond 
whose  equal  exists  not  in  the  world!" 

"Well,  it  is  not  quite  the  same  thing,"  said  Hilton. 
"Not  quite!"  added  Friedel. 

"On  the  contrary,  it  is  the  same  thing!"  answered  Cy- 
prien.   "For  as  I  made  that  diamond  I  can  make  another." 
"Oh,  Mr.  Engineer!"  said  Pantalacci,  with  a  threatening 

Vol.  13  Verne 


226  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

look.  "I  should  advise  you  not  to  try  another  experiment 
— in  the  interest  of  Griqualand — and  of  yourself!" 

"Really?"  replied  Cyprien.  "I  am  not  aware  that  I  had 
to  ask  your  permission  in  the  matter." 

"Don't  let  us  talk  about  that,"  said  Watkins.  "Is  Mr. 
Cyprien  sure  that  he  will  succeed  in  a  second  attempt? 
Can  he  guarantee  that  the  second  diamond  he  makes  will 
have  the  color,  the  weight,  and  consequently  the  value  of 
the  first?  Can  he  even  undertake  to  make  a  second  stone, 
even  of  inferior  value?  Has  not  his  success  been  due  in  a 
great  measure  to  chance?" 

The  engineer  could  not  but  be  struck  with  the  reason- 
ableness of  these  questions.  His  experiences  were  quite 
in  accord  with  the  teachings  and  practice  of  modern 
chemistry,  but  had  not  chance  come  in  to  make  him  suc- 
ceed? And  if  he  tried  again,  could  he  be  certain  of  a 
triumph  ? 

It  was  important  then  that  the  thief  should  be  captured 
and  the  diamond  recovered. 

"By-the-bye,  have  you  found  any  trace  of  Mataki?" 

"None,"  answered  Cyprien. 

"Have   they   searched   the   neighborhood?" 

"Yes,  and  searched  it  well!"  replied  Friedel. 

"The  scoundrel  probably  cleared  off  during  the  night, 
and  it  is  almost  impossible  to  know  where  he  has  gone!" 

"Has  the  police  officer  taken  the  matter  in  hand?"  asked 
Watkins. 

"Yes,"  answered  Cyprien,  "and  he  has  found  no  trace 
at  present." 

"Ah!"  exclaimed  the  farmer,  "I  will  give  five  hundred 
pounds  for  him  if  they  can  catch  him." 

"Very  likely,  Mr.  Watkins,"  said  Pantalacci.  "But  I 
am  afraid  you  will  never  see  the  diamond,  nor  the  man 
who  took  it." 

"Why  not?" 

"Because  once  he  has  got  a  start,"  replied  the  Italian, 
"he  will  never  be  fool  enough  to  stop  on  the  road.  He 
will  cross  the  Limpopo,  plunge  into  the  desert,  and  make 
for  the  Zambesi  or  Tanganyika,  or  go  among  the  Bushmen 
if  he  thinks  better." 

Did  the  astute  Neapolitan  really  think  what  he  said? 
Was  he  not  speaking  thus  to  prevent  any  pursuit  of 


MAKING  READY  227 

Mataki,  in  order  that  he  might  undertake  it  alone?    Thus 
thought  Cyprien  as  he  watched  him  narrowly. 

But  Watkins  was  not  the  man  to  give  up  the  game 
because  it  was  difficult  to  play.  He  would  have  sacri- 
ficed his  entire  fortune  to  get  back  the  incomparable  stone, 
and  through  the  open  window  his  eyes  in  their  angry 
impatience  seemed  to  gleam  across  the  green  slopes  of  the 
Vaal  as  if  he  hoped  to  find  the  fugitive  on  the  horizon. 

"What  does  that  matter?  I  must  have  my  diamond!  I 
must  catch  this  scoundrel !  If  I  hadn't  the  gout  it  wouldn't 
take  long,  I  tell  you!" 

"Father!"  said  Alice,  trying  to  soothe  him. 

"Look- here!  what  do  you  want  for  your  trouble?"  asked 
the  farmer,  looking  around  him.  "Who'll  go  after  the  nig- 
ger? I'll  make  it  worth  your  while." 

And  as  nobody  spoke  he  continued : 

"You  four  want  to  marry  my  daughter !  Well,  catch  me 
the  man  who  stole  my  diamond" — he  now  called  it  "my 
diamond" — "and  I  give  you  my  word  that  the  man  who 
does  so  shall  marry  her." 

"Done!"  exclaimed  Hilton. 

"Agreed!"  said  Friedel. 

"Who  would  not  endeavor  to  win  so  precious  a  prize?" 
simpered  Pantalacci. 

Alice  blushed  deeply  and  vainly  endeavored  to  hide  her 
confusion,  ashamed  at  seeing  herself  thus  put  up  to  auction, 
and  that  in  the  presence  of  the  young  engineer. 

"Miss  Watkins,"  said  Cyprien  in  a  low  tone,  and  leaning 
respectfully  toward  her,  "I  should  like  to  try  my  fortune 
in  this,  but  have  I  your  permission?" 

"You  have,  and  my  best  wishes,  Mr.  Cyprien!" 

"Then  I  am  ready  to  go  to  the  end  of  the  world!" 
exclaimed  Cyprien,  turning  toward  Mr.  Watkins. 

"You  won't  be  far  out,"  said  Pantalacci,  "for  Mataki 
will  lead  you  a  nice  dance.  By  tomorrow  he  ought  to  be 
at  Potchefstroom,  and  he  will  have  reached  the  hills  before 
we  have  left  our  diggings." 

"And  what  prevents  our  starting  immediately?"  said 
Cyprien. 

"You  can  go  if  you  like,"  replied  the  Italian.  "But  for 
my  part  I  want  some  food  with  me — a  wagon,  a  dozen 


228  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

oxen,  and  a  couple  of  saddle-horses  at  the  very  least. 
And  we  cannot  get  that  nearer  than  Potchefstroom." 

Again,  was  Pantalacci  speaking  seriously?  Was  it  his 
object  to  discourage  his  rivals?  Perhaps;  but  he  was  never- 
theless quite  right.  Without  such  means  of  locomotion, 
without  such  resources,  it  would  be  folly  to  attempt  a 
journey  in  Northern  Griqualand. 

But  a  team  of  oxen,  as  Cyprien  knew,  would  cost  about 
four  hundred  pounds,  and  he  had  only  one  hundred  and 
sixty. 

"An  idea!"  shouted  Hilton,  who,  as  an  "Africander"  of 
Scottish  descent,  had  a  strong  vein  of  economy  in  his 
disposition.  "Why  shouldn't  we  four  go  partners?  The 
chances  would  be  more  equal,  and  the  cost  would  be  much 
less." 

"That  seems  reasonable,"  said  Friedel. 

"I  agree,"  answered  Cyprien. 

"Then,"  remarked  Pantalacci,  "it  must  be  understood 
that  each  man  retains  his  independence,  and  is  free  to 
leave  his  companions  whenever  he  thinks  fit." 

"Of  course,"  replied  Hilton.  "We  club  together  to  buy 
the  wagon,  the  team,  and  the  provender,  but  we  can  each 
leave  when  we  please." 

"Agreed,"  said  Cyprien,  Friedel,  and  Pantalacci. 

"When  will  you  start?"  asked  Watkins,  whose  chance 
of  recovering  his  diamond  was  thus  quadrupled. 

"Tomorrow,  by  the  coach  to  Potchefstroom,"  answered 
Friedel;  "there's  no  good  thinking  of  getting  there 
earlier." 

"Right!" 

As  soon  as  this  was  settled,  Alice  took  Cyprien  apart, 
and  asked  him  if  he  really  believed  that  Mataki  was  the 
author  of  the  theft. 

"I  am  forced  to  confess,"  answered  the  engineer,  "that 
all  the  presumptions  are  against  him,  chiefly  on  account  of 
his  flight.  But  I  feel  sure  that  Pantalacci  has  some  inter- 
est in  spinning  things  out  as  long  as  he  can  in  regard  to 
it.  What  a  partner  to  work  with !  Well,  all  is  fair  in  war. 
It  is  better  to  keep  him  in  hand,  and  I  can  watch  his 
movements  more  easily  than  by  letting  him  go  off  by 
himself." 


MAKING  READY  229 

The  four  suitors  soon  bade  farewell  to  Watkins  and  his 
daughter.  As  was  only  natural  under  the  circumstances, 
the  ceremony  was  a  brief  one,  and  consisted  merely  of  a 
shake  of  the  hand.  What  could  the  rivals  say  in  thus 
going  off  together,  each  wishing  the  other  at  the  bottom 
of  the  sea? 

When  he  reached  home,  Cyprien  found  Li  .and  Bardik. 
The  young  Kaffir,  since  he  had  entered  his  service,  had 
done  his  work  most  zealously.  He  and  the  Chinaman 
were  having  a  quiet  chat  together,  when  the  young  engi- 
neer announced  that  he  was  going  away  with  Friedel, 
Hilton,  and  the  Neapolitan  in  chase  of  Mataki. 

A  look  passed  between  them— only  one.  Then,  with- 
out an  allusion  to  the  fugitive,  they  came  up  to  Cyprien 
and  said: 

"Pa,   take  us  with  you." 

"Take  you  with  me?   And  why?" 

"To  do  your  cooking,"  said  Bardik. 

"To  do  your  washing,"  said  Li. 

"And  to  stop  the  rascals  from  doing  you  harm,"  said 
both,  in  chorus. 

Cyprien  gave  them  a  keen  glance. 

"Very  well,"  he  replied,  "I  will  take  you  both,  if  you 
wish  it." 

Then  he  went  out  to  bid  good-bye  to  Vandergaart,  who, 
without  showing  approval  or  disapproval  of  the  expedi- 
tion, shook  him  cordially  by  the  hand  and  wished  him 
success. 

In  the  morning,  as,  followed  by  his  two  men,  he  walked 
down  to  the  camp  to  join  the  coach  for  Potchefstroom,  he 
lifted  his  eyes  to  Watkins  Farm,  which  was  still  wrapped 
in  sleep. 

Was  it  an  illusion?  He  thought  he  recognized  behind 
the  muslin  curtain  of  one  of  the  windows  a  slight,  girlish 
form  waving  a  hand  in  token  of  farewell. 


230  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

CHAPTER  XIII 

ACROSS    THE    TRANSVAAL 

ON  arriving  at  Potchefstroom,  the  four  travelers  ascer- 
tained that  a  young  Kaffir,  whose  description  tallied  with 
that  of  Mataki,  had  passed  through  there  the  evening  be- 
fore. This  promised  well  for  the  success  of  the  expedi- 
tion. But  it  seemed  as  though  the  enterprise  would  take 
some  time,  as  the  fugitive  had  provided  himself  with  a 
light  carriage  drawn  by  an  ostrich,  and  thus  rendered  it 
no  easy  matter  to  catch  him. 

For  there  are  few  better  goers  than  these  birds,  either 
on  the  score  of  endurance  or  speed.  Ostriches  of  burden, 
however,  are  somewhat  rare,  owing  to  the  difficulty  in 
breaking  them  in.  Hence  neither  Cyprien  nor  his  com- 
panions could  obtain  any  at  Potchefstroom,  and  Mataki 
was  off  to  the  north  with  a  good  start  and  an  animal  that 
could  put  a  dozen  horses  on  their  mettle. 

The  only  thing  left  was  to  follow  him  as  quickly  as 
possible.  He  had  a  great  advantage  in  his  superior  speed 
as  against  that  obtainable  from  the  mode  of  locomotion 
his  pursuers  intended  to  adopt.  But  the  strength  of  the 
ostrich  has  its  limits.  Mataki  would  be  obliged  to  halt  for 
a  time,  and  if  the  worst  came  to  the  worst,  was  sure  to  be 
caught  at  the  end  of  his  journey. 

Cyprien  soon  had  cause  to  congratulate  himself  on  hav- 
ing brought  Li  and  Bardik  with  him,  when  he  set  about 
procuring  his  outfit.  It  was  no  easy  matter  to  select  only 
such  articles  as  were  useful  and  necessary.  There  is  no 
guide  like  experience.  Cyprien  was  an  excellent  hand  at 
the  calculus,  but  of  the  A  B  C  of  Veld  life,  of  life  "on 
trek,"  he  knew  nothing.  And  his  companions,  instead  of 
helping  him  with  their  advice,  showed  rather  a  tendency 
to  lead  him  astray. 

As  far  as  the  tilted  wagon,  the  team  of  oxen,  and  the 
bulk  of  the  commissariat  were  concerned,  there  was  no 
difficulty.  Mutual  interest  commanded  that  these  should 
be  judiciously  chosen,  and  Hilton  acquitted  himself  to 
perfection.  But  it  was  not  so  with  matters  that  were 


ACROSS  THE  TRANSVAAL  231 

left  to  individual  choice,  such,  for  example,  as  buying  a 
horse. 

Cyprien  had  noticed  in  the  market  a  good-looking 
three-year-old,  whose  price  was  not  excessive.  He  had 
tried  his  seat,  found  it  suited  him,  and  was  about  to 
hand  over  the  money,  when  Bardik  took  him  aside,  and 
said : 

"Are  you  going  to  buy  that  horse?" 

"Yes.     It  is  the  best  I  can  find  at  the  price." 

"It  is  not  worth  having  as  a  gift,"  answered  the  Kaffir. 
"It  won't  stand  a  week's  travel." 

"Why  not?  Are  you  trying  the  medicine-man  busi- 
ness?" 

"No,  Pa;  but  Bardik  knows  the  desert,  and  says  that 
that  horse  is  not  salted." 

"Not  salted?  Do  you  want  me  then  to  buy  a  horse  in 
a  cask?" 

"No,  Pa;  but  it  means  that  he  has  not  had  the  Veld 
disease.  He  must  have  it  soon,  and  then  if  it  does  not  kill 
him,  it  will  make  him  useless." 

"Oh!"  said  Cyprien,  thinking  there  was  something  in 
the  caution  after  all.  "What  is  the  disease?" 

"A  burning  fever  and  a  cough,"  said  Bardik.  "You 
must  not  buy  a  horse  that  has  not  had  it.  You  can  easily 
see  those  that  have — and  once  they  have  had  it,  they  very 
seldom  catch  it  again." 

There  was  no  excuse  for  hesitation  under  such  circum- 
stances. Cyprien  postponed  matters,  and  went  in  search 
of  further  information.  Everybody  he  asked  confirmed 
what  he  had  heard  from  Bardik.  The  fact  was  so  no- 
torious that  it  was  seldom  mentioned. 

Having  been  put  on  his  guard,  the  engineer  became 
more  prudent,  and  betook  himself  to  a  veterinary  sur- 
geon. Thanks  to  his  guidance,  he  in  a  few  hours  secured 
the  very  mount  most  suitable  for  his  purpose,  in  the  shape 
of  an  old  gray  horse  consisting  of  nothing  but  skin  and 
bone,  and  only  possessing  a  fragment  of  tail.  That  he 
had  been  "salted"  was  obvious  enough  from  his  appear- 
ance; and,  although  his  trot  was  rather  stilted,  he  was 
evidently  a  good  one  to  go,  if  a  poor  one  to  look  at. 
Templar — such  was  his  name — enjoyed  quite  a  reputation 


232  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

in  the  country  for  endurance,  and  when  Bardik  had  in- 
spected him — for  the  Kaffir  was  of  course  consulted — he 
declared  himself  thoroughly  satisfied. 

Bardik  himself  was  specially  entrusted  with  the  man- 
agement of  the  wagon  and  the  team,  and  therein  had  con- 
siderable assistance  from  Li.  No  mounts  had  to  be 
bought  for  them,  and  Cyprien's  horse-dealing  terminated 
with  his  paying  for  his  own  steed. 

Another  difficult  matter  was  the  selection  of  the  battery. 
Cyprien  at  last  decided  on  a  Martini-Henry  and  a  Rem- 
ington, which,  though  not  very  elegant  in  appearance,  was 
a  straight  shooter  and  a  rapid  loader.  One  thing  he 
would  not  have  thought  of,  had  the  Chinaman  not  sug- 
gested it  to  him,  and  that  was  a  stock  of  explosive  bullets. 
He  had  imagined  that  five  or  six  hundred  cartridges  would 
be  sufficient,  and  was  greatly  surprised  to  find  that  four 
thousand  was  the  minimum  prudence  demanded  in  this 
land  of  wild  beasts  and  savage  men. 

Cyprien  also  purchased  a  couple  of  revolvers  with  ex- 
plosive bullets,  and  completed  his  armament  by  securing 
a  superb  hunting-knife,  which  for  five  years  had  hung  in 
the  window  of  the  gun-maker  at  Potchefstroom  without 
any  inquiry  being  made  for  it. 

It  was  now  bought  to  please  Li,  he  having  assured 
Cyprien  that  nothing  would  turn  out  more  useful  than 
this  knife,  and  the  trouble  he  afterward  took  in  sharpen- 
ing and  polishing  it,  showed  that  confidence  in  the  cold 
steel  which  he  shared  with  the  rest  of  his  race. 

Of  course  the  famous  red  box  went  with  the  careful 
Chinaman.  In  it  he  stowed  away,  with  other  mysterious 
articles,  about  sixty  yards  of  fine  strong  line.  When  he 
was  asked  what  it  was  for,  he  replied,  evasively: 

"Have  not  your  clothes  got  to  be  dried  in  the  bush  as 
well  as  anywhere  else?" 

In  twelve  hours  the  purchases  were  all  made.  Water- 
proofs, wrappers,  cooking  utensils,  tinned  provisions, 
yokes,  chains,  spare  harness,  were  stowed  at  the  back  of 
the  wagon,  and  formed  the  basis  of  the  general  store. 
The  front  of  the  wagon  was  littered  with  straw,  and 
served  as  the  bedroom  and  shelter  for  Cyprien  and  his 
companions. 


ACROSS  THE  TRANSVAAL 


233 


Hilton  had  done  his  part  of  the  work  thoroughly  well, 
and  seemed  to  have  omitted  nothing  they  were  likely  to 
require.  He  was  very  vain  of  his  colonial  experience,  and' 
to  show  his  superiority,  rather  than  from  any  feeling  of 
friendliness,  favored  his  companions  with  a  good  deal  of 
information  on  the  customs  of  the  Veld. 

At  last  Pantalacci  interrupted  with: 

"What  makes  you  want  to  tell  the  Frenchman  all  that? 
Do  you  want  to  see  him  win  the  prize?  If  I  were  you,  I 
would  keep  all  I  knew  to  myself." 

Hilton  regarded  the  Italian  with  sincere  admiration. 

"That  is  a  good  notion  of  yours.  Such  an  idea  would 
not  have  occurred  to  me." 

Cyprien  had  honestly  told  Friedel  what  he  had  learned 
about  the  horses  of  the  country,  but  to  no  purpose.  The 
German  thought  no  one  knew  anything  but  himself,  and 
bought  the  youngest  and  most  fiery  steed  he  could — the 
very  one  that  Cyprien  had  refused.  He  also  laid  in  a 
stock  of  fishing-tackle,  asserting  that  there  would  be  no 
lack  of  sport. 

The  preparations  were  finished  at  last,  and  the  caravan 
formed  up  in  the  order  it  was  to  keep  on  the  march. 

The  wagon,  drawn  by  a  dozen  red  and  black  oxen,  went 
first,  in  charge  of  Bardik.  Sometimes  the  Kaffir,  whip  in 
hand,  walked  by  the  side  of  his  team ;  sometimes  he  took 
his  seat  in  the  front  of  the  chariot,  where,  regardless  of 
the  jolting,  he  sat  in  triumph,  enchanted  with  his  mode  of 
locomotion.  The  four  horsemen  formed  the  front  and 
rear  guards,  except  at  such  times  as  they  separated  to 
shoot  a  little  game,  or  make  a  reconnaissance. 

After  a  very  brief  consultation  it  had  been  decided  to 
make  for  the  source  of  the  Limpopo.  All  advices  tended 
to  show  that  Mataki  was  following  this  road — and,  in 
fact,  he  could  not  well  take  another,  if  his  intention  was 
to  get  as  far  from  the  British  possessions  as  soon  as  he 
could.  The  Kaffir  had  an  advantage  over  his  pursuers  in 
his  perfect  knowledge  of  the  country,  and  the  lightness 
of  his  equipage.  He  obviously  knew  where  he  was  going, 
and  the  best  road  to  take  thither,  and,  thanks  to  his  friends 
in  the  north,  he  was  sure  of  welcome  and  shelter,  and  even 
help,  if  he  wished  it.  There  was,  indeed,  a  chance  that  he 
might  raise  his  tribe  and  turn  to  bay  on  those  who  were 


234  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

chasing  him.  Cyprien  and  his  comrades  were  fully  aware 
of  this,  and  appreciated  the  need  of  their  traveling  to- 
gether for  their  mutual  safety  and  ultimate  success. 

The  Transvaal,  which  they  intended  to  cross  from  south 
to  north,  is  that  vast  region  of  Equatorial  Africa  lying 
between  the  Vaal  and  the  Limpopo.  Geographically,  it  is 
divided  into  three  regions — the  table-land,  or  Hooge  Veld ; 
the  hill  country,  or  Banken  Veld;  and  the  Bush  Veld. 

The  table-land  is  the  most  southerly;  it  is  formed  by 
the  mountain  chains  which  extend  westward  and  south- 
ward from  the  Drakenberg.  It  is  the  mining  country  of 
the  Transvaal,  and  the  climate  is  as  cold  and  as  dry  as 
that  of  the  Bernese  Oberland. 

The  Banken  Veld  is  more  particularly  the  agricultural 
district.  Extending  along  the  north  of  the  Hooge  Veld, 
its  deep  valleys,  drained  by  pleasant  watercourses,  and 
shaded  by  evergreen  trees,  are  inhabited  by  the  descend- 
ants of  the  Dutch. 

The  Bush  Veld — the  hunting-ground  of  the  Transvaal — 
comprises  the  wide,  rolling  plains  stretching  up  to  the 
banks  of  the  Limpopo  toward  the  north,  and  to  Be- 
chuanaland  toward  the  east. 

Leaving  Potchefstroom  in  the  Banken  Veld,  they  had 
to  cross  diagonally  nearly  the  whole  of  it  before  reaching 
the  Bush  Veld.  This  first  part  of  the  Transvaal  offered 
few  difficulties  to  their  progress.  They  were  still  in  a 
half -civilized  country.  The  worst  that  could  happen  was 
a  wheel  stuck  fast  in  the  mud,  or  a  sick  ox.  Wild  ducks, 
partridges,  and  antelopes  abounded,  and  each  day  fur- 
nished an  ample  breakfast  or  dinner.  The  night  was 
spent  at  some  farm,  whose  inhabitants,  isolated  from  the 
rest  of  the  world  for  three-quarters  of  the  year,  were  sin- 
cerely glad  to  receive  their  guests. 

At  almost  every  farm  they  stopped  at,  they  heard  news 
of  Mataki.  Everywhere  he  had  been  seen  to  pass  in  his 
ostrich  carriage;  at  first,  two  or  three  days  in  advance, 
then  five  or  six,  then  seven  or  eight.  Evidently  they  were 
on  his  track,  but  evidently  also  he  was  gaining  rapidly 
on  his  pursuers,  who,  however,  felt  sure  of  catching  him 
at  last. 

Cyprien  and  his  three  companions  began  to  take  things 
easy,  and  to  amuse  themselves  in  their  special  ways.  The 


ACROSS  THE  TRANSVAAL  235 

engineer  made  a  collection  of  rock  specimens,  the  German 
botanized,  Pantalacci  tormented  Bardik  and  Li,  and  atoned 
for  his  buffoonery  by  making  delicious  dishes  of  macaroni 
at  every  halt.  Hilton's  business  was  to  keep  the  caravan 
provisioned  with  game,  and  hardly  a  day  passed  in  which 
he  did  not  bring  down  his  six  brace  of  partridges,  his  score 
of  quails,  and  occasionally  a  wild  boar  or  an  antelope. 

By  easy  stages  they  reached  the  Bush  Veld.  The  farms 
became  fewer,  and  at  last  disappeared  altogether.  The 
travelers  were  on  the  extreme  verge  of  civilization. 
Henceforth  they  had  to  camp  out  at  nights;  huge  fires 
had  to  be  lighted  for  men  and  cattle  to  sleep  around,  and 
a  constant ,  watch  had  to  be  kept. 

The  country  became  wilder.  Stretches  of  yellow  sand, 
clumps  of  thorn-bushes,  and  at  long  intervals  a  marshy 
stream  or  so,  took  the  place  of  the  green  valleys  of  the 
Banken  Veld.  Now  and  then  the  underwood  was  so  thick 
and  thorny  that,  instead  of  keeping  on  its  straight  course 
the  caravan  had  to  go  some  distance  around.  The  thorn- 
trees  were  from  nine  to  fifteen  feet  high,  with  numerous 
branches  spread  out  almost  horizontally,  and  armed  with 
spines  from  two  to  four  inches  in  length,  as  hard  and 
sharp  as  daggers. 

This  outer  zone  of  the  Bush  Veld  is  generally  known  as 
the  Lion  Veld,  but  it  hardly  seemed  to  justify  its  name, 
for  after  three  days'  working  through  it  not  a  lion  had 
been  seen. 

"The  name,"  said  Cyprien,  "is  probably  traditional,  and 
the  lions  have  long  since  retired  to  the  desert." 

But  Hilton  laughed. 

"You  don't  believe  in  the  lions?  That  is  because  you 
don't  know  how  to  look  for  them." 

"Not  see  a  lion  in  the  middle  of  a  naked  flat  like  this!" 
said  Cyprien  ironically. 

"Well,  I  will  bet  you  ten  pounds,"  said  Hilton,  "that  in 
less  than  an  hour  I  show  you  one  you  didn't  see." 

"I  never  bet,  on  principle,"  said  Cyprien,  "but  I  shall  be 
glad  to  see  your  lion,  all  the  same." 

The  journey  was  continued.  For  about  half  an  hour  all 
went  well,  and  nothing  was  said  about  lions,  when  sud- 
denly Hilton  exclaimed : 

"Do  you  see  that  ant-hill  over  there  on  the  right?" 


236  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

"How  beautiful!"  said  Friedel.  "We  have  seen  nothing 
else  but  those  things  for  the  last  three  days/' 

And,  in  fact,  nothing  is  more  common  in  the  Bush  Veld 
than  these  huge,  yellow  mounds,  built  up  by  ants  innum- 
erable, and,  with  the  few  clumps  of  straggling  mimosas, 
'forming  the  only  break  in  the  plain's  monotony. 

Hilton  laughed  sarcastically. 

"Mr.  Cyprien,"  he  said,  "if  you  like  to  take  the  trouble 
of  galloping  over  there — where  I  am  pointing  with  my 
finger — you  will  see  what  you  want.  Don't  you  go  too 
near,  however,  or  you  may  come  to  grief." 

Cyprien  gave  his  horse  the  spur,  and  trotted  off. 

"That  is  a  family  of  lions  over  there,"  said  the  German, 
as  soon  as  he  was  out  of  earshot.  "One  out  of  every  ten 
of  those  ant-hills  is  not  an  ant-hill." 

"Per  Baccho!"  exclaimed  Pantalacci,  "you  need  not 
have  told  him  not  to  go  too  close."  And,  noticing  that 
Bardik  and  Li  were  listening,  he  added,  "He'll  get  awfully 
scared,  and  we  shall  have  the  pleasure  of  a  good  laugh  at 
him." 

The  Italian  was  wrong.  Cyprien  was  not  the  man  to 
get  "awfully  scared,"  as  he  phrased  it.  A  couple  of 
hundred  yards  from  the  "ant-hill"  he  saw  what  it  was. 
An  enormous  lion,  a  lioness,  and  three  pups  were  stretched 
on  the  ground  like  cats,  and  quietly  sleeping  in  the  sun. 

At  the  sound  of  Templar's  hoofs  the  lion  opened  his 
eyes,  raised  his  huge  head,  and  yawned.  As  he  did  so, 
there  appeared  between  the  two  rows  of  powerful  teeth, 
a  deep,  wide  throat,  down  which  a  child  might  easily  have 
dropped.  Then  he  glared  at  the  horseman,  who  had  pulled 
up  about  twenty  yards  away. 

Fortunately  the  lion  was  not  hungry,  and  so  he  did  not 
trouble  himself  to  move. 

Cyprien,  with  his  hand  on  his  rifle,  waited  for  a  minute 
or  two,  and  then,  seeing  that  the  lion  had  no  desire  to 
commence  hostilities,  and  not  having  the  heart  to  spoil  the 
happiness  of  the  interesting  family,  turned  around,  and 
ambled  off  to  his  companions,  who  could  not  help  recog- 
nizing his  coolness  and  pluck. 

"I  should  have  lost  my  bet,  Mr.  Hilton,"  was  all  he 
said. 

That  evening:  they  halted  near  the  rig;ht  bank  of  the 


ACROSS  THE  TRANSVAAL  237 

Limpopo.  There,  in  spite  of  all  that  Hilton  could  say 
Friedel  went  out  to  fish. 

"It  is  a  dangerous  game,  I  tell  you,"  said  the  English- 
man. "In  the  Bush  Veld  people  never  hang  about  water- 
courses after  sundown.  Never — 

"So!"  said  the  German.     "Well,  then,  I'll  be  different." 

"What  harm  can  there  be,"  said  Pantalacci,  "in  his 
going  down  to  the  river-bank  for  an  hour  or  two  ?  I  have 
often  spent  half  the  day  wet  through  to  the  armpits  when 
I  have  been  after  wild  duck." 

"That  is  not  at  all  the  same  thing,"  said  Hilton,  again 
endeavoring  to  stop  Friedel. 

"Oh!  Bother!"  answered  the  Italian.  "My  dear  Hil- 
ton, just  hand  us  over  that  tin  of  scraped  cheese  for  the 
macaroni,  and  let  our  friend  go  and  catch  us  a  few  fish 
for  supper.  We  want  a  change !" 

Friedel  went  off,  and  kept  his  line  in  so  long  that  it 
was  quite  night  when  he  returned.  Then  he  made  a 
hearty  meal  off  the  fish  he  had  caught,  and  when  he  went 
to  bed  in  the  wagon,  complained  of  a  slight  shivering.  In 
the  morning  when  they  rose  to  depart,  he  was  in  a  violent 
fever,  and  found  it  impossible  to  mount  his  horse.  Never- 
theless, he  insisted  on  their  starting,  affirming  that  he 
would  be  all  right  on  the  straw.  They  did  as  he  requested. 

At  noon  he  was  delirious. 

At  three  o'clock  he  was  dead! 

"You  see,"  said  Hilton  philosophically,  "I  was  right 
when  I  said  that  you  mustn't  hang  about  water-courses 
after  sundown." 

They  halted  for  a  few  minutes  to  bury  the  corpse,  that 
they  could  not  leave  to  the  mercy  of  the  wild  beasts.  It 
was  that  of  a  rival,  perhaps  of  an  enemy,  and  yet  Cyprien 
felt  profoundly  moved  as  the  last  sad  rites  were  accom- 
plished. The  spectacle  of  death,  solemn  and  impressive  as 
it  is  everywhere,  seemed  to  gain  increased  solemnity  in 
the  desert,  for  in  Nature's  presence  man  is  more  fully 
conscious  of  his  own  inevitable  end.  Far  from  his  friends, 
far  from  all  who  loved  him,  his  melancholy  thoughts  flew 
back  to  home.  "Perhaps,"  thought  he,  "I  myself  may  lie 
on  this  plain,  never  again  to  rise;  perhaps  I  may  be 
buried  in  a  sandhill,  capped  with  a  bare  stone,  and  have 
no  friend  to  soothe  my  last  moments."  And  thus  putting 


238  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

himself  in  his  comrade's  place,  and  pitying  him,  he  felt  as 
though  a  part  of  himself  lay  buried  there. 

The  day  after  the  mournful  ceremony  Friedel's  horse 
was  seized  with  the  Veld  disease,  and  in  a  few  hours  fol- 
lowed his  master  to  the  grave. 


CHAPTER  XIV 

THE    NORTH    OF    THE    LIMPOPO 

THREE  days  elapsed  before  a  ford  could  be  found  across 
the  Limpopo.  Even  then  it  probably  would  not  have  been 
discovered,  had  not  some  Macalacca  Kaffirs  undertaken  to 
act  as  guides. 

These  Kaffirs  are  the  subject  race  held  in  slavery  by 
the  Bechuanas  as  the  Helots  were  by  the  Spartans  of  old 
— made  to  work  without  pay,  treated  with  great  severity, 
and,  worse  than  all,  forbidden  to  eat  any  .flesh.  The 
unhappy  Macalaccas  can  kill  as  many  birds  as  they  please, 
but  only  on  condition  that  they  hand  them  over  to  their 
masters. 

A  Macalacca  possesses  nothing  of  his  own,  not  even  a 
hut  or  a  calabash.  Lean  and  half  starved,  he  goes  about 
nearly  naked,  with  a  bandolier  over  his  shoulders,  serving 
him  for  a  water-bottle,  made  of  buffalo  intestines,  and 
looking  at  a  distance  like  yards  of  black  pudding. 

Bardik's  commercial  genius  was  soon  displayed  in  the 
consummate  art  with  which  he  extracted  from  these 
savages  the  avowal  that,  in  spite  of  their  misery,  they 
were  the  owners  of  sundry  ostrich  plumes,  hidden  away  in 
a  neighboring  thicket.  He  immediately  proposed  to  buy 
them,  and  an  appointment  was  made  for  the  bargain  to 
be  completed  in  the  evening. 

"You  have  some  money  with  you,  then,  to  give  them  in 
exchange?"  asked  Cyprien,  much  surprised. 

And  Bardik,  with  a  broad  grin,  showed  him  a  handful 
of  brass  buttons  which  had  taken  him  a  month  or  so  to 
collect. 

"That  is  not  proper  money,"  said  Cyprien,  "and  I  can- 
not allow  you  to  pay  these  poor  people  with  a  few  old 
buttons." 


THE  NORTH  OF  THE  LIMPOPO  239 

But  he  found  it  impossible  to  make  Bardik  understand 
in  what  way  his  idea  was  reprehensible. 

"If  the  Macalaccas  accept  my  buttons  in  exchange  for 
their  feathers,  what  is  there  to  find  fault  with?"  he 
answered.  "You  know  that  the  plumes  have  cost  them 
nothing  to  collect — they  have  not  even  a  right  to  keep 
them,  and  can  only  show  them  to  us  on  the  sly.  But  a 
button  is  something  useful,  more  useful  than  an  ostrich 
feather.  Why,  then,  do  you  stop  me  from  offering  a 
dozen  for  a  dozen  plumes?" 

The  reasoning  was  specious,  but  worthless.  What  the 
Kaffir  did  not  see  was  that  the  Macalaccas  took  the  brass 
buttons,  not  for  the  use  they  would  make  of  them,  but 
for  the  supposed  value  they  attributed  to  the  metal  disks 
which  resembled  coins  so  much  in  shape.  And  therein 
lay  the  wrong. 

Cyprien,  however,  saw  that  the  distinction  was  too  re- 
fined to  be  grasped  by  the  intelligence  of  the  savage,  and 
so  he  had  to  leave  him  to  act  as  he  pleased. 

In  the  evening,  by  torchlight,  Bardik's  bartering  was 
resumed.  The  Macalaccas  were  evidently  afraid  of  being 
taken  in  by  their  friend,  and  not  satisfied  with  the  fires 
prepared  by  the  whites,  brought  with  them  a  number  of 
corn  cobs,  which  they  lighted  and  stuck  in  the  ground. 

They  then  brought  forward  the  ostrich  plumes,  and  pro- 
ceeded to  examine  Bardik's  buttons.  And  then  began 
with  much  shouting  and  gesticulation  a  most  animated 
debate  on  the  nature  of  these  pieces  of  metal. 

What  they  said  was  unintelligible  to  all  except  them- 
selves, but  from  their  excited  faces,  eloquent  grimaces,  and 
occasional  serious  outbursts  of  anger,  it  was  obvious  that 
the  debate  was  one  of  much  interest  to  them. 

Suddenly  the  impassioned  discussion  was  interrupted  by 
an  unexpected  apparition. 

A  tall  black,  wearing  an  old  red  cotton  mantle  and  the 
usual  diadem  of  sheep-gut  of  the  Kaffir  warriors,  stalked 
out  of  the  thicket  where  the  bargaining  was  going  on,  and 
with  his  spear  struck  away  right  and  left  at  the  Macalaccas 
thus  taken  in  the  very  act  of  disobedience. 

"Lopepe!  Lopepe!"  yelled  the  unfortunate  savages, 
scattering  on  all  sides  like  a  lot  of  rats. 

But  a  ring  of  black  warriors  appeared  from  among  the 


240  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

bush-clumps  surrounding  the  camp  and  barred  their 
passage. 

Lopepe  immediately  possessed  himself  of  the  buttons. 
After  carefully  examining  them  by  the  light  of  the  maize 
torches,  he  dropped  them  with  signs  of  much  satisfaction 
into  his  leather  pouch.  Then  he  stepped  up  to  Bardik, 
and  taking  away  the  feathers  that  had  already  been  handed 
over,  he  appropriated  them  in  the  same  way  as  he  had 
done  the  buttons. 

Of  this  scene  the  whites  had  remained  passive  specta- 
tors, having  no  excuse  for  interfering  in  it.  Lopepe, 
however,  solved  the  difficulty  by  advancing  toward  them, 
stopping,  a  few  paces  off,  and  in  an  imperious  tone  de- 
livering a  long  address,  which  was  almost  unintelligible. 

Hilton,  understanding  a  few  words  of  Bechuana,  suc- 
ceeded in  catching  its  general  drift.  The  Kaffir  chief 
protested  against  Bardik  being  allowed  to  trade  with  the 
Macalaccas,  when  they  possessed  no  property  of  their  own, 
and  expressed  his  intention  of  confiscating  what  he  had 
found  as  contraband,  and  asked  what  they  were  going 
to  do. 

Opinions  were  divided.  Pantalacci  wished  to  give  in 
at  once  rather  than  cause  a  disturbance  with  the  Bechua- 
nas.  Hilton  and  Cyprien  were  afraid  that  by  doing  so 
Lopepe's  arrogance  would  be  encouraged,  and  still  greater 
risk  run  in  consequence. 

After  a  short  whispered  consultation  it  was  agreed  to 
abandon  the  buttons  to  the  Bechuana  and  to  claim  the 
feathers,  and  this  Hilton  explained  to  the  chief  in  a  few 
Kaffir  words  eked  out  by  pantomime. 

Lopepe  then  assumed  a  diplomatic  air,  and  seemed  to 
hesitate;  but  the  guns  he  caught  sight  of  in  the  gloom 
soon  decided  him,  and  the  plumes  were  given  up. 

Then  the  chief,  who  was  really  a  very  intelligent  fellow, 
made  himself  somewhat  more  agreeable  to  the  three 
whites,  and  to  Bardik  and  Li  he  offered  a  pinch  from  his 
tobacco-pouch,  and  then  sat  down  at  the  bivouac.  A 
glass  of  something  offered  him  by  the  Neapolitan  put  him 
into  excellent  humor,  and  when  he  rose,  after  an  hour  or 
so,  during  which  silence  not  un frequently  reigned  for 
minutes  at  a  time,  it  was  to  invite  the  travelers  to  visit 
him  in  the  morning  at  his  kraal. 


THE  NORTH  OF  THE  LIMPOPO          241 

This  was  promised,  and  after  shaking  hands  Lopepe 
majestically  retired. 

He  had  not  been  gone  long  before  all  in  camp  were 
asleep  except  Cyprien,  who,  wrapped  in  his  blanket,  lay 
gazing  at  the  stars.  There  was  no  moon,  but  the  black 
field  of  the  sky  was  aglow  with  its  glittering  dust. 

He  thought  of  his  people,  who  knew  nothing  of  this 
plunge  of  his  into  the  South  African  desert.  He  thought 
of  Alice,  dearer  than  all  to  him,  who  was,  perhaps,  at 
that  moment  star-gazing,  as  he  was;  and  sinking  deeper 
and  deeper  into  his  reverie,  he  was  about  to  fall  asleep, 
when  a  trampling  of  hoofs,  a  curious  agitation  on  the 
side  where  the  bullock  team  was  parked  for  the  night, 
made  him  wake  up  and  start  to  his  feet. 

In  the  shadow  Cyprien  fancied  he  saw  a  dwarfish 
figure,  more  compact  than  that  of  the  oxen,  and  this  he 
took  to  be  the  cause  of  the  agitation.  Without  a  thought 
as  to  what  he  was  doing,  Cyprien  seized  a  whip  lying 
close  by,  and  stealthily  moved  toward  the  cattle. 

He  was  not  mistaken.  In  their  midst,  come  to  trouble 
their  sleep,  crept  an  intruder.  Hardly  awake,  and  not 
thinking  what  he  did,  Cyprien  raised  the  whip  and 
brought  it  down  with  full  force  on  the  animal's  snout. 

A  fearful  growl  arose  as  the  reply  to  this  sudden  attack. 

It  was  a  lion!  and  the  young  engineer  had  treated  it  as 
if  it  were  a  cur. 

He  had  only  just  time  to  snatch  a  revolver  from  his 
belt  and  step  aside  as  the  lion  came  leaping  on  to  him 
and  seized  his  outstretched  arm.  Cyprien  felt  the  pointed 
teeth  grip  into  his  flesh,  and  was  borne  to  the  ground 
by  the  angry  beast.  Suddenly  there  was  an  explosion, 
the  lion's  body  gave  a  last  writhe,  stiffened,  and  fell  back 
motionless. 

With  the  hand  that  remained  free  Cyprien  had  coolly 
aimed  his  revolver  at  the  monster's  ear,  and  an  explosive 
bullet  had  shattered  its  head. 

The  sleepers,  aroused  by  the  growling  and  the  report, 
came  running  on  to  the  battle-field.  Cyprien  was  half 
crushed  under  the  weight  of  the  beast,  but  his  wounds 
were  merely  superficial.  Li  bathed  them  with  a  little  lint 
steeped  in  brandy,  and  then  the  best  place  on  the  floor  of 
the  wagon  was  given  up  to  the  wounded  man,  and  soon 

Vol.  13  Vern* 


242  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

all   were   again   asleep  except   Bardik,    who   remained   on 
guard  till  the  morning. 

The  day  had  hardly  broken  when  the  voice  of  James 
Hilton,  begging  his  comrades  to  come  to  his  aid,  pro- 
claimed that  something  else  had  happened.  Hilton  was 
lying  fully  dressed  on  the  front  of  the  wagon  across  the 
tarpaulin,  and  in  an  accent  of  the  keenest  terror  told  them, 
without  daring  to  move,  "I  have  got  a  snake  curled 
around  my  right  knee  under  my  trousers.  Don't  move, 
or  I  am  a  lost  man.  But  see  what  you  can  do  for  me." 

His  eyes  were  dilated  by  fright,  and  his  face  was  of 
livid  paleness.  Under  his  trousers  and  around  his  knee 
was  some  foreign  body,  like  a  piece  of  rope  rolled  around 
the  limb. 

The  situation  was  serious.  As  Hilton  had  said,  the 
first  movement  he  made  the  snake  would  strike  him. 

But  amid  the  general  indecision  Bardik  resolved  to 
act.  Having  noiselessly  drawn  his  master's  hunting-knife, 
he  approached  Hilton  by  a  sort  of  worm-like  movement 
that  brought  him  almost  imperceptibly  toward  him. 
Then  with  his  eyes  at  the  level  of  the  snake  he  seemed 
for  some  seconds  to  carefully  study  the  position  of  the 
dangerous  reptile.  Obviously  he  sought  to  discover  how 
the  animal's  head  was  placed. 

Suddenly,  by  a  quick  movement,  he  rose.  His  arm 
dashed  down,  and  the  knife  gleamed  as  it  cut  in  deeply 
across  Hilton's  knee. 

"You  can  knock  off  the  snake.  He  is  dead!"  said 
Bardik,  showing  all  his  teeth  in  a  gigantic  smile. 

Hilton  obeyed  mechanically,  and  shook  his  leg.  The 
reptile  fell  at  his  feet.  It  was  a  viper,  and  had  a  black 
head  about  an  inch  across.  Its  least  bite  meant  death. 
The  young  Kaffir  had  decapitated  it  with  marvelous  pre- 
cision. Hilton's  trousers  had  a  gash  in  them  about  six 
inches  long,  but  his  skin  was  not  even  grazed. 

It  was  a  curious  thing  that  Hilton  did  not  appear  to 
dream  of  thanking  Bardik.  Now  that  he  was  out  of 
danger,  he  seemed  to  consider  the  intervention  quite  as  a 
matter  of  course.  The  idea  never  occurred  to  him  to 
seize  the  Kaffir's  hand  and  tell  him  he  owed  him  his  life. 

"Your  knife  is  very  sharp/'  was  all  he  said,  as  Bardik 


THE  NORTH  OF  THE  LIMPOPO  243 

replaced  it  in  his  sheath,  without  appearing  to  think  very 
much  of  what  he  had  done. 

The  impressions  of  this  eventful  night  all  faded  off 
during  breakfast,  which  on  this  occasion  consisted  of  a 
single  ostrich  egg  cooked  with  butter,  and  quite  sufficient 
to  satisfy  the  appetites  of  the  five  travelers. 

Cyprien  had  a  slight  fever,  and  his  wounds  were  some- 
what painful.  He  insisted,  notwithstanding,  on  joining 
Pantalacci  and  Hilton  in  their  visit  to  Lopepe's  kraal. 
The  camp  was  thus  left  to  Bardik  and  Li,  who  undertook 
to  skin  the  lion — quite  a  monster  of  the  so-called  dog- 
muzzle  species. 

The  Bechuana  chief  awaited  his  guests  at  the  entrance 
of  his  kraal,  surrounded  by  his  warriors.  Behind  them, 
in  the  second  rank,  were  grouped  the  women  and  children, 
eager  with  curiosity  to  look  on  the  strangers.  A  few 
affected  indifference.  Seated  in  front  of  their  hemispheri- 
cal huts  they  continued  at  their  work.  Two  or  three  were 
making  a  net  with  some  long  textile  weeds  twisted  into 
string. 

There  was  a  general  look  of  misery  about  everything, 
although  the  huts  were  fairly  ftuilt.  That  of  Lopepe  was 
raised  a  little  in  the  center  of  the  kraal.  It  was  much 
larger  than  the  others,  and  covered  with  straw  mats. 

The  chief  led  his  guests  inside,  pointed  to  three  stools, 
and  seated  himself  on  one  in  front  of  them,  while  the 
guard  of  honor  formed  a  circle  behind  him. 

The  interview  began  with  the  usual  interchange  of 
civilities;  in  short,  the  ceremonial  mainly  consisted  of 
drinking  a  cup  of  fermented  liquor,  made  by  the  host 
himself,  and  each  time  the  chief,  to  show  that  no  per- 
fidious scheme  lurked  behind,  first  raised  the  cup  to  his 
own  thick  lips  before  passing  it  to  his  visitors.  Not  to 
drink  after  such  a  gracious  invitation  would  have  been 
a  deadly  insult.  The  three  whites  drank  the  Kaffir 
beer,  not  without  violent  grimacing  on  the  part  of  Panta- 
lacci, who  said  in  a  whisper  that  he  would  rather  have 
had  "a  glass  of  spirits  than  this  nasty  brew  of  the 
Bechuanas." 

Business  then  began.  Lopepe  wished  to  buy  a  gun; 
but  this  was  a  satisfaction  they  could  not  grant  him, 
although  he  offered  for  it  a  very  passable  horse,  and  a 


244  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

hundred  and  fifty  pounds  of  ivory.  In  fact,  the  colonial 
edicts  are  very  strict  on  this  point,  and  forbid  Europeans 
disposing  of  any  weapons  to  the  Kaffirs  on  the  frontier, 
except  under  special  authority  from  the  Government.  To 
make  up  for  this,  Lopepe's  guests  had  brought  him  a 
flannel  shirt,  a  steel  chain,  and  a  bottle,  which  constituted 
a  splendid  present,  and  gave  great  pleasure. 

The  Bechuana  chief,  through  Hilton,  was  only  too 
happy  to  furnish  all  the  information  in  his  power.  In 
the  first  place  a  traveler,  answering  in  every  respect  to 
Mataki,  had  passed  the  kraal  five  days  before.  This  was 
the  first  news  the  expedition  had  had  of  the  fugitive  for 
a  fortnight,  and  it  was  received  with  gratitude.  The 
young  Kaffir  had  lost  several  days  searching  for  the  ford 
across  the  Limpopo,  and  now  he  was  making  for  the 
mountains  to  the  north.  Would  it  take  him  many  days 
to  reach  the  mountains?  Seven  or  eight  at  the  least! 

Was  Lopepe  the  friend  of  the  chief  of  the  district  to 
which  Cyprien  and  his  friends  were  going? 

Lopepe  gloried  in  being  so !  Who  would  not  be  the 
friend  and  ally  of  the  great  Tonaia,  the  invincible  con- 
queror of  the  Kaffir  lands? 

Would  Tonaia  give  a  good  welcome  to  the  whites? 

Yes,  because  he  knew,  like  all  the  other  chiefs,  that  the 
whites  never  failed  to  take  vengeance  when  those  belong- 
ing to  them  were  hurt.  What  was  the  good  of  fighting 
the  whites?  Were  they  not  always  the  stronger,  thanks  to 
the  guns  which  loaded  themselves?  The  best  thing  was 
to  remain  at  peace  with  them,  to  receive  them  cordially 
and  trade  loyally. 

Such  was  what  was  ascertained  from  Lopepe.  One 
thing  only  was  of  much  importance,  and  that  was  that 
Mataki  had  lost  several  days  on  the  road,  and  that  they 
were  still  on  his  track. 

On  returning  to  the  camp,  Cyprien,  Pantalacci,  and 
Hilton  found  Li  and  Bardik  considerably  alarmed.  They 
had,  they  said,  received  a  visit  from  a  lot  of  Kaffirs  of  a 
different  tribe  from  that  to  which  Lopepe  belonged,  and 
these  had  subjected  them  to  a  strict  cross-examination. 

"Whence  came  they?  Were  they  not  spying  on  the 
Bechuanas,  collecting  information  about  them,  finding  out 
their  number,  force,  and  equipment?  It  was  not  for 


A  PLOT  245 

strangers  to  engage  in  such  an  enterprise!  The  great 
chief  Tonaia  would  have  nothing  to  say  so  long  as  they 
did  not  enter  his  territory,  but  he  would  look  on  things 
with  a  different  eye  if  they  did  cross  his  frontier." 

This  was  the  general  drift  of  their  remarks.  The 
Chinese  did  not  seem  to  be  unreasonably  scared.  But 
Bardik,  usually  so  composed,  was  suffering  from  quite  a 
serious  fright,  and  this  Cyprien  could  not  understand. 

"Wicked  warriors,"  he  said,  rolling  his  large  eyes, 
"warriors  who  hate  the  whites  and  their  'be-quick'!" 

What  was  to  be  done?  Was  much  importance  to  be 
attributed  to  the  incident?  No!  The  warriors  had  done 
no  harm  and  shown  no  disposition  to  pillage.  Their 
threats  were  harmless.  The  great  chief  Tonaia  only 
wanted  a  few  civil  remarks  and  explanations  as  to  what 
really  had  brought  the  white  men  into  the  country,  and 
all  his  suspicions  would  vanish  and  his  good  wishes  would 
be  gained. 

It  was  agreed  by  all  that  they  should  keep  on.  The 
hope  of  catching  Mataki  and  recovering  the  diamond 
overshadowed  all  other  anxieties.  * 


CHAPTER  XV 

A   PLOT 

IN  another  week  the  expedition  arrived  in  a  country 
which  in  no  way  resembled  that  they  had  traversed  since 
leaving  Griqualand.  They  were  nearing  the  mountain 
chain  to  which  Mataki  had  fled.  The  approach  to  the 
highlands  whence  the  numerous  water-courses  flowed 
down  to  the  Limpopo,  was  signaled  by  a  flora  and  fauna 
differing  entirely  from  those  of  the  plain. 

One  of  the  first  of  these  valleys  was  reached  about 
sunset.  A  river,  so  limpid  that  they  could  see  down  to 
its  bed,  flowed  through  meadows  of  emerald  green.  Fruit 
trees,  with  varied  foliage,  clothed  the  slopes  of  the  hills 
which  circled  around  it.  The  plain  in  the  center  lay  bathed 
in  the  sunshine,  and  beneath  the  shadows  of  the  huge 
baobabs  grazed  herds  of  red  antelopes,  zebras,  and  buffa- 
loes. A  little  farther  off  a  white  rhinoceros  crossed  the 
open,  and  slowly  moved  toward  the  river,  snorting  witli 


246  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

joy  at  the  thought  of  rolling  his  mass  of  flesh  in  the 
cooling  stream.  An  onager  was  braying,  and  a  troop  of 
monkeys  were  chasing  each  other  among  the  trees. 

Cyprien  and  his  two  companions  stopped  on  the  top  of 
the  hill  to  contemplate  the  unaccustomed  scene.  At  last 
they  had  reached  the  virgin  country,  where  the  wild  beast, 
still  the  undisputed  master  of  the  soil,  lived  on  in  happi- 
ness, without  a  suspicion  of  danger.  It  was  not  so  much 
the  number  of  the  animals  that  surprised  the  engineer,  as 
the  wonderful  variety.  It  seemed  like  a  diagram  in  which 
the  painter  had  depicted  each  principal  type  of  the  animal 
kingdom. 

Of  other  inhabitants  there  were  few.  The  Kaffirs  could 
not  but  be  well  scattered  in  a  district  of  such  extent. 
Cyprien  felt  that  his  artistic  and  scientific  instincts  were 
fully  satisfied,  and  allowed  himself  to  think  that  he  had 
been  transported  into  the  pre-historic  age  of  the  mega- 
therium. 

"It  only  wants  a  mammoth  or  two  to  make  the  scene 
complete!"  he  exclaimed. 

And  immediately  Li  extended  his  arm  and  pointed  to 
several  gray  masses  in  the  distance.  From  afar  they 
looked  like  rocks  in  their  motionlessness  and  color.  They 
were  a  troop  of  elephants.  The  plain  was  dotted  with 
them  for  a  space  of  several  miles. 

"You  know  something  about  elephants?"  asked  Cyprien 
of  the  Chinaman  when  they  were  halting  for  the  night. 

Li  blinked  his  little  oblique  eyes.  "I  lived  a  couple  of 
years  in  Ceylon  as  hunter's  help,"  said  he,  with  the 
marked  reserve  he  maintained  as  to  all  that  concerned  his 
biography. 

"If  we  could  only  bring  down  one  or  two!"  exclaimed 
Hilton.  "It  is  excellent  sport." 

"And  the  game  is  worth  the  powder,"  added  Pantalacci. 
"The  tusks  are  excellent  booty,  and  we  might  easily  carry 
three  or  four  dozen  behind  the  wagon.  We  might  pay 
the  costs  of  the  expedition  out  of  them." 

"That  is  an  idea,  and  a  good  one!"  exclaimed  Hilton. 
"Why  should  we  not  have  a  try  tomorrow  before  we 
start?" 

The  question  was  discussed,  and  it  was  decided  that 
they  would  strike  the  camp  at  daylight,  and  try  their  for- 


A  PLOT  247 

tune  in  the  valley  in  which,  they  had  seen  the  elephants. 

As  soon  as  supper  was  over,  they  all  retired  under  the 
tilt  of  the  wagon  with  the  exception  of  Hilton,  whose 
turn  it  was  to  keep  watch.  He  had  been  alone  about  two 
hours,  and  was  beginning  to  nod,  when  he  felt  a  light 
touch  on  his  elbow.  He  opened  his  eyes.  Pantalacci 
was  seated  by  his  side. 

"I  could  not  sleep,  and  I  thought  I  would  keep  you 
company,"  said  the  Neapolitan. 

"It  is  very  kind  of  you,  but  I  could  do  with  a  few 
hours'  sleep,"  answered  Hilton,  stretching  his  arms.  "If 
you  like,  we  can  arrange  matters.  I  will  take  your  place 
under  the  tilt,  and  you  can  stay  here." 

"No,  stop  here.  I  have  something  to  tell  you," 
answered  Pantalacci  in  a  low  voice. 

He  cast  a  glance  around  to  see  that  they  were  alone, 
and  continued,  "Have  you  ever  hunted  an  elephant?" 

"Yes,"  answered  Hilton,  "twice  before." 

"Well,  you  know  it  is  a  very  dangerous  business.  The 
elephant  is  so  ready  and  so  well  armed.  A  man  does  not 
always  get  the  best  of  it  against  him." 

"You  speak  of  the  clumsy  men,"  said  Hilton.  "With 
a  good  gun  and  explosive  bullets  there  is  little  to  fear." 

"So  I  should  think,"  replied  the  Italian.  "But  there 
are  such  things  as  accidents.  Suppose  one  was  to  happen 
to  the  Frenchman  tomorrow;  it  would  be  a  sad  blow  to 
science !" 

"A  great  misfortune!"  said  Hilton,  with  a  laugh. 

"But  for  us  the  misfortune  would  not  be  so  great," 
continued  Pantalacci,  encouraged  by  the  laugh.  "There 
would  only  be  two  of  us  then  to  follow  Mataki  and  his 
diamond,  and  between  us  we  might — " 

The  two  men  remained  silent,  gazing  into  the  fire,  each 
thinking  out  the  dastardly  idea. 

"Yes,"  said  the  Neapolitan;  "two  can  understand  each 
other,  but  three  cannot." 

Again  there  was  silence.  Suddenly  Pantalacci  lifted  his 
head  and  gazed  into  the  darkness  around  him. 

"Did  you  see  anything?"  asked  he  in  a  whisper.  "I 
thought  I  saw  a  shadow  behind  that  baobab." 

Hilton  looked  in  the  direction  indicated,  but  noticed 
nothing  suspicious. 


248  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

"There  is  nothing  there/'  he  said,  "only  the  linen  the 
Chinaman  has  put  out  to  bleach." 

Soon  the  conversation  was  resumed  between  the  con- 
spirators, but  in  a  whisper. 

"I  can  draw  the  cartridges  out  of  his  gun  without  his 
knowing  it,"  said  Pantalacci;  "and  when  we  ride  up  to 
the  elephant,  I  can  fire  behind  him,  so  as  to  attract  the 
brute's  attention  that  way,  and  then  it  would  not  take 
long!" 

Hilton  feebly  objected,  "It  may  not  be  so  easy  as  you 
think." 

"Bah!"  replied  the  Italian.  "Leave  me  alone,  and  you 
will  see." 

An  hour  later,  when  Pantalacci  resumed  his  place 
among  the  sleepers,  he  lighted  a  match  to  assure  himself 
that  no  one  had  moved.  All  was  well.  Cyprien,  Bardik, 
and  the  Chinaman  were  sound  asleep. 

At  least,  they  seemed  to  be.  But  if  the  Italian  had 
been  a  little  more  artful,  he  might  have  suspected  a 
certain  artificiality  about  the  energetic  snoring  of  the 
Chinee. 

At  daybreak  all  were  afoot.  Pantalacci  took  advantage 
of  Cyprien's  bathing  in  the  river  to  extract  the  cartridges 
from  the  gun.  It  took  him  but  twenty  seconds  to  do  this. 
He  was  alone;  Bardik  was  making  the  coffee,  and  Li  was 
collecting  the  clothes  he  had  put  out  to  bleach  on  the 
famous  line  he  had  stretched  between  a  couple  of  baobabs. 
Assuredly  no  one  had  seen  him. 

The  coffee  having  been  finished,  the  party  went  off  on 
horseback,  and  left  Bardik  in  charge  of  the  camp.  Li  had 
asked  to  accompany  the  hunters,  and  armed  himself  with 
his  master's  knife. 

In  less  than  half  an  hour  they  reached  the  spot  where, 
the  evening  before,  they  had  seen  the  elephants.  But 
now  they  had  to  go  farther  on,  out  into  the  open  between 
the  foot  of  the  mountain  and  the  right  bank  of  the  river, 
before  they  came  up  with  them. 

In  the  clear  fresh  atmosphere  illuminated  by  the  rising 
sun,  on  the  wide  stretch  of  verdant  carpet,  wet  with  the 
morning  dew,  a  group  of  elephants,  two  or  three  hundred 
in  number,  were  busy  breakfasting.  The  youngsters  were 
playing  around  their  mothers.  The  old  ones,  with  heads 


A  PLOT  249 

to  the  ground,  swinging  their  trunks  as  they  strolled 
along,  were  quietly  feeding  on  the  thick  grass  of  the 
meadow.  Nearly  all  were  flapping  their  huge  ears  as  if 
they  were  cloaks  of  leather,  fanning  from  side  to  side 
like  Indian  punkahs. 

There  was  in  all  this  calm  domestic  happiness  some- 
thing so  sacred  that  Cyprien  was  profoundly  moved,  and 
asked  his  companions  to  abandon  their  projected  massacre. 

"What  is  the  good  of  killing  the  inoffensive  creatures?" 
he  said.  "Better  leave  them  in  peace." 

But  the  proposition  was  not  to  the  taste  of  Pantalacci. 
"What  is  the  good?"  he  asked,  with  a  grin.  "The  good 
is  to  fill  our  purses,  to  get  a  few  hundredweights  of  ivory! 
Are  you  afraid  of  those  big  fellows,  Mr.  Cyprien?" 

Cyprien  shrugged  his  shoulders,  and  took  no  further 
notice  of  the  impertinence.  As  he  saw  the  Neapolitan  and 
his  companion  continue  their  advance  toward  the  clear- 
ing, he  went  with  them. 

And  now  they  were  within  a  couple  of  hundred  yards 
of  the  elephants.  If,  with  their  fine  sense  of  hearing,  the 
victims  had  not  noticed  their  approach,  it  was  because 
the  wind  blew  toward  the  hunters,  who  were  advancing 
through  a  thick  clump  of  baobab  trees. 

However,  one  of  the  elephants  began  to  show  signs  of 
disquietude,  and  raised  his  trunk  interrogatively. 

"Now  is  the  time,"  said  Pantalacci,  in  a  whisper.  "If 
we  are  to  do  any  good,  we  had  better  scatter;  let  each 
take  his  own  position,  and  we  will  fire  together  at  an 
agreed  signal;  for  at  the  first  shot  the  whole  troop  will 
take  to  flight." 

The  advice  was  adopted.  Hilton  moved  off  to  the 
right,  Pantalacci  to  the  left,  and  Cyprien  remained  in  the 
center.  Then  the  march  toward  the  clearing  was  silently 
resumed. 

At  this  moment  Cyprien  was  much  surprised  to  find 
himself  grasped  in  somebody's  arms,  and  to  hear  the  voice 
of  the  Chinaman,  "I  have  just  jumped  up  behind  you. 
Say  nothing.  You  will  soon  see  why." 

He  had  then  reached  the  edge  of  the  underwood,  and 
found  himself  about  thirty  yards  from  the  elephants. 
Already  he  lifted  his  gun,  to  be  ready  for  what  might 
happen.  As  he  did  so,  the  Chinaman  whispered,  "Your 


250  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

gun  is  not  loaded!  Never  mind.  It's  all  light!"  At 
the  same  instant  there  came  the  sound  of  a  whistle — 
the  signal  of  the  attack — and  immediately  a  gun,  only  one 
gun,  was  fired  behind  Cyprien. 

Turning  quickly,  Cyprien  saw  Pantalacci  gliding  behind 
a  tree.  But  at  the  instant  his  attention  was  called  off  in 
front  of  him. 

One  of  the  elephants  had  been  hit,  and,  infuriated  by 
his  wound,  came  charging  toward  him.  The  others,  as 
the  Neapolitan  had  foretold,  were  off  in  flight  in  a  terrible 
stampede  that  shook  the  ground  for  a  mile  or  more. 

"All  right!"  said  Li,  clutching  tightly  to  Cyprien. 
"When  he  comes  closer,  jump  Templar  aside.  Then  turn 
around  that  bush,  and  cut,  with  the  elephant  after  you.  I 
will  look  after  him!" 

Cyprien  mechanically  obeyed  the  orders.  He  had  barely 
time  to  do  so.  With  trunk  erect,  eyes  shot  with  blood, 
mouth  open,  and  tusks  at  the  charge,  on  came  the  elephant 
with  fearful  speed. 

Templar  behaved  like  an  old  campaigner.  Obeying  the 
pressure  of  the  rider's  knee,  he  executed  a  violent  swerve 
to  the  right,  and  the  elephant  shot  past,  without  touching 
him,  straight  across  the  spot  the  horse  that  moment  had 
left. 

Without  a  word  the  Chinaman  slipped  to  the  ground 
and  leaped  behind  the  bush  he  had  shown  his  master. 

"Here!  here!  Turn  around  the  bush!  Let  him  follow 
you!"  he  shouted. 

The  elephant  rushed  back,  more  furious  than  ever  from 
having  failed  in  his  first  attack.  Cyprien,  though  he  did 
not  understand  Li's  maneuver,  executed  it  most  carefully. 
He  galloped  around  the  bush,  followed  by  the  panting 
elephant,  and  twice  foiled  his  attack  by  a  sudden  swerve. 
But  would  the  maneuver  succeed  in  the  long  run?  Did 
Li  hope  to  tire  out  the  animal? 

This  did  Cyprien  ask  himself,  without  being  able  to 
reply;  when  suddenly,  to  his  great  surprise,  the  elephant 
fell  on  his  knees. 

Li,  with  incomparable  address,  had  seized  on  the  pro- 
pitious moment  glided  from  the  bush  up  to  the  very 
feet  of  the  pursuer,  and  with  one  sweep  of  the  hunting- 
knife  had  cut  the  heel  tendon  which  in  man  is  called  the 


A  PLOT  251 

Achilles.  Such  is  the  usual  practice  of  the  Indian  hunts- 
men, and  the  Chinaman,  thanks  to  his  experience  in  Cey- 
lon, had  been  able  to  deal  the  stroke  with  marvelous  cool- 
ness and  precision. 

Fallen  and  helpless,  the  elephant  remained  without  a 
movement,  with  his  head  laid  down  among  the  grass.  A 
stream  of  blood  flowed  from  his  wound,  and  with  it  his 
strength  flowed  away. 

"Hurrah!  Bravo!"  exclaimed  Pantalacci  and  Hilton, 
appearing  on  the  scene. 

"We  must  finish  him  with  a  shot  in  the  eye,"  said 
Hilton,  who  seemed  to  feel  an  irresistible  desire  to  take 
some  active  part  in  the  drama. 

And  saying  so,  he  shouldered  his  gun  and  fired. 

The  instant  the  explosion  was  heard,  the  bullet  was 
imbedded  in  the  body  of  the  elephant.  Then  came  a  last 
convulsion.  Then  he  remained  motionless,  as  if  he  were 
a  piece  of  gray  rock. 

"All  over!"  exclaimed  Hilton,  riding  close  up  to  the 
animal  to  get  a  better  view  of  him. 

"Wait!  wait!"  said  the  Chinaman,   with  a  look. 

They  had  not  long  to  wait.  As  soon  as  Hilton  reached 
the  elephant,  he  stood  up  in  his  stirrups,  and  in  derision 
tried  to  lift  one  of  the  enormous  ears.  But  the  animal 
by  a  sudden  movement  hurled  aloft  his  trunk,  and  with 
one  mighty  blow  brought  it  down  on  the  hunter,  smash- 
ing his  backbone  and  crushing  his  head  before  the  af- 
frighted witnesses  of  the  horrible  scene  could  snatch  him 
away. 

Hilton  uttered  but  one  sharp  cry  of  pain. 

In  three  seconds  he  was  but  a  mangled  mass  of  flesh, 
on  which  the  elephant  had  fallen,  never  to  rise  again. 

"I  was  sure  he  would  kill  him!"  said  the  Chinaman 
shaking  his  head.  "Elephants  never  fail,  when  they  get 
a  chance." 

Such  was  the  funeral  oration  on  James  Hilton.  The 
young  engineer  thought  of  the  treason  of  which  he  was 
to  have  been  the  victim,  and  could  not  help  recognizing 
in  the  death  a  just  punishment  for  the  share  in  the  plot 
to  deliver  him  over  defenseless  to  the  fury  of  the  angry 
beast.  Whatever  were  the  thoughts  of  the  Neapolitan, 
he  deemed  it  best  to  say  nothing. 


252  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

The  Chinaman  was  already  digging  down  into  the  grass 
of  the  prairie,  and,  with  the  aid  of  a  knife,  scooping  out 
the  grave  in  which,  with  Cyprien's  aid,  the  corpse  was 
placed.  All  this  took  some  time,  and  the  sun  was  high 
above  the  horizon  when  the  three  hunters  returned  to  the 
camp. 

When  they  reached  it,  Bardik  had  disappeared. 


CHAPTER  XVI 

TREASON 

WHAT,  then,  had  passed  in  camp  during  the  absence  of 
Cyprien  and  his  two  companions?  It  was  difficult  to  say, 
for  the  young  Kaffir  did  not  reappear. 

They  waited  for  Bardik,  they  shouted  for  Bardik,  and 
they  looked  for  him  everywhere.  Not  a  trace  of  him 
could  they  find.  The  breakfast  he  had  got  ready  remained 
by  the  fire,  which  had  gone  out,  and  seemed  to  show  that 
he  had  been  away  from  two  to  three  hours. 

Cyprien  was  reduced  to  conjectures,  but  the  conjectures 
did  nothing  toward  an  explanation.  That  the  young 
Kaffir  had  been  attacked  by  some  wild  beast  was  not 
improbable,  but  there  was  not  a  sign  of  any  struggle 
having  taken  place.  That  he  had  deserted  and  gone  back 
to  his  own  country,  as  Kaffirs  often  do,  was  very  unlikely, 
and  the  engineer  absolutely  declined  to  accept  the  hy- 
pothesis when  proffered  by  Pantalacci. 

To  sum  up,  half  a  day  was  spent  in  search,  yet  the 
young  Kaffir  had  not  been  found,  and  his  disappearance 
remained  absolutely  inexplicable. 

Pantalacci  and  Cyprien  took  counsel  together.  They 
decided  to  wait  till  the  next  day  before  they  struck  the 
camp.  Perhaps  in  the  interval  Bardik,  if  he  had  only 
wandered  off,  might  return.  But  in  thinking  matters  over, 
particularly  with  regard  to  the  visit  of  the  Kaffirs  to  one 
of  the  previous  camps,  and  the  questions  they  had  put  to 
Bardik  and  Li,  they  could  hardly  help  asking  if  Bardik 
had  not  fallen  into  the  hands  of  the  natives,  and  been 
taken  by  them  to  their  capital. 

The  day  ended  sadly,  and  the  evening  was  even  more 
lugubrious.  A  breeze  of  misfortune  seemed  to  play  over 


TREASON  253 

the  expedition.  Pantalacci  was  savage  and  dumb.  His 
accomplices,  Friedel  and  Hilton,  were  dead,  and  now  he 
alone  remained  to  face  his  young  rival.  But  he  was  more 
than  ever  resolved  to  get  rid  of  him. 

Cyprien— whom  Li  had  told  all  that  he  had  heard  about 
the  withdrawal  of  the  cartridges — had  now  to  watch 
night  and  day  over  his  traveling  companion,  though  the 
Chinaman  intended  to  share  the  task  with  him. 

Cyprien  and  Pantalacci  passed  the  evening  silently 
smoking,  and  retired  under  the  wagon-tilt  without  even  a 
"good-night."  It  was  Li's  turn  to  watch  near  the  fire 
and  keep  off  the  wild  beasts. 

The  morning  came,  and  the  young  Kaffir  did  not  re- 
turn. Cyprien  would  have  waited  four-and-twenty  hours 
longer,  to  give  his  servant  a  chance  of  rejoining,  but  the 
Neapolitan  insisted  on  an  immediate  departure. 

"We  can  very  well  do  without  Bardik,  and  to  stop 
here  is  to  risk  being  unable  to  rejoin  Mataki." 

Cyprien  gave  in,  and  the  Chinaman  set  to  work  to  put- 
to  the  team.  And  here  came  a  discovery,  and  a  serious 
one.  The  cattle  were  not  to  be  found!  The  evening 
before,  they  had  been  sleeping  in  the  high  grass  around 
the  camp.  Now  they  were  nowhere  visible. 

And  then  they  became  fully  aware  of  the  loss  the  expe- 
dition had  sustained  in  the  person  of  Bardik.  If  that 
intelligent  servant  had  been  at  his  post,  knowing  as  he  did 
the  peculiarities  of  the  South  African  ox,  he  would  not 
have  omitted  tying  up  to  trees  or  pegs  the  beasts  that  had 
had  a  day's  rest.  Usually  when  reaching  the  halting- 
places  after  a  long  march,  the  precaution  was  unnecessary; 
the  tired  cattle  never  thought  of  straying  beyond  the  out- 
skirts of  the  wagon.  But  it  was  different  after  a  day  of 
rest  and  feasting. 

Evidently  the  beasts'  first  care  on  awaking  had  been  to 
seek  for  more  delicate  grasses  than  had  satisfied  them  the 
day  before.  For  the  sake  of  mere  wandering  they  had 
strayed  off  little  by  little,  lost  sight  of  the  camp,  and  then, 
guided  by  that  peculiar  instinct  that  always  leads  them 
home,  were  probably  on  their  way  back  again  to  the 
Transvaal. 

The  disaster  is  not  an  unusual  one  in  Africa,  but  it  is 
none  the  less  serious.  Without  the  team  the  wagon  is 


254  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

useless,  and  the  wagon  is  for  the  traveler  his  house,  hi.> 
store,  and  his  fortress. 

Great  was  the  disappointment  of  Cyprien  and  Pantalacci 
when,  after  a  wild  chase  of  two  or  three  hours  along  the 
track  of  the  cattle,  they  found  they  must  give  up  all  hope 
of  recovery.  The  position  was  thus  changed  greatly  for 
the  worse,  and  another  consultation  was  held. 

Only  one  practical  solution  could  be  arrived  at,  and 
that  was  to  abandon  the  wagon,  take  as  much  provision 
and  ammunition  as  they  could  carry,  and  continue  the 
journey  on  horseback.  If  circumstances  were  propitious, 
they  might  be  able  to  meet  with  some  Kaffir  chief,  and 
from  him  buy  a  new  team.  As  for  Li,  he  could  have 
Hilton's  horse,  which  now  wanted  a  master. 

A  lot  of  the  thorn-tree  branches  were  then  cut  and 
stacked  over  the  wagon,  so  as  to  hide  it  in  a  kind  of  arti- 
ficial bush.  Their  food  and  ammunition  were  stowed 
away  in  their  pockets  and  in  the  large  linen  bag  which 
each  carried.  The  Chinaman,  to  his  great  regret,  had  to 
abandon  the  famous  red  box,  but  he  could  not  tear  him- 
self away  from  his  cord,  and  so  he  coiled  it  around  his 
waist  under  his  shirt  as  if  it  were  a  belt. 

All  being  ready,  the  three  horsemen  gave  a  last  look 
into  the  valley  which  had  been  the  scene  of  such  tragic 
events,  and  then  set  out  for  the  hills.  The  road,  like  the 
others  in  this  country,  was  merely  a  path  formed  by  the 
wild  animals,  who  always  take  the  shortest  road  to  water. 

It  was  past  noon  when  Cyprien,  Pantalacci,  and  Li 
started;  and  beneath  a  burning  sun  they  kept  on  at  a 
good  pace  till  the  evening.  Then  they  camped  in  a  deep 
gorge,  and,  well  sheltered  by  a  rock,  and  seated  around  a 
fire  of  dry  wood,  they  said  to  themselves  that  after  all 
the  loss  of  the  wagon  was  not  irreparable. 

For  two  days  they  continued  their  journey,  fully  per- 
suaded that  they  were  on  the  track  of  him  they  sought. 
And  on  the  evening  of  the  second  day,  just  before  sun- 
down, as  they  were  making  for  a  clump  of  trees  ahead 
of  them,  in  which  to  camp,  Li  uttered  a  guttural  excla- 
mation of,  "Heugh!"  and  pointed  with  his  finger  to  a 
black  figure  which  had  moved  into  view  on  the  horizon  in 
the  streaks  of  the  twilight. 

Cyprien  and  Pantalacci  looked  in  the  direction  indicated 


TREASON  255 

by  the  Chinaman.     "A  traveler!"   remarked  the  Italian. 

"Mataki  himself!"  said  Cyprien,  looking  through  his 
glasses.  "I  can  see  his  carriage  and  his  ostrich." 

And  he  handed  the  glasses  to  Pantalacci  for  him  to 
satisfy  himself  that  it  was  so. 

"How  far  off  is  he?"  asked  Cyprien. 

"Seven  or  eight  miles  at  the  least;  perhaps  ten,"  was 
the  reply. 

"Then  we  must  give  up  any  hope  of  catching  him  to- 
day." 

"Certainly,"  said  Pantalacci.  "In  half  an  hour  it  will 
be  dark,  and  we  could  not  think  of  moving  then." 

"Good!     Tomorrow  we  will  start  early  and  catch  him." 

"That  is  what  I  say." 

The  horsemen  reached  the  trees  and  dismounted.  As 
usual,  they  began  by  carefully  rubbing  down  and  seeing  to 
their  horses  before  tethering  them  where  they  were  to 
feed,  the  Chinaman  being  busy  lighting  the  fire. 

Night  came  on  while  they  were  so  employed.  The  meal 
was  a  little  more  cheerful  perhaps  than  it  had  been  for 
the  last  three  days.  As  soon  as  it  was  over,  the  travelers 
rolled  themselves  in  their  wraps  and  lay  down  by  the  fire, 
with  their  saddles  for  pillows,  to  sleep  till  dawn. 

Cyprien  and  the  Chinaman  were  soon  asleep — not  a 
very  prudent  proceeding  perhaps  on  their  part. 

The  Italian  did  not  sleep.  For  two  or  three  hours  he 
rolled  and  twisted  about  in  his  wrapper  like  a  man  labor- 
ing under  some  fixed  idea.  Temptation  had  again  come 
to  him.  At  last  he  could  withstand  it  no  longer.  He 
rose  stealthily  and  silently,  went  to  the  horses,  and  saddled 
his  own;  then  setting  free  Templar  and  the  Chinaman's 
horse,  he  led  them  after  him.  The  grass  which  carpeted 
the  ground  stifled  the  sound  of  the  hoofs,  and  the  animals 
followed  in  stupid  resignation  at  being  so  suddenly  awak- 
ened. Pantalacci  took  them  down  into  the  valley  below 
the  camp,  fastened  them  to  a  tree,  and  returned.  Neither 
of  the  sleepers  had  moved. 

He  took  his  rifle,  his  ammunition,  and  some  provisions. 
Then  he  coolly  and  deliberately  abandoned  his  comrades 
in  the  desert. 

The  idea  which  had  possessed  him  since  sundown  had 
been  that  by  seizing  the  horses  Cyprien  and  Li  would  be 


256  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

prevented  from  reaching  Mataki.  He  thus  made  sure  of 
victory.  Neither  the  odious  character  of  the  treason,  nor 
the  utter  heartlessness  of  the  robbery,  had  any  influence 
over  him.  He  descended  the  slope,  jumped  into  the 
saddle,  and  rode  off  with  the  two  horses  in  the  first  rays 
of  the  rising  moon,  that  was  just  peeping  over  the  distant 
hills. 

Cyprien  and  Li  slept  on.  About  three  o'clock  in  the 
morning  the  Chinaman  opened  his  eyes,  gazed  at  the 
stars  growing  dim  on  the  eastern  horizon,  and  said  to 
himself,  "It  is  time  to  get  the  coffee!" 

And  immediately  he  threw  off  his  blanket,  jumped  up, 
and  set  about  his  morning  toilet,  which  in  the  desert,  as 
in  the  town,  was  anything  but  elaborate. 

"Where  is  Pantalacci?"  he  asked  himself  as  he  glanced 
around. 

The  day  had  begun  to  break,  and  the  objects  around 
were  growing  clearer  in  the  light. 

"The  horses  are  not  there!"  said  Li  to  himself.  "Per- 
haps our  gallant  friend  has — " 

And  suspecting  what  had  happened,  he  ran  up  to  the 
pegs  to  which  he  had  seen  the  horses  tethered  the  night 
before.  Then  he  ran  back  to  the  camp,  and  at  a  glance 
assured  himself  that  the  Neapolitan's  baggage  had  gone 
with  him. 

There  could  be  no  mistake. 

A  white  man  would  probably  have  been  unable  to  resist 
the  temptation  of  waking  Cyprien  to  tell  him  the  impor- 
tant news.  But  the  Chinese  was  of  the  tawny  race,  and 
thought  there  was  no  need  to  hurry  in  telling  bad  news. 
And  he  quietly  set  to  work  to  get  the  coffee,  remarking 
as  he  did  so,  "It  was  very  kind  of  the  gentleman  to  leave 
a  little  behind  him!" 

The  coffee  having  been  strained  through  the  linen  bag 
he  had  made  for  it,  Li  filled  two  cups  cut  out  of  ostrich 
eggs,  and  went  up  to  Cyprien,  who  was  still  asleep. 
"Here  is  your  coffee,  Pa,"  said  he,  touching  him  on  the 
shoulder. 

Cyprien  opened  his  eyes,  stretched  his  limbs,  smiled  at 
the  Chinaman,  drew  himself  up,  and  drank  the  steaming 
liquor. 


TREASON  257 

It  was  not  till  then  that  he  noticed  the  absence  of  the 
Italian.  "Where  is  Pantalacci?"  he  asked. 

"Gone  away,"  answered  Li,  in  the  most  natural  way 
in  the  world,  as  if  there  was  nothing  at  all  unusual  in 
his  doing  so. 

"What!     Gone  away?" 

"Yes,  Pa — with  the  three  horses." 

Cyprien  threw  off  his  rug  and  gave  a  glance  around, 
which  told  him  everything. 

But  he  was  too  proud  to  show  his  anxiety  or  his  anger. 
"Very  well,"  he  said.  "The  fellow  fancies  he  has  seen 
the  last  of  us,  I  suppose;"  and  he  walked  briskly  to  and 
fro,  and  thought.  "We  must  be  off  at  once,"  he  said  to 
the  Chinaman.  "We  must  leave  the  saddles  and 
bridles,  and  all  that  would  encumber  us,  and  take  only 
the  guns  and  the  food  we  have  left.  We  may  get  on 
quicker  unmounted,  and  perhaps  find  the  shortest  roads." 

Li  hastened  to  obey.  In  a  few  minutes  the  rugs  were 
rolled  up  and  the  bags  shouldered,  and  then  all  that  it 
was  necessary  to  abandon  were  heaped  together  and 
hidden  under  a  pile  of  brushwood. 

Cyprien  was  right  in  supposing  that,  under  certain 
circumstances,  it  would  be  better  to  travel  on  foot.  He 
could  go  a  nearer  way,  and  climb  heights  that  a  horse 
was  unequal  to,  but  at  the  cost  of  what  fatigue! 

About  one  o'clock  in  the  afternoon  they  reached  the 
northern  slope  of  the  chain  they  had  been  following  for 
three  days.  According  to  the  information  given  by 
Lopepe,  they  could  not  be  very  far  from  Tonaia's  capital. 
Unfortunately  in  the  Bechuana  language  the  indications 
were  so  vague  as  to  the  route  to  follow  and  the  distance, 
that  Cyprien  was  not  sure  if  he  had  to  travel  two  days 
or  five  days  before  he  reached  the  kraal. 

As  he  and  Li  were  descending  into  the  first  valley, 
after  crossing  the  ridge,  the  latter  gave  a  short,  sharp 
laugh.  "Giraffes!"  he  said. 

Cyprien  looked  below  and  saw  about  a  score  of  these 
animals  feeding  in  the  valley.  Nothing  could  be  more 
graceful  from  afar  than  their  long  necks,  held  upright 
like  masts,  or  thrust  like  long  serpents  into  the  herbage 
for  two  or  three  yards  from  their  brown-spotted  bodies. 

Vol.  18  Verne 


258  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

"We  might  catch  one  of  those  things  to  take  the  place 
of  Templar,"  observed  Li. 

"Ride  a  giraffe!  Whoever  saw  such  a  thing?"  ex- 
claimed Cyprien. 

"I  do  not  know  if  any  one  ever  saw  it,  but  that  is  no 
reason  why  you  shouldn't  see  it,"  answered  the  Chinaman. 
"And  so  you  shall,  if  you  let  me  try!" 

Cyprien,  who  had  begun  by  thinking  it  impossible, 
ended  by  promising  to  help. 

"We  are  to  leeward  of  the  giraffes,"  said  Li;  "that  is 
lucky,  for  they  have  very  quick  noses,  and  would  have 
smelled  us.  You  go  away  to  the  right  and  frighten  them 
with  the  report  of  the  gun,  so  as  to  drive  them  this  way, 
and  I  will  look  after  the  rest." 

Cyprien  dropped  on  the  ground  all  that  could  hamper 
his  movements,  and  hurried  off. 

Li  lost  but  little  time.  He  ran  down  the  valley  and 
reached  a  track  along  the  bottom.  This  was  evidently 
that  used  by  the  giraffes,  for  it  was  all  marked  with  their 
hoofs.  The  Chinaman  took  up  his  position  behind  a  large 
tree.  He  then  unwound  his  long  cord,  which  he  was 
never  without,  and,  cutting  it  in  two,  made  two  lengths, 
each  of  about  a  hundred  feet.  To  one  end  of  each  of 
these  he  tied  a  heavy  pebble,  and  the  other  ends  he  hitched 
to  the  lower  branches  of  the  tree.  Then  he  coiled  the 
free  ends  over  his  arm,  stepped  behind  the  tree,  and 
waited. 

Five  minutes  had  barely  elapsed  when  the  report  of  a 
gun  sounded  some  distance  off.  Instantly  a  swift  tramp- 
ling began,  as  of  a  squadron  of  cavalry  at  the  charge,  and 
this  increased  from  moment  to  moment,  and  announced 
that  the  giraffes  were  coming,  as  Li  expected.  They  came 
right  down  on  him  along  the  track,  little  suspecting  what 
was  awaiting  them. 

With  their  nostrils  dilated,  their  heads  bristling,  and 
their  tongues  hanging  out,  the  giraffes  looked  really 
superb,  but  Li  had  something  else  to  do  than  admire  them. 
His  post  had  been  judiciously  chosen  at  a  narrowing  of 
the  way,  where  the  animals  could  only  pass  two  abreast, 
and  where  they  would  be  sure  to  crowd. 

He  let  two  or  three  go  by.  Then,  picking  out  one  of 
extraordinary  size,  he  flung  his  first  cord.  It  whistled  as 


TREASON  259 

it  flew  and  swung  around  the  victim's  neck.  Suddenly 
the  cord  stretched,  squeezed  the  throat,  and  pulled  the 
giraffe  up  short. 

The  Chinaman  lost  no  time  in  looking  on.  Scarcely 
had  he  seen  his  first  cord  strike  than  he  launched  the 
second,  and  brought  down  another  giraffe. 

All  was  over  in  half  a  minute.  The  frightened  herd 
escaped  in  all  directions,  and  two  half -strangled  giraffes 
remained  prisoners. 

"Come  on,  Pa!"  shouted  the  Chinaman,  as  Cyprien  ran 
up,  rather  doubtful  of  the  success  of  the  scheme. 

But  the  evidence  was  too  much  for  him.  There  were 
two  magnificent  animals,  strong,  fleshy,  with  splendid 
hams  and  lustrous  necks.  But  Cyprien  thought  only  of 
admiring  them;  to  ride  them  did  not  seem  possible. 

"How  can  you  hang  on  a  ridge  which  slopes  at  thirty 
degrees?"  asked  he,  with  a  laugh. 

"By  sitting  on  the  shoulders,  and  not  on  the  flanks," 
answered  Li.  "Besides,  we  can  roll  up  a  blanket  to  put 
under  the  saddle." 

"We  have  not  got  a  saddle." 

"I  will  soon  find  you  one." 

"And  what  is  your  bridle  to  be?" 

"You'll  see."  The  Chinese  had  a  reply  for  every  ques- 
tion, and  with  him  acts  and  words  were  not  far  apart. 

The  dinner-hour  had  not  arrived  before,  with  part  of 
his  cord,  he  had  made  two  strong  halters,  which  he 
slipped  over  the  giraffes.  The  poor  beasts  were  so  fright- 
ened at  their  misfortune,  and  were,  besides,  so  gentle  in 
disposition,  that  they  made  no  resistance.  The  other  end 
of  the  cord  did  for  reins.  This  being  finished,  nothing 
was  easier  than  to  lead  off  the  prisoners.  Cyprien  and  Li 
went  back  to  the  camp  and  repossessed  themselves  of  the 
saddles  and  other  articles  they  had  abandoned. 

By  the  evening  everything  was  arranged.  The  China- 
man was  a  marvel  of  cleverness.  Not  only  did  he  alter 
Cyprien's  saddle  so  that  it  would  seat  him  horizontally 
on  the  giraffe,  but  he  made  himself  a  saddle  of  twigs; 
and  took  the  precaution  of  breaking  in  the  giraffes  during 
half  the  night,  mounting  first  one  and  then  the  other, 
accustoming  them  to  the  rein,  and  teaching  them  that 
henceforth  they  must  obey. 


26o  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 


CHAPTER  XVII 

AN    AFRICAN    STEEPLECHASE 

THE  aspect  of  the  horsemen — or  rather  the  giraffemen 
— when  they  started  in  the  morning,  was  curious  in  the 
extreme.  It  is  very  doubtful  if  Cyprien  would  have  cared 
to  have  appeared  in  such  guise  before  Miss  Watkins  in 
the  chief  street  of  Vandergaart  Kopje.  But  in  Rome, 
people  must  do  as  do  the  Romans.  Our  hero  was  in 
the  desert,  and  giraffes  were  just  as  good  mounts  as 
dromedaries.  Their  gait  was  very  much  the  same.  Their 
backs  were  horribly  hard,  and  they  rolled  and  pitched  in 
a  way  that  nearly  made  their  riders  sea-sick. 

In  two  or  three  hours  Cyprien  and  the  Chinee  were 
sufficiently  acclimatized,  and  after  a  few  attempts  at  re- 
bellion, which  were  promptly  suppressed,  the  giraffes  be- 
came quite  docile,  and  sped  along  at  a  rapid  pace. 

The  object  now  was  to  hurry  on  as  much  as  possible, 
so  as  to  make  up  for  the  time  lost  during  the  last  three 
or  four  days.  Had  Pantalacci  caught  Mataki?  Cyprien 
resolved  that  nothing  should  keep  him  from  reaching  him. 

On  the  third  day  the  giraffemen  entered  the  plains. 
They  were  following  the  right  bank  of  a  much-winding- 
water-course  which  flowed  to  the  northward,  and  was 
probably  one  of  the  secondary  affluents  of  the  Zambesi. 
The  giraffes,  thoroughly  subdued  and  weakened  by  the 
long  stages  and  spare  diet  to  which  Li  subjected  them, 
were  driven  with  the  greatest  ease.  Cyprien  could  even 
let  go  the  rope  reins,  and  direct  his  steed  by  the  mere 
pressure  of  his  knee.  Free  from  anxiety  as  to  his  mount, 
he  took  a  good  deal  of  pleasure  in  noticing  around  him 
the  traces  of  advancing  civilization.  In  one  unbroken 
series  there  stretched  away  fields  of  manioc  or  taro,  care- 
fully tended,  properly  irrigated  by  means  of  bamboos 
placed  end  to  end,  and  reached  by  broad  and  well-made 
roads.  In  fact,  the  district  had  an  air  of  general  pros- 
perity. On  the  hills  which  bordered  the  horizon  there 
appeared  the  groups  of  white  huts,  built  of  rushes,  which 
served  as  the  homes  of  its  scattered  population. 

One  thing  that  showed  they  were  nearly  out  of  the 
desert  was  the  extraordinary  number  of  wild  animals 


AN  AFRICAN  STEEPLECHASE  261 

peopling  the  plain.  Here  and  there  innumerable  swarms 
of  birds,  of  all  sizes  and  species,  darkened  the  air.  Herds 
of  antelopes  and  gazelles  crossed  the  road  before  them. 
Occasionally  a  monstrous  hippopotamus  lifted  his  head  in 
the  river,  brayed  noisily,  and  plunged  again  beneath  the 
stream  with  a  sounding  splash. 

The  last  thing  in  Cyprien's  thoughts  was  what  greeted 
his  eyes  as  he  turned  the  flank  of  one  of  the  small  hills. 
This  was  no  less  than  Pantalacci  at  full  gallop  in  pursuit 
of  Mataki!  About  a  mile  separated  the  men  from  each 
other,  and  Cyprien  and  Li  were  some  four  miles  behind 
the  Italian. 

The  delight  of  the  latter  was  unbounded.  Cyprien  gave 
a  loud  "Hurrah!"  Li  a  sounding  "Hyugh!"  meaning  the 
same  thing,  and  then  they  put  their  giraffes  at  the  trot. 

Evidently  Mataki  had  seen  the  Neapolitan,  who  had 
begun  to  gain  on  him,  though  he  could  not  see  his  old 
master  and  his  companion,  who  were  still  too  far  off  over 
the  plain. 

The  young  Kaffir,  at  sight  of  Pantalacci — who  was 
not  a  man  to  give  quarter,  and  who,  without  waiting  for 
explanations,  might  kill  him  like  a  dog — hurried  along 
furiously  in  his  ostrich  cart.  The  swift  bird  almost  flew 
over  the  ground.  It  flew  at  such  a  rate  that  it  suddenly 
crashed  up  against  a  large  stone.  The  shock  was  so  vio- 
lent that  the  axletree  broke,  one  of  the  wheels  slipped  off, 
and  Mataki  and  the  bits  of  his  chariot  were  scattered  in 
the  road. 

The  unfortunate  Kaffir  was  dreadfully  injured  by  his 
fall,  but  the  fright  that  possessed  him  was  only  thereby 
increased.  Convinced  that  he  would  be  killed,  if  caught 
by  the  Italian,  he  picked  himself  up,  caught  the  ostrich, 
jumped  astride  of  its  back,  and  sped  off  at  a  run. 

And  then  began  an  exciting  steeplechase,  such  as  the 
world  had  never  seen  since  the  days  of  the  Roman  hippo- 
drome, when  ostrich  and  giraffe  races  formed  part  of  the 
program.  While  Pantalacci  chased  Mataki,  Cyprien  and 
Li  chased  them  both.  They  wanted  the  Kaffir  for  the 
sake  of  the  stolen  diamond,  they  wanted  the  Italian  to 
settle  accounts  with  him  for  his  cowardly  treachery. 

The  giraffes  were  given  the  reins.  They  swept  along, 
almost  as  fast  as  thorough-bred  horses,  as  with  their  long 


262  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

necks  stretched  out,  their  mouths  open,  their  ears  flung 
back,  they  were  spurred  and  whipped  to  their  topmost 
speed. 

Mataki's  ostrich  proved  a  prodigy.  No  winner  of  the 
Derby  would  have  had  a  chance  against  him.  His  short 
wings,  though  useless  for  flying,  helped  him  greatly.  So 
fast  did  he  speed  over  the  ground  that  in  a  few  minutes 
the  young  Kaffir  had  regained  all  he  had  lost. 

Mataki  had  chosen  his  mount  well  when  he  took  the 
ostrich.  If  he  could  only  keep  up  as  he  was  going  for 
another  quarter  of  an  hour,  he  would  be  safe  from  the 
Italian's  claws. 

Pantalacci  saw  that  the  slightest  halt  would  lose  him 
all  his  advantage.  Already  the  distance  between  him  and 
the  fugitive  had  sensibly  increased.  Beyond  the  mealy- 
field  through  which  they  were  racing,  a  thick  mass  of 
lentisks  and  Indian  figs  lay  waving  in  the  wind  and  bound- 
ing the  view.  If  Mataki  once  reached  it,  he  would  escape, 
as  it  would  be  impossible  to  keep  him  in  sight. 

At  full  gallop  Cyprien  and  the  Chinee  followed  in  chase. 
They  reached  the  foot  of  the  hill;  they  were  tearing 
across  the  field;  but  three  miles  still  separated  them  from 
the  Kaffir's  pursuer. 

They  could  see  that  by  a  great  effort  the  Italian  had 
gained  a  little  on  the  fugitive.  Whether  it  was  that  the 
ostrich  was  exhausted,  or  had  hurt  itself  against  a  stone, 
its  speed  had  greatly  slackened.  Pantalacci  was  not  more 
than  three  hundred  feet  from  the  Kaffir. 

But  Mataki  had  reached  the  edge  of  the  wood.  Sud- 
denly he  disappeared,  and  at  the  same  moment  Pantalacci 
was  violently  thrown,  and  his  horse  bolted. 

"Mataki  has  escaped!"  said  Li. 

"Yes;    but  Pantalacci  is  ours!"  answered  Cyprien. 

And  they  pressed  on  their  giraffes  still  faster. 

In  half  an  hour  they  had  nearly  crossed  the  mealy-field, 
and  were  only  five  hundred  yards  from  where  the  Italian 
had  come  to  grief.  Had  he  gained  the  wood,  or  did  he 
lie  on  the  ground  grievously  wounded — or  perhaps  dead? 

The  unhappy  man  was  where  he  had  fallen.  A  hundred 
paces  from  him  Cyprien  and  Li  reined  up  their  giraffes. 
And  this  is  what  they  saw. 

In   the  ardor  of  his   pursuit   the   Neapolitan   had   not 


AN  AFRICAN  STEEPLECHASE  263 

noticed  a  gigantic  net  which  had  been  set  by  the  Kaffirs 
to  catch  the  birds  that  wage  incessant  war  on  their  crops. 
In  this  net  Pantalacci  had  become  entangled. 

And  it  was  not  a  small  net.  It  measured  at  least  fifty 
yards  along  the  side,  and  already  contained  several  thou- 
sand birds  of  all  sizes  and  plumage,  and  among  them 
half  a  dozen  of  those  enormous  vultures,  a  yard  and  a 
half  from  wing-tip  to  wing-tip,  which  abound  in  South 
Africa.  When  the  Neapolitan  fell  into  their  midst,  the 
birds  were  naturally  alarmed. 

Pantalacci  was  stunned  for  a  moment  by  his  fall.  Then 
he  tried  to  rise.  But  his  feet,  legs,  and  hands  were  en- 
tangled in  the  meshes  of  the  net,  and  he  could  not  at 
first  disengage  them. 

He  had  not  much  time  to  lose.  He  gave  such  terrible 
kicks  and  wrenches  that  he  tore  up  the  net  from  the  pegs 
that  fixed  it  to  the  ground.  At  the  same  time  the  birds, 
big  and  little,  endeavored  to  escape. 

But  the  more  the  Italian  struggled,  the  more  he  was 
wrapped  in  the  meshes.  And  a  crowning  humiliation  was 
in  store  for  him.  One  of  the  giraffes  came  up — the  one 
that  bore  the  Chinaman.  Li  jumped  to  the  ground,  and 
thinking  that  the  best  way  to  secure  the  prisoner  was  to 
roll  him  in  the  net,  kicked  it  off  the  pegs  in  front  of  him, 
and  began  to  throw  it  over. 

But  a  most  extraordinary  thing  happened.  There  came 
a  tremendous  gust  of  wind,  bending  down  the  trees  as  if 
a  water-spout  were  sweeping  over  the  ground.  Pantalacci 
in  his  struggles  had  torn  the  net  from  many  of  the  pegs, 
and  seeing  himself  on  the  point  of  capture,  made  a  des- 
perate effort  to  get  free.  With  a  violent  wrench  the  last 
peg  was  torn  up,  and  the  feathered  colony  that  the  net 
held  down  took  flight  with  noisy  tumult. 

The  small  birds  escaped,  but  the  large  ones  were  caught 
in  the  meshes  by  their  talons  at  the  same  time  as  they 
spread  their  wings  for  flight,  and  together  rose.  All  these 
aerial  paddles  and  pectoral  muscles  working  together, 
helped  by  the  fury  of  the  squall,  formed  so  colossal  a 
power  that  a  hundredweight  was  but  a  featherweight  to  it. 

The  net,  rolled  and  heaped  and  entangled  on  itself, 
became  the  sport  of  the  wind,  and,  with  Pantalacci  hang- 


264  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

ing  to  it  by  his  wrists  and  hands,  rose  thirty  yards  from 
the  ground. 

Cyprien  arrived  as  the  net  rose,  and  beheld  his  enemy 
flying  up  to  the  clouds. 

The  vultures,  tiring  at  their  first  effort,  began  to  de- 
scend, describing  a  long  parabola  as  they  did  so.  In  three 
seconds  they  had  reached  the  lentisks  and  Indian  figs  to 
the  west  of  the  mealy-field.  Then,  having  shaved  the  tops 
of  the  bushes  at  about  a  dozen  feet  from  the  ground,  they 
rose  again  into  the  air. 

Cyprien  and  Li  looked  on  with  horror  at  the  sight  of 
the  unfortunate  man  borne  upward  for  a  hundred  and 
fifty  feet  by  the  prodigious  efforts  of  the  vultures  and  the 
force  of  the  breeze. 

Suddenly  a  few  meshes  broke,  and  the  Italian  clutched 
wildly  at  the  cords.  But  his  hands  missed  their  hold,  and 
he  fell  in  a  heap  to  the  earth. 

The  net,  freed  from  his  weight,  shot  up  in  the  air,  and 
was  soon  shaken  off  by  the  vultures. 

When  Cyprien  reached  him,  his  enemy  was  dead — killed 
in  this  horrible  way. 

And  now  there  remained  but  one  of  the  four  rivals  who 
had  started  on  the  Kaffir  chase  across  the  Transvaal. 


CHAPTER  XVIII 

THE   TALKING    OSTRICH 

AFTER  this  dreadful  catastrophe  Cyprien  and  Li  thought 
only  of  hurrying  from  the  spot  as  quickly  as  possible. 

They  skirted  the  north  edge  of  the  wood,  and  after  an 
hour's  walk  reached  the  bed  of  a  torrent,  which  was  then 
dry.  The  torrent-bed  formed  a  path  through  the  lentisks 
and  figs.  Into  it  they  turned. 

There  a  fresh  surprise  awaited  them.  The  torrent  led 
into  a  good-sized  lake,  surrounded  with  luxuriant  vegeta- 
tion. Cyprien  tried  to  follow  the  banks,  but  these  were 
in  places  too  steep. 

To  return  by  the  road  he  had  come  would  have  been  to 
give  up  all  hope  of  catching  Mataki ;  and  as  on  the  other 
side  of  the  lake  there  were  ranges  of  hills  leading  up  to 
mountains  of  considerable  height,  the  travelers  set  off 


THE  TALKING  OSTRICH  265 

around  the  sheet  of  water  in  the  hope  that  they  would  there 
obtain  a  good  view  over  the  surrounding  district.  The 
absence  of  any  road  made  the  operation  a  somewhat  diffi- 
cult one,  owing  to  their  having  occasionally  to  dismount 
and  lead  the  giraffes  by  the  bridle.  It  took  them  more 
than  three  hours  to  advance  five  miles  as  the  crow  flies. 

When  they  reached  the  point  on  the  other  side  of  the 
lake  opposite  to  that  they  had  started  from,  night  came 
on;  and,  thoroughly  tired  out,  they  decided  to  camp.  But 
with  their  scanty  resources  they  could  not  be  very  com- 
fortable. 

Li  busied  himself  with  his  usual  zeal,  and  did  what  he 
could,  but  the  result  was  not  encouraging. 

"You  are  very  tired,  Pa!"  said  he,  sympathizingly. 
"Our  provisions  have  nearly  all  gone!  Let  me  go  off  in 
search  of  something  to  some  village  close  by.  I  am  sure 
to  bring  somebody  to  help  you." 

"Leave  me,  Li?"  asked  Cyprien. 

"It  is  necessary  that  I  should,"  said  the  Chinaman.  "I 
will  take  one  of  the  giraffes  and  strike  off  to  the  north. 
Tonaia's  town  that  Lopepe  spoke  of  cannot  be  far  off,  and 
I  will  manage  it  so  that  they  will  welcome  you.  Then  we 
can  go  back  to  Griqualand,  where  you  need  no  longer 
trouble  yourself  about  the  three  scoundrels  that  have 
died." 

Cyprien  thought  over  the  Chinaman's  proposition.  He 
saw  that  if  the  Kaffir  was  to  be  caught,  it  would  be  in  this 
neighborhood;  consequently  it  would  not  do  to  leave  it. 
On  the  other  hand,  more  provisions  must  be  obtained. 
And  so  he  with  great  regret  decided  to  separate  from  Li 
and  wait  where  he  was  for  forty-eight  hours.  In  that 
time  the  Chinaman  on  his  giraffe  would  be  able  to  secure 
assistance  and  return. 

Li  did  not  delay  an  instant.  Thinking  nothing  of  his 
own  rest,  and  abandoning  all  idea  of  sleep,  he  wished 
Cyprien  good-bye,  kissed  his  hand,  jumped  on  his  giraffe, 
and  disappeared  in  the  night. 

For  the  first  time  since  his  departure  from  Vandergaart 
Kopje  Cyprien  found  himself  alone  in  the  desert.  He  felt 
profoundly  miserable,  and  as  he  lay  rolled  in  his  blanket, 
gave  himself  over  to  the  gloomiest  thoughts.  Isolated, 
almost  without  food  and  ammunition,  what  was  to  become 


266  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

of  him  in  this  unknown  country,  hundreds  of  miles  away 
from  civilization?  The  chance  of  catching  Mataki  was 
now  a  very  feeble  one.  He  might  be  only  half  a  mile 
from  him,  and  yet  be  ignorant  of  his  whereabouts.  The 
whole  expedition  had  been  disastrous.  Every  hundred 
miles  had  cost  the  death  of  one  of  its  members.  One  only 
remained — himself!  Was  he  destined  to  die  miserably, 
like  the  others? 

Such  were  Cyprien's  reflections  as  he  gradually  fell 
asleep. 

The  freshness  of  the  morning  and  the  night's  rest  gave 
a  more  confident  tone  to  his  thoughts  when  he  awoke. 
While  waiting  for  the  Chinaman's  return  he  resolved  to 
ascend  the  mountain  at  the  foot  of  which  he  had  camped. 
He  could  from  the  summit  command  an  extensive  view, 
and  might  with  the  help  of  his  glasses  discover  some  trace 
of  Mataki.  But  to  do  so  he  had  to  leave  his  giraffe,  for 
no  naturalist  has  as  yet  grouped  that  animal  with  the 
climbers. 

He  began  by  taking  off  the  halter  so  ingeniously  con- 
trived by  Li.  One  end  of  it  he  tied  to  the  animal's  leg, 
the  other  to  a  tree  surrounded  by  long  luscious  grass ;  and 
he  left  sufficient  length  for  the  giraffe  to  feed  at  its  ease. 
And  if  we  add  to  the  length  of  the  rope  the  length  of  the 
giraffe's  neck  we  must  admit  that  very  little  rope  was 
required  to  give  it  an  ample  radius  of  action. 

Having  secured  his  mount,  Cyprien  threw  his  gun  on  to 
one  shoulder  and  his  blanket  on  to  the  other,  and,  giving 
the  giraffe  a  friendly  pat  in  token  of  farewell,  began  the 
ascent  of  the  mountain. 

The  ascent  was  long  and  difficult.  The  whole  of  the 
day  was  passed  in  scaling  its  steep  slopes,  turning  its  rocks 
and  unclimbable  peaks,  and  recommencing  on  the  east  or 
south  an  attempt  made  unsuccessfully  on  the  north  or 
west.  When  the  night  came,  Cyprien  had  only  got  half- 
way up,  and  he  had  to  wait  till  morning  to  continue  the 
ascent. 

Starting  at  daybreak,  after  assuring  himself  by  means 
of  his  glasses  that  Li  had  not  returned  to  the  camp,  he 
reached  the  top  of  the  mountain  about  eleven  o'clock. 
There  a  cruel  deception  awaited  him.  The  summit  was 
wrapped  in  cloud,  and  a  thick  mist  hung  over  its  lower 


THE  TALKING  OSTRICH  267 

flanks.  In  vain  Cyprien  tried  to  pierce  the  curtain  and 
see  down  into  the  neighboring  valleys.  The  whole  dis- 
trict had  disappeared,  covered  with  a  mantle  of  shapeless 
vapor  which  hid  everything  beneath  it. 

Cyprien  was  obstinate,  and  waited,  hoping  the  fog 
would  clear  off.  He  hoped  in  vain.  As  the  day  wore  on, 
the  clouds  grew  in  density,  and  when  night  came,  the 
mist  turned  to  rain.  He  was  on  a  bare  plateau  with  not  a 
single  tree  or  rock  to  shelter  him,  and  night  coming  on, 
with  an  increasing  downpour  of  fine  steady  rain  that 
gradually  soaked  through  his  blanket  and  his  clothes,  and 
wet  him  to  the  skin. 

Matters  were  growing  serious.  To  descend  under  such 
circumstances  would  have  been  foolish.  Cyprien  made  up 
his  mind  to  shiver  in  the  rain  all  night,  and  dry  himself 
in  the  morning  in  the  sun. 

The  rain  was  most  refreshing  after  the  drought  that  had 
preceded  it,  and  Cyprien  soon  persuaded  himself  that 
there  was  nothing  very  disagreeable  about  it  after  all. 
One  of  its  most  unpleasant  consequences  was  that  he 
would  have  to  eat  his  dinner  uncooked.  To  light  a  fire, 
or  even  a  match,  in  such  weather  was  out  of  the  question, 
and  so  he  had  to  content  himself  with  opening  a  tin  of 
meat  and  eating  it  as  he  found  it. 

In  an  hour  or  two,  in  a  half-torpid  state  from  the  con- 
tinual rain,  he  fell  asleep  on  a  large  stone  for  a  pillow  and 
his  dripping  blanket  for  a  bed.  When  he  awoke,  he  was 
in  a  high  state  of  fever. 

Knowing  that  he  was  lost,  if  he  remained  any  longer 
beneath  the  deluge — for  the  rain  was  still  falling  in  tor- 
rents— Cyprien  made  an  effort,  rose  to  his  feet,  and,  using 
his  gun  as  a  stick,  began  the  descent  of  the  mountain. 

How  did  he  reach  the  bottom?  It  would  have  puzzled 
him  to  say.  Sometimes  gliding  down  the  greasy  slope, 
sometimes  scrambling  down  the  slippery  rocks,  bruised 
and  breathless,  and  weakened  by  the  fever,  he  kept  on  his 
downward  way,  and  about  noon  reached  the  camp  where 
he  had  left  the  giraffe. 

The  animal  had  gone,  impatient  probably  at  having 
been  left  alone,  and  perhaps  pinched  with  hunger,  for  the 
grass  within  the  circle  of  which  the  halter  formed  the 


268  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

radius   had    all    been    cropped.      The    giraffe    had    bitten 
through  the  rope,  and  gained  its  liberty. 

Cyprien  would  have  keenly  felt  this  new  piece  of  ill- 
fortune,  had  he  been  in  his  normal  state,  but  extreme 
lassitude  and  weariness  had  almost  crushed  the  life  out  of 
him.  He  could  only  throw  himself  on  his  waterproof  bag, 
which  he  fortunately  found  untouched,  change  his  wet 
clothes  for  dry  ones,  and  then  drop  back  to  sleep  under 
the  shelter  of  the  baobab  beneath  which  he  had  camped. 

Then  began  a  strange  period  of  half-slumber,  of  fever, 
of  delirium,  in  which  everything  was  mixed  up,  wherein 
time,  space,  and  distance  retained  not  a  ghost  of  reality. 
Was  it  night  or  day?  Sunshine  or  rain?  Had  he  been 
there  twelve  hours  or  sixty?  Was  he  alive  or  dead?  He 
did  not  know.  Pleasant  dreams  and  frightful  nightmares 
followed  each  other  without  intermission.  Paris,  the 
School  of  Mines,  his  home,  Vandergaart  Kopje,  Miss 
Watkins,  Pantalacci,  Hilton,  Friedel,  legions  of  elephants, 
Mataki,  and  flights  of  birds  spread  over  a  boundless  sky, 
all  his  remembrances,  sensations,  sympathies,  and  antip- 
athies jostled  each  other  in  his  wandering  brain  as  if  in 
a  straggling  battle  of  incoherences.  To  the  creations  of 
the  fever  were  added  the  impressions  of  what  was  going 
on  around  him.  And  what  made  things  all  the  more 
horrible  was  that  in  the  thick  of  a  storm  of  jackals  bark- 
ing, tiger-cats  molrowing,  hyenas  laughing,  he  painfully 
pursued  the  romance  of  his  delirium,  and  thought  that  he 
heard  the  crack  of  a  rifle,  followed  by  a  deep  silence. 
Then  the  concert  began  again,  and  lasted  till  morning. 

During  this  delirium  Cyprien  would  probably  have 
passed  from  the  fever  into  everlasting  rest,  if  the  stran- 
gest, most  extravagant  event  had  not  happened  to  bring 
him  back  to  reason. 

The  morning  came.  It  rained  no  longer;  the  sun  was 
high  on  the  horizon.  Cyprien  had  just  opened  his  eyes. 
He  looked,  not  without  curiosity,  at  an  ostrich  of  large 
stature  that,  after  approaching  him,  stood  still  a  yard 
or  two  off. 

"Is  that  Mataki's  ostrich?"  asked  he  to  himself,  still 
pursuing  his  main  line  of  thought. 

It  was  the  bird  itself  that  spoke,  and  that  in  excellent 


THE  TALKING  OSTRICH  269 

English,  "There's  no  mistake!    Cyprien!    My  poor  fellow, 
whatever  are  you  doing  here?" 

An  ostrich  that  spoke  English,  an  ostrich  that  knew  his 
name,  was  certainly  enough  to  astonish  any  man  even  in 
his  sober  senses.  But  Cyprien  was  not  in  the  least  aston- 
ished, and  took  the  remarkable  phenomenon  as  a  matter 
of  course.  He  had  seen  so  many  strange  phenomena  dur- 
ing the  night,  it  seemed  quite  a  natural  consequence  of 
his  mental  derangement. 

"You  are  not  very  polite,  Mrs.  Ostrich,"  he  answered. 
"What  business  is  it  of  yours?" 

He  spoke  in  that  dry,  jerky  way  peculiar  to  those 
suffering  from  fever,  and  which  left  no  doubt  as  to  the 
state  he  was  in.  The  ostrich  seemed  greatly  troubled. 

"Cyprien,  my  friend,  you  are  ill,  and  all  alone  in  the 
desert!"  exclaimed  the  bird  as  it  knelt  by  his  side. 

This  was  a  physiological  phenomenon  no  less  abnormal 
among  struthious  birds  tfian  that  of  the  gift  of  speech,  for 
kneeling  is  a  movement  generally  denied  to  them  by  na- 
ture. But  Cyprien  in  his  fever  persisted  in  showing  no 
astonishment.  It  seemed  just  as  natural  when  the  ostrich 
felt  under  its  left  wing,  and  took  out  a  leather  flask,  and 
gave  him  a  mouthful  of  the  contents. 

The  only  thing  that  began  to  surprise  him  was  when  the 
strange  animal  rose  and  threw  off  what  seemed  to  be  his 
plumage,  and  took  off  his  neck  and  head,  and  then 
changed  into  a  tall,  sturdy,  active  man,  and  no  other  than 
that  mighty  hunter,  Pharamond  Barthes! 

"Yes,  it's  nobody  else!"  exclaimed  Barthes.  "Did  you 
not  recognize  my  voice?  You  are  astonished  at  my  out- 
fit? It  is  a  dodge  I  learned  from  the  Kaffirs  to  get  nearer 
the  real  ostriches  and  reach  them  with  their  assegais! 
But  let  us  talk  about  yourself  my  poor  fellow.  How 
came  you  here,  sick  and  abandoned?  It  was  the  merest 
chance  I  saw  you  as  I  went  by.  I  did  not  even  know 
you  were  in  these  parts." 

Cyprien  was  hardly  in  a  state  to  talk  to  his  friend,  and 
could  only  make  a  few  signs.  Barthes  saw  that  what  was 
wanted,  was  to  get  the  sick  man  the  help  he  needed,  and 
to  attack  the  fever  as  soon  as  possible. 

His  experience  in  the  desert  had  been  a  long  one,  and 
the  bold  hunter  had  learned  from  the  Kaffirs  a  method  of 


270  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

treatment  of  great  efficacy  in  marsh  fever  such  as  his  com- 
panion was  suffering  from.  He  dug  in  the  ground  a  sort 
of  ditch,  which  he  filled  with  wood,  having  arranged  it  so 
that  there  was  a  good  draft  through  it.  When  the 
wood  had  been  lighted  and  consumed,  it  converted  the 
ditch  into  a  veritable  oven.  Barthes  laid  Cyprien  in  the 
ditch,  after  carefully  wrapping  him  up  so  as  to  leave  only 
his  head  exposed  to  the  air.  Ten  minutes  had  hardly 
elapsed  before  an  abundant  perspiration  showed  itself — a 
perspiration  which  the  amateur  doctor  took  care  to  foster 
with  the  help  of  five  or  six  cups  of  an  infusion  he  made 
with  some  herbs  he  had  gathered;  and  then  Cyprien 
dropped  off  into  a  refreshing  sleep. 

At  sundown,  when  he  awoke,  he  was  sufficiently  re- 
covered to  ask  for  something  to  eat.  His  ingenious  friend 
was  quite  prepared  for  him,  and  immediately  offered  him 
some  excellent  soup  which  he  had  made  out  of  the  spoils 
of  his  rifle  and  different  sorts  of  vegetables.  A  wing  of 
roast  bustard  and  a  cup  of  cold  water  with  just  a  suspicion 
of  cordial  completed  the  meal,  which  greatly  strengthened 
Cyprien,  and  began  to  clear  his  brain  of  the  fumes  which 
clouded  it. 

About  an  hour  afterward,  Barthes  having  treated  him- 
self to  some  dinner,  sat  down  by  the  engineer  and  told  him 
how  he  came  to  be  there  so  strangely  disguised. 

"You  know  what  I  am  capable  of  in  search  of  any 
novelty  in  sport.  During  the  last  six  months  I  had  killed 
so  many  elephants,  zebras,  giraffes,  lions,  and  all  sorts  of 
big  game  and  little  game,  fur  and  feather — without  count- 
ing a  cannibal  eagle  that  is  the  pride  of  my  collection — 
that  a  few  days  ago  I  was  seized  with  the  idea  of  making 
a  change  in  my  sporting  proceedings.  Up  to  then  I  had 
only  traveled  escorted  by  my  Basutos — thirty  resolute 
fellows  whom  I  pay  at  the  rate  of  a  bag  of  glass  beads  a 
month,  and  who  would  throw  themselves  into  the  fire  to 
please  their  lord  and  master.  But  I  was  very  hospitably 
received  by  Tonaia,  the  great  chief  of  this  country,  and 
with  a  view  of  obtaining  the  right  of  shooting,  over  his 
territory — a  right  of  which  he  is  as  jealous  as  a  Highland 
laird — I  consented  to  lend  my  Basutos  with  four  guns  for 
an  expedition  that  he  was  thinking  of  against  one  of  his 
neighbors.  The  reinforcement  rendered  him  simply  in- 


THE  TALKING  OSTRICH  271 

vincible,  and  he  gained  a  signal  triumph  over  his  enemy. 
Hence  a  close  friendship  sealed  in  blood — that  is  to  say, 
we  mutually  sucked  a  pin-prick  in  our  forearms,  and  for 
the  future  Tonaia  and  I  are  brothers  for  life — and  death! 
Assured  of  being  let  alone  wherever  I  might  wander 
throughout  his  possessions,  I  started  off  the  day  before 
yesterday  in  chase  of  tiger-cats  and  ostriches.  As  far  as 
tiger-cats  are  concerned,  I  had  the  pleasure  of  shooting 
one  last  night,  and  I  am  rather  surprised  that  you  did  not 
hear  the  row  which  preceded  the  shot.  The  fellow  had 
been  attracted  by  the  odor  of  raw  flesh,  and  two  or  three 
hundred  jackals  and  hyenas  had  been  favored  with  the 
same  idea.  You  can  imagine  the  concert  that  took  place!" 

"I  think  I  heard  it,"  said  Cyprien.  "I  even  fancied  it 
was  given  in  my  honor." 

"Not  at  all,"  said  Barthes.  "It  was  in  honor  of  a 
buffalo's  carcass  at  the  bottom  of  the  valley  opening  to 
your  right.  When  day  dawned,  nothing  was  left  of  it  but 
the  bones.  I  will  show  you;  it  is  a  very  creditable  piece 
of  anatomizing.  You  shall  also  see  my  prey,  the  biggest 
I  have  brought  down  since  I  landed  in  Africa." 

"But  why  the  strange  disguise  you  wore  this  morning?" 
asked  Cyprien. 

"It  is  an  ostrich  dress.  As  I  told  you,  the  Kaffirs  often 
use  it  to  approach  the  birds,  for  they  are  very  shy  and 
Difficult  to  get  within  range.  You  will  say  that  I  have  my 
capital  rifle.  So  I  have,  but  what  of  that?  The  fancy 
struck  me  to  go  out  in  the  Kaffir  style,  and  to  that  I  owe 
my  finding  you,  don't  I?" 

"And  just  in  time.  Without  you  I  shouldn't  have 
troubled  the  world  much  longer,"  answered  Cyprien,  as  he 
cordially  clasped  his  friend's  hand. 

He  was  now  out  of  his  ditch,  and  comfortably  lying  on 
a  bed  of  leaves  that  his  companion  had  arranged  at  the 
foot  of  the  baobab.  The  gallant  fellow's  kindness  did  not 
stop  at  that.  He  went  down  into  the  neighboring  valley 
in  search  of  his  tent,  which  he  always  took  with  him  on 
such  expeditions,  and  a  quarter  of  an  hour  afterward  he 
had  pitched  it  above  the  invalid. 

"And  now,  Cyprien,"  said  he,  "let  us  have  your  history, 
if  you  are  not  too  tired  to  tell  it." 

Cyprien   felt  himself  well  enough  to   satisfy  Barthes' 


272  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

very  natural  curiosity.  Very  shortly  he  told  him  of  what 
had  occurred  in  Griqualand,  why  he  had  come  in  pursuit 
of  Mataki  and  his  diamond,  and  what  had  been  the  chief 
incidents  of  the  expedition.  He  told  him  of  the  deaths 
of  Friedel,  Hilton,  and  Pantalacci;  the  disappearance  of 
Bardik;  and  how  he  was  waiting  for  Li  to  return  to  the 
camp. 

Barthes  listened  with  profound  attention.  When  asked 
if  he  had  come  across  a  young  Kaffir  whose  appearance 
tallied  with  that  given  by  Cyprien,  he  replied  in  the 
negative. 

"But,"  added  he,  "I  found  a  horse  that  had  been  turned 
adrift,  and  which  may  be  yours."  And  he  explained  how 
the  horse  had  fallen  into  his  hands.  "Two  days  ago,"  he 
said,  "I  was  out  hunting  with  three  young  Basutos  in  the 
mountains  to  the  south,  when  I  suddenly  saw  a  gray 
horse  dash  out  of  one  of  the  ravines.  He  had  no  harness, 
only  a  halter  and  a  rope  trailing  behind  him.  He  seemed 
very  undecided  which  way  to  go,  and  I  called  out  to  him 
and  showed  him  a  handful  of  sugar,  and  he  came  with 
me.  I  took  him  prisoner.  He  is  an  excellent  brute,  full 
of  courage  and  fire,  and  'salted  like  a  ham/  " 

"He  is  mine!     That  is  Templar!"  exclaimed  Cyprien. 

"Well,  Templar  is  yours,  then,"  answered  Barthes,  "and 
I  am  glad  to  return  him  to  you.  Now,  good-night;  go  to 
sleep,  and  at  daybreak  tomorrow  we  clear  off  from  here." 

Then,  adding  practice  to  precept,  Barthes  rolled  himself 
in  his  blanket,  and  went  to  sleep  by  the  side  of  Cyprien. 

In  the  morning  the  Chinaman  returned  with  provisions, 
and  before  Cyprien  awoke,  Barthes  explained  matters  to 
Li,  and  left  him  in  charge,  while  he  went  off  to  fetch  the 
horse. 


CHAPTER  XIX 

THE    WONDERFUL    GROTTO 

IT  was  indeed  Templar  that  Cyprien  saw  before  him 
when  he  awoke.  The  interview  was  most  affectionate. 
The  horse  seemed  to  be  as  much  pleased  as  his  master  at 
again  meeting  his  traveling  companion. 

After  breakfast  Cyprien  felt  well  enough  to  mount  and 


THE  WONDERFUL  GROTTO  273 

set  out.    Barthes  put  all  the  baggage  on  Templar  and  then 
took  him  by  the  bridle  and  led  the  way  to  Tonaia's  capital. 

As  they  went  along,  Cyprien  told  his  friend  more  in 
detail  of  the  principal  events  of  the  expedition  since  leav- 
ing Griqualand.  When  he  came  to  the  final  disappear- 
ance of  Mataki,  whose  description  he  gave,  Barthes  burst 
out  laughing. 

"Oh !"  said  he ;  "that  is  news !  I  can  tell  you  something 
about  the  thief,  if  not  about  the  diamond!" 

"What  do  you  know?"  asked  Cyprien,  much  surprised. 

"This,"  replied  Barthes,  "that  hardly  twenty-four  hours 
ago  my  Basutos  took  prisoner  a  young  Kaffir,  whom  they 
found  wandering  about  the  country,  and  handed  him  over, 
bound  hand  and  foot,  to  my  friend  Tonaia.  I  fancy  he 
would  have  made  it  hot  for  him,  for  he  doesn't  like  spies, 
and  the  stranger  evidently  belonged  to  a  tribe  at  war  with 
his.  But  his  life  was  saved!  Fortunately  they  found  out 
that  he  knew  a  little  hanky-panky  business,  and  was  some- 
thing of  a  medicine  man — " 

"That  must  be  Mataki,"  said  Cyprien. 

"Well,  he  got  off  easily,"  said  Barthes.  "Tonaia  has 
invented  all  sorts  of  punishments  for  his  enemies ;  but  you 
need  not  be  the  least  alarmed  for  your  old  servant.  His 
reputation  as  a  wizard  protects  him,  and  you  will  see  him 
this  afternoon  in  excellent  health." 

The  news  could  not  be  otherwise  than  grateful  to 
Cyprien.  He  would,  after  all,  attain  his  object,  having  no 
doubt  that  if  Mataki  had  the  diamond  in  his  possession, 
he  would  hand  it  over. 

The  two  friends  continued  in  conversation  as  they 
crossed  the  plain  which  Cyprien  had  galloped  over  on 
giraffe-back  a  few  days  before. 

In  the  evening  Tonaia's  capital  appeared  in  sight,  lying 
like  a  huge  amphitheater  on  the  side  of  a  hill  which 
formed  the  northern  horizon.  It  was  a  regular  town,  of 
from  ten  to  fifteen  thousand  inhabitants,  with  well-marked 
roads  and  good-sized  huts,  some  of  them  almost  elegant 
in  shape,  bearing  outward  signs  of  ease  and  affluence. 
The  king's  palace,  surrounded  by  high  palisades,  and 
guarded  by  black  warriors  armed  with  assegais,  occupied 
almost  a  quarter  of  the  city. 

Barthes  had  only  to  show  himself  for  the   barriers  to 

Vol.  13  Verne 


274  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

fall  before  him,  and  he  and  Cyprien  were  immediately 
conducted  across  a  series  of  large  courts  to  the  hall  of 
ceremony,  where  the  "invincible  conqueror"  sat  in  state, 
surrounded  by  his  officers  and  guards. 

Tonaia  was  about  forty  years  of  age.  He  was  tall  and 
well  built.  A  sort  of  diadem  of  boars'  teeth  was  on  his 
head,  and  he  wore  a  red,  sleeveless  tunic,  and  an  apron  of 
the  same  color  richly  embroidered  with  beads.  On  his 
arms  and  legs  were  numerous  copper  bracelets.  His  face 
showed  intelligence  and  refinement,  but  he  had  a  crafty, 
hard-hearted  look. 

He  accorded  a  grand  reception  to  Barthes,  whom  he 
had  not  seen  for  some  days,  and  in  it  Cyprien  shared,  as 
the  friend  of  his  faithful  ally. 

"The  friends  of  our  friends  are  our  friends,"  said  the 
chief. 

And  learning  that  his  new  guest  was  not  very  well, 
Tonaia  bestirred  himself  to  install  him  in  one  of  the  best 
rooms  in  the  palace,  and  to  provide  him  with  an  excellent 
supper. 

Acting  on  the  advice  of  Barthes,  all  mention  of  Mataki 
was  deferred  till  the  morrow,  when  Cyprien  had  suf- 
ficiently recovered  to  appear  before  the  king. 

The  whole  court  was  assembled  in  the  great  saloon  of 
the  palace.  Tonaia  and  his  two  guests  were  in  the  center 
of  the  circle.  Barthes  opened  the  negotiations  in  the 
language  of  the  country,  which  he  spoke  fluently. 

"My  Basutos,"  he  said,  "have  recently  brought  to  you 
a  young  Kaffir.  The  young  Kaffir  turns  out  to  be  the 
servant  of  my  comrade,  the  learned  philosopher,  Victor 
Cyprien,  who  trusts  to  your  generosity  to  surrender  him. 
And  I,  as  he  is  my  friend  and  your  friend,  ask  you  this 
favor." 

As  soon  as  Barthes  began  his  speech  Tonaia  assumed  an 
appropriate  diplomatic  air. 

"The  great  white  philosopher  is  welcome !"  he  answered. 
"But  what  ransom  does  he  offer  for  my  prisoner?" 

"An  excellent  gun,  ten  times  ten  cartridges,  and  a  bag 
of  beads,"  answered  Barthes. 

A  flattering  murmur  ran  around  the  audience  in  recog- 
nition of  the  splendor  of  the  offer.  Tonaia  alone  did  not 
appear  dazzled  at  it. 


THE  WONDERFUL  GROTTO 


275 


"Tonaia  is  a  great  prince,"  he  said,  rising  on  his  throne, 
"and  the  gods  watch  over  him!  A  month  ago  they  sent 
Pharamond  Barthes  with  his  brave  warriors  and  wonder- 
ful guns  to  help  us  conquer  our  foes!  That  is  why,  if 
Pharamond  Barthes  desires  it,  the  servant  shall  be  given 
over  safe  and  sound  to  his  master." 

"And  where  is  he  at  this  moment?"  asked  the  hunter. 

"In  the  sacred  grotto,  where  he  is  guarded  night  and 
day,"  answered  Tonaia,  with  all  the  importance  of  one  of 
the  most  powerful  of  the  Kaffir  chiefs. 

Barthes  translated  the  reply  to  Cyprien,  and  asked  the 
king's  permission  to  go  with  his  companion  and  seek  the 
prisoner  in  the  grotto. 

As  he  said  so,  there  was  a  murmur  of  disapproval 
among  the  assembly.  The  demand  of  the  Europeans 
seemed  unreasonable.  Never  under  any  pretext  had  a 
stranger  been  admitted  within  the  mysterious  grotto.  A 
cherished  tradition  declared  that  the  day  the  white  men 
learned  the  secret,  the  empire  of  Tonaia  would  crumble 
to  dust. 

But  the  king  was  not  particularly  pleased  at  his  deci- 
sions being  prejudged  in  this  way,  and  the  murmur  in- 
duced him,  from  mere  caprice,  to  grant  what,  without  it, 
he  would  probably  have  refused. 

"Tonaia  is  the  blood-brother  of  Pharamond  Barthes, 
and  there  is  nothing  he  need  hide  from  him!  Can  you 
and  your  friend  keep  an  oath?" 

Barthes  nodded  affirmatively. 

"Then,"  said  the  Kaffir  king,  "swear  to  touch  nothing 
that  you  see  in  the  grotto!  Swear  to  live  ever  afterward 
when  you  come  out  as  though  you  had  never  known  its 
existence !  Swear  to  never  seek  to  enter  it  again,  nor  even 
to  attempt  to  do  so !  Swear  that  you  will  tell  no  one  what 
you  will  see!" 

Barthes  and  Cyprien  raised  their  hands,  and  repeated 
word  for  word  the  formula  of  the  oath  that  had  been 
delivered  to  them;  and  then  Tonaia  gave  a  few  orders  in 
a  low  tone,  the  court  rose,  and  the  guards  formed  into 
two  lines.  Slaves  brought  in  a  few  pieces  of  fine  linen, 
with  which  the  eyes  of  the  strangers  were  bandaged. 
Then  the  king  sat  down  between  them  in  a  large  palanquin 


276  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

of  straw,  which  several  Kaffirs  lifted  to  their  shoulders, 
and  then  the  procession  moved  off. 

The  journey  was  quite  long  enough;  it  took  nearly  two 
hours.  From  the  motions  of  the  palanquin  the  friends 
made  out  that  they  were  being  carried  over  hilly  ground. 
Then  the  coolness  of  the  air  and  the  echo  of  the  steps 
of  the  escort  resounding  from  walls  quite  close  together 
indicated  that  they  were  journeying  underground.  Then 
the  puffs  of  resinous  smoke  which  floated  into  their  faces 
told  them  that  torches  had  been  lighted  to  show  the  way. 
A  quarter  of  an  hour  afterward  the  palanquin  was 
unshouldered.  Tonaia  made  his  guests  step  out,  and 
ordered  their  bandages  to  be  removed. 

Dazzled  with  the  light  after  so  long  a  darkness,  Barthes 
and  Cyprien  thought  at  first  they  were  the  prey  of  some 
ecstatic  illusion,  so  splendid  and  unexpected  was  the  sight 
that  greeted  their  eyes. 

They  were  in  the  center  of  an  immense  grotto.  The 
ground  was  covered  with  fine  sand  bespangled  with  gold. 
The  vault  was  as  high  as  that  of  a  Gothic  cathedral,  and 
stretched  away  out  of  sight  into  the  distant  darkness.  The 
walls  were  covered  with  stalactites  of  varied  hue  and 
wondrous  richness,  and  from  them  the  light  of  the  torches 
was  reflected,  flashing  back  with  all  the  colors  of  the 
rainbow,  with  the  glow  of  a  furnace  fire  and  the  wealth 
of  the  aurora. 

Colors  of  the  most  dazzling,  shapes  the  most  extra- 
ordinary, dimensions  the  most  unexpected,  distinguished 
these  innumerable  crystals.  They  were  not,  as  in  most 
grottoes,  pendants,  monotonously  similar  to  each  other, 
but  nature  had  given  free  scope  to  fancy,  and  seemed  to 
have  exhausted  every  combination  of  tint  and  effect  to 
which  the  marvelous  brilliancy  of  the  rocks  could  lend 
itself. 

Blocks  of  amethyst,  walls  of  sardonyx,  masses  of  rubies, 
needles  of  emeralds,  colonnades  of  sapphires  deep  and 
slender  as  forest  pines,  bergs  of  aquamarine,  whorls  of 
turquoise,  mirrors  of  opal,  masses  of  rose  gypsum,  and 
gold-veined  lapis  lazuli — all  that  the  crystal  kingdom  could 
offer  that  was  precious  and  rare  and  bright  and  dazzling 
had  served  as  the  materials  for  this  astonishing  specimen 
of  architecture;  and,  further,  every  form,  even  of  the 


THE  WONDERFUL  GROTTO  277 

vegetable  kingdom,  seemed  to  have  been  laid  under  con- 
tribution in  the  wondrous  work.  Carpets  of  mineral 
mosses  soft  and  velvety  as  the  finest  gauze,  crystalline 
trees  loaded  with  flowers  and  fruits  of  jewels  recalling  the 
fairy  gardens  of  Japanese  art,  lakes  of  diamonds,  palaces 
of  chalcedony,  turrets  and  minarets  of  beryl  and  topaz, 
rose  pile  upon  pile,  and  heaped  together  so  many  splen- 
dors that  the  eye  refused  to  grasp  them.  The  decomposi- 
tion of  the  luminous  rays  by  the  thousands  of  prisms,  the 
showers  of  brilliancy  that  flashed  and  flowed  from  every 
side,  produced  the  most  astonishing  combination  of  light 
and  color  that  had  ever  dazzled  the  eyes  of  man. 

Cyprien  doubted  no  longer.  He  beheld  himself  trans- 
ported to  one  of  those  mysterious  receptacles  whose  ex- 
istence he  had  long  suspected,  in  which  nature  stored  and 
crystallized  wholesale  those  precious  gems  which  she  only 
gives  to  man  in  favored  spots  and  in  fragmentary  and 
isolated  specimens.  For  a  moment  he  was  tempted  to 
doubt  the  reality  of  his  vision,  but  as  he  passed  a  huge 
heap  of  crystal  he  tried  to  scratch  it  with  the  ring  on  his 
finger,  and  found  the  attempt  was  in  vain.  The  immense 
crypt  was  built  up  of  genuine  diamonds,  rubies,  and 
sapphires,  and  in  masses  so  prodigious  that  their  value 
was  beyond  all  calculation. 

Only  astronomical  numbers  could  be  called  in  to  give 
an  approximate  amount.  In  fact,  there,  buried  in  the 
earth,  unknown  and  unproductive,  lay  a  mass  of  wealth 
that  could  be  reckoned  in  trillions  and  quadrillions. 

Was  Tonaia  acquainted  with  the  enormous  wealth  he 
here  possessed?  Probably  not.  Even  Barthes  who  knew 
little  about  such  matters,  did  not  suspect  for  a  moment 
that  the  marvelous  crystals  were  precious  stones.  Most 
likely  the  Kaffir  king  thought  himself  simply  the  master 
and  guardian  of  a  particularly  curious  grotto,  whose  secret 
an  oracle  or  some  traditional  superstition  forbade  him  to 
reveal. 

One  thing  seemed  to  confirm  this  opinion.  In  several 
corners  of  the  cave  Cyprien  noticed  heaps  of  human  bones. 
Was  this,  then,  the  burial-place  of  the  tribe,  or — what  was 
more  horrible  and  more  probable — did  they  here  shed 
human  blood  in  the  rites  of  sacrifice  or  the  practice  of 
cannibalism  ? 


278  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

Barthes  was  of  the  latter  opinion  and  whispered  to 
Cyprien,  "Tonaia  told  me  that  since  his  accession  nothing 
of  this  sort  had  occurred,  but  the  sight  of  those  bones 
rather  shakes  my  confidence  in  him;"  and  he  pointed  to  a 
huge  heap  that  had  been  recently  formed,  and  which  bore 
obvious  marks  of  having  been  cooked. 

The  impression  was  confirmed  a  few  minutes  later. 

The  king  and  his  guests  reached  the  end  of  the  grotto, 
before  an  opening  which  ran  back  into  a  recess  similar  to 
one  of  the  lateral  chapels  in  a  basilica.  Behind  the  iron 
grating  which  shut  it  in  there  was  a  wooden  cage;  in  the 
cage  was  a  prisoner.  The  cage  was  just  large  enough  to 
allow  him  to  crouch,  while — the  fact  was  too  obvious — he 
was  fattened  up  for  an  approaching  feast! 

The  prisoner  was  Mataki. 

"You!  you!  pa!"  exclaimed  the  unfortunate  Kaffir  as 
soon  as  he  recognized  Cyprien.  "Take  me  with  you! 
Deliver  me!  I  would  rather  go  back  to  Griqualand  and 
be  hanged  than  remain  in  this  poultry-coop  for  the  hor- 
rible punishment  Tonaia  intends  before  he  eats  me!" 

This  was  said  in  such  a  pitiful  voice  that  Cyprien  was 
quite  moved  by  it. 

"Be  it  so,  Mataki,"  he  said ;  "I  can  obtain  your  liberty, 
but  you  cannot  come  out  of  that  cage  until  you  have 
given  up  the  diamond — " 

"The  diamond,  pa!"  interrupted  the  Kaffir — "the  dia- 
mond !  I  have  no  diamond !  I  never  had  it !  I  swear  it ! 
I  swear  it!" 

He  said  this  in  such  a  tone  of  truth  that  Cyprien  had 
no  doubt  of  his  veracity.  Besides,  he  had  always  doubted 
that  Mataki  was  the  thief. 

"But  then,  if  you  did  not  take  the  diamond,"  he  asked, 
"why  did  you  run  away?" 

"Why?  Because  when  my  comrades  were  tried  with 
the  wands,  they  said  that  I  must  be  the  thief,  and  that  I 
had  acted  as  I  did  to  disarm  their  suspicion.  When  in 
Griqualand  you  accuse  a  Kaffir,  you  know  it  is  not  long 
before  he  is  sentenced  and  hanged ;  and,  for  fear  that  they 
should  catch  me,  I  ran  away,  as  if  I  had  been  guilty." 

"He  is  speaking  the  truth,  I  think,"  said  Barthes. 

"So  do  I,"  said  Cyprien;  "and  perhaps  he  was  not  far 
wrong  in  getting  out  of  the  way  of  Griqualand  justice." 


THE  WONDERFUL  GROTTO  279 

Then  he  turned  to  Mataki.  "Well,  I  do  not  doubt  your 
innocence,  but  at  Vandergaart  Kopje  they  will  not  believe 
you  when  you  tell  your  story.  Are  you  willing  to  take 
your  chance,  and  go  back?" 

"Yes;  I  will  risk  everything  rather  than  remain  here!" 
said  Mataki,  who  seemed  a  prey  to  the  keenest  terror. 

"We  will  see  about  it,"  answered  Cyprien — "my  friend 
will  do  so  at  once." 

Barthes  stepped  up  to  the  king.  "Speak  out,"  he  said. 
"What  do  you  want  for  the  prisoner?" 

Tonaia  reflected  for  a  moment,  and  then  said,  "Four 
guns,  ten  times  ten  cartridges,  and  four  bags  of  beads. 
That  is  not  too  much,  is  it?" 

"It  is  twenty  times  too  much,  but  Pharamond  Barthes  is 
your  friend,  and  he  will  give  you  what  you  ask ;"  and  then 
he  stopped  for  an  instant,  and  continued,  "Listen,  Tonaia. 
You  shall  have  the  four  guns,  the  ten  times  ten  cartridges, 
and  the  four  bags  of  beads;  but  you  shall  give  us  a  team 
of  bullocks  to  take  us  back  across  the  Transvaal,  with  the 
necessary  provisions  and  an  escort  of  honor." 

"That  I  will  do,"  said  Tonaia,  in  a  tone  of  complete 
satisfaction. 

Then  he  whispered  confidentially  into  Barthes'  ear, 
"The  team  is  all  ready.  They  came  out  of  your  friend's 
wagon  when  my  men  came  across  them  on  their  way 
home." 

The  prisoner  was  at  once  handed  over;  and  after  a  final 
glance  at  the  splendors  of  the  grotto,  Cyprien,  Barthes, 
and  Mataki  were  blindfolded,  and  returned  to  Tonaia's 
palace,  where  a  grand  banquet  was  given  in  honor  of  the 
treaty. 

It  was  agreed  that  Mataki  should  not  appear  imme- 
diately at  Vandergaart  Kopje,  but  should  remain  in  the 
neighborhood  and  re-enter  the  engineer's  service  when  he 
was  sure  it  was  safe  to  do  so. 

On  the  morrow  Barthes,  Cyprien,  Li,  and  Mataki  de- 
parted with  a  numerous  escort  for  Griqualand.  But  the 
Star  of  the  South  seemed  to  be  irretrievably  lost,  and  Mr. 
Watkins  might  as  well  give  up  his  idea  of  sending  it  to 
the  Tower  of  London  to  sparkle  among  the  crown  jewels 
of  Great  Britain. 


280  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

CHAPTER  XX 

THE   RETURN 

JOHN  WATKINS  had  never  been  in  a  worse  humor  than 
since  the  departure  of  the  four  rivals  in  search  of  Mataki. 
As  the  days  and  weeks  went  by  it  seemed  to  him  that  all 
chance  of  recovering  the  precious  diamond  was  rapidly 
vanishing.  And  his  companions  had  all  gone;  and  Friedel, 
Hilton,  Pantalacci,  even  Cyprien,  whom  he  had  been 
accustomed  to  see  so  often,  were  much  missed.  So  he 
betook  himself  to  his  gin,  and,  as  may  be  easily  imagined, 
the  alcoholic  support  he  administered  to  his  grief  was 
not  much  calculated  to  sweeten  his  character. 

At  the  farm  the  greatest  anxiety  prevailed  as  to  the 
fate  of  the  expedition,  for  Bardik  had  been  carried  off  by 
a  party  of  Kaffirs,  and,  escaping  a  few  days  afterward, 
had  made  his  way  back  to  Griqualand  with  the  news  of 
the  deaths  of  Hilton  and  Friedel.  Alice  was  very  un- 
happy; she  sang  no  longer,  and  her  piano  remained  dumb. 
Even  her  ostriches  but  slightly  interested  her.  Dada  no 
longer  made  her  smile  at  his  greediness,  and  impudently 
swallowed  the  most  extraordinary  things  without  the 
slightest  protest. 

Miss  Watkins  had  two  causes  of  alarm.  The  first  was 
lest  Cyprien  should  never  return;  the  second,  lest  Panta- 
lacci, the  most  hated  of  her  admirers,  should  bring  back 
"The  Star"  and  claim  the  reward  of  his  success.  The 
idea  of  becoming  the  wife  of  the  Italian  was  absolutely 
abhorrent  to  her.  She  thought  of  it  by  day,  and  dreamed 
of  it  by  night ;  and  her  bright  cheeks  grew  paler  and  paler, 
and  her  blue  eyes  clouded  still  deeper  with  gloom. 

Three  months  had  passed.  It  was  evening.  She  was 
sitting  near  the  lamp  in  the  parlor;  her  father  was  on 
the  other  side  of  the  table,  smoking  and  drinking  as 
usual.  Her  head  was  bent  over  her  woolwork,  which  she 
had  taken  up  in  place  of  her  neglected  music,  and  in 
silent  and  sorrowful  reverie  she  was  thinking  over  her 
fate. 

There  came  a  gentle  tap  at  the  door. 

"Come  in!"  she  said,  somewhat  surprised,  and  wonder- 
ing who  it  could  be  at  such  an  hour. 


THE  RETURN  281 

"It  is  only  I,  Miss  Watkins,"  said  a  voice  which  made 
her  start — Cyprien's  voice! 

He  had  come  back — thin,  sunburned,  with  a  long  beard 
which  disguised  him,  and  clothes  faded  and  worn  by 
travel,  but  active  and  courteous  and  cheery  as  ever. 

Alice  jumped  up  and  uttered  a  cry  of  astonishment  and 
gladness.  With  one  hand  she  strove  to  check  the  beatings 
of  her  heart;  the  other  she  held  out  to  the  engineer,  and 
he  was  clasping  it  in  his  when  Mr.  Watkins  awoke  from 
his  slumbers  and  asked,  "What's  up?" 

It  took  the  farmer  two  or  three  minutes  to  grasp  the 
situation.  But  scarcely  had  the  first  gleam  of  intelligence 
struck  him  than  a  cry — a  cry  straight  from  the  heart — 
escaped  him — "And  the  diamond?" 

The  diamond,  alas!  had  not  come  back. 

Cyprien  briefly  told  the  story  of  the  expedition.  He 
related  the  death  of  Friedel,  of  Hilton,  of  Pantalacci,  the 
pursuit  of  Mataki  and  his  imprisonment  by  Tonaia — 
without  mentioning  his  return  to  Griqualand — and  ex- 
plained his  reasons  for  feeling  sure  of  the  Kaffir's  inno- 
cence. He  did  not  forget  to  mention  the  devotion  of 
Bardik  and  Li,  and  the  friendship  of  Barthes,  and  en- 
larged on  what  he  owed  to  the  gallant  hunter,  and  how, 
thanks  to  him,  he  had  been  able  to  return  with  his  two 
servants  from  a  journey  that  had  proved  fatal  to  his 
companions.  He  said  nothing  of  the  criminal  schemes  of 
his  rivals,  and  he  did  not  forget  his  promise  to  keep  the 
secret  of  the  wonderful  grotto  and  its  mineral  riches,  to 
which  those  of  the  Griqualand  diamond  field  were  as 
worthless  ballast. 

"Tonaia/'  said  he,  in  conclusion,  "faithfully  kept  his 
engagements.  Two  days  after  I  reached  his  capital,  every- 
thing was  ready  for  our  return — provisions,  teams,  and 
escort.  Under  the  command  of  the  king  in  person  about 
three  hundred  blacks  with  flour  and  smoked  meat  accom- 
panied us  to  the  camp  where  we  had  abandoned  the 
wagon,  which  we  found  untouched  beneath  the  brushwood 
we  had  heaped  upon  it.  We  then  bade  good-bye  to  our 
host,  having  given  him  five  guns  instead  of  the  four  he 
expected,  and  thus  made  him  the  most  redoubtable  poten- 
tate between  the  Limpopo  and  the  Zambesi!" 


282  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

"But  how  about  your  return  journey  when  you  left 
your  camp?"  asked  Miss  Watkins. 

"Our  return  journey  was  slow,  but  devoid  of  accidents. 
Our  escort  left  us  at  the  Transvaal  frontier,  where  Phara- 
mond  Barthes  and  his  Basutos  separated  from  us  to  go 
to  Durban,  and  after  a  forty  days'  march  across  the  Veld, 
here  we  are,  very  much  as  we  were  before  we  left." 

"But  why  did  Mataki  run  away?"  asked  Watkins,  who 
had  listened  to  the  recital  with  much  interest,  without 
showing  the  slightest  emotion  about  the  three  men  who 
would  never  return. 

"Mataki  fled  because  he  was  afraid." 

"Is  there  no  justice  in  Griqualand?"  asked  the  farmer. 

"Yes,  but  justice  that  is  often  too  summary,  Mr. 
Watkins;  and  I  hardly  blame  the  poor  fellow,  when 
wrongfully  accused,  for  having  thought  it  best  to  dis- 
appear during  the  first  excitement  at  the  diamond's  loss." 

"Nor  do  I,"  said  Alice. 

"And  I  repeat  that  he  is  not  guilty,  and  I  think  they 
will  leave  him  alone  for  the  future." 

"Hum!"  said  Watkins,  apparently  unconvinced.  "Don't 
you  think  Mataki  shammed  that  fear,  so  as  to  get  out  of 
reach  of  the  police?" 

"No!  He  is  innocent!  I  am  sure  of  it,"  said  Cyprien 
rather  dryly,  "and  I  think  that  I  have  bought  the  assur- 
ance rather  dear." 

"Oh!  you  are  welcome  to  your  opinion,  and  I  am 
welcome  to  mine." 

Alice  saw  that  the  discussion  was  likely  to  end  in  a 
dispute,  and  so  struck  in  by  way  of  diversion  with,  "Do 
you  know,  Mr.  Cyprien,  that  during  your  absence  your 
claim  has  turned  out  a  splendid  one,  and  that  your  partner, 
Mr.  Steel,  is  on  the  road  to  become  one  of  the  richest 
diggers  in  the  Kopje?" 

"No,  I  did  not,"  answered  Cyprien  frankly.  "My  first 
visit  I  paid  to  you,  Miss  Watkins,  and  I  know  nothing  of 
what  has  happened  during  my  absence." 

"Perhaps  you  have  not  had  any  dinner?"  asked  Alice, 
with  the  instinct  of  the  thorough  little  housewife  that 
she  was. 

"I  am  sorry  to  say  I  have  not,"  said  Cyprien,  blushing, 
though  why  he  blushed,  he  did  not  know. 


THE  RETURN  283 

"Oh!  But  you  must  not  go  without  food.  An  invalid 
like  you — after  such  a  trying  journey.  Why,  it  is  nearly 
eleven  o'clock!" 

And  without  heeding  his  protestations  she  ran  to  the 
kitchen,  and  reappeared  with  a  tray  covered  with  a  spot- 
less cloth,  and  bearing  some  cold  viands  and  a  beautiful 
peach  tart  that  she  herself  had  made. 

The  tray  was  deposited  in  front  of  Cyprien,  who  seemed 
much  confused,  and  as  he  hesitated  to  use  the  knife  on  a 
superb  "biltong"— 

"Shall  I  cut  it  for  you  ?"  asked  Miss  Watkins,  with  one 
of  her  sweetest  smiles. 

And  the  farmer,  suddenly  getting  hungry  at  the  sight  of 
the  gastronomic  display,  asked  for  another  plate  and  a 
slice  of  biltong.  Alice  was  delighted  to  wait  on  them, 
and  merely  to  keep  the  gentlemen  company,  as  she  said, 
began  to  eat  a  few  almonds. 

The  hurriedly-prepared  supper  was  simply  delightful. 
Never  had  the  young  engineer  experienced  such  a  trium- 
phant appetite.  He  had  three  helpings  of  peach  tart,  and 
quite  won  the  heart  of  Mr.  Watkins,  who,  however,  soon 
dropped  off  to  sleep. 

"And  what  have  you  been  doing  during  the  last  three 
months?"  asked  Cyprien.  "I  am  afraid  you  have  for- 
gotten all  your  chemistry." 

"No,  sir;  you  are  wrong.  I  have  been  working  very 
hard,  and  I  have  been  trying  some  experiments  in  your 
laboratory.  Oh!  I  didn't  break  anything!  You  needn't 
look  so  frightened.  I  am  very  fond  of  chemistry,  and 
cannot  understand  how  you  could  leave  such  a  splendid 
science  to  become  a  digger  or  a  bushman." 

"But  you  know  why  I  gave  up  chemistry." 

"I  know  nothing,"  said  Alice,  with  a  blush,  "and  I 
think  you  were  wrong.  Were  I  in  your  place,  I  should 
try  and  make  another  diamond.  That  is  much  better  than 
looking  for  one  underground!" 

"Is  that  an  order,  then?"  asked  Cyprien,  with  his  voice 
all  of  a  tremble. 

"Oh,  no!"  answered  Alice,  with  a  smile,  "only  a  re- 
quest. Oh,  Mr.  Cyprien,"  she  continued  more  seriously, 
"if  you  only  knew  how  unhappy  I  have  been  in  knowing 
that  you  were  exposed  to  all  the  fatigues  and  dangers  you 


284  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

have  been  through.  You  have  not  told  me  all,  but  I  can 
guess.  A  man  like  you,  so  learned,  so  well  prepared  to 
do  good  work  and  make  great  discoveries,  ought  not  to 
have  been  exposed  to  perish  in  the  desert  from  the  bite  of 
a  snake  or  the  grip  of  a  lion  without  any  gain  to  science 
or  humanity.  It  was  so  wrong  to  let  you  go;  and  it  was 
only  by  a  miracle  that  you  escaped  to  come  back.  With- 
out your  friend  Mr.  Barthes — " 

She  did  not  finish,  but  the  tears  welling  up  into  her 
eyes  completed  the  thought  for  her. 

"Those  tears,"  said  Cyprien,  "are  more  precious  to  me 
than  all  the  diamonds  in  the  world,  and  make  me  forget 
all  my  troubles." 

There  was  a  short  silence,  which  Alice  broke  with  her 
usual  tact,  by  resuming  her  account  of  her  chemical 
studies. 

It  was  past  midnight  when  Cyprien  returned  to  his  hut, 
where  a  packet  of  letters  awaited  him,  carefully  arranged 
on  his  work-table  by  Miss  Watkins. 

These  letters,  reaching  him  after  so  long  an  absence,  he 
hardly  dared  open.  If  they  brought  him  news  of  some 
misfortune!  His  father,  his  mother,  his  little  sister  Jane! 
So  many  things  can  happen  in  three  months ! 

He  rapidly  glanced  through  them,  and  found  they  con- 
tained nothing  but  good  news.  All  his  people  were  well. 
There  were  the  warmest  congratulations  on  his  excellent 
theory  of  diamond  formation.  He  could  stay  another  six 
months  in  Griqualand,  if  he  thought  his  doing  so  would 
be  in  the  interests  of  science.  Everything  was  for  the 
best,  and  Cyprien  went  to  sleep  with  a  lighter  heart  than 
he  had  had  for  many  a  day. 

In  the  morning  he  visited  his  friends,  and  stayed  some 
time  with  Thomas  Steel,  who  had  been  working  to  con- 
siderable purpose.  The  hearty  Lancashire  lad  received 
his  partner  with  the  greatest  cordiality.  Cyprien  arranged 
with  him  for  Bardik  and  Li  to  resume  work  as  before, 
intending,  if  they  were  successful,  to  give  them  a  share 
in  the  claim. 

On  his  part,  he  had  given  up  all  thoughts  of  again 
trying  his  hand  at  digging,  and,  in  accordance  with 
Alice's  wish,  resolved  to  resume  his  chemical  researches. 

His  conversation  with  her  had  confirmed  him  in  his  own 


THE  RETURN  285 

ideas.  He  had  for  some  time  thought  that  his  true  course 
was  to  abandon  the  rougher  work,  and  leave  travel  and 
adventure  alone.  Too  loyal  and  faithful  to  his  word  to 
think  for  an  instant  of  abusing  the  confidence  of  Tonaia, 
and  profiting  by  his  knowledge  of  the  cavern  with  its 
marvelous  minerals,  he  found  in  it  a  valuable  confirma- 
tion of  his  theory  of  gems,  which  could  not  but  increase 
his  ardor  in  research.  And  so  he  returned  to  his  labora- 
tory and  resumed  his  investigations. 

And  he  had  a  strong  incentive  to  do  so,  for  since  the 
artificial  diamond  had  been  lost,  Mr.  Watkins  said  no 
more  about  his  daughter's  marriage.  If  the  engineer  could 
make  another  gem  of  extraordinary  value,  the  farmer 
might  again  be  induced  to  entertain  the  subject. 

And  so  Cyprien  resolved  to  set  to  work  without  delay, 
and  made  no  attempt  to  conceal  his  proceedings  from  the 
diggers  of  Vandergaart  Kopje.  It  would  have  been  well, 
perhaps,  had  he  done  so. 

He  obtained  a  new  tube  of  great  resisting  power,  and 
filled  it  in  the  same  way. 

"What  I  want,"  said  he  to  Alice,  "to  crystallize  the 
carbon — that  is  to  say,  make  the  diamond — is  a  proper 
solvent,  which  by  evaporation  or  cooling  will  give  the 
crystallization.  We  have  a  solvent  for  aluminium  in 
sulphide  of  carbon,  and  by  analogy  we  must  find  some- 
thing similar  for  carbon,  such  as  boron  or  silicon." 

Although  Cyprien  was  not  in  possession  of  this  solvent, 
he  went  on  with  his  work.  Instead  of  Mataki,  who  pru- 
dently kept  away  from  the  camp,  Bardik  was  employed  in 
keeping  in  the  fire  night  and  day,  a  task  he  fulfilled  as 
zealously  as  his  predecessor. 

In  the  meantime,  foreseeing  that  after  this  prolongation 
of  his  stay  in  Griqualand  he  would  have  to  leave  for 
Europe,  Cyprien  started  on  another  item  in  his  program, 
which  he  had  hitherto  left  untouched.  This  was  the  de- 
termination of  the  exact  position  of  a  certain  depression 
in  the  north-east  of  the  plain,  which  seemed  to  have  been 
the  spot  where  the  waters  debouched  at  the  time  the 
diamantiferous  deposit  was  formed. 

Five  or  six  days  after  his  return  from  the  Transvaal  he 
was  working  at  this  with  all  his  usual  precision.  For  an 
hour  or  more  he  had  been  placing  his  poles,  and  noting 


286  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

his  bench-marks  on  a  fully-detailed  map  he  had  procured 
at  Kimberley,  and,  strange  to  relate,  in  every  case  he 
found  that  nowhere  did  his  figures  agree  with  the  plan! 
At  last,  after  repeated  trials,  there  was  no  resisting  the 
evidence  that  the  map  was  out  of  truth  as  regards  its 
compass  bearings,  and  that  the  latitudes  and  longitudes 
were  erroneous. 

He  was  using  an  excellent  chronometer,  that  had  been 
duly  rated,  and  which  he  had  specially  brought  out  with 
him  for  the  purpose  of  determining  the  longitude,  and  the 
time  was  high  noon.  Hence,  feeling  assured  of  the  infalli- 
bility of  his  compass  and  his  declination  needle,  he  had 
no  hesitation  in  deciding  that  the  map  on  which  he  was 
marking  his  observations  was  entirely  untrustworthy, 
owing  to  some  serious  oversight. 

In  fact,  the  north  of  the  map,  as  shown  by  the  arrow 
was  really  the  north-north-west,  and  all  the  positions  had 
necessarily  to  be  altered. 

"I  see  what  it  is,"  Cyprien  suddenly  exclaimed,  "the 
asses  who  did  this  forgot  to  allow  for  the  variation,  and 
that  is  nearly  twenty-nine  degrees  west!  All  their  latitude 
and  longitude  lines  ought  to  be  swung  around  twenty-nine 
degrees!  They  must  have  funny  surveyors  that  produced 
this  masterpiece." 

And  he  chuckled  loudly  at  the  blunder. 

"Well,  to  err  is  human.  Let  him  throw  the  first  stone 
at  these  fellows  who  never  made  a  mistake  in  his  life." 

Cyprien  had  no  reason  for  keeping  secret  the  rectifica- 
tion he  had  made  in  the  orientation  of  the  diamantiferous 
beds  of  the  district.  As  he  was  returning  to  the  farm,  he 
met  Vandergaart,  and  casually  mentioned  it  to  him. 

"It  is  very  curious  that  such  a  huge  mistake  was  not 
found  out  before.  It  affects  all  the  maps  of  the  district." 

The  old  lapidary  pricked  up  his  ears  and  looked  Cyprien 
straight  in  the  face. 

"Are  you  sure  you  are  right?"  he  asked. 

"Oh,  yes!" 

"And  will  you  swear  it  in  a  court  of  justice?" 

"In  a  dozen  courts,  if  you  like." 

"And  no  one  can  deny  what  you  say?" 

"Certainly  not;  I   should  only  have  to  point  out  the 


VENETIAN  JUSTICE  287 

mistake.  It  is  open,  gross,  palpable.  They  have  omitted 
the  magnetic  variation,  that  is  all." 

Vandergaart  shook  hands  and  walked  off  without  an- 
other word,  and  Cyprien  soon  forgot  the  strange  way  in 
which  the  intelligence  had  affected  him. 

But  two  or  three  days  afterward,  when  he  went  to  call 
on  the  old  lapidary,  he  found  the  door  shut.  On  it  was  a 
notice,  "AWAY  ON  BUSINESS." 


CHAPTER  XXI 

VENETIAN  JUSTICE 

DURING  the  following  days  Cyprien  was  busy  attending 
to  his  experiment.  He  had  introduced  several  changes  in 
the  construction  of  his  furnace  and  contrived  a  better 
draft.  By  doing  so  he  hoped  to  make  his  second  diamond 
in  much  less  time  than  he  had  done  the  first. 

Miss  Watkins  took  great  interest  in  the  attempt  which 
she  had  really  originated.  Frequently  was  she  seen  at  the 
furnace,  watching  through  the  grating  the  fire  that  roared 
within. 

John  Watkins  was  no  less  interested  than  his  daughter, 
but  from  other  motives.  He  wished  to  become  once  more 
the  owner  of  a  gem  whose  value  could  be  reckoned  in 
millions.  Great  was  his  fear  that  the  experiment  would 
not  succeed  a  second  time,  and  that  chance  would  fail  to 
play  the  important  part  in  it  that  it  had  done  on  the 
previous  occasion. 

But  if  the  farmer  and  Miss  Watkins  encouraged  the 
experimenter  to  persevere,  it  was  not  so  with  the  diggers. 
Their  opinions  were  the  same  as  those  of  Pantalacci,  Hil- 
ton, and  Friedel;  and  the  Jew  Nathan  never  ceased  in  his 
scheming  to  excite  them  against  the  young  engineer.  If 
this  manufacture  of  diamonds  was  to  become  a  trade — 
if,  like  white  sapphires,  amethysts,  topazes,  and  emeralds 
made  from  crystals  of  alumina  colored  by  metallic  acids, 
diamonds  were  to  be  turned  out  from  the  laboratory  with- 
out trouble — the  market  value  of  the  stones  would  tend 
to  diminish.  If  making  diamonds  was  to  become  a  recog- 
nized handicraft,  the  diamond-fields  at  the  Cape  and  else- 
where would  be  ruined. 


288  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

All  this  had  been  said  after  the  first  experiment,  and 
now  it  was  repeated  with  more  violence  and  acrimony. 
The  diggers  wished  little  good  to  Cyprien  or  his  works. 
But  he  thought  little  of  the  diggers,  and  went  on  his  way, 
determined  to  see  his  experiment  through.  He  was  not 
going  to  hang  back  before  public  opinion,  and  had  no 
intention  of  keeping  a  secret  that  might  do  good  to  all. 

But  if  he  continued  his  work  without  fear  or  hesitation, 
Miss  Watkins,  who  heard  what  was  going  on,  began  to 
tremble  for  him.  She  reproached  herself  with  having  led 
him  on  to  the  track.  To  trust  to  the  police  protecting  him 
was  to  trust  to  a  broken  reed.  A  murderous  stroke  is 
quickly  dealt,  and  may  fall  before  any  one  can  intervene. 
Cyprien  might  have  to  atone  with  his  life  for  the  sup- 
posed injury  he  had  done  to  the  diggers  of  South  Africa. 

Alice  grew  anxious,  and  could  not  hide  her  anxiety 
from  the  engineer.  He  reassured  her  as  well  as  he  could, 
and  thanked  her  for  the  motive  that  had  prompted  her  to 
speak.  In  the  interest  she  took  in  him  he  saw  the  proof 
of  a  tender  sentiment,  whose  existence  was  now  no 
secret  between  them.  Cyprien  was  only  too  pleased 
that  his  experiment  led  to  closer  intimacy  with  Alice,  and 
bravely  continued  his  work. 

"What  I  am  doing  is  for  us  both,"  he  said  to  her. 
But  Miss  Watkins,  noticing  what  people  were  saying  down 
at  the  claims,  lived  a  life  of  terror. 

And  not  without  reason.  A  regular  agitation  was 
organized  against  Cyprien,  and  the  diggers  did  not  confine 
themselves  to  threats  and  recriminations,  but  proceeded  to 
do  damage. 

One  evening,  when  Cyprien  went  off  to  look  at  the 
furnace,  he  found  it  had  been  broken  down.  During 
Bardik's  absence  a  lot  of  men  had  taken  advantage  of  the 
darkness  and  in  a  couple  of  minutes  destroyed  what  had 
been  the  work  of  days.  The  bricks  had  been  thrown 
about,  the  furnaces  had  been  smashed,  the  fires  put  out, 
and  the  tools  scattered  and  rendered  useless.  Nothing 
was  left  of  what  had  cost  so  much  thought  and  trouble. 
All  had  to  be  begun  over  again,  if  he  was  the  man  not 
to  give  in  to  mere  brute  strength,  or  he  would  have  to 
abandon  the  game. 

"No!"  he  exclaimed.     "No,  I  will  not  give  in!     And 


VENETIAN  JUSTICE  289 

tomorrow  I  will  give  information  against  the  scoundrels 
who  have  destroyed  my  property.  We  shall  see  if  there 
is  justice  in  Griqualand." 

There  was  justice,  but  not  the  sort  Cyprien  imagined. 

Without  saying  a  word  to  anybody,  without  even  telling 
Miss  Watkins,  for  fear  of  adding  to  her  alarm,  Cyprien 
regained  his  hut,  and  lay  down  to  sleep,  resolved  to  begin 
legal  proceedings  in  the  morning,  even  if  he  had  to  go 
eventually  to  the  Governor  of  the  Cape. 

He  had  slept  perhaps  two  hours,  when  the  noise  of  his 
door  opening  awoke  him  with  a  start. 

Five  men  in  crape  masks,  armed  with  revolvers  and 
rifles  and  carrying  bull's-eye  lanterns,  took  up  their  posi- 
tion around  the  bed. 

Cyprien  had  no  idea  that  anything  serious  was  intended. 
In  fact,  he  would  have  laughed,  had  not  the  pleasantry 
seemed  to  him  unworthy  of  such  a  compliment. 

But  a  heavy  hand  struck  him  hard  on  the  shoulder,  and 
one  of  the  masked  men  opened  a  paper  he  held,  and  in  a 
gruff  voice  read  as  follows: — 

"Victor  Cyprien — 

"This  is  to  give  you  notice  that  the  secret  tribunal  of 
Vandergaart  Kopje,  twenty-two  members  being  present, 
acting  in  the  name  of  the  public  safety,  have  this  day,  at 
twenty-five  minutes  past  midnight,  sentence'd  you  to  death. 
You  have  by  a  treacherous  discovery  threatened  their  in- 
terests, their  lives,  and  the  lives  of  their  families,  and  of 
all  men  who  earn  their  livelihood  by  the  cutting  and  sale 
of  diamonds.  The  tribunal  in  their  wisdom  have  decided 
that  such  a  discovery  deserves  annihilation,  and  that  the 
death  of  one  man  is  preferable  to  that  of  many  thousands 
of  his  fellows.  It  has  decreed  that  you  shall  now  have 
ten  minutes  to  prepare  for  death,  and  that  you  shall 
choose  the  manner  in  which  you  will  die;  that  your  papers 
shall  be  burned,  with  the  exception  of  an  open  letter  you 
can  address  to  your  relatives;  and  that  your  hut  shall  be 
razed  to  the  ground. 

"And  thus  be  it  with  all  traitors!" 

As  he  heard  this  death  warrant,  Cyprien's  confidence 
began  to  quail,  and  he  wondered  if  this  curious  comedy 
was  one  of  the  savage  customs  of  the  country  or  was 
really  in  earnest. 

Vol.  13  Verne 


290  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

The  man  who  held  him  by  the  shoulders  soon  cleared 
away  his  doubts. 

"Get  up  at  once,"  he  said  gruffly;  "we  have  no  time  to 
lose." 

"It  is  a  murder!"  replied  Cyprien,  as  he  rose  and  began 
to  dress  by  his  bedside. 

He  was  more  disgusted  than  frightened,  and  concen- 
trated his  thoughts  on  what  had  happened  to  him  with 
the  coolness  with  which  he  would  have  attacked  a  mathe- 
matical problem.  Who  were  these  men?  He  could  not 
discover  even  by  the  sound  of  their  voices.  Evidently 
those  among  them  who  knew  him  personally  were  ad- 
visedly silent. 

"Have  you  chosen  what  death  you  will  die?"  asked 
the  masked  man. 

"I  have  no  choice  to  make,  and  I  protest  against  the 
odious  crime  of  which  you  wish  to  be  guilty,"  said  Cyprien 
in  a  firm  voice. 

"You  can  protest,  but  you  will  none  the  less  be  hanged. 
Don't  you  want  to  write  anything?" 

"Nothing  I  would  care  to  trust  to  assassins  like  you!" 

"Forward,  then!"  said  the  chief. 

Two  men  placed  themselves  on  each  side  of  the  en- 
gineer, and  the  procession  was  formed  to  pass  through  the 
doorway. 

But  as  the  advance  began,  something  very  unexpected 
happened.  Into  the  middle  of  the  secret  commissioners 
of  Vandergaart  Kopje  a  man  rushed  with  a  bound. 

It  was  Mataki. 

The  young  Kaffir,  who  often  prowled  around  the  camp 
after  dark,  had  noticed  the  masked  men,  and  followed 
them.  He  had  heard  all  that  passed,  had  understood  the 
danger  that  threatened  his  master,  and  suddenly  leaped  in, 
scattered  the  diggers  right  and  left,  and  threw  himself  at 
Cyprien's  feet. 

"Why  do  these  men  want  to  kill  you,  pa?"  asked  he, 
clasping  his  master's  legs,  while  the  masked  men  in  vain 
endeavored  to  tear  him  away. 

"Because  I  made  an  artificial  diamond,"  answered 
Cyprien,  clasping  Mataki's  hands  to  prevent  his  being 
torn  away  from  him. 


VENETIAN  JUSTICE  291 

"Oh,  pa!  I  am  so  sorry  for  the  harm  I  have  done!" 
said  the  Kaffir,  bursting  into  tears. 

"What?"  asked  Cyprien. 

"Yes,  I  will  confess  everything  now  they  want  to  kill 
you!"  said  Mataki.  "Yes,  they  ought  to  kill  me,  not 
you,  for  I  put  the  big  diamond  in  the  cannon!" 

"Take  this  fellow  away!"  said  the  leader  of  the  gang. 

"I  put  it — I  put  the  diamond  in  the  tube !"  said  Mataki, 
struggling.  "Yes,  I  swindled  you,  pa!  I  thought  you 
would  like  to  think  that  your  experiment  had  come  off!" 

His  protestations  were  so  fierce  in  their  energy  that  the 
masked  men  stopped  to  listen  to  them. 

"Is  that  true?"  asked  Cyprien,  surprised  and  disap- 
pointed at  what  he  heard. 

"Yes!  a  hundred  times  yes!     I  speak  the  truth!" 

And  then  the  men  released  him,  and  he  sat  on  the 
ground  and  spoke  as  follows — 

"The  day  of  the  landslip,  when  I  was  buried  by  the  fall, 
I  found  the  big  diamond!  I  was  holding  it  in  my  hand 
and  wondering  how  I  was  to  hide  it,  when  the  wall  fell 
on  me,  to  punish  me  for  my  wicked  thought.  When  I 
came  back  to  life,  I  found  the  stone  in  the  bed  you  had 
put  me  in.  I  was  going  to  give  it  you,  but  I  was  ashamed 
to  confess  that  I  was  a  thief,  and  I  waited  for  a  favorable 
opportunity.  Not  long  afterward  pa  wanted  to  make  a 
diamond,  and  set  me  to  look  after  the  fire.  The  second 
day,  while  I  was  there  alone,  the  gun  burst,  and  the 
furnace  was  all  broken.  Then  I  thought  that  pa  would  be 
sorry  because  his  experiment  had  failed;  and  I  squeezed  a 
handful  of  clay  around  the  big  diamond  and  slipped  it 
into  the  cracked  gun;  and  I  made  the  furnace  all  right 
again,  so  that  pa  could  not  see  it  had  broken.  I  waited 
and  said  nothing,  and  when  pa  found  the  diamond,  he 
was  very  glad." 

A  burst  of  laughter  that  the  five  men  could  not  restrain 
saluted  these  last  words  of  Mataki. 

Cyprien  did  not  laugh;  he  bit  his  lips  in  vexation. 

It  was  impossible  to  mistake  the  Kaffir's  story;  it  was 
obviously  too  true.  In  vain  Cyprien  sought  for  some 
reason  for  his  telling  a  falsehood.  In  vain  he  said  to 
himself,  "A  diamond  exposed  to  such  a  temperature  would 
have  been  volatilized!" 


292  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

His  sound  sense  showed  him  at  once  that,  protected  in 
its  envelope  of  clay,  the  gem  had  escaped  the  heat,  or 
been  only  partially  affected  by  it.  Perhaps,  even,  it  was 
the  torrefaction  that  had  given  it  its  sable  tint.  Perhaps 
it  had  been  volatilized  and  recrystallized  in  its  shell! 

These  thoughts  crowded  into  his  brain  and  associated 
themselves  with  extraordinary  rapidity.  He  was  stupefied. 

"I  remember  seeing  the  piece  of  earth  in  the  Kaffir's 
hand  on  the  day  of  the  landslip,"  said  one  of  the  men, 
when  the  laughter  had  somewhat  subsided;  "and  he 
clutched  it  so  tight  in  his  fingers  that  we  couldn't  get 
it  out." 

"There  is  no  doubt  now,"  said  another.  "Is  it  possible 
to  make  a  diamond?  We  must  have  been  mad  to  think 
so!  As  well  try  to  make  a  star!" 

And  they  began  to  laugh  again. 

Assuredly  Cyprien  suffered  more  from  their  mirth  than 
their  menaces. 

After  consulting  together  in  a  whisper,  the  leader  said 
to  him,  "We  are  of  opinion  that  the  execution  of  the 
sentence  passed  on  you,  Victor  Cyprien,  may  be  respited. 
You  are  free!  but  remember  that  the  sentence  always 
hangs  on  you!  One  word — one  sign,  even — to  the  police, 
and  you  shall  die!  Your  very  good  health!"  and,  fol- 
lowed by  his  companions,  he  disappeared  through  the 
doorway. 

The  room  was  left  in  darkness.  Cyprien  might  have 
imagined  he  had  been  the  prey  of  a  nightmare.  But  the 
sobs  of  Mataki,  who  lay  stretched  on  the  ground,  and 
wept  noisily  with  his  head  between  his  hands,  proclaimed 
the  reality  of  what  he  had  passed  through. 

It  was  cruelly  true!  He  had  escaped  from  death,  but 
at  the  cost  of  a  deep  humiliation.  He,  a  mining  engineer, 
a  pupil  of  the  Poly  technique,  a  distinguished  chemist,  and 
well-known  geologist,  had  been  taken  in  by  a  miserable 
Kaffir!  Or  rather,  it  was  his  own  vanity,  his  ridiculous 
presumption,  that  had  led  him  to  this  unheard-of  blunder. 
He  had  even  thought  out  a  theory  accounting  for  his 
discovery!  What  could  be  more  ridiculous? 

"My  paper!"  he  exclaimed.  "Have  the  brutes  taken 
it  away  with  them?" 

He  lighted  a  candle.    No!    His  memoir  was  there.    No 


VENETIAN  JUSTICE  293 

one  had  seen  it.    He  could  not  rest  until  he  had  burned  it. 

Mataki's  grief  was  so  intense  that  he  endeavored  to 
comfort  him.  This  was  not  very  difficult.  At  the  first 
kind  words  of  his  "pa"  he  seemed  to  live  again.  And 
Cyprien  assured  him  of  his  forgiveness  on  condition  that 
he  left  off  such  tricks  for  ever. 

Mataki  promised  by  all  that  was  sacred  that  he  would 
do  so,  and  Cyprien  went  to  bed. 

In  the  morning,  when  it  became  known  that  the  Star  of 
the  South  was  neither  more  nor  less  than  a  natural  dia- 
mond, that  the  diamond  had  been  found  by  the  young 
Kaffir,  who  was  quite  conversant  with  its  value,  all  the 
suspicion  against  him  was  again  awakened.  Watkins  made 
a  tremendous  noise.  Mataki  must  be  the  thief!  After 
having  thought  of  stealing  it  once,  it  was  evident  that  he 
had  stolen  it  on  the  night  of  the  dinner. 

Cyprien  protested,  and  offered  to  guarantee  the  Kaffir's 
innocence,  but  no  one  would  listen  to  him.  And  this 
showed  him  how  well  founded  had  been  Mataki's  fear  of 
returning  to  Griqualand. 

But  the  young  engineer  had  no  idea  of  giving  in,  and  so 
brought  forward  an  argument  which,  to  his  mind,  suf- 
ficiently cleared  the  Kaffir. 

"I  believe  in  his  innocence,"  said  he  to  John  Watkins; 
"and,  besides,  if  he  was  guilty,  it  is  my  business,  and  no 
one  else's.  Natural  or  artificial,  the  diamond  belonged  to 
me  before  I  gave  it  to  Miss  Alice — " 

"Oh,  it  belonged  to  you,  did  it?"  said  Watkins,  with 
a  sneer. 

"Certainly,"  said  Cyprien.  "Was  it  not  found  on  my 
claim  by  Mataki,  who  was  in  my  service?" 

"Nothing  could  be  more  correct,"  answered  the  farmer, 
"and  consequently  it  belonged  to  me  by  the  terms  of  our 
agreement,  which  gave  me  the  three  first  stones  which 
turned  up." 

Cyprien  gazed  in  astonishment.  It  was  true,  and  he 
said  nothing. 

"My  claim  is  just,  I  believe?"  asked  John  Watkins. 

"Quite  just,"  answered  Cyprien. 

"I  shall  be  very  much  obliged  to  you,  then,  if  you  will 
say  so  in  writing,  in  case  we  come  across  the  diamond 
which  some  scoundrel  has  so  impudently  stolen." 


294  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

Cyprien  seized  a  sheet  of  blank  paper,  and  wrote: 

I  beg  to  state  that  the  diamond  found  on  my  claim  by 
a  Kaffir  in  my  service  is,  under  the  terms  of  my  agree- 
ment, the  property  of  Mr.  John  Stapleton  Watkins. 

"VICTOR  CYPRIEN." 

And  with  this  vanished  all  the  dreams  of  our  youthful 
engineer.  If  the  diamond  ever  did  appear,  it  belonged  of 
right  to  Watkins,  and  a  new  abyss  that  many  millions 
could  not  fill  had  opened  between  Alice  and  him. 

And  if  the  farmer's  claim  was  disastrous  to  these  two, 
it  was  none  the  less  so  to  Mataki.  The  diamond  had  been 
stolen  from  John  Watkins,  and  John  Watkins  was  not  the 
man  to  abandon  the  chase  when  he  thought  the  thief  was 
in  his  power. 

And  so  Mataki  was  arrested,  imprisoned,  and  in  twelve 
hours  had  been  sentenced  to  be  hanged,  in  spite  of  all  that 
Cyprien  could  say  or  do  for  him. 

*'  He  would  escape,  if  he  would  restore  the  Star  of  the 
South.  But  he  could  not  restore  it,  for  he  had  never  taken 
it.  And  Cyprien  did  not  know  what  to  do  to  save  the 
unfortunate  man,  in  whose  innocence  he  was  obstinate 
enough  still  to  believe. 

CHAPTER  XXII 

A  MINE  OF  A  NEW  SORT 

Miss  WATKINS  notwithstanding  Cyprien's  silence,  soon 
heard  all  about  the  visit  of  the  masked  men. 

"Ah!"  she  said  to  him.  "Is  not  your  life  worth  more 
than  all  the  diamonds  in  the  world?" 

"Dearest  Alice—" 

"You  must  not  experiment  in  that  way  any  more." 

"You  order  me?" 

"Yes!  I  order  you  to  leave  off,  as  I  once  ordered  you 
to  begin.  That  is,  if  you  like  to  take  orders  from  me." 

"As  I  like  always  to  obey  them,"  said  Cyprien,  taking 
the  hand  that  Alice  held  out  to  him. 

But  when  he  told  her  what  had  happened  to  Mataki, 
she  was  in  despair,  particularly  when  she  learned  that  her 
father  was  the  cause. 


A  MINE  OF  A  NEW  SORT  295 

She,  like  Cyprien,  did  not  believe  in  the  poor  Kaffir's 
guilt.  She,  like  him,  would  do  all  she  could  to  save  him. 
But  how  to  do  so,  and  how  to  influence  her  father  in  his 
favor  was  more  than  she  could  discover. 

Mr.  Watkins  had  obtained  no  confession  from  Mataki. 
He  had  shown  him  the  gallows  on  which  he  was  to  hang; 
he  had  promised  him  pardon,  if  he  would  only  confess; 
but  all  to  no  purpose.  Then,  having  to  give  up  all  hope 
of  ever  recovering  the  Star  of  the  South,  he  had  gone 
quite  mad  with  rage.  No  one  dare  come  near  him. 

The  day  after  the  sentence,  Mr.  Watkins,  suffering 
rather  less  than  usual  from  his  gout,  took  advantage  of 
the  relief  to  put  his  papers  in  order.  Seated  in  front  of 
a  large  writing-table  of  ebony  inlaid  with  yellow  mar- 
queterie,  a  relic  of  the  old  Dutch  domination,  stranded 
after  many  vicissitudes  in  this  remote  corner  of  Griqua- 
land,  he  was  leisurely  running  through  his  different  as- 
signments, agreements,  and  correspondence. 

Behind  him,  Alice,  lost  in  her  work,  was  stitching  away, 
without  noticing  the  big  ostrich,  Dada,  who  stalked  about 
the  room  with  his  usual  gravity,  sometimes  giving  a 
glance  out  of  the  window,  sometimes  giving  a  long,  scru- 
tinizing look  at  Mr.  Watkins. 

An  exclamation  from  the  farmer  made  Alice  look  up. 
"That  bird  is  a  nuisance!"  he  said.  "Look,  he  has 
swallowed  a  deed!  Here,  Dada!  Tsh!  Tsh!  Give  it 
up!  Give  it  up!"  And  then  came  a  torrent  of  abuse. 
"You  wretched  old  brute!  You  have  swallowed  it!  A 
most  important  thing  like  that!  The  deed  of  assignment 
that  gave  me  the  Kopje!  It  is  abominable!  I'll  make 
you  give  it  up — if  I  have  to  throttle  you!" 

And  Watkins  jumped  off  the  chair  and  ran  after  the 
ostrich,  which  made  two  or  three  turns  of  the  room,  and 
then  bounded  out  through  the  open  window. 

"Father !"  said  Alice,  aghast  at  her  favorite's  greediness, 

"do  be  calm!    Listen  to  me!    You  will  make  yourself  ill!" 

But  Watkins  did  not  hear  her.     The  ostrich's  escape 

had  driven  him  to  distraction;  and,  almost  choking  with 

rage,  he  hobbled  after  the  bird,  and  roared  out: 

"I  have  had  too  much  of  it!  I  will  settle  you!  I  am 
not  going  to  give  up  my  title-deeds  in  that  way!  I  will 
put  a  bullet  through  you,  and  we'll  see!" 


296  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

Alice  burst  into  tears. 

"Father!  Do  have  mercy  on  the  poor  thing!"  said  she. 
"Is  the  paper  so  very  important?  Cannot  you  get  a  dupli- 
cate? Will  you  make  me  miserable  and  kill  poor  Dada 
for  such  a  trifle  as  that?" 

But  John  Watkins  would  hear  nothing.  He  was  look- 
ing around  on  all  sides  in  search  of  the  victim. 

At  last  he  caught  sight  of  Dada  standing  by  the  side  of 
the  hut  occupied  by  Cyprien.  Bringing  his  gun  to  his 
shoulder  he  took  aim,  but  the  ostrich  seemed  to  recognize 
the  danger,  and  disappeared  around  the  corner. 

"Just  wait!  Wait!  I'll  have  you,  you  brute!"  said 
Watkins. 

And  Alice,  more  frightened  than  ever,  followed  him, 
to  make  yet  another  appeal  for  mercy. 

They  reached  the  hut  and  walked  around  it.  No 
ostrich!  Dada  had  become  invisible! 

He  could  not  have  left  the  hill,  for  they  would  have 
seen  him.  He  must  have  gone  inside  the  hut  through  the 
door,  or  through  one  of  the  windows  which  were  open  at 
the  back. 

So  thought  Watkins.  And  he  hurried  up  and  knocked 
at  the  door.  Cyprien  opened  it. 

"Mr.  Watkins?  Miss  Watkins?  I  am  delighted  to  see 
you.  Come  in,"  said  he,  looking  very  much  surprised  at 
the  unexpected  visit. 

The  farmer  hastily  explained  matters.  He  was  very 
much  out  of  breath,  and  very  much  excited. 

"Well,  well,  have  a  look  for  the  culprit,"  said  Cyprien. 

"And  I'll  precious  soon  settle  his  hash  for  him!"  added 
the  farmer,  brandishing  his  gun  like  a  tomahawk. 

At  the  same  moment  a  glance  from  the  young  lady 
showed  Cyprien  the  horror  with  which  she  regarded  the 
projected  execution.  His  mind  was  consequently  made 
up  immediately.  He  would  not  find  the  ostrich. 

"Li,"  he  whispered  to  the  Chinaman,  "I  expect  the 
ostrich  is  in  your  room.  Tie  it  up  there,  and  let  it  get 
away  as  soon  as  I  have  taken  Mr.  Watkins  in  the  oppo- 
site direction." 

Unfortunately  this  excellent  plan  proved  a  failure  at  the 
outset,  for  the  ostrich  had  taken  refuge  in  the  very  first 
room  into  which  Mr.  Watkins  went.  There  it  was,  mak- 


A  MINE  OF  A  NEW  SORT  297 

ing  itself  as  small  as  possible,  with  its  head  stuck  under 
a  chair,  but  as  visible  as  the  sun  at  noonday. 

Watkins  rushed  at  it. 

"Now,  you  brute,  your  time  has  come!" 

But,  angry  as  he  was,  he  hesitated.  To  fire  a  gun 
point-blank  in  a  house  that  did  not  belong  to  him  was 
rather  too  strong  a  proceeding. 

Alice  turned  away  and  wept,  and  saw  nothing  of  this 
hesitation. 

Then  a  brilliant  idea  occurred  to  the  engineer. 

"Mr.  Watkins!  You  only  want  to  recover  your  paper? 
Well,  you  need  not  kill  Dada  to  do  that!  We  can  open 
the  stomach,  for  the  document  can  hardly  have  got  out  of 
it  yet.  Will  you  allow  me  to  try  the  operation?  I  have 
worked  at  zoology  at  the  museum,  and  I  know  quite 
enough  to  manage  a  little  surgical  affair  like  that." 

Whether  it  was  that  the  idea  of  vivisection  flattered  the 
vengeful  instincts  of  the  farmer,  or  that  his  anger  was 
cooling  down,  or  that  he  was  touched  by  his  daughter's 
tears,  any  way,  he  allowed  himself  to  be  persuaded,  and 
accepted  the  compromise. 

"But  we  must  not  lose  the  document,"  insisted  he;  "if 
it  is  not  in  the  stomach,  we  must  go  farther  down  for  it! 
I  must  have  it  at  any  price." 

The  operation  was  not  quite  so  easy  as  it  looked  at 
first  sight,  notwithstanding  the  resigned  attitude  of  the 
wretched  Dada.  A  small  ostrich  has  prodigious  strength, 
and  once  the  patient  felt  the  amateur  surgeon's  knife,  the 
gigantic  Dada  might  turn  on  them  in  anger,  and  escape. 
And  so  Li  and  Bardik  were  called  in  to  assist. 

First  of  all  the  ostrich  had  to  be  secured.  The  lines 
which  Li  always  kept  in  his  room  came  in  very  handy. 
An  arrangement  of  hitches  and  knots  soon  bound  Dada 
beak  and  foot. 

Cyprien  did  not  stop  there.  In  order  to  spare  the 
sensibility  of  Miss  Watkins,  he  resolved  to  save  the  ostrich 
all  pain,  and  so  covered  its  head  with  a  handkerchief 
moistened  with  chloroform. 

That  done,  he  began  the  operation,  not  without  con- 
siderable anxiety. 

Alice,  shuddering  at  these  preliminaries  and  pale  as 
death,  had  taken  refuge  in  an  adjoining  room. 


298  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

Cyprien  began  by  feeling  at  the  base  of  the  bird's  neck 
so  as  to  find  the  gizzard.  This  was  not  very  difficult,  for 
the  gizzard  forms  at  the  upper  part  of  the  thoracic  region 
a  mass  of  some  size,  hard  and  prominent,  which  the  fingers 
could  easily  distinguish  among  the  softer  parts  of  its 
vicinity. 

With  a  sharp  penknife  the  skin  of  the  neck  was  care- 
fully cut  into.  It  was  large  and  loose,  like  that  of  a 
turkey,  and  covered  with  gray  down,  which  was  easily 
pressed  aside.  The  incision  caused  just  a  little  blood  to 
flow,  and  this  was  carefully  wiped  off  with  a  wet  rag. 

Cyprien  noticed  the  position  of  the  two  or  three  impor- 
tant arteries,  and  carefully  pulled  them  aside  with  the  wire 
hooks  he  had  given  Bardik  to  hold.  Then  he  opened  a 
white,  pearly  tissue,  which  filled  a  large  cavity  above  the 
collar-bone.  He  had  reached  the  gizzard. 

Imagine  the  gizzard  of  a  fowl  increased  almost  a  hun- 
dred-fold in  size,  hardness,  and  weight,  and  you  have  the 
gizzard  of  the  ostrich. 

Dada's  gizzard  looked  like  a  large,  brown  pocket, 
greatly  distended  with  the  food  or  the  foreign  bodies  that 
the  voracious  animal  had  swallowed  during  the  day — or 
in  the  past.  And  it  was  quite  enough  to  see  this  brawny, 
healthy  organ  to  understand  that  there  was  little  danger 
in  resolutely  attacking  it. 

With  the  sharp  hunting-knife  that  Li  placed  in  his 
hand,  Cyprien  cut  deeply  down  into  the  mass. 

Down  the  fissure  it  was  easy  to  introduce  the  hand  to 
the  very  bottom  of  the  gizzard. 

The  first  thing  Cyprien  lighted  on  was  the  deed  so 
much  regretted  by  Mr.  Watkins.  It  was  rolled  up  into 
a  ball,  slightly  creased  perhaps,  but  still  intact. 

"There  is  something  else,"  said  Cyprien,  who  had  put 
back  his  hand  into  the  hole.  And  bringing  it  back,  he 
found  an  ivory  ball.  "The  darning-ball  belonging  to  Miss 
Watkins,"  he  exclaimed.  "Only  think,  it  is  five  months 
ago  since  it  was  swallowed!  Evidently  it  could  not  pass 
the  lower  orifice." 

He  handed  the  ball  to  Bardik,  and  resumed  his  investi- 
gations like  an  archaeologist  amid  the  ruins  of  a  Roman 
camp. 

"A   copper  candlestick!"   he  exclaimed,   extracting  one 


A  MINE  OF  A  NEW  SORT  299 

of  those  useful  articles,  crushed,  flattened,  oxydized,  but 
still  recognizable. 

Here  the  laughter  of  Bardik  and  Li  became  so  noisy 
that  Alice,  who  had  just  entered  the  room,  could  not  help 
joining  in. 

"Some  coins!  A  key!  A  small-tooth  comb!"  continued 
Cyprien,  proceeding  with  his  inventory. 

Suddenly  he  turned  pale.  His  fingers  seemed  to  grasp 
an  exceptional  form!  No!  There  could  be  no  doubt  of 
it!  And  yet  he  hardly  dared  to  believe  in  such  good 
fortune ! 

At  length  he  pulled  out  his  hand,  and  held  up  the  object 
he  had  found. 

And  what  a  shout  escaped  from  John  Watkins! 

"The  Star  of  the  South !" 

Yes.  The  famous  diamond  was  recovered  intact,  and 
had  lost  none  of  its  brilliancy.  It  sparkled  in  the  light 
from  the  window  like  a  constellation. 

One  strange  thing  about  it  was  noticed  at  once  by  all 
present.  It  had  changed  color! 

Instead  of  being  black,  as  formerly,  the  Star  of  the 
South  was  now  rose-color.  A  beautiful  rose,  which  added, 
if  possible,  to  its  limpidity  and  splendor. 

"Do  you  think  that  will  damage  its  value?"  asked 
Watkins,  as  soon  as  he  could  speak,  for  surprise  and  de- 
light had  almost  deprived  him  of  breath. 

"Not  the  least  in  the  world,"  said  Cyprien.  "On  the 
contrary,  it  is  an  additional  peculiarity  which  classes  the 
stone  among  the  rare  family  of  chameleon  diamonds.  It 
does  not  seem  to  be  very  cold  in  Dada's  gizzard,  though 
it  is  generally  due  to  sudden  changes  of  temperature  that 
we  get  the  alteration  in  tint  of  the  colored  diamonds." 

"Ah!  At  all  events,  I  have  found  you  again,  my 
beauty,"  said  Watkins,  clasping  the  diamond  in  his  hand 
to  assure  himself  it  was  not  all  a  dream.  "You  have 
caused  me  so  much  anxiety  by  your  flight,  ungrateful 
Star,  that  I  shall  not  let  you  go  again."  And  he  lifted 
it  to  his  eyes,  and  he  gave  such  a  longing  look  that  he 
seemed  about  to  swallow  it,  like  another  Dada. 

Cyprien  ordered  Bardik  to  give  him  a  needle  threaded 
with  coarse  thread,  and  then  he  carefully  replaced  the 
gizzard  of  the  ostrich.  Then  he  sewed  up  the  incision  in 


300  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

the  neck,  and  then  he  undid  the  bandages.  Dada,  much 
crestfallen,  hung  his  head,  and  did  not  seem  disposed  to 
move. 

"Do  you  think  he  will  get  over  it?"  asked  Alice,  more 
interested  in  the  sufferings  of  her  favorite  than  in  the 
reappearance  of  the  diamond. 

"Get  over  it,  Miss  Watkins?"  said  Cyprien.  "Do  you 
think  I  should  have  tried  the  operation,  if  I  had  not  been 
sure  he  would?  In  three  days  he  will  feel  nothing  of  it, 
and  in  two  hours  he  will  have  filled  the  curious  pouch  we 
have  just  emptied." 

Reassured  by  the  promise,  Alice  gave  the  engineer  a 
look  of  gratitude  that  fully  recompensed  him  for  all  his 
trouble.  As  she  did  so,  Mr.  Watkins  had  just  succeeded 
in  convincing  himself  that  he  was  in  his  sober  senses,  and 
that  he  had  really  recovered  his  wonderful  diamond.  He 
left  the  window. 

"Mr.  Cyprien,"  he  said,  in  majestic  and  solemn  tones, 
"you  have  done  me  a  great  service,  and  I  do  not  know 
how  to  reward  you  for  it." 

Cyprien's  heart  began  to  leap. 

To  reward  him!  Well,  Mr.  Watkins,  there  was  a  very 
simple  way!  Was  it  so  difficult  to  keep  your  promise  and 
give  your  daughter's  hand  to  the  man  who  brought  back 
the  Star  of  the  South?  Was  it  not  the  same  as  if  he  had 
brought  it  from  the  depths  of  the  Transvaal? 

So  Cyprien  thought,  but  he  was  too  proud  to  speak. 
And,  besides,  he  thought  the  same  idea  might  occur  to  the 
farmer.  But  Watkins  said  nothing  at  all  about  it,  and 
having  beckoned  to  his  daughter,  left  the  hut,  and  returned 
to  the  farm. 

It  need  hardly  be  said  that  a  few  minutes  afterward 
Mataki  was  set  free.  But  he  had  had  a  narrow  escape  of 
paying  with  his  life  for  the  greediness  of  Dada,  and  had 
got  off  unexpectedly  well. 


THE  HOUR  OF  TRIUMPH  301 


CHAPTER  XXIII 

THE   HOUR  OF  TRIUMPH 

THE  fortunate  John  Watkins,  now  the  richest  farmer  in 
Griqualand,  having  already  given  a  dinner  in  honor  of 
the  birth  of  the  Star  of  the  South,  considered  that  he 
could  not  do  better  than  give  another  in  honor  of  its 
restoration.  This  time,  however,  precautions  were  taken 
against  a  disappearance,  and  Dada  was  not  one  of  the 
guests. 

The  dinner  took  place  in  the  afternoon  of  the  day  after 
that  on  which  the  Star  was  recovered.  Watkins  had  in- 
vited all  his  friends,  of  high  and  low  degree.  He  had 
ordered  from  the  butcher  sufficient  meat  to  feed  a  squad- 
ron of  dragoons,  and  bought  up  all  the  wines,  liquors,  and 
provisions,  preserved  and  otherwise,  that  the  neighbor- 
hood could  furnish. 

By  four  o'clock  the  table  was  laid  in  the  large  room, 
the  wine  was  ready  on  the  sideboard,  and  the  beef  and 
mutton  were  roasting  at  the  fire.  At  six  o'clock  the 
guests  arrived,  all  dressed  in  their  very  best.  At  seven 
the  diapason  of  conversation  had  attained  such  volume 
that  a  trumpet  would  have  had  hard  work  to  make  itself 
heard  above  the  uproar.  There  was  Mathys  Pretorius, 
who  had  regained  his  equanimity  now  that  he  had  no 
longer  to  fear  the  persecutions  of  Pantalacci;  there  was 
Thomas  Steel,  the  picture  of  health  and  strength;  there 
was  Nathan  the  broker;  and  there  were  the  farmers,  the 
diggers  and  all  the  leading  tradesmen  of  Vandergaart 
Kopje. 

Cyprien,  thanks  to  Alice's  commands,  had  not  been  able 
to  decline  his  invitation,  and  Alice  herself  was,  of  course, 
present.  And  both  of  them  were  very  miserable,  for  the 
"more  than  millionaire,"  John  Watkins,  could  no  longer 
dream  of  giving  his  daughter  to  "a  mere  engineer,  who 
did  not  even  know  how  to  make  a  diamond!" 

Thus  did  the  worthy  egotist  speak  of  the  man  to  whom 
he  owed  his  newly-found  wealth. 

The  dinner  proceeded  amid  the  unrestrained  enthusiasm 
of  the  diners.  In  front  of  the  fortunate  farmer — and  not 
behind  him,  as  on  the  former  occasion — the  Star  of  the 


302  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

South  reposed  on  a  tiny  cushion  of  blue  velvet.  It  was 
placed  inside  a  glass  globe,  and  the  glass  was  inside  a 
cage  of  substantial  iron  bars.  Ten  toasts  had  already 
been  drunk  to  its  beauty,  to  its  incomparable  limpidity,  to 
its  unequaled  brilliancy.  The  heat  was  overpowering. 

Isolated  and  meditative,  Miss  Watkins  seemed  uncon- 
scious of  the  tumult  around  her.  She  looked  at  Cyprion, 
and  the  tears  began  to  gather  in  her  eyes.  Suddenly  three 
loud  knocks  were  heard  at  the  door.  The  noise  was  in- 
stantly hushed. 

"Come  in!"  shouted  Watkins,  "whoever  you  are.  If 
you  are  thirsty,  you  are  just  in  time." 

The  door  opened.  The  long,  lean  figure  of  Jacobus 
Vandergaart  appeared  in  the  doorway. 

The  guests  looked  at  each  other  in  surprise.  The  ani- 
mosity between  Watkins  and  Vandergaart  was  so  noto- 
rious that  a  murmur  of  expectancy  ran  around  the  table. 
Every  one  anticipated  something  serious.  Every  sound 
was  hushed!  Every  eye  was  turned  on  the  old  lapidary. 
Standing  erect,  with  his  arms  crossed,  with  his  silver  locks 
escaping  from  beneath  his  hat,  with  his  long  black  coat 
that  he  wore  only  on  high  days  and  holidays,  he  seemed 
the  very  spirit  of  revenge. 

John  Watkins  was  seized  with  a  vague  terror,  and  a 
secret  shudder  passed  through  him.  He  turned  pale,  not- 
withstanding the  fiery  tint  with  which  his  devotions  at  the 
alcoholic  shrine  had  been  repaid.  He  seemed  to  struggle 
against  some  unaccountable  presentiment  as  he  broke 
silence  with,  "Well,  it  is  a  long  time,  neighbor  Vander- 
gaart, since  you  gave  me  the  chance  of  seeing  you  in  my 
house.  What  good  wind  has  blown  you  here  this  even- 
ing?" 

"The  wind  of  justice,"  said  the  old  man  coldly, 
come  to  tell  you  that  right  has  triumphed  after  an  eclipse 
of  seven  years !  I  come  to  tell  you  that  the  hour  of  atone- 
ment has  struck,  that  I  take  back  my  own  again,  and 
that  the  Kopje,  which  has  always  borne  my  name,  is  now 
mine  in  law  as  it  always  has  been  mine  in  equity!  John 
Watkins,  you  have  been  stripped  of  what  belongs  to  me! 
Today  it  is  you  whom  the  law  nas  despoiled  and  con- 
demned to  give  back  what  you  took  from  me!" 

When  Watkins  first  caught  sight  of  Vandergaart  and 


THE  HOUR  OF  TRIUMPH  303 

the  vague  fear  of  danger  stole  over  him  he  felt  the  blood 
run  cold  in  his  veins;  but  now  the  danger  had  become 
distinct  and  defined,  his  sanguine,  violent  temperament 
made  him  advance  to  meet  it. 

And  so,  lolling  back  in  his  arm-chair,  he  said,  with  a 
scornful  laugh,  "The  good  man  is  mad !  I  always  thought 
he  was  cracked,  and  it  seems  that  the  hole  has  got  bigger !" 

The  guests  applauded  the  pleasantry.  Vandergaart  re- 
mained impassive.  "He  laughs  best  who  laughs  last," 
said  he,  as  he  drew  a  folded  paper  from  his  pocket.  "John 
Watkins,  you  know  that  a  formal  judgment,  confirmed  on 
appeal,  so  that  the  Queen  herself  could  not  put  it  aside, 
assigned  to  you  the  land  in  this  district  lying  to  the  west 
of  the  twenty-fifth  degree  of  east  longitude,  and  assigned 
to  me  all  that  lying  to  the  east  of  that  meridian?" 

"Precisely  so,  my  worthy  historian,"  exclaimed  John 
Watkins;  "and  you  would  spend  your  time  much  better 
at  home  in  bed  than  in  coming  here  and  interrupting  a 
lot  of  fellows  at  their  dinner  who  do  not  happen  to  owe 
a  farthing  to  any  one." 

Vandergaart  unfolded  the  paper.  "This  is  a  certificate," 
continued  he,  in  his  mildest  voice,  "of  the  Lands  De- 
partment, countersigned  by  the  governor,  and  duly  reg- 
istered at  Victoria  the  day  before  yesterday,  to  the  effect 
that  there  is  a  serious  error  in  all  the  existing  maps  and 
plans  of  Griqualand.  The  error  was  committed  ten  years 
ago  by  the  surveyors  who  plotted  the  district,  and  who 
forgot  to  make  the  necessary  allowance  for  magnetic 
variation  in  their  determination  of  the  true  north.  The 
error  affects  every  map  and  plan  of  the  district  they  sur- 
veyed. The  rectification  of  that  error,  which  has  now 
been  made,  takes  the  twenty-fifth  degree  of  longitude 
three  miles  farther  west.  That  rectification  reinstates  me 
in  possession  of  the  Kopje  which  was  adjudged  to  you — 
for,  in  the  opinion  of  the  lawyers  and  of  the  chief  justice 
himself,  the  original  judgment  still  stands!  That,  Mr. 
Watkins,  is  what  I  came  here  to  tell  you!" 

Whether  it  was  that  the  farmer  had  imperfectly  under- 
stood, or  that  he  simply  refused  to  understand,  he  again 
tried  to  answer  the  lapidary  with  a  scornful  laugh.  But 
this  time  the  laugh  sounded  hollow,  and  received  no  echo 
from  those  around  the  table.  The  witnesses  of  the  scene 


304  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

sat  lost  in  astonishment,  with  their  eyes  fixed  on  Vander- 
gaart,  apparently  as  much  struck  by  his  gravity  and  as- 
surance as  by  the  confidence  he  evidently  felt. 

Nathan  was  the  first  to  break  silence,  and  give  expres- 
sion to  the  general  feeling.  "There  is  nothing  absurd, 
at  first  sight,  in  what  Vandergaart  has  said.  The  error 
might  have  been  made  in  the  longitude  after  all,  and 
before  doing  anything  either  way,  it  may  be  as  well  to 
wait  for  further  proofs/' 

"Wait  for  proofs!"  exclaimed  Watkins,  slapping  his 
fist  down  on  the  table.  "I  don't  want  any  proofs!  I 
laugh  at  your  proofs!  Is  this  my  house  or  is  it  not? 
Have  I  not  been  maintained  in  possession  of  the  Kopje 
by  a  definite  judgment,  of  which  even  this  old  crocodile 
recognizes  the  validity?  Well,  what  does  anything  else 
matter  to  me?  If  I  am  to  be  molested  in  the  peaceful 
possession  of  my  own,  I'll  do  what  I  did  before,  I'll  go 
to  the  courts,  and  we'll  soon  see  who'll  win!" 

"The  courts,"  replied  Vandergaart,  with  his  inexorable 
moderation,  "have  done  all  they  can.  There  is  now  only 
a  question  of  fact.  Does  the  twenty-fifth  degree  of  longi- 
tude run  where  it  says  it  does  on  the  plans,  or  does  it 
not?  And  it  has  been  officially  decided  that  it  does  not; 
that  there  has  been  a  mistake  in  the  matter;  and  the  con- 
clusion is  inevitable  that  the  Kopje  must  be  given  back  to 
me."  And  so  saying,  Vandergaart  displayed  the  official 
certificate,  with  all  its  seals  and  signatures. 

The  farmer's  embarrassment  became  manifestly  serious. 
He  fidgeted  in  his  chair.  He  tried  to  laugh,  and  the  at- 
tempt failed.  His  eyes  by  chance  rested  on  the  Star  of  the 
South.  The  sight  seemed  to  restore  the  confidence  that 
was  fast  forsaking  him. 

"And  if  so,"  he  replied,  "if  in  defiance  of  all  right  and 
justice  the  property  legally  given  to  me,  and  peacefully 
enjoyed  by  me  for  the  last  seven  years,  has  to  be  given 
back,  what  does  it  matter?  Have  I  not  something  to  con- 
sole me  in  that  solitary  gem,  which  I  can  put  in  my  waist- 
coat pocket  and  snap  my  fingers  at  the  world?" 

"You  are  wrong  again,  John  Watkins,"  answered  Van- 
dergaart very  decidedly.  "The  Star  of  the  South  is  now 
mine  by  the  same  title  as  that  by  which  I  hold  the  Kopje. 


THE  FATE  OF  THE  STAR  305 

Everything  is  mine — your  house  and  all  it  contains.  And 
I  am  prepared  to  take  it,  as  you  see!" 

And  Vandergaart  clapped  his  bony  hands,  and  a  file  of 
police  appeared  at  the  open  door,  and  a  sheriff's  officer 
stepped  in,  seized  a  chair,  and  took  possession  in  all  due 
form.  The  guests  had  risen.  The  farmer  remained  in 
his  chair,  looking  as  crushed  and  helpless  as  if  he  had 
been  struck  by  lightning. 

Alice  had  thrown  her  arm  around  his  neck,  and  was 
trying  in  vain  to  comfort  him.  Vandergaart  never  took 
his  eyes  off  him.  In  his  glance  there  was  more  of  pity 
than  of  hate,  as  he  followed  the  look  which  the  farmer 
gave  the  Star  of  the  South,  now  sparkling  more  brilliantly 
than  ever  in  the  center  of  the  scene  of  disaster. 

"Ruined!  Ruined!"  The  words  were  all  that  escaped 
from  the  farmer's  quivering  lips. 

And  then  arose  Cyprien.  "Mr.  Watkins,"  he  said,  "now 
that  your  prosperity  seems  to  be  under  a  cloud,  perhaps 
you  will  allow  me  to  take  advantage  of  the  opportunity 
that  offers.  I  have  the  honor  to  ask  for  your  daughter's 
hand!" 


CHAPTER  XXIV 

THE  FATE  OF  THE  STAR 

THE  effect  of  the  engineer's  speech  was  truly  gratifying. 
Its  complete  disinterestedness  touched  the  not  very  sen- 
sitive hearts  of  the  guests,  and  there  was  a  round  of 
noisy  applause. 

Alice,  with  her  eyes  cast  down  and  her  heart  beating 
violently,  seemed  the  only  one  that  betrayed  no  surprise 
at  her  lover's  proceedings;  and  she  remained  silent  by  her 
father's  side.  Watkins,  still  crushed  by  his  terrible  mis- 
fortune, raised  his  head.  He  knew  enough  of  Cyprien  to 
know  that  if  he  gave  him  his  daughter,  her  happiness 
would  be  assured,  but  he  would  not  yet  admit  that  he  saw 
no  objection  to  the  marriage.  Cyprien,  confused  at  the 
publicity  to  which  his  ardor  had  committed  him,  grew 
conscious  of  the  strangeness  of  the  position,  and  wished 
he  had  remained  more  master  of  his  feelings. 

The  silence  of  mutual  embarrassment  was  ended   by 

Vol.  13  Verne 


306  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

Vandergaart,  who  stepped  toward  the  farmer.  "John 
Watkins,"  said  he,  "I  do  not  wish  to  abuse  my  victory, 
and  I  am  not  one  of  those  that  strike  a  man  when  he  is 
down.  In  vindicating  my  right,  I  have  only  done  my 
duty.  But  I  know  by  experience  that  right  may  sometimes 
border  closely  on  injustice,  and  I  do  not  wish  to  visit 
your  sins  on  the  heads  of  those  who  are  innocent.  Be- 
sides, I  am  alone  in  the  world,  and  not  so  very  far  from 
my  grave.  What  is  the  use  of  so  much  wealth,  if  I  can- 
not dispose  of  it?  If,  Watkins,  you  agree  to  the  match 
between  these  two  youngsters,  I  will  give  them  the  Star 
of  the  South  as  a  wedding  present!  And  I  will  make 
them  my  heirs;  and  thus,  as  fully  as  I  can,  repair  the  in- 
voluntary injury  I  have  done  to  your  daughter!" 

At  these  words  a  murmur  of  sympathetic  interest  ran 
around  the  assemblage.  Every  one  looked  at  John  Wat- 
kins.  His  eyes  seemed  to  glisten  as  he  shaded  them  with 
his  trembling  hand.  "Jacobus  Vandergaart !"  he  cried, 
unable  to  restrain  the  tumultuous  feelings  which  agitated 
him.  "Yes!  You  are  a  real  good  fellow,  and  in  thus 
ensuring  the  young  people's  happiness  you  have  nobly 
avenged  the  wrong  I  did  you." 

Neither  Alice  nor  Cyprien  could  find  words  to  reply, 
but  their  looks  spoke  for  them.  The  old  man  held  out 
his  hand  to  his  enemy,  and  Watkins  clasped  it  eagerly. 
And  every  eye  was  moist;  even  the  old  police-sergeant, 
who  looked  as  dry  as  an  Admiralty  biscuit,  found  it  nec- 
essary to  cough  and  use  his  handkerchief. 

Watkins  seemed  quite  a  different  man.  His  expression 
had  changed  to  be  as  kindly  and  gentle  as  it  had  hitherto 
been  hard  and  heartless.  And  Vandergaart  had  resumed 
his  wonted  look  of  placid  good-nature.  "Let  us  forget  and 
forgive,"  said  he,  "and  let  us  wish  the  young  couple  every 
happiness." 

The  storm  having  thus  passed  away,  Vandergaart  took 
his  place  at  the  table,  and  began  to  talk  to  Watkins  of 
his  plans  for  the  future. 

"Let  us  sell  everything  and  go  with  the  youngsters  to 
Europe.  We  could  settle  near  them,  do  some  good  with 
our  money,  and  end  our  days  in  peace." 

Meanwhile  the  temperature  continued  to  rise,  the  air 
becoming  more  and  more  oppressive,  and  converting  the 


THE  FATE  OF  THE  STAR  307 

guests  into  so  many  electrical  machines.  In  vain  the 
windows  and  the  doors  were  thrown  open.  Not  a  breath 
caused  a  candle-flame  to  flicker.  Such  pressure  could 
only  end  in  one  way — there  would  be  a  storm  with  heavy 
thunder  and  torrential  rain,  and  the  relief  that  the  storm 
would  give  was  eagerly  awaited. 

Suddenly  a  blinding  flash  threw  a  sickly  tint  over  all, 
and  instantly  the  roar  of  the  thunder,  as  it  rolled  over 
the  plain,  announced  that  the  concert  had  begun.  At  the 
same  moment  a  furious  squall  burst  into  the  room  and 
blew  out  all  the  lights.  Then  the  cataracts  of  heaven 
were  opened  and  the  deluge  commenced. 

"Did  you  hear  that  sharp  click  after  the  thunderclap?" 
asked  Thomas  Steel,  while  the  windows  were  being  shut 
and  the  candles  relighted.  "I  thought  a  glass  globe  had 
cracked." 

Immediately  all  eyes  instinctively  turned  toward  the 
Star  of  the  South.  The  diamond  had  vanished! 

But  neither  the  iron  cage  nor  the  glass  globe  that 
covered  it  had  changed  its  position.  It  was  manifestly 
impossible  that  any  one  could  have  touched  it. 

The  phenomenon  seemed  to  verge  on  the  miraculous. 
Cyprien  eagerly  leaned  forward  and  noticed  on  the  velvet 
cushion  in  place  of  the  diamond,  a  little  mound  of  ashy 
powder.  He  could  not  restrain  a  shout  of  surprise,  and 
in  a  word  told  what  had  happened,  "The  Star  of  the 
South  has  crumbled  into  dust!" 

Every  one  in  Griqualand  knows  that  this  curious  prop- 
erty is  peculiar  to  the  diamonds  of  the  district.  Though 
not  often  mentioned  it  is  nevertheless  true  that,  owing  to 
some  hitherto  unintelligible  molecular  action,  the  most 
precious  of  the  gems  will  sometimes  fly  to  pieces  like  a 
bombshell,  and  leave  nothing  behind  but  a  tiny  pinch  of 
dust,  that  may  or  may  not  be  of  use  for  industrial  pur- 
poses. 

The  engineer  was  evidently  thinking  more  of  the  scien- 
tific interest  of  the  accident  than  of  the  enormous  pecuni- 
ary loss  it  meant  for  him.  "What  is  very  curious," 
he  said,  while  all  looked  on  amazed,  "is  not  so  much  that 
the  stone  has  crumbled  up,  but  that  it  should  have  waited 
till  today  to  go  off.  Diamonds  generally  break  up  so 


308  STAR  OF  THE  SOUTH 

much  sooner  after  cutting.     About  ten  days  is  the  usual 
time,  is  it  not,  Mr.  Vandergaart  ?" 

"That  is  so,  and  it  is  the  first  time  in  my  life  that  I 
ever  saw  a  diamond  go  three  months  after  it  had  been 
cut!"  said  the  old  man  with  a  sigh.  "You  see,  it  was 
destined  that  the  Star  of  the  South  should  belong  to  no- 
body. When  I  think  that  we  might  have  prevented  the 
disaster,  had  we  given  the  diamond  a  trifling  coat  of 
grease— 

"Really?"  exclaimed  Cyprien,  with  the  satisfaction  of  a 
man  who  at  last  sees  a  way  out  of  a  difficulty.  "Then  I 
can  explain  it  all.  The  poor  fragile  Star  received  the 
coating  of  grease  in  Dada's  gizzard,  and  that  is  why  it 
lasted  till  today.  It  might  have  been  much  better  if  it 
had  gone  to  pieces  four  months  ago,  and  saved  us  our 
scamper  across  the  Transvaal!" 

Watkins  seemed  very  ill  at  ease  in  his  arm-chair,  and 
now  he  broke  out  with,  "How  can  you  take  things  so 
coolly?  There  you  are,  talking  about  the  millions  gone 
in  smoke  as  if  they  were  only  a  cigarette!" 

"That  shows  we  are  philosophers,"  said  Cyprien.  "There 
is  nothing  like  being  wise  when  wisdom  has  become  a 
necessity." 

"Philosophers  if  you  like,"  said  the  farmer.  "But 
millions  are  millions,  and  you  don't  pick  them  up  every 
day.  Ah,  Jacobus!  you  have  done  me  a  greater  service 
than  you  think.  I  am  afraid  I  should  have  gone  off  like 
a  bombshell  had  the  Star  still  been  mine." 

"Why  should  it  matter?"  said  Cyprien,  with  a  tender 
look  at  Alice's  sunny  face.  "I  have  this  evening  won  so 
precious  a  diamond  that  the  loss  of  no  other  can  trouble 
me." 

And  thus  ended,  in  a  way  well  worthy  of  its  brief  and 
troubled  history,  the  career  of  the  largest  cut  diamond 
the  world  has  seen. 

THE    END. 


The  Purchase  of  the  North  Pole 

or 
Earth  Topsy  Turvy 

A  Sequel  to  a  Trip  to  the  Moon 


The  Purchase  of  the  North  Pole 


CHAPTER  I 

THE    NORTH    POLAR    PRACTICAL    ASSOCIATION 

ND  so,  Mr.  Maston,  you  consider  that  a 
woman  can  do  nothing  for  the  advance  of 
the  mathematical  or  experimental  sciences?" 
"To  my  extreme  regret,  Mrs.  Scorbitt," 
said  J.  T.  Maston,  "I  am  obliged  to  say  so. 
That  there  have  been  many  remarkable  fe- 
male mathematicians,  especially  in  Russia,  I  willingly  ad- 
mit ;  but  with  her  cerebral  conformation  it  is  not  in  a  woman 
to  become  an  Archimedes  or  a  Newton." 

"Then,  Mr.  Maston,  allow  me  to  protest  in  the  name  of 
my  sex — " 

"Sex  all  the  more  charming,  Mrs.  Scorbitt,  from  its 
never  having  taken  to  transcendental  studies!" 

"According  to  you,  Mr.  Maston,  if  a  woman  had  seen 
an  apple  fall  she  would  never  have  been  able  to  discover 
the  laws  of  universal  gravitation  as  did  the  illustrious 
Englishman  at  the  close  of  the  seventeenth  century!" 

"In  seeing  an  apple  fall,  Mrs.  Scorbitt,  a  woman  would 
have  only  one  idea — to  eat  it,  after  the  example  of  our 
mother  Eve." 

"You  deny  us  all  aptitude  for  the  higher  speculations — " 

"All  aptitude?  No,  Mrs.  Scorbitt.  But  I  would  ask 
you  to  remember  that  since  there  have  been  people  on  this 
earth,  and  women  consequently,  there  has  never  been 
discovered  a  feminine  brain  to  which  we  owe  a  discovery 
in  the  domain  of  science  analogous  to  the  discoveries  of 
Aristotle,  Euclid,  Kepler,  or  Laplace." 

"Is  that  a  reason?  Is  it  inevitable  that  the  future 
should  be  as  the  past?" 

"Hum!  That  which  has  not  happened  for  thousands 
of  years  is  not  likely  to  happen." 


3i2   PURCHASE  OF  THE  NORTH  POLE 

"Then  we  must  resign  ourselves  to  our  fate,  Mr.  Mas- 
ton.  And  as  we  are  indeed  good — " 

"And  how  good!"  interrupted  J.  T.  Maston,  with  all 
the  amiable  gallantry  of  which  a  philosopher  crammed 
with  x  was  capable. 

Mrs.  Scorbitt  was  quite  ready  to  be  convinced.  "Well, 
Mr.  Maston,"  she  said,  "each  to  his  lot  in  this  world. 
Remain  the  extraordinary  mathematician  that  you  are. 
Give  yourself  entirely  to  the  problems  of  that  immense 
enterprise  to  which  you  and  your  friends  have  devoted 
their  lives!  I  will  remain  the  good  woman  I  ought  to 
be,  and  assist  you  with  the  means." 

"For  which  you  will  have  our  eternal  gratitude,"  said 
J.  T.  Maston. 

Mrs.  Scorbitt  blushed  deliciously,  for  she  felt,  if  not  for 
philosophers  in  general,  at  least  for  J.  T.  Maston,  a  truly 
strange  sympathy.  Is  not  a  woman's  heart  unfathom- 
able? 

An  immense  enterprise  it  was  which  this  wealthy  Amer- 
ican widow  had  resolved  to  support  with  large  sums  of 
money.  The  object  of  its  promoters  was  as  follows: 

The  Arctic  territories,  properly  so  called,  according  to 
the  highest  geographical  authorities,  are  bounded  by  the 
seventy-eighth  parallel,  and  extend  over  fourteen  hundred 
thousand  square  miles,  while  the  seas  extend  over  seven 
hundred  thousand. 

Within  this  parallel  have  intrepid  modern  discoverers 
advanced  nearly  as  far  as  the  eighty-fourth  degree  of 
latitude,  revealing  many  a  coast  hidden  beyond  the  lofty 
chain  of  icebergs,  giving  names  to  capes,  promontories, 
gulfs,  and  bays  of  these  vast  Arctic  highlands.  But  be- 
yond this  eighty-fourth  parallel  is  a  mystery,  the  unrealiz- 
able desideratum  of  geographers.  No  one  yet  knows  if 
land  or  sea  lies  hidden  in  that  space  of  six  degrees,  that 
impassable  barrier  of  Polar  ice. 

In  this  year,  189 — ,  the  United  States  Government  had 
unexpectedly  proposed  to  put  up  to  auction  the  circum- 
polar  regions  then  remaining  undiscovered,  having  been 
urged  to  this  extraordinary  step  by  an  American  society 
which  had  been  formed  to  obtain  a  concession  of  the  ap- 
parently useless  tract. 

Some  years  before,  the  Berlin  Conference  had  formu- 


NORTH  POLAR  PRACTICAL  ASSOCIATION  313 

lated  a  special  code  for  the  use  of  Great  Powers  wishing 
to  appropriate  the  property  of  another  under  pretext  of 
colonization  or  opening  up  commercial  routes.  But  this 
code  was  not  applicable,  under  the  circumstances,  as  the 
Polar  domain  was  not  inhabited.  Nevertheless,  as  that 
which  belongs  to  nobody  belongs  to  all,  the  new  society 
did  not  propose  to  "take"  but  to  "acquire." 

In  the  United  States  there  is  no  project  so  audacious 
for  which  people  cannot  be  found  to  guarantee  the  cost 
and  find  the  working  expenses.  This  was  well  seen  when 
a  few  years  before  the  Gun  Club  of  Baltimore  had  entered 
on  the  task  of  despatching  a  projectile  to  the  Moon,  in  the 
hope  of  obtaining  direct  communication  with  our  satellite. 
Was  it  not  these  enterprising  Yankees  who  had  furnished 
the  larger  part  of  the  sums  required  by  this  interesting 
attempt?  And  if  it  had  succeeded,  would  it  not  be  owing 
to  two  of  the  members  of  the  said  club  who  had  dared  to 
face  the  risk  of  an  entirely  novel  experiment? 

If  a  Lesseps  were  one  day  to  propose  to  cut  a  gigantic 
canal  through  Europe  and  Asia,  from  the  shores  of  the 
Atlantic  to  the  China  Sea;  if  a  well-sinker  of  genius  were 
to  offer  to  pierce  the  earth  in  the  hopes  of  finding  and 
utilizing  the  beds  of  silicates  supposed  to  be  there'  in  a 
fluid  state;  if  an  enterprising  electrician  proposed  to  com- 
bine the  currents  disseminated  over  the  surface  of  the 
globe  so  as  to  form  an  inexhaustible  source  of  heat  and 
light;  if  a  daring  engineer  were  to  have  the  idea  of  stor- 
ing in  vast  receptacles  the  excess  of  summer  temperature, 
in  order  to  transfer  it  to  the  frozen  regions  in  the  winter; 
if  a  hydraulic  specialist  were  to  propose  to  utilize  the  force 
of  the  tide  for  the  production  of  heat  or  power  at  will;  if 
companies  were  to  be  formed  to  carry  out  a  hundred 
projects  of  this  kind — it  is  the  Americans  who  would  be 
found  at  the  head  of  the  subscribers,  and  rivers  of  dollars 
would  flow  into  the  pockets  of  the  projectors,  as  the  great 
rivers  of  North  America  flow  into — and  are  lost  in — the 
ocean. 

It  was  only  natural  that  public  opinion  should  be  much 
exercised  at  the  announcement  that  the  Arctic  regions  were 
to  be  sold  to  the  highest  bidder,  particularly  as  no  public 
subscription  had  been  opened  with  a  view  to  the  purchase, 
for  "all  the  capital  had  been  subscribed  in  advance,"  and, 


314   PURCHASE  OF  THE  NORTH  POLE 

"it  was  left  for  Time  to  show  how  it  was  proposed  to 
utilize  the  territory  when  it  had  become  the  property  of 
the  purchaser!" 

Utilize  the  Arctic  regions!  In  truth  such  an  idea  could 
only  have  originated  in  the  brain  of  a  madman! 

But  nevertheless  nothing  could  be  more  serious  than 
the  scheme. 

In  fact,  a  communication  had  been  sent  to  many  of  the 
journals  of  both  continents,  concluding  with  a  demand  for 
immediate  inquiry  on  the  part  of  those  interested.  It 
was  the  New  York  Herald  that  first  published  this  curious 
farrago,  and  the  innumerable  patrons  of  Gordon  Bennett 
read,  on  the  morning  of  the  7th  of  November,  the  follow- 
ing advertisement,  which  rapidly  spread  through  the 
scientific  and  industrial  world,  and  became  appreciated  in 
very  different  ways: 

"NOTICE  To  THE  INHABITANTS  OF  THE  TERRESTRIAL 

GLOBE. 

"The  regions  of  the  North  Pole  situated  within  the 
'eighty- fourth  degree  of  north  latitude  have  not  yet  been 
utilized,  for  the  very  good  reason  4hat  they  have  not  yet 
been  discovered. 

"The  furthest  points  attained  by  the  navigators  of 
different  nations  are  the  following:  82°  45',  said  to  have 
been  reached  by  the  Englishman,  Parry,  in  July,  1847,  in 
long.  28°  E.  north  of  Spitzbergen;  83°  20'  28",  said  to 
have  been  reached  by  Markham  in  the  English  expedition 
of  Sir  John  Nares,  in  May,  1876,  in  long.  50°  W.  north  of 
Grinnell  Land;  83°  35',  said  to  have  been  reached  by 
Lockwood  and  Brainard  in  the  American  expedition  of 
Lieutenant  Greely,  in  May,  1882,  in  long.  42°  W.  in  the 
north  of  Nares'  Land. 

"It  can  thus  be  considered  that  the  region  extending 
from  the  eighty-fourth  parallel  to  the  Pole  is  still  un- 
divided among  the  different  States  of  the  globe.  It  is, 
therefore,  excellently  adapted  for  annexation  as  a  private 
estate  after  formal  purchase  in  public  auction. 

"The  property  belongs  to  nobody  by  right  of  occupa- 
tion, and  the  Government  of  the  United  States  of  America, 
having  been  applied  to  in  the  matter,  have  undertaken  to 


NORTH  POLAR  PRACTICAL  ASSOCIATION  315 

name  an  official  auctioneer  for  the  purpose  of  its  disposal. 

"A  company  has  been  formed  at  Baltimore,  under  the 
title  of  the  North  Polar  Practical  Association,  which  pro- 
poses to  acquire  the  region  by  purchase,  and  thus  obtain 
an  indefeasible  title  to  all  the  continents,  islands,  islets, 
rocks,  seas,  lakes,  rivers,  and  watercourses  whatsoever  of 
which  this  Arctic  territory  is  composed,  although  these 
may  be  now  covered  with  ice,  which  ice  may  in  summer- 
time disappear. 

"It  is  understood  that  this  right  will  be  perpetual  and 
indefeasible,  even  in  the  event  of  modification — in  any 
way  whatsoever— —of  the  geographical  or  meteorological 
conditions  of  the  globe. 

"The  project  having  herewith  been  brought  to  the 
knowledge  of  the  people  of  the  two  worlds,  representatives 
of  all  nations  will  be  admitted  to  take  part  in  the  bidding, 
and  the  property  will  be  adjudged  to  the  highest  bidder. 

"The  sale  will  take  place  on  the  3rd  of  December  of  the 
present  year  in  the  Auction  Mart  at  Baltimore,  Maryland, 
United  States  of  America. 

"For  further  particulars  apply  to  William  S.  Forster, 
provisional  agent  of  the  North  Polar  Practical  Associa- 
tion, 93  High  Street,  Baltimore." 

It  may  be  that  this  communication  will  be  considered  as 
a  madman's  freak;  but  at  any  rate  it  must  be  admitted 
that  in  its  clearness  and  frankness  it  left  nothing  to  be 
desired.  The  serious  part  of  it  was  that  the  Federal 
Government  had  undertaken  to  treat  a  sale  by  auction  as 
a  valid  concession  of  these  undiscovered  territories. 

Opinions  on  the  matter  were  many.  Some  readers  saw 
in  it  only  one  of  those  prodigious  outbursts  of  American 
humbug,  which  would  exceed  the  limits  of  puffism  if  the 
depths  of  human  credulity  were  not  unfathomable.  Others 
thought  the  proposition  should  be  seriously  entertained. 
And  these  laid  stress  on  the  fact  that  the  new  company 
had  not  appealed  to  the  public  for  funds.  It  was  with 
their  own  money  that  they  sought  to  acquire  the  northern 
regions.  They  did  not  seek  to  drain  the  dollars  and 
bank-notes  of  the  simple  into  their  coffers.  No !  All  they 
asked  was  to  pay  with  their  own  money  for  their  circum- 
polar  property!  This  was  indeed  extraordinary! 


316        PURCHASE  OF  THE  NORTH  POLE 

To  those  people  who  were  fond  of  figures  it  seemed  that 
all  the  said  company  had  to  do  was  to  buy  the  right  of 
the  first  occupant,  but  that  was  difficult,  as  access  to  the 
Pole  appeared  to  be  forbidden  to  man,  and  the  new  com- 
pany would  necessarily  act  with  prudence,  for  too  many 
legal  precautions  could  hardly  be  taken. 

It  was  noticed  that  the  document  contained  a  clause 
providing  for  future  contingencies.  This  clause  gave  rise 
to  much  contradictory  interpretation,  for  its  precise  mean- 
ing escaped  the  most  subtle  minds.  It  stipulated  that  the 
right  would  be  perpetual,  even  in  the  event  of  modification 
in  any  way  whatsoever  of  the  geographical  or  meteoro- 
logical conditions  of  the  globe.  What  was  the  meaning 
of  this  clause?  What  contingency  did  it  provide  for? 
How  could  the  earth  ever  undergo  a  modification  affecting 
its  geography  or  meteorology,  especially  in  the  territories 
in  question? 

"Evidently,"  said  the  knowing  ones,  "there  is  some- 
thing in  this!" 

Explanations  there  were  many  to  exercise  the  ingenuity 
of  some  and  the  curiosity  of  others. 

The  Philadelphia  Ledger  made  the  following  sugges- 
tion: "The  future  acquirers  of  the  Arctic  regions  have 
doubtless  ascertained  by  calculation  that  the  nucleus  of  a 
comet  will  shortly  strike  the  earth  in  such  a  manner  that 
the  shock  will  produce  the  geographical  and  meteorological 
changes  for  which  the  clause  provides." 

This  sounded  scientific,  but  it  threw  no  light  on  the 
matter.  The  idea  of  a  shock  from  such  a  comet  did  not 
commend  itself  to  the  intelligent.  It  seemed  inadmissible 
that  the  concessionaries  should  have  prepared  for  so  hypo- 
thetical an  eventuality. 

"Perhaps,"  said  the  New  Orleans  Delta,  "the  new  com- 
pany imagine  that  the  precession  of  the  equinoxes  will 
produce  the  modification  favorable  to  the  utilization  of 
their  new  property." 

"And  why  not,"  asked  the  Hamburger  Correspondent, 
"if  the  movement  modifies  the  parallelism  of  the  axis  of 
our  spheroid?" 

"In  fact,"  said  the  Paris  Revue  Scientifique,  "did  not 
Adhemar  say,  in  his  book  on  the  revolutions  of  the  sea, 
that  the  precession  of  the  equinoxes,  combined  with  the 


NORTH  POLAR  PRACTICAL  ASSOCIATION  317 

secular  movement  of  the  major  axis  of  the  terrestrial 
orbit,  would  be  of  a  nature  to  bring  about,  after  a  long 
period,  a  modification  in  the  mean  temperature  of  the 
different  parts  of  the  Earth,  and  in  the  quantity  of  ice 
accumulated  at  the  Poles?" 

"That  is  not  certain,"  said  the  Edinburgh  Guardian, 
"and  even  if  it  were  so,  would  it  not  require  a  lapse  of 
twelve  thousand  years  for  Vega  to  become  our  pole-star, 
in  accordance  with  the  said  phenomenon,  and  for  the 
Arctic  regions  to  undergo  a  change  in  climate?" 

"Well,"  said  the  Copenhagen  Dagblad,  "in  twelve  thou- 
sand years  it  will  be  time  enough  to  subscribe  the  money. 
Meanwhile  we  do  not  intend  to  risk  a  krone." 

But  although  the  Revue  Scientifique  might  be  right 
with  regard  to  Adhemar,  it  was  probable  that  the  North 
Polar  Practical  Association  had  never  reckoned  on  a 
modification  due  to  the  precession  of  the  equinoxes.  And 
no  one  managed  to  discover  the  meaning  of  the  clause,  or 
the  cosmical  change  for  which  it  provided. 

To  ascertain  what  it  meant  application  might  perhaps 
be  made  to  the  directorate  of  the  new  company?  Why 
not  apply  to  its  chairman?  But  the  chairman  was  un- 
known! Unmentioned,  too,  were  the  secretary  and  direc- 
tors. There  was  nothing  to  show  from  whom  the  adver- 
tisement emanated.  It  had  been  brought  to  the  office  of 
the  New  York  Herald  by  a  certain  William  S.  Forster, 
of  Baltimore,  a  worthy  agent  for  codfish,  acting  for 
Ardrinell  and  Co.,  of  Newfoundland,  and  evidently  a  man 
of  straw.  He  was  as  mute  on  the  subject  as  the  fish 
consigned  to  his  care,  and  the  cleverest  of  reporters  and 
interviewers  could  get  nothing  out  of  him. 

But  if  the  promoters  of  this  industrial  enterprise  per- 
sisted in  keeping  their  identity  a  mystery,  their  intentions 
were  indicated  clearly  enough. 

They  intended  to  acquire  the  freehold  of  that  portion  of 
the  Arctic  regions  bounded  by  the  eighty-fourth  parallel 
of  latitude,  with  the  North  Pole  as  the  central  point. 

Nothing  was  more  certain  than  that  among  modern 
discoverers  only  Parry,  Markham,  Lockwood  and  Brain- 
ard  had  penetrated  within  a  degree  of  this  parallel.  Other 
navigators  of  the  Arctic  seas  had  all  halted  far  below  it. 
Payer,  in  1874,  had  stopped  at  82°  15',  to  the  north  of 


3i8   PURCHASE  OF  THE  NORTH  POLE 

Franz  Joseph  Land  and  Nova  Zambia;  De  Long,  in  the 
Jeannette  expedition  in  1879,  had  stopped  at  78°  45',  in 
the  neighborhood  of  the  islands  which  bear  his  name. 
Others,  by  way  of  New  Siberia  and  Greenland,  in  the 
latitude  of  Cape  Bismarck,  had  not  advanced  beyond  the 
76th,  77th,  and  79th  parallels;  so  that  by  leaving  a  space 
of  twenty-five  minutes  between  Lockwood  and  Brainard's 
83°  35'  and  the  84°  mentioned  in  the  prospectus,  the 
North  Polar  Practical  Association  would  not  encroach  on 
prior  discoveries.  Its  project  affected  an  absolutely  virgin 
soil,  untrodden  by  human  foot. 

The  area  of  the  portion  of  the  globe  within  this  eighty- 
fourth  parallel  is  tolerably  large. 

From  84°  to  90°  there  are  six  degrees,  which,  at  sixty 
miles  each,  give  a  radius  of  360  miles  and  a  diameter  of 
720  miles.  The  circumference  is  thus  2216  miles,  and  the 
area,  in  round  numbers,  407,000  square  miles.  This  is 
nearly  a  tenth  of  the  whole  of  Europe — a  good-sized 
estate! 

The  advertisement,  it  will  have  been  noticed,  assumed 
the  principle  that  regions  not  known  geographically  and 
belonging  to  nobody  in  particular  belonged  to  the  world 
at  large.  That  the  majority  of  the  Powers  would  admit 
this  contention  was  supposable,  but  it  was  possible  that 
States  bordering  on  these  Arctic  regions,  or  considering 
the  regions  as  the  prolongation  of  their  dominions  toward 
the  north,  might  claim  a  right  of  possession.  And  their 
pretensions  would  be  all  the  more  justified  by  the  discov- 
eries that  had  been  made  having  been  chiefly  due  to  these 
regions;  and  of  course  the  Federal  Government,  as  nomi- 
nators of  the  auctioneer,  would  give  these  Powers  an 
opportunity  of  claiming  compensation,  and  satisfy  the 
claim  with  the  money  realized  by  the  sale.  At  the  same 
time,  as  the  partisans  of  the  North  Polar  Practical  Asso- 
ciation continually  insisted,  the  property  was  uninhabited, 
and  as  no  one  occupied  it,, no  one  could  oppose  its  being 
put  up  to  auction. 

The  bordering  States  with  rights  not  to  be  disregarded 
were  six  in  number — Great  Britain,  the  United  States, 
Denmark,  Sweden  and  Norway,  Holland,  and  Russia. 
But  there  were  other  countries  that  might  put  in  a  claim 
on  the  ground  of  discoveries  made  by  their  navigators. 


NORTH  POLAR  PRACTICAL  ASSOCIATION  319 

France  might,  as  usual,  have  intervened  on  account  of 
a  few  of  her  children  having  taken  part  in  occasional 
expeditions.  There  was  the  gallant  Bellot,  who  died  in 
1853  near  Beechy  Island,  during  the  voyage  of  the 
Phoenix,  sent  in  search  of  Sir  John  Franklin.  There  was 
Dr.  Octave  Pavy,  who  died  in  1884  at  Cape  Sabine,  dur- 
ing the  stay  of  the  Greely  expedition  at  Fort  Conger. 
And  there  was  the  expedition  in  1838-39,  which  took  to 
the  Spitzbergen  Seas,  Charles  Martins  and  Marmier  and 
Bravais,  and  their  bold  companions.  But  France  did  not 
propose  to  meddle  in  the  enterprise,  which  was  more  indus- 
trial than  scientific;  and,  at  the  outset,  she  abandoned  any 
chance  she  might  have  of  a  slice  of  the  Polar  cake. 

It  was  the  same  with  Germany.  She  could  point  to  the 
Spitzbergen  expedition  of  Frederick  Martens,  and  to  the 
expeditions,  in  1869-70,  of  the  Germania  and  Hansa, 
under  Koldewey  and  Hegeman,  which  reached  Cape  Bis- 
marck on  the  Greenland  coast.  But  notwithstanding  these 
brilliant  discoveries  she  decided  to  make  no  increase  to  the 
Germanic  empire  by  means  of  a  slice  from  the  Pole. 

So  it  was  with  Austria-Hungary,  which,  however,  had 
her  claims  on  Franz  Joseph  Land  to  the  northward  of 
Siberia. 

As  Italy  had  no  right  of  intervention  she  did  not  inter- 
vene— which  is  not  quite  so  obvious  as  it  may  appear. 

The  same  happened  with  regard  to  the  Samoyeds  of 
Siberia,  the  Eskimos  who  are  scattered  along  the  northern 
regions  of  America,  the  natives  of  Greenland,  of  Labrador, 
of  the  Baffin  Parry  Archipelago,  of  the  Aleutian  Islands 
between  Asia  and  America,  and  of  Russian  Alaska,  which 
became  American  in  1867.  But  these  people — the  undis- 
puted aborigines  of  the  northern  regions — had  no  voice  in 
the  matter.  How  could  such  poor  folks  manage  to  make 
a  bid  at  the  auction  promoted  by  the  North  Polar  Practical 
Association?  And  if  they  outbid  the  rest,  how  could 
they  pay?  In  shellfish,  or  walrus  teeth,  or  seal  oil?  But 
surely  they  had  some  claim  on  this  territory?  Strange  to 
say,  they  were  not  even  consulted  in  the  matter! 

Such  is  the  way  of  the  world! 


320   PURCHASE  OF  THE  NORTH  POLE 
CHAPTER  II 

TO   SYNDICATE   OR    NOT   TO   SYNDICATE 

IF  the  new  company  "acquired"  the  Arctic  regions, 
these  regions  would,  owing  to  the  company's  nationality, 
become  for  all  practical  purposes  a  part  of  the  United 
States.  What  would  the  first  inhabitant  say?  Would  the 
other  Powers  permit  it? 

The  Swedes  and  Norwegians  were  the  owners  of  the 
North  Cape,  situated  within  the  seventieth  parallel,  and 
made  no  secret  that  they  considered  they  had  rights  ex- 
tending beyond  Spitzbergen  up  to  the  Pole  itself.  Had 
not  Kheilhau,  the  Norwegian,  and  Nordenskiold,  the  cele- 
brated Swede,  contributed  much  to  geographical  progress 
in  those  regions?  Undoubtedly. 

Denmark  was  already  master  of  Iceland  and  the  Faroe 
Isles, -besides  the  colonies  in  the  Arctic  regions  at  Disco,  in 
Davis's  Straits;  at  Holsteinborg,  Proven,  Godhavn,  and 
Upernavik,  in  Baffin  Sea;  and  on  the  western  coast  of 
Greenland.  Besides,  had  not  Behring,  a  Dane  in  the 
Russian  service,  passed  through  in  1728  the  straights  now 
bearing  his  name?  And  had  he  not  thirteen  years  after- 
ward, died  on  the  island  also  named  after  him?  And 
before  him,  in  1619,  had  not  Jon  Munk  explored  the 
eastern  coast  of  Greenland,  and  discovered  many  points 
up  to  then  totally  unknown?  Was  not  Denmark  to  have 
a  voice  in  the  matter? 

There  was  Holland,  too.  Had  not  Barents  and  Heems- 
kerk  visited  Spitzbergen  and  Nova  Zembla  at  the  close  of 
the  sixteenth  century?  Was  it  not  one  of  her  children, 
Jan  Mayen,  whose  audacious  voyage  in  1611  gave  her 
possession  of  the  island  named  after  him  situated  within 
the  seventy-first  parallel? 

And  how  about  Russia?  Had  not  Behring  been  under 
the  orders  of  Alexis  Tschirikof?  Had  not  Paulutski,  in 
1751,  sailed  into  the  Arctic  seas?  Had  not  Martin  Span- 
berg  and  William  Walton  adventured  in  these  unknown 
regions  in  1739,  and  done  notable  exploring  work  in  the 
straits  between  Asia  and  America?  Had  not  Russia  her 
Siberian  territories,  extending  over  a  hundred  and  twenty 
degrees  to  the  limits  of  Kamtchatka  along  the  Asiatic 


a  w  01  rti  grxB  lo 


'•<•  ,••  'i-p-l 
;•;  A';  \    ii;!.uo 
s-.ol  v 


• 


~  first  in  I 

-  .•/  the 

"WHEN  THE  SEAS  ARE  SHIFTED." 

"  Yes,"  said  Baldenak.  "  But  suppose  the  change  of  axis  throws 
the  seas  out  of  their  existing  basins?  " 

"  And  if  the  ocean  level  is  lowered  at  different  points,"  said  Jensen, 
"  some  people  may  find  themselves  so  high  up  in  the  world  that  com- 
munication with  them  will  be  impossible  !"  *  *  *  * 

The  modification  of  the  axis  was  evidently  a  public  danger.  A 
change  of  23°  28'  would  produce  a  considerable  displacement  in  the 
seas,  owing  to  the  flattening  at  the  Poles.  The  Earth  was  thus  threat- 
ened with  similar  disasters  to  those  that,  it  is  believed,  have  recently 
occurred  in  Mars.  There  entire  continents,  among  others  Libya  and 
Schiaparelli,  have  been  submerged,  as  shown  by  the  faint  blue  replacing 
the  faint  red.  Lake  Moeris  has  disappeared.  North  and  south  there 
have  been  changes,  and  the  oceans  have  withdrawn  from  many  localities 
they  formerly  occupied. -Page  366.  '  ^'^  ^ 

?     And  had  he  not  years  after- 

.  amed   after    him?     And 

had    not  Jon    Munk   explored    the 

md    discovered    many   points 

known?     Was   not  Denmark  to  have 


Barents  and  Heems- 

at  the 
>ne 


Vol.  13. 

• 


-verity 
the  Asiatic 


TO  SYNDICATE  OR  NOT  TO  SYNDICATE;  321 

littoral,  peopled  by  Samoyeds,  Yakuts,  Tchouktchis,  and 
others,  and  bordering  nearly  half  of  the  Arctic  Ocean? 
Was  there  not  on  the  seventy-fifth  parallel,  at  less  than 
nine  hundred  miles  from  the  Pole,  the  Liakhov  Archi- 
pelago, discovered  at  the  beginning  of  the  eighteenth 
century  ? 

And  how  about  the  United  Kingdom,  which  possessed 
in  Canada  a  territory  larger  than  the  whole  of  the  United 
States,  and  whose  navigators  held  the  first  place  in  the 
history  of  the  frozen  north?  Had  not  the  British  a  right 
to  be  heard  in  the  matter? 

But,  not  unnaturally,  the  British  Government  considered 
that  they  had  quite  enough  to  do  without  troubling  them- 
selves about  an  advertisement  in  the  New  York  Herald. 
The  Foreign  Office  did  not  consider  the  consignee  of  cod- 
fish even  worthy  of  a  pigeon-hole;  and  the  Colonial  Office 
seemed  quite  ignorant  of  his  existence  until  the  Secre- 
tary's attention  was  called  to  the  subject,  when  the  official 
reply  was  given  that  the  matter  was  one  of  purely  local 
interest,  in  which  her  Majesty's  Government  had  no  inten- 
tion of  concerning  themselves. 

In  Canada,  however,  some  stir  was  made,  particularly 
among  the  French;  and  at  Quebec  a  syndicate  was  formed 
for  the  purpose  of  competing  with  the  company  at  Balti- 
more. The  other  countries  interested  followed  the  Cana- 
dian lead.  Although  the  Governments  haughtily  ignored 
the  audacious  proposition,  speculative  individuals  were 
found  in  Holland,  Scandinavia,  Denmark,  and  Russia  to 
venture  sufficient  funds  for  preliminary  expenses  with  a 
view  to  acquire  imaginary  rights  that  might  prove  profit- 
ably transferable. 

Three  weeks  before  the  date  fixed  for  the  sale  the  repre- 
sentatives of  these  various  syndicates  arrived  in  the  United 
States. 

The  only  representative  of  the  American  company  was 
the  William  S.  Forster  whose  name  figured  in  the  adver- 
tisement of  the  7th  of  November. 

Holland  sent  Jacques  Jansen,  a  councillor  of  the  Dutch 
East  Indies,  fifty-three  years  of  age,  squat,  broad,  and  pro- 
tuberant, with  short  arms  and  little  bow  legs,  aluminium 
spectacles,  face  round  and  red,  hair  in  a  mop,  and  grizzly 
whiskers — a  solid  man,  not  a  little  incredulous  on  the 

Vol.  18  Verne 


322    PURCHASE  OF  THE  NORTH  POLE 

subject  of  an  enterprise  whose  practical  consequences  he 
did  not  quite  see. 

The  Danish  syndicate  sent  Erik  Baldenak,  an  ex-sub- 
governor  of  the  Greenland  colonies,  a  man  of  middle 
height,  somewhat  unequal  about  the  shoulders,  with  a  per- 
ceptible corporation,  a  large  head,  and  eyes  so  short- 
sighted that  everything  he  read  he  almost  touched  with  his 
nose.  His  instructions  were  to  treat  as  beyond  argument 
the  rights  of  his  country,  which  was  the  legitimate  pro- 
prietor of  the  Polar  regions. 

The  Swedes  and  Norwegians  sent  Jan  Harald,  professor 
of  cosmography  at  Christiania,  who  had  been  one  of  the 
warmest  partisans  of  the  Nordenskiold  expedition,  a  true 
type  of  the  Norseman,  with  clear,  fresh  face,  and  beard 
and  hair  of  the  color  of  the  over-ripe  corn.  Harald's 
private  opinion  was  that  the  Polar  cap  was  covered  with 
the  Palseocrystic  Sea,  and  therefore  valueless.  But  none 
the  less,  he  intended  to  do  the  best  he  could  for  those  who 
employed  him. 

The  representative  of  the  Russian  financiers  was  Colonel 
Boris  Karkof,  half  soldier,  half  diplomatist;  tall,  stiff, 
hairy,  bearded,  mustached;  very  uncomfortable  in  his  civil- 
ian clothes,  and  unconsciously  seeking  for  the  handle  of 
the  sword  he  used  to  wear.  The  colonel  was  very  anxious 
to  know  what  was  concealed  in  the  proposition  of  the 
North  Polar  Practical  Association,  with  a  view  to  ascer- 
taining if  it  would  not  give  rise  to  international  difficulties. 

England  having  declined  all  participation  in  the  matter, 
the  only  representatives  of  the  British  Empire  were  those 
from  the  Quebec  Company.  These  were  Major  Donellan, 
a  French-Canadian,  whose  ancestry  is  sufficiently  apparent 
from  his  name,  and  a  compatriot  of  his  named  Todrin. 
Donellan  was  tall,  thin,  bony,  nervous,  and  angular,  and 
of  just  such  a  figure  as  the  Parisian  comic  journals  carica- 
ture as  that  of  an  Englishman.  Todrin  was  the  very 
opposite  of  the  Major,  being  short  and  thick-set,  and  talk- 
ative and  amusing.  He  was  said  to  be  of  Scotch  descent, 
but  no  trace  of  it  was  observable  in  his  name,  his  char- 
acter, or  his  appearance. 

The  representatives  arrived  at  Baltimore  by  different 
steamers.  They  were  each  furnished  with  the  needful 
credit  to  outbid  their  rivals  up  to  a  certain  point;  but  the 


TO  SYNDICATE  OR  NOT  TO  SYNDICATE  323 

limit  differed  in  each  case.  The  Canadian  representatives 
had  command  of  much  the  most  liberal  supplies,  and  it 
seemed  as  though  the  struggle  would  resolve  itself  into  a 
dollar  duel  between  the  two  American  companies. 

As  soon  as  the  delegates  arrived  they  each  tried  to  put 
themselves  in  communication  with  the  North  Polar  Prac- 
tical Association  unknown  to  the  others.  Their  object 
was  to  discover  the  motives  of  the  enterprise,  and  the 
profit  the  Association  expected  to  make  out  of  it.  But 
there  was  no  trace  of  an  office  at  Baltimore.  The  only 
address  was  that  of  William  S.  Forster,  High  Street,  and 
the  worthy  codfish  agent  pretended  that  he  knew  nothing 
about  it.  The  secret  of  the  Association  was  impenetrable. 

The  consequence  was  that  the  delegates  met,  visited 
each  other,  cross-examined  each  other,  and  finally  entered 
into  communication  with  a  view  of  taking  united  action 
against  the  Baltimore  company.  And  one  day,  on  the 
22nd  of  November,  they  found  themselves  in  conference  at 
the  Wolseley  Hotel,  in  the  rooms  of  Major  Donellan  and 
Todrin,  the  meeting  being  due  to  the  diplomatic  efforts  of 
Colonel  Boris  Karkof. 

To  begin  with,  the  conversation  occupied  itself  with  the 
advantages,  commercial  or  industrial,  which  the  Associa- 
tion expected  to  obtain  from  its  Arctic  domain.  Professor 
Harald  inquired  if  any  of  his  colleagues  had  been  able  to 
ascertain  anything  with  regard  to  this  point;  and  all  of 
them  confessed  that  they  had  endeavored  to  pump  William 
S.  Forster  without  success. 

"I  failed,"  said  Baldenak. 

"I  did  not  succeed,"  said  Jansen. 

"When  I  went,"  said  Todrin,  "I  found  a  fat  man  in  a 
black  coat  and  wearing  a  stove-pipe  hat.  He  had  on  a 
white  apron,  and  when  I  asked  him  about  this  affair,  he 
told  me  that  the  South  Star  had  just  arrived  from  New- 
foundland with  a  full  cargo  of  fine  cod,  which  he  was 
prepared  to  sell  me  on  advantageous  terms  on  behalf  of 
Messrs.  Ardrinell  and  Co." 

"Eh !  eh !"  said  the  Councillor  of  the  Dutch  East  Indies. 
"You  had  much  better  buy  a  full  cargo  of  fine  cod  than 
throw  your  money  into  the  Arctic  Sea." 

"That's  not  the  question,"  said  the  Major.  "We  are 
not  talking  of  codfish,  but  of  the  Polar  ice-cap—" 


324        PURCHASE  OF  THE  NORTH  POLE 

"Which,"  said  Toclrin,  "the  codfishman  wants  to  wear." 

"It  will  give  him  influenza,"  said  the  Russian. 

"That  is  not  the  question,"  said  the  Major.  "For  some 
reason  or  other,  this  North  Polar  Practical  Association — 
mark  the  word  'Practical/  gentlemen — wishes  to  buy  four 
hundred  and  seven  thousand  square  miles  around  the 
North  Pole,  from  the  eighty-fourth — " 

"We  know  all  that,"  said  Professor  Harald.  "But 
what  we  want  to  know  is,  what  do  these  people  want  to 
do  with  these  territories,  if  they  are  territories,  or  these 
seas,  if  they  are  seas — " 

"That  is  not  the  question/'  said  Donellan.  "Here  is  a 
company  proposing  to  purchase  a  portion  of  the  globe 
which,  by  its  geographical  position,  seems  to  belong  to 
Canada." 

"To  Russia,"  said  Karkof. 

"To  Holland,"  said  Jansen. 

"To  Scandinavia,"  said  Harald. 

"To  Denmark,"  said  Baldenak. 

"Gentlemen!"  said  Todrin,  "excuse  me,  but  that  is  not 
the  question.  By  our  presence  here  we  have  admitted  the 
principle  that  the  circumpolar  territories  can  be  put  up  to 
auction,  and  become  the  property  of  the  highest  bidder. 
Now,  as  you  have  powers  to  draw  to  a  certain  amount, 
why  should  you  not  join  forces  and  control  such  a  sum  as 
the  Baltimore  company  will  find  it  impossible  to  beat?" 

The  delegates  looked  at  one  another.  A  syndicate  of 
syndicates!  In  these  days  we  syndicate  as  unconcernedly 
as  we  breathe,  as  we  drink,  as  we  eat,  as  we  sleep.  Why 
not  syndicate  still  further? 

But  there  was  an  objection,  or  rather  an  explanation 
was  necessary,  and  Jansen  interpreted  the  feeling  of  the 
meeting  when  he  asked : 

"And  after?" 

Yes!    After? 

"But  it  seems  to  me  that  Canada — "  said  Donellan. 

"And  Russia — "  said  Karkof. 

"And  Holland — "  said  Jansen. 

"And  Denmark — "  said  Baldenak. 

"Don't   quarrel,    gentlemen,"    said    Todrin.      "What   is 
the  good?    Let  us  form  our  syndicate." 
"And  after?"  said  Harald. 


TO  SYNDICATE  OR  NOT  TO  SYNDICATE  325 

"After?"  said  Todrin.     "Nothing  can  be  simpler,  gen- 
tlemen.     When  you   have   bought   the   property    it   will 
remain  indivisible  among  you,  and  then  for  adequate  com- 
pensation you  can  transfer  it  to  one  of  the  syndicates  we 
represent;  but  the  Baltimore  company  will  be  out  of  it." 
It  was  a  good  proposal,  at  least  for  the  moment,  for  in 
the  future  the  delegates  could  quarrel  among  themselves 
for  the  final  settlement.     Anyway,  as  Todrin  had  justly 
remarked,  the  Baltimore  company  would  be  out  of  it. 
"That  seems  sensible,"  said  Baldenak. 
"Clever,"  said  Karkof. 
"Artful,"  said  Harald. 
"Sly,"  said  Jansen. 
"Quite  Canadian,"  said  Donellan. 

"And    so,    gentlemen,"    said    Karkof,    "it    is    perfectly 
understood  that  if  we  form  a  syndicate  the  rights  of  each 
will  be  entirely  reserved." 
"Agreed." 

It  only  remained  to  discover  what  sums  had  been  placed 
to  the  credit  of  the  delegates  by  the  several  associations, 
which  amounts  when  totaled  would  probably  exceed  any- 
thing at  the  disposal  of  the  North  Polar  Practical  people. 
The  question  was  asked  by  Todrin. 
But  then  came  a  change  over  the  scene.  There  was 
complete  silence.  No  one  would  reply.  Open  his  purse, 
empty  his  pocket  into  the  common  cash-box,  tell  in  advance 
how  much  he  had  to  bid  with — there  was  no  hurry  to  do 
that!  And  if  disagreement  arose  later  on,  if  circumstances 
obliged  the  delegates  to  look  after  themselves,  if  the 
diplomatic  Karkof  were  to  feel  hurt  at  the  little  wiles  of 
Jansen,  who  might  take  offense  at  the  clumsy  artifices  of 
Baldenak,  who,  in  turn,  became  irritated  at  the  ingenuities 
of  Harald,  who  might  decline  to  support  the  pretentious 
claims  of  Donellan,  who  would  find  himself  compelled  to 
intrigue  against  all  his  colleagues  individually  and  collec- 
tively— to  proclaim  the  length  of  their  purses  was  to 
reveal  their  game,  which  above  all  things  they  desired  to 
keep  dark. 

Obviously  there  were  only  two  ways  of  answering- 
Todrin's  indiscreet  demand.  They  might  exaggerate  their 
resources,  which  would  be  embarrassing  when  they  had  to 


326    PURCHASE  OF  THE  NORTH  POLE 

put  the  money  down;  or  they  might  minimize  them  in 
such  a  way  as  to  turn  the  proposition  into  a  joke. 

This  idea  occurred  to  the  Dutchman. 

"Gentlemen,"  said  he,  "I  regret  that  for  the,  acquisition 
of  the  Arctic  regions  I  am  unable  to  dispose  of  more  than 
fifty  gulden." 

"And,"  said  the  Russian,  "all  I  have  to  venture  is  thirty- 
five  roubles." 

"I  have  twenty  kroner,"  said  Harald. 

"I  have  only  fifteen,"  said  Baldenak. 

"Well,"  said  the  Major,  "it  is  evident  that  the  profit  in 
this  matter  will  be  yours,  for  all  I  have  at  my  disposal  is 
the  miserable  sum  of  thirty  cents." 


CHAPTER   III 

THE   NORTH   POLE  IS  KNOCKED  DOWN   TO   THE   HIGHEST 
BIDDER 

THAT  the  sale  on  the  3rd  of  December  should  take  place 
in  the  Auction  Mart  might  appear  strange.  As  a  rule, 
only  furniture,  instruments,  pictures,  and  objects  of  art 
were  sold  there.  But  for  this  curious  departure  from  the 
ordinary  practice  in  the  sale  of  land  a  precedent  was  dis- 
coverable, as  already  a  portion  of  our  planet  had  changed 
hands  under  the  hammer. 

A  few  years  before,  at  San  Francisco,  in  California,  an 
island  in  the  Pacific  Ocean,  Spencer  Island,  had  been  sold 
to  the  rich  W.  W.  Kolderup,  when  he  outbid  J.  R.  Tas- 
kinar,  of  Stockton.  Spencer  Island  was  habitable;  it  was 
only  a  few  degrees  from  the  Californian  coast;  it  had 
forests,  watercourses,  a  fertile  soil,  and  fields  and  prairies 
fit  for  cultivation ;  it  was  not  an  indefinite  region,  covered 
perhaps  with  sea  and  perpetual  ice,  which  probably  no  one 
would  ever  occupy.  For  Spencer  Island  four  million 
dollars  had  been  paid;  for  the  Polar  territories  it  was  not 
to  be  expected  that  anything  like  that  amount  would  be 
forthcoming. 

Nevertheless,  the  strangeness  of  the  affair  had  brought 
together  a  considerable  crowd,  chiefly  of  lookers-on,  to 
witness  the  result.  The  sale  was  to  take  place  at  noon, 
and  all  the  morning  the  traffic  in  Bolton  Street  was  seri- 


POLE  SOLD  TO  HIGHEST  BIDDER        327 

ously  interfered  with.  Long  before  the  hour  fixed  for 
the  sale  the  room  was  full,  with  the  exception  of  a  few 
seats  railed  off  and  reserved  for  the  delegates;  and  when 
Baldenak,  Karkof,  Jansen,  Harald,  Donellan,  and  Todrin 
had  taken  these  places,  they  formed  a  compact  group, 
shoulder  to  shoulder,  and  looked  as  if  they  were  a  veritable 
storming  column  ready  for  the  assault  of  the  Pole. 

Close  to  them  was  the  consignee  of  codfish,  whose 
vulgar  visage  expressed  the  sublimest  indifference.  He 
looked  the  least  excited  of  all  the  crowd,  and  seemed  to 
be  thinking  only  of  how  he  could  most  profitably  dispose 
of  the  cargoes  now  on  their  way  to  him  from  Newfound- 
land. Who  were  the  capitalists  represented  by  this  man, 
with  probably  millions  of  dollars  at  his  command? 

There  was  nothing  to  show  that  J.  T.  Maston  and  Mrs. 
Scorbitt  had  anything  to  do  with  the  affair.  How  could 
it  be  supposed  that  they  had?  They  were  there,  though, 
but  lost  in  the  crowd,  and  were  surrounded  by  a  few  of 
the  principal  members  of  the  Gun  Club,  apparently  simply 
as  spectators  and  quite  disinterested.  William  S.  Forster 
seemed  to  have  not  the  least  knowledge  of  their  existence. 

As  it  was  impossible  to  hand  around  the  North  Pole 
for  the  purposes  of  examination,  a  large  map  of  the  Arctic 
regions  had  been  hung  behind  the  auctioneer's  desk. 
Seventeen  degrees  above  the  Arctic  Circle  a  broad  red 
line  around  the  eighty-fourth  parallel  marked  off  the  por- 
tion of  the  globe  which  the  North  Polar  Practical  Asso- 
ciation had  brought  to  the  hammer.  According  to  the 
map,  the  region  was  occupied  by  a  sea  covered  with  an 
ice-cap  of  considerable  thickness.  But  that  was  the  affair 
of  the  purchasers.  At  least,  no  one  could  complain  that 
they  had  been  deceived  as  to  the  nature  of  the  goods. 

As  twelve  o'clock  struck,  the  auctioneer,  Andrew  R. 
Gilmour,  entered  by  a  little  door  behind  his  desk.  He 
surveyed  the  assembly  for  an  instant  through  his  glasses, 
and  then,  calling  for  silence  by  a  tap  from  his  hammer, 
he  addressed  the  crowd  as  follows: 

"Gentlemen,  I  have  been  instructed  by  the  Federal 
Government  to  offer  for  sale  a  property  situated  at  the 
North  Pole,  bounded  by  the  eighty-fourth  parallel  of  lati- 
tude, and  consisting  of  certain  continents  and  seas,  either 
solid  or  liquid — but  which  I  am  not  quite  sure.  Kindly 


328    PURCHASE  OF  THE  NORTH  POLE 

cast  your  eyes  on  this  map.  It  has  been  compiled  accord- 
ing to  the  latest  information.  You  will  see  that  the  area 
is  approximately  four  hundred  and  seven  thousand  square 
miles.  To  facilitate  the  sale  it  has  been  decided  that  the 
biddings  for  this  extensive  region  shall  be  made  per  square 
mile.  You  will  therefore  understand  that  every  cent  bid 
will  represent  in  round  numbers  407,000  cents,  and  every 
dollar  407,000  dollars.  I  must  ask  you  to  be  silent,  gen- 
tlemen, if  you  please." 

The  appeal  was  not  superfluous,  for  the  impatience  of 
the  public  was  producing  a  gradually-increasing  tumult 
that  would  drown  the  voices  of  the  bidders. 

When  tolerable  quietness  had  been  established,  thanks 
to  the  intervention  of  Flint,  the  auctioneer's  porter,  who 
roared  like  a  siren  on  a  foggy  day,  Gilmour  continued: 

"Before  we  begin  the  biddings,  I  think  it  right  to  remind 
you  of  three  things.  The  property  has  only  one  boundary, 
that  of  the  eighty- fourth  degree  of  north  latitude.  It  has 
a  guaranteed  title.  And  it  will  remain  the  property  of 
the  purchasers,  no  matter  what  geographical  or  meteoro- 
logical modifications  the  future  may  produce." 

Always  this  curious  observation! 

"Now,  gentlemen,"  said  Gilmour;  "what  offers?"  and, 
giving  his  hammer  a  preliminary  shake,  he  continued  in  a 
nasal  tone,  "We  will  start  at  ten  cents  the  square  mile." 

Ten  cents,  the  tenth  of  a  dollar,  meant  40,700  dollars 
for  the  lot. 

Whether  Gilmour  had  a  purchaser  at  this  price  or  not, 
the  amount  was  quickly  increased  by  Baldenak. 

"Twenty  cents!"  he  said. 

"Thirty  cents!"  said  Jansen  for  the  Dutchmen. 

"Thirty-five!"  said  Professor  Harald. 

"Forty!"  said  the  Russian. 

That  meant  162,800  dollars,  and  yet  the  bidding  had 
only  begun.  The  Canadians  had  not  even  opened  their 
mouths.  And  William  S.  Forster  seemed  absorbed  in  the 
Newfoundland  Mercury. 

"Now,  gentlemen,"  said  Gilmour,  "any  advance  on  forty 
cents?  Forty  cents!  Come,  the  Polar  cap  is  worth  more 
than  that;  it  is — " 

What  he  would  have  added  is  unknown ;  perhaps  it  was, 
"guaranteed  pure  ice" ;  but  the  Dane  interrupted  him  with : 


POLE  SOLD  TO  HIGHEST  BIDDER         329 

"Fifty  cents!" 

Which  the  Dutchman  at  once  capped  with: 

"Sixty!" 

"Sixty  cents  the  square  mile!  Any  advance  on  sixty 
cents?" 

These  sixty  cents  made  the  respectable  sum  of  244,200 
dollars. 

At  Jansen's  bid,  Donellan  raised  his  head  and  looked 
at  Todrin;  but  at  an  almost  imperceptible  negative  sign 
from  him  he  remained  silent. 

All  that  Forster  did  was  to  scrawl  a  few  notes  on  the 
margin  of  his  newspaper. 

"Come,  gentlemen,"  said  the  auctioneer;  "wake  up! 
Surely  you  are  going  to  give  more  than  that?" 

And  the  hammer  began  to  move  up  and  down,  as  if  in 
disgust  at  the  weakness  of  the  bidding. 

"Seventy  cents!"  said  Harald,  in  a  voice  that  trembled 
a  little. 

"Eighty  cents!"  said  Karkof,  almost  in  the  same  breath. 

A  nod  from  Todrin  woke  up  the  Major,  as  if  he  were 
on  springs. 

"Hundred  cents!"  said  the  Canadian. 

That  meant  407,000  dollars. 

Four  hundred  and  seven  thousand  dollars!  A  high 
price  to  pay  for  a  collection  of  icebergs,  ice-fields,  and 
ice-floes ! 

And  the  representative  of  the  North  Polar  Practical 
Association  did  not  even  raise  his  eyes  from  his  news- 
paper. Had  he  been  instructed  not  to  bid?  If  he  had 
waited  for  his  competitors  to  bid  their  highest,  surely  the 
moment  had  come?  In  fact,  their  look  of  dismay  when 
the  Major  fired  his  "hundred  cents"  showed  that  they  had 
abandoned  the  battle. 

"A  hundred  cents  the  square  mile!"  said  the  auctioneer. 
"Any  advance?  Is  that  so?  Is  that  so?  No  advance?" 

And  he  took  a  firm  grasp  on  his  hammer,  and  looked 
around  him. 

"Once!"  he  continued.     "Twice!     Any  advance?" 

"A  hundred  and  twenty  cents!"  said  Forster,  quietly,  as 
he  turned  over  a  page  of  his  newspaper. 

"And  forty!"  said  the  Major. 
"And  sixty!"  drawled  Forster, 


330    PURCHASE  OF  THE  NORTH  POLE 

"And  eighty!"  drawled  the  Major,  quite  as  placidly. 
"A  hundred  and  ninety!"  said  Forster. 
"And  five!"  said  the  Major,  as  if  it  were  a  mere  casual 
observation. 

You  might  have  heard  an  ant  walk,  a  bleak  swim,  a 
moth  fly,  a  worm  wriggle,  or  a  microbe  wag  its  tail — if  it 
has  a  tail. 

Gilmour  allowed  a  few  moments  to  pass,  which  seemed 
like  centuries.  The  consignee  of  codfish  continued  reading 
his  newspaper  and  jotting  down  figures  on  the  margin 
which  had  evidently  nothing  to  do  with  the  matter  on 
hand.  Had  he  reached  the  length  of  his  tether?  Had 
he  made  his  last  bid?  Did  this  price  of  195  cents  the 
square  mile,  or  793,050  dollars  for  the  whole,  appear  to 
him  to  have  reached  the  last  limjt  of  absurdity? 

"One  hundred  and  ninety-five  cents!"  said  the  auc- 
tioneer. "Going  at  one  hundred  and  ninety-five  cents!" 

And  he  raised  his  hammer. 

"One  hundred  and  ninety-five  cents!    Going!    Going!" 

And  every  eye  was  turned  on  the  representative  of  the 
North  Polar  Practical  Association. 

That  extraordinary  man  drew  a  large  handkerchief  from 
his  pocket,  and,  hiding  his  face  in  it,  blew  a  long,  sonor- 
ous blast  with  his  nose. 

Then  J.  T.  Maston  looked  at  him,  and  Mrs.  Scorbitt's 
eyes  took  the  same  direction.  Ar.J  by  the  paleness  of 
their  features  it  could  be  seen  how  keen  was  the  excite- 
ment they  were  striving  to  subdue.  Why  did  Forster 
hesitate  to  outbid  the  Major? 

Forster  blew  his  nose  a  second  time ;  then,  with  an  even 
louder  blast,  he  blew  it  a  third  time.  And  between  the 
blasts  he  quietly  observed: 

"Two  hundred  cents!" 

A  shudder  ran  through  the  hall. 

The  Major  seemed  overwhelmed,  and  fell  back  against 
Todrin.  At  this  price  per  square  mile,  the  Arctic  regions 
would  cost  814,000  dollars.  The  Canadian  limit  had 
evidently  been  passed. 

"Two  hundred  cents!"  said  Gilmoun  "Once!  Twice! 
Any  advance?"  he  continued. 

The  Major  looked  at  the  Professor,  and  the  Colonel, 
and  the  Dutchman,  and  the  Dane;  and  the  Professor,  and 


OLD  ACQUAINTANCES  331 

the  Colonel,  and  the  Dutchman,  and  the  Dane  looked  at 
the  Major. 

"Going!    Going!"  said  the  auctioneer. 

Everyone  looked  at  the  codfish  man. 

"Gone!" 

And  down  came  Gilmour's  hammer. 

The  North  Polar  Practical  Association,  represented  by 
William  S.  Forster,  had  become  the  proprietors  of  the 
North  Pole  and  its  promising  neighborhood.  And  when 
William  S.  Forster  had  to  name  the  real  purchasers,  he 
placidly  drawled,  "Barbicane  &  Co.!'* 


CHAPTER  IV 

OLD     ACQUAINTANCES 

BARBICANE  &  Co.!  The  president  of  the  Gun  Club! 
What  was  the  Gun  Club  going  to  do  with  the  North 
Pole?  We  shall  see. 

Is  it  necessary  formally  to  introduce  Impey  Barbicane, 
the  president  of  the  Gun  Club,  and  Captain  Nicholl,  and 
J.  T.  Maston,  and  Tom  Hunter  with  the  wooden  legs,  and 
the  brisk  Bilsby,  and  Colonel  Bloomsberry  and  their  col- 
leagues? No!  Although  twenty  years  had  elapsed  since 
the  attention  of  the  world  was  concentrated  on  these  re- 
markable personages,  they  had  remained  much  as  they 
were,  just  as  incomplete  corporeally,  and  just  as  obstreper- 
ous, just  as  daring,  just  as  wrapped  up  in  themselves  as 
when  they  had  embarked  in  their  extraordinary  adventure. 
Time  had  made  no  impression  on  the  Gun  Club;  it  re- 
spected them  as  people  respect  the  obsolete  cannon  that  are 
found  in  the  museums  of  old  arsenals. 

If  the  Gun  Club  comprised  1833  members  at  its  founda- 
tion— that  is  persons  and  not  limbs,  for  a  number  of  these 
were  missing — if  30,575  correspondents  were  proud  of 
their  connection  with  the  club,  the  number  had  in  no  way 
decreased.  On  the  contrary,  thanks  to  the  unprecedented 
attempt  they  had  made  to  open  communication  with  the 
Moon,  as  related  in  the  Moon  Voyage,  its  celebrity  had 
increased  enormously. 

It  will  be  remembered  that  a  few  years  after  the  War 
of  Secession  certain  members  of  the  Gun  Club,  tired  of 


332    PURCHASE  OE  THE  NORTH  POLE 

doing  nothing,  had  proposed  to  send  a  projectile  to  the 
Moon  by  means  of  a  monster  Columbiad.  A  gun  nine 
hundred  feet  long  had  been  solemnly  cast  at  Tampa  Town, 
in  the  Floridan  peninsula,  and  loaded  with  400,000  Ibs.  of 
fulminating  cotton.  Shot  out  by  this  gun,  a  cylindro- 
conical  shell  of  aluminium  had  been  sent  flying  among  the 
stars  of  the  night  under  a  pressure  of  six  million  millions 
of  litres  of  gas.  Owing  to  a  deviation  of  the  trajectory, 
the  projectile  had  gone  around  the  Moon  and  fallen  back 
to  the  earth,  dropping  into  the  Pacific  Ocean  in  lat.  27°  f 
N.,  long.  141°  37'  west;  when  the  frigate  Susquehanna 
had  secured  it,  to  the  great  satisfaction  of  its  passengers. 

Of  its  passengers,  two  members  of  the  Gun  Club,  the 
president,  Impey  Barbicane,  and  Captain  Nicholl,  with  a 
hare-brained  Frenchman,  had  taken  passage  in  the  projec- 
tile and  had  all  returned  from  the  voyage  safe  and  sound. 
But  if  the  two  Americans  were  then  present  ready  to  risk 
their  lives  in  some  new  adventure,  it  was  not  so  with 
Michel  Ardan.  He  had  returned  to  Europe,  and  made  a 
fortune,  and  was  now  planting  cabbages  in  his  retirement, 
if  the  best-informed  reporters  were  to  be  believed. 

Barbicane  and  Nicholl  had  also  retired,  comparatively 
speaking,  but  they  had  retired  only  to  dream  of  some  new 
enterprise  of  a  similar  character.  They  were  in  no  want 
of  money.  From  their  last  undertaking  there  remained 
nearly  two  hundred  thousand  dollars  out  of  the  five  mil- 
lions and  a  half  yielded  by  the  public  subscriptions  of  the 
old  and  new  worlds ;  and  by  exhibiting  themselves  in  their 
aluminium  projectile  throughout  the  United  States  they 
had  realized  enough  wealth  and  glory  to  satisfy  the  most 
exacting  of  human  ambitions.  They  would  have  been 
content  if  idleness  had  not  been  wearisome  to  them;  and  it 
was  probably  in  order  to  find  something  to  do  that  they 
had  now  bought  the  Arctic  regions. 

But  it  should  not  be  forgotten  that  if  they  had  paid  for 
their  purchase  eight  hundred  thousand  dollars  and  more, 
it  was  because  Evangelina  Scorbitt  had  advanced  the  bal- 
ance they  required. 

Although  Barbicane  and  Nicholl  enjoyed  incomparable 
celebrity,  there  was  one  who  shared  it  with  them.  This 
was  J.  T.  Maston,  the  impetuous  secretary  of  the  Gun 
Club.  Was  it  not  this  able  mathematician  who  had  made 


OLD  ACQUAINTANCES  333 

the  calculations  which  had  enabled  the  great  experiment 
to  be  made?  If  he  had  not  accompanied  his  two  col- 
leagues on  their  extraordinary  voyage,  it  was  not  from 
fear;  certainly  not!  But  the  worthy  gunner  wanted  a 
right  arm,  and  had  a  gutta-percha  cranium,  owing  to  one 
of  those  accidents  so  common  in  warfare;  and  if  he  had 
shown  himself  to  the  Selenites  it  might  have  given  them 
an  erroneous  idea  of  the  inhabitants  of  the  Earth,  of 
which  the  Moon  after  all  is  but  the  humble  satellite. 

To  his  profound  regret  J.  T.  Maston  had  had  to  resign 
himself  to  staying  at  home.  But  he  was  not  idle.  After 
the  construction  of  the  immense  telescope  on  the  summit 
of  Long's  Peak,  one  of  the  highest  of  the  Rocky  Moun- 
tains, he  had  transported  himself  there,  and  from  the 
moment  he  found  the  projectile  describing  its  majestic 
trajectory  in  the  sky  he  never  left  his  post  of  observation. 
At  the  eye-piece  of  the  huge  instrument  he  devoted  him- 
self to  the  task  of  following  his  friends  as  they  journeyed 
in  their  strange  carriage  through  space. 

It  might  be  thought  that  the  bold  voyagers  were  for- 
ever lost  to  earth.  The  projectile,  drawn  into  a  new  orbit 
by  the  Moon,  might  gravitate  eternally  around  the  Queen 
of  the  Night  as  a  sort  of  sub-satellite.  But  no !  A  devia- 
tion, which  by  many  was  called  providential,  had  modified 
the  projectile's  direction,  and,  after  making  the  circle  of 
the  Moon,  brought  it  back  from  that  spheroid  at  a  speed 
of  17,280  miles  an  hour  at  the  moment  it  plunged  into 
the  ocean. 

Luckily  the  liquid  mass  of  the  Pacific  had  broken  the 
fall,  which  had  been  perceived  by  the  U.  S.  frigate  Sus- 
quehanna.  As  soon  as  the  news  had  reached  J.  T.  Maston, 
he  had  set  out  in  all  haste  from  the  observatory  at  Long's 
Peak  to  the  rescue  of  his  friends.  Soundings  were  taken 
in  the  vicinity  of  where  the  shell  had  been  seen  to  fall, 
and  the  devoted  Maston  had  not  hesitated  to  go  down  in 
diver's  dress  to  find  his  friends.  But  such  trouble  was 
unnecessary.  The  projectile  being  of  aluminium,  displac- 
ing an  amount  of  water  greater  than  its  own  weight,  had 
returned  to  the  surface  of  the  Pacific  after  a  magnificent 
plunge.  And  President  Barbicane,  Captain  Nicholl,  and 
Michel  Ardan  were  found  in  their  floating  prison  playing 
dominoes. 


334    PURCHASE  OF  THE  NORTH  POLE 

The  part  that  Maston  took  in  these  extraordinary  pro- 
ceedings had  brought  him  prominently  to  the  front.  He 
was  not  handsome,  with  his  artificial  cranium  and  his 
mechanical  arm  with  its  hook  for  a  hand.  He  was  not 
young,  for  fifty-eight  years  had  chimed  and  struck  at  the 
date  of  our  story's  beginning.  But  the  originality  of  his 
character,  the  vivacity  of  his  intelligence,  the  fire  in  his 
eye,  the  impetuosity  with  which  he  had  attacked  every- 
thing, had  made  him  the  beau-ideal  of  a  man  in  the  eyes 
of  Evangelina  Scorbitt.  His  brain,  carefully  protected 
beneath  its  gutta-percha  roof  was  intact,  and  justly  bore 
the  reputation  of  being  one  of  the  most  remarkable  of 
the  day. 

Mrs.  Scorbitt — though  the  least  calculation  gave  her 
a  headache — had  a  taste  for  mathematicians  if  she  had 
not  one  for  mathematics.  She  looked  upon  them  as  upon 
beings  of  a  peculiar  and  superior  species.  Heads  where 
^r's  knocked  against  ^s  like  nuts  in  a  bag,  brains  which 
rejoiced  in  algebraic  formulae,  hands  which  threw  about 
triple  integrals  as  an  equilibrist  plays  with  glasses  and 
bottles,  intelligences  which  understood  this  sort  of  thing: 

/  f  f  &  (x  y  2)  dx  dy  dz 

— these  were  the  wise  men  who  appeared  worthy  of  all 
the  admiration  of  a  woman,  attracted  to  them  propor- 
tionally to  their  mass  and  in  inverse  ratio  to  the  square  of 
their  distances.  And  ].  T.  Maston  was  bulky  enough  to 
exercise  on  her  an  irresistible  attraction,  and  as  to  the 
distance  between  them  it  would  be  simply  zero,  if  she 
succeeded  in  her  plans. 

It  must  be  confessed  that  this  gave  some  anxiety  to  the 
secretary  of  the  Gun  Club,  who  had  never  sought  happi- 
ness in  such  close  approximations.  Besides,  Evangelina 
Scorbitt  was  no  longer  in  her  first  youth;  but  she  was 
not  a  bad  sort  of  person  by  any  means,  and  she  would 
have  wanted  for  nothing  could  she  only  see  the  day 
when  she  was  introduced  to  the  drawing-rooms  of  Balti- 
more as  Mrs.  J.  T.  Maston. 

The  widow's  fortune  was  considerable.  Not  that  she 
was  as  rich  as  Gould,  Mackay,  Vanderbilt,  or  Gordon  Ben- 
nett, whose  fortunes  exceed  millions,  and  who  could  give 
alms  to  a  Rothschild.  Not  that  she  possessed  the  millions 
of  Mrs.  Moses  Carper,  Mrs.  Stewart,  or  Mrs.  Crocker;, nor 


OLD  ACQUAINTANCES  335 

was  she  as  rich  as  Mrs.  Hammersley,  Mrs.  Helby  Green, 
Mrs.  Maffitt,  Mrs.  Marshall,  Mrs.  Para  Stevens,  Mrs. 
Mintbury,  and  a  few  others.  But  she  was  the  possessor 
of  four  good  millions  of  dollars,  which  had  come  to  her 
from  John  P.  Scorbitt,  who  had  made  a  fortune  by  trade 
in  fashionable  sundries  and  salt  pork.  And  this  fortune 
the  generous  widow  would  have  been  happy  to  employ 
for  the  advantage  of  J.  T.  Maston,  to  whom  she  would 
bring  a  treasure  of  tenderness  yet  more  inexhaustible. 

At  Maston's  request,  she  had  cheerfully  consented  to 
put  several  hundreds  of  thousands  of  dollars  at  the  dis- 
posal of  the  North  Polar  Practical  Association,  without 
even  knowing  what  it  was  all  about.  With  J.  T.  Maston 
concerned  in  it  she  felt  assured  that  the  work  could  not 
but  be  grandiose,  sublime,  super-excellent.  The  past  of  the 
Gun  Club's  secretary  was  voucher  enough  for  the  future- 
It  may  be  guessed,  therefore,  if  she  lost  confidence 
when  the  auctioneer's  hammer  knocked  down  the  North 
Pole  to  Barbicane  &  Co.  While  J.  T.  Maston  formed 
part  of  the  "Co."  could*  she  do  otherwise  than  applaud? 

And  thus  it  happened  that  Evangelina  Scorbitt  found 
herself  chief  proprietor  of  the  Arctic  regions  within  the 
eighty-fourth  parallel.  But  what  would  she  do  with 
them?  Or  rather,  how  was  the  company  going  to  get  any 
benefit  out  of  their  inaccessible  domain? 

That  was  the  question!  And  if  in  a  pecuniary  sense  it 
had  much  interest  for  Mrs.  Scorbitt,  from  a  curiosity 
point  of  view  it  had  quite  as  much  interest  for  the  world 
at  large. 

The  trusting  widow  had  asked  a  few  questions  of  Mas- 
ton  before  she  advanced  the  funds.  But  Maston  invariably 
maintained  the  closest  reserve.  Mrs.  Scorbitt,  he  re- 
marked, would  know  soon  enough,  but  not  before  the 
hour  had  come,  for  she  would  be  astonished  at  the  object 
of  the  new  association. 

Doubtless  he  was  thinking  of  some  undertaking  which 
to  quote  Jean  Jacques,  "never  had  an  example,  and  never 
will  have  imitators,"  of  something  destined  to  leave  far 
behind  the  attempt  made  by  the  Gun  Club  to  open  up 
communication  with  the  Moon. 

When  Evangelina  grew  somewhat  pressing  in  her  in- 
quiries, J.  T.  Maston  had  placed  his  hook  on  his  half- 


336   PURCHASE  OF  THE  NORTH  POLE 

closed  lips,  and  remarked  soothingly,  "Have  confidence, 
Mrs.  Scorbitt;  have  confidence !" 

And  if  Mrs.  Scorbitt  had  confidence  before  the  sale, 
what  immense  joy  she  must  have  experienced  at  the  re- 
sult! Still  she  could  not  help  asking  the  eminent  mathe- 
matician, what  he  was  going  to  do  next.  And  though 
she  smiled  on  him  bewitchingly,  the  eminent  mathemati- 
cian only  replied,  as  he  cordially  shook  her  hand,  "You 
will  know  very  soon!" 

That  shake  of  the  hand  immediately  calmed  the  im- 
patience of  Mrs.  Scorbitt.  And  a  few  days  later  there 
was  another  shake,  for  the  old  and  new  worlds  were  con- 
siderably shaken — to  say  nothing  of  the  shake  that  was 
coming — when  they  learned  the  project  for  which  the 
North  Polar  Practical  Association  appealed  to  the  public 
for  subscriptions. 

The  company  announced  that  it  had  "acquired"  the  ter- 
ritory for  the  purpose  of  working — "the  coal-fields  at 
the  North  Pole"! 


CHAPTER  V 

THE   POLAR    COAL-FIELD 

"BuT  are  there  any  coal-fields  at  the  Pole?"  Such  was 
the  first  question  that  presented  itself. 

"Why  should  there  be  coal  at  the  Pole?"  said  some. 

"Why  should  there  not  be?"  said  others. 

Coal-beds  are  found  in  many  parts  of  the  world.  There 
is  coal  in  Europe;  there  is  coal  in  America;  and  in  Africa; 
and  in  Asia;  and  in  Oceania.  As  the  globe  is  more  and 
more  explored,  beds  of  fossil  fuel  are  revealed  in  strata  of 
all  ages.  There  is  true  coal  in  the  primary  rocks,  and 
there  is  lignite  in  the  secondaries  and  tertiaries. 

England  alone  produces  a  hundred  and  sixty  millions 
of  tons  a  year;  the  world  consumes  four  hundred  million 
tons,  and  with  the  requirements  of  industry  there  is  no 
decrease  but  an  increase  in  the  consumption.  The  substi- 
tution of  electricity  for  steam  as  a  motive  power  means 
the  expenditure  of  coal  just  the  same.  The  industrial 
stomach  cannot  live  without  coal;  industry  is  a  carboniv- 
orous  animal  and  must  have  its  proper  food. 


THE  POLAR  COAL/FIELD  337 

Carbon  is  something  else  than  a  combustible.  It  is  the 
telluric  substance  from  which  science  draws  the  major 
part  of  the  products  and  sub-products  used  in  the  arts. 
With  the  transformations  to  which  it  is  subject  in  the 
crucibles  of  the  laboratory  you  can  dye,  sweeten,  perfume, 
vaporize,  purify,  heat,  light,  and  you  can  produce  the 
diamond. 

But  the  coal-beds  from  which  our  carbon  at  present 
chiefly  comes  are  not  inexhaustible.  And  the  well-in- 
formed people  who  are  in  fear  for  the  future  are  looking 
about  for  new  supplies  wherever  there  is  a  probability  of 
their  existence. 

"But  why  should  there  be  coal  at  the  Pole?" 

"Why?"  replied  the  supporters  of  President  Barbicane. 
"Because  in  the  carboniferous  period,  according  to  a  well- 
known  theory,  the  volume  of  the  Sun  was  such  that  the 
difference  in  temperature  between  the  Equator  and  the 
Poles  was  inappreciable.  Immense  forests  covered  the 
northern  regions  long  before  the  appearance  of  man,  when 
our  planet  was  subject  to  the  prolonged  influence  of  heat 
and  humidity." 

And  this  the  journals,  reviews,  and  magazines  that 
supported  the  North  Polar  Practical  Association  insisted 
on  in  a  thousand  articles,  popular  and  scientific.  If  these 
forests  existed,  what  more  reasonable  to  suppose  than  that 
the  weather,  the  water,  and  the  warmth  had  converted 
them  into  coal-beds? 

But  in  addition  to  this  there  were  certain  facts  which 
were  undeniable.  And  these  were  important  enough  to 
suggest  that  a  search  might  be  made  for  the  mineral  in 
the  regions  indicated. 

So  thought  Donellan  and  Todrin  as  they  sat  together 
in  a  corner  of  the  "Two  Friends." 

"Well,"  said  Todrin,  "can  Barbicane  be  right?" 

"It  is  very  likely,"  said  the  Major. 

"But  then  there  are  fortunes  to  be  made  in  opening  up 
the  Polar  regions!" 

"Assuredly,"  said  the  Major.  "North  America  has 
immense  deposits  of  coal ;  new  discoveries  are  often  being 
announced,  and  there  are  doubtless  more  to  follow.  The 
Arctic  regions  seem  to  be  a  part  of  the  American  conti- 
nent geologically.  They  are  similar  in  formation  and 

Vol.  13  Verne 


338    PURCHASE  OF  THE  NORTH  POLE 

physiography.  Greenland  is  a  prolongation  of  the  new 
world,  and  certainly  Greenland  belongs  to  America — " 

"As  the  horse's  head,  which  it  looks  like,  belongs  to  the 
animal's  body/'  said  Todrin. 

"Nordenskiold,"  said  Donellan,  "when  he  explored 
Greenland,  found  among  the  sandstones  and  schists  inter- 
calations of  lignite  with  many  forest  plants.  Even  in 
the  Disko  district,  Steenstrup  discovered  eleven  localities 
with  abundant  vestiges  of  the  luxuriant  vegetation  which 
formerly  encircled  the  Pole." 

"But  higher  up?"  asked  Todrin. 

"Higher  up,  or  farther  up  to  the  northward,"  said  the 
Major,  "the  presence  of  coal  is  extremely  probable,  and 
it  only  has  to  be  looked  for.  And  if  there  is  coal  on  the 
surface,  is  it  not  reasonable  to  suppose  that  there  is  coal 
underneath  ?" 

The  Major  was  right.  He  was  thoroughly  posted  up 
in  all  that  concerned  the  geology  of  the  Arctic  regions, 
and  he  would  have  held  on  for  some  time  if  he  had  not 
noticed  that  the  people  in  the  "Two  Friends"  were  listen- 
ing to  him. 

"Are  you  not  surprised  at  one  thing,  Major?" 

"What  is  that?" 

"That  in  this  affair,  in  which  you  would  expect  to 
meet  with  engineers  and  navigators,  you  have  only  to 
deal  with  artillerists.  What  have  they  to  do  with  the 
coal-mines  of  the  North  Pole?" 

"That  is  rather  surprising,"  said  the  Major. 

And  every  morning  the  newspapers  returned  to  this 
matter  of  the  coal-mines. 

"Coal-beds!"  said  one,  "what  coal-beds?" 

"What  coal-beds?"  replied  another;  "why,  those  that 
Nares  found  in  1875  and  1876  on  the  eighty-second 
parallel,  when  his  people  found  the  miocene  flora  rich  in 
poplars,  beeches,  viburnums,  hazels,  and  conifers." 

"And  in  1881-1884,"  added  the  scientific  chronicler  of 
the  New  York  Witness,  "during  the  Greely  expedition  to 
Lady  Franklin  Bay,  a  bed  of  coal  was  discovered  by  our 
men  at  Watercourse  Creek,  close  to  Fort  Conger.  Did 
not  Dr.  Pavy  rightly  consider  that  these  carboniferous 
deposits  were  apparently  destined  to  be  used  some  day 
for  contending  with  the  cold  of  that  desolate  region?" 


THE  POLAR  COAL-FIELD  339 

When  these  facts  were  brought  forward,  it  will  be  easily 
understood  that  Impey  Barbicane's  adversaries  were  hard 
up  for  a  reply.  The  partisans  of  the  "Why  should  there 
be  coal?"  had  to  lower  their  flag  to  the  partisans  of  "Why 
should  there  not  be?"  Yes,  there  was  coal!  And  prob- 
ably a  considerable  amount  of  it  The  circumpolar  area 
contained  large  deposits  of  the  precious  combustible  on  the 
site  of  the  formerly  luxuriant  vegetation. 

But  if  the  ground  were  cut  from  under  their  feet  re- 
garding the  existence  of  the  coal,  the  detractors  took  their 
revenge  in  attacking  the  question  from  another  point. 

"Be  it  so!"  said  the  Major  one  day  in  the  rooms  of  the 
Gun  Club  itself,  when  he  discussed  the  matter  with  Bar- 
bicane.  "Be  it  so!  I  admit  there  is  coal  there;  I  am 
convinced  there  is  coal  there.  But  work  it !" 

"That  we  are  going  to  do,"  said  Barbicane  tranquilly. 

"Get  within  the  eighty-fourth  parallel,  beyond  which  no 
explorer  has  yet  gone!" 

"We  will  get  beyond  it!" 

"Go  to  the  Pole  itself!" 

"We  are  going  there !" 

And  in  listening  to  the  president  of  the  Gun  Club 
making  these  cool  answers,  talking  with  such  assurance, 
expressing  his  opinion  so  haughtily  and  unmistakably,  the 
most  obstinate  began  to  hesitate.  They  felt  they  were  in 
the  presence  of  a  man  who  had  lost  nothing  of  his  former 
qualities;  calm,  cool,  with  a  mind  eminently  serious  and 
concentrated,  exact  as  a  chronometer,  adventurous,  and 
bringing  the  most  practical  ideas  to  bear  on  the  most 
daring  undertakings.  Solid,  morally  and  physically,  he 
was  "deep  in  the  water,"  to  employ  a  metaphor  of 
Napoleon's,  and  could  hold  his  own  against  wind  or  tide. 
His  enemies  and  rivals  knew  that  only  too  well. 

He  had  stated  that  he  would  reach  the  North  Pole! 
He  would  set  foot  where  no  human  foot  had  been  set 
before!  He  would  hoist  the  Stars  and  Stripes  on  one  of 
the  two  spots  of  earth  which  remained  immovable  while 
all  the  rest  spun  around  in  diurnal  rotation! 

Here  was  a  chance  for  the  caricaturists!  In  the  win- 
dows of  the  shops  and  kiosks  of  the  great  cities  of  Europe 
and  America  there  appeared  thousands  of  sketches  and 


340        PURCHASE  OF  THE  NORTH  POLE 

prints  displaying  Impey  Barbicane  seeking  the  most  ex- 
travagant means  o'f  attaining  his  object. 

Here  the  daring  American,  assisted  by  all  the  members 
of  the  Gun  Club,  pickaxe  in  hand,  was  driving  a  sub- 
marine tunnel  through  masses  of  ice,  which  was  to  emerge 
at  the  very  point  of  the  axis. 

Here  Barbicane,  accompanied  by  J.  T.  Maston — a  very 
good  portrait — and  Captain  Nicholl,  descended  in  a  bal- 
loon on  the  point  in  question,  and,  after  unheard-of  dan- 
gers, succeeding  in  capturing  a  lump  of  coal  weighing 
half  a  pound,  which  was  all  the  circumpolar  deposit  con- 
tained. 

Here  J.  T.  Maston,  who  was  as  popular  as  Barbicane 
with  the  caricaturists,  had  been  seized  by  the  magnetic 
attraction  of  the  Pole,  and  was  fast  held  to  the  ground  by 
his  metal  hook. 

And  it  may  be  remarked  here  that  the  celebrated  calcu- 
lator was  of  too  touchy  a  temperament  to  laugh  at  any 
jest  at  his  personal  peculiarities.  He  was  very  much  an- 
noyed at  it,  and  it  will  be  easily  imagined  that  Mrs.  Scor- 
bitt  was  not  the  last  to  share  in  his  just  indignation. 

Another  sketch,  in  the  Brussels  Magic  Lantern,  repre- 
sented Impey  Barbicane  and  his  co-directors  working  in 
the  midst  of  flames,  like  so  many  incombustible  sala- 
manders. To  melt  the  ice  of  the  Palseocrystic  Sea,  they 
had  poured  over  it  a  sea  of  alcohol,  and  then  lighted 
the  spirit,  so  as  to  convert  the  polar  basin  into  a  bowl  of 
punch.  And,  playing  on  the  word  punch,  the  Belgian 
designer  had  had  the  irreverence  to  represent  the  president 
of  the  Gun  Club  as  a  ridiculous  punchinello. 

But  of  all  the  caricatures,  that  which  obtained  the  most 
success  was  published  by  the  Parisian  Charivari  under  the 
signature  of  "Stop."  In  the  stomach  of  a  whale,  comfort- 
ably furnished  and  padded,  Impey  Barbicane  and  J.  T. 
Maston  sat  smoking  and  playing  chess,  waiting  their 
arrival  at  their  destination.  The  new  Jonahs  had  not 
hesitated  to  avail  themselves  of  an  enormous  marine 
mammifer,  and  by  this  new  mode  of  locomotion  had 
passed  under  the  ice-floes  to  reach  the  inaccessible  Pole. 

The  phlegmatic  president  was  not  in  the  least  incom- 
moded by  this  intemperance  of  pen  and  pencil.  He  let  the 


A  TELEPHONIC  CONVERSATION          341 

world  talk,  and  sing,  and  parody,  and  caricature;  and  he 
quietly  went  on  with  his  work. 

As  soon  as  he  had  obtained  the  concession,  he  had  issued 
an  appeal  to  the  public  for  the  subscription  of  fifteen  mil- 
lions of  dollars  in  hundred-dollar  shares.  Such  was  the 
credit  of  Barbicane  &  Co.,  that  applications  flowed  in 
wholesale.  But  it  is  as  well  to  say  that  nearly  all  the 
applications  came  from  the  United  States. 

"So  much  the  better!"  said  the  supporters  of  the  North 
Polar  Practical  Association.  "The  work  will  be  entirely 
American." 

The  prospectus  was  so  plausible,  the  speculators  be- 
lieved so  tenaciously  in  the  realization  of  its  promises, 
and  admitted  so  imperturbably  the  existence  of  the  Polar 
coal-mines,  that  the  capital  was  subscribed  three  times 
over. 

Two-thirds  of  the  applications  were  declined  with  regret, 
and  on  the  i6th  of  December  the  capital  of  fifteen  mil- 
lions of  dollars  was  fully  paid  up.  It  was  about  thrice  as 
much  as  the  amount  subscribed  for  the  Gun  Club  when 
they  made  their  great  experiment  of  sending  a  projectile 
from  the  Earth  to  the  Moon. 


CHAPTER  VI 

A  TELEPHONIC  CONVERSATION 

NOT  only  had  Barbicane  announced  that  he  would  at- 
tain his  object — and  now  the  capital  at  his  command 
enabled  him  to  reach  it  without  hindrance — but  he  would 
certainly  not  have  appealed  for  funds  if  he  was  not  certain 
of  success. 

The  North  Pole  was  at  last  to  be  conquered  by  the 
audacious  genius  of  man! 

Barbicane  and  his  co-directors  had  the  means  of  suc- 
ceeding where  so  many  others  had  failed.  They  would  do 
what  had  not  been  done  by  Franklin,  Kane,  Nares,  or 
Greely.  They  would  advance  beyond  the  eighty- fourth 
parallel.  They  would  take  possession  of  the  vast  portion 
of  the  globe  that  had  fallen  to  them  under  the  hammer. 
They  would  add  to  the  American  flag  the  forty-third  star 


342         PURCHASE  OF  THE  NORTH  POLE 

for  the  forty-third  state  annexed  to  the  American  Con- 
federation. 

"Rubbish!"  said  the  European  delegates. 

And  the  means  of  conquering  the  Pole — means  that 
were  practical,  logical,  indisputable,  and  of  a  simplicity 
quite  infantine — were  the  suggestion  of  J.  T.  Maston.  It 
was  in  his  brain,  where  ideas  were  cooked  in  cerebral  mat- 
ter in  a  state  of  constant  ebullition,  that  there  had  been 
conceived  this  great  geographical  work,  and  the  means 
devised  of  bringing  it  to  a  successful  issue. 

The  secretary  of  the  Gun  Club  was  a  remarkable  calcu- 
lator. The  solution  of  the  most  complicated  problems  of 
mathematical  science  was  but  sport  to  him.  He  laughed 
at  difficulties,  whether  in  the  science  of  magnitudes,  that 
is  algebra,  or  in  the  science  of  numbers,  that  is  arithmetic; 
and  it  was  a  treat  to  see  him  handle  the  symbols,  the  con- 
ventional signs  which  form  the  algebraic  notation,  whether 
letters  of  the  alphabet,  representing  quantities  or  magni- 
tudes, or  lines  coupled  or  crossed,  which  indicate  the  re- 
lation between  the  quantities  and  the  operations  to  which 
they  are  submitted. 

Ah!  The  co-efficients,  the  exponents,  the  radicals,  the 
indices,  and  the  other  arrangements  adopted  in  that  lan- 
guage! How  the  signs  leaped  from  his  pen,  or  rather 
from  the  piece  of  chalk  which  wriggled  at  the  end  of  his 
metal  hook,  for  he  preferred  to  work  on  a  blackboard. 
There,  on  a  surface  of  ten  square  yards — for  nothing  less 
would  do  for  J.  T.  Maston — he  reveled  in  all  the  ardor 
of  his  algebraical  temperament.  They  were  no  miserable 
little  figures  that  he  employed  in  his  calculations.  No; 
the  figures  were  fantastic,  gigantic,  traced  writh  a  furious 
hand.  His  2's  and  3's  waltzed  like  shavings  in  a  whirl- 
wind; his  7's  were  like  gibbets,  and  only  wanted  a  corpse 
to  complete  them;  his  8's  were  like  spectacles;  and  his  6's 
and  Q'S  had  flourishes  interminable! 

And  the  letters  with  which  he  built  up  his  formulae! 
The  a's  and  b's  and  c's  he  used  for  his  quantities  given  or 
known;  and  the  #'s,  /s  and  s's  he  used  for  the  quantities 
sought  or  unknown,  and  especially  his  £s,  which  twisted 
in  zigzags  like  lightning  flashes!  And  what  turns  and 
twiggles  there  were  in  his  TT'S  his  A's,  his  w's!  Even  a 
Euclid  or  an  Archimedes  would  have  been  proud  of  them ! 

And  as  to  his  signs,  in  pure  unblurred  chalk,  they  were 


A  TELEPHONIC  CONVERSATION          343 

simply  marvellous.  His  +  showed  the  addition  was 
unmistakable.  His  — ,  though  humbler,  was  quite  a  work 
of  art.  His  X  was  as  clear  as  a  St.  Andrew's  cross.  And 
as  to  his  =,  so  rigorously  equal  were  they,  as  to  indicate 
without  a  chance  of  mistake,  that  J.  T.  Maston  lived  in  a 
country  where  equality  was  no  vain  formula.  His  <,  his 
>,  and  his  <  were  really  grand!  And  as  to  his  V,  the 
joot  of  a  quantity  or  of  a  number,  it  was  really  a  triumph, 
and  when  he  completed  the  horizontal  bar  in  this  style 


it  seemed  as  if  the  indicatory  vinculum  would  shoot  clean 
off  the  blackboard  and  menace  the  world  with  inclusion 
within  the  maniacal  equation. 

But  do  not  suppose  that  the  mathematical  intelligence 
of  J.  T.  Maston  was  bounded  by  the  horizon  of  elementary 
algebra.  No!  The  differential  calculus,  the  integral  cal- 
culus, the  calculus  of  variations  were  no  strangers  to  him, 
and  with  unshaking  hand  he  dashed  down  the  famous 
sign  of  integration,  the  shape  so  terrible  in  its  simplicity, 
the  f 

that  speaks  of  an  infinity  of  elements  of  the  infinitely 
little. 

And  like  it  was  his  2  which  represents  the  sum  of  a 
finite  number  of  finite  elements;  like  it  was  his  oc  with 
which  mathematicians  indicate  the  variant;  like  it  were 
all  the  mysterious  symbols  employed  in  this  language  so 
unintelligible  to  ordinary  mortals.  In  short,  this  astonish- 
ing man  was  capable  of  mounting  the  mathematical  ladder 
to  the  very  topmost  rung. 

Such  was  J.  T.  Maston.  No  wonder  his  colleagues  had 
every  confidence  in  him  when  he  undertook  to  solve  the 
wildest  abracadabrant  calculations  that  occurred  to  their 
audacious  brains!  No  wonder  that  the  Gun  Club  had 
confided  to  him  the  problem  regarding  the  hurling  of 
the  projectile  from  the  Earth  to  the  Moon!  No  wonder 
that  Evangelina  Scorbitt  was  intoxicated  with  his  glory, 
and  had  conceived  for  him  an  admiration  which  perilously 
bordered  on  love! 

But  in  the  case  under  consideration,  the  solution  of  the 
problem  regarding  the  conquest  of  the  North  Pole,  J.  T. 
Maston  had  no  flight  to  take  in  the  sublime  regions  of 


344    PURCHASE  OF  THE  NORTH  POLE 

analysis.  To  allow  the  concessionaries  of  the  Arctic 
regions  to  make  use  of  their  new  possessions,  the  secre- 
tary of  the  Gun  Club  had  but  a  simple  problem  in  me- 
chanics to  occupy  his  mind.  It  was  a  complicated  prob- 
lem, no  doubt,  requiring  ingenious  and  possibly  novel 
formulae,  but  it  could  be  done. 

Yes!  They  could  trust  J.  T.  Maston,  although  the 
slightest  slip  might  entail  the  loss  of  millions!  But  never 
since  his  baby  head  had  toyed  with  the  first  notions  of 
arithmetic  had  he  made  a  mistake,  never  had  he  been  the 
millionth  of  an  inch  out  in  a  matter  of  measurement,  and 
if  he  had  made  an  error  in  the  last  of  twenty  places  of 
decimals  his  gutta-percha  cranium  would  have  burst  its 
fixings. 

It  was  important  to  insist  on  the  remarkable  mathe- 
matical powers  of  J.  T.  Maston.  We  have  done  so !  Now 
we  have  to  show  him  at  work,  and  to  do  that  we  must  go 
back  a  few  weeks. 

About  a  month  before  the  famous  advertisement,  J.  T. 
Maston  had  been  requested  to  work  out  the  elements  of 
the  project  of  which  he  had  suggested  to  his  colleagues 
the  marvelous  consequences. 

For  many  years  he  had  lived  at  No.  179  Franklin 
Street,  one  of  the  quietest  streets  in  Baltimore,  far  from 
the  business  quarter,  for  in  commerce  he  took  no  interest; 
far  from  the  noise  of  the  crowd,  for  the  mob  he  abhorred. 

There  he  occupied  a  modest  habitation  known  as  Bal- 
listic Cottage,  living  on  the  pension  he  drew  as  an  old 
artillery  officer,  and  on  the  salary  paid  him  as  the  Gun 
Club  secretary.  He  lived  alone  with  one  servant,  Fire- 
Fire,  a  name  worthy  of  an  artilleryman's  valet.  This 
negro  was  a  servant  of  the  first-water,  and  he  served  his 
master  as  faithfully  as  he  would  have  served  a  gun. 

J.  T.  Maston  was  a  confirmed  bachelor,  being  of  opinion 
that  bachelorhood  is  the  only  state  worth  caring  about 
in  this  sublunary  sphere.  He  knew  the  Sclav  proverb, 
that  a  woman  draws  more  with  one  hair  than  four  oxen 
in  a  plow;  and  he  was  on  his  guard. 

If  he  was  alone  at  Ballistic  Cottage,  it  was  because  he 
wished  to  be  alone.  He  had  only  to  nod  to  change  his 
solitude  of  one  into  a  solitude  of  two,  and  help  himself 
to  half  the  fortune  of  a  millionaire.  There  was  no  doubt 


A  TELEPHONIC  CONVERSATION.          345 

of  it.  Mrs.  Scorbitt  would  only  have  been  too  happy; 
'but  J.  T.  Maston  was  not  going  to  be  too  happy;  and  it 
seemed  that  these  two  people  so  admirably  adapted  to 
each  other — in  the  widow's  opinion — would  never  under- 
stand each  other. 

The  cottage  was  a  very  quiet  one.  There  was  a  ground- 
floor  and  a  first-floor.  The  ground-floor  had  its  veranda, 
its  reception-room  and  dining-room,  and  the  kitchen  in 
a  small  annex  in  the  garden.  Above  them  was  a  bed- 
room in  front,  and  a  workroom  facing  the  garden  away 
from  the  noise,  a  buen  retiro  of  the  savant  and  the  sage 
within  whose  walls  were  solved  calculations  that  would 
have  raised  the  envy  of  a  Newton  or  a  Laplace. 

Different,  indeed,  was  the  home  of  Mrs.  Scorbitt,  in  the 
fashionable  quarter  of  New  Park,  with  the  balconies  on  its 
front  covered  with  the  fantastic  sculpture  of  American 
architecture,  Gothic  and  Renascence  jumbled  together; 
its  enormous  hall,  its  picture  galleries,  its  double  twisted 
staircase,  its  numerous  domestics,  its  stables,  its  coach- 
houses, its  gardens,  its  lawns,  its  trees,  its  fountains,  and 
the  tower  which  dominated  its  battlements  from  the  sum- 
mit of  which  fluttered  in  the  breeze  the  blue  and  gold 
banner  of  the  Scorbitts. 

Three  miles  divided  New  Park  from  Ballistic  Cottage. 
But  a  telephone  wire  united  the  two  habitations,  and  at 
the  ringing  of  the  call  between  the  mansion  and  the  cot- 
tage conversation  could  be  instantly  established.  If  the 
talkers  could  not  see  each  other,  they  could  hear  each 
other;  and  no  one  will  be  surprised  to  learn  that  Evange- 
lina  Scorbitt  called  J.  T.  Maston  much  oftener  before  his 
telephonic  plate  than  J.  T.  Maston  called  Evangelina  Scor- 
bitt before  hers.  The  mathematician  would  leave  his 
work,  not  without  some  disgust,  to  receive  a  friendly 
"good  morning,"  and  he  would  reply  by  a  growl  along 
the  wire,  which  he  hoped  would  soften  as  it  went,  and 
then  he  would  return  to  his  problems. 

It  was  on  the  3rd  of  October,  after  a  last  and  long 
conference,  that  J.  T.  Maston  took  leave  of  his  colleagues 
to  devote  himself  to  his  task.  It  was  the  most  important 
investigation  he  had  undertaken.  He  had  to  calculate 
the  mechanical  formulae  required  for  the  advance  on  the 
Pole,  and  the  economical  working  of  the  coal-beds  thereof. 


346        PURCHASE  OF  THE  NORTH  POLE 

He  estimated  that  it  would  take  him  rather  more  than  a 
week  to  accomplish  this  mysterious  task.  It  was  a  com- 
plicated and  delicate  inquiry,  necessitating  the  resolution 
of  a  large  number  of  equations  dealing  with  mechanics, 
analytical  geometry  of  the  three  dimensions,  and  spherical 
trigonometry. 

To  be  free  from  trouble,  it  had  been  arranged  that  the 
secretary  of  the  Gun  Club  should  retire  to  his  cottage, 
and  be  visited  and  disturbed  by  no  one.  This  was  a  great 
trial  for  Mrs.  Scorbitt,  but  she  had  to  resign  herself  to  it. 
She  and  President  Barbicane,  Captain  Nicholl,  the  brisk 
Bilsby,  Colonel  Bloomsberry,  and  Tom  Hunter  with  his 
wooden  legs,  had  called  on  Maston  in  the  afternoon  to 
bid  him  farewell  for  a  time. 

"You  will  succeed,  dear  Maston,"  she  said,  as  she  rose 
to  go. 

"But  be  sure  you  don't  make  a  mistake,"  said  Barbi- 
cane, with  a  smile. 

"A  mistake!  He!"  exclaimed  Mrs.  Scorbitt,  with  hor- 
ror at  the  thought. 

With  a  grip  of  the  hand  from  some,  a  sigh  from  one, 
wishes  for  success,  and  recommendations  not  to  overwork 
himself  from  others,  the  mathematician  saw  his  friends 
depart.  The  door  of  Ballistic  Cottage  was  shut,  and  Fire- 
Fire  received  orders  to  open  it  to  no  one — not  even  to  the 
President  of  the  United  States  of  America. 

For  the  first  two  days  of  his  seclusion  J.  T.  Maston 
thought  over  the  problem  without  touching  the  chalk. 
He  read  over  certain  works  relative  to  the  elements,  the 
earth,  its  mass,  its  density,  its  volume,  its  form,  its  rotation 
on  its  axis,  and  translation  around  its  orbit — elements 
which  were  to  form  the  bases  of  his  calculations. 

These  are  the  principal,  which  it  is  as  well  the  reader 
should  have  before  him.  Form  of  the  Earth :  an  ellip- 
soid of  revolution,  with  a  major  diameter  of  7926.6 
miles,  and  a  minor  diameter  of  7899.6  miles.  The  differ- 
ence between  the  two,  owing  to  the  flattening  of  the 
spheroid  at  the  Poles  being  27  miles,  or  one  two-hundred- 
and-ninety-third  of  its  mean  diameter. 

Circumference  of  the  Earth  at  the  Equator:  24,899 
miles,  the  meridional  circumference  being  24,856  miles. 


A  TELEPHONIC  CONVERSATION          347 

Surface  of  the  Earth:  197,000,000  square  miles. 

Volume  of  the  Earth:  260,000,000,000  cubic  miles. 

Density  of  the  Earth:  five  and  a  half  times  that  of 
water,  the  mass  being  approximately  6,000,000,000,000,- 
000,000,000  tons. 

Duration  of  the  Earth's  journey  around  the  Sun:  365 
days  and  a  quarter,  constituting  the  solar  year,  or  more 
exactly  365  days,  6  hours,  9  minutes,  thus  giving  the 
spheroid  an  average  velocity  of  66,000  miles  an  hour. 

Rate  of  the  Earth's  rotation  at  the  Equator:  1037.4583 
miles  per  hour. 

The  following  were  the  units  of  length,  force,  time,  and 
inclination  which  J.  T.  Maston  required  for  his  calcula- 
tions; the  mile,  the  ton,  the  second,  and  the  angle  at  the 
center  which  cuts  off  in  any  circle  an  arc  equal  to  the 
radius. 

It  was  on  the  5th  of  October,  at  five  o'clock  in  the  after- 
noon— it  is  important  to  know  the  precise  time  in  a  work 
of  such  celebrity — that  J.  T.  Maston,  after  much  reflecting, 
began  to  write.  And,  to  begin  with,  he  attacked  the 
problem  at  its  base — that  is,  by  the  number  representing 
the  circumference  of  the  Earth,  and  one  of  its  great  circles, 
viz.  the  Equator. 

The  blackboard  was  placed  in  an  angle  of  the  room  on 
an  easel  of  polished  oak,  well  in  the  light  of  one  of  the 
windows  which  opened  on  to  the  garden.  Little  sticks  of 
chalk  were  placed  on  the  shelf  at  the  bottom  of  the  board. 
A  sponge  to  wipe  out  with  was  in  the  calculator's  left 
hand.  His  right  hand,  or  rather  his  hook,  was  reserved 
for  writing  down  the  figures  of  his  working. 

He  began  by  describing  the  circumference  of  the  ter- 
restrial spheroid.  At  the  Equator  the  curve  of  the  globe 
was  marked  by  a  plain  line  representing  the  front  part  of 
the  curve,  and  by  a  dotted  line  representing  the  back  half 
of  the  curve.  The  axis  was  a  perpendicular  line  cutting 
the  Equator,  and  marked  N.S. 

On  the  left-hand  top  corner  of  the  board  he  wrote  the 
number  that  used  to  represent  the  earth's  circumference  in 
metrical  measurement — 

40,000,000. 

He  knew  that   this   was  an   assumption  admitted   to   be 
erroneous,  but  it  afforded  a  good  round  integer  to  begin 


348        PURCHASE  OF  THE  NORTH  POLE 

with,  and  the  subsequent  rectification  of  his  calculations 
by  the  inclusion  of  the  missing  meters  was  but  child's- 
play  to  so  transcendental  a  mathematician  as  J.  T.  Maston. 

He  was  so  pre-occupied  that  he  had  not  noticed  the 
state  of  the  sky — which  had  changed  considerably  during 
the  afternoon.  For  the  last  hour  one  of  those  great 
storms  had  been  gathering  which  affect  the  organizations 
of  all  living  things.  Livid  clouds  like  whitish  wool  flocks 
had  accumulated  on  the  gray  expanse  and  hung  heavily 
over  the  city.  The  roll  of  distant  thunder  was  heard. 
One  or  two  flashes  had  already  rent  the  atmosphere  where 
the  electric  tension  was  at  its  highest. 

J.  T.  Maston,  more  and  more  absorbed,  saw  nothing, 
heard  nothing. 

Suddenly  an  electric  bell  troubled  the  silence  of  the 
room  with  its  hurried  tinkling. 

"Good!"  exclaimed  the  mathematician.  "If  interrupters 
can't  get  in  by  the  door,  they  come  through  the  wire! 
A  fine  invention  for  people  who  wish  to  be  left  alone! 
I'll  see  if  I  can't  turn  that  current  off  while  I  am  at 
work !"  And  stepping  up  to  the  telephone,  he  asked,  "Who 
wants  me?" 

"I  want  a  moment's  talk  with  you,"  said  a  feminine 
voice. 

"And  who  is  speaking?" 

"Have  you  not  recognized  my  voice,  dear  Mr.  Maston? 
It  is  Mrs.  Scorbitt." 

"Mrs.  Scorbitt!  She  will  not  leave  me  a  moment's 
peace."  But  the  last  words  were  prudently  muttered  above 
the  instrument,  so  that  the  widow  heard  them  not.  And 
J.  T.  Maston,  seeing  that  he  must  say  something  civil, 
replied,  "Ah!  It  is  you,  Mrs.  Scorbitt?" 

"I,  dear  Mr.  Maston!" 

"And  what  does  Mrs.  Scorbitt  want  with  me?"-v 

"To  tell  you  that  there  is  a  storm  coming  your  way." 

"Well,  I  cannot  stop  it—" 

"No,  but  I  wanted  to  ask  if  you  had  taken  care  to  shut 
your  window — " 

Mrs.  Scorbitt  had  hardly  ended  before  a  tremendous 
clap  of  thunder  filled  the  air.  It  seemed  as  though  a  vast 
sheet  of  silk  had  been  torn  apart  for  an  infinity  of  length. 
The  lightning  had  flashed  down  over  Ballistic  Cottage, 


A  TELEPHONIC  CONVERSATION          349 

and,   conducted  by  the  telephone  wire,  had   invaded  the 
mathematician's  room  with  a  brutality  quite  electric. 

J.  T.  Maston,  bending  over  the  mouthpiece  of  the  in- 
strument, received  the  hardest  voltaic  knock  that  had  ever 
found  the  mouth  of  a  philosopher.  The  flash  had  run 
along  his  metal  hook,  and  spun  him  around  like  a  teeto- 
tum. The  blackboard  he  struck  with  his  back  was  hurled 
down  in  the  corner.  And  the  lightning  disappeared  out 
of  the  window. 

Stunned  for  a  moment — and  it  was  a  wonder  it  was  no 
worse — J.  T.  Maston  slowly  rose,  and  rubbed  the  different 
parts  of  his  body  to  make  sure  he  was  not  hurt. 

Then,  having  lost  none  of  his  coolness,  as  beseemed  the 
ancient  pointer  of  the  Columbiad,  he  put  his  room  in 
order,  picked  up  his  easel,  hoisted  up  his  blackboard, 
gathered  up  the  fragments  of  chalk  scattered  on  the  carpet, 
and  resumed  his  work,  which  had  been  so  rudely  inter- 
rupted. 

But  he  noticed  that  by  the  fall  of  the  blackboard  the 
figures  he  had  written  on  the  right-hand  top  corner,  which 
represented  in  meters  the  approximate  equatorial  circum- 
ference of  the  earth,  had  been  partially  erased.  He 
stretched  his  hook  up  to  re-write  them  when  the  bell 
sounded  with  a  feverish  tinkle. 

"Again!"  exclaimed  J.  T.  Maston.  And  he  went  to 
the  telephone. 

"Who  is  there?"  he  asked. 

"Mrs.  Scorbitt." 

"And  what  does  Mrs.  Scorbitt  want?" 

"Did  that  horrible  flash  of  lightning  strike  Ballistic 
Cottage?" 

"I  have  every  reason  to  believe  so." 

"Good  Heavens !    The  lightning—" 

"Do  not  be  uneasy,  Mrs.  Scorbitt." 

"You  are  not  hurt,  dear  Mr.  Maston?" 

"Not  at  all." 

"You  are  sure  you  have  not  been  touched?" 

"I  am  only  touched  by  your  thought  fulness  for  me," 
said  the  philosopher  gallantly 

"Good  evening,  dear  Mr.  Maston." 

"Good  evening,  dear  Mrs.  Scorbitt." 

And  he  returned  to  his  blackboard. 


350   PURCHASE  OF  THE  NORTH  POLE 

"Confound  that  excellent  woman,"  he  said;  "if  she 
hadn't  called  me  to  the  telephone  I  should  not  have  run 
the  chance  of  being  struck  by  lightning." 

And  to  insure  being  left  in  quiet,  he  judiciously  put  the 
telephone  out  of  action. 

Then  he  resumed  his  work.  From  the  number  on  the 
board  he  gradually  built  up  a  definitive  formula,  and  then 
noting  it  on  the  left,  he  cleared  away  the  working  by 
which  he  had  arrived  at  it,  and  launched  forth  into  an 
appalling  series  of  figures  and  signs. 

Eight  days  later  the  wonderful  calculation  was  finished, 
and  the  secretary  of  the  Gun  Club  triumphantly  bore  off 
to  his  colleagues  the  solution  of  the  problem  which  they 
had  awaited  with  a  very  natural  impatience. 

The  practical  means  of  arriving  at  the  North  Pole  to 
work  its  coal-mines  were  mathematically  established. 
Then  the  company  was  formed  under  the  title  of  The 
North  Polar  Practical  Association.  Then  the  Arctic  re- 
gions were  purchased  under  the  auctioneer's  hammer.  And 
then  the  shares  were  offered  to  the  world. 


CHAPTER  VII 

BARBICANE   MAKES  A  SPEECH 

ON  the  22nd  of  December  a  general  meeting  was  called 
of  the  shareholders  of  the  North  Polar  Practical  Associ- 
ation, to  take  place  at  the  rooms  of  the  Gun  Club  in 
Union  Square.  And  the  square  itself  was  hardly  large 
enough  to  hold  the  crowd. 

Usually  the  large  hall  of  the  club  was  decorated  with 
weapons  of  all  sorts  appropriate  to  the  noble  profession 
of  its  members.  It  was  quite  an  artillery  museum.  Even 
the  furniture  itself,  the  chairs  and  tables,  and  couches,  was 
of  the  pattern  of  the  murderous  engines  which  had  sent  to 
a  better  world  so  many  worthy  people  whose  secret  desire 
had  been  to  die  of  old  age. 

On  this  occasion  the  furniture  had  been  removed.  This 
was  not  a  warlike  assembly;  it  was  an  industrial  and 
pacific  assembly  over  which  Barbicane  was  to  preside. 
The  hall  was  full  to  suffocation,  and  the  crowd  of  those 
who  could  not  get  in  stretched  half  across  Union  Square. 


BARBICANE  MAKES  A  SPEECH  351 

The  members  of  the  Gun  Club  who  had  held  the  first 
shares  in  the  company  had  secured  places  around  the  plat- 
form. Among  them,  even  more  triumphant  than  usual, 
were  Colonel  Bloomsberry,  Tom  Hunter  with  the  wooden 
legs,  and  the  brisk  Bilsby.  A  comfortable  arm-chair  had 
been  reserved  for  Mrs.  Scorbitt,  as  was  only  right,  con- 
sidering that  she  was  the  chief  proprietor  of  the  Polar 
freehold;  and  there  were  a  number  of  other  lady  share- 
holders belonging  to  all  classes  of  the  city,  whose  bright 
bonnets,  and  hats,  and  feathers,  and  ribbons,  were  a  wel- 
come relief  to  the  black  coats  of  the  noisy  men  that 
crowded  under  the  glazed  cupola  of  the  hall. 

The  immense  majority  of  shareholders  were  not  so  much 
supporters  as  personal  friends  of  the  directors.  But  among 
the  crowd  were  the  representatives  of  the  rival  companies 
who  had  bid  against  Forster  at  the  auction  sale,  and  who 
now  had  taken  shares  in  order  to  be  qualified  to  vote  and 
make  mischief  at  the  meetings.  It  can  be  easily  imagined 
with  what  intense  curiosity  they  awaited  Barbicane's  ad- 
dress, which  would  probably  throw  some  light  on  the 
way  in  which  the  North  Pole  was  to  be  reached.  Perhaps 
there  was  a  difficulty  there  even  greater  than  working  the 
mines?  If  any  objections  could  be  made  we  may  be  sure 
that  Baldenak,  Karkof,  Jansen,  and  Harald  were  quite 
equal  to  making  them.  And  the  Major  and  his  invaluable 
Todrin  would  lose  no  chance  of  driving  Barbicane  behind 
his  last  entrenchments. 

It  was  eight  o'clock.  The  hall,  the  side  rooms,  and  the 
corridors  of  the  Gun  Club  glowed  with  Edison  lamps. 
Ever  since  the  doors  had  been  opened  to  the  public  there 
had  been  an  incessant  uproar,  but  as  soon  as  the  directors 
appeared  all  was  silent. 

At  a  table  covered  with  a  black  cloth,  on  the  platform, 
Barbicane,  Nicholl,  and  J.  T.  Maston  took  up  their  posi- 
tions in  the  fullest  glare  of  the  light.  As  they  did  so 
three  cheers,  punctuated  by  the  needful  "hips,"  broke 
forth,  and  were  echoed  in  the  adjacent  streets.  Solemnly 
J.  T.  Maston  and  Captain  Nicholl  sat  down  in  all  the 
plenitude  of  their  celebrity.  Then  Barbicane,  who  had 
remained  standing,  put  his  right  hand  in  his  trousers 
pocket,  his  left  thumb  in  his  waistcoat  pocket,  and  began 
to  speak  as  follows: — 


352        PURCHASE  OF  THE  NORTH  POLE 

"Fellow  shareholders :  The  directorate  of  the  North 
Polar  Practical  Association  have  called  this  meeting  in  the 
rooms  of  the  Gun  Club,  as  they  have  something  of  im- 
portance to  communicate  to  you. 

"You  have  learned  from  the  newspapers  that  the  object 
of  our  company  is  the  opening  up  of  the  coal-fields  of  the 
North  Pole,  the  concession  of  which  we  have  obtained. 
The  estate  acquired  in  public  auction  is  the  property  of  the 
company,  and  the  capital,  which  was  all  subscribed  by  the 
nth  of  December  last,  enables  us  to  enter  at  once  on  an 
enterprise  which  will  produce  a  rate  of  interest  unknown 
up  to  now  in  any  commercial  or  industrial  operation  what- 
ever." 

Here  the  first  murmur  of  approval  for  a  moment  inter- 
rupted the  orator. 

"You  are  aware  of  how  we  came  to  discover  that  there 
were  rich  beds  of  coal,  and  also  possibly  of  fossil  ivory, 
in  the  circumpolar  regions.  The  statements  in  the  public 
press  leave  no  doubt  as  to  the  existence  of  these  coal 
strata. 

"Now  coal  has  become  the  source  of  all  modern  industry. 
To  say  nothing  of  the  fuel  used  for  heating  purposes,  or 
of  its  employment  for  the  production  of  steam  and  elec- 
tricity, I  may  direct  your  attention  to  its  derivatives,  the 
aniline  colors,  the  perfumes,  the  picrates,  salicylic  acid, 
naphtol,  phenol,  antipyrin,  benzin,  naphthalin,  pyrogallic 
acid,  tannin,  saccharin,  tar,  asphalt,  pitch,  lubricating  oils, 
varnish,  yellow  prussiate  of  potass,  cyanide,  bitters,  etc., 
etc." 

And  after  this  enumeration,  which  had  been  given  with 
great  rapidity,  the  orator  paused  like  an  exhausted  runner 
to  take  a  long  breath.  Then  he  continued,  "It  is  indubi- 
table that  coal  will  in  time  be  exhausted.  Before  five 
hundred  years  the  mines  in  operation  today — " 

"Three  hundred!"  shouted  one  of  the  crowd. 

"Two  hundred!"  roared  another. 

"Let  us  say  a  delay  more  or  less  restricted,"  said  Bar- 
bicane,  "and  put  ourselves  in  a  position  to  see  what  new 
coal-fields  then  remain,  supposing  that  the  present  fields 
are  exhausted  at  the  close  of  this  century." 

Here  he  paused  to  enable  his  audience  to  concentrate 
their  attention.  Then  he  continued,  "Now,  fellow  share- 


BARBICANE  MAKES  A  SPEECH  353 

holders,  follow  me,  and  let  us  start  for  the  North  Pole." 

And  the  audience  rose  as  if  to  pack  their  baggage  ready 
for  shipboard. 

An  observation  from  Major  Donellan  put  a  sudden  stop 
to  this  movement  of  enthusiasm. 

"Before  you  start/'  said  he,  "will  you  kindly  inform  the 
meeting  how  you  intend  going?  Are  you  going  by  sea?" 

"Neither  by  sea,  nor  by  land,  nor  by  air!"  said  Bar- 
bicane  sweetly. 

And  the  assembly  sat  down,  a  prey  to  very  pardonable 
curiosity. 

"You  are  not  without  some  knowledge,"  continued  the 
orator,  "of  the  attempts  that  have  been  made  to  reach  that 
inaccessible  point  of  the  terrestrial  spheroid.  It  is  better, 
however,  that  I  should  remind  you  of  a  few  of  them.  It 
will  be  to  render  due  honor  to  the  bold  pioneers  who 
have  survived  and  those  who  have  succumbed  in  these 
expeditions." 

Unanimous  approval  from  the  entire  audience  irrespec- 
tive of  nationality. 

"In  1845,"  resumed  Barbicane,  "Sir  John  Franklin  with 
the  Erebus  and  Terror  set  out  to  find  the  North- West 
Passage,  and  nothing  more  was  heard  of  him. 

"In  1854  the  American,  Kane,  and  his  lieutenant,  Mor- 
ton, went  in  search  of  Franklin.  They  returned,  but  their 
ship,  the  Advance  did  not  return. 

"In  1859  Sir  Leopold  MacClintock  discovered  a  docu- 
ment from  which  it  appeared  that  no  survivor  remained  of 
the  Erebus  and  Terror  expedition. 

"In  1860  Hayes  left  Boston  in  the  schooner  United 
States,  crossed  the  eighty-first  parallel,  and  returned  in 
1862  without  being  able  to  advance  farther,  notwithstand- 
ing the  heroic  efforts  of  his  companions. 

"In  1869  Captains  Koldewey  and  Hegeman,  both  Ger- 
mans, left  Bremerhaven  in  the  Hansa  and  Germania.  The 
Hansa  was  crushed  in  the  ice  a  little  below  the  seventy- 
first  parallel,  and  the  crew  had  to  take  to  their  boats  to 
reach  the  coast  of  Greenland.  The  Germania  was  more 
fortunate,  and  returned  to  Bremerhaven,  but  she  had  not 
been  able  to  get  higher  than  the  seventy-seventh  parallel. 

"In  1871  Captain  Hall  left  New  York  in  the  steamer 
Polaris.  Four  months  afterward,  during  the  terrible 

Vol.  13  Verne 


354    PURCHASE  OF  THE  NORTH  POLE 

winter,  he  died.  A  year  later  the  Polaris,  caught  in  the 
floes  after  reaching  the  eighty-second  parallel,  was  crushed 
by  the  ice.  Eighteen  of  her  men,  under  Lieutenant  Tyson, 
took  refuge  on  an  ice-floe  and  reached  the  continent  after 
long  drifting  about  in  the  Arctic  Ocean. 

"In  1875  Sir  George  Nares  left  Portsmouth  with  the 
Alert  and  Discovery.  It  was  in  his  memorable  Arctic 
campaign  that  winter  quarters  were  established  between 
the  eighty-second  and  eighty-third  parallels,  and  that  Cap- 
tain Markham,  in  a  dash  to  the  northward,  stopped  within 
four  hundred  miles  of  the  Pole,  no  one  up  to  then  having 
been  so  near. 

"In  1879  our  great  citizen,  Gordon  Bennett — " 

Here  there  were  three  cheers  given  for  the  proprietor  of 
the  New  York  Herald. 

"Fitted  out  the  Jeannettey  which  he  confided  to  Captain 
De  Long.  The  Jeannette  left  San  Francisco  with  thirty- 
three  men,  passed  through  Behring  Straits,  was  caught  by 
the  ice  at  Herald  Island,  and  sank  at  Bennett  Island,  near 
the  seventy-seventh  parallel.  The  men  had  only  one  re- 
source; to  make  southward  with  the  boats  or  journey 
over  the  ice-fields.  Misery  decimated  them.  De  Long 
died  in  October.  Many  others  succumbed,  and  twelve  only 
returned  from  the  expedition. 

"In  1881  Lieutenant  Greely  left  St.  John's,  Newfound- 
land, in  the  steamer  Proteus,  to  establish  a  station  on  Lady 
Franklin  Bay,  a  little  below  the  eighty-second  degree. 
There  he  founded  Fort  Conger,  whence  he  sent  out  ex- 
peditions west  and  north,  one  of  which,  under  Lieutenant 
Lockwood  and  his  companion,  Brainard,  in  May,  1882, 
claims  to  have  reached  83°  35',  being  fifteen  miles  nearer 
than  Markham's  farthest.  That  is  the  nearest  yet  ob- 
tained. It  is  the  Ultima  Thule  of  circumpolar  cartography." 

Here  there  were  loud  cheers  in  honor  of  the  American 
discoverers. 

"But,"  said  Barbicane,  "the  expedition  ended  in  disaster. 
The  Proteus  sank.  Eighty-four  men  were  left  in  frightful 
misery.  Doctor  Pavy  died.  Greely  was  discovered  by 
the  Thetis  in  1883  w^tn  onty  s^x  companions,  and  one  of 
these  was  Lieutenant  Lockwood,  who  soon  succumbed, 
adding  another  name  to  the  sorrowful  martyrology  of 
Arctic  exploration." 


BARBICANE   MAKES  A   SPEECH          355 

There  was  respectful  silence  while  Barbicane  paused. 

Then  in  a  thrilling  voice  he  resumed: 

"And  so,  in  spite  of  devotion  and  courage  unparalleled, 
the  eighty-fourth  degree  has  never  been  passed.  And  we 
may  even  assert  that  it  never  will  be  by  means  of  ships  or 
sledges.  It  is  not  given  to  man  to  face  such  dangers  and 
support  such  extremes  of  temperature.  It  is  by  other 
means  we  must  advance  to  the  conquest  of  the  Pole!" 

From  the  subdued  murmur  of  the  audience  it  was  evi- 
dent that  therein  lay  the  interest  of  the  communication. 
What  was  this  secret? 

"And  how  are  you  going  to  capture  it?"  asked  the 
Canadian. 

"Before  ten  minutes  are  up  you  will  know,  sir,"  replied 
Barbicane,  "and  in  addressing  the  shareholders  generally 
I  say,  Have  confidence  in  us,  for  the  promoters  of  the 
affair  are  the  same  men  who  embarked  in  the  cylindro- 
conical — " 

"The  cylindro-conical,"  interrupted  Todrin. 

"Dared  to  venture  to  the  moon." 

"And  have  come  back  as  we  see!"  added  Todrin,  not 
without  signs  of  disapproval. 

"Yes,"  continued  Barbicane,  "within  the  next  ten  min- 
utes you  will  know  what  we  propose." 

A  murmur  of  "Oh!"  and  "Eh!"  and  "Ah!"  rose  in 
answer  to  the  reply. 

It  seemed  as  though  the  orator  had  said,  "Within  the 
ten  minutes  we  shall  be  at  the  Pt>le!" 

He  continued,  "And  now,  is  it  a  -continent  at  the  Pole  ? 
Is  it  not  a  sea  such  as  Sir  George  Nares  called  the  Palseo- 
crystic  Sea,  the  sea  of  ancient  ice?  To  that  I  say,  We 
do  not  think  so." 

"That  is  not  good  enough,"  said  Baldenak.  "It  is  not 
a  question  of  not  thinking  so  but  of  being  certain." 

"Well!  I  reply  to  our  exuberant  interrupter  that  we  are 
certain.  It  is  solid  ground,  not  a  liquid  basin,  that  the 
North  Polar  Practical  Association  has  purchased.  It  is  a 
plateau  like  the  desert  of  Gobi  in  Central  Asia,  two  or 
three  miles  above  sea-level,  as  can  be  easily  and  logically 
proved  from  the  observations  made  in  the  regions  of 
which  the  polar  domain  is  really  a  prolongation.  Norden- 
skiold  and  other  observers  have  all  stated  that  Greenland 


356    PURCHASE  OF  THE  NORTH  POLE 

increases  in  height  as  it  goes  northward.  A  hundred  miles 
from  Disko  its  altitude  is  nearly  7000  feet.  And  if  we 
consider  the  different  products,  animal  or  vegetable,  found 
in  the  secular  ice,  such  as  the  carcasses  of  mastodons,  the 
trunks  of  conifers,  you  can  see  that  the  continent  was 
once  a  fertile  one,  inhabited  certainly  by  animals,  and 
probably  by  men.  There  lie  buried  the  thick  forests  of 
pre-historic  times,  which  have  formed  the  coal-fields  we 
propose  to  develop.  Yes!  It  is  a  continent  around  the 
Pole,  a  virgin  continent  untrodden  by  human  foot." 

Great  applause. 

When  the  echoes  of  the  applause  had  rolled  away,  the 
strident  voice  of  the  Canadian  was  heard,  "Seven  minutes 
out  of  the  ten  have  gone,  and  we  have  not  yet  reached 
the  Pole!" 

"We  will  be  there  in  three  minutes,"  placidly  remarked 
Barbicane. 

He  continued,  "But  if  it  is  a  continent,  and  the  con- 
tinent is  elevated  as  we  have  reason  to  believe,  it  is  ob- 
structed by  eternal  ice,  covered  with  icebergs  and  ice-fields, 
and  under  such  circumstances  its  development  would  be 
difficult—" 

"Impossible!"  said  Harald. 

"Impossible,  I  am  aware,"  said  Barbicane.  "And  it  is 
to  conquer  this  impossibility  that  our  efforts  are  directed. 
We  have  no  need  of  ships  or  sledges  to  reach  the  Pole, 
but  thanks  to  our  arrangements  the  fusion  of  the  ice, 
ancient  or  modern,  will  take  place  like  enchantment!" 

He   paused.      There   was   absolute    silence. 

"Gentlemen,"  he  continued,  "Archimedes  demanded  but 
a  fulcrum  to  lift  the  world!  Well,  we  have  found  a 
fulcrum !  A  lever  was  what  the  great  Syracusan  geometer 
required,  and  a  lever  we  possess !  We  are  in  a  position  to 
displace  the  Pole — " 

"Displace  the  Pole!"  exclaimed  Baldenak. 

"Bring  it  to  Baltimore !"  said  Professor  Harald. 

Evidently  Barbicane  did  not  wish  to  be  more  precise, 
for  he  continued,  "As  to  this  fulcrum — " 

"Don't  tell !     Don't  tell !"  shouted  one  of  the  audience. 

"As  to  this  lever—" 

"Keep  it  secret!  Keep  it  secret!"  shouted  the  specta- 
tors. 


BARBICANE  MAKES  A  SPEECH  357 

"We  will  keep  it  secret!"  said  Barbicane. 

Baldenak  and  Co.  protested  in  vain.  The  orator  con- 
tinued, "As  to  the  results  of  this  mechanical  operation — 
an  operation  unprecedented  in  industrial  annals — which 
we  have  undertaken  and  will  bring  to  a  successful  issue 
thanks  to  your  capital,  I  will  say  a  few  words." 

"Listen!  listen!"  shouted  the  crowd. 

"The  first  idea  of  our  enterprise  occurred  to  one  of  the 
most  learned,  devoted,  and  illustrious  of  our  colleagues. 
To  him  also  belongs  the  glory  of  hawing  made  the  calcu- 
lations which  rendered  the  theory  practicable,  for  if  the 
development  of  the  Polar  mines  is  child's  play,  the  dis- 
placement of  the  Pole  is  a  problem  which  higher  mechanics 
can  alone  deal  with.  That  is  why  we  addressed  ourselves 
to  our  worthy  secretary,  J.  T.  Maston!" 

"Hurrah!  'Hip!  hip!  hip!  hurrah!  for  J.  T.  Maston!" 
shouted  the  whole  assembly,  electrified  by  the  presence 
among  them  of  that  extraordinary  man. 

Ah!  How  much  was  Mrs.  Scorbitt  moved  at  the  ac- 
clamations which  resounded  around  the  celebrated  calcu- 
lator! 

He,  with  great  modesty,  bowed  his  head  to  the  right; 
then  to  the  left,  and  then  saluted  in  front  with  his  metal 
hook. 

"Already,"  said  Barbicane,  "when  the  great  meeting 
which  celebrated  the  arrival  in  America  of  the  Frenchman 
Michel  Ardan,  a  few  months  before  our  departure  for  the 
Moon—" 

The  American  spoke  as  coolly  of  the  voyage  to  the 
Moon  as  of  a  railway  journey  to  New  York. 

"J.  T.  Maston  had  exclaimed,  'Let  us  invent  machines, 
let  us  find  a  fulcrum,  and  we  will  shift  the  axis  of  the 
Earth!'  Many  of  you  heard  him,  and  will  remember  it. 
Well,  the  machines  are  invented,  the  fulcrum  is  found,  and 
it  is  to  the  righting  of  the  Earth's  axis  that  our  efforts  will 
be  directed." 

"What!"  exclaimed  Donellan.  "You  will  put  the 
Earth's  axis  upright?" 

"Yes,  sir,"  said  Barbicane;  "or  rather  we  can  make  a 
new  axis  on  which  the  diurnal  rotation  formerly — " 

"Modify  the  diurnal  rotation!"  exclaimed  Karkof. 

"Absolutely!  and  without  touching  its  duration.     The 


358    PURCHASE  OF  THE  NORTH  POLE 

operation  will  bring  the  Pole  to  about  the  sixty-seventh 
parallel,  and  under  such  circumstances  the  Earth  will  be- 
have like  Jupiter,  whose  axis  is  nearly  perpendicular  to  the 
plane  of  his  orbit.  This  displacement  of  23°  28'  will  suf- 
fice to  obtain  for  our  Polar  property  sufficient  warmth  to 
melt  the  ice  accumulated  for  thousands  of  years." 

The  audience  looked  at  him  in  a  state  of  breathlessness. 
No  one  dared  to  interrupt  or  even  to  applaud  him.  All 
were  overwhelmed  with  the  idea,  which  was  so  ingenious 
and  so  simple;  to  change  the  axis  on  which  the  globe 
turns ! 

The  representatives  of  the  rival  syndicates  were  as- 
tounded, annihilated,  and  remained  without  a  word  to  say 
for  themselves. 

But  the  applause  broke  out  when  Barbicane  concluded 
with  sublime  simplicity,  "Thus  it  is  the  Sun  himself  who 
will  melt  the  icebergs  and  ice-floes,  and  render  it  easy  to 
obtain  access  to  the  Pole!" 

"And  so,"  said  Donellan,  "if  man  cannot  get  to  the 
Pole,  the  Pole  must  come  to  man?" 

"Just  so!"  said  Barbicane. 


CHAPTER  VIII 

LIKE  JUPITER 

0 

YES!    Like  Jupiter. 

At  the  time  of  that  memorable  meeting  in  honor  of 
Michel  Ardan — so  appropriately  mentioned  by  the  orator 
— if  J.  T.  Maston  had  excitedly  exclaimed,  "Let  us  right 
the  Earth's  axis,"  it  was  because  the  daring  and  fantasti- 
cal Frenchman,  one  of  the  heroes  of  the  Moon  Voyage, 
had  chanted  his  dithyrambic  hymn  in  honor  of  the  most 
important  planets  of  our  solar  system.  In  his  superb 
panegyric  he  had  celebrated  the  special  advantages  of  the 
giant  planet,  as  we  briefly  reported  at  the  time. 

The  problem  solved  by  the  calculator  of  the  Gun  Club 
was  the  substitution  of  a  new  axis  of  rotation  for  the  old 
one  on  which  the  Earth  had  turned  ever  since  in  popular 
phrase,  "the  world  was  a  world."  This  new  axis  of  rota- 
tion would  be  perpendicular  to  the  plane  of  its  orbit; 
and  under  such  conditions  the  climatal  situation  of  the  old 


LIKE  JUPITER  359 

Pole  would  be  much  the  same  as  that  of  Trondjhem,  in 
Norway,  in  spring  time.  The  palseocrystic  armor  would 
thus  naturally  melt  under  the  rays  of  the  Sun;  and  at  the 
same  time  climate  would  be  distributed  over  the  Earth  as 
the  climates  are  distributed  in  Jupiter. 

The  inclination  of  our  planet's  axis,  or  in  other  terms, 
the  angle  which  its  axis  of  rotation  makes  with  the  plane 
of  its  ecliptic  is  66°  32'.  A  few  degrees  would  thus  bring 
the  axis  perpendicular  to  the  plane  of  the  orbit  it  de- 
scribes around  the  Sun. 

But — it  is  important  to  remark — the  effort  that  the 
North  Polar  Practical  Association  was  about  to  make 
would  not,  strictly  speaking,  right  the  Earth's  axis.  Me- 
chanically, no  force,  however  considerable,  could  accom- 
plish that.  The  Earth  is  not  like  a  chicken  on  a  spit,  that 
we  can  take  it  in  our  hand  and  shift  it  as  we  will.  But 
the  making  of  a  new  axis  was  possible — it  may  be  said 
easy — if  the  engineers  only  had  the  fulcrum  dreamed  of 
by  Archimedes  and  the  lever  imagined  by  J.  T.  Maston. 

But  as  it  had  been  decided  to  keep  the  invention  a  secret 
until  further  orders,  all  that  could  be  done  was  to  study 
the  consequences.  And  to  begin  with,  the  journals  and 
reviews  of  all  sorts  appealing  to  the  learned  and  the  ignor- 
ant devoted  themselves  to  considering  how  Jupiter  was 
affected  by  the  approximate  perpendicularity  of  his  axis 
to  the  plane  of  his  orbit. 

Jupiter,  like  Mercury,  Venus,  the  Earth,  Mars,  Saturn, 
Uranus,  and  Neptune,  forms  part  of  the  solar  system,  and 
sweeps  around  at  nearly  five  hundred  million  miles  from 
the  central  fire;  and  his  volume  is  about  fourteen  times 
that  of  the  Earth. 

If  there  be  such  a  thing  as  Jovian  life,  that  is  to  say,  if 
there  are  any  inhabitants  on  Jupiter,  the  following  are  the 
advantages  they  obtain  by  living  on  the  great  planet — 
advantages  so  poetically  brought  into  relief  at  the  mem- 
orable meeting  above  alluded  to. 

In  the  first  place,  during  the  diurnal  rotation  of  Jupiter, 
which  occupies  nine  hours,  fifty-five  minutes,  the  days  are 
always  equal  to  the  nights  in  all  latitudes;  that  is  to  say, 
the  Jovian  day  is  four  hours,  fifty-seven  minutes  long,  and 
the  Jovian  night  lasts  also  four  hours  and  fifty-seven 
minutes. 


36o   PURCHASE  OF  THE  NORTH  POLE 

"There,"  said  the  admirers  of  Jovian  existence,  "you 
have  something  suited  to  people  of  regular  habits.  They 
will  be  delighted  to  submit  to  such  regularity." 

That  is  what  would  happen  to  the  Earth  if  Barbicane 
did  what  he  promised,  only  as  the  new  axis  would  make 
no  difference  in  the  time  of  rotation,  twenty-four  hours 
would  still  separate  the  successive  noons,  and  our  spheroid 
would  be  blessed  with  nights  and  days  each  twelve  hours 
long,  and  we  would  live  in  a  perpetual  equinox. 

"But  the  climatal  phenomena  would  be  much  more  curi- 
ous; and  no  less  interesting,"  said  the  enthusiasts,  "would 
be  the  absence  of  the  seasons." 

Owing  to  the  inclination  of  the  axis  to  the  plane  of  the 
orbit,  we  have  the  annual  changes  known  as  spring,  sum- 
mer, autumn,  and  winter.  The  Jovians  could  know  noth- 
ing of  these  things,  and  the  Terrestrians  would  know 
them  no  more.  The  moment  the  new  axis  became  perpen- 
dicular to  the  ecliptic  there  would  be  neither  frigid  zones 
nor  torrid  zones,  but  the  whole  Earth  would  rejoice  in  a 
temperate  climate. 
Why  was  this? 

What  is  the  Torrid  zone?  It  is  that  part  of  the  Earth 
comprised  between  the  Tropics  of  Cancer  and  Capricorn. 
Every  place  within  this  zone  has  the  Sun  in  the  zenith 
twice  a  year. 

What  are  the  Temperate  zones?  The  part  comprised 
between  the  Tropics  and  the  Polar  circles;  between  23°  28' 
and  66°  32'  of  latitude,  and  in  which  the  Sun  never  rises 
to  the  zenith,  but  is  above  the  horizon  on  every  day  in 
the  year. 

What  are  the  Frigid  zones?  That  part  of  the  circum- 
polar  regions  in  which  the  Sun  does  not  rise  above  the 
horizon  on  every  day  in  the  year;  while  at  the  Pole  itself 
he  does  not  rise  for  six  months  at  a  time. 

The  height  of  the  Sun  above  the  horizon  is  the  cause  of 
the  excessive  heat  of  the  Torrid  zone,  the  moderate  heat 
of  the  Temperate  zone,  and  the  excessive  cold  within  the 
Polar  circles. 

When  the  axis  became  perpendicular  these  things  would 
be  different.  The  Sun  would  remain  on  the  plane  of  the 
Equator.  All  the  year  around  he  would  pursue  his  imper- 
turbable twelve-hour  course,  and  rise  to  a  distance  from  the 


LIKE  JUPITER  361 

zenith  according  to  the  latitude  of  the  place.  In  countries 
of  twenty  degrees  of  latitude  he  would  rise  seventy  degrees 
above  the  horizon;  in  countries  of  forty-nine  degrees  of 
latitude  he  would  rise  forty-one;  in  places  of  eighty- four 
degrees  he  would  rise  six,  and  of  ninety  degrees  (the 
Pole),  he  would  just  peep  half  his  diameter  above  the 
horizon.  The  days  would  be  perfectly  regular,  and  the 
Sun  would  rise  at  the  same  time,  and  also  at  the  same 
point  on  the  horizon,  throughout  the  year. 

"Look  at  the  advantages!"  said  the  friends  of  Barbi- 
cane.  "Every  man,  according  to  his  temperament,  can 
choose  his  own  climate,  which  will  be  invariable !" 

Those  modern  Titans,  the  North  Polar  Practical  Asso- 
ciation, were  going  to  effect  a  complete  change  in  the 
state  of  things  which  had  existed  ever  since  the  spheroid 
had  been  launched  on  its  orbit  to  become  the  Earth  as  we 
know  it. 

The  astronomer  might  lose  a  few  of  the  familiar  constel- 
lations; the  poet  might  lose  the  long  winter  nights  and 
the  long  summer  days  that  figure  so  frequently  in  modern 
verse;  but  what  of  that  when  we  think  of  the  advantages 
that  would  be  enjoyed  by  the  majority  of  the  human  race? 

As  the  newspapers  in  the  Barbicane  interest  pointed  out, 
the  products  of  the  Earth  being  reduced  to  regularity,  the 
farmer  could  always  plant  and  sow  in  the  most  favorable 
temperature. 

"Be  it  so!"  said  the  opposition.  "But  are  we  to  have 
no  rains,  or  hail,  or  storms,  or  waterspouts,  or  other  odds 
and  ends  that  make  matters  pleasant  for  the  depressed 
agriculturist  ?" 

"You  may  have  them,  of  course,"  said  the  Barbicanians, 
"but  they  will  probably  be  rarer,  owing  to  the  regularity 
of  the  climate  having  its  effect  on  the  troubles  of  the 
atmosphere!  Yes,  humanity  will  profit  greatly  by  the 
new  state  of  things.  It  will  be  quite  a  transformation  of 
the  terrestrial  globe.  Barbicane  &  Co.  will  have  con- 
ferred much  good  on  the  present  and  future  generations 
by  destroying  the  inequality  of  the  days  and  nights  and 
the  irritating  diversity  of  the  seasons!" 

And  the  Nwv  York  Sun  of  the  27th  of  December  con- 
cluded one  of  its  most  eloquent  articles: — 


362    PURCHASE  OF  THE  NORTH  POLE 

"Honor  to  Impey  Barbicane  and  his  colleagues!  Not 
only  will  they  have  made  the  Earth  more  hygienically 
habitable,  but  they  will  have  made  it  more  productive;  for 
then  we  can  sow  as  soon  as  we  have  harvested,  for  no  time 
will  be  wasted  over  the  winter.  Not  only  will  our  coal 
supplies  be  increased  by  the  new  fields,  which  will  insure 
a  supply  for  many  long  years,  but  the  climatal  conditions 
will  be  altered  to  our  great  advantage!  Honor,  then,  to 
Barbicane  &  Co.,  who  will  take  the  first  rank  among  the 
benefactors  of  mankind!" 


CHAPTER  IX 

SULPHURIC  ALCIDE 

SUCH  were  the  advantages  promised  by  Barbicane's 
changing  the  axis  of  rotation — a  change,  however,  which 
would  only  slightly  affect  the  movement  of  our  spheroid 
around  the  Sun.  The  Earth  would  continue  to  describe 
its  orbit  through  space,  and  the  conditions  of  the  solar  year 
would  remain  the  same. 

When  the  consequences  of  the  change  of  axis  were 
brought  to  the  knowledge  of  the  world,  they  caused  ex- 
traordinary excitement.  At  first  this  problem  of  the  higher 
mechanics  received  an  enthusiastic  welcome.  The  idea  of 
having  seasons  of  constant  equality,  and,  according  to  the 
latitude,  "to  suit  consumers,"  was  very  attractive.  The 
crowd  reveled  in  the  thought  that  they  could  enjoy  the 
perpetual  spring  which  the  bard  of  Telemachus  accorded 
to  the  Island  of  Calypso,  and  that  they  could  have  the 
spring  either  fresh  or  mild.  Where  the  new  axis  was  to 
be  seemed  to  be  the  secret  of  Barbicane,  Nicholl,  and 
J.  T.  Maston,  which  they  were  in  no  hurry  to  present  to 
the  public.  Would  they  reveal  it  in  advance,  or  would  it 
be  known  after  the  experiment?  It  would  be  as  well  to 
say  so,  perhaps,  as  opinion  began  to  show  signs  of  anxiety 
in  the  matter. 

One  observation  occurred  naturally  to  the  mind,  and 
was  at  once  commented  on  in  the  newspapers.  By  what 
mechanical  means  was  the  change  to  be  produced,  which 
evidently  required  the  employment  of  an  enormous  force? 

The  Forum,  an  important  New  York  review,  very  justly 


SULPHURIC  ALCIDE  363 

remarked:  "If  the  Earth  did  not  turn  on  its  axis,  it  is 
probable  that  a  relatively  feeble  shock  would  suffice  to 
give  a  movement  of  rotation  around  an  axis  arbitrarily 
chosen ;  but  the  Earth  is  like  an  enormous  gyroscope  mov- 
ing at  high  velocity,  and  it  is  a  natural  law  that  such  an 
apparatus  has  a  tendency  to  turn  around  the  same  axis, 
as  Foucault  demonstrated  in  his  well-known  experiments. 
It  will  therefore  be  very  difficult,  if  not  impossible,  to 
shift  it." 

But  after  asking  what  would  be  the  effort  required  by 
the  engineers  of  the  North  Polar  Practical  Association,  it 
was  at  least  as  interesting  to  know  if  the  effort  was  to  be 
suddenly  or  insensibly  applied.  And  if  it  was  to  be  a 
sudden  effort,  would  not  the  proceedings  of  Messrs.  Barbi- 
cane  &  Co.  produce  some  rather  alarming  catastrophes  on 
the  face  of  the  Earth? 

Here  was  something  to  occupy  the  brains  of  the  wise 
and  foolish.  A  shock  is  a  shock,  and  it  is  never  agreeable 
to  receive  the  blow  or  the  counter-blow.  There  was  a 
likelihood  that  the  promoters  of  the  enterprise  had  been 
so  busy  with  the  advantages  the  world  was  to  possess  that 
they  had  overlooked  the  destruction  the  operation  would 
entail.  And  with  considerable  cleverness  the  Major  and 
his  allies  made  the  most  of  this,  and  began  to  agitate 
public  opinion  against  the  president  of  the  Gun  Club. 

Although  France  had  taken  no  part  in  the  syndicating, 
and  officially  treated  the  matter  with  disdain,  yet  there 
was  in  that  country  an  individual  who  conceived  the  idea 
of  setting  out  for  Baltimore,  to  follow,  for  his  own  private 
satisfaction,  the  different  phases  of  the  enterprise. 

He  was  a  mining  engineer  of  about  five  and  thirty  years 
of  age.  He  had  been  the  first  on  the  list  when  admitted 
to  the  Polytechnic  School,  and  he  had  been  the  first  on 
the  list  when  he  left  it,  so  that  he  must  have  been  a  mathe- 
matician of  the  first  order,  and  probably  superior  to  J.  T. 
Maston,  who,  though  he  was  a  long  way  above  the  aver- 
age, was  only  a  calculator  after  all — that  is  to  say,  what 
Leverrier  was  compared  to  Newton  or  Laplace. 

This  engineer  was  a  man  of  brains,  and — though  he  was 
none  the  worse  for  that — somewhat  of  a  humorist,  and 
an  original.  In  conversation  with  his  intimates,  even  when 
he  talked  science,  his  language  was  more  that  of  the  slang 


364    PURCHASE  OF  THE  NORTH  POLE 

of  the  streets  than  of  the  academical  formulae  he  employed 
when  he  wrote.  He  was  a  wonderful  worker,  being  ac- 
customed to  sit  for  ten  hours  at  a  stretch  before  his  table, 
writing  pages  on  pages  of  algebra  with  as  much  ease  as 
he  would  have  written  a  letter. 

This  singular  man  was  called  Pierdeux  (Alcide),  and  in 
his  way  of  condensing  it — as  is  the  custom  of  his  comrades 
— he  generally  signed  himself  7Pierd,  or  even  TPi,  with- 
out even  dotting  the  i.  He  was  so  perfervid  in  his  dis- 
cussions that  he  had  been  named  Sulphuric  Alcide.  Not 
only  was  he  big,  but  he  was  tall.  His  friends  affirmed  that 
his  height  was  exactly  the  five  millionth  part  of  a  quarter 
of  the  meridian,  and  they  were  not  far  out.  Although  his 
head  was  rather  too  small  for  his  powerful  bust  and 
shoulders,  yet  he  held  it  well,  and  piercing  were  the  eyes 
that  looked  through  his  pince-nez.  He  was  chiefly  dis- 
tinguished by  one  of  those  physiognomies  in  which  gaiety 
and  gravity  intermingle,  and  his  hair  had  been  prema- 
turely thinned  by  the  abuse  of  algebraic  signs  under  the 
light  of  the  gas-lamps  in  the  study. 

He  was  one  of  the  best  fellows  whose  memory  lingers 
at  the  school.  Although  his  character  was  independent 
enough,  he  was  always  loyal  to  the  requirements  of  Code 
X,  which  is  law  among  the  Polytechnicians  in  all  that 
concerns  comradeship  and  respect  for  the  uniform.  He 
was  equally  appreciated  under  the  trees  of  the  court  of 
"Acas,"  so  named  because  there  are  no  acacias,  as  in  the 
"casers,"  the  dormitories,  in  which  the  arrangements  of 
his  box,  and  the  order  that  reigned  in  his  "coffin,"  denoted 
an  absolutely  methodical  mind. 

That  the  head  of  Alcide  Pierdeux  was  a  little  too  small 
for  his  body  we  admit,  but  that  it  was  filled  to  the  me- 
ninges  will  be  believed.  Above  all  things,  he  was  a  mathe- 
matician like  all  his  comrades  are,  or  have  been,  but  he 
only  used  his  mathematics  in  application  to  experimental 
science,  whose  chief  attraction  to  him  was  that  it  had  much 
to  do  with  industry.  Herein  he  recognized  the  inferior 
side  of  his  nature.  No  one  is  perfect.  His  strong  point 
was  the  study  of  those  sciences  which,  notwithstanding 
their  immense  progress,  have,  and  always  will  have,  secrets 
for  their  followers. 

Alcide  was  still  a  bachelor.     He  was  still  "equal  to 


SULPHURIC  ALCIDE  365 

one,"  as  he  phrased  it,  although  he  had  no  objection  to 
become  "the  half  of  two."  His  friends  had  had  ideas  of 
marrying  him  to  a  very  charming  girl  at  Martigues.  But, 
unfortunately,  she  had  a  father,  who  responded  to  the  first 
overtures  in  the  following  "martigalade" :  "No,  your 
Alcide  is  too  clever!  He  talks  to  my  poor  girl  in  a  way 
that  is  unintelligible  to  her!" 

And  hence  Alcide  resolved  to  take  a  year's  holiday,  and 
thought  he  could  not  employ  his  time  better  than  in  fol- 
lowing the  North  Polar  Practical  Association  in  its  pe- 
culiar undertaking. 

As  soon  as  he  arrived  at  Baltimore  he  began  to  think 
over  the  matter  seriously.  That  the  Earth  would  become 
Jovian  by  the  change  of  its  axis  mattered  very  little  to 
him.  But  by  what  means  it  was  to  be  brought  about  ex- 
cited his  curiosity,  and  not  without  reason.' 

In  his  picturesque  language  he  said  to  himself,  "Evi- 
dently Barbicane  is  going  to  give  our  ball  a  terrible  knock ; 
but  what  sort  of  a  knock?  Everything  depends  on  that! 
I  suppose  he  is  going  to  play  for  'side/  as  if  with  a  cue 
at  a  billiard-ball;  but  if  he  hits  us  'square'  he  may  jolt 
us  out  of  our  orbit,  and  then  the  years  will  dance  to  a 
pretty  tune.  They  are  going  to  shift  the  old  axis  for  a 
new  one,  probably  above  it,  but  I  do  not  see  where  they 
are  to  get  their  taking-off  place  from,  or  how  they  are  to 
manage  the  knock.  If  there  was  no  rotation,  a  mere  flip 
would  suffice,  but  they  can't  put  down  that  diurnal  spin. 
That  is  the  canisdentum." 

He  meant  "the  rub,"  but  that  was  his  way  of  expressing 
himself. 

"Whatever  they  do,"  he  continued,  "there  will  be  no 
end  of  a  row  before  it  is  over." 

Try  all  he  could,  the  engineer  could  not  discover  Barbi- 
cane's  plan,  which  for  one  reason  was  much  to  be  re- 
gretted, as  if  it  had  been  known  to  him  he  would  at  once 
have  made  the  calculations  he  needed. 

But  all  at  present  was  a  mystery.  And  so  it  happened 
that  on  the  29th  of  December  Alcide  Pierdeux,  "Inge- 
nieur  au  Corps  National  des  Mines  de  France,"  was  hurry- 
ing with  lengthy  strides  through  the  crowded  streets  of 
Baltimore. 


366    PURCHASE  OF  THE  NORTH  POLE 


CHAPTER  X 

A  CHANGE  IN  PUBLIC  OPINION 

A  MONTH  had  elapsed  since  the  meeting  in  the  rooms  of 
the  Gun  Club,  and  a  change  had  taken  place  in  public 
opinion. 

The  advantages  of  altering  the  axis  of  rotation  were 
being  forgotten;  and  the  disadvantages  were  being  en- 
larged upon.  It  was  impossible  that  a  catastrophe  could 
be  avoided,  for  any  change  must  necessarily  be  occasioned 
by  a  violent  shock.  What  the  catastrophe  would  be  no 
one  could  say.  Was  this  amelioration  of  climate  desir- 
able? Who  would  gain  by  it  except  the  Eskimos,  Laps, 
and  Samoyeds,  who  had  nothing  to  lose? 

The  Major  and  his  allies  were  indefatigable  in  their 
prophecies  of  evil. 

"It  is  evident/'  said  Karkof,  "that  the  projectors  will 
do  all  they  can  to  protect  the  United  States  from  the 
consequences  of  the  shock." 

"But  can  they?"  asked  Harald.  "When  you  shake  a 
tree  all  the  branches  shake." 

"And,"  said  the  Dutchman,  "when  you  are  hit  in  the 
stomach  does  not  your  v/hole  body  shake?" 

"That  is  what  that  famous  clause  meant!"  said  Todrin. 
"Here  are  the  geographical  and  meteorological  modifica- 
tions!" 

"Yes,"  said  Baldenak.  "But  suppose  the  change  of 
axis  throws  the  seas  out  of  their  existing  basins?" 

"And  if  the  ocean  level  is  lowered  at  different  points," 
said  Jansen,  "some  people  may  find  themselves  so  high 
up  in  the  world  that  communication  with  them  will  be 
impossible !" 

"If  they  go  up  too  high  they  will  not  be  able  to 
breathe!"  said  Harald. 

"Would  you  like  to  see  Baltimore  as  high  as  Mont 
Blanc?"  asked  Donellan. 

This  modification  of  the  axis  was  evidently  a  public 
danger.  A  change  of  23°  28'  would  produce  a  consider- 
able displacement  in  the  seas,  owing  to  the  flattening  at 
the  Poles.  The  Earth  was  thus  threatened  with  similar 


A  CHANGE  IN  PUBLIC  OPINION  367 

disasters  to  those  that,  it  is  believed,  have  recently  oc- 
curred in  Mars.  There  entire  continents,  among  others 
Libya  and  Schiaparelli,  have  been  submerged,  as  shown 
by  the  faint  blue  replacing  the  faint  red.  Lake  Moeris 
has  disappeared.  North  and  south  there  have  been  changes, 
and  the  oceans  have  withdrawn  from  many  localities  they 
formerly  occupied.  If  a  few  charitable  souls  have  been 
much  affected  at  the  "floods  in  Mars" — almost  as  much 
as  to  open  subscriptions  for  the  sufferers — what  would 
they  do  for  the  floods  on  the  Earth? 

Protests  came  in  by  every  post.  The  United  States 
Government  was  urged  to  interfere. 

"Look  at  these  Yankees,"  said  one.  "They  want  to 
hang  the  globe  on  another  axletree!  As  if  the  old  one, 
after  all  these  centuries,  had  worn  out!  But  is  it  not  as 
sound  as  it  was  at  the  beginning?" 

And  there  was  Sulphuric  Alcide  at  work  trying  to  find 
out  the  nature  and  direction  of  the  shock  that  J.  T. 
Maston  had  arranged.  Once  master  of  the  secret,  he 
would  very  soon  know  what  parts  of  the  Earth  were  in 
danger. 

It  was  not  likely  that  the  United  States  would  suffer. 
Barbicane  &  Co.  were  quite  Yankees  enough  to  take  care 
of  their  own  country.  Evidently  the  new  Continent  be- 
tween the  Arctic  Sea  and  the  Gulf  of  Mexico  had  nothing 
to  fear.  It  was  even  possible  that  North  America  would 
gain  a  considerable  accession  of  territory. 

"That  may  be,"  said  the  nervous  people  who  only  saw 
the  perilous  side  of  things.  "But  are  you  sure?  Sup- 
posing J.  T.  Maston  has  made  a  mistake?  Supposing 
Barbicane  makes  a  mistake  when  he  puts  Maston's  theory 
in  practice?  Such  a  thing  can  happen  to  the  cleverest 
artillerists!  They  do  not  always  score  a  bull's-eye!" 

These  fears  were  sedulously  worked  upon  by  the  Major 
and  the  opposition.  Todrin  published  a  number  of  articles 
in  a  leading  Canadian  newspaper.  Harald  rushed  into 
print  in  a  Swedish  journal.  Colonel  Boris  Karkof  tried 
his  hand  in  a  Russian  one.  The  Americans  began  to  take 
sides.  The  New  York  Tribune  and  the  Boston  Journal 
took  up  their  parable  against  Barbicane.  In  vain  the 
North  Polar  Practical  Association  tried  to  stem  the  rising 
tide.  In  vain  Mrs.  Scorbitt  paid  ten  dollars  a  line  for 


368    PURCHASE  OF  THE  NORTH  POLE 

serious  articles,  humorous  articles,  and  smart,  scathing 
paragraphs  treating  the  dangers  as  chimerical.  In  vain 
the  enthusiastic  widow  endeavored  to  show  that  if  ever 
hypothesis  was  unjustifiable,  it  was  that  which  assumed 
that  J.  T.  Maston  was  capable  of  an  error! 

Neither  Barbicane  nor  his  co-directors  took  the  trouble 
to  say  anything.  They  let  the  talk  go  on  without  making 
any  change  in  their  habits.  They  seemed  to  be  thoroughly 
absorbed  in  the  immense  preparations  necessitated  by  their 
undertaking.  The  revulsion  of  public  opinion  seemed  to 
concern  them  not  in  the  least. 

But  in  spite  of  all  Mrs.  Scorbitt  could  do,  it  soon  came 
about  that  Impey  Barbicane,  Captain  Nicholl,  and  J.  T. 
Maston  began  to  be  looked  upon  as  dangers  to  society. 
So  high  grew  the  clamor  that  the  Federal  Government 
had  to  interfere,  and  call  upon  them  to  declare  their  in- 
tentions. What  were  their  means  of  action?  How  did 
they  intend  to  substitute  one  axis  for  another?  What 
would  be  the  consequences  of  the  substitution?  What 
parts  of  the  globe  would  the  substitution  endanger? 

The  excitement  raging  in  every  State  in  the  Union  al- 
lowed of  no  hesitation  on  the  part  of  the  Washington 
Government.  A  Commission  of  Inquiry,  composed  of 
engineers,  mathematicians,  hydrographers,  and  geogra- 
phers, to  the  number  of  fifty,  presided  over  by  the  cele- 
brated John  Prestice,  was  appointed  on  the  iQth  of 
February,  with  full  powers  to  investigate  the  affair,  and 
put  a  stop  to  it  if  necessary. 

Impey  Barbicane  was  requested  to  attend  before  the 
Commission.  Barbicane  did  not  come. 

The  police  went  to  look  for  him  at  his  residence,  95 
Cleveland  Street,  Baltimore.  Barbicane  was  there  no 
longer. 

Where  was  he?     They  did  not  know. 

When  had  he  gone  away  ?  Five  weeks  ago,  on  the  I  ith 
of  January,  he  had  left  Maryland  in  company  with  Captain 
Nicholl. 

Where  had  they  gone?    No  one  could  say. 

Evidently  the  two  members  of  the  Gun  Club  were  on 
their  way  to  the  mysterious  region  where  preparations 
would  begin  under  their  direction. 

But  where  could  that  be  ? 


A  CHANGE  IN  PUBLIC  OPINION          36$ 

It  Was  important  to  know,  if  the  scheme  of  these  dan- 
gerous projectors  was  to  be  nipped  in  the  bud. 

The  effect  of  this  departure  of  Barbicane  and  Nicholl 
was  immense.  The  popular  wrath  rose  like  the  rising  of 
the  equinoctial  tide  against  the  North  Polar  Practical 
Association. 

But  there  was  one  man  who  ought  to  know  what  had 
become  of  Barbicane  and  his  colleague.  There  was  one 
who  ought  to  be  able  to  reply,  and  instantly,  J.  T.  Maston ! 

J.  T.  Maston  was  requested  to  appear  before  the  Com- 
mission. He  did  not  go! 

Had  he  then  left  Baltimore?  Had  he  gone  with  his 
colleagues,  to  help  in  the  work  of  which  the  world  awaited 
the  results  with  such  very  natural  alarm? 

No!  J.  T.  Maston  was  still  to  be  found  at  Ballistic 
Cottage.  He  was  still  incessantly  at  work,  but  now  on 
other  calculations,  which  he  only  left  to  spend  an  occa- 
sional evening  with  Mrs.  Scorbitt  at  New  Park. 

A  policeman  was  sent  with  an  order  from  the  president 
of  the  Commission.  The  policeman  reached  the  cottage, 
knocked  at  the  door,  entered  the  hall,  and  had  a  warm 
reception  from  Fire-Fire  and  a  cool  one  from  J.  T.  Mas- 
ton. 

However,  the  secretary  of  the  Gun  Club  thought  it  as 
well  to  go  quietly,  and  he  appeared  before  the  Commission 
complaining  bitterly  of  having  been  interrupted  in  his 
occupation. 

The  first  question  put  to  him  was,  "Do  you  know  the 
whereabouts  of  Impey  Barbicane  and  Captain  Nicholl?" 

"I  do,"  said  J.  T.  Maston,  "but  I  am  not  authorized  to 
tell  you." 

Second  question:  "Are  these  two  men  occupied  in  the 
preparations  for  their  intended  modification  of  the  terres- 
trial axis?" 

"That,"  said  J.  T.  Maston,  "is  part  of  the  secret  with 
which  I  am  entrusted,  and  I  refuse  to  say." 

Would  he  submit  his  calculations  to  the  Commission, 
that  they  might  judge  if  the  project  of  the  Association 
could  be  accomplished? 

"No,  certainly  not!"  said  J.  T.  Maston.  "It  is  my 
right  as  a  free  American  citizen  to  keep  from  anybody 
the  result  of  my  work!" 

Vol.  13  Verne 


370        PURCHASE  OF  THE  NORTH  POLE 

"But  if  that  is  your  right,  Mr.  Maston,"  said  President 
Prestice  solemnly,  as  if  he  spoke  in  the  name  of  the  entire 
world,  "it  may  be  your  duty  to  speak  in  face  of  the 
anxiety  that  exists." 

J.  T.  Maston  did  not  think  it  was  his  duty.  He  had 
only  one  duty — to  keep  silent;  and  he  would  keep  silent. 

In  spite  of  their  persistence,  their  supplications,  their 
threats,  the  members  of  the  Commission  of  Inquiry  could 
get  nothing  out  of  the  man  with  the  iron  hook.  Never 
would  they  have  believed  that  so  much  obstinacy  lurked 
within  a  gutta-percha  cranium!  J.  T.  Maston  left  as  he 
had  arrived,  and  that  he  was  congratulated  on  his  valiant 
defense  by  Mrs.  Scorbitt  we  need  hardly  say. 

When  the  result  of  J.  T.  Maston's  appearance  was 
made  known,  public  opinion  took  a  form  that  was  really 
serious  for  his  safety.  The  pressure  on  the  Government 
became  so  great  that  Secretary  John  S.  Wright  had  to 
obtain  permission  from  the  President  to  act  manu  militari. 

On  the  evening  of  the  I3th  of  March,  J.  T.  Maston  was 
in  his  workroom  at  Ballistic  Cottage,  absorbed  in  his 
algebra,  when  the  bell  of  the  telephone  tinkled  nervously. 

"Hallo,  there!  Hallo,  there!"  murmured  the  instru- 
ment in  a  way  that  showed  great  anxiety. 

"Who's  there?"  asked  J.  T.  Maston. 

"Mrs.  Scorbitt." 

"What  is  it?" 

"Be  on  your  guard!  I  have  just  heard  that  this  very 
night—" 

The  sentence  had  not  been  finished  when  the  door  of 
Ballistic  Cottage  was  burst  open  by  a  push  from  several 
shoulders,  and  up  the  staircase  came  an  extraordinary 
tumult.  There  was  a  voice  protesting;  then  other  voices 
silencing  it;  then  a  bump  as  of  a  fallen  body — bump, 
bump — it  was  the  negro,  Fire-Fire,  rolling  downstairs 
after  an  unavailing  defense  of  his  master's  home — bump, 
bump;  the  door  of  the  workroom  flew  open;  policemen 
rushed  in;  the  excitable  Maston  seized  a  revolver;  in- 
stantly he  was  disarmed ;  a  policeman  laid  his  hand  on  the 
papers  on  the  desk;  Maston  slipped  free  and  dashed  at  a 
note-book;  the  police  were  after  him;  before  they  could 
reach  him  he  had  torn  out  the  last  leaf,  clapped  it  to  his 
mouth,  and  gulped  it  down  as  if  it  had  been  a  pill! 


THE  CONTENTS  OF  THE  NOTE-BOOK    371 

"Now!"  said  he  in  the  tone  of  a  Leonidas  at  Ther- 
mopylae, "Now  you  can  do  your  duty." 

An  hour  afterward  he  was  in  the  jail  at  Baltimore. 

And  that  was  probably  the  best  thing  that  could  have 
happened  to  him,  for  the  populace  were  in  such  a  state  of 
excitement  that  the  police  might  have  found  themselves 
powerless  to  protect  him. 


CHAPTER  XI 

THE   CONTENTS   OF   THE   NOTE-BOOK 

THE  book  seized  by  the  Baltimore  police  contained  thirty 
pages,  sprinkled  with  formulae,  multiplications,  equations, 
and  finally  the  general  results  of  J.  T.  Maston's  calcula- 
tion. It  was  a  work  of  the  higher  mechanics,  appreciable 
only  by  mathematicians.  One  of  the  equations  was  the — 


V2  — V2 


.*<-    ) 

V         r./ 


of  which  we  heard  in  the  Moon  Voyage. 

The  "general  reader"  could  make  neither  head  nor  tail 
of  Maston's  performances;  but  they  could  understand  the 
results  as  told  to  the  newspapers  a  few  days  later. 

There  was  nothing  wrong  with  J.  T.  Maston's  working, 
the  Commission  reported.  The  calculations  had  been  made 
with  such  precision  that  the  Commission  had  no  doubt  as 
to  their  accuracy  and  consequences.  If  the  operation  was 
effected,  the  terrestrial  axis  would  be  undoubtedly  changed, 
and  then  the  catastrophes  foreseen  would  be  accomplished 
in  all  their  plentitude. 

"The  object,"  said  the  official  communication  to  the  news- 
papers, "of  the  directorate  of  the  North  Polar  Practical 
Association  is  the  substitution  of  a  new  axis  of  rotation 
for  the  old  one;  and  it  is  proposed  to  attain  this  object  by 
means  of  the  recoil  of  an  apparatus  fixed  in  some  agreed 
point  of  the  Earth's  circumference.  If  the  core  of  this 
apparatus  is  firmly  fixed  in  the  ground,  there  can  be  no 
doubt  but  that  it  would  communicate  its  recoil  to  the  mass 
of  our  planet. 

"The  apparatus  adopted  by  the  Association  is  a  monster 
cannon,  which  would  have  no  effect  if  discharged  vertically. 


372    PURCHASE  OF  THE  NORTH  POLE 

To  produce  the  maximum  effect  it  must  be  aimed  hori- 
zontally toward  the  north  or  south,  and  it  is  this  latter 
direction  which  has  been  decided  on  by  the  Association. 
In  this  way  the  recoil  will  produce  a  shock  toward  the 
north  of  the  nature  of  that  given  to  a  billiard-ball  when 
struck  on  the  side." 

Exactly  as  Alcide  had  foreseen! 

"As  soon  as  the  explosion  takes  place,  the  center  of  the 
Earth  will  be  displaced  in  a  direction  parallel  to  that  of 
the  impetus,  and  a  change  will  ensue  in  the  plane  of  the 
orbit,  and  consequently  in  the  length  of  the  year;  but  this 
will  be  so  slight  as  to  be  of  no  appreciable  amount.  At 
the  same  time  the  Earth  would  take  a  movement  of  rota- 
tion around  an  axis,  supposing  that  no  rotation  existed 
previous  to  the  shock.  But  as  the  rotation  in  the  line  of 
the  Poles  already  exists,  it  will  combine  with  the  accessory 
rotation  produced  by  the  recoil,  and  result  in  a  new  axis. 
If  the  gun  is  fired  at  the  moment  when  the  Equator  and 
the  Ecliptic  are  in  intersection,  and  if  the  recoil  is  enough 
to  displace  the  Pole  23°  28',  then  the  new  axis  will  become 
perpendicular  to  the  plane  of  the  orbit. 

"The  consequences  of  this  perpendicularity  were  clearly 
stated  by  Impey  Barbicane  at  the  meeting  on  the  22nd  of 
December. 

"Given  the  mass  of  the  Earth  and  the  amount  of  move- 
ment it  possesses,  can  a  gun  be  produced  having  a  recoil 
sufficient  to  produce  such  a  displacement  of  the  Pole  as 
23°  28'? 

"Undoubtedly;  if  a  gun,  or  series  of  guns,  be  constructed 
in  accordance  with  the  laws  of  mechanics,  or  if  the  in- 
ventors possess  an  explosive  of  the  necessary  power.  Such 
an  explosive  they  unfortunately  possess.  It  was  discov- 
ered by  Captain  Nicholl.  Its  name  is  meli-melonite,  but 
all  that  is  known  of  it  is  that  it  is  a  mixture  of  organic 
substances  with  nitric  acid.  A  certain  number  of  mona- 
tomic  radicles  are  substituted  for  the  same  number  of 
atoms  of  hydrogen,  and  a  powder  is  obtained,  which,  like 
fulmi-cotton,  is  formed  by  combination,  not  by  mechanical 
mixture  of  the  principal  comburents  and  combustibles. 

"Whatever  this  explosive  may  be,  the  force  it  possesses 
is  sufficient  to  carry  a  projectile  weighing  180,000  tons 
beyond  the  terrestrial  attraction,  and  it  is  hoped  by  the 


THE  CONTENTS  OF  THE  NOTE-BOOK    373 

Association  that  the  recoil  will  have  the  effect  of  displacing 
the  Pole,  and  forming  a  new  axis  perpendicular  to  the 
plane  of  the  ecliptic.  From  which  would  result  the  catas- 
trophes which  have  alarmed  the  inhabitants  of  the  Earth. 

'There  is  a  chance  that  humanity  may  yet  escape  the 
consequences  of  an  operation  which  would  bring  about 
such  regrettable  geographical  and  meteorological  changes 
in  the  surface  of  the  globe.  Is  it  possible  to  construct  a 
cannon  of  the  dimensions  required?  We  are  of  opinion 
that  it  is  very  doubtful  if  it  can  be  done. 

"It  is  well  known  that  the  two  chief  directors  of  the 
North  Polar  Practical  Association  have  left  Baltimore  and 
America,  probably  for  the  purpose  of  attempting  the  manu- 
facture of  this  cannon  in  some  distant  part  of  the  world. 

"Where  they  have  gone  to  is  unknown,  and  consequently 
it  is  impossible  to  secure  the  malefactors  who  would  upset 
the  world  under  pretense  of  opening  up  new  coal-fields. 

"Evidently  the  place  was  indicated  on  the  last  page  of 
the  note-book  captured  by  the  police  from  J.  T.  Maston. 
But  this  last  page  had  disappeared,  having  been  swallowed 
by  the  said  J.  T.  Maston,  now  in  prison  at  Baltimore. 

"Such  is  the  position.  If  Impey  Barbicane  can  make 
his  cannon  and  his  projectile,  he  will  change  the  earth's 
axis,  and  within  the  next  six  months  the  earth  will  be 
subjected  to  his  reckless  assault. 

"A  date  has  been  chosen  for  the  discharge  of  the  pro- 
jectile, the  date  on  which  the  shock  would  have  its 
maximum  of  effect  on  the  terrestrial  spheroid. 

"This  date  is  the  22nd  of  September,  twelve  hours 
after  the  passage  of  the  Sun  across  the  meridian  of  the 
place  x. 

"This  place  it  is  impossible  from  the  calculations  to 
discover. 

"There  is  nothing  in  J.  T.  Maston's  note-book  to  show 
the  position  of  the  new  axis. 

"It  is  therefore  impossible  to  state  what  territories  or 
seas  will  be  affected  by  the  attempt. 

"The  difference  of  level  will  be  considerable.  After  the 
shock  the  surface  of  the  sea  will  take  the  form  of  an 
ellipsoid  of  revolution,  and  the  level  will  change  nearly 
all  over  the  globe. 

"In  fact  the  intersection  of  the  level  of  the  old  sea  with 


374    PURCHASE  OF  THE  NORTH  POLE 

the  level  of  the  new  sea,  of  two  equal  surfaces  of  revolu- 
tion with  the  axes  intersecting,  will  be  of  two  curved 
planes,  and  the  maxima  of  elevation  or  abasement  will 
exceed  25,000  feet. 

"It  is  worthy  of  remark  that  the  ancient  Pole  will  be 
immersed  under  more  than  9000  feet  of  water,  so  that  the 
district  acquired  by  the  North  Polar  Practical  Association 
will  be  flooded  unless  there  exists  at  the  Pole  a  plateau  of 
more  than  that  number  of  feet  of  elevation. 

"Where  the  maximum  of  alteration  of  land  will  take 
place  is  unknown.  There  is  in  the  equation  an  unknown 
quantity,  which  no  known  formula  can  value.  This  un- 
known is  the  position  of  x,  where  the  shock  is  to  be 
applied.  This  x  is  the  secret  of  the  promoters  of  this 
deplorable  affair. 

"In  conclusion,  it  is  desirable  to  point  out  that  all  the 
inhabitants  of  the  Earth  are  interested  in  unraveling  the 
secret,  for  all  are  menaced  by  the  proceedings  of  the 
Association. 

"Notice  is  therefore  given  to  the  inhabitants  of  all  parts 
of  the  world  to  keep  a  strict  watch  over  all  operations 
regarding  the  founding  of  cannons,  or  the  fabrication  of 
powders  or  projectiles  taking  place  on  their  territories,  and 
to  report  the  appearance  of  any  stranger  connected  there- 
with to  the  Commission  of  Inquiry  at  Baltimore,  U.  S.  A. 

"It  is  urgently  necessary  that  the  information  should 
reach  the  Commission  before  the  22nd  of  September  next, 
the  date  on  which  the  established  order  of  the  terrestrial 
system  h  so  seriously  menaced." 


CHAPTER  XII 

HEROIC  SILENCE 

IT  was  a  cannon  that  hurled  the  projectile  up  to  the 
Moon;  it  was  to  be  a  cannon  that  was  to  change  the 
terrestrial  axis!  The  cannon!  Always  the  cannon!  Bar- 
bicane  and  Co.  evidently  suffered  from  chronic  attacks  of 
aggravated  "cannonism"!  Was  a  cannon  the  ultima  ratio 
of  the  world?  Was  it  to  be  the  brutal  sovereign  of  the 
universe?  The  canon  rules  theology,  was  the  cannon  to 
give  the  law  to  commerce  awd  cosmology? 


HEROIC  SILENCE  375 

A  cannon  was  the  engine  Barbicane  &  Co.  were  to  bring 
into  action.  They  had  not  devoted  their  lives  to  ballistics 
for  nothing.  After  the  Columbiad  of  Tampa  Town  there 
was  to  come  the  monster  cannon  of — of — the  place  xl 
And  already  there  were  people  who  could  hear  the  sonor- 
ous command: 

"No.  i!     Aim  at  the  Moon!     Fire!" 

"No.  2!     Change  the  Earth's  axis!     Fire!" 

And  then  for  the  "general  upset"  predicted  by  Sul- 
phuric Alcide! 

The  publication  of  the  report  of  the  Commission  pro- 
duced an  effect  of  which  it  is  impossible  even  to  give  an 
idea.  There  was  nothing  in  it  of  a  soothing  tendency,  it 
must  be  admitted.  By  J.  T.  Maston's  calculations,  the 
problem  had  evidently  been  solved.  The  operation  to  be 
attempted  by  Barbicane  &  Co.  would,  it  was  only  too  clear, 
introduce  a  most  regrettable  modification  in  the  diurnal 
movement.  A  new  axis  would  be  substituted  for  the  old. 
And  we  know  what  would  be  the  consequences  of  that 
substitution. 

The  enterprise  of  Barbicane  &  Co.  was  thus  judged, 
cursed,  and  demitted  to  general  reprobation.  Barbicane 
&  Co.  were  dangers  to  society.  If  they  retained  a  few 
partisans  in  the  United  States,  they  were  few  indeed. 

From  the  point  of  view  of  their  own  personal  safety, 
Impey  Barbicane  and  Captain  Nicholl  had  certainly  done 
wisely  to  clear  out.  They  would  assuredly  have  come  to 
grief  if  they  had  not  done  so.  It  was  not  with  impunity 
that  they  could  menace  fourteen  hundred  millions  of 
people,  upset  their  habits  and  customs,  and  disturb  their 
very  existence  by  provoking  a  general  catastrophe. 

But  how  had  these  two  men  managed  to  disappear  with- 
out leaving  a  trace?  How  could  they  have  gotten  away 
unperceived  with  the  men  and  material  necessary  for  their 
project?  Hundreds  of  wagons,  if  they  went  by  railway, 
and  hundreds  of  ships,  if  they  went  by  sea,  would  be 
required  for  the  transport  of  the  metal,  the  fuel,  and  the 
meli-melonite.  It  was  quite  incomprehensible  how  the  de- 
parture could  have  taken  place  incognito.  But  it  had 
taken  place  nevertheless. 

Inquiries  were  made,  but  nothing  was  discovered  as  to 
any  order  being  sent  to  any  of  the  metallurgical  or  chem- 


376   PURCHASE  OF  THE  NORTH  POLE 

ical  works  of  the  world.  It  was  inexplicable!  But  the 
explanation  would  come — some  day! 

Barbicane  and  Nicholl  having  mysteriously  disappeared, 
were  beyond  immediate  danger.  But  J.  T.  Maston!  He 
was  under  lock  and  key;  but  were  not  public  reprisals  to 
be  feared?  Bah!  He  did  not  trouble  himself  about  that 
in  the  least!  Admirably  obstinate  was  the  calculator! 
He  was  of  iron — like  his  fore-arm!  At  nothing  did  he 
quail ! 

From  the  depths  of  his  cell  in  the  jail  of  Baltimore  the 
secretary  of  the  Gun  Club  became  more  and  more  absorbed 
in  the  distant  contemplation  of  the  colleagues  he  had  not 
accompanied.  In  his  mind's  eye  he  could  see  Barbicane 
and  Nicholl  preparing  their  gigantic  enterprise  in  that 
unknown  region  where  no  one  could  interfere  with  them. 
He  saw  them  making  the  cannon,  mixing  the  meli-melonite, 
casting  the  projectile  which  the  Sun  would  soon  count 
among  its  minor  asteroids!  That  new  star  which  was  to 
bear  the  name  of  Scorbitta,  as  a  delicate  compliment  to 
the  millionaire  of  New  Park!  J.  T.  Maston  began  to 
count  the  days  that  would  elapse  before  the  word  to  fire 
was  given. 

It  was  the  month  of  April.  In  two  months  and  a  half 
the  Sun  would  halt  at  the  solstice  on  the  Tropic  of  Cancer 
and  retrograde  toward  the  Tropic  of  Capricorn.  Three 
months  later  he  would  cross  the  Equator  at  the  autumnal 
equinox.  And  with  that  would  finish  the  seasons  that  for 
millions  of  ages  had  alternated  with  such  regularity  in 
every  terrestrial  year.  For  the  last  time  the  spheroid  would 
submit  to  the  inequality  of  its  days  and  nights.  For  the 
future  the  number  of  hours  between  sunrise  and  sunset 
would  be  equal  all  over  the  globe. 

In  truth  it  was  a  magnificent  work!  J.  T.  Maston 
forgot  all  about  the  Polar  coal-field  in  contemplating  the 
cosmographical  consequences  of  his  labors.  The  principal 
object  of  the  Association  had  been  forgotten  in  the  trans- 
formations the  face  of  the  earth  would  undergo — not- 
withstanding that  the  earth  did  not  care  about  these 
magnificent  transformations. 

J.  T.  Maston,  alone  and  defenseless  in  his  cell,  resisted 
every  pressure  brought  to  bear  on  him.  The  members  of 
the  Commission  of  Inquiry  visited  him  daily,  and  obtained 


HEROIC  SILENCE  377 

nothing.  It  occurred  at  last  to  John  Prestice  to  make  use 
of  an  influence  that  might  succeed  better  than  his — that 
of  Mrs.  Scorbitt.  No  one  was  ignorant  of  the  lengths 
to  which  the  widow  would  go  when  the  celebrated  calcu- 
lator was  in  peril. 

There  was  a  meeting  of  the  Commission,  and  Mrs. 
Scorbitt  was  authorized  to  visit  the  prisoner  as  often  as 
she  thought  fit.  Was  not  she  threatened  with  the  danger 
from  the  recoil  of  the  monster  cannon  as  much  as  any 
other  of  the  world's  inhabitants?  Would  her  New  Park 
mansion  escape  the  final  catastrophe  any  more  than  the 
wigwam  of  the  poor  Indian  or  the  humble  hut  of  the 
backwoodsman?  Was  not  her  life  as  much  in  danger  as 
that  of  the  obscurest  Samoyed  or  South  Sea  Islander? 
The  president  of  the  Commission  elaborately  explained 
this  to  her,  and  suggested  that  she  should  bring  her 
influence  to  bear  for  the  general  good. 

If  she  could  only  get  J.  T.  Maston  to  state  where  Bar- 
bicane  and  Nicholl  had  gone,  there  would  still  be  time  to 
pursue  them  and  save  humanity  from  the  impending  fate. 

And  so  Mrs.  Scorbitt  had  access  to  the  jail.  What  she 
desired  above  all  was  to  see  J.  T.  Maston,  who  had  been 
torn  by  the  police  from  the  comforts  of  his  cottage.  Let 
it  not  be  supposed  that  the  heroic  Evangelina  was  a  slave 
to  human  weakness.  And  if,  on  the  Qth  of  April,  some 
indiscreet  ear  had  been  applied  to  the  keyhole  the  first 
time  that  the  widow  appeared  in  the  cell,  this  is  what 
would  have  met  it: 

"At  last,  dear  Maston,  I  see  you  again!" 

"You,  Mrs.  Scorbitt!" 

"Yes,  my  friend,  after  four  weeks,  four  long  weeks  of 
separation — " 

"Exactly  twenty-eight  days,  five  hours,  forty-five  min- 
utes," said  Maston,  looking  at  his  watch. 

"At  last  we  meet !" 

"But  why,  Mrs.  Scorbitt?  Why  have  they  allowed  you 
to  come  here?" 

"To  use  whatever  influence  a  boundless  admiration  may 
have  on  him  who  is  its  object!" 

"What!"  exclaimed  J.  T.  Maston,  "you  have  consented 
to  talk  thus  to  me!  You  have  imagined  that  I  would 
betray  my  colleagues?" 


378        PURCHASE  OF  THE  NORTH  POLE 

"Do  you  think  so  meanly  of  me?  I  to  ask  you  to 
sacrifice  your  safety  to  your  honor?  I  to  urge  you  to 
an  act  which  would  be  the  disgrace  of  a  life  consecrated 
to  the  highest  speculations  of  the  higher  mechanics?" 

"Bravo,  Mrs.  Scorbitt!  I  recognize  the  worthy  share- 
holder of  our  Association!  Never  did  I  doubt  your 
courage !" 

"Thank  you,  dear  Maston." 

"As  for  me,  to  divulge  our  work;  to  reveal  at  what  spot 
on  the  surface  of  the  earth  our  effort  is  to  be  made;  to 
sell  the  secret  I  fortunately  kept  hidden  within  me;  to 
permit  these  barbarians  to  launch  off  in  pursuit  of  our 
friends,  to  interrupt  the  labors  they  are  engaged  in  for 
our  profit  and  our  glory!  I  would  rather  die  first!" 

"Maston,  you  are  sublime!"  said  Evangelina. 

In  truth,  these  two  beings,  so  closely  united  in  enthu- 
siasm— and  equally  mad — were  born  to  understand  each 
other. 

"No!"  continued  Maston.  "Never  shall  they  know  the 
name  of  the  country  which  my  calculations  have  desig- 
nated, and  which  will  become  immortal.  They  may  kill 
me  if  they  will,  but  they  shall  never  possess  my  secret." 

"And  they  may  kill  me  with  you,"  said  Mrs.  Scorbitt; 
"for  I  also  will  be  dumb." 

"Fortunately,  they  do  not  know  that  you  possess  the 
secret." 

"Do  you  think  I  am  capable  of  revealing  it  because  I 
am  only  a  woman?  to  betray  our  colleagues  and  you? 
No,  my  friend;  no!  The  Philistines  may  raise  the  world 
against  you  to  tear  you  from  your  cell,  but  I  will  be  with 
you,  and  we  shall  have  at  least  the  consolation  of  dying 
together!" 

And  that  was  the  way  the  conversation  ended  every 
time  the  widow  visited  the  prisoner.  And  every  time  the 
Commissioners  inquired  as  to  the  result  the  answer  was 
the  same. 

"Nothing  yet;  but  in  time  I  hope  to  obtain  what  you 
want!" 

Oh,  the  astuteness  of  woman! 

"In  time!"  she  said.  But  time  marched  on;  weeks 
went  by  like  days,  days  like  hours,  hours  like  minutes. 

It  was  now  May.     Mrs.  Scorbitt  had  obtained  nothing; 


HEROIC  SILENCE  379 

and  if  she  had  failed,  who  could  hope  to  succeed?  Was 
the  world  to  resign  itself  to  this  terrible  blow  without  a 
chance  of  hindering  it? 

Well,  no!  in  such  things  resignation  is  unacceptable. 
Our  friends  the  delegates  were  unceasing  in  fomenting 
the  excitement.  Jansen  overwhelmed  the  Commissioners 
daily.  Karkof  picked  a  quarrel  with  the  secretary.  Do- 
nellan,  to  make  things  worse,  directed  attention  to  another 
victim  in  the  shape  of  the  codfish  merchant,  Forster,  who 
had  sunk  into  insignificance  after  the  auction  sale,  to  bid 
at  which  he  had  been  engaged.  And  in  order  to  bring 
the  phlegmatic  fishmonger  prominently  to  the  front,  the 
Canadian  attempted  to  knock  him  down.  To  complicate 
matters  further,  "the  friendly  Powers"  began  "to  bring 
pressure  to  bear"  on  the  Washington  Government,  which 
had  quite  enough  to  do  to  withstand  the  "pressure"  of  its 
own  people.  In  reply  the  Washington  Government  issued 
a  circular  authorizing  the  arrest  of  the  two  "malefactors" 
by  any  power  whatsoever.  But  none  the  less  did  it 
remain  impossible  to  discover  where  the  malefactors  had 
gone. 

Then  the  Powers  hinted  that  if  J.  T.  Maston  were 
properly  dealt  with,  J.  T.  Maston  would  reveal  the  secret. 
But  the  Government  might  as  well  have  tried  to  extract  a 
word  from  Harpocrates,  the  god  of  silence,  or  from  the 
chief  deaf-mute  of  the  New  York  Institute. 

And  then  the  exasperation  increased  with  the  general 
anxiety,  and  a  few  practical  minds  drew  attention  to  the 
fact  that  the  torture  system  of  the  Middle  Ages  was  not 
without  some  advantages.  So  it  was  proposed  to  intro- 
duce, for  the  benefit  of  J.  T.  Maston,  a  few  experiments 
with  the  "boot,"  the  "scavenger's  daughter,"  "molten 
lead,"  "boiling  oil,"  the  "wooden  horse,"  the  "bastinado," 
etc.,  etc.  But  such  things  were  impossible  in  the  century 
which  invented  the  magazine  rifle,  roburite,  bellite,  pan- 
clastite,  and  other  "ites,"  not  to  mention  the  far  superior 
meli-melonite. 

J.  T.  Maston  had,  then,  no  fear  of  being  put  to  the 
torture.  All  that  could  be  done  with  him  was  to  hope 
that  he  would  speak,  or  that  chance  would  speak  for  him. 


380        PURCHASE  OF.  THE  NORTH  POLE 


CHAPTER  XIII 

A    TRULY    EPIC    REPLY, 

TIME  advanced,  and  so  probably  did  the  works  of  Barbi- 
cane  &  Co.,  but  where,  was  the  mystery. 

But  if  their  works  were  to  require  a  foundry  capable  of 
casting  a  gun  a  million  times  larger  than  a  four-hundred 
pounder,  and  a  projectile  weighing  one  hundred  and  eighty 
thousand  tons,  they  would  want  thousands  of  workmen; 
and  where,  oh!  where  could  they  be? 

In  what  part  of  the  old  or  new  world  had  Barbicane  & 
Co.  installed  themselves  so  secretly  as  to  be  invisible  to 
the  nations  around?  Had  they  gone  to  some  desert  island 
of  the  Pacific?  But  there  are  no  desert  islands  now.  That 
they  had  gone  to  the  Arctic  or  Antarctic  regions  was 
extremely  unlikely,  for  those  were  the  very  regions  they 
intended  to  displace. 

There  was  no  need  to  look  for  them  all  over  the  world, 
for  J.  T.  Maston's  note-book  had  revealed  the  fact  that  the 
shot  must  be  fired  from  near  the  Equator.  Along  the 
equinoctial  line,  they  might  be  in  Brazil  or  Peru,  or 
Sumatra,  or  Borneo,  or  Celebes,  or  New  Guinea,  but 
surely  they  would  have  been  discovered  by  the  people  in 
the  neighborhood?  All  through  Africa,  too,  they  would 
be  almost  certain  of  discovery.  There  remained  the  Mai- 
dive  Islands,  the  Admiralty,  Gilbert,  and  Christmas 
Islands,  the  Galapagos  and  San  Pedro  Islands;  but  all 
these  had  been  searched,  and  no  trace  of  Barbicane  &  Co. 
had  been  found. 

And  what  did  Alcide  Pierdeux  think  of  all  this?  More 
"sulphuric"  than  ever,  he  knew  no  rest  in  considering  the 
different  consequences  of  the  problem.  That  Captain 
Nicholl  had  invented  an  explosive  of  such  power  that  its 
expansion  was  three  or  four  thousand  times  greater  than 
the  most  violent  explosives  used  in  modern  war,  and  five 
thousand  six  hundred  times  stronger  than  "good  old  gun- 
powder," was,  he  remarked,  "etonnant,  not  to  say  deton- 
nant !"  but  it  was  not  impossible.  No  one  knows  what  the 
future  has  in  store  for  us  in  that  kind  of  progress.  In  the 


A  TRULY  EPIC  REPLY  381 

shifting  of  the  Earth's  axis  by  means  of  the  recoil  of  a 
gun  there  was  nothing  to  surprise  him. 

"It  is  evident,"  he  said  to  himself,  "that  every  day  the 
Earth  receives  the  counter-shock  from  every  shock  pro- 
duced on  its  surface!  It  is  certain  that  when  hundreds  of 
thousands  of  men  amuse  themselves  by  sending  thousands 
of  projectiles  weighing  pounds,  or  millions  weighing 
ounces,  even  when  I  walk  or  jump,  or  when  I  stretch  out 
my  arm,  or  when  a  blood  corpuscle  circulates  in  my  veins, 
it  must  in  some  way  influence  the  mass  of  our  spheroid. 
But  in  the  name  of  an  integral  will  Barbicane's  jolt  be 
sufficient  to  upset  the  Earth?  If  the  equations  of  that 
brute  Maston  really  demonstrate  that,  we  must  make  up 
our  minds  to  it!" 

In  truth,  Alcide  could  not  but  admire  the  ingenious 
calculations  of  the  secretary  of  the  Gun  Club,  communi- 
cated by  the  Commission  of  Inquiry  to  the  mathematicians 
who  could  understand  them.  And  Alcide,  who  read  alge- 
bra as  if  it  were  newspaper,  found  the  study  of  them  ex- 
tremely interesting. 

But  if  the  upset  did  come,  what  a  dreadful  state  of  af- 
fairs there  would  be  in  the  world!  What  cities  thrown 
down,  what  mountains  shaken,  what  people  destroyed  by 
millions,  what  waters  hurled  from  their  beds,  what  fearful 
terrors!  It  would  be  such  an  earthquake  as  had  never 
quaked  before! 

"If  Nicholl's  powder,"  he  said,  "was  not  quite  so 
strong,  the  projectile  might  return  to  give  the  Earth  an- 
other shock  either  before  or  behind  the  firing-point,  after 
making  the  turn  of  the  globe,  and  then  everything  might 
soon  be  knocked  back  into  place,  after  causing  immense 
destruction,  nevertheless!  But  they  are  going  to  throw  it 
overboard!  Thanks  to  their  meli-melonite  their  shell  will 
describe  the  half  of  a  hyperbola  and  never  come  back  to 
beg  pardon  for  having  given  that  kick  to  the  terrestrial 
ball!" 

And  Alcide  threw  his  arms  about  like  the  semaphore  at 
Portsmouth  Dockyard,  at  the  risk  of  breaking  everything 
within  a  radius  of  six  feet  of  him. 

"If  the  firing-point  were  known  I  could  soon  find  the 
great  circles  in  which  the  alteration  will  be  zero,  and  the 
places  where  it  will  reach  the  maximum,  so  as  to  give 


382    PURCHASE  OF  THE  NORTH  POLE 

folks  notice  to  clear  out  and  save  themselves  from  being 
smashed  by  their  houses  tumbling  about  their  ears!  But 
how  am  I  to  know  that  firing-point?" 

And  he  ran  his  fingers  through  the  very  little  hair  that 
had  been  left  him. 

"The  results  of  the  shock  may  be  much  more  compli- 
cated than  they  imagine!  Why  should  not  the  volcanoes 
take  the  opportunity  to  favor  us  with  a  few  disorderly 
eruptions,  and,  like  a  first  voyager,  displace  some  of  the 
matter  in  their  insides?  Why  should  not  the  uplifted 
ocean  take  a  header  into  some  of  the  craters?  There's  a 
chance  for  you!  That  would  give  an  explosion  that  might 
send  the  whole  tellurian  box  of  tricks  sky  high,  or  rather 
sky  higher!  What  do  you  say  to  that,  you  'confounded 
Maston?  You  obstinate  mute!  What  do  you  mean  by 
juggling  with  our  poor  Earth  as  if  it  were  a  ball  on  a 
billiard  table?" 

These  alarming  hypotheses  of  Sulphuric  Alcide  were 
taken  up  and  discussed  by  the  newspapers  all  over  the 
world.  The  pyrotechnic  display  organized  by  Barbicane 
&  Co.  would  end  in  waterspouts,  tidal  waves,  deluges, 
would  it?  But  such  catastrophes  would  only  be  partial! 
Thousands  of  people  would  disappear,  and  the  rest  would 
hardly  notice  anything  worth  mentioning!  As  the  fatal 
day  approached,  fear  came  over  the  bravest.  It  might 
have  been  the  dreadful  year  1000  from  the  way  in  which 
the  people  generally  conducted  themselves. 

What  happened  in  that  year  1000  it  may  be  interesting 
to  recall.  Owing  to  a  passage  in  the  Apocalypse,  the 
people  of  Europe  were  persuaded  that  the  Day  of  Judg- 
ment was  nigh.  They  waited  for  the  signs  of  wrath;  the 
son  of  Perdition,  Antichrist,  was  to  be  revealed. 

"In  the  last  year  of  the  tenth  century,"  relates  H. 
Martin,  "everything  was  interrupted — pleasures,  business, 
interest,  even  the  work  in  the  fields.  'Why,'  said  the 
people,  'should  we  provide  for  a  future  that  will  never 
come?  Let  us  think  of  eternity,  which  will  begin  tomor- 
row/ They  provided  only  for  their  immediate  needs;  they 
handed  over  their  lands  and  castles  to  the  monasteries  to 
obtain  their  protection  in  the  kingdom  in  the  skies  which 
was  about  to  come  to  them.  Many  of  the  deeds  of  gift  to 


A  TRULY  EPIC  REPLY  383 

the  churches  begin  with  the  words,  'The  end  of  the  world 
approaching,  and  its  ruin  being  imminent.'  When  the  end 
of  the  fatal  term  arrived  the  people  kept  within  the  ba- 
silicas, the  chapels,  the  edifices  consecrated  to  God,  and 
waited  in  agony  for  the  seven  trumpets  of  the  seven  angels 
of  judgment  to  sound  in  the  sky." 

As  we  know,  New  Year's  Day,  1000,  was  reached  with- 
out any  disturbance  in  the  laws  of  Nature.  But  this  time 
the  expectation  of  the  catastrophe  was  not  based  on  a 
doubtful  interpretation  of  a  text.  It  was  a  change  to  be 
applied  to  the  earth's  equilibrium  based  on  indisputable  cal- 
culations, which  the  progress  of  the  ballistic  and  mechanical 
sciences  rendered  quite  possible.  This  time  it  was  not  the 
sea  that  would  give  back  the  dead,  but  the  sea  that  would 
engulf  millions  of  the  living. 

Under  these  circumstances,  the  position  of  J.  T.  Maston 
became  daily  more  critical.  Mrs.  Scorbitt  trembled  lest 
he  should  become  the  victim  of  the  general  mania.  Some- 
times she  thought  of  advising  him  to  speak  the  word  which 
he  so  obstinately  kept  to  himself.  But  she  dared  not,  and 
she  did  well.  It  would  have  been  to  expose  herself  to  a 
categorical  refusal. 

The  city  of  Baltimore  was  a  prey  to  terror,  and  it  be- 
came difficult  to  restrain  the  populace,  who  were  being 
excited  even  unto  madness  by  the  newspapers,  by  the  tele- 
grams which  they  published  from  the  four  angles  of  the 
earth,  to  use  the  apocalyptic  language  of  St.  John  the 
Evangelist  in  the  days  of  Domitian.  Assuredly,  if  J.  T. 
Maston  had  lived  under  that  persecuting  emperor,  his  busi- 
ness would  soon  have  been  settled.  He  would  have  been 
thrown  to  the  beasts.  But  he  would  have  contented  him- 
self with  replying: 

"I  am  there  already!" 

But  no  matter  what  happened,  he  refused  to  reveal  the 
position  of  place  x,  knowing  well  that  if  he  divulged  it 
Barbicane  and  Nicholl  would  be  prevented  from  continuing 
their  work. 

After  all,  there  was  something  grand  in  this  struggle 
between  one  man  and  the  entire  world.  J.  T.  Maston 
increased  in  grandeur  in  the  mind  of  Mrs.  Scorbitt,  and 
also  in  the  opinion  of  his  colleagues  of  the  Gun  Club. 
These  gallant  fellows  were  as  obstinate  as  retired  artillery- 


384   PURCHASE  OF  THE  NORTH  POLE 

men,  and  never  swerved  from  their  support  of  Barbicane 
&  Co.  The  secretary  of  the  Gun  Club  reached  such  a 
height  of  celebrity  that  a  number  of  persons  even  wrote  to 
him,  as  they  do  to  famous  criminals,  to  obtain  a  few  lines 
from  the  hand  of  the  man  who  was  going  to  upset  the 
globe. 

This  was  all  very  fine,  but  it  was  more  and  more  dan- 
gerous. The  populace  thronged  day  and  night  around  the 
jail  of  Baltimore.  There  was  great  shouting  and  much 
tumult.  The  mob  would  have  lynched  J.  T.  Maston  there 
and  then  if  they  could;  and  the  police  saw  the  time  was 
coming  when  they  could  no  longer  protect  him. 

Desirous  of  satisfying  the  American  mob,  as  well  as  the 
mob  of  other  countries,  the  Washington  Government  de- 
cided to  bring  J.  T.  Maston  to  trial. 

With  a  jury  selected  from  the  terrified  masses,  "the 
affair  would  not  hang  about  long,"  to  quote  the  words  of 
Alcide,  who  felt  a  kind  of  sympathy  for  the  calculator's 
tenacity. 

On  the  5th  of  September,  the  President  of  the  Commis- 
sion visited  the  prisoner  in  his  cell. 

Mrs.  Scorbitt,  at  his  urgent  request,  was  allowed  to 
accompany  him.  Perhaps  at  the  last  attempt  the  influence 
of  this  amiable  lady  might  be  successful.  It  would  not  do 
to  neglect  anything.  All  means  were  legitimate  that 
might  secure  the  word  of  the  enigma.  If  they  did  not 
succeed,  they  would  see !  ' 

"They  will  see !"  said  the  knowing  ones.  "Suppose  they 
hang  J.  T.  Maston,  and  the  catastrophe  takes  place  all 
the  same?" 

At  eleven  o'clock,  then,  Maston  found  himself  in  the 
presence  of  John  Prestice  and  Evangelina  Scorbitt. 

"For  the  last  time,"  said  Prestice,  "will  you  answer 
me?" 

"What  about?"  said  Maston. 

"Where  has  your  colleague,  Barbicane,  gone  to?" 

"I  have  already  told  you  a  hundred  times." 

"Repeat  it  for  the  hundred  and  first." 

"He  has  gone  where  he  will  fire  the  cannon." 

"And  where  will  he  fire  the  cannon?" 

"Where  Barbicane  is  at  this  present  moment." 

"Take  care,  Maston!" 


A  TRULY  EPIC  REPLY  385 

^Of  what?" 

"Of  the  consequences  of  your  refusal  to  reply.     The 
result  will  be—" 

"That  you  will  not  discover  what  you  have  no  right  to 
know." 

"What  we  have  the  right  to  know." 

"That  is  not  my  opinion." 

"We  are  going  to  put  you  on  your  trial."  , 

"You  can  put  me  on  my  trial." 

"And  the  jury  will  find  you  guilty." 

"Let  them  find  me  guilty." 

"And  the  sentence  will  immediately  be  given  and  imme- 
diately executed." 

"Very  well." 

"Dear  Maston!"  said  Evangelina,  whose  heart  trembled 
at  the  prospect. 

"Oh!  Mrs.  Scorbitt,"  said  J.  T.  Maston. 

She  bowed  her  head,  and  was  silent. 

"Would  you  like  to  know  what  the  sentence  will  be?" 

"Yes,  if  you  like." 

"You  will  be  hanged,  as  you  deserve." 

"Really." 

"And  you  will  be  hanged,  sir,  as  sure  as  two  and  two 
make  four." 

"Then,  sir,  I  shall  have  a  chance,"  said  the  phlegmatic 
Maston.  "If  you  were  only  the  least  bit  of  a  mathemati- 
cian you  would  not  say  as  sure  as  two  and  two  make 
four.  What  is  it  that  proves  that  all  mathematicians  up 
to  now  have  not  been  mad  in  asserting  that  the  sum  of 
two  numbers  is  equal  to  that  of  their  parts,  that  two  and 
two  make  exactly  four?" 

"Sir!"  exclaimed  the  president,  completely  puzzled. 

"Ah!"  continued  Maston.  "If  you  had  said  as  sure  as 
one  and  one  make  two,  all  right!  That  is  absolutely 
evident,  for  it  is  no  longer  a  theorem,  it  is  a  definition." 

At  this  lesson  in  arithmetic,  the  president  of  the  Com- 
mission retired,  while  Mrs.  Scorbitt's  eyes  were  ablaze 
with  admiration  for  the  extraordinary  abilities  of  her 
beloved  calculator. 


Vol.  13  Verne 


386        PURCHASE  OF  THE  NORTH  POLE 


CHAPTER  XIV 

THE  GEOGRAPHICAL  VALUE  OF  X. 

FORTUNATELY  for  J.  T.  Maston,  the  Federal  Govern- 
ment unexpectedly  received  the  following  telegram: 

"To  John  S.  Wright,  Washington,  U.  S.  A. 

"Zanzibar,  i3th  September,  5  a.  m.,  local  time.  Great 
foundries  have  been  established  among  the  Wamasai  to 
the  south  of  Kilimanjaro.  For  eight  months  Impey  Bar- 
bicane  and  Nicholl  have  been  there,  with  hundreds  of 
black  workmen  under  the  authority  of  the  Sultan  Bali- 
Bali.  Information  for  Government  purposes. — Richard 
W.  Trust,  U.  S.  Consul." 

And  that  is  how  the  great  secret  was  discovered.  And 
that  is  why  the  secretary  of  the  Gun  Club  was  not  hanged. 

But  who  can  say  that  he  did  not  live  to  regret  that  he 
was  not  removed  from  mankind  in  all  the  plenitude  of 
his  glory? 

Anyhow  the  fact  of  the  discovery  is  so  important  in  our 
history  that  we  shall  only  be  treating  it  with  due  respect 
in  giving  it  this  chapter  to  itself. 


CHAPTER  XV 

INTERESTING  FOR  THE  INHABITANTS  OF  THE  TERRESTRIAL 

SPHEROID 

AND  so  the  Washington  Government  knew  where  Bar- 
bicane  &  Co.  had  commenced  business.  There  could  be 
no  doubt  as  to  the  authenticity  of  the  telegram.  The 
Consul  of  Zanzibar  was  too  cautious  a  man  for  his  infor- 
mation to  be  doubted,  and  it  was  confirmed  by  subsequent 
telegrams.  The  gigantic  works  of  the  North  Polar  Prac- 
tical Association  were  in  full  swing  in  the  center  of  the 
Kilimanjaro  region,  about  three  hundred  miles  from  the 
East  Coast  of  Africa,  a  little  below  the  equinoctial  line. 

How  had  they  come  to  be  installed  so  secretly  in  this 
lost  country,  at  the  foot  of  the  famous  mountain  dis- 
covered in  1848  by  Krapf  and  Rebmann?  How  had 


INTERESTING  FOR  THE  INHABITANTS   387 

Barbicane  &  Co.  been  able  to  build  their  foundries  and 
collect  their  staff?  By  what  means  had  they  managed  to 
enter  into  peaceful  relations  with  the  savage  tribes  of  the 
district,  and  their  cruel  and  grasping  chiefs?  Nobody 
knew.  And  as  there  were  only  a  few  days  to  run  before 
the  22nd,  it  was  not  unlikely  that  nobody  would  know. 

When  J.  T.  Maston  learned  from  Evangelina  that  the 
mystery  of  Kilimanjaro  had  been  cleared  up  by  a  telegram 
from  Zanzibar — 

"Pshaw !"  he  said,  making  a  wonderful  zigzag  in  the 
air  with  his  iron  hook.  "They  do  not  travel  yet  by  tele- 
graph or  telephone;  and  in  six  days — patarapatanboom- 
boom — all  will  be  ready!" 

And  any  one  who  heard  the  secretary  of  the  Gun  Club 
deliver  the  sonorous  onomatope,  like  a  roar  from  a  Colum- 
biad,  would  have  wondered  at  the  amount  of  vital  energy 
remaining  in  the  old  artilleryman. 

But  there  was  no  doubt  that  he  was  right.  There  was 
no  time  to  send  messengers  to  the  Wamasai  to  arrest 
Impey  Barbicane.  Even  if  the  messengers  started  from 
Egypt,  or  Aden,  or  Massowah,  or  Zanzibar,  however 
quickly  they  might  travel,  they  would  have  to  contend 
with  the  difficulties  of  the  country,  with  the  obstacles 
unavoidable  on  a  road  through  a  mountainous  region,  and 
probably  with  followers  acting  under  the  orders  of  a  sultan 
as  despotic  as  he  was  black. 

All  hope  would  have  to  be  given  up  of  stopping  the 
operation  or  arresting  the  operator. 

But,  if  that  was  impossible,  nothing  was  easier  now  than 
to  know  the  worst  that  could  happen.  The  firing-point 
had  been  revealed,  and  it  was  a  simple  matter  of  calcula- 
tion— a  complicated  calculation  evidently,  but  not  beyond 
the  capacities  of  algebraists  in  particular  and  mathema- 
ticians in  general. 

At  first  the  Government  kept  the  despatch  secret,  their 
object  being  to  be  able  to  indicate  when  they  published  it 
what  would  be  the  results  of  the  displacement  of  the  axis 
with  regard  to  the  alteration  in  the  level  of  the  waters. 
The  inhabitants  of  the  world  would  then  know  the  fate 
that  was  in  store  for  them,  according  to  the  segment  of 
the  spheroid  on  which  they  resided. 
L  On  the  1 4th  of  September  the  telegram  was  sent  to  the 


388        PURCHASE  OF  THE  NORTH  POLE 

Longitudes  Office  at  Washington,  with  instructions  to 
work  out  the  final  consequences,  ballistic  and  geographical. 
The  next  day  but  one  the  information  was  ready.  It  was 
cabled  at  once  to  all  the  Governments  of  the  new  and  old 
worlds,  and  having  been  printed  in  thousands  of  news- 
papers, it  was  cried  in  all  the  great  cities  by  all  the  news- 
boys of  the  globe,  as — 

"What  is  going  to  happen?" 

Which  was  the  question  being  asked  in  every  language 
just  then. 

And  this  is  the  reply  as  given  by  the  Longitudes  Office. 

"IMPORTANT  NOTICE. 

"The  experiment  to  be  attempted  by  Barbicane  &  Co. 
is  as  follows: 

"To  produce  a  recoil  on  the  22nd  of  September  at 
midnight,  local  time,  by  means  of  a  monster  cannon  throw- 
ing a  projectile  of  one  hundred  and  eighty  thousand  tons. 

"If  this  discharge  is  effected  just  below  the  Equator, 
near  the  thirty-eighth  meridian,  at  the  base  of  the  Kili- 
manjaro chain,  and  if  it  is  directed  toward  the  south,  the 
mechanical  effect  on  the  terrestrial  spheroid  will  be  as 
follows : 

"At  once,  owing  to  the  shock  being  combined  with  the 
diurnal  movement,  a  new  axis  will  be  formed,  the  old  axis 
being  23°  28',  and  the  new  one  being  perpendicular  to 
the  plane  of  the  ecliptic. 

"In  the  north  the  extremity  of  the  new  axis  will  be 
situated  between  Greenland  and  Grinnell  Land,  on  that 
part  of  Baffin  Sea  cut  by  the  Arctic  Circle.  In  the  south 
it  will  be  on  the  Antarctic  Circle  to  the  east  of  Adelaide 
Land. 

"As  an  example  of  the  new  meridians,  we  may  mention 
that  passing  through  Dublin  in  Ireland,  Paris  in  France, 
Palermo  in  Sicily,  Obeid  in  Darfur,  Kilimanjaro,  Ker- 
guelen  Island,  the  new  Antarctic  Pole,  the  Society  Islands 
in  the  Pacific,  Vancouver  Island,  and  Melville  Peninsula. 

"The  new  Equator  will  pass  through  the  Kilimanjaro 
country,  the  Indian  Ocean,  Goa,  a  little  below  Calcutta, 
Mangala  in  Siam,  Hong  Kong,  the  Marshall  and  Walker 


INTERESTING  FOR  THE  INHABITANTS   389 

Islands  in  the  Pacific,  Rio  Janeiro,  Saint  Helena,  and  by 
St.  Paul  de  Loanda  across  Africa  to  Kilimanjaro. 

"The  new  Equator  having  been  formed  by  the  new  axis, 
it  is  possible  to  calculate  the  results  on  the  ocean  levels. 

"It  is  worthy  of  note  that  Barbicane  &  Co.,  or  rather 
the  directors  of  the  North  Polar  Practical  Association, 
have  evidently  been  desirous  of  doing  as  little  damage  as 
possible.  Had  the  discharge  been  effected  toward  the 
north,  the  consequences  would  have  been  disastrous  for  the 
most  civilized  portions  of  the  globe;  but  by  firing  toward 
the  south  the  consequences,  so  far  as  the  submergence  of 
the  land  is  concerned,  will  only  affect  the  less  peopled  and 
wilder  countries. 

"The  globe  will,  for  the  purposes  of  this  inquiry,  be 
divided  by  two  great  circles,  intersecting  at  right  angles 
at  Kilimanjaro  and  the  antipodes  of  that  mountain,  thus 
giving  four  segments,  two  in  the  northern  hemisphere, 
and  two  in  the  southern  hemisphere,  separated  by  lines  in 
which  no  alteration  of  level  will  occur. 

"i.     The  northern  hemisphere: 

"The  first  segment,  to  the  west  of  Kilimanjaro,  will 
comprise  Africa  from  the  Congo  to  Egypt,  Europe  from 
Turkey  to  Greenland,  America  from  British  Columbia  to 
Peru  and  Brazil  north  of  San  Salvador — in  fact  the  whole 
of  the  North  Atlantic  and  the  greater  part  of  the  Equa- 
torial Atlantic. 

"The  second  segment,  to  the  east  of  Kilimanjaro,  will 
comprise  the  greater  part  of  Europe  from  the  Black  Sea 
to  Sweden,  the  Russian  Empire,  Arabia,  almost  all  India, 
Persia,  Beloochistan,  Afghanistan,  Turkestan,  the  Celestial 
Empire,  Mongolia,  Japan,  Corea,  the  Northern  Pacific  and 
Alaska — and  also  the  Polar  regions,  so  regrettably  placed 
in  the  possession  of  Barbicane  &  Co. 

"2.     The  southern  hemisphere: 

"The  third  segment,  to  the  east  of  Kilimanjaro,  will 
comprise  Madagascar,  Kerguelen  Island,  Mauritius,  and 
all  the  islands  of  the  Indian  Ocean,  the  Antarctic  Ocean 
to  the  New  Pole,  the  Malay  Peninsula,  Java,  Sumatra, 
Borneo,  the  Philippines,  Australia,  New  Zealand,  and  all 
the  southern  Pacific  up  to  the  meridian  of  the  Society 
Islands. 

"The  fourth  segment*  to  the  west  of  Kilimanjaro,  will 


390    PURCHASE  OF  THE  NORTH  POLE 

include  Africa  south  of  the  Congo  and  the  Mozambique 
Channel,  the  Cape  of  Good  Hope,  the  South  Atlantic, 
South  America  below  Pernambuco  and  Lima,  Bolivia, 
Brazil,  Uruguay,  the  Argentine  Confederation,  Tierra  del 
Fuego,  the  Sandwich  and  South  Shetland  Islands,  and  a 
portion  of  the  South  Pacific. 

"Such  will  be  the  four  segments  of  the  globe  divided 
by  lines  of  no  alteration  in  level. 

"In  each  of  these  four  segments  there  will  be  a  central 
point  where  the  effect  will  attain  its  maximum,  either  of 
increase  or  decrease. 

"This  maximum  will  approach  25,000  feet  at  each  point 
and  at  the  point  the  consequences  will  be  most  serious. 

"In  two  of  the  segments  situated  opposite  each  other 
in  the  northern  and  southern  hemispheres,  the  sea  will 
retire  to  flow  into  the  two  other  segments. 

"In  the  first  segment  the  Atlantic  Ocean  will  almost 
entirely  empty  itself,  the  point  of  maximum  being  about 
the  Bermudas,  where  the  bottom  will  become  visible  if  the 
depth  of  the  sea  in  that  locality  be  less  than  25,000  feet. 
Consequently,  between  America  and  Europe,  vast  terri- 
tories will  be  revealed,  which  the  United  States,  Great 
Britain,  France,  Spain  and  Portugal  can  annex  pro  rata 
to  their  Atlantic  coast-lines,  or  otherwise,  as  they  may 
think  fit.  But  it  must  be  remembered  that  as  the  waters 
are  lowered,  so  will  the  air  be.  The  coast  of  Europe  and 
America  will  be  lifted  to  such  an  extent,  that  towns  placed 
twenty  or  even  thirty  degrees  from  the  point  of  maximum, 
will  have  no  more  air  than  is  now  available  at  three  miles 
from  the  surface  of  the  sea.  New  York,  Philadelphia, 
Charlestown,  Panama,  Lisbon,  Madrid,  Paris,  London, 
Edinburgh,  Dublin  will  be  thus  elevated,  but  Cairo,  Con- 
stantinople, Dantzic,  Stockholm  on  one  side,  and  the 
western  coast  towns  of  America  on  the  other,  will  retain 
their  present  level.  The  Bermudas  will  be  in  such  rarefied 
air  as  has  hitherto  been  only  experienced  by  aeronauts, 
and  will  become  as  uninhabitable  as  the  upper  peaks  of 
the  mountains  of  Tibet. 

"Similar  effects  will  be  experienced  in  the  opposite 
southern  segment  comprising  the  Indian  Ocean,  Australia, 
and  the  Pacific.  At  Adelaide  and  Melbourne  the  level  of 
the  sea  will  sink  25,000  feet  below  them,  and  the  air 


INTERESTING  FOR  THE  INHABITANTS   391 

will  become  so  pure  and  rarefied  as  to  be  unbreathable. 

"Such  are  the  two  segments  from  which  the  waters  will 
retire.  In  the  sea  that  will  be  left  there  will  probably  be 
many  new  islands,  formed  by  the  summits  of  submarine 
mountain-chains. 

"In  the  other  segments  the  waters  will  rise  to  a  corre- 
sponding height. 

"In  the  segment  north-east  of  Kilimanjaro  the  maxi- 
mum will  be  at  Yakutsk  in  Siberia.  This  town  will  be 
submersed  under  25,000  feet  of  water — less  its  actual  alti- 
tude— and  thence  thinning  out  on  all  sides  the  flood  will 
spread  out  over  Asiatic  Russia,  India,  China,  Japan  and 
Alaska.  The  Ural  Mountains  may  possibly  appear  above 
the  waters  as  islands.  St.  Petersburg  and  Moscow  on 
one  side,  Calcutta,  Bangkok,  Saigon,  Pekin,  Hong  Kong, 
and  Tokyo,  on  the  other,  will  disappear  beneath  the  waves 
at  variable  depths,  but  at  depths  quite  sufficient  to  drown 
such  of  the  Russians,  Hindoos,  Siamese,  Cochinchinese, 
Chinese,  and  Japanese  who  have  not  left  the  country 
before  the  catastrophe. 

"In  the  segment  south-west  of  Kilimanjaro  the  disasters 
will  not  be  of  such  magnitude,  as  the  segment  is  in  a 
great  measure  covered  by  the  Atlantic  and  Pacific,  the 
level  of  which  will  rise  25,000  feet  above  the  Falkland 
Islands.  But  nevertheless  much  territory  will  disappear, 
among  others  all  South  Africa  from  the  Gulf  of  Guinea 
and  Kilimanjaro  to  the  Cape  of  Good  Hope,  all  South 
America  south  of  Central  Brazil  and  Peru,  including  Chili, 
the  Argentine  Republic  down  to  Tierra  del  Fuego.  The 
Patagonians,  however  tall  they  may  be,  will  not  escape 
destruction,  as  they  will  not  even  have  the  resource  of 
escaping  to  the  Cordilleras,  not  one  of  whose  summits  will 
in  those  parts  rise  above  sea-level. 

"Such  will  be  the  results  produced  by  the  changes  of 
the  level  of  the  waters.  And  such  are  the  eventualities 
for  which  those  interested  must  prepare,  unless  something 
happens  to  prevent  the  dastardly  enterprise  of  Barbicane 
&  Co." 


392    PURCHASE  OF  THE  NORTH  POLE 
CHAPTER  XVI 

THE    CHORUS    OF    TERROR 

ACCORDING  to  the  "important  notice,"  the  dangers  of 
the  position  could  be  avoided,  or  rather  fled  from,  by 
hurrying  off  to  the  neutral  zones. 

The  people  in  peril  could  be  divided  into  two  classes, 
the  asphyxiated  and  the  drowned. 

The  effect  of  the  communication  was  to  give  rise  to  very 
different  opinions,  which  soon  developed  into  the  most 
violent  protestations. 

On  the  side  of  the  asphyxiated  were  the  Americans  of 
the  United  States,  the  Europeans  of  the  United  Kingdom, 
and  France,  Spain,  etc.  The  prospect  of  being  able  to 
annex  territories  from  the  ocean-bed  was  not  attractive 
enough  to  persuade  them  to  accept  the  change. 

On  the  side  of  the  drowned  were  the  inhabitants  of 
South  America,  and  the  Hindoos,  Russians,  and  Chinese. 
But  Great  Britain  was  not  likely  to  allow  Barbicane  &  Co. 
to  deprive  her  of  her  southern  colonies;  and  the  other 
nations  decidedly  objected  to  being  so  summarily  disposed 
of.  Evidently  the  Gulf  of  Mexico  would  be  emptied  to 
form  a  huge  territory  of  the  Antilles,  which  the  Mexicans 
and  Americans  might  claim  in  accordance  with  the  Monroe 
Doctrine.  Evidently  the  lift  of  the  Philippines  and  Celebes 
would  bring  up  an  immense  region  which  the  British  and 
Spanish  might  share.  But  vain  such  compensation!  It 
would  never  balance  the  loss  due  to  the  terrible  inundation. 

If  the  new  seas  were  only  to  rise  over  the  Samoyeds, 
Laps,  Fuegians,  Patagonians,  Tartars  even,  Chinese,  Jap- 
anese, or  even  Argentines,  the  world  might  have  borne 
the  bereavement.  But  the  catastrophe  affected  too  many 
of  the  great  Powers  for  them  to  bear  it  quietly. 

Although  the  central  part  would  remain  much  as  it  is, 
Europe  would  be  lifted  in  the  west  and  lowered  in  the 
east,  that  is  to  say  half  asphyxiated  on  one  side  and  half 
drowned  on  the  other. 

Such  a  state  of  affairs  was  unacceptable.  Besides,  the 
Mediterranean  would  be  nearly  drained  dry,  and  that 
neither  French,  Italians,  Spaniards,  Greeks,  Turks,  nor 
Egyptians  cared  for,  as  their  position  on  its  coast  gave 


THE  CHORUS  OF  TERROR  393 

them  indisputable  rights  over  the  sea.  And  what  would 
be  the  use  of  the  Suez  Canal,  which  would  escape,  owing 
to  its  position  on  the  neutral  line?  What  was  to  be  done 
with  that  when  there  was  no  Mediterranean  at  one  end 
and  very  little  Red  Sea  at  the  other — unless  it  was  length- 
ened by  several  hundred  miles? 

Great  Britain  had  no  desire  to  see  Gibraltar,  Malta,  and 
Cyprus  transformed  into  mountain-tops  which  ironclads 
would  try  to  anchor  near  in  vain.  And  the  British  Gov- 
ernment declined  to  entertain  in  any  form  the  suggested 
compensation  from  the  risen  bed  of  the  Atlantic. 

In  short,  all  the  world  was  in  arms  against  Barbicane 
&  Co.  Even  the  people  on  the  neutral  lines  were  urgent 
in  their  protests.  And  so  it  soon  came  about  that  Barbi- 
cane, Nicholl,  and  J.  T.  Maston  were  put  under  the  ban 
of  humanity. 

But  how  the  newspapers  prospered !  What  a  rush  there 
was  for  copies!  What  editions  after  editions!  For  the 
first  time  in  the  history  of  the  newspaper  press  all  the 
papers  of  every  country  in  the  world  were  agreed  upon 
one  matter.  And  the  effect  of  that  is  more  easily 
imagined  than  described! 

J.  T.  Maston  might  well  believe  that  his  last  hour  was 
come. 

In  fact,  a  frantic  mob  broke  into  his  prison  on  the 
evening  of  the  I7th  of  September  with  the  intention  of 
lynching  him,  and  it  is  well  to  say,  the  police  made  no 
objection. 

The  cell  was  empty!  With  the  worthy  calculator's 
weight  in  gold,  Mrs.  Scorbitt  had  managed  his  escape. 
The  jailer  was  the  more  ready  to  be  bribed  by  a  fortune 
as  he  had  hopes  of  enjoying  it  for  some  years.  In  fact, 
Baltimore,  like  Washington,  New  York,  and  the  other 
chief  cities  of  the  Atlantic  seaboard,  was  in  the  list  of 
towns  to  be  reasonably  elevated,  and  in  which  there 
would  remain  enough  air  for  the  daily  consumption  of 
their  inhabitants. 

J.  T.  Maston  had  gained  some  mysterious  retreat  where 
he  was  safe  from  the  fury  of  popular  wrath.  Thus  was 
the  life  of  the  great  world-troubler  saved  by  a  woman's 
devotion. 

And  now  only  four  days  remained  before  Barbicane  & 


394    PURCHASE  OF  THE  NORTH  POLE 

Co.  did  their  awful  deed.  The  important  notice  had  been 
generally  understood.  If  there  had  been  a  few  skeptics 
before,  there  were  none  now.  The  Government  issued 
proclamations  to  such  of  their  peoples  as  were  to  be  sent 
up  into  the  rarefied  air,  and  to  the  greater  number  that 
were  to  be  dropped  into  deep  water. 

The  result  was  such  a  migration  as  had  never  been 
seen,  not  even  when  the  Aryan  families  began  to  remove. 
An  exodus  took  place  comprising  every  branch  of  the 
Hottentots,  Melanesians,  Negroes,  Red  Men,  Yellow  Men, 
Brown  Men,  White  Men. 

Unfortunately  the  time  was  too  short.  It  could  be 
reckoned  in  hours.  Given  a  few  months,  the  Chinese 
might  abandon  China,  the  Australians  Australia,  the  Pata- 
gonians  Patagonia,  the  Siberians  Siberia. 

But  time!     Time!     The  time!     How  was  it  possible? 

Migration  was  useless. 

There  was  only  one  chance! 

Suppose  that  Barbicane  &  Co.  were  to  fail? 


CHAPTER  XVII 

THE   WORKS   AT    KILIMANJARO 

THE  country  of  the  Wamasai  is  situated  in  the  east  of 
Central  Africa,  between  Zanzibar  and  the  great  lakes.  Our 
knowledge  of  it  is  due  chiefly  to  Thomson,  Johnston, 
Count  Tekeli  and  Doctor  Meyer.  It  is  a  mountainous  dis- 
trict under  the  sovereignty  of  the  Sultan  Bali-Bali,  whose 
people  are  negroes,  and  number  from  thirty  to  forty 
thousand. 

Three  degrees  south  of  the  Equator  rises  the  chain  of 
Kilimanjaro,  which  lifts  its  highest  summit  over  18,000 
feet  above  the  sea,  and  commands  northward,  southward, 
and  westward,  the  vast  and  fertile  plains  of  the  Wamasai. 

A  few  miles  below  the  first  slopes  of  the  mountain  lies 
the  town  of  Kisongo,  where  the  Sultan  resides.  The 
capital  is,  truth  to  tell,  but  a  large  village.  It  is  occupied 
by  a  population,  highly  gifted  and  intelligent,  and  working 
hard  as  much  by  itself  as  by  its  slaves  under  the  iron  yoke 
of  Bali-Bali,  who  is  justly  considered  to  be  one  of  the 
most  remarkable  sovereigns  of  Central  Africa. 


THE  WORKS  AT  KILIMANJARO          395 

Impey  Barbicane  and  Captain  Nicholl,  accompanied  by 
ten  foremen  devoted  to  the  enterprise,  had  arrived  at 
Kisongo  in  the  first  week  of  January.  The  fact  of  their 
departure  had  only  been  communicated  to  J.  T.  Maston 
and  Mrs.  Scorbitt.  They  had  embarked  at  New  York  for 
the  Cape  of  Good  Hope;  thence  they  had  gone  to  Zanzi- 
bar; and  a  bark,  secretly  chartered,  had  taken  them  to 
Mombasa  on  the  other  side  of  the  channel.  An  escort 
from  the  Sultan  had  met  them  at  this  port,  and  after  a 
difficult  journey  of  about  300  miles  across  this  harassed 
region,  obstructed  by  forests,  cut  up  by  streams,  and 
checkered  with  marshes,  they  had  reached  the  royal  resi- 
dence. 

As  soon  as  he  had  obtained  J.  T.  Maston's  calculations, 
Barbicane  had  put  himself  in  communication  with  Bali- 
Bali  through  a  Swedish  explorer  who  intended  to  spend 
a  few  years  in  this  part  of  Africa.  The  Sultan  had 
become  one  of  the  warmest  admirers  of  the  audacious 
Yankee  after  the  celebrated  Moon  Voyage,  the  fame  of 
which  had  spread  even  to  this  distant  country.  Without 
disclosing  his  object  Barbicane  had  obtained  from  the 
Wamasai  the  needful  authority  to  open  important  works  at 
the  southern  base  of  Kilimanjaro.  For  the  very  consid- 
erable sum  of  three  hundred  thousand  dollars  Bali-Bali 
had  engaged  to  furnish  him  with  the  labor  he  required  to 
do  what  he  liked  with  Kilimanjaro.  He  could  take  it  down 
if  he  liked,  or  carry  it  away  if  he  could;  and  he  became 
as  much  the  owner  of  the  mountain  as  he  was  of  the 
North  Pole. 

Barbicane  and  his  colleague  were  cordially  welcomed  at 
Kisongo.  Bali-Bali  felt  an  admiration  bordering  on  adora- 
tion for  the  two  illustrious  voyagers  who  had  launched  out 
into  space  to  attain  the  circumlunar  regions,  and  sympa- 
thized enthusiastically  with  the  projectors  of  the  myste- 
rious works  they  wished  to  establish  in  his  kingdom.  He 
undertook  that  the  enterprise  should  be  kept  secret,  both 
by  himself  and  his  subjects,  for  all  of  whom  he  could 
answer,  as  not  one  of  the  negroes  engaged  had  the  right 
to  leave  the  works  for  a  day  under  penalty  of  the  most 
dreadful  punishments. 

On  this  account  the  operation  was  enveloped  in  a 
mystery  that  the  cleverest  detectives  of  America  and 


396   PURCHASE  OF  THE  NORTH  POLE 

Europe  failed  to  penetrate,  and  if  it  was  discovered  at 
last  it  was  because  the  Sultan  had  relaxed  his  severity 
after  the  completion  of  the  works,  and  that  there  are 
traitors  or  chatterers  even  among  negroes.  It  was  in  this 
way  that  Richard  W.  Trust,  the  consul  at  Zanzibar,  got 
wind  of  what  was  happening  at  Kilimanjaro.  But  at  that 
date,  the  i3th  of  September,  it  was  too  late  to  stop  Barbi- 
cane  in  the  accomplishment  of  his  plans. 

The  reason  that  Barbican e  &  Co.  had  chosen  the 
country  of  the  Wamasai  as  the  scene  of  their  operations 
was  that,  in  the  first  place,  it  was  little  known  and  rarely 
visited  by  travelers,  and,  secondly,  that  the  mass  of  Kili- 
manjaro offered  all  the  qualities  of  solidity  and  position 
necessary  for  their  work.  Besides,  the  country  was  rich 
in  all  the  materials  they  required,  and  these  were  found 
under  conditions  that  made  them  easily  workable. 

A  few  months  before  leaving  the  United  States,  Barbi- 
cane  had  learned  from  the  Swedish  explorer  that  iron  and 
coal  were  abundant  in  the  Kilimanjaro  chain.  There  were 
no  mines  to  be  opened,  and  no  shafts  to  be  driven  thou- 
sands of  feet  into  the  crust  of  the  earth.  The  minerals 
were  on  the  surface,  and  had  only  to  be  picked  up  from 
the  ground.  And  in  addition  to  these,  there  were  large 
deposits  of  nitrate  of  soda  and  iron  pyrites,  such  as  were 
required  for  the  manufacture  of  the  meli-melonite. 

Barbicane  and  Nicholl  had  brought  no  staff  of  workmen 
with  them  except  the  ten  foremen,  on  whom  they  could 
depend.  These  could  take  command  of  the  ten  thousand 
negroes  placed  at  their  disposal  by  Bali-Bali,  to  whom  was 
entrusted  the  task  cf  making  the  monster  cannon  and  its 
no  less  monster  projectile. 

A  fortnight  after  the  arrival  of  Barbicane  and  his 
colleague  among  the  Wamasai,  three  large  workshops  had 
been  erected  on  the  south  of  the  mountain;  one  as  the 
foundry  for  the  gun,  one  as  the  foundry  for  the  shot,  and 
one  as  the  factory  for  the  meli-melonite. 

And  how  did  Barbicane  &  Co.  intend  to  cast  a  cannon 
of  such  colossal  dimensions?  The  only  chance  for  the 
inhabitants  of  the  world  was,  as  we  have  seen,  in  the 
difficulty  of  dealing  with  such  a  huge  undertaking. 

To  cast  a  cannon  a  million  times  larger  than  a  four 
hundred  pounder  would  have  been  beyond  the  power  of 


THE  WORKS  AT  KILIMANJARO          397 

man.  To  make  a  four  hundred  pounder  is  difficult 
enough,  but  a  four  hundred  million  pounder!  Barbicane 
&  Co.  did  not  attempt  to  do  so.  It  was  not  a  cannon, 
nor  even  a  mortar,  that  they  had  in  their  minds.  They 
simply  intended  to  drive  a  gallery  into  the  mountain. 

Evidently  this  enormous  mine  would  have  the  same 
effect  as  a  gigantic  Columbiad,  the  manufacture  of  which 
would  have  been  as  costly  as  it  was  difficult,  owing  to  the 
thickness  it  would  have  to  be  to  avoid  the  risk  of  burst- 
ing. Barbicane  &  Co.  had  always  intended  to  act  in  this 
way,  and  if  J.  T.  Maston's  note-book  spoke  of  a  cannon, 
it  was  the  four  hundred  pounder  he  had  taken  as  the 
basis  of  his  calculations. 

Consequently,  a  spot  was  chosen  a  hundred  feet  up  the 
southern  side  of  the  chain,  from  the  base  of  which  the 
plains  extended  for  miles  and  miles,  so  that  nothing  would 
be  in  the  way  of  the  projectile  when  it  was  hurled  from 
the  long  tube  in  the  mass  of  Kilimanjaro. 

With  great  precision  and  much  labor  Barbicane  carried 
on  the  driving  of  his  tunnel.  Easy  to  him  was  the  con- 
struction of  boring  machines  worked  with  air  compressed 
by  the  power  of  the  large  waterfalls  in  the  district.  The 
holes  bored  by  the  machines  were  charged  with  meli- 
melonite,  and  the  blasting  of  the  rock  was  easy,  it  being 
a  kind  of  syenite  composed  of  orthoclasic  felspar  and 
amphibolic  hornblende.  It  was  a  favorable  circumstance 
that  a  rock  so  constituted  would  strongly  resist  the  fright- 
ful pressure  developed  by  the  expansion  of  the  gas;  but 
the  height  and  thickness  of  the  mountain  afforded  ample 
security  against  any  exterior  splitting  or  cracking. 

The  thousands  of  workmen  under  the  guidance  of  the 
ten  foremen,  superintended  by  Barbicane,  progressed  with 
such  zeal  and  intelligence  that  in  less  than  six  months  the 
tunnel  was  finished.  It  measured  nearly  ninety  feet  in 
diameter  and  two  thousand  feet  long.  As  it  was  impor- 
tant that  the  projectile  should  glide  along  a  perfectly 
smooth  surface  without  losing  any  of  the  gas  of  deflagra- 
tion, the  interior  was  lined  with  a  smooth  tube  of  cast 
iron.  This  was  a  much  larger  affair  than  the  celebrated 
Columbiad  of  Tampa  Town,  which  had  sent  the  aluminium 
projectile  around  the  Moon.  But  what  is  there  that  is 
impossible  to  the  engineers  of  the  modern  world? 


398    PURCHASE  OF  THE  NORTH  POLE 

While  the  boring  went  on  in  the  flank  of  Kilimanjaro, 
the  workmen  were  busy  at  the  second  foundry.  While 
the  tube  was  being  built  the  enormous  projectile  was  in 
process  of  manufacture. 

All  it  consisted  of  was  a  mass  of  cast-iron,  cylindro- 
conical  in  form,  weighing  one  hundred  and  eighty  thou- 
sand tons.  It  had  never  been  intended  to  make  such  a 
casting  in  one  piece,  but  to  provide  one  hundred  and 
eighty  masses,  each  of  one  thousand  tons,  which  could  be 
hoisted  into  the  tube  and  arranged  in  front  of  the  meli- 
melonite  so  as  to  form  a  compact  charge. 

It  thus  became  necessary  to  furnish  the  second  foundry 
with  four  hundred  thousand  tons  of  ore,  seventy  thousand 
tons  of  flux,  and  four  hundred  thousand  tons  of  good  coal, 
which  at  the  outset  was  transformed  into  two  hundred 
and  eighty  thousand  tons  of  coke.  As  the  deposits  were 
all  in  the  vicinity,  this  was  only  a  matter  of  transport. 

The  greatest  difficulty  was  the  construction  of  the  blast 
furnaces  for  dealing  with  the  ore;  but  nevertheless,  before 
a  month  was  out  ten  furnaces  were  at  work,  capable,  each, 
of  an  output  of  one  hundred  and  eighty  tons  a  day.  This 
gave  eighteen  hundred  tons  in  the  twenty-four  hours,  and 
a  hundred  and  eighty  thousand  tons  in  ten  working  days. 

In  the  meli-melonite  factory  the  work  went  on  easily, 
and  so  secretly  that  the  composition  of  the  explosive  was 
never  discovered.  All  went  well;  and  there  was  hardly 
an  accident  to  mar  the  progress. 

The  Sultan  was  delighted.  He  followed  the  operations 
with  indefatigable  assiduity,  and  it  may  be  imagined  how 
his  Majesty's  presence  stimulated  the  zeal  of  his  faithful 
subjects. 

When  he  asked  what  it  all  meant,  Barbicane  would 
reply  enigmatically: 

"It  is  a  work  which  will  change  the  face  of  the  world !" 

"A  work,"  Captain  Nicholl  would  add,  "that  will  con- 
fer on  the  Sultan  Bali-Bali  a  glory  that  will  never  fade 
among  the  monarchs  of  Eastern  Africa!" 

And  that  the  Sultan  of  the  Wamasai  felt  proud  there 
is  no  need  for  us  to  insist! 

On  the  2Qth  of  August  the  works  were  completed.  The 
tunnel  was  lined  with  the  smooth  iron  tube  built  up 
within  it.  At  the  end  lay  stored  two  thousand  tons  of 


THE  WORKS  AT  KILIMANJARO          399 

meli-melonite  in  communication  with  the  box  of  fulminate. 
Then  came  the  projectile  three  hundred  and  forty-five  feet 
long.  In  front  of  the  projectile  was  a  space  of  fourteen 
hundred  and  fifty  feet  in  which  effect  would  be  given  to 
the  impulse  due  to  the  expansion  of  the  gas. 

That  being  the  case,  there  remained  the  question — a 
question  of  pure  ballistics — would  the  projectile  have  the 
trajectory  assigned  to  it  by  J.  T.  Maston?  The  calcula- 
tions were  correct.  They  indicated  in  what  measure  the 
projectile  would  deviate  to  the  east  of  the  meridian  of 
Kilimanjaro  in  virtue  of  the  earth's  rotation,  and  what 
would  be  the  form  of  the  hyperbolic  curve  which  it  de- 
scribed in  virtue  of  its  enormous  initial  velocity. 

Second  question :  Would  it  be  visible  during  its  flight  ? 
No,  for  when  it  left  the  tube  plunged  in  the  darkness  of 
the  earth,  it  could  not  be  seen,  and  besides  owing  to  its 
moderate  height  it  would  liave  a  very  considerable  angular 
velocity.  Once  it  entered  the  zone  of  light,  the  smallness 
of  its  volume  would  conceal  it  from  the  most  powerful 
glasses,  and  for  a  stronger  reason  it  would,  when  free 
from  the  influence  of  terrestrial  attraction,  gravitate  for- 
ever around  the  Sun. 

Assuredly  Barbicane  &  Co.  might  be  proud  of  the  work 
they  were  about  to  complete.  Why  was  not  J.  T.  Maston 
there  to  admire  the  admirable  execution  of  the  works 
which  was  worthy  of  the  precision  of  the  calculations  that 
had  inspired  them?  And  above  all  things  why  was  he 
far  away  when  the  formidable  detonation  would  awake  the 
echoes  of  the  most  distant  horizons  of  Africa? 

In  thinking  of  him  his  colleagues  had  no  notion  that 
he  had  had  to  leave  Ballistic  Cottage  after  escaping  from 
Baltimore  jail,  and  was  now  in  hiding  to  save  his  pre- 
cious life.  They  knew  not  to  what  a  degree  public  opinion 
had  risen  against  the  North  Polar  Practical  Association. 
They  knew  not  what  would  be  the  massacres,  quarterings, 
and  roastings  if  the  people  happened  to  lay  hold  of  them. 
Indeed  they  were  fortunate  that  when  the  mine  was  fired 
they  could  only  be  saluted  by  the  shouts  of  the  Wamasai. 

"At  last!"  said  Captain  Nicholl,  when  on  the  evening 
of  the  22nd  of  September  they  were  strolling  about  at  the 
mouth  of  the  mine. 


400    PURCHASE  OF  THE  NORTH  POLE 

"Yes!  At  last!  And  also— Ha!"  and  Barbicane  gave 
a  sigh  of  relief. 

"If  you  had  to  begin  again?" 

"Bah!     We  should  begin  again  1" 

"What  luck,"  said  Nicholl,  "that  we  should  have  at  our 
disposal  this  admirable  meli-melonite  1" 

"Which  will  make  you  illustrious,  Nicholl!" 

"Doubtless,  Barbicane,"  said  the  captain  modestly. 
"But  do  you  know  how  many  galleries  we  should  have 
had  to  drive  in  the  flanks  of  Kilimanjaro  to  obtain  the 
same  result  if  we  had  only  had  fulmi-cotton  like  that 
which  flung  our  projectile  at  the  Moon?" 

"Tell  me." 

"One  hundred  and  eighty,  Barbicane!" 

"Well,  we  would  have  driven  them!" 

"And  a  hundred  and  eighty  projectiles  of  a  hundred 
and  eighty  thousand  tons!" 

"We  would  have  made  them,  Nicholl!" 

There  is  no  nonsense  about  men  of  this  stamp.  But 
when  artillerists  have  made  the  round  of  the  Moon,  of 
what  could  they  not  be  capable? 

***** 

And  that  very  evening,  an  hour  or  two  only  before  the 
discharge  was  to  take  place,  and  while  Barbicane  and 
Nicholl  were  thus  congratulating  themselves,  Alcide  Pier- 
deux,  shut  up  in  his  room  at  Baltimore,  jumped  to  his 
feet  and  whooped  like  a  Redskin. 

"Whoooop!  Mr.  J.  T.  Maston!  You  brute,  you  shall 
swallow  your  problem,  you  shall!  And  why  didn't  I  see 
that  before!  In  the  name  of  a  cosine!  If  I  knew  where 
you  were  I  would  ask  you  to  supper,  and  we  would  have 
a  glass  of  champagne  together  at  the  very  moment  your 
gun  is  to  go  off!" 

And  he  capered  around  the  room  and  whirled  his  arms 
about  like  a  railway  signal  gone  mad. 

"Whoooop,  you  old  plum-tree!  You  must  have  had  a 
big  bang  when  you  calculated  the  cannon  of  Kilimanjaro! 
Hurrah  for  the  cannon  of  Kilimanjaro;  and  how  many 
more  would  you  like?  That  is  not  only  the  sine  qua  non, 
my  boy,  but  the  sine  cannon!  Whoooop!" 


WAMASAI  WAIT  FOR  WORD  TO  FIRE    401 


CHAPTER  XVIII 

THE  WAMASAI  WAIT  FOR  THE  WORD  TO  FIRE 

IT  was  the  evening  of  the  22nd  of  September — that 
memorable  date  to  which  public  opinion  assigned  an  in- 
fluence as  disastrous  as  that  of  the  ist  of  January,  1000. 

Twelve  hours  after  the  sun  passed  the  meridian  of 
Kilimanjaro,  that  is  to  say,  at  midnight,  the  hand  of 
Captain  Nicholl  would  fire  the  terrible  mine. 

From  Kilimanjaro  to  Baltimore  is  one  hundred  and 
fourteen  degrees,  or  a  difference  in  time  of  four  hundred 
and  fifty-six  minutes.  At  the  moment  of  discharge  it 
would  be  twenty-four  minutes  past  five  in  the  afternoon  in 
the  great  city  of  Maryland. 

The  weather  was  magnificent.  The  sun  had  just  set 
on  the  plains  of  the  Wamasai  behind  a  perfectly  clear 
horizon.  Barbicane  &  Co.  could  not  have  wished  for  a 
better  night,  a  calmer  or  a  more  star-lit  one,  in  which  to 
hurl  their  projectile  into  space.  There  was  not  a  cloud  to 
mingle  with  the  artificial  vapors  developed  by  the  deflagra- 
tion of  the  meli-melonite. 

Who  knows?  Perhaps  Barbicane  and  Nicholl  were 
regretting  that  they  could  not  take  their  places  inside  the 
projectile?  In  the  first  second  they  could  have  traveled 
over  seventeen  hundred  miles!  After  having  penetrated 
the  mysteries  of  the  lunar  world,  they  would  have  pene- 
trated those  of  the  solar  world,  and  under  conditions 
differently  interesting  from  those  of  Hector  Servadac  on 
the  comet  Gallia! 

The  Sultan  Bali-Bali,  the  great  personages  of  his  court, 
that  is  to  say,  his  minister  of  finance  and  his  minister  of 
works,  and  the  staff  of  black  workmen,  were  gathered 
together  to  watch  their  final  operation.  But,  with  com- 
mendable prudence,  they  had  taken  up  their  position  three 
miles  away  from  the  mouth  of  the  mine,  so  as  to  suffer  no 
inconvenience  from  the  disturbance  of  the  atmosphere. 

Around  them  were  a  few  thousand  natives  from  Kis- 
ongo  and  the  villages  in  the  south  of  the  province,  who 
had  been  ordered  by  the  Sultan  to  come  and  admire  the 
spectacle. 

A  wire  connecting  an  electric  battery  with  the  detonator 

Vol.  18  Verne 


402    PURCHASE  OF  THE  NORTH  POLE 

of  the  fulminate  in  the  tube  lay  ready  to  fire  the  meJi- 
melonite. 

As  a  prelude,  an  excellent  repast  had  assembled  at  the 
same  table  the  Sultan,  his  American  visitors,  and  the 
notabilities  of  the  capital — the  whole  at  the  cost  of  Bali- 
Bali,  who  did  the  thing  all  the  better  from  his  knowing  he 
would  be  reimbursed  out  of  the  ample  purse  of  Barbicane 
&Co. 

It  was  eleven  o'clock  when  the  banquet,  which  had 
begun  at  half-past  seven,  came  to  an  end  by  a  toast  pro- 
posed by  the  Sultan  in  honor  of  the  engineers  of  the 
North  Polar  Practical  Association  and  the  success  of  their 
undertaking. 

In  an  hour  the  modification  of  the  geographical  and 
climatological  conditions  of  the  Earth  would  be  an  ac- 
complished fact. 

Barbicane,  his  colleague,  and  the  ten  foremen  began  to 
take  up  their  places  around  the  hut  in  which  the  electric 
battery  was  placed. 

Barbicane,  chronometer  in  hand,  counted  the  minutes — 
and  never  did  they  seem  so  long — those  minutes  which 
seemed  not  years,  but  centuries! 

At  ten  minutes  to  twelve  he  and  Captain  Nicholl  ap- 
proached the  apparatus  which  put  the  wire  in  communica- 
tion with  the  cannon  of  Kilimanjaro. 

The  Sultan,  his  court,  the  crowd  of  natives,  formed  an 
immense  circle  around  them. 

It  was  essential  that  the  discharge  should  take  place  at 
the  precise  moment  indicated  in  the  calculations  of  J.  T. 
Maston,  that  is  at  the  instant  the  sun  touched  the  equi- 
noctial line,  which  henceforth  he  would  never  leave  in  his 
apparent  orbit  around  the  terrestrial  spheroid. 

Five  minutes  to  twelve ! 

Four  minutes  to  twelve! 

Three  minutes  to  twelve! 

Two  minutes  to  twelve! 

One  minute  to  twelve! 

Barbicane  followed  the  hand  of  the  chronometer,  which 
was  lighted  by  a  lantern  held  by  one  of  the  foremen. 

Captain  Nicholl  stood  with  his  finger  on  the  button  of 
the  apparatus  ready  to  close  the  circuit. 

Twenty  seconds  to  twelve! 


MASTON  REGRETS  NOT  BEING  LYNCHED  403 

Ten  seconds! 

There  was  not  the  suspicion  of  a  shake  in  the  hand  of 
the  impassible  Captain  Nicholl.  He  and  his  friend  were 
no  more  excited  than  when,  shut  up  in  the  projectile,  they 
waited  for  the  Columbiad  to  despatch  them  to  the  Moon. 

Five  seconds! 

One! 

"FIRE!"  said  Barbicane. 

And  Nicholl's  ringer  pressed  the  button. 

The  noise  was  truly  awful.  The  echoes  rolled  in 
thunders  far  beyond  the  realm  of  the  Wamasai.  There 
was  a  shrill  shriek  of  the  projectile  which  traversed  the 
air  under  the  impetus  from  milliards  of  milliards  of  litres 
of  gas  developed  by  the  instantaneous  deflagration  of  two 
thousand  tons  of  meli-melonite.  It  seemed  as  though  there 
had  passed  over  the  surface  of  the  Earth  one  of  those 
storms  in  which  are  gathered  all  the  fury  of  Nature. 

And  the  effect  could  have  been  no  more  terrible  if  all 
the  guns  of  all  the  artilleries  of  the  world  had  been  joined 
to  the  thunders  of  the  sky  to  give  one  long  continuous  roar 
together. 


CHAPTER  XIX 

J.    T.    MASTON   REGRETS    HE   WAS   NOT   LYNCHED 

THE  capitals  of  the  globe — and  also  the  less  important 
towns,  and  even  the  humbler  villages — were,  as  a  rule, 
waiting  for  the  result  in  a  paroxysm  of  terror.  The  news- 
papers took  care  that  the  exact  moment  corresponding  to 
midnight  at  Kilimanjaro  should  be  thoroughly  well  known. 

At  Baltimore,  as  we  are  aware,  twelve  hours  after  the 
passage  of  the  Sun  on  the  meridian  of  Kilimanjaro,  it 
would  be  5 124  p.  m. 

We  need  not  enlarge  on  the  agony  of  these  moments. 
The  most  powerful  pen  of  modern  times  would  be  helpless 
to  describe  them. 

That  the  inhabitants  of  Baltimore  ran  no  danger  of 
being  swept  away  by  the  rising  sea  may  be  very  true! 
That  they  would  not  see  Chesapeake  Bay  empty  itself,  and 
Cape  Hatteras  at  the  end  become  a  mountain  crest  above 
the  dried  Atlantic,  is  agreed!  But  the  city,  like  many 


404   PURCHASE  OF  THE  NORTH  POLE 

others  not  menaced  with  emersion  or  immersion,  might  be 
shattered  by  the  shock,  its  monuments  thrown  down,  and 
its  streets  engulfed  in  the  abysses  that  might  open  in  the 
ground !  And  was  there  not  a  justification  for  fearing  for 
those  other  parts  of  the  world  which  would  never  survive 
the  displacement  of  the  waters? 

Why,  certainly! 

And  so  every  human  being  in  that  city  felt  a  cold  shiver 
in  the  spinal  marrow  during  that  fatal  minute.  Yes!  all 
trembled  with  terror — but  one!  And  that  one  was  Sul- 
phuric Alcide,  who  was  quietly  sipping  a  cup  of  hot  coffee 
as  if  he  and  the  old  world  would  last  forever. 

5 124  p.  m.,  answering  to  Kilimanjaro  midnight,  passed. 

At  Baltimore — nothing  occurred! 

At  London,  Berlin,  Paris,  Rome,  Constantinople — 
nothing !  Not  the  least  shock ! 

Professor  Milne,  in  the  coal-pit  at  Kagoshima,  in  Japan, 
gazed  steadily  at  the  tromometer,  and  saw  not  the  least 
abnormal  movement  in  the  crust  of  the  Earth  in  that  part 
of  the  world. 

At  Baltimore  there  was  no  sign  of  any  disturbance 
whatsoever.  The  sky  was  cloudy,  and  when  the  night 
came  it  was  impossible  to  see  if  the  apparent  movement  of 
the  stars  had  changed — which  would,  of  course,  have  indi- 
cated a  change  in  the  Earth's  axis. 

What  a  night  did  J.  T.  Maston  pass  in  his  retreat,  un- 
known to  all  save  Mrs.  Scorbitt!  He  raged!  He  raved! 
He  could  not  keep  still.  Would  that  he  had  been  a  few 
days  older,  to  see  if  the  curve  of  the  Sun  was  modified — 
an  indisputable  proof  of  the  success  of  the  operation.  On 
the  23rd  the  change  would  not  be  noticeable,  for  on  that 
day  the  Sun  invariably  rises  due  east  in  every  country  of 
the  globe. 

In  the  morning  the  Sun  rose  just  as  usual. 

Major  Donellan  and  his  friends  were  on  the  terrace  of 
their  hotel.  They  had  furnished  themselves  with  instru- 
ments of  extreme  precision,  which  would  show  if  the  Sun 
described  its  curve  in  the  plane  of  the  Equator. 

*There  was  nothing  to  show  that  it  did;  and  a  few 
minutes  after  it  had  risen  the  radiant  disk  inclined  toward 
the  southern  hemisphere. 

There  was  no  change  in  its  apparent  path. 


MASTON  REGRETS  NOT  BEING  LYNCHED  405 

The  Major  and  his  colleagues  expressed  their  delight  by 
giving  three  cheers  for  the  Sun. 

The  sky  was  superb,  the  horizon  quite  clear  from  the 
mists  of  the  night,  and  never  did  the  glorious  orb  present 
himself  under  greater  conditions  of  splendor  before  a 
wondering  people. 

"And*in  the  very  place  noted  by  the  laws  of  astronomy !" 
said  Baldenak. 

"Of  our  old  astronomy,"  said  Karkof,  "which  these 
madmen  attempted  to  annihilate!" 

"To  their  cost  and  shame,"  said  Jansen. 

"And  the  Arctic  regions  will  remain  under  their  eternal 
ice!"  said  Professor  Harald. 

"Hurrah  for  the  Sun!"  shouted  Donellan.  "He  is  good 
enough  for  us  as  he  is!" 

"Hurrah!  hurrah!"  said  the  others  on  the  balcony. 

Then  it  was  that  Todrin,  who  had  said  nothing,  re- 
marked judiciously,  "Perhaps  they  have  not  fired!" 

"Not  fired?"  ejaculated  the  Major  aghast. 

And  that,  with  a  different  intonation,  was  what  J.  T. 
Maston  and  Mrs.  Scorbitt  said. 

"Not  fired?" 

And  that  was  what  the  wise  and  the  foolish  were  ask- 
ing; and  it  was  what  Alcide  Pierdeux  said,  adding, 
"Whether  they  fired  or  no,  it  does  not  matter!  The 
Earth  will  still  spin  on  its  old  axis!" 

No  one  knew  what  had  passed  at  Kilimanjaro;  but 
before  the  end  of  the  day  an  answer  was  given  to  the 
question  that  puzzled  humanity. 

There  was  a  telegram  from  Zanzibar: — 

"To  John  S.  Wright,  Washington,  U.  S.  A. 

"Zanzibar,  23rd  September,  7:27  a.  m.,  local  time.  Dis- 
charge took  place  at  midnight  from  cannon  on  southern 
side  of  Kilimanjaro.  Projectile  traveled  with  fearful 
shriek.  Awful  explosion.  Province  devastated  by  a  tor- 
nado. Sea  risen  in  the  Mozambique  Channel.  Many  ships 
damaged  and  driven  on  shore.  Towns  and  villages  anni- 
hilated. All  well,  as  usual.— Richard  W.  Trust,  U.  S. 
Consul." 


406    PURCHASE  OF  THE  NORTH  POLE 

Yes.  All  well  as  usual!  Nothing  changed  in  the  state 
of  affairs  except  the  disasters  among  the  Wamasai  caused 
by  the  artificial  tornado  and  the  wrecks  caused  by  the 
risen  sea. 

And  had  it  not  been  the  same  when  the  famous  Colum- 
biad  had  sent  its  projectile  toward  the  Moon?  The  shock 
communicated  to  the  soil  of  Florida  had  only  been  ex- 
perienced for  a  hundred  miles  around.  But  this  time  the 
effect  ought  to  have  been  a  hundred  times  as  great. 

Under  any  circumstances  the  telegram  informed  the 
world  of  two  matters  of  interest: — 

1.  The  enormous  cannon  had  been  made  in  the  flank  of 
Kilimanjaro. 

2.  It  had  been  fired  at  the  time  stated. 

And  then  the  world  gave  a  shout  of  satisfaction,  which 
was  followed  by  an  immense  shout  of  laughter. 

Barbicane  &  Co.'s  attempt  had  failed  piteously!  J.  T. 
Maston's  calculations  might  as  well  be  put  in  the  waste- 
paper  basket !  The  North  Polar  Practical  Association  had 
nothing  now  to  do  but  go  into  another  kind  of  liquidation ! 

Could  it  be  possible  that  the  secretary  of  the  Gun  Club 
had  made  a  mistake? 

"I  would  rather  believe  I  am  deceived  in  the  affection 
with  which  he  inspires  me,"  said  Mrs.  Evangelina  Scorbitt. 

And  if  there  was  a  discomfited  being  on  the  face  of 
the  planet  it  was  J.  T.  Maston.  When  he  saw  that  nothing 
had  changed  in  the  conditions  of  the  Earth's  movement, 
he  was  buoyed  up  with  hope  that  some  accident  had  re- 
tarded the  work  of  Barbicane  and  Nicholl. 

But  since  the  Zanzibar  telegram  he  had  to  admit  that 
the  experiment  had  failed. 

Failed?  And  the  equations,  the  formulae  from  which  he 
had  deduced  the  success  of  the  enterprise!  Was  the  gun 
not  long  enough,  the  projectile  not  heavy  enough,  the  ex- 
plosive not  strong  enough?  No!  It  was  inadmissible! 

J.  T.  Maston  was  in  such  a  state  of  excitement  that  he 
declared  he  would  leave  his  retreat.  Mrs.  Scorbitt  tried 
in  vain  to  prevent  him.  Not  that  she  feared  for  his  life, 
for  the  danger  was  over.  But  the  pleasantries  that  would 
be  showered  on  the  unhappy  calculator,  the  jokes  that 
would  rain  on  his  work — she  would  have  spared  him. 

And,  still  more  serious,  what  was  the  reception  the  Gun 


MASTON  REGRETS  NOT  BEING  LYNCHED  407 

Club  would  give  him?  Would  they  retain  him  as  their 
secretary  after  a  failure  that  covered  them  with  ridicule? 
Was  not  he,  the  author  of  the  calculations,  entirely  re* 
sponsible  for  the  collapse? 

He  would  listen  to  nothing.  He  would  yield  neither  to 
the  tears  nor  prayers  of  Mrs.  Scorbitt.  He  came  out  of 
the  house  in  which  he  was  hidden.  He  appeared  in  the 
streets  of  Baltimore.  He  was  recognized,  and  those  whom 
he  had  menaced  in  their  fortune  and  existence,  whose 
anxiety  he  had  prolonged  by  his  obstinate  silence,  took 
vengeance  on  him  by  deriding  him  in  every  way. 

The  street  boys  shouted  after  him,  "Go  along,  old  Pole- 
shifter!"  "Hallo,  old  clock-jobber!"  "How's  the  figuring 
tinker?" 

And  a  mob  gathered  and  began  to  hustle  him,  and  he 
had  to  seek  refuge  in  the  New  Park  mansion,  where  Mrs. 
Scorbitt  did  her  best  to  console  him.  It  was  in  vain. 

J.  T.  Maston — after  the  example  oHt  Niobe — would  not 
be  consoled.  His  gun  had  produced  no  more  effect  on 
the  terrestrial  spheroid  than  an  ordinary  petard. 

A  fortnight  went  by,  and  the  world  had  already  for- 
gotten the  North  Polar  Practical  Association.  A  fort- 
night, and  no  news  of  Barbicane  or  Captain  Nicholl! 
Had  they  perished  in  the  counter-shock  of  the  explosion, 
victims  to  the  ravages  produced  among  the  Wamasai? 
Had  they  paid  with  their  lives  for  the  biggest  mystifica- 
tion of  modern  times? 

No.  At  the  explosion  Barbicane  and  Nicholl  had  been 
thrown  down;  so  had  the  Sultan,  and  several  thousand 
natives;  but  they  had  all  risen  again  safe  and  sound. 

"Is  it  a  success?"  asked  Bali-Bali,  rubbing  his  shoulders. 

"Can  you  doubt  it?" 

"I — doubt  it!     But  when  shall  we  know?" 

"In  a  day  or  two !"  said  Barbicane. 

Did  he  see  that  the  attempt  had  failed? 

Possibly.  But  he  never  would  have  admitted  it  to  the 
monarch  of  the  Wamasai. 

Two  days  afterward  Barbicane  and  Nicholl  took  their 
leave  of  Bali-Bali,  not  without  paying  a  good  round  sum 
for  the  destruction  done  to  the  surface  of  his  kingdom. 
And  as  the  money  went  to  his  own  private  pocket,  and  his 


408        PURCHASE  OF  THE  NORTH  POLE 

subjects  got  not  a  dollar,  he  had  no  cause  to  regret  so 
lucrative  an  affair. 

Then  the  two  friends,  followed  by  their  foremen,  reached 
Zanzibar,  where  they  found  a  vessel  starting  for  Suez. 
There,  under  assumed  names,  they  took  passage  to  Mar- 
seilles, whence  by  the  P.  L.  M.  and  the  Quest  they  reached 
Havre,  where  they  went  on  board  the  Bourgogne  and 
crossed  the  Atlantic. 

In  twenty-two  days  after  they  left  the  Wamasai  they 
were  in  New  York. 

On  the  1 5th  of  October,  at  three  o'clock  in  the  after- 
noon, they  knocked  at  the  door  of  the  mansion  in  New 
Park. 

A  minute  afterward  they  were  in  the  presence  of  Mrs. 
Scorbitt  and  J.  T.  Maston. 

CHAPTER  XX 

THE   END   OF   THIS    REMARKABLE   STORY 

"BARBICANE?    Nicholl?" 

"Maston!" 

"You?" 

"We!" 

And  in  that  pronoun,  spoken  simultaneously  by  the  two 
in  a  singular  tone,  there  was  everything  that  could  be 
said  in  the  way  of  irony  and  reproach. 

J.  T.  Maston  passed  his  iron  hook  across  his  forehead. 
Then  in  a  voice  that  hissed  between  his  lips  he  asked : 

"Your  gallery  at  Kilimanjaro  was  two  thousand  feet 
long  and  ninety  in  diameter?" 

"Yes." 

"Your  projectile  weighed  one  hundred  and  eighty  thou- 
sand tons?" 

"Yes." 

"And  you  used  two  thousand  tons  of  meli-melonite  ?" 

"Yes." 

The  three  yes's  fell  like  blows  of  a  sledge-hammer  on 
J.  T.  Maston's  occiput. 

"Then  I  conclude — "  he  said. 

"What?"  asked  Barbicane. 


THE  END  OF  THIS  REMARKABLE  STORY  409 

"That,  as  the  experiment  failed,  the  explosive  did  not 
give  the  projectile  the  necessary  initial  velocity!" 

"Indeed!"  said  Captain  Nicholl. 

"And  that  your  meli-melonite  is  only  fit  for  pop-guns!" 

Captain  Nicholl  started  at  the  insult. 

"Maston!"  he  exclaimed. 

"Nicholl!" 

"Will  you  fight  me  with  meli-melonite?" 

"No;  with  fulmi-cotton.     It  is  surer!" 

Mrs.  Scorbitt  hastened  to  interfere. 

"Gentlemen!  Gentlemen!"  she  said.    "Between  friends!" 

Then  Impey  Barbicane  put  in  a  word  very  quietly. 
"What  is  the  use  of  abusing  each  other?  It  is  certain 
that  the  calculations  of  our  friend  Maston  were  correct, 
and  it  is  certain  that  the  explosive  of  our  friend  Nicholl 
was  sufficient!  We  followed  exactly  the  teachings  of 
science!  And  we  failed!  For  what  reason?  Probably 
we  shall  never  know!" 

"Well,"  said  the  secretary  of  the  Gun  Club;  "we  will 
try  it  again!" 

"And  the  money  which  has  been  lost?"  observed  Cap- 
tain Nicholl. 

"And  public  opinion,  which  will  not  permit  you  to  again 
risk  the  fate  of  the  world?"  added  Mrs.  Scorbitt. 

"What  will  become  of  the  North  Pole?"  asked  Nicholl. 

"What  is  the  value  of  the  shares  in  the  North  Polar 
Practical  Association?"  asked  Barbicane. 

Oh,  what  a  fall  there  had  been  thereof!  The  certifi- 
cates could  be  bought  at  waste-paper  prices. 

Such  was  the  memorable  fiasco  of  the  gigantic  project 
of  Barbicane  &  Co. 

If  ever  unfortunate  engineers  were  overwhelmed  with 
ridicule,  if  ever  there  were  amusing  articles  in  the  news- 
papers, caricatures,  comic  songs,  parodies — it  was  then. 
Barbicane,  the  director  of  the  Association,  the  members  of 
the  Gun  Club,  were  literally  covered  with  scorn.  The 
storm  of  contempt  was  so  thoroughly  American  that  it 
was  untranslatable  even  in  Volapuk.  And  Europe  joined 
in  with  such  vigor  that  at  last  America  was  scandalized. 
And  then  remembering  that  Barbicane,  Nicholl,  and  Mas- 
ton  were  of  American  birth,  and  belonged  to  the  famous 
club  of  Baltimore,  a  reaction  in  their  favor  set  in,  which 


410    PURCHASE  OF  THE  NORTH  POLE 

was  almost  strong  enough  to  make  the  United  States  de- 
clare war  against  the  Old  World. 

But  was  it  ever  to  be  known  why  the  enterprise  failed? 
Did  the  failure  prove  that  the  project  was  impossible,  that 
the  forces  of  which  man  disposes  will  never  be  sufficient  to 
bring  about  a  change  in  the  Earth's  diurnal  movement, 
that  never  would  the  Polar  regions  be  displaced  in  latitude 
to  such  an  extent  that  their  icy  mantle  will  be  melted  by 
the  solar  rays? 

That  this  was  the  case  appeared  undoubted  a  few  days 
after  the  return  of  Barbicane  and  Nicholl  to  the  United 
States. 

A  letter  appeared  in  the  Parisian  Temps  of  the  i/th  of 
October,  which  did  mankind  a  service  in  confirming  it  in 
its  feeling  of  security. 

The  letter  was  the  following: — 

"The  abortive  attempt  to  furnish  the  Earth  with  a  new 
axis  is  now  known.  Nevertheless,  the  calculations  of  J. 
T.  Maston  were  correctly  founded,  and  would  have  pro- 
duced the  desired  results  if  by  some  inexplicable  distrac- 
tion they  had  not  been  nullified  by  an  error  at  the  outset. 

"In  fact,  the  celebrated  secretary  of  the  Gun  Club  took 
for  his  basis  the  circumference  of  the  terrestrial  spheroid 
at  forty  thousand  metres  instead  of  forty  million  metres 
— and  that  nullified  the  solution. 

"How  came  he  to  make  such  an  error?  What  could 
have  caused  it?  How  could  so  remarkable  a  mathema- 
tician have  made  such  a  mistake?  Conjecture  is  vain. 

"There  is  no  doubt  that  the  problem  of  the  change  of 
the  terrestrial  axis  was  correctly  stated,  and  it  should  have 
been  correctly  worked  out.  But  the  initial  error  of  three 
noughts  produced  an  error  of  twelve  noughts  in  the  final 
result. 

"It  is  not  a  cannon  a  million  times  as  large  as  a  four 
hundred-pounder,  but  a  million  million  million  such  can- 
nons, hurling  a  million  million  million  projectiles  of  one 
hundred  and  eighty  thousand  tons,  that  would  displace  the 
Pole  23°  28',  supposing  that  meli-melonite  has  the  ex- 
pansive power  attributed  to  it  by  Captain  Nicholl. 

"In  short,  the  effect  of  the  discharge  at  Kiliman- 
jaro has  been  to  displace  the  Pole  three  microns — that  is, 


THE  END  OF  THIS  REMARKABLE  STORY  411 

one  ten-thousandth  of  an  inch,  and  the  maximum  effect 
on  the  level  of  the  sea  must  have  been  just  nine-thousandths 
of  a  micron. 

"The  projectile  has  become  a  small  planet,  and  hence- 
forth belongs  to  our  system,  in  which  it  is  retained  by  the 
solar  attraction. 

"ALCIDE  PIERDEUX." 

So  it  was  some  distraction  of  J.  T.  Maston's,  an  error 
of  three  noughts  at  the  beginning  of  his  calculations,  that 
had  brought  this  humiliating  disaster  on  Barbicane  &  Co. 
The  members  of  the  Gun  Club  were  furious,  but  among 
the  general  public  a  reaction  arose  in  favor  of  the  poor 
fellow.  After  all,  it  was  this  mistake  which  had  caused  all 
the  evil — or  rather  all  the  good,  for  it  saved  the  world 
from  ruin. 

And  so  compliments  came  in  from  all  parts,  and  letters 
arrived  in  millions  congratulating  J.  T.  Maston  on  having 
forgotten  his  three  noughts! 

But  that  extraordinary  man,  more  deeply  disgusted  than 
ever,  would  not  listen  to  the  congratulatory  world.  Barbi- 
cane, Nicholl,  Tom  Hunter  with  the  wooden  legs,  Colonel 
Bloomsberry,  the  brisk  Bilsby,  and  their  friends,  would 
never  forgive  him. 

But  at  least  there  remained  Mrs.  Scorbitt! 
At  first  J.  T.  Maston  refused  to  admit  that  he  had  made 
a  mistake;  and  set  to  work  to  check  his  calculations. 

Sulphuric  Alcide  was,  however,  accurate.  And  that  was 
why,  when  he  found  the  error  at  the  last  moment,  and 
had  no  time  to  reassure  his  fellow-men  he  so  calmly 
sipped  his  pleasant  hot  cup  of  coffee  while  the  spinal  mar- 
row was  so  unpleasantly  cool  in  his  fellow-men's  backs. 

There  was  no  disguising  the  fact.  Three  noughts  had 
slipped  out  of  the  terrestrial  waist! 

Then  it  was  that  J.  T.  Maston  remembered!  It  was  at 
the  beginning  of  his  labors  when  he  had  shut  himself  up  in 
Ballistic  Cottage.  He  had  written  the  number  40,000,000 
on  the  blackboard. 

At  that  moment  came  a  hurried  tinkle  from  the  tele- 
phone. He  had  gone  to  the  instrument.  He  had  ex- 
changed a  few  words  with  Mrs.  Scorbitt.  There  was  a 
flash  of  lightning  that  upset  him  and  his  blackboard.  He 


412    PURCHASE  OF  THE  NORTH  POLE 

picked  himself  and  his  blackboard  up.  He  began  to  write 
in  the  figures  half  rubbed  out  by  the  fall.  He  had  just 
written  40,000 — when  the  bell  rang  a  second  time.  And 
when  he  returned  to  work  he  had  forgotten  the  three  last 
noughts  in  the  measure  of  the  Earth's  equator! 

Now  all  that  was  the  fault  of  Mrs.  Scorbitt.  If  she  had 
not  bothered  him  he  would  never  have  been  knocked 
down  by  the  return  shock  of  that  electrical  discharge. 

And  so  the  unhappy  woman  also  received  a  shock  when 
J.  T.  Maston  told  her  how  the  mistake  had  been  made. 
Yes !  She  was  the  cause  of  the  disaster !  It  was  her  doing 
that  J.  T.  Maston  was  now  dishonored  for  the  many  years 
he  had  to  live,  for  it  was  the  general  custom  to  die  as 
centenarians  in  the  Gun  Club. 

And  after  the  interview  J.  T.  Maston  fled  from  the 
house  in  New  Park.  He  went  back  to  Ballistic  Cottage 
He  strode  about  his  work-room  saying  to  himself: 

"Now  I  am  good  for  nothing  in  the  world !" 

"Not  even  if  you  were  to  marry?"  said  a  voice  which 
emotion  made  heartrending. 

It  was  Mrs.  Scorbitt. 

Tearful  and  distracted  she  had  followed  J.  T.  Maston. 

"Dear  Maston!"  said  she. 

"Well!  Yes!"  said  he;  "on  one  condition— that  I  never 
again  touch  mathematics." 

"I  abominate  them!"  said  the  widow. 

And  thus  it  was  that  Mrs.  Scorbitt  became  Mrs.  J.  T. 
Maston. 

As  to  Alcide  Pierdeux,  what  honor,  what  celebrity  that 
letter  brought  both  him  and  his  old  school!  Translated 
into  all  languages,  copied  into  all  newspapers,  it  made  his 
name  known  throughout  the  world. 

It  happened,  therefore,  that  the  father  of  the  pretty 
Provengale,  who  had  refused  him  his  daughter's  hand 
because  he  was  too  learned,  came  to  read  the  famous  letter 
in  the  Petit  Marseillais.  Without  any  assistance  he  man- 
aged to  make  out  its  meaning.  And  then  he  was  seized 
with  remorse,  and,  as  a  preliminary  measure,  sent  Sul- 
phuric Alcide  an  invitation  to  dinner. 

And  so  the  world  was  left  as  it  was. 

No  attempt  was  made  by  Barbicane  &  Co.  to  resume 
business.  Any  attempt  would  have  been  futile.  Alcide's 


THE  END  OF  THIS  REMARKABLE  STORY  413 

contention  was  indisputable.  It  could  be  shown  by 
mechanics  that  to  effect  a  displacement  of  23°  28',  even 
with  meli-melonite,  so  many  Kilimanjaro  guns  or  mines 
would  be  required,  that  the  surface  of  the  spheroid  could 
not  hold  them. 

The  world's  inhabitants  could  thus  sleep  in  peace.  To 
modify  the  conditions  of  the  Earth's  movement  is  beyond 
the  powers  of  man.  It  is  not  given  to  mankind  to  change 
the  order  established  by  the  Creator  in  the  system  of  the 
Universe. 

THE   END. 


PLEASE  DO  NOT  REMOVE 
CARDS  OR  SlIPS  FROM  THIS  POCKET 

UNIVERSITY  OF  TORONTO  LIBRARY 


H&SS 

•' 

3384 
V.13